SONIC AUTOMOTIVE INC
S-1/A, 1997-11-06
AUTO DEALERS & GASOLINE STATIONS
Previous: FINANCIAL ASSET SEC INC MORT PART SECURITIES SER 1997-NAMC2, 8-K, 1997-11-06
Next: PINNACLE BANCSHARES INC /GA, SC 13D, 1997-11-06




<PAGE>
   
    As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 6, 1997
    
                                                      Registration No. 333-33295
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
                            ------------------------
   
                                AMENDMENT NO. 7
    
                                       TO
                                    FORM S-1
                             REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                     UNDER
                           THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                            ------------------------
                             Sonic Automotive, Inc.
             (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
<TABLE>
<S>                                <C>                             <C>
           Delaware                            5511                     56-2010790
(State or Other Jurisdiction of    (Primary Standard Industrial      (I.R.S. Employer
Incorporation or Organization)     Classification Code Number)     Identification No.)
</TABLE>
 
                        5401 East Independence Boulevard
                                 P.O. Box 18747
                        Charlotte, North Carolina 28218
                            Telephone (704) 532-3301
         (Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including
            area code, of Registrant's principal executive offices)
                               ------------------
                              Mr. O. Bruton Smith
                            Chief Executive Officer
                             Sonic Automotive, Inc.
                        5401 East Independence Boulevard
                                 P.O. Box 18747
                        Charlotte, North Carolina 28218
                            Telephone (704) 532-3301
      (Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including
                        area code, of agent for service)
                               ------------------
                                   Copies To:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                             <C>
                      Gary C. Ivey, Esq.                                           Stuart H. Gelfond, Esq.
            Parker, Poe, Adams & Bernstein L.L.P.                          Fried, Frank, Harris, Shriver & Jacobson
                     2500 Charlotte Plaza                                             One New York Plaza
               Charlotte, North Carolina 28244                                     New York, New York 10004
                   Telephone (704) 372-9000                                        Telephone (212) 859-8000
</TABLE>
 
                               ------------------
        Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public:
As soon as practicable after the effective date of this Registration Statement.
                               ------------------
     If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on
a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of
1933, check the following box. [ ]
     If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering
pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following box
and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier
effective registration statement for the same offering. [ ] __________________.
     If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c)
under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act
registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement
for the same offering. [ ] __________________.
     If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434,
please check the following box. [ ]
                               ------------------
     The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or
dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall
file a further amendment that specifically states that this Registration
Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of
the Securities Act of 1933 or until the Registration Statement shall become
effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting
pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
<PAGE>
                                EXPLANATORY NOTE
     This Registration Statement contains two separate prospectuses. The first
prospectus relates to a public offering of shares of Class A Common Stock of
Sonic Automotive, Inc., par value $.01 per share (the "Class A Common Stock") in
the United States and Canada (the "U.S. Offering). The second prospectus relates
to a concurrent offering of Class A Common Stock outside the United States and
Canada (the "International Offering"). The prospectuses for the U.S. Offering
and the International Offering will be identical in all respects, except for
their respective front cover pages, first page of "Prospectus Summary",
"Underwriting" sections and back cover pages. Such alternate pages to be
included in the International Offering prospectus appear in this Registration
Statement immediately following the complete prospectus for the U.S. Offering.
 
<PAGE>

(A redherring appears on the left hand side of this page, rotated 90 degrees. 
Text follows.)

Information contained herein is subject to completion or amendment. A
registration statement relating to these securities has been filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission. These securities may not be sold nor may 
offers to buy be accepted prior to the time the registration statement becomes 
effective. This Prospectus shall not constitute an offer to sell or the 
solicitation of an offer to buy nor shall there be any sale of these 
securities in any State in which such offer, solicitation or sale would be 
unlawful prior to registration or qualification under the securities laws of 
any such State.


   
                             SUBJECT TO COMPLETION
                 PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUS DATED NOVEMBER 5, 1997
    
PROSPECTUS
                                5,000,000 Shares

                          (Sonic Automotive Inc. logo)
 
                              Class A Common Stock
                            ------------------------
     All of the 5,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock, par value $.01 per
share (the "Class A Common Stock"), offered hereby are being sold by Sonic
Automotive, Inc. ("Sonic" or the "Company"). Of the 5,000,000 shares of Class A
Common Stock offered hereby, 4,000,000 shares are being offered for sale
initially in the United States and Canada by the U.S. Underwriters (as defined
herein) and 1,000,000 shares are being offered for sale initially in a
concurrent offering outside the United States and Canada by the International
Managers (as defined herein). The initial public offering price and the
aggregate underwriting discount per share will be identical for both the U.S.
Offering and the International Offering. See "Underwriting."
     Each share of Class A Common Stock entitles its holder to one vote per
share. Each share of Class B Common Stock, par value $.01 per share (the "Class
B Common Stock," and together with the Class A Common Stock, the "Common
Stock"), entitles the holder to ten votes per share, except in certain limited
circumstances. All of the shares of Class B Common Stock are held by the members
of the Smith Group (as defined herein), who are all of the stockholders of the
Company prior to the consummation of the Offering. After consummation of the
Offering, the Smith Group will beneficially own shares representing
approximately 92.6% of the combined voting power of the Company's Common Stock
(approximately 91.6% if the Underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised in
full). See "Description of Capital Stock -- Common Stock."
     Prior to the Offerings, there has been no public market for the Class A
Common Stock. It is currently estimated that the initial public offering price
will be between $12.00 and $14.00 per share. For a discussion of factors to be
considered in determining the initial public offering price, see "Underwriting."
     The Class A Common Stock has been approved for listing on the New York
Stock Exchange, subject to official notice of issuance, under the symbol "SAH."
     See "Risk Factors" beginning on page 9 for a discussion of certain factors
that should be considered by prospective purchasers of the Class A Common Stock
offered hereby.
                            ------------------------
THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES
  AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS
    THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES
     COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS
        PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL
                                      OFFENSE.
[CAPTION]
<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>                       <C>                       <C>
                                                                Price to                Underwriting              Proceeds to
                                                                 Public                 Discount (1)              Company (2)
<S>                                                     <C>                       <C>                       <C>
Per Share...........................................               $                         $                         $
Total (3)...........................................               $                         $                         $
</TABLE>
(1) The Company has agreed to indemnify the several Underwriters against certain
    liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, as
    amended. See "Underwriting."
(2) Before deducting expenses payable by the Company estimated at $2,000,000.
(3) The Company has granted to the U.S. Underwriters and the International
    Managers options to purchase up to an additional 600,000 and 150,000 shares
    of Class A Common Stock, respectively, in each case exercisable within 30
    days of the date hereof and solely to cover over-allotments, if any. If such
    options are exercised in full, the total Price to Public, Underwriting
    Discount and Proceeds to Company will be $       , $       and $       ,
    respectively. See "Underwriting."
                            ------------------------
     The shares of Class A Common Stock are being offered by the several
Underwriters, subject to prior sale, when, as and if issued to and accepted by
them, subject to approval of certain legal matters by counsel for the
Underwriters and certain other conditions. The Underwriters reserve the right to
withdraw, cancel or modify such offer and to reject orders in whole or in part.
It is expected that delivery of the shares of Class A Common Stock will be made
in New York, New York on or about        , 1997.
                            ------------------------
Merrill Lynch & Co.
                      NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
                                                      Wheat First Butcher Singer
                            ------------------------
                 The date of this Prospectus is        , 1997.
 
<PAGE>

                    (Sonic Automotive Inc. logo)
                          (Map appears here)
 
Fort Mill Chrysler
Plymouth Dodge
Fort Mill Ford
Frontier Oldsmobile
Cadillac
Lake Norman Chrysler-
Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
Lake Norman Dodge
Lone Star Ford
Dodge of Chattanooga
Infiniti of Chattanooga
Jaguar of Chattanooga
Dyer and Dyer Volvo
Ken Marks Ford
Kia and Volkswagen
of Chattanooga
Cleveland Village Honda
Cleveland Chrysler-
Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
Nelson Bowers Ford
BMW and Volvo
of Chattanooga


     The Company intends to furnish its stockholders with annual reports 
containing financial statements audited by its independent public accountants 
and will make available copies of its quarterly reports for the first three 
quarters of each year.

    Certain persons participating in the Offering may engage in transactions 
that stabilize, maintain, or otherwise affect the price of the Class A 
Common Stock. Such transactions may include stabilizing, the purchase of 
Class A Common Stock to cover syndicate short positions and the imposition 
of penalty bids. For a description of these activities, see 
"Underwriting."

                          -----------------
    This Prospectus includes statistical data regarding the retail automotive
industry. Unless otherwise indicated herein, such data is taken or derived 
from information published by a division of Intertec Publishing Corp. in its
"Ward's Dealer Business," Crain's Communications, Inc. in its "Automotive
News" and "1997 Market Data Book" and the Industry Analysis Division of the
National Automobile Dealers Association ("NADA") in its "Industry
Analysis and Outlook" and "Automotive Executive Magazine" publications.

    No Manufacturer (as defined in this Prospectus) has been involved, directly
or indirectly, in the preparation of this Prospectus or in the Offering being
made hereby. Although, as described in this Prospectus, Manufacturers will
have granted consents for various of the Acquisitions (as defined herein) and
for this Offering, no Manufacturer has made any statements or representations
for the purpose of such statements or representations being included in this
Prospectus, and no Manufacturer has any responsibility for the accuracy or
completeness of this Prospectus.


 
<PAGE>
                               PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
     The following summary is qualified in its entirety by, and should be read
in conjunction with, the more detailed information and financial statements
(including the notes thereto) appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus. References
in this Prospectus to "Sonic" or the "Company" (i) are to Sonic Automotive, Inc.
and, unless the context indicates otherwise, its consolidated subsidiaries and
their respective predecessors, (ii) give effect to a recently completed
Reorganization (as defined below) of the Company, and (iii) assume that the
Company has consummated the acquisition of the assets or all the capital stock
of six additional dealerships or dealership groups, as described herein, in
North Carolina, Tennessee, Florida, Georgia and South Carolina (the
"Acquisitions"). See "The Acquisitions." References to the "Offering" are to the
offering of 4,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock made hereby in the United
States and Canada by the U.S. Underwriters (the "U.S. Offering") and to the
concurrent offering of 1,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock outside the
United States and Canada by the International Managers (the "International
Offering"), collectively. References to the "Underwriters" are to the U.S.
Underwriters and the International Managers, collectively. Unless otherwise
indicated, all information in this Prospectus (a) gives retroactive effect to a
625-for-1 stock split (effected in the form of a stock dividend) of the
Company's Class B Common Stock to be consummated prior to the consummation of
the Offering (the "Stock Split") and (b) assumes that the Underwriters'
over-allotment option is not exercised. The Acquisitions will be consummated on
or before the closing of the Offering.
                                  The Company
     The Company is one of the leading automotive retailers in the United
States, operating 23 dealership franchises, four standalone used vehicle
facilities and seven collision repair centers in the southeastern and
southwestern United States. Sonic sells new and used cars and light trucks,
sells replacement parts, provides vehicle maintenance, warranty, paint and
repair services and arranges related financing and insurance ("F&I") for its
automotive customers. The Company's business is geographically diverse, with
dealership operations in the Charlotte, Chattanooga, Nashville,
Tampa-Clearwater, Houston and Atlanta markets, each of which the Company
believes is experiencing favorable demographic trends. Sonic sells 15 domestic
and foreign brands, which consist of BMW, Cadillac, Chrysler, Dodge, Ford,
Honda, Infiniti, Jaguar, Jeep, KIA, Oldsmobile, Plymouth, Toyota, Volkswagen and
Volvo. In several of its markets, the Company has a significant market share for
new cars and light trucks, including 13.7% in Charlotte and 9.1% in Chattanooga
in 1996. Pro forma for the Acquisitions, the Company had revenues of $899.6
million and retail unit sales of 24,206 new and 13,475 used vehicles in 1996.
The Company believes that in 1996, based on pro forma retail unit sales, it
would have been one of the ten largest dealer groups out of a total of more than
15,000 dealer groups in the United States.
     The Company's founder and Chief Executive Officer, O. Bruton Smith, has
over 30 years of automotive retailing experience. In addition, the Company's
other executive officers, regional vice presidents and executive managers have
on average 18 years of automotive retailing experience. The Company's
dealerships are among those dealerships that have won the highest attainable
awards from various manufacturers measuring quality and customer satisfaction.
These awards include the Five Star Award from Chrysler, the Chairman's Award
from Ford, the President's Award from BMW and the President's Circle Award from
Infiniti. In addition, the Company was named to Ford's Top 100 Club, which
consists of Ford's top 100 retailers based on retail volume and consumer
satisfaction.
     The Company intends to pursue an acquisition growth strategy led by a
management team that has experience in the consolidation of automotive retailing
as well as motorsports businesses. Bruton Smith, who is also the Chief Executive
Officer of Speedway Motorsports, Inc., the owner and operator of several
motorsports facilities, first entered the automotive retailing business in the
mid-1960's. Mr. Smith will devote approximately 50% of his business time to the
Company. Since 1990, Mr. Smith has successfully acquired three dealerships and
increased his dealerships' revenues from $199.4 million in 1992 to $376.6
million in 1996, without giving effect to the Acquisitions. In the Tennessee
market, Nelson E. Bowers, II, the Company's Executive Vice President, has
acquired or opened eight dealerships since 1992 and increased revenues
(primarily through acquisitions) of the dealership group to be acquired by the
Company from $13.2 million in 1992 to $101.5 million in 1996. No assurance can
be given that Messrs. Smith and Bowers will be successful in acquiring or
opening new dealerships for the Company or increasing the Company's revenues.
     The Company believes the competitive advantages which differentiate it from
its local competitors include the reputation of the Company's management in the
automotive retailing industry, regional and national economies of scale, brand
and geographic diversity, and the established customer base and local name
recognition of the Company's dealerships. The Company has developed and
implemented several growth strategies to capitalize on these competitive
advantages. One of these is to continue to expand its operations in the
Southeast and Southwest by acquiring additional dealerships both within its
current markets and in new markets. The Company also is seeking additional
growth from the increased sale of higher margin products and services such as
wholesale parts, after-market products, collision repair services and F&I.
     The Company believes that an opportunity exists for dealership groups with
significant equity capital and experience in identifying, acquiring and
professionally managing dealerships, to acquire additional dealerships and
capitalize on changes in
                                       3
 
<PAGE>
the automotive retailing industry. With approximately $640 billion in 1996
sales, automotive retailing is the largest consumer retail market in the United
States. The industry today is highly fragmented, with the largest 100 dealer
groups generating less than 10% of total sales revenues and controlling less
than 5% of all new vehicle dealerships. The Company believes that these factors,
together with increasing capital costs of operating automobile dealerships, the
lack of alternative exit strategies (especially for larger dealerships) and the
aging of many dealership owners provide attractive consolidation opportunities.
     Automobile retailing is highly competitive. The Company's competition
includes franchised automobile dealerships, some with greater resources than the
Company, selling the same or similar makes of vehicles offered by the Company.
Other competitors include other franchised dealers, private market buyers and
sellers of used vehicles, used vehicle dealers, service center chains and
independent service and repair shops. Primarily as a result of competitive
pressures, gross profit margins on new vehicle sales have been declining since
1986. The Company has also experienced gross profit margin pressure on used
vehicle sales over the last 18 months. For further discussion of competition
affecting the Company's business, see "Risk Factors -- Competition" and
"Business -- Competition."
Growth Strategy
(Bullet) Acquire Dealerships. The Company plans to implement a "hub and spoke"
         acquisition program primarily by pursuing (i) well-managed dealerships
         in new metropolitan and growing suburban geographic markets, and (ii)
         dealerships that will allow the Company to capitalize on regional
         economies of scale, offer a greater breadth of products and services in
         any of its markets or increase brand diversity.
          New Markets. The Company looks to acquire well-managed dealerships in
     geographic markets it does not currently serve, principally in the
     Southeast and Southwest regions of the United States. Generally, the
     Company will seek to retain the acquired dealerships' operational and
     financial management, and thereby benefit from their market knowledge, name
     recognition and local reputation.
          Existing Markets. The Company seeks growth in its operations within
     existing markets by acquiring dealerships that increase the brands,
     products and services offered in those markets. These acquisitions should
     produce opportunities for additional operating efficiencies, promote
     increased name recognition and provide the Company with better
     opportunities for repeat and referral business.
(Bullet) Pursue Opportunities in Ancillary Products and Services. The Company
         intends to pursue opportunities to increase its sales of higher-margin
         products and services by expanding its collision repair centers and its
         wholesale parts and after-market products businesses, which, other than
         after-market products, are not directly related to the new vehicle
         cycle.
          Collision Repair Centers. The Company's collision repair business
     provides favorable margins and is not significantly affected by economic
     cycles or consumer spending habits. The Company believes that because of
     the high capital investment required for collision repair shops and the
     cost of complying with environmental and worker safety regulations, large
     volume body shops will be more successful in the future than smaller volume
     shops. The Company believes that this industry will consolidate and that it
     will be able to expand its collision repair business. The Company currently
     has seven collision repair centers accounting for approximately $8.9
     million in pro forma revenue for the year ended 1996.
          Wholesale Parts. Over time, the Company plans to capitalize on its
     growing representation of numerous manufacturers in order to increase its
     sales of factory authorized parts to wholesale buyers such as independent
     mechanical and body repair garages and rental and commercial fleet
     operators.
          After-Market Products. The Company intends to expand its offerings of
     after-market products in many of its dealership locations. After-market
     products, such as custom wheels, performance parts, telephones and other
     accessories, enable the dealership to capture incremental revenue on new
     and used vehicle sales.
(Bullet) Enhance Profit Opportunities in Finance and Insurance. The Company
         offers its customers a wide range of financing and leasing alternatives
         for the purchase of vehicles, as well as credit life, accident and
         health and disability insurance and extended service contracts. As a
         result of its size and scale, the Company believes it will be able to
         negotiate with the lending institutions that purchase its financing
         contracts to increase the Company's revenues. Likewise, the Company
         expects to negotiate to increase the commissions it earns on extended
         service and insurance products.
(Bullet) Increase Used Vehicle Sales. The Company believes that there will be
         opportunities to improve the used vehicle departments at several of its
         dealerships. The Company currently operates four standalone used
         vehicle facilities. In 1998, the Company intends to convert part of an
         existing facility in Nashville to a used vehicle facility. It also
         intends to develop used vehicle facilities in other markets where
         management believes opportunities exist.
                                       4
 
<PAGE>
Operating Strategy
(Bullet) Operate Multiple Dealerships in Geographically Diverse Markets. The
         Company operates dealerships in Charlotte, Chattanooga, Nashville,
         Tampa-Clearwater, Houston and Atlanta. By operating in several
         locations throughout the United States, the Company believes it will be
         better able to insulate its earnings from local economic downturns. In
         addition, the Company believes that by establishing a significant
         market presence in its operating regions, it will be able to provide
         superior customer service through a market-specific sales, service,
         marketing and inventory strategy.
(Bullet) Achieve High Levels of Customer Satisfaction. Customer satisfaction has
         been and will continue to be a focus of the Company. The Company's
         personalized sales process is intended to satisfy customers by
         providing high-quality vehicles in a positive, "consumer friendly"
         buying environment. Some Manufacturers offer specific performance
         incentives, on a per vehicle basis, if certain customer satisfaction
         index ("CSI") levels (which vary by Manufacturer) are achieved by a
         dealer. Manufacturers can withhold approval of acquisitions if a dealer
         fails to maintain a minimum CSI score. Historically, the Company has
         not been denied Manufacturer approval of acquisitions based on CSI
         scores. To keep management focused on customer satisfaction, the
         Company includes CSI results as a component of its incentive
         compensation program.
(Bullet) Train and Develop Qualified Management. Sonic requires all of its
         employees, from service technicians to regional vice presidents, to
         participate in in-house training programs. The Company leverages the
         experience of senior management, along with third party trainers from
         manufacturers, industry affiliates and vendors, to formally train all
         employees. This training is also a convenient and effective way to
         share best practices among the Company's employees at all levels of the
         various dealerships. The Company believes that its comprehensive
         training of all employees at every level of their career path offers
         the Company a competitive advantage over other dealership groups in the
         development and retention of its workforce.
(Bullet) Offer a Diverse Range of Automotive Products and Services. Sonic offers
         a broad range of automotive products and services, including a wide
         selection of new and used vehicles, vehicle financing and insurance
         programs, replacement parts and maintenance and repair programs.
         Offering numerous new vehicle brands enables the Company to satisfy a
         variety of customers, reduces dependence on any one Manufacturer and
         reduces exposure to supply problems and product cycles.
(Bullet) Capitalize on Efficiencies in Operations. Because management
         compensation is based primarily on dealership performance, expense
         reduction and operating efficiencies are a significant management
         focus. As the Company pursues its acquisition strategy, the Company's
         size and market presence should provide it with an opportunity to
         negotiate favorable contracts on such expense items as advertising,
         purchasing, bank financings, employee benefit plans and other vendor
         contracts.
(Bullet) Utilize Professional Management Practices and Incentive Based
         Compensation Programs. As a result of Sonic's size and geographic
         dispersion, the Company's senior management has instituted a
         multi-tiered management structure to supervise effectively its
         dealership operations. In an effort to align management's interest with
         that of stockholders, a portion of the incentive compensation program
         for each officer, vice president and executive manager is provided in
         the form of Company stock options, with additional incentives based on
         the performance of individual profit centers. Sonic believes that this
         organizational structure, with room for advancement and the opportunity
         for equity participation, serves as a strong motivation for its
         employees.
(Bullet) Apply Technology Throughout Operations. The Company believes that, with
         the customized technology it has introduced in certain markets, it has
         been able to improve its operations over time by integrating its
         systems into all aspects of its business. In these markets the Company
         uses computer-based technology to monitor its dealerships' operating
         performance and quickly adjust to market changes and to integrate
         computer systems into its sales, F&I and parts and service operations.
         The Company intends to expand this computer system into more of its
         dealerships and markets as existing contracts for computer systems
         expire.
                               The Reorganization
     The Company was recently incorporated and capitalized with the stock of the
automobile dealerships that have been under the control of Bruton Smith
comprised of Town & Country Ford, Town & Country Toyota, Lone Star Ford, Fort
Mill Ford and Frontier Oldsmobile-Cadillac (the "Sonic Dealerships"). As of June
30, 1997, the Company effected a reorganization (the "Reorganization") pursuant
to which: (i) the Company acquired all of the capital stock or limited liability
company interests of the Sonic Dealerships (the "Dealership Securities"); and
(ii) the Company issued Class B Common Stock to the Smith Group in exchange for
the Dealership Securities. In connection with the Reorganization and the
Offering, the Company will convert from the last-in-first-out method (the "LIFO
Method") of inventory accounting to the first-in-first-out method (the "FIFO
Method") of inventory accounting (the "FIFO Conversion"), conditioned upon the
closing of the Offering. In connection with the FIFO Conversion, and in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, the accompanying
financial information of the Company has been retroactively restated to reflect
the FIFO Conversion. See "The Reorganization."
                                       5
 
<PAGE>
                                The Acquisitions
     In the past five months, the Company has consummated or signed definitive
agreements to purchase six dealerships or dealership groups for an aggregate
purchase price of approximately $94.8 million. These acquisitions consist of Ken
Marks Ford located in Clearwater, Florida (the "Ken Marks Acquisition")
(consummated on October 15, 1997), seven dealerships controlled by the Bowers
Transportation Group in Chattanooga, Tennessee and one dealership in Nashville,
Tennessee (the "Bowers Acquisition"), Lake Norman Dodge and Lake Norman
Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle located in Cornelius, North Carolina (the "Lake
Norman Acquisition") (consummated on September 29, 1997), Dyer & Dyer Volvo
located in Atlanta, Georgia (the "Dyer Acquisition"), the acquisition of the
assets of Jeff Boyd Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge located in Fort Mill, South
Carolina, by the Company's subsidiary, Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge Inc.
(the "Fort Mill Acquisition") (consummated on June 3, 1997), and the acquisition
of the assets of Williams Motors located in Rock Hill, South Carolina, by the
Company's subsidiary, Town and Country Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep of Rock Hill, Inc.
(the "Williams Acquisition") (consummated on October 10, 1997) (collectively,
the "Acquisitions"). The dealerships underlying the Acquisitions had aggregate
total revenues of approximately $490.1 million in 1996 and enhance the Company's
market presence in the Southeast. See "The Acquisitions."
     The Company's principal executive office is located at 5401 East
Independence Boulevard, Charlotte, North Carolina. Its mailing address is P.O.
Box 18747, Charlotte, North Carolina 28218, and its telephone number is (704)
532-3301.
                                  The Offering
<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>
Class A Common Stock Offered by the Company...........  5,000,000 shares (1)
Class A Common Stock initially offered in:
  The U.S. Offering (1)...............................  4,000,000 shares
  The International Offering (1)......................  1,000,000 shares
Common Stock to be outstanding after the Offering:
  Class A Common Stock................................  5,000,000 shares (1)(2)
  Class B Common Stock................................  6,250,000 shares
       Total..........................................  11,250,000 shares
Voting Rights.........................................  The Class A Common Stock and Class B Common Stock vote as a single
                                                        class on all matters, except as otherwise required by law, with each
                                                        share of Class A Common Stock entitling its holders to one vote and
                                                        each share of Class B Common Stock entitling its holder to ten votes
                                                        except with respect to certain limited matters. See "Description of
                                                        Capital Stock."
Use of proceeds.......................................  The net proceeds of the Offering will be used to fund the
                                                        Acquisitions, including repaying certain indebtedness incurred by the
                                                        Company in connection with the Acquisitions already consummated. See
                                                        "The Acquisitions" and "Use of Proceeds."
Listing...............................................  The Class A Common Stock has been approved for listing on the New
                                                        York Stock Exchange (the "NYSE"), subject to offical notice of
                                                        issuance, under the symbol "SAH."
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Does not include up to an aggregate of 600,000 and 150,000 shares of Class A
    Common Stock, respectively, that may be sold by the Company upon exercise of
    the over-allotment options granted to the U.S. Underwriters and the
    International Managers. See "Underwriting."
(2) Excludes (i) 1,125,000 shares of Class A Common Stock reserved for future
    issuance to Company employees under the Company's Stock Option Plan (as
    defined herein) (including up to 587,509 shares of Class A Common Stock
    reserved for issuance upon exercise of options to be granted on or before
    the consummation of the Offering pursuant to the Stock Option Plan), (ii)
    150,000 shares of Class A Common Stock reserved for issuance to eligible
    Company employees under the Company's ESPP (as defined herein) and (iii)
    42,187 shares of Class A Common Stock (45,000 shares if the U.S.
    Underwriters' and the International Managers' over-allotment options are
    exercised) reserved for issuance under the Dyer Warrant (defined herein).
    See "The Acquisitions -- The Dyer Acquisition" and "Management -- Stock
    Option Plan."
                                  Risk Factors
     The Company's ability to make acquisitions in the future may be limited to
some extent by the Manufacturers. The Company is required to obtain Manufacturer
approval for any acquisition in accordance with industry practice. Moreover,
pursuant to Manufacturer policies currently in effect or their approvals of the
transactions contemplated hereby, the Company could acquire no more than ten
Chrysler dealerships in the United States, no more than the lesser of (i) 15
Ford and 15 Lincoln Mercury dealerships or (ii) that number of Ford and Lincoln
Mercury dealerships accounting for 2% of the preceding year's retail sales of
those brands in the United States, six additional Toyota dealerships, three
Lexus dealerships, six additional Honda dealerships, three Acura dealerships and
five additional GM dealerships (within the next two years, subject to increase
under certain conditions). For additional information concerning these and other
limitations on acquisitions imposed by the Manufacturers, see "Risk
Factors -- Risks Associated with Acquisitions," " -- Stock Ownership/Issuance
Limits; Limitation on Ability to Issue Additional Equity" and
" -- Manufacturers' Restrictions on Acquisitions."
     See "Risk Factors" beginning on page 9 for a discussion of other factors
that should be considered by prospective purchasers of the Class A Common Stock
offered hereby.
                                       6
 
<PAGE>
   Summary Historical and Pro Forma Combined and Consolidated Financial Data
     The following Summary Historical and Pro Forma Combined and Consolidated
Financial Data should be read in conjunction with "Management's Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," the Combined and
Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company and the related notes and "Pro
Forma Combined and Consolidated Financial Data" included elsewhere in this
Prospectus. The Company acquired Fort Mill Ford, Inc. and Fort Mill
Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge in February 1996 and in June 1997, respectively. Both of
these acquisitions were accounted for using the purchase method of accounting.
As a result the Summary Historical Combined and Consolidated Financial Data
below does not include the results of operations of these dealerships prior to
the date they were acquired by the Company. Accordingly, the actual historical
data for the periods after the acquisition may not be comparable to data
presented for periods prior to the acquisitions of Fort Mill Ford and Fort Mill
Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge. Additionally, the Summary Historical and Pro Forma
Combined and Consolidated Financial Data below is not necessarily indicative of
the results of operations or financial position which would have resulted had
the Reorganization, the Acquisitions and the Offering occurred during the
periods presented. In connection with the FIFO Conversion, and in accordance
with generally accepted accounting principles, the Summary Historical and Pro
Forma Combined and Consolidated Financial Data has been retroactively restated
to reflect the FIFO Conversion.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                          Six Months Ended
                                                           Year Ended December 31,                            June 30,
                                       ---------------------------------------------------------------   -------------------
                                                                                                Pro
                                                              Actual                           Forma           Actual
                                       ----------------------------------------------------   --------   -------------------
                                         1992       1993       1994       1995     1996(1)    1996(2)    1996(1)    1997(3)
                                       --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
<S>                                    <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
                                                      (in thousands, except per share and vehicles unit data)
Combined and Consolidated Statement
  of Operations Data:
Revenues:
  Vehicle sales......................  $171,065   $203,630   $227,960   $267,308   $326,842   $788,255   $164,333   $185,077
  Parts, service and collision
    repair...........................    24,543     30,337     33,984     35,860     42,644     94,912     21,005     22,907
  Finance and insurance..............     3,743      3,711      5,181      7,813      7,118     16,471      4,277      4,763
                                       --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
    Total revenues...................   199,351    237,678    267,125    310,981    376,604    899,638    189,615    212,747
Cost of sales........................   174,713    208,445    233,011    270,878    331,047    786,129    167,191    188,422
                                       --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
Gross profit.........................    24,638     29,233     34,114     40,103     45,557    113,509     22,424     24,325
Selling, general and administrative
  expenses...........................    20,251     22,738     24,632     29,343     33,677     85,856     16,590     18,413
Depreciation and amortization........       682        788        838        832      1,076      3,510        360        396
                                       --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
Operating income.....................     3,705      5,707      8,644      9,928     10,804     24,143      5,474      5,516
Interest expense floor plan..........     2,215      2,743      3,001      4,505      5,968      9,342      2,801      3,018
Interest expense, other..............       290        263        443        436        433      3,171        184        269
Other income.........................     1,360        613        609        449        618      2,222        369        274
                                       --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
Income before income taxes and
  minority interest..................     2,560      3,314      5,809      5,436      5,021     13,852      2,858      2,503
Provision for income taxes...........        27        723      2,118      2,176      1,924      5,517      1,093        916
                                       --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
Income before minority interest......     2,533      2,591      3,691      3,260      3,097      8,335      1,765      1,587
Minority interest in earnings (loss)
  of subsidiary......................       (31)       (22)        15         22        114         --         41         47
                                       --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
Net income...........................  $  2,564   $  2,613   $  3,676   $  3,238   $  2,983   $  8,335   $  1,724   $  1,540
                                       --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                                       --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
Net income per share (4).............                                                         $   0.74
                                                                                              --------
                                                                                              --------
<CAPTION>
 
                                         Pro
                                        Forma
                                       --------
                                       1997(2)
                                       --------
<S>                                    <C>
 
Combined and Consolidated Statement
  of Operations Data:
Revenues:
  Vehicle sales......................  $418,624
  Parts, service and collision
    repair...........................    49,881
  Finance and insurance..............     9,410
                                       --------
    Total revenues...................   477,915
Cost of sales........................   419,492
                                       --------
Gross profit.........................    58,423
Selling, general and administrative
  expenses...........................    43,574
Depreciation and amortization........     1,662
                                       --------
Operating income.....................    13,187
Interest expense floor plan..........     5,241
Interest expense, other..............     1,674
Other income.........................     1,247
                                       --------
Income before income taxes and
  minority interest..................     7,519
Provision for income taxes...........     2,815
                                       --------
Income before minority interest......     4,704
Minority interest in earnings (loss)
  of subsidiary......................        --
                                       --------
Net income...........................  $  4,704
                                       --------
                                       --------
Net income per share (4).............  $   0.42
                                       --------
                                       --------
</TABLE>
 
Other Combined and
Consolidated Operating Data:
<TABLE>
<S>                                    <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
New vehicle units sold...............     8,060      9,429      9,686     10,273     11,693     24,206      6,027      6,553
Used vehicle units sold -- retail
  (5)................................     3,892      4,104      4,374      5,172      5,488     13,475      2,836      2,638
New vehicle sales revenues...........  $126,230   $152,525   $164,361   $186,517   $233,146   $540,505   $115,721   $137,069
Used vehicle sales revenues -- retail
  (5)................................    33,636     37,742     47,537     60,766     68,054    181,787     35,200     32,666
Parts, service and collision repair
  sales revenues.....................    24,543     30,337     33,984     35,860     42,644     94,912     21,005     22,906
Gross profit margin..................     12.4%      12.3%      12.8%      12.9%      12.1%      12.6%      11.8%      11.4%
New vehicle gross margin.............      6.7%       6.9%       7.0%       7.3%       7.4%       7.4%       6.6%       6.5%
Used vehicle gross margin (retail)
  (5)................................     10.7%      10.5%      10.9%       9.5%       8.4%       9.2%       8.4%       8.5%
Parts, service and collision repair
  gross margin.......................     36.3%      36.4%      35.9%      36.1%      36.5%      42.3%      35.8%      35.4%
<CAPTION>
New vehicle units sold...............    12,596
<S>                                    <C>
Used vehicle units sold -- retail
  (5)................................     7,043
New vehicle sales revenues...........  $285,143
Used vehicle sales revenues -- retail
  (5)................................    96,249
Parts, service and collision repair
  sales revenues.....................    49,881
Gross profit margin..................     12.2%
New vehicle gross margin.............      7.3%
Used vehicle gross margin (retail)
  (5)................................      8.9%
Parts, service and collision repair
  gross margin.......................     42.3%
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                As of
                                                                                    As of                   June 30, 1997
                                                                                 December 31,        ----------------------------
                                                                                     1996             Actual        Pro Forma
                                                                                --------------       --------    ----------------
<S>                                                                             <C>                  <C>         <C>
Combined and Consolidated Balance Sheet Data:
Working capital..............................................................      $ 19,780          $ 16,899        $ 41,382
Total assets.................................................................       110,976           120,384         295,139
Long-term debt...............................................................         5,286             5,137          36,980
Total liabilities............................................................        84,367            91,978         208,242
Minority interest............................................................           314                --              --
Stockholders' equity.........................................................        26,295            28,406          86,897
</TABLE>
 
                                                   (footnotes on following page)
                                       7
 
<PAGE>
- ---------------
(1) The actual statement of operations data for the year ended December 31, 1996
    includes the results of Fort Mill Ford, Inc. from the date of acquisition,
    February 1, 1996.
(2) For information regarding the pro forma adjustments made to the Company's
    historical financial data, which give effect to the Reorganization, the
    Acquisitions, and the Offering, see "Pro Forma Combined and Consolidated
    Financial Data."
(3) The actual statement of operations data for the six months ended June 30,
    1997 include the results of Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge, Inc. from the
    date of acquisition June 3, 1997.
(4) Historical net income per share is not presented, as the historical capital
    structure of the Company prior to the Offering is not comparable with the
    capital structure that will exist after the Offering.
(5) The term "retail" describes sales to consumers as compared to sales to
    wholesalers.
   
                            RECENT DEVELOPMENTS

     The Company's unaudited total revenues and gross profit for the 
nine months ended September 30, 1997 were $339.8 million and 
$39.2 million, respectively, representing increases of $56.4 million 
or 19.9% and $5.2 million or 15.4%, respectively, from the 
comparable 1996 period. These increases were primarily due to increases 
in sales from retail vehicles and parts, service, collision and 
repair services, along with additional revenues from the acquisitions of 
the Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge, Lake Norman Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep 
and Lake Norman Dodge dealerships. Operating income and net income 
for the nine months ended September 30, 1997 were $8.7 million 
and $2.5 million, respectively, representing increases of $0.8 million 
or 10.0% and $46,000 or 1.9%, respectively, primarily due to the increase 
in gross profit and the stability of selling, general and administrative 
expenses as a percentage of total revenues.
    
   
     Total revenues and gross profit for the third quarter ended September 30,
1997 were $127.1 million and $14.8 million, respectively, representing increases
of $33.3 million or 35.4% and $3.3 million or 29.0%, respectively, from the
comparable 1996 period. These increases were primarily due to increases in sales
from retail vehicles and parts, service, collision and repair services, along
with additional revenue from the acquisitions of the Fort Mill
Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge, Lake Norman Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep and Lake Norman
Dodge dealerships. Operating income and net income for the quarter ended
September 30, 1997 were $3.2 million and $0.9 million, respectively,
representing increases of $0.7 million or 30.4% and $0.2 million or 33.4%,
respectively, primarily due to the increase in gross profit and a decrease in
selling, general and administrative expenses as a percentage of total revenues.
    
                                       8
 

<PAGE>
                                  RISK FACTORS
     Prospective investors should carefully consider and evaluate all of the
information set forth in this Prospectus, including the principal risk factors
set forth below.
Dependence on Automobile Manufacturers
     Each of the Company's dealerships operates pursuant to a franchise
agreement between the applicable automobile manufacturer (or authorized
distributor thereof) (the "Manufacturer") and the subsidiary of the Company that
operates such dealership. The Company is dependent to a significant extent on
its relationship with such Manufacturers.
     After giving effect to the Reorganization and the Acquisitions, vehicles
manufactured by Ford Motor Company ("Ford"), Chrysler Corporation ("Chrysler"),
Volvo Motors ("Volvo") and Toyota Motor Sales (U.S.A.) ("Toyota") accounted for
approximately 64.5%, 17.9%, 6.0% and 5.8%, respectively, of the Company's 1996
pro forma unit sales of new vehicles. No other Manufacturer accounted for more
than 5% of the new vehicle sales of the Company during 1996. See "Business --
New Vehicle Sales," and " -- Relationships with Manufacturers." Accordingly, a
significant decline in the sale of Ford, Chrysler, Toyota, or Volvo new cars
could have a material adverse effect on the Company. Manufacturers exercise a
great degree of control over the operations of the Company's dealerships. Each
of the franchise agreements provides for termination or non-renewal for a
variety of causes, including any unapproved change of ownership or management
and other material breaches of the franchise agreements. The Company believes
that it is in compliance in all material respects with all its franchise
agreements. The Company has no reason to believe that it will not be able to
renew all of its franchise agreements upon expiration, but there can be no
assurance that any of such agreements will be renewed or that the terms and
conditions of such renewals will be favorable to the Company. If a Manufacturer
terminates or declines to renew one or more of the Company's significant
franchise agreements, such action could have a material adverse effect on the
Company and its business. Actions taken by Manufacturers to exploit their
superior bargaining position in negotiating the terms of such renewals or
otherwise could also have a material adverse effect on the Company. See
"Business -- Relationships with Manufacturers."
     The Company also depends on the Manufacturers to provide it with a
desirable mix of popular new vehicles that produce the highest profit margins
and which may be the most difficult to obtain from the Manufacturers. If the
Company is unable to obtain a sufficient allocation of the most popular
vehicles, its profitability may be materially adversely affected. In some
instances, in order to obtain additional allocations of these vehicles, the
Company purchases a larger number of less desirable models than it would
otherwise purchase and its profitability may be materially adversely affected
thereby. The Company's dealerships depend on the Manufacturers for certain sales
incentives and other programs that are intended to promote dealership sales or
support dealership profitability. Manufacturers have historically made many
changes to their incentive programs during each year. A reduction or
discontinuation of a Manufacturer's incentive programs may materially adversely
affect the profitability of the Company.
     The success of each of the Company's dealerships depends to a great extent
on the financial condition, marketing, vehicle design, production capabilities
and management of the Manufacturers which the Company represents. Events such as
strikes and other labor actions by unions, or negative publicity concerning a
particular Manufacturer or vehicle model, may materially and adversely affect
the Company. Similarly, the delivery of vehicles from Manufacturers later than
scheduled, which may occur particularly during periods when new products are
being introduced, can lead to reduced sales. Although, the Company has attempted
to lessen its dependence on any one Manufacturer by establishing dealer
relationships with a number of different domestic and foreign automobile
Manufacturers, adverse conditions affecting Ford, Chrysler, Toyota and Volvo in
particular, could have a material adverse affect on the Company. For instance,
workers at a Chrysler engine plant went on strike in April 1997 for 29 days. The
strike by the United Auto Workers caused Chrysler's vehicle production to drop
during the Spring of 1997, especially for production of its most popular truck
and van models. This strike materially affected the Company due to Chrysler's
inability to provide the Company with a sufficient supply of new vehicles and
parts during such period. In the event of another such strike, the Company may
need to purchase inventory from other automobile dealers at prices higher than
it would be required to pay to the Manufacturers in order to carry an adequate
level and mix of inventory. Consequently, such events could materially adversely
affect the financial results of the Company. See "Business -- New Vehicle Sales"
and " -- Relationship with Manufacturers."
     Many Manufacturers attempt to measure customers' satisfaction with their
sales and warranty service experiences through systems which vary from
Manufacturer to Manufacturer but which are generally known as CSI. These
Manufacturers may use a dealership's CSI scores as a factor in evaluating
applications for additional dealership acquisitions and other matters such as
vehicle inventory allocations. The components of CSI have been modified from
time to time in the past, and there is no assurance that such components will
not be further modified or replaced by different systems in the future. To date,
the Company has not been adversely affected by these standards and has not been
denied approval of any acquisition based on low CSI scores. However, there can
be no assurance that the Company will be able to comply with such standards
                                       9
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
in the future. Failure of the Company's dealerships to comply with the standards
imposed by Manufacturers at any given time may have a material adverse effect on
the Company.
     The Company must also obtain approvals by the applicable Manufacturer for
any of its acquisitions. See " -- Risks Associated with Acquisitions."
Competition
     Automobile retailing is a highly competitive business with over 22,000
franchised automobile dealerships in the United States at the beginning of 1996.
The Company's competition includes franchised automobile dealerships selling the
same or similar makes of new and used vehicles offered by the Company in the
same markets as the Company and sometimes at lower prices than those of the
Company. These dealer competitors may be larger and have greater financial and
marketing resources than the Company. Other competitors include other franchised
dealers, private market buyers and sellers of used vehicles, used vehicle
dealers, service center chains and independent service and repair shops. Gross
profit margins on sales of new vehicles have been declining since 1986. The
Company has also had margin pressure on its used vehicle sales over the last 18
months. The used car market faces increasing competition from non-traditional
outlets such as used-car "superstores," which use sales techniques such as one
price shopping, and the Internet. Several groups have begun to establish
nationwide networks of used vehicle superstores. In Charlotte and Atlanta, where
the Company has significant operations, CarMax Superstores operate in
competition with the Company. In addition, car superstores operate in many of
the Company's other markets. "No negotiation" sales methods are also being tried
for new cars by at least one of these superstores and by dealers for Saturn and
other dealerships. Some recent market entrants may be capable of operating on
smaller gross margins compared to the Company, and may have greater financial,
marketing and personnel resources than the Company. In addition, certain
Manufacturers, such as Ford, have publicly announced that they may directly
enter the retail market in the future, which could have a material adverse
effect on the Company. The increased popularity of short-term vehicle leasing
also has resulted, as these leases expire, in a large increase in the number of
late model vehicles available in the market, which puts added pressure on
margins. As the Company seeks to acquire dealerships in new markets, it may face
increasingly significant competition (including from other large dealer groups
and dealer groups that have publicly-traded equity) as it strives to gain market
share through acquisitions or otherwise.
     The Company's franchise agreements do not give the Company the exclusive
right to sell a Manufacturer's product within a given geographic area. The
Company could be materially adversely affected if any of its Manufacturers award
franchises to others in the same markets where the Company is operating. A
similar adverse affect could occur if existing competing franchised dealers
increase their market share in the Company's markets. The Company's gross
margins may decline over time as it expands into markets where it does not have
a leading position. These and other competitive pressures could materially
adversely affect the Company's results of operations. See
"Business -- Competition."
Operating Condition of Acquired Businesses
     Although the Company has conducted what it believes to be a prudent level
of investigation regarding the operating condition of the assets to be purchased
in the Acquisitions in light of the circumstances of each transaction, certain
unavoidable levels of risk remain regarding the actual operating condition of
these assets. Until the Company actually assumes operating control of such
assets, it will not be able to ascertain their actual value and, therefore, will
be unable to ascertain whether the price paid for the Acquisitions represented a
fair valuation. The same risk regarding the actual operating condition of
businesses to be acquired will also apply to future acquisitions by the Company.
Risks of Consolidating Operations as a Result of the Acquisitions
     In connection with the Acquisitions, Sonic is acquiring six dealerships or
dealership groups. Each of these dealerships or groups has been operated and
managed as a separate independent entity to date, and the Company's future
operating results will depend on its ability to integrate the operations of
these businesses and manage the combined enterprise. The Company's management
group has been expanded in connection with these Acquisitions. There can be no
assurance that the management group will be able to effectively and profitably
integrate in a timely manner each of the dealerships included in the
Acquisitions or any future acquisitions, or to manage the combined entity
without substantial costs, delays or other operational or financial problems.
The inability of the Company to do so could have a material adverse effect on
the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.
Risks Associated with Acquisitions
     The retail automobile industry is considered a mature industry in which
minimal growth is expected in unit sales of new vehicles. Accordingly, the
Company's future growth will depend in large part on its ability to acquire
additional dealerships as well as on its ability to manage expansion, control
costs in its operations and consolidate dealership acquisitions, including the
Acquisitions, into existing operations. In pursuing a strategy of acquiring
other dealerships, including the Acquisitions,
                                       10
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
the Company faces risks commonly encountered with growth through acquisitions.
These risks include, but are not limited to, incurring significantly higher
capital expenditures and operating expenses, failing to assimilate the
operations and personnel of the acquired dealerships, disrupting the Company's
ongoing business, dissipating the Company's limited management resources,
failing to maintain uniform standards, controls and policies, impairing
relationships with employees and customers as a result of changes in management
and causing increased expenses for accounting and computer systems, as well as
integration difficulties. Installing new computer systems has in the past
disrupted existing operations as management and salespersons adjust to new
technologies. In addition, as contracts with existing suppliers of the Company's
computer systems expire, the Company's strategy may be to install new systems at
its existing dealerships. The Company expects that it will take one to two years
to fully integrate an acquired dealership into the Company's operations and
realize the full benefit of the Company's strategies and systems. There can be
no assurance that the Company will be successful in overcoming these risks or
any other problems encountered with such acquisitions, including in connection
with the Acquisitions. Acquisitions may also result in significant goodwill and
other intangible assets that are amortized in future years and reduce future
stated earnings. See "The Acquisitions," "Management's Discussion and Analysis
of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business -- Growth
Strategy."
     Although there are many potential acquisition candidates that fit the
Company's acquisition criteria, there can be no assurance that the Company will
be able to consummate any such transactions in the future or identify those
candidates that would result in the most successful combinations, or that future
acquisitions will be able to be consummated at acceptable prices and terms. In
addition, increased competition for acquisition candidates could result in fewer
acquisition opportunities for the Company and higher acquisition prices. The
magnitude, timing and nature of future acquisitions will depend upon various
factors, including the availability of suitable acquisition candidates,
competition with other dealer groups for suitable acquisitions, the negotiation
of acceptable terms, the Company's financial capabilities, the availability of
skilled employees to manage the acquired companies and general economic and
business conditions.
     In addition, the Company's future growth as a result of its acquisition of
automobile dealerships will depend on its ability to obtain the requisite
Manufacturer approvals. There can be no assurance that it will be able to obtain
such consents in the future. See " -- Manufacturers' Restrictions on
Acquisitions" and "Business -- Relationships with Manufacturers."
     In certain cases, the Company may be required to file applications and
obtain clearances under applicable federal antitrust laws before consummation of
an acquisition. These regulatory requirements may restrict or delay the
Company's acquisitions, and may increase the cost of completing such
transactions.
Limitations on Financial Resources Available for Acquisitions; Possible
Inability to Refinance Existing Debt
     The Company intends to finance acquisitions with cash on hand, through
issuances of equity or debt securities and through borrowings under credit
arrangements. The Company anticipates the borrowing limit under its long-term
credit arrangements will be increased following consummation of the Offering,
although no assurance can be given that any such increase will occur or that
such increase will adequately meet the Company's future financing needs.
Similarly, there is no assurance that the Company will be able to obtain
additional debt or equity securities financing. Using cash to complete
acquisitions could substantially limit the Company's operating or financial
flexibility. Using stock to consummate acquisitions may result in significant
dilution of stockholders' percentage interest in the Company, which dilution may
be prohibited by the Company's franchise agreements with Manufacturers. See
" -- Stock Ownership/Issuance Limits." If the Company is unable to obtain
financing on acceptable terms, the Company may be required to reduce
significantly the scope of its presently anticipated expansion, which could
materially adversely affect the Company's business. See "The Acquisitions,"
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operation -- Liquidity and Capital Resources" and "Business -- Growth Strategy."
     In addition, the Company is dependent to a significant extent on its
ability to finance the purchase of inventory, which in the automotive retail
industry involves significant sums of money in the form of floor plan financing.
As of June 30, 1997 on a pro forma basis for the Acquisitions, the Company had
approximately $142.2 million of floor plan indebtedness. Substantially all the
assets of the Company's dealerships are pledged to secure such indebtedness,
which may impede the Company's ability to borrow from other sources. Many floor
plan lenders are associated with Manufacturers with whom the Company has
franchise agreements. Consequently, deterioration of the Company's relationship
with a Manufacturer could adversely affect its relationship with the affiliated
floor plan lender and vice-versa. In addition, the Company must obtain new floor
plan financing or obtain consents to assume such financing in connection with
its acquisition of dealerships. See " -- Dependence on Automobile
Manufacturers."
     The Company's obligations under the Six-Month Facility (as defined herein)
are guaranteed by Bruton Smith, the Company's Chairman and Chief Executive
Officer, which guarantee is secured by a pledge of shares of Speedway
Motorsports, Inc. common stock owned by Bruton Smith. The Company's obligations
under the Revolving Facility (as defined herein) are guaranteed by Bruton Smith
and are secured by, among other things, a pledge of shares of Speedway
Motorsports, Inc.
                                       11
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
common stock owned by Sonic Financial Corporation ("Sonic Financial"). The
Company currently intends to re-finance the Six-Month Facility (to the extent
not repaid through proceeds of the Offering) with additional borrowings under
the Revolving Facility, which the Company anticipates will be expanded from its
current limit of $26.0 million to $75.0 million following the consummation of
the Offering. (If net proceeds of the Offering to the Company are $70 million or
greater, the guarantee of the Revolving Facility by Bruton Smith and the pledge
of shares of Speedway Motorsports, Inc. common stock owned by Sonic Financial,
will be released pursuant to the terms of the Revolving Facility. If net
proceeds of the Offering to the Company are less than $70 million, Sonic
Financial will be required to provide continued credit support for the Revolving
Facility in the form of a pledge of shares of Speedway Motorsports, Inc. common
stock owned by Sonic Financial equal in value to three times the amount of the
shortfall between $70 million and the actual net proceeds of the Offering to the
Company.) When the Company will need to refinance the Revolving Facility, there
can be no assurance that Mr. Smith will agree to guarantee such debt or that the
assets of Mr. Smith or Sonic Financial will be available to provide additional
security under a new credit agreement, or that a new credit agreement could be
arranged on terms as favorable as the terms of the Six-Month Facility or the
Revolving Facility without a guarantee by, or pledge of the assets of, Mr. Smith
or Sonic Financial.
Stock Ownership/Issuance Limits; Limitation on Ability to Issue Additional
Equity
     Standard automobile franchise agreements prohibit transfers of any
ownership interests of a dealership and its parent, such as Sonic, and,
therefore, often do not by their terms accommodate public trading of the capital
stock of a dealership or its parent. While, prior to the Offering and as a
condition thereto, all of the Manufacturers of which Company subsidiaries are
franchisees will have agreed to permit the Offering and trading in the Class A
Common Stock (except as described under " -- No Consent From Jaguar or KIA"), a
number of Manufacturers will continue to impose restrictions upon the
transferability of the Common Stock. Ford may cause the Company to sell or
resign from one or more of its Ford franchises if any person or entity (other
than members of the Smith Group) acquires 15% or more of the Company's voting
securities. Likewise, General Motors, Toyota and Nissan Motor Corporation In
U.S.A. ("Infiniti") may force the sale of their respective franchises if 20% of
more of the Company's voting securities are so acquired. American Honda Co.,
Inc. ("Honda") may force the sale of the Company's Honda franchise if any person
or entity, excluding members of the Smith Group, acquires 5% of the Common Stock
(10% if such entity is an institutional investor), and Honda deems such person
or entity to be unsatisfactory. Volkswagen of America, Inc. ("Volkswagen") has
approved of the public sale of only 25% of the voting control of the Company and
requires prior approval of any change in control or management of the Company
that would affect the Company's control or management of its Volkswagen
franchise subsidiaries. Chrysler also has approved of the public sale of only
50% of the Common Stock and requires prior approval of any future sales that
would result in a change in voting or managerial control of the Company. Honda's
approval of the Offering is subject to the Smith Group plus Nelson Bowers owning
51% of the shares of Common Stock on a fully-diluted basis. Upon consummation of
the Offering, 48.9% of the Common Stock (on a fully diluted basis after giving
effect to the options to be issued at the time of the Offering under the Stock
Option Plan) will be owned by persons other than the Smith Group or Nelson
Bowers (assuming full exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment option).
Accordingly, the Company will not be able to issue additional shares of Common
Stock (in connection with an acquisition or otherwise) or options without the
consent of Honda and Chrysler or being in violation of such dealership
agreement. See "Business -- Relationships with Manufacturers." In a similar
manner, the lending arrangements the Company has recently obtained require that
voting control over the Company be maintained by the Smith Group. See
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources." Any transfer of shares of the
Company's Common Stock, including a transfer by members of the Smith Group, will
be outside the control of the Company and, if such transfer results in a change
in control of the Company, could result in the termination or non-renewal of one
or more of its franchise agreements and in a default under its credit
arrangements. Moreover, these issuance limitations may impede the Company's
ability to raise capital through additional equity offerings or to issue Common
Stock as consideration for, and therefore, to consummate, future acquisitions.
Such restrictions also may prevent or deter prospective acquirors from acquiring
control of the Company and, therefore, may adversely impact the Company's equity
value. See " -- Limitations on Financial Resources Available for Acquisitions;
Possible Inability to Refinance Existing Debt."
     The Company has contractual obligations to provide "piggyback" registration
rights to holders of Class B Common Stock to register their shares under the
Securities Act under certain circumstances. Additionally, such shares will
become in the future, eligible for sale pursuant to the terms of Rule 144
promulgated under the Securities Act ("Rule 144"). See "Certain
Transactions -- Registration Rights Agreement" and "Shares Eligible for Future
Sale." The Company will also issue certain stock options prior to consummation
of the Offering. See "Management -- Stock Option Plan."
Manufacturers' Restrictions on Acquisitions
     The Company is required to obtain the consent of the applicable
Manufacturer prior to the acquisition of any additional dealership franchises.
There can be no assurance that Manufacturers will grant such approvals.
Obtaining the consent of the Manufacturers for acquisitions of dealerships could
also take a significant amount of time. Obtaining the approvals of the
Manufacturers for the Acquisitions has taken approximately five months. Although
no assurances can be given, the Company
                                       12
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
believes that Manufacturer approvals of subsequent acquisitions from
Manufacturers with which the Company has previously completed applications and
agreements may take less time. The Company has received the approval of all of
the applicable Manufacturers in connection with the Acquisitions except Jaguar
Cars, a division of Ford ("Jaguar") and Kia Motors America, Inc. ("KIA"). If the
Company experiences delays in obtaining, or fails to obtain, approvals of the
Manufacturers for acquisitions of dealerships, the Company's growth strategy
could be materially adversely affected. In determining whether to approve an
acquisition, the Manufacturers may consider many factors, including the moral
character, business experience, financial condition, ownership structure and CSI
scores of the Company and its management. In addition, under an applicable
franchise agreement or under state law a Manufacturer may have a right of first
refusal to acquire a dealership in the event the Company seeks to acquire a
dealership franchise.
     In addition, a Manufacturer may limit the number of such Manufacturers'
dealerships that may be owned by the Company or the number that may be owned in
a particular geographic area. For example, Ford currently limits the Company to
no more than the lesser of (i) 15 Ford and 15 Lincoln Mercury dealerships or
(ii) that number of Ford and Lincoln Mercury dealerships accounting for 2% of
the preceding year's retail sales of those brands in the United States. It also
limits the Company to owning only one Ford dealership in any market area, as
defined by Ford, having three or less Ford dealerships in it and no more than
25% of the Ford dealerships in a market area having four or more Ford
dealerships. Chrysler has asked the Company to defer any further acquisitions of
Chrysler or Chrysler division dealerships until it has established a proven
performance record with the Chrysler dealerships it owns or is acquiring in the
Acquisitions. BMW has made a similar request. Moreover, Chrysler has recently
announced its general policy of limiting ownership to ten Chrysler dealerships
in the United States, six Chrysler dealerships in the same sales zone, as
determined by Chrysler, and two dealerships in the same market (but no more than
one like vehicle line brand in the same market). Toyota currently limits the
number of dealerships which may be owned by any one group to seven Toyota and
three Lexus dealerships nationally and restricts the number of dealerships that
may be owned to (i) the greater of one dealership, or 20% of the Toyota dealer
count in a "Metro" market (as defined by Toyota), (ii) the lesser of five
dealerships or 5% of the Toyota dealerships in any Toyota region (currently 12
geographic regions), and (iii) two Lexus dealerships in any one of the four
Lexus geographic areas. Toyota further requires that at least nine months elapse
between acquisitions. Similarly, it is currently the policy of Honda to restrict
any company from holding more than seven Honda or more than three Acura
franchises nationally and to restrict the number of franchises to (i) one Honda
dealership in a "Metro" market (a metropolitan market represented by two or more
Honda dealers) with two to 10 Honda dealership points, (ii) two Honda
dealerships in a Metro market with 11 to 20 Honda dealership points, (iii) three
Honda dealerships in a Metro market with 21 or more Honda dealership points,
(iv) no more than 4% of the Honda dealerships in any one of the 10 Honda
geographic zones, (v) one Acura dealership in a Metro market (a metropolitan
market with two or more Acura dealership points), and (vi) two Acura dealerships
in any one of the six Acura geographic zones. Toyota and Honda also prohibit
ownership of contiguous dealerships and the coupling of a franchise with any
other brand without their consent. General Motors Corporation ("GM" or "General
Motors") has limited the number of GM dealerships that the Company may acquire
during the next two years to five additional GM dealership locations, which
number may be increased on a case-by-case basis. In addition, GM limits the
maximum number of GM dealerships that the Company may acquire to 50% of the GM
dealerships, by franchise line, in a GM-defined geographic market area having
multiple GM dealers.
     As a condition to granting their consent to the Acquisitions, a number of
Manufacturers have also imposed certain other restrictions on the Company. In
addition to the restrictions under " -- Stock Ownership/Issuance Limits;
Limitation on Ability to Issue Additional Equity" above, these restrictions
principally consist of restrictions on (i) certain material changes in the
Company or extraordinary corporate transactions such as a merger, sale of a
material amount of assets or change in the Board of Directors or management of
the Company which could have a material adverse effect on the Manufacturer's
image or reputation or could be materially incompatible with the Manufacturer's
interests; (ii) the removal of a dealership general manager without the consent
of the Manufacturer; and (iii) the use of dealership facilities to sell or
service new vehicles of other manufacturers. If the Company is unable to comply
with these restrictions, the Company generally must (i) sell the assets of the
dealerships to the Manufacturer or to a third party acceptable to the
Manufacturer, or (ii) terminate the dealership agreements with the Manufacturer.
Other manufacturers may impose other and more stringent restrictions in
connection with future acquisitions.
     The Company owns, after giving effect to the Reorganization and the
Acquisitions, five Ford dealerships, six Chrysler dealerships, two BMW
dealerships, two Volvo dealerships, two Volkswagen dealerships and one
dealership each of GM, Toyota, Honda, Jaguar, Infiniti and KIA.
No Consent from Jaguar or KIA
     The Company has not entered into any agreement with respect to the approval
by (a) Jaguar of the proposed acquisition of the assets of the Jaguar of
Chattanooga dealership (the "Jaguar Dealership") or (b) KIA of the proposed
acquisition of the assets of the KIA of Chattanooga dealership (the "KIA
Dealership") by the Company as a part of the Bowers Acquisition. The Company and
each of Jaguar and KIA are continuing to negotiate with respect to this matter,
although no assurance can
                                       13
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
be given that such negotiations will result in an arrangement that is favorable
to the Company. If Jaguar or KIA refuses to give its approval to the Company,
the Company may not be able to acquire the Jaguar Dealership or the KIA
Dealership, as the case may be. The Jaguar Dealership and the KIA Dealership
each accounted for less than 1% of the Company's 1996 pro forma revenues and
profits, respectively.
Potential Conflicts of Interest
     Bruton Smith, the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of the Company, will
continue to serve as the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Speedway
Motorsports. Accordingly, the Company will compete with Speedway Motorsports for
the management time of Mr. Smith. Under his employment agreement with the
Company, Mr. Smith is required to devote approximately 50% of his business time
to the affairs of the Company. The remainder of his business time may be devoted
to other entities including Speedway Motorsports.
     The Company has in the past and will likely in the future enter into
transactions with entities controlled by either Mr. Smith, Nelson Bowers or Ken
Marks or other affiliates of the Company. The Company believes that all of these
arrangements are favorable to the Company and were entered into on terms that,
taken as a whole, reflect arms'-length negotiations, although certain lease
provisions included in such transactions may be at below-market rates. Since no
independent appraisals evaluating these business transactions were obtained,
there can be no assurance that such transactions are on terms no less favorable
than could have been obtained from unaffiliated third parties. Certain of the
existing arrangements will continue after the Offering. Potential conflicts of
interest could also arise in the future between the Company and these affiliated
parties in connection with the enforcement, amendment or termination of these
arrangements. See "Certain Transactions." The Company anticipates renegotiating
its leases with all related parties at lease expiration at fair market rentals,
which may be higher than current rents. For further discussion of these related
party leases, see "Certain Transactions -- Certain Dealership Leases."
     In addition to his interest and responsibilities with the Company, Nelson
Bowers has ownership interests in several non-Company entities, including a
Toyota dealership in Cleveland, Tennessee, an auto body shop in Chattanooga,
Tennessee a used-car auction house and a Saturn dealership in Chattanooga,
Tennessee which he may negotiate to sell back to the manufacturer. These
enterprises are involved in businesses that are related to, and that compete
with, the businesses of the Company. Pursuant to his employment agreement, Mr.
Bowers is not permitted to participate actively in the operation of those
businesses (other than the Saturn dealership) and is only permitted to maintain
a passive investment in these enterprises.
     Under the General Corporation Law of Delaware ("Delaware Law") generally, a
corporate insider is precluded from acting on a business opportunity in his
individual capacity if that opportunity is one which the corporation is
financially able to undertake, is in the line of the corporation's business, is
of practical advantage to the corporation and is one in which the corporation
has an interest or reasonable expectancy. Accordingly, corporate insiders are
generally required to engage in new business opportunities of the Company only
through the Company unless a majority of the Company's disinterested directors
decide under the standards discussed above that it is not in the best interest
of the Company to pursue such opportunities.
     The Company's Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (the
"Certificate") contains provisions providing that transactions between the
Company and its affiliates must be no less favorable to the Company than would
be available in corporate transactions in arms'-length dealing with an unrelated
third party. Moreover, any such transactions involving aggregate payments in
excess of $500,000 must be approved by a majority of the Company's directors and
a majority of the Company's independent directors. Otherwise, the Company must
obtain an opinion as to the financial fairness of the transaction to be issued
by an investment banking or appraisal firm of national standing.
Lack of Independent Directors
     As of the date hereof, all of the members of the Company's Board of
Directors are employees and/or majority shareholders of the Company or
affiliates thereof. Although the Company intends to appoint at least two
independent directors following completion of the Offering, such directors will
not constitute a majority of the Board, and the Company's Board may not have a
majority of independent directors in the future. In the absence of a majority of
independent directors, the Company's executive officers, who also are principal
stockholders and directors, could establish policies and enter into transactions
without independent review and approval thereof, subject to certain restrictions
under the Certificate. In addition, although the Company intends to establish
audit and compensation committees which will consist entirely of outside
directors, until those committees are established, audit and compensation
policies could be approved without independent review. These and other
transactions could present the potential for a conflict of interest between the
Company and its stockholders generally and the controlling officers,
stockholders or directors. See "Management."
                                       14
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
Dependence on Key Personnel and Limited Management and Personnel Resources
     The Company's success depends to a significant degree upon the continued
contributions of its management team (particularly its senior management) and
service and sales personnel. Additionally, Manufacturer franchise agreements
require the prior approval of the applicable Manufacturer before any change is
made in franchise general managers. For instance, Volvo has required that Nelson
Bowers and Richard Dyer maintain a 20% interest in, and be the general managers
of, the Company's Volvo dealerships formerly owned by them. Consequently, the
loss of the services of one or more of these key employees could have a material
adverse effect on the Company. Although the Company has employment agreements
with Bruton Smith, Bryan Scott Smith, Nelson Bowers, Theodore M. Wright, O. Ken
Marks, Jr. and Jeffrey C. Rachor, the Company will not have employment
agreements in place with other key personnel. In addition, as the Company
expands it may need to hire additional managers and will likely be dependent on
the senior management of any businesses acquired. The market for qualified
employees in the industry and in the regions in which the Company operates,
particularly for general managers and sales and service personnel, is highly
competitive and may subject the Company to increased labor costs in periods of
low unemployment. The loss of the services of key employees or the inability to
attract additional qualified managers could have a material adverse effect on
the Company. In addition, the lack of qualified management or employees employed
by the Company's potential acquisition candidates may limit the Company's
ability to consummate future acquisitions. See "Business -- Growth Strategy,"
"Business -- Competition" and "Management."
Mature Industry; Cyclical and Local Nature of Automobile Sales
     The United States automobile dealership industry generally is considered a
mature industry in which minimal growth is expected in unit sales of new
vehicles. As a consequence, growth in the Company's revenues and earnings are
likely to be significantly affected by the Company's success in acquiring and
integrating dealerships and the pace and size of such acquisitions. See
" -- Risks Associated with Acquisitions" and "Business -- Growth Strategy."
     The automobile industry is cyclical and historically has experienced
periodic downturns characterized by oversupply and weak demand. Many factors
affect the industry, including general economic conditions and consumer
confidence, the level of discretionary personal income, interest rates and
credit availability. For the six months ended June 30, 1997, industry retail
sales were down 2% as a result of retail car sales declines of 5.3% and retail
truck sales gains of 2.4% from the same period in 1996. Future recessions may
have a material adverse effect on the Company's business.
     Local economic, competitive and other conditions also affect the
performance of dealerships. The Sonic Dealerships are located in the Charlotte
and Houston markets. Pursuant to the Acquisitions, the Company is acquiring
dealerships in the metropolitan areas of Charlotte, Chattanooga, Nashville,
Tampa-Clearwater and Atlanta. While the Company intends to pursue acquisitions
outside of these markets, the Company expects that the majority of its
operations will continue to be concentrated in these areas for the foreseeable
future. As a result, the Company's results of operations will depend
substantially on general economic conditions and consumer spending habits in the
Southeast and, to a lesser extent, in the Houston market, as well as various
other factors, such as tax rates and state and local regulations, specific to
North Carolina, Tennessee, Florida, Texas, Georgia and South Carolina. There can
be no assurance that the Company will be able to expand geographically, or that
any such expansion will adequately insulate it from the adverse effects of local
or regional economic conditions. See "Business -- Growth Strategy."
Seasonality
     The Company's business is seasonal, with a disproportionate amount of
revenues occurring in the second, third and fourth fiscal quarters. See
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations."
Imported Product Restrictions and Foreign Trade Risks
     Certain motor vehicles retailed by the Company, as well as certain major
components of vehicles retailed by the Company, are of foreign origin.
Accordingly, the Company is subject to the import and export restrictions of
various jurisdictions and is dependent to some extent upon general economic
conditions in and political relations with a number of foreign countries,
particularly Japan and Sweden. Additionally, fluctuations in currency exchange
rates may adversely affect the Company's sales of vehicles produced by foreign
manufacturers. Imports into the United States may also be adversely affected by
increased transportation costs and tariffs, quotas or duties.
Adverse Effect of Governmental Regulation; Environmental Regulation Compliance
Costs
     The Company is subject to a wide range of federal, state and local laws and
regulations, such as local licensing requirements, and consumer protection laws.
The violation of these laws and regulations can result in civil and criminal
penalties being levied against the Company or in a cease and desist order
against Company operations that are not in compliance. Future acquisitions by
the Company may also be subject to regulation, including antitrust reviews. The
Company believes
                                       15
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
that it complies in all material respects with all laws and regulations
applicable to its business, but future regulations may be more stringent and
require the Company to incur significant additional costs.
     The Company's facilities and operations are also subject to federal, state
and local laws and regulations relating to environmental protection and human
health and safety, including those governing wastewater discharges, air
emissions, the operation and removal of underground storage tanks, the use,
storage, treatment, transportation and disposal of solid and hazardous materials
and the remediation of contamination associated with such disposal. Certain of
these laws and regulations may impose joint and several liability on certain
statutory classes of persons for the costs of investigation or remediation of
contaminated properties, regardless of fault or the legality of the original
disposal. These persons include the present or former owner or operator of a
contaminated property and companies that generated, disposed of or arranged for
the disposal of hazardous substances found at the property.
     Past and present business operations of the Company subject to such laws
and regulations include the use, storage handling and contracting for recycling
or disposal of hazardous or toxic substances or wastes, including
environmentally sensitive materials such as motor oil, waste motor oil and
filters, transmission fluid, antifreeze, freon, waste paint and lacquer thinner,
batteries, solvents, lubricants, degreasing agents, gasoline and diesel fuels.
The Company is subject to other laws and regulations as a result of the past or
present existence of underground storage tanks at many of the Company's
properties. The Company, like many of its competitors, has incurred, and will
continue to incur, capital and operating expenditures and other costs in
complying with such laws and regulations. In addition, soil and groundwater
contamination exist at certain of the Company's properties, and there can be no
assurance that other properties have not been contaminated by any leakage from
underground storage tanks or by any spillage or other releases of hazardous or
toxic substances or wastes.
     Certain laws and regulations, including those governing air emissions and
underground storage tanks, have been amended so as to require compliance with
new or more stringent standards as of future dates. The Company cannot predict
what other environmental legislation or regulations will be enacted in the
future, how existing or future laws or regulations will be administered or
interpreted or what environmental conditions may be found to exist in the
future. Compliance with new or more stringent laws or regulations, stricter
interpretation of existing laws or the future discovery of environmental
conditions may require additional expenditures by the Company, some of which may
be material. See "Business -- Governmental Regulations and Environmental
Matters."
Concentration of Voting Power and Anti-takeover Provisions
     The Common Stock is divided into two classes with different voting rights,
which allows for the maintenance of control of the Company by the holders of the
Class B Common Stock. Holders of Class A Common Stock are entitled to one vote
per share on all matters submitted to a vote of the stockholders of the Company.
Holders of Class B Common Stock are entitled to ten votes per share on all
matters, except that the Class B Common Stock is entitled to only one vote per
share with respect to any transaction proposed or approved by the Company's
Board of Directors, proposed by or on behalf of the holders of the Class B
Common Stock or their affiliates or as to which any members of the Smith Group
or any affiliate thereof has a material financial interest (other than as a then
existing stockholder of the Company) constituting a (a) "going private"
transaction (as defined herein), (b) disposition of substantially all of the
Company's assets, (c) transfer resulting in a change in the nature of the
Company's business, or (d) merger or consolidation in which current holders of
Common Stock would own less than 50% of the Common Stock following such
transaction. The two classes vote together as a single class on all matters,
except where class voting is required by Delaware Law, which exception would
apply, among other situations, to a vote on any proposal to modify the voting
rights of the Class A Common Stock. See "Description of Capital Stock." Upon
completion of this Offering (assuming the Underwriters' over-allotment option is
not exercised), the existing holders of Class B Common Stock will have
approximately 92.6% of the combined voting power of the Common Stock (in those
circumstances in which the Class B Common Stock has ten votes per share) and
55.6% of the outstanding Common Stock. Accordingly such holders of Class B
Common Stock will effectively have the ability to elect all of the directors of
the Company and to control all other matters requiring the approval of the
Company's stockholders. In addition, the Company may issue additional shares of
Class B Common Stock to members of the Smith Group in the future for fair market
value. See "Principal Stockholders."
     The disproportionate voting rights of the Class B Common Stock under the
above-mentioned circumstances could have a material adverse effect on the market
price of the Class A Common Stock. Such disproportionate voting rights may make
the Company a less attractive target for a takeover than it otherwise might be,
or render more difficult or discourage a merger proposal, a tender offer or a
proxy contest, even if such actions were favored by a majority of the holders of
the Class A Common Stock.
                                       16
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
     Certain provisions of the Certificate and the Company's Bylaws make it more
difficult for stockholders of the Company to effect certain corporate actions.
See "Description of Capital Stock -- Delaware Law, Certain Charter and Bylaw
Provisions and Certain Franchise Agreement Provisions." Under the Company's
Stock Option Plan, options outstanding thereunder become immediately exercisable
upon a change in control of the Company. See "Management -- Employment
Agreements" and " -- Stock Option Plan." The agreements, corporate documents and
laws described above, as well as provisions of the Company's franchise
agreements described in " -- Dependence on Automobile Manufacturers" and
" -- Stock Ownership/Issuance Limits; Limitation on Ability to Issue Additional
Equity" above (permitting Manufacturers to terminate such agreements upon a
change of control) and provisions of the Company's lending arrangements
described in " -- Stock Ownership/Issuance Limits; Limitation on Ability to
Issue Additional Equity" above (creating an event of default thereunder upon a
change in control), may have the effect of delaying or preventing a change in
control of the Company or preventing stockholders from realizing a premium on
the sale of their shares of Class A Common Stock upon an acquisition of the
Company.
     The Certificate authorizes the Board of Directors of the Company to issue
three million shares of "blank check" preferred stock with such designations,
rights and preferences as may be determined from time to time by the Board of
Directors. Accordingly, the Board of Directors is empowered, without stockholder
approval, to issue preferred stock with dividend, liquidation, conversion,
voting or other rights or preferences that could adversely affect the voting
power or other rights of the holders of the Class A Common Stock. In the event
of issuance, the preferred stock could be utilized, under certain circumstances,
as a method of discouraging, delaying, or preventing a change in control of the
Company. The issuance of preferred stock could also prevent stockholders from
realizing a premium upon the sale of their shares of Class A Common Stock upon
an acquisition of the Company. Although the Company has no present intention to
issue any shares of its preferred stock, there can be no assurance that the
Company will not do so in the future. See "Description of Capital Stock."
     Additionally, the Company's Bylaws provide: (i) for a Board of Directors
divided into three classes serving staggered terms; (ii) that special meetings
of stockholders may be called only by the Chairman or by the Company's Secretary
or Assistant Secretary at the request in writing of a majority of the Board of
Directors; (iii) that no stockholder action may be taken by written consent; and
(iv) that stockholders seeking to bring business before an annual meeting of
stockholders, or to nominate candidates for election as directors at an annual
or a special meeting of stockholders, must provide timely notice thereof in
writing. These provisions will impair the stockholders' ability to influence or
control the Company or to effect a change in control of the Company, and may
prevent stockholders from realizing a premium on the sale of their shares of
Class A Common Stock upon an acquisition of the Company. See "Description of
Capital Stock."
No Prior Public Market for Class A Common Stock and Possible Volatility of Stock
Price
     Prior to the Offering, there has been no public market for the Class A
Common Stock. The Class A Common Stock has been approved for listing on the
NYSE, subject to official notice of issuance. The initial public offering price
of the Class A Common Stock will be determined by negotiations among the Company
and representatives of the Underwriters. See "Underwriting." There can be no
assurance that the market price of the Class A Common Stock prevailing at any
time after this Offering will equal or exceed the initial public offering price
or that an active trading market will be developed after the Offering or, if
developed, that it will be sustained. Quarterly and annual operating results of
the Company, variations between such results and the results expected by
investors and analysts, changes in local or general economic conditions or
developments affecting the automobile industry, the Company or its competitors
could cause the market price of the Class A Common Stock to fluctuate
substantially. As a result of these factors, as well as other factors common to
initial public offerings, the market price could fluctuate substantially from
the initial offering price. In addition, the stock market has, from time to
time, experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations, which could adversely
effect the market price for the Class A Common Stock without regard to the
financial performance of the Company.
Dilution
     Purchasers of Class A Common Stock in the Offering will experience
immediate and substantial dilution in the amount of $11.59 per share in net
tangible book value per share from the initial offering price. See "Dilution."
Potential Adverse Market Price Effect of Additional Shares Eligible for Future
Sale
     The 6,250,000 shares of Class B Common Stock owned beneficially by existing
stockholders of the Company, the 587,509 shares of Class A Common Stock
underlying options to be granted by the Company under the Stock Option Plan on
or before the consummation of the Offering and the 42,187 shares of Class A
Common Stock (45,000 shares if the Underwriter's over-allotment option is
exercised in full) underlying the Dyer Warrant (as defined herein), are
"restricted securities" as defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act, and may
in the future be resold in compliance with Rule 144. See "Management -- Stock
Option Plan" and "The Acquisitions -- The Dyer Acquisition." In addition,
6,250,000 shares of Common Stock constituting restricted securities are subject
to certain piggyback registration rights. See "Certain Transactions --
Registration Rights Agreements." No prediction can be made as to the effect that
resale of shares of Common Stock, or the
                                       17
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
availability of shares of Common Stock for resale, will have on the market price
of the Class A Common Stock prevailing from time to time. The resale of
substantial amounts of Common Stock, or the perception that such resales may
occur, could materially and adversely affect prevailing market prices for the
Common Stock and the ability of the Company to raise equity capital in the
future. The Company has agreed, subject to certain exceptions, not to issue, and
all executive officers of the Company and all owners of the Class B Common Stock
have agreed not to resell, any shares of Common Stock or other equity securities
of the Company for 180 days after the date of this Prospectus without the prior
written consent of the representatives of the Underwriters. See
"Management -- Stock Option Plan," "Shares Eligible for Future Sale" and
"Underwriting."
                                       18
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
                               THE REORGANIZATION
     The Company was incorporated in 1997 and capitalized with the stock of the
Sonic Dealerships, which have been under the control of Bruton Smith and which
are comprised of Town & Country Ford, Town & Country Toyota, Lone Star Ford,
Fort Mill Ford and Frontier Oldsmobile-Cadillac. As of June 30, 1997, the
Company effected the Reorganization pursuant to which: (i) the Company acquired
all of the Dealership Securities; and (ii) the Company issued Class B Common
Stock in exchange for the Dealership Securities. See "Certain
Transactions -- Other Transactions." Subsequent to the Reorganization, the
Company will convert from the LIFO Method of inventory accounting to the
industry standard FIFO Method of inventory accounting, conditioned upon the
closing of the Offering. In connection with the FIFO Conversion, and in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, the accompanying
financial information of the Company has been retroactively restated to reflect
the FIFO Conversion. As a result of the Reorganization, the historical combined
financial information included in this Prospectus is not necessarily indicative
of the results of operations, financial position and cash flows of the Company
in the future or of those which would have resulted had the Reorganization been
in effect during the periods presented in the Company's Combined and
Consolidated Financial Statements included elsewhere in this Prospectus. See
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations -- Overview."
                                THE ACQUISITIONS
     In the last four months, the Company has consummated or signed definitive
agreements to purchase six additional dealerships or dealership groups for an
aggregate purchase price of approximately $94.8 million. These acquisitions
consist of the Ken Marks Acquisition (consummated on October 15, 1997), the
Bowers Acquisition, the Lake Norman Acquisition (consummated on September 29,
1997), the Dyer Acquisition, the Fort Mill Acquisition (consummated on June 3,
1997) and the Williams Acquisition (consummated on October 10, 1997).
     The closing of the Offering is contingent upon the Company consummating the
remaining Acquisitions. The Company intends to use the proceeds from the
Offering to pay the purchase prices of the remaining Acquisitions and to repay
certain of the indebtedness incurred in connection with the consummated
Acquisitions. See "Use of Proceeds." In addition, the Company intends to
refinance all of the floor plan indebtedness of the dealerships being acquired
in the Acquisitions.
     The following table sets forth the sources and uses of funds for financing
of the Acquisitions after giving effect to the Offering:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                (in millions)
<S>                                                                             <C>
Sources of funds:
  The Six-Month Facility(a)..................................................      $   3.3
  The Revolving Facility.....................................................         26.0
  The Bowers Note (as defined below).........................................          4.0
  Class A Common Stock offered hereby(b).....................................         58.5
  Existing escrows(c)........................................................          3.0
                                                                                -------------
     Total...................................................................      $  94.8
                                                                                -------------
                                                                                -------------
Uses of funds:
  The Ken Marks Acquisition(d)...............................................      $  25.5
  The Bowers Acquisition.....................................................         27.6
  The Lake Norman Acquisition(e).............................................         18.2
  The Dyer Acquisition(f)....................................................         18.0
  The Fort Mill Acquisition(g)...............................................          3.7
  The Williams Acquisition...................................................          1.8
                                                                                -------------
     Total...................................................................      $  94.8
                                                                                -------------
                                                                                -------------
</TABLE>
 
                                                   (footnotes on following page)
                                       19
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
- ---------------
 (a) The Company initially borrowed $20 million under this facility to fund the
     Lake Norman Acquisition and the Williams Acquisition, approximately $16.7
     million of which is anticipated to be repaid with the proceeds of the
     Offering assuming the shares are sold at the mid-point of the range set
     forth on the front cover of this Prospectus.
(b) Represents net proceeds assuming Class A Common Stock is sold at the
    mid-point of the range set forth on the front cover of this Prospectus. To
    the extent the Class A Common Stock is sold below such mid-point, borrowings
    under the Revolving Facility or the Six-Month Facility will be adjusted.
 (c) Pursuant to the Ken Marks Acquisition, the Lake Norman Acquisition, the
     Bowers Acquisition, and the Dyer Acquisition, $0.5 million, $0.5 million,
     $1.0 million and $1.0 million, respectively, has been deposited by Sonic
     into escrow accounts.
(d) The Ken Marks Acquisition was financed with the proceeds of the Company's
    initial borrowing under the Revolving Facility.
 (e) The Lake Norman Acquisition was financed with the proceeds of the Six-Month
     Facility.
 (f) Does not include the Dyer Warrant. See footnote 2 to the Pro Forma Combined
     and Consolidated Balance Sheet as of June 30, 1997.
(g) $3.5 million of the purchase price for the Fort Mill Acquisition was
    initially funded from the proceeds of a loan from Bruton Smith. This loan
    will be repaid from the proceeds of the Offering.
     The Ken Marks Acquisition. Ken Marks Ford is located in Clearwater,
Florida. Ken Marks, Jr., together with the other stockholders of Ken Marks Ford,
and the Company entered into a definitive stock purchase agreement in July 1997,
providing for the acquisition by the Company of all of the outstanding stock of
Ken Marks Ford. Ken Marks Ford had retail sales of approximately 4,369 new and
1,764 used vehicles, had aggregate revenues of approximately $148.4 million in
1996, and, based on revenues, is one of the 20 largest Ford dealerships in the
United States. This acquisition further implements the Company's growth strategy
by adding a well-managed dealership with significant presence in a new market.
Ken Marks, Jr., with over 13 years of automotive retailing experience in central
Florida, will continue to serve as the Executive Manager of Ken Marks Ford and
will join the senior management team of the Company as the Regional Vice
President for Florida.
     In the Ken Marks Acquisition, consummated on October 15, 1997, the Company
purchased all of the outstanding capital stock of Ken Marks Ford for a total of
approximately $25.5 million. At closing, the Company paid the stockholders of
Ken Marks Ford the sum of approximately $25.5 million (of which $0.5 million
will be paid to certain employees of Ken Marks Ford in the form of stay
bonuses), less $0.5 million which was deposited into escrow for certain
contingencies. The $25.5 million sum will be adjusted downward to the extent
that the net book value of Ken Marks Ford as of the closing is ultimately
determined to be less than approximately $5.1 million. Ken Marks Ford will
continue to lease its facilities from an affiliate of the original stockholders
of Ken Marks Ford. See "Business -- Facilities" and "Certain
Transactions -- Certain Dealership Leases."
     The Bowers Acquisition. European Motors of Nashville (a BMW and Volkswagen
dealership), European Motors (a BMW and Volvo dealership), Jaguar of Chattanooga
(a Jaguar and Infiniti dealership), Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle,
Nelson Bowers Dodge, Cleveland Village Imports (a Honda dealership), Nelson
Bowers Ford, L.P. and KIA of Chattanooga (a KIA and Volkswagen dealership)
(collectively, the "Bowers Dealerships") and the Company, as well as the persons
and entities controlling the Bowers Dealerships, have entered into a definitive
asset purchase agreement dated as of June 24, 1997. The Bowers Dealerships are
located in the Chattanooga, Tennessee metropolitan area, with the exception of
European Motors of Nashville, which is located in Nashville, Tennessee. The
Bowers Dealerships had retail sales of approximately 2,331 new and 1,777 used
vehicles, and had aggregate revenues of approximately $101.5 million in 1996.
The Bowers Dealerships estimate that their combined market share of total new
vehicle unit sales in the Chattanooga metropolitan market was approximately 9.1%
for 1996. This acquisition serves the Company's growth strategy by adding a
group of well-managed dealerships with a substantial portion of its sales in
luxury vehicles. Nelson Bowers, the Bowers Dealerships' chief executive, and
Jeffrey Rachor, their chief operating officer, have over 20 and 10 years of
experience in the automotive industry, respectively. Mr. Bowers will join the
Company's senior management team as Executive Vice President. Mr. Rachor will be
the Company's Regional Vice President for the Mid-South region, which includes
Tennessee, Georgia, Kentucky and Alabama.
     The Company will acquire substantially all the Bowers Dealerships' assets,
excluding real property, and assume substantially all the liabilities associated
with the purchased assets. For the Bowers Acquisition, the Company agreed to pay
up to $27.6 million. At closing, the Company will pay $22.6 million in cash to
the sellers and will deposit $1.0 million into an escrow account, all subject to
certain potential downward adjustments based on the net book value of the
purchased assets and assumed liabilities as of the closing. The balance (up to
$4.0 million) of the purchase price will be evidenced by the
                                       20
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
Company's promissory notes that will be payable in 28 equal quarterly
installments and will bear interest at NationsBank's prime rate less 0.5% (the
"Bowers Note"). The sellers or their affiliates will retain ownership of certain
real property underlying some of the dealerships and will lease such property to
the Company. See "Business -- Facilities" and "Certain Transactions -- Certain
Dealership Leases." In the event the Company fails to close the Bowers
Acquisition by November 21, 1997, it has agreed to pay a termination fee.
     Volvo's consent to the Company's acquisition of the European Motors' Volvo
franchise assets requires that Mr. Bowers maintain a 20% interest in, and serve
as the manager of, the Company's Volvo franchisee subsidiary operating the
European Motors' Volvo assets. See "Certain Transactions -- The Bowers Note."
     The Lake Norman Acquisition. Lake Norman Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle and
Lake Norman Dodge (collectively, the "Lake Norman Dealerships") are both located
in Cornelius, North Carolina approximately 20 miles north of Charlotte. The Lake
Norman Dealerships had retail sales of approximately 3,572 new and 2,320 used
vehicles, and had aggregate revenues of approximately $137.7 million in 1996.
The existing management of the Lake Norman Dealerships will continue with the
Company.
     On September 29, 1997, the Company acquired substantially all the Lake
Norman Dealerships' assets, excluding real property, and assume substantially
all of the sellers' liabilities. For the Lake Norman Acquisition, the Company
agreed to pay up to $18.2 million. At closing, the Company paid $17.7 million in
cash to the sellers and deposited $0.5 million into an escrow account. The
purchase price will be adjusted downward based on the net book value of the
purchased assets and assumed liabilities as of the closing date, to be
determined after the closing. The sellers of the assets retained ownership of
the three tracts of real property underlying the dealerships and lease such
property to the Company. See "Business -- Facilities."
     The Dyer Acquisition. Dyer & Dyer, Inc. ("Dyer Volvo"), which is located in
Atlanta, Georgia, is the largest Volvo dealership in the United States in terms
of retail unit sales. For 1996, Dyer Volvo had retail sales of approximately
1,284 new and 1,493 used vehicles, and had aggregate revenues of approximately
$72.6 million. This acquisition is a significant step in the Company's growth
strategy in that it adds a large, well-managed dealership in a new geographic
market and increases the Company's presence in the luxury car market. Richard
Dyer, who has over 25 years in the automotive retailing industry, will continue
as the Company's Executive Manager of Dyer Volvo.
     The Company will acquire all of the operating assets of Dyer Volvo for
$18.0 million plus assumption of substantially all of Dyer Volvo's existing
recorded liabilities and obligations. The $18.0 million purchase price is
subject to adjustment in the event that net book value of the purchased assets,
less assumed liabilities, is more or less than $10.5 million as of the date of
the closing. At the closing, the Company will pay $17.0 million in cash to the
seller and deposit $1.0 million into an escrow account. In addition, the Company
will issue a warrant to Richard Dyer to purchase 0.375% of the Company's
outstanding shares of Common Stock (in the form of Class A Common Stock) after
consummation of the Offering (45,000 shares if the Underwriters' over-allotment
option is exercised in full) pursuant to his employment agreement with the
Company at a per share exercise price equal to the initial public offering per
share price (the "Dyer Warrant"). The Dyer Warrant is exercisable immediately
and will expire five years after the consummation of the Dyer Acquisition. The
Dyer Warrant is in addition to stock options that are to be granted to Richard
Dyer under the Company's Stock Option Plan. Dyer Volvo leases its dealership
premises and the Company will assume Dyer Volvo's obligations under the leases
at the closing. See "Business -- Facilities." The closing of the Dyer
acquisition will occur no later than November 21, 1997. If the Company fails to
perform its obligation to close by that date, it has agreed to pay a termination
fee.
     Volvo's consent to the Dyer Acquisition requires that Richard Dyer maintain
a 20% interest in, and serve as the manager of, the Company's Volvo franchisee
subsidiary operating the Dyer Volvo dealership.
     The Fort Mill Acquisition. Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge is located in
Fort Mill, South Carolina, which is a part of the Charlotte market. In 1996,
Jeff Boyd Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge (the predecessor to Fort Mill
Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge) had retail sales of approximately 632 new and 842 used
vehicles, and had total revenues of $20.3 million.
     As of June 3, 1997, the Company consummated the acquisition of certain
dealership assets, excluding real property, of Jeff Boyd Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge
for a total purchase price of approximately $3.7 million in cash and assumed the
floor plan liabilities of the sellers. Of the $3.7 million purchase price paid,
$3.5 million was advanced to the Company by Bruton Smith and is to be repaid
with proceeds from the Offering. See "Certain Transactions -- The Smith
Advance." An affiliate of Jeff Boyd Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge retained ownership
of the real property underlying the dealership and leased the property to the
Company. See "Business -- Facilities."
     The Williams Acquisition. Town and Country Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep of Rock
Hill is located in Rock Hill, South Carolina, approximately 35 miles south of
Charlotte. In 1996, Williams Motors, Inc. (the predecessor to Town and Country
                                       21
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep of Rock Hill) had retail sales of approximately 248 new
and 280 used vehicles, and had total revenues of $9.6 million.
     As of October 10, 1997, the Company acquired substantially all of the
operating assets of Williams Motors (excluding primarily used car inventory and
real estate) for $1.8 million plus assumption of floor plan indebtedness to
Chrysler Credit Corporation. The Company leases the dealership premises from the
sellers for one to five years, at the Company's option. See
"Business -- Facilities."
     Future Acquisitions. The Company intends to pursue acquisitions in the
future that will be financed with cash or debt or equity financing or a
combination thereof. Any acquisitions using equity financing would require the
consent of Chrysler and Honda under the dealership agreements with such
Manufacturers. Although the Company has identified and has held preliminary
discussions with several potential acquisition candidates, at this time the
Company has no agreements to effect any such acquisitions other than the
Acquisitions. There is no assurance that the Company will consummate any future
acquisition, that they will be on favorable terms to the Company or that
financing for such acquisitions will be available. All future acquisitions by
the Company will be contingent upon the consent of the applicable manufacturer.
No assurance can be given that any such consents will be obtained. The Company
is currently negotiating with Ford Motor Credit Company ("Ford Motor Credit") to
increase the Revolving Facility (as defined herein) from $26.0 million to $75.0
million in order to finance future acquisitions and for general corporate
purposes, although there can be no assurance that the Company will obtain any
such financing. After giving pro forma effect to the Acquisitions and the
financing thereof, the Company will have approximately $45.7 million available
under the Revolving Facility (assuming (i) the Revolving Facility is increased
from $26.0 million to $75.0 million, (ii) no exercise of the Underwriters'
over-allotment option, (iii) that the shares of Class A Common Stock offered
hereby are sold at the mid-point of the range of the initial public offering
price set forth on the front cover of this Prospectus and (iv) that at the time
the Revolving Facility is increased it is used to refinance the remaining
balance under the Six-Month Facility). See "Risk Factors -- Risks Associated
with Acquisitions" and " -- Limitations on Financial Resources Available for
Acquisitions; Possible Inability to Refinance Existing Debt" and "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources."
                                       22
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
                                USE OF PROCEEDS
     The net proceeds to the Company from the sale of 5,000,000 shares of Class
A Common Stock offered hereby are estimated to be approximately $58.5 million
($67.5 million if the Underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised in full),
assuming an initial public offering price of $13.00 per share (the midpoint of
the range of the initial public offering price set forth on the cover page of
this Prospectus) and after deducting the underwriting discount and estimated
expenses of the Offering. The net proceeds will be used to pay a portion of the
purchase price for the Acquisitions in the aggregate amount of approximately
$38.3 million, to repay a loan of approximately $3.5 million advanced by Bruton
Smith in connection with the Acquisitions, which bears interest at 3.83% per
annum and to repay approximately $16.7 million of the Six-Month Facility, which
was used to finance the Lake Norman Acquisition and bears interest at 7.75% per
annum. See "The Acquisitions" and "Certain Transactions -- The Smith Advance."
                                DIVIDEND POLICY
     The Company intends to retain all of its earnings to finance the growth and
development of its business, including future acquisitions, and does not
anticipate paying any cash dividends on its Common Stock for the foreseeable
future. Any future change in the Company's dividend policy will be made at the
discretion of the Board of Directors of the Company and will depend upon the
Company's operating results, financial condition, capital requirements, general
business conditions and such other factors as the Board of Directors deems
relevant. Furthermore, the Company's existing credit arrangements include
covenants which preclude the payment of dividends. See "Management's Discussion
and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations -- Liquidity and
Capital Resources" and "Description of Capital Stock."
                                       23
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
                                 CAPITALIZATION
     The following table sets forth, as of June 30, 1997, the capitalization of
the Company (a) on an actual basis, including the Reorganization which is
effective as of June 30, 1997, and (b) on a pro forma basis, as adjusted to
reflect the Acquisitions, the financing thereof, the Offering and the
application of the estimated net proceeds thereof to be received by the Company.
See "The Acquisitions" and "Use of Proceeds." This table should be read in
conjunction with "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
and Results of Operations" and the unaudited Pro Forma Combined and Consolidated
Financial Statements of the Company and the related notes thereto included
elsewhere in this Prospectus.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                              June 30, 1997
                                                                                                         -----------------------
                                                                                                                     Pro Forma
                                                                                                                      for the
                                                                                                                    Acquisitions
                                                                                                                      and the
                                                                                                         Actual     Offering(1)
                                                                                                         -------    ------------
<S>                                                                                                      <C>        <C>
                                                                                                         (dollars in thousands)
Short-term debt:
  Notes payable -- floor plan.........................................................................   $67,856      $142,191
  Notes payable -- other..............................................................................        --         3,713
  Current maturities of long-term debt................................................................       487         1,343
                                                                                                         -------    ------------
     Total short-term debt............................................................................   $68,343      $147,247
                                                                                                         -------    ------------
                                                                                                         -------    ------------
Long-term debt........................................................................................   $ 5,137      $ 36,980
                                                                                                         -------    ------------
Stockholders' equity:
  Preferred Stock, $.10 par value, 3,000,000 shares authorized; no shares issued and outstanding......        --            --
  Class A Common Stock, $.01 par value, 50,000,000 shares authorized; no shares issued and
     outstanding, actual; 5,000,000 shares issued and outstanding, as adjusted (2)....................        --            50
  Class B Common Stock, $.01 par value, 15,000,000 shares authorized; 10,000 shares issued and
     outstanding, actual; 6,250,000 shares issued and outstanding, as adjusted (3)....................        62            62
  Additional paid-in capital..........................................................................    14,418        72,818
  Retained earnings and members' and partners' equity.................................................    14,023        14,064
  Unrealized loss on marketable equity securities.....................................................       (97)          (97)
                                                                                                         -------    ------------
     Total stockholders' equity.......................................................................    28,406        86,897
                                                                                                         -------    ------------
       Total capitalization...........................................................................   $33,543      $123,877
                                                                                                         -------    ------------
                                                                                                         -------    ------------
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Adjusted to give pro forma effect to the Acquisitions (including the
    financing thereof) and the Offering (and the application of the net proceeds
    thereof). See "Pro Forma Combined and Consolidated Financial Data."
(2) 5,750,000 shares if the Underwriters' overallotment option is exercised in
    full. Excludes 1,125,000 shares of Class A Common Stock reserved for future
    issuance under the Company's Stock Option Plan (including up to 587,509
    shares of Class A Common Stock reserved for issuance upon exercise of
    options to be granted on or before the consummation of the Offering pursuant
    to the Stock Option Plan) and 150,000 shares of Class A Common Stock
    reserved for future issuance under the Company's ESPP, and excludes 42,187
    shares of Class A Common Stock (45,000 shares if the Underwriters'
    over-allotment option is exercised in full) reserved for issuance under the
    Dyer Warrant. See "The Acquisitions -- The Dyer Acquisition" and
    "Management -- Stock Option Plan."
(3) Actual shares of Class B Common Stock include the effect of the Stock Split
    (which will be effected in the form of a stock dividend).
                                       24
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
                                    DILUTION
     The pro forma net tangible book value (deficit) of the Company (after
giving effect to the Acquisitions) as of June 30, 1997 was $(6.81) per share of
Common Stock. Pro forma net tangible book value (deficit) per share is
determined by dividing the pro forma tangible net worth of the Company (pro
forma total assets less goodwill less pro forma total liabilities) by the total
number of outstanding shares of Common Stock. After giving effect to the sale of
the 5,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock offered hereby and the receipt of
an assumed $58.5 million of net proceeds from the Offering (based on an assumed
initial public offering price of $13.00 per share and net of the underwriting
discounts and estimated offering expenses), pro forma net tangible book value of
the Company at June 30, 1997 would have been $1.41 per share. This represents an
immediate increase in pro forma net tangible book value of $8.22 per share to
existing stockholders and an immediate dilution of $11.59 per share to the new
investors purchasing Class A Common Stock in the Offering. The following table
illustrates the per share dilution:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                      <C>         <C>
Assumed initial public offering price per share.......................................               $13.00
  Pro forma net tangible book value (deficit) per share before giving effect to the
     Offering.........................................................................      (6.81)
  Increase in pro forma net tangible book value per share attributable to the
     Offering.........................................................................       8.22
                                                                                         --------
Pro forma net tangible book value per share after giving effect to the Offering.......                 1.41
                                                                                                     ------
Dilution per share to new investors...................................................               $11.59
                                                                                                     ------
                                                                                                     ------
</TABLE>
 
     The following table sets forth, on a pro forma basis as of June 30, 1997,
the number of shares of Common Stock purchased from the Company, the total
consideration paid to the Company and the average price per share paid to the
Company by existing stockholders and new investors purchasing shares from the
Company in the Offering (before deducting underwriting discounts and commissions
and estimated offering expenses):
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        Shares Purchased        Total Consideration       Average
                                                                      ---------------------    ----------------------    Price Per
                                                                        Number      Percent      Amount       Percent      Share
                                                                      ----------    -------    -----------    -------    ---------
<S>                                                                   <C>           <C>        <C>            <C>        <C>
Existing stockholders (1)..........................................    6,250,000      55.6%    $16,604,170      20.3%     $  2.66
New investors (2)..................................................    5,000,000      44.4      65,000,000      79.7        13.00
                                                                      ----------    -------    -----------    -------
     Total.........................................................   11,250,000     100.0%    $81,604,170     100.0%     $  7.25
                                                                      ----------    -------    -----------    -------
                                                                      ----------    -------    -----------    -------
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Does not reflect the possible exercise of options to purchase 1,125,000
    shares of Class A Common Stock reserved for issuance under the Company's
    Stock Option Plan, including options to purchase 587,509 shares of Class A
    Common Stock that will be granted immediately before the completion of the
    Offering with an exercise price equal to the initial public offering price,
    the possible issuance of 150,000 shares of Class A Common Stock reserved for
    issuance under the Company's ESPP, and the possible exercise of the Dyer
    Warrant to purchase 42,187 shares of Class A Common Stock (45,000 shares if
    the Underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised in full) at an exercise
    price equal to the initial public offering price pursuant to the Offering.
    See "Management -- Stock Option Plan" and "Certain Transactions."
(2) Assumes that the Underwriters' over-allotment option is not exercised. Sales
    pursuant to the full exercise by the Underwriters of the over-allotment
    option will cause the total number of shares purchased by new investors,
    total consideration paid by new investors, percent of total consideration
    paid by new investors and average price per share for all investors to
    increase to 5,750,000, $74.8 million, 81.8% and $7.25, respectively.
                                       25
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
               SELECTED COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA
     The selected combined and consolidated statement of operations data for the
years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996 and the selected combined balance
sheet data as of December 31, 1995 and 1996 are derived from the Company's
audited financial statements, which are included elsewhere in this Prospectus.
The selected combined and consolidated statement of operations data for the
years ended December 31, 1992 and 1993 and the selected combined and
consolidated balance sheet data as of December 31, 1992, 1993 and 1994 are
derived from the Company's unaudited financial statements, which are not
included in this Prospectus. The selected combined and consolidated results of
operations data for the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997, and the
selected combined and consolidated balance sheet data at June 30, 1997, are
derived from the unaudited financial statements of the Company, which are
included elsewhere in this Prospectus. In the opinion of management, these
unaudited financial statements reflect all adjustments necessary for a fair
presentation of its results of operations and financial condition. All such
adjustments are of a normal recurring nature. The results of operations for an
interim period are not necessarily indicative of results that may be expected
for a full year or any other interim period. In connection with the FIFO
Conversion, and in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, the
selected combined and consolidated financial data has been retroactively
restated to reflect the FIFO Conversion. This selected combined and consolidated
financial data should be read in conjunction with "Management's Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and the Combined and
Consolidated Financial Statements and related notes included elsewhere in this
Prospectus.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                         Six Months Ended
                                                           Year Ended December 31,                           June 30,
                                           --------------------------------------------------------    --------------------
                                             1992        1993        1994        1995      1996(1)(2)  1996(1)(2)  1997(3)(2)
                                           --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
<S>                                        <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>
                                                                            (in thousands)
Combined and Consolidated Statement of
  Operations Data:
Revenues:
  Vehicle sales.........................   $171,065    $203,630    $227,960    $267,308    $326,842    $164,333    $185,077
  Parts, service and collision
     repair.............................     24,543      30,337      33,984      35,860      42,644      21,005      22,907
  Finance and insurance.................      3,743       3,711       5,181       7,813       7,118       4,277       4,763
                                           --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
     Total revenues.....................    199,351     237,678     267,125     310,981     376,604     189,615     212,747
Cost of sales...........................    174,713     208,445     233,011     270,878     331,047     167,191     188,422
                                           --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
Gross profit............................     24,638      29,233      34,114      40,103      45,557      22,424      24,325
Selling, general and administrative
  expenses..............................     20,251      22,738      24,632      29,343      33,677      16,590      18,413
Depreciation and amortization...........        682         788         838         832       1,076         360         396
                                           --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
Operating income........................      3,705       5,707       8,644       9,928      10,804       5,474       5,516
Interest expense, floor plan............      2,215       2,743       3,001       4,505       5,968       2,801       3,018
Interest expense, other.................        290         263         443         436         433         184         269
Other income............................      1,360         613         609         449         618         369         274
                                           --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
Income before income taxes and minority
  interest..............................      2,560       3,314       5,809       5,436       5,021       2,858       2,503
Provision for income taxes..............         27         723       2,118       2,176       1,924       1,093         916
                                           --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
Income before minority interest.........      2,533       2,591       3,691       3,260       3,097       1,765       1,587
Minority interest in earnings (loss) of
  subsidiary............................        (31)        (22)         15          22         114          41          47
                                           --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
Net income(4)...........................   $  2,564    $  2,613    $  3,676    $  3,238    $  2,983    $  1,724    $  1,540
                                           --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
                                           --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
Combined and Consolidated Balance Sheet
  Data:
Working capital.........................   $  5,883    $  9,629    $ 13,246    $ 18,140    $ 19,780    $ 20,625    $ 16,899
Total assets............................     48,524      54,917      69,061      79,462     110,976      99,456     120,384
Long-term debt..........................      3,904       4,142       3,773       3,561       5,286       4,825       5,137
Total liabilities.......................     43,336      46,822      57,274      62,956      84,367      73,695      91,978
Minority interest.......................        139         161         177         200         314         240          --
Stockholders' equity....................      5,049       7,934      11,610      16,306      26,295      25,521      28,406
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) The statement of operations data includes the results of Fort Mill Ford,
    Inc. from the date of acquisition, February 1, 1996.
                                         (footnotes continued on following page)
                                       26
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
     (2) The Company acquired Fort Mill Ford, Inc. and Fort Mill
         Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge in February 1996 and in June 1997,
         respectively. Both of these acquisitions were accounted for using the
         purchase method of accounting. As a result, the Selected Combined and
         Consolidated Financial Data below does not include the results of
         operations of these dealerships prior to the date they were acquired by
         the Company. Accordingly, the actual historical data for periods after
         the acquisition may not be comparable to data presented for periods
         prior to the acquisition of Fort Mill Ford and Fort Mill
         Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge.
     (3) The statement of operations data for the six months ended June 30, 1997
         includes the results of Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge, Inc. from
         the date of acquisition, June 3, 1997.
     (4) Historical net income per share is not presented, as the historical
         capital structure of the Company prior to the Offering is not
         comparable with the capital structure that will exist after the
         Offering.
                                       27
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
               PRO FORMA COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA
     The following unaudited pro forma combined and consolidated statements of
operations for the year ended December 31, 1996 and for the six months ended
June 30, 1997 reflect the historical accounts of the Company for those periods,
adjusted to give pro forma effect to the Reorganization, the Acquisitions and
the Offering, as if these events had occurred at January 1, 1996. The following
unaudited pro forma consolidated balance sheet as of June 30, 1997 reflects the
historical accounts of the Company as of that date adjusted to give pro forma
effect to the Acquisitions and the Offering as if these events had occurred on
June 30, 1997. The Acquisitions will be consummated on or before the closing of
the Offering and are conditions precedent to the closing of the Offering. The
Company will convert to the FIFO Method of inventory accounting conditioned and
effective upon the closing of the Offering. In connection with the FIFO
Conversion, and in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, the
accompanying financial information of the Company has been retroactively
restated to reflect the FIFO Conversion. See "Management's Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations -- Overview."
     The pro forma combined and consolidated financial data and accompanying
notes should be read in conjunction with the Combined and Consolidated Financial
Statements and related notes of the Company as well as the financial statements
and related notes of the Bowers Dealerships, the Lake Norman Dealerships, Ken
Marks Ford and Dyer Volvo, all of which are included elsewhere in this
Prospectus. Such pro forma data and accompanying notes do not give effect to the
Fort Mill Acquisition, the Williams Acquisition or the financing thereof because
management does not believe such acquisitions or financings are material. The
Company believes that the assumptions used in the following statements provide a
reasonable basis on which to present the pro forma financial data. The pro forma
combined financial data is provided for informational purposes only and should
not be construed to be indicative of the Company's financial condition or
results of operations had the transactions and events described above been
consummated on the dates assumed, and are not intended to project the Company's
financial condition on any future date or its results of operation for any
future period.
                                       28
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
                   Pro Forma Combined Statement of Operations
                          Year Ended December 31, 1996
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                       Company                                     The Acquisitions
                               ------------------------   -------------------------------------------------------------------
                                             Pro Forma                                                           Pro Forma
                                            Adjustments                                                       Adjustments for
                                              for the        Bowers                                                 the
                                             Reorgani-     Dealerships    Lake Norman   Ken Marks    Dyer      Acquisitions
                               Actual (1)     zation      Pro Forma (2)   Dealerships   Ford (3)     Volvo        (4)(5)
                               ----------   -----------   -------------   -----------   ---------   -------   ---------------
<S>                            <C>          <C>           <C>             <C>           <C>         <C>       <C>
                                                                         (in thousands, except per share data)
Revenues:
  Vehicle sales...............  $ 326,842     $             $ 144,177      $ 124,539    $ 131,826   $60,871       $
  Parts, service and collision
    repair....................     42,644                      17,338          9,543       14,224    11,163
  Finance and insurance.......      7,118                       2,877          3,617        2,317       542
                               ----------   -----------   -------------   -----------   ---------   -------   ---------------
    Total revenues............    376,604                     164,392        137,699      148,367    72,576
Cost of sales.................    331,047                     142,424        121,806      128,850    62,547          (545)(11)
                               ----------   -----------   -------------   -----------   ---------   -------   ---------------
Gross profit..................     45,557                      21,968         15,893       19,517    10,029           545
Selling, general and
  administrative expenses.....     33,677                      18,977         14,215       16,190     6,997        (1,299)(12)
                                                                                                                   (3,351)(13)
                                                                                                                      249(14)
Depreciation and
  amortization................      1,076       75(8)             733             89           94       126          (193)(15)
                                                                                                                    1,539(16)
                                                                                                                      (29)(14)
                               ----------   -----------   -------------   -----------   ---------   -------   ---------------
Operating income..............     10,804         (75)          2,258          1,589        3,233     2,906         3,629
Interest expense, floor
  plan........................      5,968                       1,522          1,552        2,054       373        (2,127)(10)
Interest expense, other(6)....        433                         199             50                                  315(17)
                                                                                                                     (108)(14)
                                                                                                                    2,282(6)
Other income..................        618                         797            258           97       452
                               ----------   -----------   -------------   -----------   ---------   -------   ---------------
Income before income taxes and
  minority interest...........      5,021         (75)          1,334            245        1,276     2,985         3,267
Provision for income taxes....      1,924         (30)(9)          61                         546       955         1,390(18)
                                                                                                                    1,627(19)
                                                                                                                       79(20)
                                                                                                                     (955)(21)
                               ----------   -----------   -------------   -----------   ---------   -------   ---------------
Income before minority
  interest....................      3,097         (45)          1,273            245          730     2,030         1,126
Minority interest in earnings
  of subsidiary...............        114        (114)(8)
                               ----------   -----------   -------------   -----------   ---------   -------   ---------------
Net income....................  $   2,983     $    69       $   1,273      $     245    $     730   $ 2,030       $ 1,126
                               ----------   -----------   -------------   -----------   ---------   -------   ---------------
                               ----------   -----------   -------------   -----------   ---------   -------   ---------------
Pro forma net income per
  share(7)....................
Weighted average shares
  outstanding (000's).........
<CAPTION>
                                                 Pro Forma
                                                  for the
                                                 Reorgani-
                                 Pro Forma      zation, the
                                Adjustments     Acquisitions
                                  for the         and the
                                 Offering         Offering
                                -----------     ------------
<S>                             <C>             <C>
 
Revenues:
  Vehicle sales...............    $               $788,255
  Parts, service and collision
    repair....................                      94,912
  Finance and insurance.......                      16,471
                                -----------     ------------
    Total revenues............                     899,638
Cost of sales.................                     786,129
                                -----------     ------------
Gross profit..................                     113,509
Selling, general and
  administrative expenses.....        201(22)       85,856
 
Depreciation and
  amortization................                       3,510
 
                                -----------     ------------
Operating income..............       (201)          24,143
Interest expense, floor
  plan........................                       9,342
Interest expense, other(6)....                       3,171
 
Other income..................                       2,222
                                -----------     ------------
Income before income taxes and
  minority interest...........       (201)          13,852
Provision for income taxes....        (80)(23)       5,517
 
                                -----------     ------------
Income before minority
  interest....................       (121)           8,335
Minority interest in earnings
  of subsidiary...............
                                -----------     ------------
Net income....................    $  (121)        $  8,335
                                -----------     ------------
                                -----------     ------------
Pro forma net income per
  share(7)....................                    $   0.74
                                                ------------
                                                ------------
Weighted average shares
  outstanding (000's).........                      11,250
                                                ------------
                                                ------------
</TABLE>
 
                                       29
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
                   Pro Forma Combined Statement of Operations
                         Six Months Ended June 30, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  The Acquisitions
                                        Company             -------------------------------------------------------------
                               --------------------------                                                      Pro Forma
                                             Pro Forma                                                        Adjustments
                                            Adjustments        Bowers                       Ken                 for the
                                              For the        Dealerships    Lake Norman    Marks      Dyer    Acquisitions
                               Actual(1)   Reorganization   Pro Forma (2)   Dealerships   Ford (3)   Volvo      (4)(5)
                               ---------   --------------   -------------   -----------   --------   ------   -----------
<S>                            <C>         <C>              <C>             <C>           <C>        <C>      <C>
                                                         (in thousands, except per share data)
Revenues:
  Vehicle sales..............  $ 185,077       $               $67,219        $69,798      $65,157   $31,373    $
  Parts, service and
    collision repair.........     22,907                         9,694          5,321        5,999    5,960
  Finance and insurance......      4,763                         1,539          1,950        1,029      129
                               ---------   --------------   -------------   -----------   --------   ------   -----------
    Total revenues...........    212,747                        78,452         77,069       72,185   37,462
Cost of sales................    188,422                        67,390         68,272       63,402   32,377        (371)(11)
                               ---------   --------------   -------------   -----------   --------   ------   -----------
Gross profit.................     24,325                        11,062          8,797        8,783    5,085         371
Selling, general and
  administrative expenses....     18,413                         8,744          6,937        7,547    3,498        (923)(12)
                                                                                                                 (1,004)(13)
                                                                                                                    191(14)
Depreciation and
  amortization...............        396           36(8)           338             47           47      151        (100)(15)
                                                                                                                    769(16)
                                                                                                                    (22)(14)
                               ---------   --------------   -------------   -----------   --------   ------   -----------
Operating income.............      5,516          (36)           1,980          1,813        1,189    1,436       1,460
Interest expense, floor
  plan.......................      3,018                           885          1,185          925      276      (1,048)(10)
Interest expense, other
  (6)........................        269                           118             68                             1,141(6)
                                                                                                                    158(17)
                                                                                                                    (80)(14)
Other income.................        274                           459            176           91      247
                               ---------   --------------   -------------   -----------   --------   ------   -----------
Income before income taxes
  and minority interest......      2,503          (36)           1,436            736          355    1,407       1,289
Provision for income taxes...        916          (15)(9)           31                         147                  436(18)
                                                                                                                  1,285(19)
                                                                                                                     83(20)
                               ---------   --------------   -------------   -----------   --------   ------   -----------
Income before minority
  interest...................      1,587          (21)           1,405            736          208    1,407        (515)
Minority interest in earnings
  of subsidiary..............         47          (47)(8)
                               ---------   --------------   -------------   -----------   --------   ------   -----------
Net income...................  $   1,540       $   26          $ 1,405        $   736      $   208   $1,407     $  (515)
                               ---------   --------------   -------------   -----------   --------   ------   -----------
                               ---------   --------------   -------------   -----------   --------   ------   -----------
Pro forma net income per
  share (7)..................
Weighted average shares
  outstanding (000's)........
<CAPTION>
 
                                Pro Forma    Pro Forma for the
                               Adjustments    Reorganization,
                                 for the     the Acquisitions
                                Offering     and the Offering
                               -----------   -----------------
<S>                            <C>           <C>
 
Revenues:
  Vehicle sales..............    $               $ 418,624
  Parts, service and
    collision repair.........                       49,881
  Finance and insurance......                        9,410
                               -----------   -----------------
    Total revenues...........                      477,915
Cost of sales................                      419,492
                               -----------   -----------------
Gross profit.................                       58,423
Selling, general and
  administrative expenses....                       43,574
                                     171(22)
 
Depreciation and
  amortization...............                        1,662
 
                               -----------   -----------------
Operating income.............       (171)           13,187
Interest expense, floor
  plan.......................                        5,241
Interest expense, other
  (6)........................                        1,674
 
Other income.................                        1,247
                               -----------   -----------------
Income before income taxes
  and minority interest......       (171)            7,519
Provision for income taxes...        (68) (23)         2,815
 
                               -----------   -----------------
Income before minority
  interest...................       (103)            4,704
Minority interest in earnings
  of subsidiary..............
                               -----------   -----------------
Net income...................    $  (103)        $   4,704
                               -----------   -----------------
                               -----------   -----------------
Pro forma net income per
  share (7)..................                    $    0.42
                                             -----------------
                                             -----------------
Weighted average shares
  outstanding (000's)........                       11,250
                                             -----------------
                                             -----------------
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
 (1) The actual combined statement of operations data for the Company includes
     the results of Fort Mill Ford from February 1, 1996, the effective date of
     its acquisition. Pro forma adjustments have not been presented to include
     the results of operations for Fort Mill Ford for the one month period ended
     February 1, 1996 because management believes such results are not material.
     The actual consolidated statement of operations data for the six months
     ended June 30, 1997 include the results of Fort Mill
     Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge from June 3, 1997, the date of its acquisition.
                                         (footnotes continued on following page)
                                       30
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
      (2) During 1996 and 1997, Nelson Bowers acquired three automobile
          dealerships whose operating results, from their respective dates of
          acquistion, are included in the historical combined and consolidated
          statement of operations in the table below. The following table
          adjusts the historical combined and consolidated statements of
          operations to include the acquirees as if the acquisitions had
          occurred on January 1, 1996.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           Year Ended December 31, 1996
                                               ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                   Bowers         European       European     Nelson                     Bowers
                                               Dealerships(a)    Motors of      Motors of     Bowers    Pro Forma     Dealerships
                                                (Historical)   Chattanooga(e)  Nashville(b)  Dodge(b)  Adjustments    (Pro Forma)
                                               --------------  --------------  ------------  --------  -----------   --------------
<S>                                            <C>             <C>             <C>           <C>       <C>           <C>
                                                                                  (in thousands)
Revenues:
  Vehicle sales...............................    $ 91,183         $6,940        $ 21,827    $24,227    $               $144,177
  Parts, service and collision repair.........       7,970          1,194           4,740      3,434                      17,338
  Finance and insurance.......................       2,337                            199        341                       2,877
                                               --------------  --------------  ------------  --------  -----------   --------------
    Total revenues............................     101,490          8,134          26,766     28,002                     164,392
Cost of sales.................................      87,757          7,130          23,054     24,483                     142,424
                                               --------------  --------------  ------------  --------  -----------   --------------
Gross profit..................................      13,733          1,004           3,712      3,519                      21,968
Selling, general and administrative
expenses......................................      11,807            926           3,401      2,843                      18,977
Depreciation and amortization.................         365             37              86        106          139(d)         733
                                               --------------  --------------  ------------  --------  -----------   --------------
Operating income..............................       1,561             41             225        570         (139)         2,258
Interest expense, floor plan..................       1,178             87             208         49                       1,522
Interest expense, other.......................         196                                         3                         199
Other income..................................         121             92             166        418                         797
                                               --------------  --------------  ------------  --------  -----------   --------------
Income before income taxes....................         308             46             183        936         (139)         1,334
Provision for income taxes....................          61                                                                    61
                                               --------------  --------------  ------------  --------  -----------   --------------
Net Income....................................    $    247         $   46        $    183    $   936    $    (139)      $  1,273
                                               --------------  --------------  ------------  --------  -----------   --------------
                                               --------------  --------------  ------------  --------  -----------   --------------
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      Six Months Ended June 30, 1997
                                                                           -----------------------------------------------------
                                                                               Bowers        Nelson                    Bowers
                                                                           Dealerships(a)    Bowers     Pro Forma    Dealerships
                                                                            (Historical)    Dodge(c)   Adjustments   (Pro Forma)
                                                                           --------------   --------   -----------   -----------
<S>                                                                        <C>              <C>        <C>           <C>
                                                                                              (in thousands)
Revenues:
  Vehicle sales..........................................................     $ 63,950      $ 3,269     $             $  67,219
  Parts, service and collision repair....................................        9,107          587                       9,694
  Finance and insurance..................................................        1,497           42                       1,539
                                                                           --------------   --------   -----------   -----------
    Total revenues.......................................................       74,554        3,898                      78,452
Cost of sales............................................................       63,945        3,445                      67,390
                                                                           --------------   --------   -----------   -----------
Gross profit.............................................................       10,609          453                      11,062
Selling, general and administrative expenses.............................        8,294          450                       8,744
Depreciation and amortization............................................          309           14            15(d)        338
                                                                           --------------   --------   -----------   -----------
Operating income (loss)..................................................        2,006          (11 )         (15)        1,980
Interest expense, floor plan.............................................          881            4                         885
Interest expense, other..................................................          118                                      118
Other income.............................................................          422           37                         459
                                                                           --------------   --------   -----------   -----------
Income before income taxes...............................................        1,429           22           (15)        1,436
Provision for income taxes...............................................           31                                       31
                                                                           --------------   --------   -----------   -----------
Net Income...............................................................     $  1,398      $    22     $     (15)    $   1,405
                                                                           --------------   --------   -----------   -----------
                                                                           --------------   --------   -----------   -----------
</TABLE>
 
           (a) The historical statement of operations data for the Bowers
               Dealerships includes the results of Nelson Bowers Dodge from
               March 1, 1997, the date of its acquisition by the owners of the
               Bowers Dealerships. Such statement also includes the results of
               European Motors of Nashville and European Motors of Chattanooga
               from October 1, 1996 and May 1, 1996, respectively, which were
               acquired by the owners of the Bowers Dealerships on those dates.
                                         (footnotes continued on following page)
                                       31
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
           (b) Reflects the results of operations of (i) Nelson Bowers Dodge for
               the year ended December 31, 1996; and (ii) European Motors of
               Nashville for the period from January 1, 1996 to October 1, 1996,
               the date of its acquisition by the owners of the Bowers
               Dealerships. Such data was obtained from monthly financial
               statements prepared by the dealership as required by the
               manufacturers.
           (c) Reflects the results of operations of Nelson Bowers Dodge for the
               period from January 1, 1997 to March 1, 1997, the date of its
               acquisition by the owners of the Bowers Dealerships. Such data
               was obtained from monthly financial statements prepared by the
               dealership as required by the manufacturers.
           (d) Reflects the amortization of goodwill resulting from the
               acquisition of Nelson Bowers Dodge, European Motors of Nashville
               and European Motors of Chattanooga over an assumed amortization
               period of 40 years for the period not included in the historical
               financial statements, assuming that such acquisitions were
               consummated on January 1, 1996.
           (e) Reflects the results of operations of European Motors of
               Chattanooga for the period from January 1, 1996 to April 30,
               1996, the date of its acquisition by the owners of the Bowers
               Dealerships. Such data was obtained from monthly financial
               statements prepared by the dealership as required by the
               Manufacturer.
      (3) Ken Marks Ford's fiscal year ends on April 30 of each year.
          Accordingly, the Statement of Operations data for Ken Marks Ford for
          the year ended December 31, 1996 was derived by adjusting the data for
          the year ended April 30, 1997 to include results from January 1, 1996
          through April 30, 1996, and exclude results from January 1, 1997
          through April 30, 1997. The Statement of Operations data for the six
          months ended June 30, 1997 was similarly derived by adjusting the
          historical financial statements for the year ended April 30, 1997 to
          include results from May 1, 1997 through June 30, 1997, and excludes
          results from May 1, 1996 through December 31, 1996.
      (4) The Company has excluded (i) the results of operations of Fort Mill
          Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge for the year ended December 31, 1996 and the
          period ended June 3, 1997 and (ii) the historical results of
          operations and related pro forma adjustments related to the Williams
          Acquisition because management believes such results and adjustments
          are not material to the Pro Forma Combined and Consolidated Statement
          of Operations.
      (5) Prior to the Company's acquisition of the Lake Norman Dealerships, its
          former owners directed $550,000 and $150,000 in contributions to
          charitable organizations during the year ended December 31, 1996 and
          the six months ended June 30, 1997, respectively. It is the Company's
          intention not to maintain the level of charitable contributions
          already reflected in the Company's historical combined financial
          statements. Although no pro forma adjustment to eliminate this expense
          has been included in the accompanying Pro Forma Combined and
          Consolidated Statements of Operations, the Company believes disclosure
          and consideration of the Lake Norman Dealerships contributions is
          appropriate to understand the continuing impact on the Company's
          results of operations of the acquisition of the Lake Norman
          Dealerships.
      (6) Reflects the increase in interest expense associated with the assumed
          borrowings made under the Company's new credit arrangements of $26.9
          million to provide a portion of the funds necessary for consummation
          of the Acquisitions. The effective interest rate used in the pro forma
          calculation was 8.5%. This assumed borrowing level was calculated
          based upon a per share price of the Offering of $13.00, which is the
          midpoint of the range of the initial public offering price shown on
          the cover page of this Prospectus. Should the actual per share price
          of the Offering be different, the actual amount borrowed to provide a
          portion of the funds necessary for the consummation of the
          Acquisitions and the related interest expense would be different than
          the amounts assumed here.
      (7) Pro forma net income per share is based upon the assumption that
          11,250,000 shares of Common Stock are outstanding after the Offering.
          This amount represents 5,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock to be
          issued in the Offering and 6,250,000 shares of Class B Common Stock
          owned by the Company's stockholders immediately following the
          Reorganization and the Acquisitions and giving effect to the Stock
          Split. See "Principal Stockholders" and Note 1 to the Company's
          Combined and Consolidated Financial Statements included elsewhere in
          this Prospectus.
      (8) Reflects the elimination of minority interest in earnings as a result
          of the acquisition of the 31% minority ownership interest in Town &
          Country Toyota, Inc. for $3.2 million of Class B Common Stock in
          connection with the Reorganization, and the amortization of
          approximately $3.0 million in related goodwill over 40 years arising
          from such acquisition.
      (9) Reflects the net increase in the provision for income taxes due to the
          amortization of goodwill related to the acquisition of the minority
          interest pursuant to the Reorganization, calculated at the effective
          rate of 39.9%.
                                         (footnotes continued on following page)
                                       32
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
     (10) Reflects the decrease in interest expense, floor plan resulting from
          the refinancing of the floor plan notes payable arrangements of the
          Company and the dealerships being acquired in the Acquisitions under
          one master agreement. The aggregate balance of floor plan notes
          payable arrangements of the Company and the dealerships being acquired
          in the Acquisitions was $136.2 million and $142.2 million at December
          31, 1996 and June 30, 1997, respectively. The average interest expense
          under this new agreement is approximately 7.6% compared to historical
          interest rates ranging from 7.75% to 10.25%.
     (11) Adjustment reflects the conversion from the LIFO Method of inventory
          accounting to the FIFO Method of inventory accounting at the Lake
          Norman Dealerships, Ken Marks Ford and Dyer Volvo in the amount of
          $169,000, $260,000 and $116,000, respectively for the year ended
          December 31, 1996 and $324,000 at the Lake Norman Dealerships and
          $47,000 at Ken Marks Ford for the six months ended June 30, 1997
          (there being no significant amount for Dyer Volvo during this period).
          The Company will convert to the FIFO Method conditioned upon the
          closing of the Offering. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of
          Financial Condition and Results of Operations -- Overview."
     (12) Reflects the net decrease in selling, general and administrative
          expenses related to the net reduction in salaries and fringe benefits
          of owners and officers of the acquired dealerships who will become
          employees of the Company after the Offering, consistent with reduced
          salaries pursuant to employment agreements with the Company, effective
          upon consummation of the Offering.
     (13) The decrease in selling, general and administrative expenses reflects
          the elimination of salaries paid to owners of certain dealerships
          acquired in the Acquisitions whose positions and salaries will be
          eliminated in conjunction with the Offering.
     (14) Reflects the Company's estimate of the increase in rent expense
          related to lease agreements entered into with the sellers of the
          Bowers Dealerships for the dealerships' real property with a net
          carrying value of $2.3 million that will not be acquired by the
          Company, and decreases in depreciation expense (based on useful lives
          ranging from 31.5 to 39 years) and interest expense related to
          mortgage indebtedness encumbering such property. The related mortgage
          indebtedness was approximately $1.8 million with interest charged at
          8.9% annually. The increase in rent expense and decreases in
          depreciation expense and interest expense are based on the terms of
          the asset purchase agreement pertaining to the Bowers Dealerships.
     (15) Reflects the elimination of amortization expense related to goodwill
          that arose in previous acquisitions in the Bowers Dealerships,
          assuming that each of the acquisitions giving rise to goodwill was
          consummated on January 1, 1996. See Note (2) above.
     (16) Reflects the amortization over an assumed amortization period of 40
          years of approximately $61.6 million in intangible assets, which
          consist primarily of goodwill, resulting from the Acquisitions which
          were assumed to occur on January 1, 1996. See "The Acquisitions" and
          "Pro Forma Combined and Consolidated Balance Sheet."
     (17) In connection with the Bowers Acquisition, the Company will issue a
          promissory note of up to $4.0 million that will bear interest at
          NationsBank's prime rate less 0.5%. This adjustment reflects an
          increase in interest expense related to the promissory note assuming a
          prime rate of 8.5%.
     (18) Reflects the net increase in provision for income taxes resulting from
          adjustments (6) and (11) through (17) above, computed using effective
          income tax rates ranging from 38.5% to 42.8%.
     (19) Certain of the Bowers Dealerships, the Lake Norman Dealerships, and
          Dyer Volvo were not subject to federal and state income taxes because
          they were either S corporations, partnerships, or limited liability
          companies during the period indicated. This adjustment reflects an
          increase in the federal and state income tax provision as if these
          entities had been taxable at the combined statutory income tax rate of
          approximately 39%. Upon completion of the Acquisitions, these
          businesses that have historically not been subject to corporate income
          tax will thereafter be subject to federal and state income tax as C
          corporations.
     (20) Reflects an increase from the Company's historical effective tax rate
          resulting from a higher statutory tax rate used due to an increase in
          taxable income for the pro forma combined entity and from an
          additional pro forma permanent difference for non-taxable goodwill
          amortization.
     (21) Reflects the elimination of federal and state tax expense which were
          assessed on the recapture of the LIFO inventory reserve which was
          required by tax law pursuant to the conversion of Dyer Volvo from a C
          corporation to an S corporation effective January 1, 1996. The
          liability associated with this tax assessment was not a liability
          assumed by the Company in its purchase of the net assets of Dyer
          Volvo.
     (22) Reflects the increase in salaries of existing and new officers who
          have entered into employment agreements with the Company, effective
          upon consummation of the Offering.
     (23) Reflects the net decrease in provision for income taxes resulting from
          adjustment (22) above, computed using an effective income tax rate of
          39.9%.
                                       33
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
               Pro Forma Combined and Consolidated Balance Sheet
                              As of June 30, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 The Acquisitions
                                                     ------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                               Pro Forma
                                           Actual      Bowers      Lake Norman   Ken Marks                  Adjustments for
Assets                                      (1)      Dealerships   Dealerships     Ford      Dyer Volvo    the Acquisitions
                                          --------   -----------   -----------   ---------   ----------   -------------------
<S>                                       <C>        <C>           <C>           <C>         <C>          <C>
                                                                            (in thousands)
Current Assets:
  Cash and cash equivalents.............. $  9,238     $ 4,766       $ 3,467      $ 2,491     $    173         $ (85,300)(2)
                                                                                                                  26,850(9)
  Marketable equity securities...........      769
  Receivables............................   12,897       2,649         2,535        2,347        2,535
  Inventories............................   73,410      30,948        22,778       14,802       11,129             6,817(3)
  Deferred income taxes..................      256                                     96
  Other current assets...................      818       2,779           244          679           32
                                          --------   -----------   -----------   ---------   ----------         --------
      Total current assets...............   97,388      41,142        29,024       20,415       13,869           (51,633)
Property and equipment, net..............   13,270       4,106           567          489        1,156            (2,311)(4)
                                                                                                                  61,550(2)
Goodwill, net............................    9,463       8,286                                                    (8,286)(5)
Other assets.............................      263         658(2)        462           14          297
                                          --------   -----------   -----------   ---------   ----------         --------
      Total assets....................... $120,384     $54,192       $30,053      $20,918     $ 15,322         $    (680)
                                          --------   -----------   -----------   ---------   ----------         --------
                                          --------   -----------   -----------   ---------   ----------         --------
Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity
Current Liabilities:
  Notes payable-floor plan............... $ 67,856     $26,771       $25,865      $16,165     $  5,534         $
  Notes payable-other....................                3,685            28
  Trade accounts payable.................    3,848       1,190         1,352          622
  Accrued interest.......................      491         178
  Other accrued liabilities..............    3,394       1,424           472        1,648          512
  Taxes payable..........................      913(10)                                 67          239               176(6)
  Payable to Company's Chairman..........    3,500
  Current maturities of long-term debt...      487         428            71                                         357(2)
                                          --------   -----------   -----------   ---------   ----------         --------
      Total current liabilities..........   80,489      33,676        27,788       18,502        6,285               533
Long-term debt...........................    5,137       2,332           786                                      (1,768)(4)
                                                                                                                   3,643(2)
                                                                                                                  26,850(9)
Payable to affiliated companies..........      855
Deferred income taxes....................      931                                     17                            882(6)
Income tax payable.......................    4,566(10)
Other long-term liabilities..............                                                          238
Stockholders' Equity:
  Common Stock of combined companies.....                  300            75            1          153              (529)(2)
  Class A Common Stock...................
  Class B Common Stock...................       62
  Paid-in capital........................   14,418                       600          424           28            (1,052)(2)
  Treasury stock.........................                                                       (4,976)            4,976(2)
  Retained earnings and members' and        14,023      17,884           804        1,974       13,594             6,817(3)
    partners' equity.....................                                                                         (1,058)(6)
                                                                                                                    (543)(4)
                                                                                                                 (31,145)(2)
                                                                                                                  (8,286)(5)
  Unrealized loss on marketable                (97)
    equity securities....................
                                          --------   -----------   -----------   ---------   ----------         --------
      Total stockholders' equity.........   28,406      18,184         1,479        2,399        8,799           (30,820)
                                          --------   -----------   -----------   ---------   ----------         --------
Total liabilities and stockholders'       $120,384     $54,192       $30,053      $20,918     $ 15,322         $    (680)
 equity..................................
                                          --------   -----------   -----------   ---------   ----------         --------
                                          --------   -----------   -----------   ---------   ----------         --------
<CAPTION>
 
                                              Pro Forma
                                           Adjustments for
Assets                                      the Offering      Total
                                           ---------------   --------
<S>                                        <C>               <C>
 
Current Assets:
  Cash and cash equivalents..............     $  58,450(7)   $ 16,635
                                                 (3,500)(8)
  Marketable equity securities...........                         769
  Receivables............................                      22,963
  Inventories............................                     159,884
  Deferred income taxes..................                         352
  Other current assets...................                       4,552
                                           ---------------   --------
      Total current assets...............        54,950       205,155
Property and equipment, net..............                      17,277
 
Goodwill, net............................                      71,013
Other assets.............................                       1,694
                                           ---------------   --------
      Total assets.......................     $  54,950      $295,139
                                           ---------------   --------
                                           ---------------   --------
Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity
Current Liabilities:
  Notes payable-floor plan...............     $              $142,191
  Notes payable-other....................                       3,713
  Trade accounts payable.................                       7,012
  Accrued interest.......................                         669
  Other accrued liabilities..............                       7,450
  Taxes payable..........................                       1,395
  Payable to Company's Chairman..........        (3,500)(8)
  Current maturities of long-term debt...                       1,343
                                           ---------------   --------
      Total current liabilities..........        (3,500)      163,773
Long-term debt...........................                      36,980
 
Payable to affiliated companies..........                         855
Deferred income taxes....................                       1,830
Income tax payable.......................                       4,566
Other long-term liabilities..............                         238
Stockholders' Equity:
  Common Stock of combined companies.....
  Class A Common Stock...................            50(7)         50
  Class B Common Stock...................                          62
  Paid-in capital........................        58,400(7)     72,818
  Treasury stock.........................
  Retained earnings and members' and                           14,064
    partners' equity.....................
 
  Unrealized loss on marketable                                   (97)
    equity securities....................
                                           ---------------   --------
      Total stockholders' equity.........        58,450        86,897
                                           ---------------   --------
Total liabilities and stockholders'           $  54,950      $295,139
 equity..................................
                                           ---------------   --------
                                           ---------------   --------
</TABLE>
 
                                                   (footnotes on following page)
                                       34
 <PAGE>
<PAGE>
- ---------------
 (1) The Reorganization, including the acquisition of the 31% minority interest
     in Town & Country Toyota for $3.2 million in Class B Common Stock in
     exchange therefor, was effective as of June 30, 1997 and is therefore
     reflected in the actual balance sheet as of that date. The acquisition of
     the minority interest resulted in the recognition of $3.0 million of
     additional goodwill.
 (2) Reflects the preliminary allocation of the aggregate purchase price of the
     Acquisitions based on the estimated fair value of the net assets acquired.
     Because the carrying amount of the net assets acquired, which primarily
     consist of accounts receivable, inventory, equipment, and floor plan
     indebtedness, approximates their fair value, management believes the
     application of purchase accounting will not result in an adjustment to the
     carrying amount of those net assets. Under the acquisition agreements, the
     negotiated purchase prices for the Acquisitions will be adjusted downward
     to the extent that the fair value of the tangible net assets as of the
     closing is less than an agreed upon amount. The amount of goodwill and the
     corresponding amortization actually recorded may ultimately be different
     from the amounts estimated here, depending upon the actual fair value of
     tangible net assets acquired at closing of the Acquisitions. The estimated
     purchase price allocation consists of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                       Bowers Dealerships    Ken Marks Ford    Lake Norman Dealerships    Dyer Volvo     Total
                                       ------------------    --------------    -----------------------    ----------    -------
<S>                                    <C>                   <C>               <C>                        <C>           <C>
                                                                            (in thousands)
Estimated total consideration:
  Cash..............................        $ 23,600            $ 25,500               $18,200             $ 18,000     $85,300
  Promissory note issued............           4,000                  --                    --                   --       4,000
                                             -------         --------------            -------            ----------    -------
      Total.........................          27,600              25,500                18,200               18,000      89,300
Less negotiated minimum fair value
  of tangible net assets acquired...           9,200               5,050                 3,000               10,500      27,750
                                             -------         --------------            -------            ----------    -------
Excess of purchase price over fair
  value of net tangible assets
  acquired..........................        $ 18,400            $ 20,450               $15,200             $  7,500     $61,550
                                             -------         --------------            -------            ----------    -------
                                             -------         --------------            -------            ----------    -------
</TABLE>
 
     In connection with the acquisition of Dyer Volvo, the Company will issue a
     warrant that will entitle the holder to acquire 42,187 shares of Class A
     Common Stock, representing a 0.375% ownership interest in the Company at an
     exercise price per share equal to the price offered in the Offering. The
     Pro Forma Combined and Consolidated Balance Sheet does not give effect to
     the issuance of this warrant because management believes the effect on the
     Company's pro forma financial position and results of operations would not
     be materially different from that which is presented. The difference
     between the purchase price and the fair market value of the net tangible
     assets acquired will be allocated to intangible assets, primarily goodwill
     and amortized over 40 years.
     Volvo's consent to the acquisition of European Motors' Volvo franchise as
     part of the Bowers Acquisition and the acquisition of Dyer Volvo requires
     that each former owner maintain a 20% voting interest in, and serve as the
     manager of, these respective dealerships. Company management believes that
     the effect of these arrangements, as currently structured, on the Company's
     pro forma financial positions and results of operations would not be
     materially different from that presented above.
 (3) Reflects the conversion from the LIFO Method of inventory accounting to the
     FIFO Method of inventory accounting at the Lake Norman Dealerships, Ken
     Marks Ford and Dyer Volvo in the amounts of $1.6 million, $2.8 million and
     $2.5 million, respectively. The Company intends to convert to the FIFO
     Method conditioned upon the closing of the Offering. See "Management's
     Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
     Operations -- Overview."
 (4) Reflects the distribution of real property of the Bowers Dealerships with a
     net depreciated cost of approximately $2.3 million, which are not being
     acquired in the Acquisitions, and the related mortgage indebtedness in the
     amount of approximately $1.8 million. See "Certain Transactions."
 (5) Reflects the elimination of goodwill that arose in previous acquisitions of
     the Bowers Dealerships.
 (6) Reflects the amount of taxes payable that will result from the FIFO
     conversion at Ken Marks Ford in the amount of $1.1 million.
 (7) Reflects the issuance of Class A Common Stock in the Offering assuming a
     per share price of $13.00, which is the midpoint of the range of the
     initial public offering price set forth on the cover page of this
     Prospectus, and the Stock Split pertaining to the Class B Common Stock. See
     "Use of Proceeds" and "Prospectus Summary."
 (8) Reflects the repayment of the Payable to the Company's Chairman. See "Use
     of Proceeds."
 (9) Reflects borrowings made under the Company's new credit arrangements to
     provide a portion of the funds necessary for consummation of the
     Acquisitions. These borrowings are payable in full two years from
     establishment, and have been shown as a non-current liability in the
     accompanying pro forma combined and consolidated balance sheet. Should the
     actual per share price of the Offering be different than $13.00, the net
     proceeds of the Offering and the actual amount borrowed to provide a
     portion of the funds necessary for the consummation of the Acquisitions
     would be different than amounts assumed here (excluding funds borrowed to
     finance the Fort Mill Acquisition and the Williams Acquisition). See "Use
     of Proceeds."
(10) In connection with the Reorganization and the Offering, the Company will
     convert from the last-in, first-out (LIFO) method of inventory accounting
     to the first-in, first-out (FIFO) method of inventory accounting. The
     accompanying pro forma combined and consolidated balance sheet includes
     $5.5 million representing an additional tax liability which will result
     from this conversion. This liability will be payable over a six-year
     period.
                                       35
 <PAGE>
 
<PAGE>
                      MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
                OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
     The following discussion of the results of operations and financial
condition should be read in conjunction with (i) the Sonic Automotive, Inc. and
Affiliated Companies Combined and Consolidated Financial Statements and the
related notes thereto included elsewhere in this Prospectus, (ii) the financial
statements of certain of the entities being acquired in the "Acquisitions" and
the related notes thereto and (iii) the Pro Forma Financial Statements and the
related notes thereto, all included elsewhere in this Prospectus.
Overview
     Sonic Automotive, Inc. is one of the leading automotive retailers in the
United States, operating 23 dealership franchises, four standalone used vehicle
facilities and seven collision repair centers in the southeastern and
southwestern United States. Sonic sells new and used cars and light trucks,
sells replacement parts, provides vehicle maintenance, warranty, paint and
repair services and arranges related F&I for its automotive customers. The
Company's business is geographically diverse, with dealership operations in the
Charlotte, Chattanooga, Nashville, Tampa-Clearwater, Houston and Atlanta
markets, each of which the Company believes is experiencing favorable
demographic trends. Sonic sells 15 domestic and foreign brands, which consist of
BMW, Cadillac, Chrysler, Dodge, Ford, Honda, Infiniti, Jaguar, Jeep, KIA,
Oldsmobile, Plymouth, Toyota, Volkswagen and Volvo. In several of its markets,
the Company has a significant market share for new cars and light trucks,
including 13.7% in Charlotte and 9.1% in Chattanooga in 1996. Pro forma for the
Acquisitions, the Company had revenues of $899.6 million and retail unit sales
of 24,206 new and 13,475 used vehicles in 1996. The Company believes that in
1996, based on pro forma retail unit sales it would have been one of the ten
largest dealer groups out of a total of more than 15,000 dealer groups in the
United States and, based on pro forma revenues, it would have had three of the
top 100 individual dealerships locations in the United States.
     The Company intends to pursue an acquisition growth strategy led by a
management team that has experience in the consolidation of automotive retailing
as well as motorsports businesses. Bruton Smith, who is also the Chief Executive
Officer of Speedway Motorsports, Inc., the owner and operator of several
motorsports facilities, first entered the automotive retailing business in the
mid-1960's. Mr. Smith will devote approximately 50% of his business time to the
Company. Since 1990, Mr. Smith has successfully acquired three dealerships and
increased revenues from his dealerships from $199.4 million in 1992 to $376.6
million in 1996, without giving effect to the Acquisitions. In the Tennessee
market, Mr. Bowers has acquired or opened eight dealerships since 1992 and
increased revenues (primarily through acquisitions) of the Bowers Dealerships
from $13.2 million in 1992 to $101.5 million in 1996. No assurance can be given
that Messrs. Smith and Bowers will be successful in acquiring or opening new
dealerships for the Company or increasing the Company's revenues.
     New vehicle revenues include the sale and lease of new vehicles. Used
vehicle revenues include amounts received for used vehicles sold to retail
customers, other dealers and wholesalers. Other operating revenues include parts
and services revenues, fees and commissions for arranging F&I and sales of third
party extended warranties for vehicles (collectively, "F&I transactions"). In
connection with vehicle financing contracts, the Company receives a fee (a
"finance fee") from the lender for originating the loan. If, within 90 days of
origination, the customer pays off the loans through refinancing or
selling/trading in the vehicle or defaults on the loan, the finance company will
assess a charge (a "chargeback") for a portion of the original commission. The
amount of the chargeback depends on how long the related loan was outstanding.
As a result, the Company has established reserves based on its historical
chargeback experience. The Company also sells warranties provided by third-party
vendors, and recognizes a commission at the time of sale.
     While the automotive retailing business is cyclical, Sonic sells several
products and services that are not closely tied to the sale of new and used
vehicles. Such products and services include the Company's parts and service and
collision repair businesses, both of which are not dependent upon near-term new
vehicle sales volume. One measure of cyclical exposure in the automotive
retailing business is based on the dealerships' ability to cover fixed costs
with gross profit from revenues independent of vehicle sales. According to this
measurement of "fixed coverage," a higher percentage of non-vehicle sales
revenue to fixed costs indicates a lower exposure to economic cycles. Each
manufacturer requires its dealerships to report fixed coverage according to a
specific method, and the methods used vary widely among the manufacturers and
are not comparable.
     The Company's cost of sales and profitability are also affected by the
allocations of new vehicles which its dealerships receive from Manufacturers.
When the Company does not receive allocations of new vehicle models adequate to
meet customer demand, it purchases additional vehicles from other dealers at a
premium to the manufacturer's invoice, reducing the gross margin realized on the
sales of such vehicles. In addition, the Company follows a disciplined approach
in selling
                                       36
 
<PAGE>
vehicles to other dealers and wholesalers when the vehicles have been in the
Company's inventory longer than the guidelines set by the Company. Such sales
are frequently at or below cost and, therefore, affect the Company's overall
gross margin on vehicle sales. The Company's salary expense, employee benefits
costs and advertising expenses comprise the majority of its selling, general and
administrative ("SG&A") expenses. The Company's interest expense fluctuates
based primarily on the level of the inventory of new vehicles held at its
dealerships, substantially all of which is financed (such financing being called
"floor plan financing").
     The Company has historically accounted for all of its dealership
acquisitions using the purchase method of accounting and, as a result, does not
include in its financial statements the results of operations of these
dealerships prior to the date they were acquired by the Company. The Combined
and Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company discussed below reflect the
results of operations, financial position and cash flows of each of the
Company's dealerships acquired prior to June 30, 1997. As a result of the
effects of the Reorganization, as well as the effects of the Acquisitions and
the Offering, the historical combined and consolidated financial information
described in "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and
Results of Operations," is not necessarily indicative of the results of
operations, financial position and cash flows of the Company in the future or
the results of operations, financial position and cash flows which would have
resulted had the Reorganization and Acquisitions occurred at the beginning of
the periods presented in the Combined and Consolidated Financial Statements.
     The Company's total revenues have increased from $199.4 million in 1992 to
$376.6 million in 1996, for a compound annual growth rate of 17.2% (primarily as
a result of acquisitions). Operating income during this period experienced
faster growth, with operating income increasing from $3.7 million in 1992 to
$10.8 million in 1996, for a 30.7%, compound annual growth rate (primarily as a
result of acquisitions). Income before income taxes and minority interest,
however, has only increased at a compound annual growth rate of 18.3% primarily
because interest expense on floor plan obligations has increased from 1.1% of
total revenues in 1992 to 1.6% of total revenues in 1996. Inventory and floor
plan balances increased during 1995 and 1996 to support the Company's strategy
of increasing market share. In early 1997, the Company instituted additional
inventory controls in order to reduce interest costs to levels typical of the
industry. Interest expense on floor plan obligations as a percentage of total
revenues has improved from 1.5% for the six months ended June 30, 1996 to 1.4%
for the six months ended June 30, 1997.
     As of June 30, 1997, the Company effected the Reorganization pursuant to
which the Company (i) acquired all of the capital stock of the Sonic Dealerships
and (ii) issued Class B Common Stock in exchange for the Dealership Securities.
The Company will acquire these minority interests in purchase transactions at a
price in excess of their book value by approximately $2.5 million. This excess
will be capitalized as goodwill and amortized over forty years. From May through
October 1997, the Company consummated or signed definitive agreements to
purchase six additional dealerships or dealership groups for an aggregate
purchase price of $94.8 million. The Company intends to use the proceeds from
the Offering, along with borrowings under the Six-Month Facility (as defined
herein), the initial borrowing under the Revolving Facility (as defined herein),
and the Bowers Note to pay the purchase price of the Acquisitions. In connection
with the Acquisitions, the Company will book approximately $61.6 million of
goodwill which will be amortized over forty years.
     The automobile industry is cyclical and historically has experienced
periodic downturns, characterized by oversupply and weak demand. Many factors
affect the industry including general economic conditions and consumer
confidence, the level of discretionary personal income, interest rates and
available credit. During the five years ended December 31, 1996, the automobile
industry was generally in a growth period with new vehicles sales growing at a
compound rate of 10.5% as a result of price increases of 6.2% and unit sales
increases of 4.0%. During the first six months of 1997, however, industry sales
of new cars declined by 2.0%, although the Company's new car and light truck
unit sales increased by 7.0% during the period. During these periods, interest
rates were relatively stable.
                                       37
 
<PAGE>
Results of Operations
     The following table summarizes, for the periods presented, the percentages
of total revenues represented by certain items reflected in the Company's
statement of operations.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                   Percentage of Total Revenues for
                                                                            ----------------------------------------------
                                                                                                          Six Months Ended
                                                                             Year Ended December 31,          June 30,
                                                                            --------------------------    ----------------
                                                                             1994      1995      1996      1996      1997
                                                                            ------    ------    ------    ------    ------
<S>                                                                         <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>
Revenues:
New vehicle sales........................................................   61.5  %   60.0  %   61.9  %   61.0  %   64.4  %
Used vehicle sales.......................................................   23.9  %   26.0  %   24.9  %   25.6  %   22.6  %
Parts, service and collision repair......................................   12.7  %   11.5  %   11.3  %   11.1  %   10.8  %
Finance and insurance....................................................    1.9  %    2.5  %    1.9  %    2.3  %    2.2  %
                                                                            ------    ------    ------    ------    ------
Total revenues...........................................................   100.0 %   100.0 %   100.0 %   100.0 %   100.0 %
Cost of sales............................................................   87.2  %   87.1  %   87.9  %   88.2  %   88.6  %
                                                                            ------    ------    ------    ------    ------
Gross profit.............................................................   12.8  %   12.9  %   12.1  %   11.8  %   11.4  %
Selling, general and administrative......................................    9.2  %    9.4  %    8.9  %    8.8  %    8.7  %
Operating income.........................................................    3.2  %    3.2  %    2.9  %    2.9  %    2.6  %
Interest expense.........................................................    1.3  %    1.6  %    1.7  %    1.6  %    1.6  %
                                                                            ------    ------    ------    ------    ------
Income before income taxes...............................................    2.2  %    1.7  %    1.3  %    1.5  %    1.2  %
                                                                            ------    ------    ------    ------    ------
                                                                            ------    ------    ------    ------    ------
</TABLE>
 
  Six Months Ended June 30, 1997 Compared to Six Months Ended June 30, 1996
     Revenues. Revenues grew in each of the Company's primary revenue areas,
except for used vehicles, for the first half of 1997 as compared with the first
half of 1996, causing total revenues to increase 12.2% to $212.7 million. New
vehicle sales revenue increased 18.4% to $137.1 million, compared with $115.7
million. New vehicle unit sales increased from 6,027 to 6,553, accounting for
51.5% of the increase in vehicle sales revenues. The remainder of the increase
was primarily due to a 8.9% increase in the average selling price resulting from
changes in vehicle prices, particularly a shift in customer preference to higher
cost light trucks and sport utility vehicles.
     Used vehicle revenues from retail sales declined 7.2% from $35.2 million in
the first half of 1996 to $32.7 million in the first half of 1997. The decline
in used vehicle revenues was due principally to declines in used vehicle unit
sales at the Company's Town & Country Ford and Lone Star Ford locations, which
related to changes in consumer demand.
     The Company's parts, service and collision repair revenue increased 9.0% to
$22.9 million from $21.0 million, and declined as a percentage of revenue to
10.8% from 11.1%. The increase in service and parts revenue was due principally
to increased parts revenue, including wholesale parts, from the Company's Lone
Star Ford and Fort Mill Ford locations. F&I revenue increased $0.5 million, due
principally to increased new vehicle sales and related financings.
     Gross Profit. Gross profit increased 8.5% in the 1997 period to $24.3
million from $22.4 million in the 1996 period due to increases in revenues of
new vehicles principally at the Company's Lone Star Ford and Fort Mill Ford
locations. Parts and service revenue increases also contributed to the increase
in gross profit. Gross profit as a percentage of sales declined from 11.8% to
11.4% due principally to reductions in higher margin used vehicle sales from the
prior period.
     Selling, General and Administrative Expenses. SG&A expenses increased 10.8%
from $16.6 million to $18.4 million. These expenses increased due to increases
in sales volume as well as expenses associated with the Acquisitions and the
Offering.
     Interest Expense. The Company's interest expense increased 10.1% from $3.0
million to $3.3 million. The increase in interest expense was due to the
acquisition of Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge dealership in June of 1997,
increases in interest rates on floor plan debt and increased new vehicle
inventory levels at existing dealerships.
     Net Income. As a result of the factors noted above, the Company's net
income decreased by $0.2 million in the first half of 1997 compared to the first
half of 1996.
  Year Ended December 31, 1996 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 1995
     Revenues. The Company's total revenue increased 21.1% to $376.6 million in
1996 from $311.0 million in 1995. New vehicle sales increased 25.0% to $233.1
million in 1996 from $186.5 million in 1995, primarily because of the
acquisition in
                                       38
 
<PAGE>
February 1996 of the Company's Fort Mill Ford dealership. The inclusion of the
results of the Fort Mill Ford dealership accounted for 65.3% of the Company's
overall increase in new vehicle sales in 1996. Of the increase in sales, 60.7%
was attributable to increases in unit sales from 1995 to 1996. The remainder of
the increase in new vehicle sales in 1996 was largely attributable to an
increase in average unit sales prices of 9.8% which the Company believes was
primarily due to changes in inventory mix (in response to shifting customer
preferences to light trucks and sport utility vehicles) and general increases in
new vehicle sales prices.
     Used vehicle revenues from retail sales increased 12.0% to $68.0 million in
1996 from $60.8 million in 1995. The inclusion of the results of the Company's
Fort Mill Ford dealership accounted for substantially all of this increase in
used vehicle sales. The Company attributes the remainder of the increase in its
used vehicle sales in 1996 to increases of approximately 5.6% in the average
retail selling price per vehicle sold. Increases in average retail selling
prices were due to changes in product mix and general price increases.
     The Company's parts, service and collision repair revenue increased 19.0%
to $42.6 million for 1996, compared to $35.9 million in 1995. Of this increase,
$4.4 million or 64.5% was due to the inclusion of the Company's Fort Mill Ford
dealership in the 1996 results of operations. The remainder of the increase was
principally the result of improved service operations and wholesale parts
distribution at the Company's Town and Country Ford dealership. F&I revenues
declined $0.7 million, or 8.9%, due principally to reductions in sales of
finance and insurance products at Town and Country Ford.
     Gross Profit. Gross profit increased 13.7% in 1996 to $45.6 million from
$40.1 million in 1995 primarily due to the addition of the Fort Mill Ford
dealership. Gross profit decreased from 12.9% to 12.1% as a percentage of sales
due principally to declines in F&I income and declines in gross profit margins
on the sale of used vehicles. Gross margins on new vehicles increased primarily
due to increases in the average selling price per unit due to a change in mix of
new vehicles sold, particularly higher margin light trucks and sport utility
vehicles.
     Selling, General and Administrative Expenses. The Company's SG&A expenses
increased $4.3 million, or 14.8%, from $29.3 million in 1995 to $33.7 million in
1996. However, as a percentage of revenue, SG&A expenses decreased from 9.4% to
8.9%. Expenses associated with the Fort Mill Ford dealership acquired by the
Company in 1996 accounted for approximately 91.4% of this increase. The Company
attributes the remainder of the increase in selling, general and administrative
expenses primarily to higher compensation levels in 1996 and to an increase in
advertising expenses.
     Interest Expense. The Company's interest expense in 1996 increased 29.6% to
$6.4 million from $4.9 million in 1995. Of this increase, $1.0 million or 70.4%
was attributable to floor plan financing at the Company's Fort Mill Ford
dealership acquired in February 1996. The remainder of the increase primarily
reflects interest expense on the debt assumed in the acquisition of Fort Mill
Ford and an increase in floor plan interest rates during 1996.
     Net Income. The Company's net income in 1996 decreased 6.3% to $3.0 million
from $3.2 million in 1995. This decrease was principally caused by increased
interest costs related to floor plan financing and debt assumed in the
acquisition of Fort Mill Ford.
  Year Ended December 31, 1995 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 1994
     Revenues. The Company's total revenue increased 16.4% to $311.0 million in
1995 from $267.1 million in 1994. New vehicle sales increased 13.5% to $186.5
million in 1995 from $164.4 million in 1994. The Company attributes the increase
in new vehicle sales to unit sales increases of 6.1% primarily from the Town &
Country Ford and Lone Star Ford dealerships which increased 9.3% and 7.1%,
respectively. The remainder of the increase was due to increased sales of higher
priced light trucks and sport utility vehicles and general price increases.
     Used vehicle revenues from retail sales increased by 27.9% to $60.8 million
in 1995, compared with $47.5 million in 1994. The increase in used vehicle unit
sales was due principally to increases at the Company's Lone Star Ford, Town &
Country Ford and Frontier Cadillac-Oldsmobile locations. Unit sales volume
increased 18.2%, or 798 units, accounting for 70.9% of the increase in used
vehicle revenues. The remainder of the increase was due to improvements in
product mix and general increases in used vehicle selling prices.
     The Company's parts, service and collision repair revenue increased 5.5% or
$1.9 million, from $34.0 million in 1994 to $35.9 million in 1995. Wholesale
parts sale increases at the Company's Lone Star Ford dealership and improved
service operations at the Company's Town and Country Toyota dealership account
for the majority of the increase. F&I revenue increased $2.6 million due
principally to additional sales of F&I products at the Company's Town and
Country Ford and Lone Star Ford dealerships.
                                       39
 
<PAGE>
     Gross Profit. Gross profit increased 17.6% in 1995 to $40.1 million from
$34.1 million in 1994. Gross profit as a percentage of sales increased from
12.8% to 12.9% due principally to a 50.8% increase in high margin F&I product
sales. Gross margins on used vehicles improved due to the Company's strategy of
improved inventory management and the purchase of quality used vehicles.
     Selling, General and Administrative Expenses. The Company's SG&A expenses
increased $4.7 million to $29.3 million or 19.1% and represented 9.4% in total
revenues in 1995 from $24.6 million or 9.2% of total revenues in 1994.
     Interest Expense. The Company's interest expense in 1995 increased 43.5% to
$4.9 million from $3.4 million in 1994. Increased interest expense was due to
increases in inventory levels and related floor plan borrowings.
     Net Income. The Company's net income in 1995 decreased 13.5% to $3.2
million from $3.7 million in 1994. This decrease was caused by the increase in
floor plan financing due to an increase in vehicle inventory levels.
Liquidity and Capital Resources
     The Company's principal needs for capital resources are to finance
acquisitions, debt service and working capital requirements. Historically, the
Company has relied primarily upon internally generated cash flows from
operations, borrowing under its various credit facilities and borrowings and
capital contributions from its stockholders to finance its operations and
expansion. After the Offering, the Company does not expect to receive any
additional financing from its existing stockholders.
     The Company has historically maintained a separate revolving floor plan
credit facility for each dealership which has been used to finance vehicle
inventory. The Company currently has floor plan credit facilities with Ford
Motor Credit, Chrysler Financial Corporation and World Omni Financial
Corporation. As of June 30, 1997 there was an aggregate of $67.9 million
outstanding under the floor plan credit facilities. These floor plan facilities
bear interest at variable rates ranging from LIBOR plus 2.75% to prime plus
1.0%. Typically new vehicle floor plan indebtedness exceeds the related
inventory balances. The inventory balance is generally reduced by the
manufacturer's purchase discounts, and such reduction is not reflected in the
related floor plan liability. These manufacturer purchase discounts are standard
in the industry, typically occur on all new vehicle purchases, and are not used
to offset the related floor plan liability. These discounts are aggregated and
generally paid to the Company by the manufacturer on a quarterly basis. The
related floor plan liability becomes due as vehicles are sold.
     The Company makes monthly interest payments on the amount financed under
the floor plan lines but is not required to make loan principal repayments prior
to the sale of the vehicles. The underlying notes are due when the related
vehicles are sold and are collateralized by vehicle inventories and other assets
of the Company. The floor plan financing agreements contain a number of
covenants, including among others, covenants restricting the Company with
respect to the creation of liens and changes in ownership, officers and key
management personnel.
     The Company has received a commitment from Ford Motor Credit to consolidate
its new vehicle floor plan lines, contingent upon the Offering and other
customary terms and conditions. The average interest expense under this new
agreement is anticipated to be approximately 7.6% compared to historical
interest rates ranging from 7.75% to 10.25%.
     The Company leases various facilities and equipment under operating lease
agreements including leases with related parties. See "Certain
Transaction -- Leases."
     During the first six months of 1997, the Company generated net cash of $4.0
million from operating activities. Net cash provided by operating activities was
$2.1 million in 1996 and was primarily attributable to net income of $3.0
million. Increased inventory levels and accounts receivable were primarily
offset by increased floor plan indebtedness and accounts payable. The increase
in inventory levels in 1996 reflects an increase in the volume of sales and the
timing of shipments from the Manufacturers. Increased receivables reflect
increased sales primarily attributable to Fort Mill Ford and Fort Mill
Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge acquired in 1996 and 1997, respectively. The Company
generated net cash from operations of $3.0 million in 1995 and 1994.
     Cash used for investing activities, excluding amounts paid in acquisitions,
was approximately $0.8 million for the first six months of 1997 and related
primarily to acquisitions of property and equipment. Cash provided by (used in)
investing activities was ($11.5) million, $0.3 million and ($1.7) million in
1996, 1995 and 1994, respectively, including $1.9 million, $1.5 million and $1.4
million of capital expenditures during such periods.
     In 1996, cash provided by financing activities of $7.1 million reflected
the purchase of capital stock by a stockholder of the Company, the proceeds of
which were used to fund the acquisition of Fort Mill Ford and the purchase of
stock by a stockholder of Town & Country Ford. Cash used in financing
activities, excluding capital contributions for the six months ended June 30,
1997 was $0.2 million principally due to scheduled payments on long-term debt.
                                       40
 
<PAGE>
     In conjunction with the recent consummation of the Lake Norman Acquisition,
the Company obtained from NationsBank, N.A. ("NationsBank") a short-term line of
credit in an aggregate principal amount of up to $20.0 million that matures no
later than February 15, 1998 (the "Six-Month Facility"). A total of $20.0
million in aggregate principal amount is currently outstanding under the
Six-Month Facility, which amount has been applied to fund the purchase price of
the Lake Norman Acquisition and the Williams Acquisition. The Six-Month Facility
is secured by a pledge of Speedway Motorsports, Inc. common stock shares owned
by Bruton Smith, the Company's Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. See
"Certain Transactions -- The Smith Guaranties and Pledges." No assets of the
Company secure the Six-Month Facility, and the Company is under no obligation to
repay or reimburse Mr. Smith should NationsBank foreclose on the securities
pledged by Mr. Smith.
     The Company recently obtained a secured, revolving acquisition line of
credit (the "Revolving Facility") from Ford Motor Credit in an initial aggregate
principal amount of $26.0 million (the "Initial Loan Commitment"), which the
Company expects to be increased to an aggregate principal amount of $75.0
million (the "Maximum Loan Commitment") pursuant to a commitment from Ford Motor
Credit. The Company has also received a commitment from Ford Motor Credit to
provide floor plan financing to the Company's wholly-owned dealership
subsidiaries (the "Wholesale Credit Lines" and, together with the Revolving
Facility, the "Facilities"). Under the terms of the Revolving Facility governing
the Initial Loan Commitment, the Revolving Facility will mature on December 15,
1997, unless the Revolving Facility is increased to the Maximum Loan Commitment.
After the increase to the Maximum Loan Commitment, the Revolving Facility will
mature in two years, unless the Company requests that such term be extended, at
the option of Ford Motor Credit, for a number of additional one year terms to be
negotiated by the parties. No assurance can be given that such extensions will
be granted. The Revolving Facility is expected to be increased to the Maximum
Loan Commitment after the consummation of the Offering, subject to customary
terms and conditions. The proceeds from the Initial Loan Commitment were used to
consummate the Ken Marks Acquisition. Amounts to be drawn under the Maximum Loan
Commitment are anticipated by the Company to be used (i) for the acquisition of
additional dealership subsidiaries, (ii) to refinance the amounts remaining
outstanding under the Six-Month Facility (after application of the proceeds of
the Offering), which will result in the retirement of the Six-Month Facility,
and (iii) to provide general working capital needs of the Company not to exceed
$10 million. The Wholesale Credit Lines are to be provided to the Company's
dealership subsidiaries, including the dealerships acquired in the Acquisitions,
subject to customary terms and conditions on terms substantially the same as the
floor plan financing previously provided by Ford Motor Credit to the Company's
subsidiaries.
     Although management believes that the Revolving Facility will be increased
to the Maximum Loan Commitment after the consummation of the Offering, no
assurance can be given that such increase will occur. The Initial Loan
Commitment is secured by a pledge of Speedway Motorsports, Inc. common stock
owned by Sonic Financial. See "Certain Transactions -- The Smith Guaranties and
Pledges." The Company is under no obligation to repay or reimburse Sonic
Financial if Ford Motor Credit forecloses on its securities. In addition, all of
the Facilities are secured by a pledge by the Company of all the capital stock,
membership interests and partnership interests of all of the Company's
dealership subsidiaries and a lien on all of the Company's other assets, except
for real estate owned by the Company. Mr. Smith and the Company's subsidiaries
also guarantee the Facilities, and the Company will guarantee the Wholesale
Credit Lines. The guarantees made by the Company's dealership subsidiaries are
secured by certain assets of such dealership subsidiaries. If the Revolving
Facility is increased to the Maximum Loan Commitment, Mr. Smith's guaranty and
Sonic Financial's pledge of Speedway Motorsports, Inc. common stock may be
released. (If net proceeds of the Offering to the Company are $70 million or
greater, the guarantee of the Revolving Facility by Bruton Smith, and the pledge
of shares of Speedway Motorsports, Inc. common stock owned by Sonic Financial,
will be released pursuant to the terms of the Revolving Facility. If net
proceeds of the Offering to the Company are less than $70 million, Sonic
Financial will be required to provide continued credit support for the Revolving
Facility in the form of a pledge of shares of Speedway Motorsports, Inc. common
stock owned by Sonic Financial equal in value to three times the amount of the
shortfall between $70 million and the actual net proceeds of the Offering to the
Company.) When the Company will need to refinance the Revolving Facility, there
can be no assurance that Mr. Smith will agree to guarantee such debt or that the
assets of Mr. Smith or Sonic Financial will be available to provide additional
security under a new credit agreement, or that a new credit agreement could be
arranged on terms as favorable as the terms of the Six-Month Facility or the
Revolving Facility without a gurantee by, or pledge of the assets of, Mr. Smith
or Sonic Financial. Pursuant to the terms of the Revolving Facility, the Company
also agreed not to pledge any of its assets to any third party (with the
exception of currently encumbered real estate and assets of the Company's
dealership subsidiaries that are subject to previous pledges or liens). See
"Risk Factors -- Limitations on Financial Resources Available for Acquisitions;
Possible Inability to Refinance Existing Debt."
     The Revolving Facility currently does not contain any affirmative financial
covenants by the Company, but does contain certain negative covenants made by
the Company, including covenants restricting or prohibiting the payment of
dividends, capital expenditures and material dispositions of assets as well as
other customary covenants. It is anticipated by the Company that when the
Initial Loan Commitment is increased to the Maximum Loan Commitment, the
Revolving Facility will be
                                       41
 
<PAGE>
amended by Ford Motor Credit and the Company to provide for, in addition to the
negative covenants described in the previous sentence, additional financial
covenants requiring the Company to maintain compliance with, among other things,
specified ratios of (i) debt to tangible equity (as defined in the Revolving
Facility), (ii) current assets to current liabilities, (iii) earnings before
interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization (EBITDA) to fixed charges, (iv)
EBITDA to interest expense, (v) EBITDA to total debt and (vi) EBITDA to total
floor plan debt. Moreover, the loss of voting control over the Company by the
Smith Group or the failure by the Company, with certain exceptions, to own all
the outstanding equity, membership or partnership interests in its dealership
subsidiaries will constitute an event of default under the Revolving Facility.
     Capital expenditures, excluding amounts paid in acquisitions, were $0.9
million, $1.9 million, $1.5 million and $1.4 million in the first six months of
1997 and in 1996, 1995 and 1994, respectively. The Company's principal capital
expenditures typically include building improvements and equipment for use in
the Company's dealerships. Capital expenditures in 1996 and 1995 were primarily
attributable to expenditures for the addition of a used car lot in 1996 and
other capital improvements at the Lone Star Ford dealership. Excluding the
purchase price for the Acquisitions and future acquisitions, the Company is
anticipating total capital expenditures in the second half of 1997 to be
approximately $1.0 million. The Company expects to increase its capital
expenditures over the next few years as part of its acquisition and growth
strategy.
     The Company believes that funds generated through future operations and
availability of borrowings under its floor plan financing (or any replacements
thereof) and its other credit arrangements (including the Maximum Loan
Commitment expected to become effective after consummation of the Offering) will
be sufficient to fund its debt service and working capital requirements and any
seasonal operating requirements, including its currently anticipated internal
growth for the foreseeable future. The Company estimates that it will incur a
tax liability of approximately $5.5 million in connection with the change in its
tax basis of accounting for inventory from LIFO to FIFO. The Company believes
that it will be required to pay this liability over a six-year period, beginning
in January 1998, and believes that it will be able to pay such obligation with
cash provided by operations. The Company expects to fund any future acquisitions
from its future cash flow from operations, additional debt financing (including
the Maximum Loan Commitment) or Class A Common Stock issuances. The Company does
not currently have in place any credit facilities for additional acquisitions.
There can be no assurance that additional financing can be obtained on terms
favorable to the Company, or that the Company will be able to use its Common
Stock to fund any future acquisitions. See "Risk Factors -- Limitations on
Financial Resources Available for Acquisitions; Possible Inability to Refinance
Existing Debt", " -- Stock Ownership/Issuance Limits; Limitation on Ability to
Issue Additional Equity" and "The Acquisitions -- Future Acquisitions."
Seasonality
     The Company's operations are subject to seasonal variations. The first
quarter generally contributes less revenue and operating profits than the
second, third and fourth quarters. Seasonality is principally caused by weather
conditions and timing of manufacturer incentive programs and model changeovers.
     Set forth below is revenue information with respect to the Company's
operations for the most recent six quarters.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             1996                               1997
                                                           -----------------------------------------     -------------------
                                                             1st        2nd         3rd        4th         1st        2nd
                                                           Quarter    Quarter     Quarter    Quarter     Quarter    Quarter
                                                           -------    --------    -------    -------     -------    --------
<S>                                                        <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>
                                                                                    (in thousands)
Revenues................................................   $85,669    $103,946    $93,222    $93,767     $98,739    $114,008
</TABLE>
 
Effects of Inflation
     Due to the relatively low levels of inflation in 1994, 1995 and 1996 and
the first half of 1997, inflation did not have a significant effect on the
Company's results of operations for those periods.
New Accounting Standards
     In February 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement
of Financial Accounting Standards No. 128, "Earnings Per Share." This Statement
specifies the computation, presentation and disclosure requirements for earnings
per share. The Company believes that the adoption of such Statement would not
result in earnings per share materially different than pro forma earnings per
share presented in the accompanying statements of income.
     In June 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of
Financial Accounting Standards No. 130, "Reporting Comprehensive Income." This
standard establishes standards of reporting and display of comprehensive income
and its components in a full set of general-purpose financial statements. This
Statement will be effective for the Company's fiscal year ending December 31,
1998, and the Company does not intend to adopt this statement prior to the
effective date. Had the Company adopted this Statement as of January 1, 1994, it
would have reported comprehensive income of $2.8 million, $2.4 million and $2.1
million for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
                                       42
 
<PAGE>
                                    BUSINESS
Overview
     The Company is one of the leading automotive retailers in the United
States, operating 23 dealership franchises, four standalone used vehicle
facilities and seven collision repair centers in the southeastern and
southwestern United States. Sonic sells new and used cars and light trucks,
sells replacement parts, provides vehicle maintenance, warranty, paint and
repair services and arranges related F&I for its automotive customers. The
Company's business is geographically diverse, with dealership operations in the
Charlotte, Chattanooga, Nashville, Tampa-Clearwater, Houston and Atlanta
markets, each of which the Company believes is experiencing favorable
demographic trends. Sonic sells 15 domestic and foreign brands, which consist of
BMW, Cadillac, Chrysler, Dodge, Ford, Honda, Infiniti, Jaguar, Jeep, KIA,
Oldsmobile, Plymouth, Toyota, Volkswagen and Volvo. In several of its markets,
the Company has a significant market share for new cars and light trucks,
including 13.7% in Charlotte and 9.1% in Chattanooga in 1996. Pro forma for the
Acquisitions, the Company had revenues of $899.6 million and retail unit sales
of 24,206 new and 13,475 used vehicles in 1996. The Company believes that in
1996, based on pro forma retail unit sales, it would have been one of the ten
largest dealer groups out of a total of more than 15,000 dealer groups in the
United States and, based on pro forma revenues, it would have had three of the
top 100 individual dealerships locations in the United States.
     The Company's founder and Chief Executive Officer, O. Bruton Smith, has
over 30 years of automotive retailing experience. In addition, the Company's
other executive officers, regional vice presidents and executive managers have
on average 18 years of automotive retailing experience. The Company's
dealerships are among those dealerships that have won the highest attainable
awards from various manufacturers measuring quality and customer satisfaction.
These awards include the Five Star Award from Chrysler, the Chairman's Award
from Ford, the President's Award from BMW and the President's Circle Award from
Infiniti. In addition, the Company was named to Ford's Top 100 Club, which
consists of Ford's top 100 retailers based on retail volume and consumer
satisfaction. Also, various members of the management team have served on
several manufacturer dealer councils which act as liaisons between the
manufacturers and dealer groups.
     The Company intends to pursue an acquisition growth strategy led by a
management team that has experience in the consolidation of automotive retailing
as well as motorsports businesses. Bruton Smith, who is also the Chief Executive
Officer of Speedway Motorsports, Inc., the owner and operator of several
motorsports facilities, first entered the automotive retailing business in the
mid-1960's. Mr. Smith will devote approximately 50% of his business time to the
Company. Since 1990, Mr. Smith has successfully acquired three dealerships and
increased his dealerships' revenues from $199.4 million in 1992 to $376.6
million in 1996, without giving effect to the Acquisitions. In the Tennessee
market, Mr. Bowers has acquired or opened eight dealerships since 1992 and
increased revenues (primarily through acquisitions) of the Bowers Dealerships
from $13.2 million in 1992 to $101.5 million in 1996. No assurance can be given
that Messrs. Smith and Bowers will be successful in acquiring or opening new
dealerships for the Company or increasing the Company's revenues.
     The Company believes the competitive advantages which differentiate it from
its local competitors include the reputation of the Company's management in the
automotive retailing industry, regional and national economies of scale, brand
and geographic diversity, and the established customer base and local name
recognition of the Company's dealerships. The Company has developed and
implemented several growth strategies to capitalize on these competitive
advantages. One of these is to continue to expand its operations in the
Southeast and Southwest by acquiring additional dealerships both within its
current markets and in new markets. The Company also is seeking additional
growth from the increased sale of higher margin products and services such as
wholesale parts, after-market products, collision repair services and F&I.
     Automobile retailing is highly competitive. The Company's competition
includes franchised automobile dealerships, some with greater resources than the
Company, selling the same or similar makes of vehicles offered by the Company.
Other competitors include other franchised dealers, private market buyers and
sellers of used vehicles, used vehicle dealers, service center chains and
independent service and repair shops. Primarily as a result of competitive
pressures, gross profit margins on new vehicle sales have been declining since
1986. The Company has also experienced gross profit margin pressure on used
vehicle sales over the last 18 months. For further discussion of competition
affecting the Company's business, see "Risk Factors -- Competition" and
"Business -- Competition."
Growth Strategy
     The Company's objective is to capitalize on the consolidation of the
automotive retailing industry. Key elements of the Company's strategy to achieve
this objective include the acquisition of additional dealerships and the
leveraging of the Company's new vehicle franchises to increase sales of higher
margin products and services.
                                       43
 
<PAGE>
(Bullet) Acquire Dealerships. The Company plans to implement a "hub and spoke"
         acquisition program primarily by pursuing (i) well-managed dealerships
         in new metropolitan and growing suburban geographic markets, and (ii)
         dealerships that will allow the Company to capitalize on regional
         economies of scale, offer a greater breadth of products and services in
         any of its markets or increase brand diversity. The growth generated
         through acquisitions creates opportunities for economies of scale,
         including more favorable financing terms from lenders and cost savings
         from the consolidation of administrative functions such as employee
         benefits, risk management and employee training.
          New Markets. The Company looks to acquire well-managed dealerships in
     geographic markets it does not currently serve, principally in the
     Southeast and Southwest regions of the United States. The Company will
     target dealers having superior operational and financial management.
     Generally, the Company will seek to retain the acquired dealerships'
     operational and financial management, and thereby benefit from their market
     knowledge, name recognition and local reputation. The Company also
     anticipates that management teams at the acquired dealerships will enable
     the Company to identify more effectively additional acquisition
     opportunities in these markets.
          Existing Markets. The Company seeks growth in its operations within
     existing markets by acquiring dealerships that increase the brands,
     products and services offered in those markets. These acquisitions should
     produce opportunities for additional operating efficiencies, promote
     increased name recognition and provide the Company with better
     opportunities for repeat and referral business. Such acquisitions should
     also create opportunities for regional economies of scale in areas such as
     vendor consolidation, facility and personnel utilization and advertising
     spending. Additionally, cost savings may be achieved by consolidating
     certain administrative functions on a regional basis that would not be
     efficient on a national basis, such as accounting, information systems,
     title work, credit and collection.
(Bullet) Pursue Opportunities in Ancillary Products and Services. The Company
         intends to pursue opportunities to increase its sales of higher-margin
         products and services by expanding its collision repair centers and its
         wholesale parts and after-market products businesses, which, other than
         after market products, are not directly related to the new vehicle
         cycle.
          Collision Repair Centers. The Company's collision repair business
     provides favorable margins and is not significantly affected by economic
     cycles or consumer spending habits. The Company believes that because of
     the high capital investment required for collision repair shops and the
     cost of complying with environmental and worker safety regulations, large
     volume body shops will be more successful in the future than smaller volume
     shops. The Company believes that this industry will consolidate and that it
     will be able to capitalize on this trend by expanding its collision repair
     business. The Company also believes that opportunities exist for those
     automotive retailers that can establish relationships with major insurance
     carriers. The Company currently participates in 35 direct repair programs
     with major insurance companies and its relationships with these carriers
     provide a source of collision repair customers. The Company currently has
     eight collision repair centers accounting for approximately $8.9 million in
     pro forma revenue for the year ended 1996. Sonic intends over the next
     several years to establish collision repair centers at various of its other
     facilities as market conditions warrant.
          Wholesale Parts. Over time, the Company plans to capitalize on its
     growing representation of numerous manufacturers in order to increase its
     sales of factory authorized parts to wholesale buyers such as independent
     mechanical and body repair garages and rental and commercial fleet
     operators.
          After-Market Products. The Company intends to expand its offerings of
     after-market products in many of its dealership locations. After-market
     products, such as custom wheels, performance parts, telephones and other
     accessories, enable the dealership to capture incremental revenue on new
     and used vehicle sales.
(Bullet) Enhance Profit Opportunities in Finance and Insurance. The Company
         offers its customers a wide range of financing and leasing alternatives
         for the purchase of vehicles, as well as credit life, accident and
         health and disability insurance and extended service contracts. As a
         result of its size and scale, the Company believes it will be able to
         negotiate with the lending institutions that purchase its financing
         contracts to increase the Company's revenues. Likewise, the Company
         expects to negotiate to increase the commissions it earns on extended
         service and insurance products. It also expects that the integration of
         innovative computer technologies and in-depth sales training will serve
         as an important tool in enhancing F&I profitability.
(Bullet) Increase Used Vehicle Sales. The Company believes that there will be
         opportunities to improve the used vehicle departments at several of its
         dealerships. The Company currently operates four standalone used
         vehicle facilities. In 1998, the Company intends to convert part of an
         existing facility in Nashville to a used vehicle facility. It also
         intends to develop used vehicle facilities in other markets where
         management believes opportunities exist.
                                       44
 
<PAGE>
Operating Strategy
     Sonic's operating objectives are to focus on customer satisfaction
throughout the organization in order to build long-term customer relationships
and to capitalize on operating efficiencies which will enhance its financial
performance. The Company seeks to achieve these objectives by implementing the
following operating strategies.
(Bullet) Operate Multiple Dealerships in Geographically Diverse Markets. The
         Company operates dealerships in Charlotte, Chattanooga, Nashville,
         Tampa-Clearwater, Houston and Atlanta. By operating in several
         locations throughout the United States, the Company believes it will be
         better able to insulate its earnings from local economic downturns. In
         addition, the Company believes that by establishing a significant
         market presence in its operating regions, it will be able to provide
         superior customer service through a market-specific sales, service,
         marketing and inventory strategy. It is the Company's strategy, for
         instance, that the savings in a market on reduced advertising costs
         will be re-deployed into customer service and customer retention
         programs. The Company's market share in its Charlotte and Chattanooga
         markets was 13.7% and 9.1%, respectively in 1996.
(Bullet) Achieve High Levels of Customer Satisfaction. Customer satisfaction has
         been and will continue to be a focus of the Company. The Company's
         personalized sales process is intended to satisfy customers by
         providing high-quality, affordable vehicles in a positive, "consumer
         friendly" buying environment. The Company's service department also
         seeks to provide its customers with a professional and reliable service
         experience of a consistently high standard. Beyond establishing strong
         consumer loyalty, this focus on customer satisfaction engenders good
         relations with Manufacturers. Manufacturers generally measure CSI,
         which is a result of a survey given to new vehicle buyers. Some
         Manufacturers offer specific performance incentives, on a per vehicle
         basis, if certain CSI levels (which vary by Manufacturer) are achieved
         by a dealer. Manufacturers can withhold approval of acquisitions if a
         dealer fails to maintain a minimum CSI score. Historically, the Company
         has not been denied Manufacturer approval of acquisitions based on CSI
         scores. To keep management focused on customer satisfaction, the
         Company includes CSI results as a component of its incentive
         compensation program.
(Bullet) Train and Develop Qualified Management. Sonic requires all of its
         employees, from service technicians to regional vice presidents, to
         participate in in-house training programs. The Company leverages the
         experience of senior management, along with third party trainers from
         manufacturers, industry affiliates and vendors, to formally train all
         employees. This training regimen has resulted in many of the Company's
         regional vice presidents, executive managers and salespeople being
         certified by NADA, and has become a convenient and effective way to
         share best practices among the Company's employees at all levels of the
         various dealerships. The Company is developing an education center (the
         "Education Center") to be equipped with classrooms specifically
         designed on a departmental basis. The F&I classroom in the Education
         Center, for example, is to be equipped with simulation software that
         replicates the dealers' systems and allows the employee to handle all
         facets of an F&I transaction. The Company believes that its
         comprehensive training of all employees at every level of their career
         path offers the Company a competitive advantage over other dealership
         groups in the development and retention of its workforce.
(Bullet) Offer a Diverse Range of Automotive Products and Services. Sonic offers
         a broad range of automotive products and services, including a wide
         selection of new and used vehicles, vehicle financing and insurance
         programs, replacement parts and maintenance and repair programs. The
         Company offers 15 product lines ranging from economy to luxury brands
         consisting of BMW, Cadillac, Chrysler, Dodge, Ford, Honda, Infiniti,
         Jaguar, Jeep, KIA, Oldsmobile, Plymouth, Toyota, Volkswagen and Volvo.
         The Company also offers a variety of used vehicles at a broad range of
         prices. Offering numerous new vehicle brands enables the Company to
         satisfy a variety of customers, reduces dependence on any one
         Manufacturer and reduces exposure to supply problems and product
         cycles.
(Bullet) Capitalize on Efficiencies in Operations. Because management
         compensation is based primarily on dealership performance, expense
         reduction and operating efficiencies are a significant management
         focus. As the Company pursues its acquisition strategy, the Company's
         size and market presence should provide it with an opportunity to
         negotiate favorable contracts on such expense items as advertising,
         purchasing, bank financings, employee benefit plans and other vendor
         contracts. In addition, the Company has instituted both regional and
         national operations committees that meet on a regular basis to share
         best practices to improve dealership performance.
(Bullet) Utilize Professional Management Practices and Incentive Based
         Compensation Programs. As a result of Sonic's size and geographic
         dispersion, the Company's senior management has instituted a
         multi-tiered management structure to supervise effectively its
         dealership operations. In addition to the officers of the Company, this
         structure includes executive managers who are responsible for
         individual dealership operations, as well as regional vice presidents
         responsible for various regions throughout the country. In an effort to
         align management's interest with that of stockholders, a portion of
                                       45
 
<PAGE>
         the incentive compensation program for each officer, vice president and
         executive manager is provided in the form of Company stock options,
         with additional incentives based on the performance of individual
         profit centers. Sonic believes that this organizational structure, with
         room for advancement and the opportunity for equity participation,
         serves as a strong motivation for its employees.
(Bullet) Apply Technology Throughout Operations. The Company believes that, with
         the customized technology it has introduced in certain markets, it has
         been able to improve its operations over time by integrating its
         systems into all aspects of its business. In these markets the Company
         uses computer-based technology to monitor its dealerships' operating
         performance and quickly adjust to market changes, and to integrate
         computer systems into its sales, F&I and parts and service operations.
         For example, sales managers use a database to identify and solicit
         prospective customers, and to design appropriate financing packages for
         prospective buyers. Service and parts managers utilize computer
         technology to coordinate between the two departments and to service
         customers more efficiently. In addition to these uses, the Company's
         technology also plays a role in its inventory management. The Company
         intends to expand this computer system into more of its dealerships and
         markets as existing contracts for computer systems expire.
Industry Overview
     Automotive retailing, with approximately $640 billion in 1996 retail sales,
is the largest consumer retail market in the United States, representing
approximately 8% of the domestic gross product based on data collected by NADA
and the U.S. Department of Commerce. Retail sales of new vehicles, which are
sold exclusively through new vehicle dealers, were approximately $328 billion.
In addition, used vehicle retail sales in 1996 were estimated at $311 billion,
with approximately $260 billion in sales by franchised and independent dealers
and the balance in privately negotiated transactions. From 1992 to 1996, new
vehicles sales have grown at an annual compound rate of 10.5%, while used
vehicle sales have grown at a rate of 15.8% for retail used vehicle sales and
6.7% for wholesale used vehicle sales. This significant increase in sales
revenue is primarily because the average price of a new vehicle has risen at a
compound average rate of 6.2% from 1992 to 1996 and newer, high-quality used
vehicles now comprise a larger part of the used vehicle market. During this
period, unit sales grew at rates of only 4.0% for new vehicles, 6.4% for retail
used vehicles and 1.4% for wholesale used vehicles. For the six months ended
June 30, 1997, industry retail sales were down 2% as a result of retail car
sales declines of 5.3% and retail truck sales gains of 2.4% from the same period
in 1996.
     The following table sets forth information regarding vehicle sales by new
vehicle dealerships for the periods indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           United States New Vehicle Dealers' Vehicle Sales
                                                                                                 (1)
                                                                          --------------------------------------------------
                                                                           1992       1993       1994       1995       1996
                                                                          ------     ------     ------     ------     ------
<S>                                                                       <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
                                                                               (Units in millions; dollars in billions)
New vehicle unit sales.................................................     12.9       13.9       15.1       14.7       15.1
New vehicle sales (2)..................................................   $220.3     $253.3     $289.1     $301.2     $328.4
Used vehicle unit sales-retail.........................................      9.3        9.9       10.9       11.5       11.9
Used vehicle sales-retail (2)..........................................   $ 77.1     $ 90.7     $110.6     $126.9     $137.9
Used vehicle unit sales-wholesale......................................      6.9        6.4        6.9        7.0        7.3
Used vehicle sales -- wholesale (2)....................................   $ 26.2(3)  $ 24.3     $ 27.9     $ 30.4     $ 33.9
Total vehicle sales....................................................   $323.6     $368.3     $427.6     $458.5     $500.2
Annual growth in total vehicle sales...................................       --       13.8%      16.1%       7.2%       9.1%
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Reflects new vehicle dealership sales at retail and wholesale. In addition,
    sales by independent retail used vehicle dealers were approximately $81,
    $100, $134, $130 and $122 billion, respectively, and casual used car sales
    were estimated at approximately $36, $33, $40, $52 and $51 billion,
    respectively, for each of the five years ended December 31, 1996.
(2) Sales figures are calculated by multiplying unit sales by the average sales
    price for the year.
(3) The NADA did not report the averages sales price for wholesale transactions
    prior to 1993. As a result, the 1992 wholesale used vehicle sales were
    calculated using the 1993 average wholesale price for used vehicles.
     In addition to new and used vehicles, dealerships offer a wide range of
other products and services, including repair and warranty work, replacement
parts, extended warranty coverage, financing and credit insurance. In 1996, the
average dealership's revenue consisted of 57.7% new vehicles sales, 30.4% used
vehicle sales, and 11.9% other products and services. As a result of intense
competition for new vehicle sales, the average dealership generates the majority
of its profits from the sale of used vehicles and other products and services,
including finance and insurance, mechanical and collision repair, and parts and
                                       46
 
<PAGE>
service. In 1996, for example, a used vehicle earned an average gross margin of
11.0% as compared to a new vehicle's average gross margin of 6.4%, in each case
for sales by new vehicle dealerships. As is typical in the retailing industry,
dealership profitability varies widely across different stores and, ultimately,
profitability depends on effective management of inventory, competition,
marketing, quality control and, most importantly, responsiveness to the
customer.
     New Vehicle Sales. Franchised dealerships were originally established by
automobile manufacturers for the distribution of their new vehicles. In return
for exclusive distribution rights within specified territories, manufacturers
exerted significant influence over their dealers by limiting the transferability
of ownership in dealerships, designating the dealerships location, and managing
the supply and composition of the dealership's inventory. These arrangements
resulted in the proliferation of small, single-owner operations that, at their
peak in the late 1940's, totaled almost 50,000. As a result of competitive,
economic and political pressures during the 1970's and 1980's, significant
changes and consolidation occurred in the automotive retail industry. One of the
most significant changes was the increased penetration by foreign manufacturers
and the resulting loss of market share by domestic car makers, which forced many
dealerships to close or sell to better-capitalized dealership groups. According
to industry data, the number of franchised dealerships has declined from
approximately 25,000 dealerships in 1990 to approximately 22,000 in 1996.
Although significant consolidation has taken place since the automotive
retailing industry's inception, the industry today remains highly fragmented,
with the largest 100 dealer groups generating less than 10% of total sales
revenues and controlling less than 5% of all franchised dealerships.
     Used Vehicle Sales. Sales of used vehicles have increased over the past
five years, primarily as a result of the substantial increase in new vehicle
prices and the greater availability of newer used vehicles due to the increased
popularity of short-term leases. Like the new vehicle market, the used vehicle
market is highly fragmented, with approximately 22,000 new vehicle dealers
accounting for approximately $172 billion in 1996 sales. In addition, an even
greater number of independent used car dealers accounted for approximately $122
billion in 1996 sales. Privately negotiated transactions accounted for the
remaining 1996 sales, estimated at $51 billion. In addition, an increasing
number of used vehicles are being sold by "superstore" outlets, which market
only used vehicles and offer a wide selection of low mileage, popular models. In
1996, the top 100 new vehicle dealer groups accounted for less than 2% of used
vehicle sales.
     Industry Consolidation. The Company believes that further consolidation is
likely due to increased capital requirements of dealerships, the limited number
of viable alternative exit strategies for dealership owners, and the desire of
certain manufacturers to strengthen their brand identity by consolidating their
franchised dealerships. The Company also believes that an opportunity exists for
dealership groups with significant equity capital, and experience in
identifying, acquiring and professionally managing dealerships, to acquire
additional dealerships for cash, stock, debt or a combination thereof. Publicly
owned dealer groups, such as the Company, are able to offer prospective sellers
tax advantaged transactions through the use of publicly traded stock which may,
in certain circumstances, make them more attractive to prospective sellers.
Dealership Operations
     Upon completion of the Reorganization and the Acquisitions, the Company
will own eight dealership franchises in the Charlotte market, ten dealership
franchises in the Chattanooga market, two dealership franchises in the Nashville
market, one dealership franchise in the Houston market, one dealership franchise
in the Tampa-Clearwater market and one dealership franchise in the Atlanta
market.
     The following table sets forth, for each of those areas, information
relating to the Company's pro forma performance for the year ended December 31,
1996 and the six months ended June 30, 1997:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    Nashville/                   Tampa/
                                                       Charlotte    Chattanooga    Houston     Clearwater    Atlanta
                                                        Market        Market        Market       Market      Market      Total
                                                       ---------    -----------    --------    ----------    -------    --------
<S>                                                    <C>          <C>            <C>         <C>           <C>        <C>
                                                                                    (in thousands)
Year ended December 31, 1996 sales:
New vehicles........................................   $ 229,181     $  98,777     $ 83,763     $ 88,844     $39,940    $540,505
Used vehicles.......................................     105,034        45,400       33,403       42,982      20,931     247,750
Parts, service and collision repair.................      33,260        17,338       18,927       14,224      11,163      94,912
Finance and insurance...............................       7,397         2,877        3,338        2,317         542      16,471
                                                       ---------    -----------    --------    ----------    -------    --------
  Total.............................................   $ 374,872     $ 164,392     $139,431     $148,367     $72,576    $899,638
                                                       ---------    -----------    --------    ----------    -------    --------
                                                       ---------    -----------    --------    ----------    -------    --------
Six months ended June 30, 1997 sales:
New vehicles........................................   $ 123,130     $  40,938     $ 55,902     $ 45,577     $19,596    $285,143
Used vehicles.......................................      57,978        26,281       17,865       19,580      11,777     133,481
Parts, service and collision repair.................      17,865         9,694       10,363        5,999       5,960      49,881
Finance and insurance...............................       4,464         1,539        2,249        1,029         129       9,410
                                                       ---------    -----------    --------    ----------    -------    --------
  Total.............................................   $ 203,437     $  78,452     $ 86,379     $ 72,185     $37,462    $477,915
                                                       ---------    -----------    --------    ----------    -------    --------
                                                       ---------    -----------    --------    ----------    -------    --------
</TABLE>
 
                                       47
 
<PAGE>
     Since 1990 the Company has grown significantly, as a result of the
acquisition and integration of new vehicle dealerships and an increase in
revenues at its existing dealerships. The following table sets forth the name,
brands, year of acquisition and location of the dealerships acquired by or
awarded to the Company or one of the Bowers Dealerships since 1990:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                              Year
                                                                                            Acquired             Location
                                                                                            --------           ------------
<S>                                                                                         <C>                <C>
Dealership and brands currently represented
Sonic Automotive
Town & Country Toyota.............................................................            1990             Charlotte
Fort Mill Ford....................................................................            1996             Charlotte
Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge.................................................            1997             Charlotte
Lake Norman Dodge.................................................................            1997             Charlotte
Lake Norman Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle..........................................            1997             Charlotte
Williams Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep...................................................            1997             Charlotte
Ken Marks Ford....................................................................            1997             Tampa/
                                                                                                               Clearwater
Bowers Dealerships
Infiniti of Chattanooga...........................................................            1992             Chattanooga
Nelson Bowers Ford................................................................            1993             Chattanooga
Cleveland Village Honda...........................................................            1994             Chattanooga
Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle............................................            1994             Chattanooga
Jaguar of Chattanooga (awarded franchise).........................................            1995             Chattanooga
European Motors of Nashville
  "BMW, Volkswagen"...............................................................            1996             Nashville
European Motors
  "BMW, Volvo"....................................................................            1996             Chattanooga
Nelson Bowers Dodge...............................................................            1997             Chattanooga
KIA -- VW of Chattanooga (awarded franchise)......................................            1997             Chattanooga
</TABLE>
 
Dealership Management
     Operations of the dealerships are overseen by Regional Vice Presidents, who
report to the Company's Chief Operating Officer. Each of the Company's
dealerships is managed by an Executive Manager who is responsible for the
operations of the dealership and the dealership's financial and customer
satisfaction performance. The Executive Manager is responsible for selecting,
training and retaining dealership personnel. All Executive Managers report to
the Company's senior management on a regular basis and prepare a comprehensive
monthly financial and operating statement of their dealership. In addition, the
Company's senior management meets on a monthly basis with its Executive Managers
to address changing customer preferences, operational concerns and to share best
practices, such as maintaining a customer-friendly buying environment,
maximizing potential revenues per new vehicle sale through increased F&I
penetration, using customer calling and coupon programs to attract and retain
service customers, and continued training of dealership personnel.
     Each Executive Manager is complemented by a team which includes two senior
managers that aid in the operation of the dealership. The General Sales Manager
is primarily responsible for the operations, personnel, financial performance
and customer satisfaction performance of the new vehicle sales, used vehicle
sales, and finance and insurance departments. The Parts and Service Director is
primarily responsible for the operations, personnel, financial and customer
satisfaction performance of the service, parts and collision repair departments
(if applicable). Each of the departments of the dealership typically has a
manager who reports to the General Sales Manager or Parts and Service Director.
     After the Acquisitions, the Company's Regional Vice Presidents will be as
listed, with their region of responsibility and age, on the following table:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Name                       Age     Region of Responsibility
- ------------------        ------   ---------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                       <C>      <C>
Ken Marks, Jr.                35   Florida
Jeffrey C. Rachor             35   Mid-South (Tennessee, Georgia, Kentucky and Alabama)
Ivan A. Tufty                 57   Texas
William Sullivan              65   North Carolina and South Carolina
</TABLE>
 
New Vehicle Sales
     The Company sells 15 brands of cars, light trucks and sport utility
vehicles. The products have a broad range of prices from lower priced, or
economy vehicles, to luxury vehicles. The Company believes that its brand,
product and price diversity
                                       48
 
<PAGE>
reduces the risk of changes in customer preferences, product supply shortages
and aging products. Sales of new vehicles in 1996 were approximately 41% cars
and 59% trucks. Approximately 13% of sales in 1996 were luxury brands (BMW,
Cadillac, Infiniti, Jaguar and Volvo). See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on
Automobile Manufacturers."
     The following table sets forth, by vehicle brand, information relating to
the Company's and the dealerships being acquired pursuant to the Acquisitions
new vehicle sales for 1996 and the first six months of 1997:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      New Vehicle Sales
                                                                         -------------------------------------------
                                                                                                         Six Months
                                                                                                            Ended
                                                                                  Year Ended              June 30,
                                                                            December 31, 1996 (1)         1997 (1)
                                                                         ----------------------------    -----------
                                                                                        Percentage of
                                                                         New Vehicle     New Vehicle     New Vehicle
                                                                          Revenues        Revenues        Revenues
                                                                         -----------    -------------    -----------
<S>                                                                      <C>            <C>              <C>
                                                                               (revenue amounts in thousands)
Vehicle Brand/Manufacturer
BMW...................................................................    $  10,838            2.2%       $  13,993
Cadillac..............................................................        2,029            0.4%             770
Chrysler/Dodge/Plymouth/Jeep/Eagle....................................       88,951           17.9%          50,935
Ford..................................................................      297,169           59.9%         164,768
Honda.................................................................       11,599            2.3%           4,992
Infiniti..............................................................        6,618            1.3%           3,247
Jaguar................................................................        2,296            0.5%           1,405
KIA...................................................................           --             --              685
Oldsmobile............................................................        2,212            0.4%           1,055
Toyota................................................................       30,520            6.2%          19,246
Volvo.................................................................       43,060            8.7%          21,478
Volkswagen............................................................          732            0.2%             257
                                                                         -----------    -------------    -----------
  Total...............................................................    $ 496,024          100.0%       $ 282,831
                                                                         -----------    -------------    -----------
                                                                         -----------    -------------    -----------
<CAPTION>
 
                                                                        Percentage of
                                                                         New Vehicle
                                                                          Revenues
                                                                        -------------
<S>                                                                      <C>
 
Vehicle Brand/Manufacturer
BMW...................................................................         4.9%
Cadillac..............................................................         0.3%
Chrysler/Dodge/Plymouth/Jeep/Eagle....................................        18.0%
Ford..................................................................        58.3%
Honda.................................................................         1.8%
Infiniti..............................................................         1.1%
Jaguar................................................................         0.5%
KIA...................................................................         0.2%
Oldsmobile............................................................         0.4%
Toyota................................................................         6.8%
Volvo.................................................................         7.6%
Volkswagen............................................................         0.1%
                                                                        -------------
  Total...............................................................       100.0%
                                                                        -------------
                                                                        -------------
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Does not include Nelson Bowers Dodge which was purchased on March 1, 1997
    and KIA-VW of Chattanooga which was purchased in April 1997. European Motors
    of Nashville and European Motors were purchased in October 1996 and May
    1996, respectively, and information for such dealerships is included from
    their purchase dates through December 1996.
     The Company seeks to provide customer oriented service and build lasting
customer relationships that will result in repeat and referral business. Sales
techniques and processes vary depending on the product line and local market
conditions. All of the Company's dealerships use computer technology for
prospecting and customer follow-up and extensively train sales staff to meet the
needs of customers. Certain of the dealerships use computer kiosks to allow
customers to browse vehicle inventories at their leisure. Depending on brand and
local market, dealerships may use "greeters" rather than sales people to
initially assist customers entering a dealership.
     Substantially all of the Company's new vehicles are acquired from
Manufacturers. Allocation of vehicle inventory from Manufacturers is based
primarily on sales volume and input from dealers. Vehicle purchases are financed
through revolving credit facilities known in the industry as floor plan lending.
     The following table presents information with respect to the Company's new
vehicle sales:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                   Sonic Dealerships
                                                 Sonic Dealerships                                --------------------
                      ------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                    Six Months Ended
                                              Year Ended December 31,                                   June 30,
                      ------------------------------------------------------------------------    --------------------
                                                                                   Pro Forma
                                                                                    for the
                                               Actual                             Acquisitions           Actual
                      --------------------------------------------------------    ------------    --------------------
                        1992        1993        1994        1995        1996          1996          1996        1997
                      --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    ------------    --------    --------
<S>                   <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>             <C>         <C>
                                                  (in thousands, except vehicle unit data)
Unit sales............    8,060      9,429       9,686      10,273      11,693        24,206         6,027       6,553
Sales revenue......... $126,230   $152,525    $164,361    $186,517    $233,146      $540,505      $115,721    $137,069
Gross profit.......... $  8,513   $ 10,474    $ 11,494    $ 13,584    $ 17,169      $ 40,221      $  7,672    $  8,893
Gross profit margin...      6.7%       6.9%        7.0%        7.3%        7.4%          7.4%          6.6%        6.5%
<CAPTION>
 
                         Pro Forma
                          for the
                        Acquisitions
                        ------------
                            1997
                        ------------
<S>                      <C>
 
Unit sales............      12,596
Sales revenue.........    $285,143
Gross profit..........    $ 20,749
Gross profit margin...         7.3%
</TABLE>
 
     New vehicle sales include retail lease transactions and lease-type
transactions, both of which are arranged by the Company. New vehicle leases
generally have short terms. Lease customers, therefore, return to the new
vehicle market more
                                       49
 
<PAGE>
frequently. Leases also provide a source of late-model, generally low mileage,
vehicles for its used vehicle inventory. Generally, leased vehicles are under
warranty for the entire lease term, which allows the Company to provide repair
service to the lessee throughout the term of the lease.
Used Vehicle Sales
     The Company sells a broad variety of makes and models of used cars, vans,
trucks and sport utility vehicles. On a pro forma basis in 1996, the Company
sold 9,281 used car and 4,194 used truck (including sport utility vehicles)
units. Used vehicle retail sales for 1996 represented 35.8% of pro forma total
retail unit sales.
     Used vehicles are obtained by the Company through customer trade-ins, at
"closed" auctions which may be attended only by new vehicle dealers and which
offer off-lease, rental and fleet vehicles, and at "open" auctions which offer
repossessed vehicles and vehicles sold by other dealers. The Company sells its
used vehicles to retail customers and, in the case of vehicles in poor condition
or vehicles which remain unsold for a specified period of time, to other dealers
or wholesalers. Sales to other dealers or wholesalers are frequently close to or
below cost and therefore negatively affect the Company's gross margin on used
vehicle sales.
     The Company emphasizes retail sales of used vehicles in order to offer a
wider variety of vehicles and to benefit from the higher gross margins from used
vehicle sales. To improve the marketability of used vehicles the Company employs
both manufacturer supported and in-house used car certification programs and
sale of extended warranties on used vehicles. At certain locations, the Company
provides a five day money back guarantee on the sale of all used vehicles. The
Company intends to expand this guarantee program to all locations.
     After the Acquisitions, the Company will operate four standalone used car
facilities. As the Company enters new markets and gains market share in existing
markets, the Company intends to expand its standalone used car facilities to
take advantage of the high quality sources of vehicles available to new vehicle
retailers.
     The following table sets forth information on the Company's used vehicle
sales:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                     Sonic Dealerships
                                                       Sonic Dealerships                             ------------------
                              -------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                      Six Months Ended
                                                    Year Ended December 31,                               June 30,
                              -------------------------------------------------------------------    ------------------
                                                                                      Pro Forma
                                                                                       for the
                                                    Actual                           Acquisitions          Actual
                              ---------------------------------------------------    ------------    ------------------
                               1992       1993       1994       1995       1996          1996         1996       1997
                              -------    -------    -------    -------    -------    ------------    -------    -------
<S>                           <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>             <C>        <C>
                                                      (in thousands, except vehicle unit data)
Retail unit sales..........     3,892      4,104      4,374      5,172      5,488        13,475        2,836      2,638
Retail sales revenue.......   $33,636    $37,742    $47,537    $60,766    $68,054      $181,787      $35,200    $32,666
Retail gross profit........     3,610      3,964      5,182      5,792      5,748        16,762        2,968      2,772
Retail gross margin........      10.7%      10.5%      10.9%       9.5%       8.4%          9.2%         8.4%       8.5%
Wholesale unit sales.......     3,756      4,189      4,656      5,009      5,344        12,385        2,751      2,750
Wholesale sales revenue....   $11,199    $13,363    $16,062    $20,025    $25,642      $ 65,963      $13,412    $15,342
Wholesale gross profit.....        16         27         43       (45)        (23)          (52)         (12)      (145)
Wholesale gross margin.....       0.1%       0.2%       0.3%     (0.2)%      (0.1)%        (0.1)%       (0.1)%     (0.9)%
Total unit sales...........     7,648      8,293      9,030     10,181     10,832        25,860        5,587      5,388
Total revenue..............   $44,835    $51,105    $63,599    $80,791    $93,696      $247,750      $48,612    $48,008
Total gross profit.........     3,626      3,991      5,225      5,747      5,725        16,710        2,956      2,627
Total gross margin.........       8.1%       7.8%       8.2%       7.1%       6.1%          6.7%         6.1%       5.5%
<CAPTION>
 
                               Pro Forma
                                for the
                             Acquisitions
                             -------------
                                 1997
                             -------------
<S>                           <C>
 
Retail unit sales..........        7,043
Retail sales revenue.......    $  96,249
Retail gross profit........        8,521
Retail gross margin........          8.9%
Wholesale unit sales.......        6,513
Wholesale sales revenue....    $  37,232
Wholesale gross profit.....          (34)
Wholesale gross margin.....          0.1%
Total unit sales...........       13,556
Total revenue..............    $ 133,481
Total gross profit.........        8,487
Total gross margin.........          6.4%
</TABLE>
 
Service and Part Sales
     The Company provides service and parts at each of its franchised
dealerships. The Company provides maintenance and repair services at its 19 new
vehicle dealership facilities and three used vehicle facilities. The Company
utilizes approximately 400 service bays in providing both warranty and
non-warranty services. Service and parts sales provide higher gross margins than
vehicle sales. On a pro forma basis in 1996, the Company's service and parts
operations generated $85.9 million in revenues and $35.1 million in gross
profit, representing 9.6% and 31.0% of total revenues and gross profit,
respectively.
     Historically, the automotive repair industry has been highly fragmented.
However, the Company believes the increased use of advanced technology in
vehicles has made it difficult for independent repair shops to perform major or
technical repairs. Additionally, manufacturers permit warranty work to be
performed only at franchised dealerships. Given the increasing technological
complexity of motor vehicles and the trend to long term warranties, the Company
believes an increasing percentage of repair work will be performed at franchised
dealerships.
                                       50
 
<PAGE>
     The Company regards its service operations as an integral part of its
overall approach to customer service. Vehicle service provides additional
opportunities to build long-term customer relationships. The Company uses
customer calling, coupon programs and other techniques to attract and retain
service customers. Although individual dealerships vary based on markets and
brands, many Company dealerships use service "teams" and variable rate or "menu"
pricing structures to improve customer satisfaction with repair service.
     Sales of factory authorized equipment and parts to wholesale customers are
an integral component of parts operations at certain of the Company's
dealerships. For example, the Company's Lone Star Ford dealership sold
approximately $9.3 million in wholesale parts in 1996. The Company plans to
capitalize on its representation of numerous manufacturers and its experience as
a wholesale parts distributor in order to increase sales of factory authorized
equipment and parts to wholesale customers.
     The following table sets forth information regarding the Company's service
and parts sales:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                     Sonic Dealerships
                                                       Sonic Dealerships                             ------------------
                              -------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                      Six Months Ended
                                                    Year Ended December 31,                               June 30,
                              -------------------------------------------------------------------    ------------------
                                                                                      Pro Forma
                                                                                       for the
                                                    Actual                           Acquisitions          Actual
                              ---------------------------------------------------    ------------    ------------------
                               1992       1993       1994       1995       1996          1996         1996       1997
                              -------    -------    -------    -------    -------    ------------    -------    -------
<S>                           <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>             <C>        <C>
                                                                   (In thousands)
Sales revenue..............   $21,778    $27,243    $30,298    $31,957    $37,702      $ 85,958      $18,607    $20,220
Gross profit...............     7,540      9,540     10,344     11,003     13,106        35,142        6,317      6,822
Gross profit margin........      34.6%      35.0%      34.1%      34.4%      34.8%         40.9%        33.9%      33.7%
<CAPTION>
 
                              Pro Forma
                               for the
                             Acquisitions
                             ------------
                                 1997
                             ------------
<S>                           <C>
 
Sales revenue..............    $ 44,649
Gross profit...............      18,494
Gross profit margin........        41.4%
</TABLE>
 
Collision Repair
     The Company operates collision repair centers, or body shops, at seven of
its dealership locations. In 1996, collision repair accounted for $8.9 million,
or 1.0%, of the Company's pro forma revenues and 4.4% of the Company's gross
profit. The Company's collision repair business provides favorable margins and,
similar to service and parts, is not significantly affected by business cycles
or consumer preferences. In addition, because of the higher cost of used
vehicles, insurance adjusters are more hesitant to declare a vehicle a total
loss, resulting in more significant, and higher cost, repair jobs. The Company
believes that, because of the high capital investment required for collision
repair shops and the cost of complying with governmental regulations, large
volume body shops will be more successful in the future than smaller volume
shops. The Company believes the collision repair business will consolidate and
that it will be able to capitalize on this consolidation.
     The following table sets forth information regarding the Company's
collision repair operations:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                             Sonic
                                                                                                          Dealerships
                                                            Sonic Dealerships                           ----------------
                                      --------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                        Six Months Ended
                                                         Year Ended December 31,                            June 30,
                                      --------------------------------------------------------------    ----------------
                                                                                         Pro Forma
                                                                                          for the
                                                          Actual                        Acquisitions         Actual
                                      ----------------------------------------------    ------------    ----------------
                                       1992      1993      1994      1995      1996         1996         1996      1997
                                      ------    ------    ------    ------    ------    ------------    ------    ------
<S>                                   <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>             <C>       <C>
                                                                        (In thousands)
Sales revenue......................   $2,765    $3,094    $3,686    $3,903    $4,942       $8,954       $2,398    $2,686
Gross profit.......................    1,378     1,516     1,870     1,956     2,452        4,993        1,201     1,284
Gross profit margin................     49.8%     49.0%     50.7%     50.1%     49.6%        55.8%        50.1%     47.8%
<CAPTION>
 
                                      Pro Forma
                                       for the
                                     Acquisitions
                                     ------------
                                         1997
                                     ------------
<S>                                   <C>
 
Sales revenue......................     $5,232
Gross profit.......................      2,628
Gross profit margin................       50.2%
</TABLE>
 
Finance and Insurance
     The Company offers its customers a wide range of financing and leasing
alternatives for the purchase of vehicles. In addition, as part of each sale,
the Company offers customers credit life, accident and health and disability
insurance to cover the financing cost of their vehicle, as well as warranty or
extended service contracts. The Company's pro forma revenue from financing,
insurance and extended warranty transactions was $16.5 million in 1996 and $9.4
million for the six months ended June 30, 1997.
     The Company believes that its customers' ability to obtain financing at its
dealerships significantly enhances the Company's ability to sell new and used
vehicles. The Company provides a variety of financing and leasing alternatives
in order to meet the specific needs of each potential customer. The Company
believes its ability to obtain customer-tailored financing on a "same day" basis
provides it with an advantage over many of its competitors, particularly smaller
competitors which do not generate sufficient volume to attract the diversity of
financing sources that are available to the Company. The dealership will then be
able to provide a customer with a broader array of lease payment alternatives
and, consequently, appeal to a term buyer who is trying to purchase a vehicle of
choice at or below a specific monthly payment. During 1996, the Company arranged
for financing for approximately 44.0% of its new vehicle sales and 53.1% of its
used vehicle sales.
                                       51
 
<PAGE>
     The Company assigns its vehicle financing contracts and leases to other
parties, instead of directly financing sales, which reduces the Company's
exposure to loss from financing activities. The Company receives a commission
from the lender for originating and assigning the loan or lease but is assessed
a chargeback fee by the lender if a loan is canceled, in most cases, within 120
days of making the loan. Early cancellation can result from early repayment
because of refinancing of the loan, the sale or trade-in of the vehicle, or
default on the loan. The Company establishes an allowance to absorb estimated
chargebacks and refunds. The Company believes that its high volume of business
makes the Company's retail contracts more attractive to lenders, which may
enable the Company to negotiate higher commission rates in contrast to lower
volume dealerships.
     In addition to its financing activities, the Company offers extended
service contracts in connection with the sale of new and used vehicles. Extended
service contracts on new vehicles supplement the warranties offered by the
vehicle manufacturer, and on used vehicles, such contracts supplement any
remaining manufacturer warranty or serve as the primary service contract on the
vehicle. The extended service contracts sold by the Company are issued by
third-party insurers that pay the Company a commission upon sale of the
contract. In 1996, the Company sold extended service contracts on 24.0% and
36.1% respectively, of its new and used retail vehicle sales. The Company also
offers its customers credit life, health and accident insurance when they
finance an automobile purchase, and receives a commission on each policy sold.
Sales and Marketing
     The Company's marketing and advertising activities vary among its
dealerships and among its markets. The Company advertises primarily through
television, newspapers, radio and direct mail and regularly conducts special
promotions designed to focus vehicle buyers on its product offerings. The
Company intends to continue tailoring its marketing efforts to the relevant
marketplace in order to reach the Company's targeted customer base. The Company
also has computer technology to aid sales people in prospecting for customers.
Under arrangements with manufacturers, the Company receives a subsidy for a
portion of its advertising expenses incurred in connection with a manufacturer's
vehicles. Because of the Company's leading market presence in certain markets,
the Company believes it has been able to realize cost savings on its advertising
expenses due to volume discounts and other concessions from media. The Company
also believes its consolidated marketing campaigns within particular markets
result in enhanced name recognition and sales volume when compared with smaller
competitors in the same market.
Relationships with Manufacturers
     Each of the Company's dealerships operates under a separate franchise or
dealer agreement (a "Dealer Agreement") which governs the relationship between
the dealership and the Manufacturer. In general, each Dealer Agreement specifies
the location of the dealership for the sale of vehicles and for the performance
of certain approved services in a specified market area. The designation of such
areas generally does not guarantee exclusivity within a specified territory. In
addition, most Manufacturers allocate vehicles on a "turn and earn" basis which
rewards high volume. A Dealer Agreement requires the dealer to meet specified
standards regarding showrooms, the facilities and equipment for servicing
vehicles, inventories, minimum net working capital, personnel training, and
other aspects of the business. The Dealer Agreement with each dealership also
gives each Manufacturer the right to approve the dealership's general manager
and any material change in management or ownership of the dealership. Each
Manufacturer may terminate a Dealer Agreement under certain circumstances, such
as a change in control of the dealership without Manufacturer approval, the
impairment of the reputation or financial condition of the dealership, the
death, removal or withdrawal of the dealership's general manager, the conviction
of the dealership or the dealership's owner or general manager of certain
crimes, a failure to adequately operate the dealership or maintain wholesale
financing arrangements, insolvency or bankruptcy of the dealership or a material
breach of other provisions of the Dealer Agreement. In connection with the
Offering, the Company is amending its Dealer Agreements or otherwise obtaining
consents from Manufacturers to revise those provisions which would have
prohibited the Company from selling its Common Stock to the public. See
"Description of Capital Stock -- Delaware Law, Certain Charter and Bylaw
Provisions and Certain Franchise Agreement Provisions."
     Many automobile manufacturers are still developing their policies regarding
public ownership of dealerships. The Company believes that these policies will
continue to change as more dealership groups sell their stock to the public, and
as the established, publicly-owned dealership groups acquire more franchises. To
the extent that new or amended manufacturer policies restrict the number of
dealerships which may be owned by a dealership group, or the transferability of
the Company's Common Stock, such policies could have a material adverse effect
on the Company. See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on Automobile Manufacturers,"
" -- Manufacturers' Restrictions on Acquisitions," " -- Stock Ownership/Issuance
Limits; Limitation on Ability to Issue Additional Equity" and " -- Concentration
of Voting Power and Anti-Takeover Provisions."
                                       52
 
<PAGE>
     The Company's Dealer Agreement with Ford requires the Company to deliver to
Ford all Securities and Exchange Commission filings made by the Company or
third-parties with respect to the Company, including Schedules 13D and 13G. If
any such filing shows that (a) any person or entity would acquire 15% or more of
Sonic's voting securities, (b) any person or entity that owns or controls 15% or
more of Sonic's voting securities (or other securities convertible into such
voting securities) intends or may intend to acquire additional voting securities
of Sonic, (c) an extraordinary corporate transaction, such as a merger or
liquidation, involving Sonic or any of its subsidiaries is anticipated, (d) a
material asset sale involving Sonic or any of its subsidiaries is anticipated,
(e) a change in Sonic's Board of Directors or management is planned or has
occurred, or (f) any other material change in Sonic's business or corporate
structure is planned or has occurred, then the Company must give Ford notice of
such event. If Ford reasonably determines that such an event is not in its
interest, the Company may be required to sell or resign from one or more of its
Ford franchises. Should Sonic or any of its Ford franchisee subsidiaries enter
into an agreement to transfer the assets of a Ford franchisee subsidiary to a
third party, the right of first refusal described in the Ford Dealer Agreement
will apply.
     Under the Company's Dealer Agreements with Toyota and Infiniti, Toyota and
Infiniti have the right to approve any ownership or voting rights of Sonic of
20% or greater by any individual or entity. Honda may force the sale of the
Company's Honda franchise if any person or entity, other than members of the
Smith Group, acquires 5% or greater of the Common Stock (10% or greater if such
entity is an institutional investor), and Honda deems such person or entity to
be unsatisfactory. Volkswagen has approved the sale of no more than 25% of the
voting control of Sonic in the Offering, and any future changes in ownership or
transfers among the Company's current stockholders that could effect the voting
or managerial control of Sonic's Volkswagen franchisee subsidiaries requires the
prior approval of Volkswagen. Similarly, Chrysler has approved of the public
sale of only 50% of the Common Stock and requires prior approval of any future
sales that would result in a change in voting or managerial control of the
Company. Moreover, Honda's approval of the Offering is subject to the Smith
Group plus Nelson Bowers owning 51% of the shares of Common Stock on a
fully-diluted basis. Upon consummation of the Offering, 48.9% of the Common
Stock (on a fully-diluted basis after giving effect to the options to be issued
at the time of the Offering under the Stock Option Plan), will be owned by
persons other than the Smith Group or Nelson Bowers (assuming full exercise of
the Underwriters' over-allotment option).
     Under the Company's Dealer Agreement with General Motors ("GM"), the
Company has agreed, among other things, to disclose the following provisions:
          Sonic will deliver to GM copies of all Schedules 13D and 13G, and all
     amendments thereto and terminations thereof, received by Sonic, within five
     days of receipt of such Schedules. If Sonic is aware of any ownership of
     its stock that should have been reported to it on Schedule 13D but that is
     not reported in a timely manner, it will promptly give GM written notice of
     such ownership, with any relevant information about the owner that Sonic
     possesses.
          If Sonic, through its Board of Directors or through shareholder
     action, proposes or if any person, entity or group sends Sonic a Schedule
     13D, or any amendments thereto, disclosing (a) an agreement to acquire or
     the acquisition of aggregate ownership of more than 20% of the voting stock
     of Sonic and (b) Sonic, through its Board of Directors or through
     shareholder action, proposes or if any plans or proposals which relate to
     or would result in the following: (i) the acquisition by any person of more
     than 20% of the voting stock of Sonic other than for the purposes of
     ordinary passive investment; (ii) an extraordinary corporate transaction,
     such as a material merger, reorganization or liquidation, involving Sonic
     or a sale or transfer of a material amount of assets of Sonic and its
     subsidiaries; (iii) any change which, together with any changes made to the
     Board of Directors within the preceding year, would result in a change in
     control of the then current Board of Sonic; or (iv) in the case of an
     entity that produces motor vehicles or controls or is controlled by or is
     under common control with an entity that either produces motor vehicles or
     is a motor vehicle franchisor, the acquisition by any person, entity or
     group of more than 20% of the voting stock of Sonic and any proposal by any
     such person, entity or group, through the Sonic Board of Directors or
     shareholders action, to change the Board of Directors of Sonic, then, if
     such actions in GM's business judgment could have a material or adverse
     effect on its image or reputation in the GM dealerships operated by Sonic
     or be materially incompatible with GM's interests (and upon notice of GM's
     reasons for such judgment), Sonic has agreed that it will take one of the
     remedial actions set forth in the next paragraph within 90 days of
     receiving such Schedule 13D or such amendment.
          If Sonic is obligated under the previous paragraph to take remedial
     action, it will (a) transfer to GM or its designee, and GM or its designee
     will acquire the assets, properties or business associated with any GM
     dealership operated by Sonic at fair market value as determined in
     accordance with GM's Dealership Agreement with the Company, or (b) provide
     evidence to GM that such person, entity or group no longer has such
     threshold level of ownership interest in Sonic or that the actions
     described in clause (b) of the previous paragraph will not occur.
                                       53
 
<PAGE>
          Should Sonic or its GM franchisee subsidiary enter into an agreement
     to transfer the assets of the GM franchisee subsidiary to a third party,
     the right of first refusal described in the GM Dealer Agreement shall apply
     to any such transfer.
     Certain state statutes in Florida and other states limit manufacturers'
control over dealerships. Under Florida law, notwithstanding any contrary terms
in a dealer agreement, manufacturers may not unreasonably withhold approval for
the sale of a dealership. Acceptable grounds for disapproval include material
shortcomings in the character, financial condition or business experience of the
proposed transferee. In addition, dealerships may challenge manufacturers'
attempts to establish new dealerships in the dealer's markets, and state
regulators may deny applications to establish new dealerships for a number of
reasons, including a determination that the manufacturer is adequately
represented in the area. Manufacturers must have "good cause" for any
termination or failure to renew a dealer agreement, and an automaker's license
to distribute vehicles in Florida may be revoked if, among other things, the
automaker has forced or attempted to force an automobile dealer to accept
delivery of motor vehicles not ordered by that dealer.
     Under Texas law, despite the terms of contracts between manufacturers and
dealers, manufacturers may not unreasonably withhold approval of a transfer of a
dealership. It is unreasonable under Texas law for a manufacturer to reject a
prospective transferee of a dealership who is of good moral character and who
otherwise meets the manufacturer's written, reasonable and uniformly applied
standards or qualifications relating to the prospective transferee's business
experience and financial qualifications. In addition, under Texas law and the
laws of other states, franchised dealerships may challenge manufacturers'
attempts to establish new franchises in the franchised dealers' markets, and
state regulators may deny applications to establish new dealerships for a number
of reasons, including a determination that the manufacturer is adequately
represented in the region. Texas law limits the ability of manufacturers to
terminate or fail to renew franchises. In addition, other laws in Texas and
elsewhere limit the ability of manufacturers to withhold their approval for the
relocation of a franchise or require that disputes be arbitrated. In addition, a
manufacturer's license to distribute vehicles in Texas may be revoked if, among
other things, the manufacturer has forced or attempted to force an automobile
dealer to accept delivery of motor vehicles not ordered by that dealer.
     Georgia law provides that no manufacturer may arbitrarily reject a proposed
change of control or sale of an automobile dealership, and any manufacturer
challenging such a transfer of a dealership must provide written reasons for its
rejection to the dealer. Manufacturers bear the burden of proof to show that any
disapproval of a proposed transfer of a dealership is not arbitrary. If a
manufacturer terminates a franchise agreement due to a proposed transfer of the
dealership or for any other reason not considered to constitute good cause under
Georgia law, such termination will be ineffective. As an alternative to
rejecting or accepting a proposed transfer of a dealership or terminating the
franchise agreement, Georgia law provides that a manufacturer may offer to
purchase the dealership on the same terms and conditions offered to the
prospective transferee.
     Under Tennessee law, a manufacturer may not modify, terminate or refuse to
renew a franchise agreement with a dealer except for good cause, as defined in
the governing Tennessee statutes. Further, a manufacturer may be denied a
Tennessee license, or have an existing license revoked or suspended if the
manufacturer modifies, terminates, or suspends a franchise agreement due to an
event not constituting good cause. Good cause includes material shortcomings in
the character, financial condition or business experience of the dealer. A
manufacturer's Tennessee license may also be revoked if the manufacturer
prevents or attempts to prevent the sale or transfer of the dealership by
unreasonably withholding consent to the transfer.
Competition
     The retail automotive industry is highly competitive. Depending on the
geographic market, the Company competes with both dealers offering the same
brands and product line as the Company and dealers offering other automakers'
vehicles. The Company also competes for vehicle sales with auto brokers and
leasing companies. The Company competes with small, local dealerships and with
large multi-franchise auto dealerships. Many of the Company's larger competitors
are larger and have greater financial and marketing resources and are more
widely known than the Company. Some of the Company's competitors also may
utilize marketing techniques, such as Internet visibility or "no negotiation"
sales methods, not currently used by the Company.
     The Company also competes with regional and national car rental companies,
which sell their used rental cars, and used automobile "superstores," such as
AutoNation and CarMax. In the future, new competitors may enter the automotive
retailing market, including automobile manufacturers (such as Ford) that may
decide to open additional retail outlets or acquire other dealerships. In
addition, the used vehicle superstores generally offer a greater and more varied
selection of vehicles than the Company's dealerships. As the Company seeks to
acquire dealerships in new markets, it may face significant competition
(including competition from other publicly-owned dealer groups) as it strives to
gain market share. See "Risk Factors -- Competition."
                                       54
 
<PAGE>
     The Company believes that the principal competitive factors in vehicle
sales are the marketing campaigns conducted by automakers, the ability of
dealerships to offer a wide selection of the most popular vehicles, the location
of dealerships and the quality of customer service. Other competitive factors
include customer preference for makes of automobiles, pricing (including
manufacturer rebates and other special offers) and warranties.
     In addition to competition for vehicle sales, the Company also competes
with other auto dealers, service stores, auto parts retailers and independent
mechanics in providing parts and service. The Company believes that the
principal competitive factors in parts and service sales are price, the use of
factory-approved replacement parts, the familiarity with a dealer's makes and
models and the quality of customer service. A number of regional and national
chains offer selected parts and service at prices that may be lower than the
Company's prices.
     In arranging or providing financing for its customers' vehicle purchases,
the Company competes with a broad range of financial institutions. The Company
believes that the principal competitive factors in providing financing are
convenience, interest rates and contract terms.
     The Company's success depends, in part, on national and regional
automobile-buying trends, local and regional economic factors and other regional
competitive pressures. The Company sells its vehicles in the Charlotte,
Chattanooga, Nashville, Tampa-Clearwater, Houston and Atlanta markets.
Conditions and competitive pressures affecting these markets, such as
price-cutting by dealers in these areas, or in any new markets the Company
enters, could adversely affect the Company, although the retail automobile
industry as a whole might not be affected. See "Risk Factors -- Competition."
Governmental Regulations and Environmental Matters
     A number of regulations affect the Company's business of marketing,
selling, financing and servicing automobiles. The Company also is subject to
laws and regulations relating to business corporations generally.
     Under North Carolina, South Carolina, Tennessee, Florida, Georgia and Texas
law as well as the laws of other states into which the Company may expand, the
Company must obtain a license in order to establish, operate or relocate a
dealership or operate an automotive repair service. These laws also regulate the
Company's conduct of business, including its advertising and sales practices.
Other states may have similar requirements.
     The Company's operations are also subject to laws governing consumer
protection. Automobile dealers and manufacturers are subject to so-called "Lemon
Laws" that require a manufacturer or the dealer to replace a new vehicle or
accept it for a full refund within one year after initial purchase if the
vehicle does not conform to the manufacturer's express warranties and the dealer
or manufacturer, after a reasonable number of attempts, is unable to correct or
repair the defect. Federal laws require certain written disclosures to be
provided on new vehicles, including mileage and pricing information.
     The imported automobiles purchased by the Company are subject to United
States customs duties and, in the ordinary course of its business, the Company
may, from time to time, be subject to claims for duties, penalties, liquidated
damages, or other charges. Currently, United States customs duties are generally
assessed at 2.5% of the customs value of the automobiles imported, as classified
pursuant to the Harmonized Tariff Schedule of the United States. See "Risk
Factors -- Imported Products."
     The Company's financing activities with its customers are subject to
federal truth-in-lending, consumer leasing and equal credit opportunity
regulations as well as state and local motor vehicle finance laws, installment
finance laws, usury laws and other installment sales laws. Some states regulate
finance fees that may be paid as a result of vehicle sales. State and federal
environmental regulations, including regulations governing air and water quality
and the storage and disposal of gasoline, oil and other materials, also apply to
the Company.
     The Company believes that it complies in all material respects with the
laws affecting its business. Possible penalties for violation of any of these
laws include revocation of the Company's licenses and fines. In addition, many
laws may give customers a private cause of action.
     As with automobile dealerships generally, and service parts and body shop
operations in particular, the Company's business involves the use, storage,
handling and contracting for recycling or disposal of hazardous or toxic
substances or wastes, including environmentally sensitive materials such as
motor oil, waste motor oil and filters, transmission fluid, antifreeze, freon,
waste paint and lacquer thinner, batteries, solvents, lubricants, degreasing
agents, gasoline and diesel fuels. The Company's business also involves the past
and current operation and/or removal of aboveground and underground storage
tanks containing such substances or wastes. Accordingly, the Company is subject
to regulation by federal, state and local authorities establishing health and
environmental quality standards, and liability related thereto, and providing
penalties for violations of those standards. The Company is also subject to
laws, ordinances and regulations governing remediation of
                                       55
 
<PAGE>
contamination at facilities it operates or to which it sends hazardous or toxic
substances or wastes for treatment, recycling or disposal.
     The Company believes that it does not have any material environmental
liabilities and that compliance with environmental laws and regulations will
not, individually or in the aggregate, have a material adverse effect on the
Company's results of operations or financial condition. However, soil and
groundwater contamination is known to exist at certain properties used by the
Company. Furthermore, environmental laws and regulations are complex and subject
to frequent change. There can be no assurance that compliance with amended, new
or more stringent laws or regulations, stricter interpretations of existing laws
or the future discovery of environmental conditions will not require additional
expenditures by the Company, or that such expenditures will not be material. See
"Risk Factors -- Adverse Effect of Government Regulation; Environmental
Regulatory Compliance Costs."
                                       56
 
<PAGE>
Facilities
     The Company's principal executive offices are located at 5401 East
Independence Boulevard, Charlotte, North Carolina 28218, and its telephone
number is (704) 532-3301. These executive offices are located on the premises
owned by Town & Country Ford. The following table identifies, for each of the
properties to be utilized by the Company's dealership operations the location,
the owner/lessor, and the term and rental rate of the Company's lease for such
property, if applicable:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                     1997
                                       Ownership                                    Monthly     Expiration
             Dealership                 Status             Owner/Lessor            Rent (2)        Date         Facility
- -------------------------------------  ---------   ----------------------------   -----------   ----------   ---------------
<S>                                    <C>         <C>                            <C>           <C>          <C>
Town & Country Ford..................  Lease       STC Properties (1)             $   34,083         2000    Main Bldg.
                                                                                                             Body Shop
  5401 East Independence Blvd.,
  Charlotte
Lone Star Ford.......................  Lease       Viking Investments (1)         $   30,000         2005    Main Bldg.
                                                                                                             Used Car Bldg.
  8477 North Freeway, Houston                                                                                Body Shop
                                                                                                             Fleet Bldg.
Fort Mill Ford.......................  Own         --                                     --           --    Main Bldg.
                                                                                                             Body Shop
  788 Gold Hill Rd., Fort Mill, SC
Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge....  Lease       Jeffrey Boyd                   $   16,667         2002    Main Bldg.
                                                                                                             Used Car Bldg.
  3310 Hwy. 51, Fort Mill, SC
Town & Country Toyota................  Own         --                                     --           --    Main Bldg.
                                                                                                             Body Shop
  9101 South Blvd., Charlotte
Frontier Oldsmobile-Cadillac.........  Lease       Landers Oldsmobile-Cadillac    $   17,000       1998(3 )  Main Bldg.
                                                                                                             Body Shop
  2501 Roosevelt Blvd., Monroe, NC                                                                           Used Car Bldg.
Ken Marks Ford.......................  Lease       Marks Holding Company (1)      $   95,000       2007(3 )  Main Bldg.
  24825 US Hwy. 19 North, Clearwater
  &
  3925 Tampa Rd., Oldsmar, FL
Dyer Volvo...........................  Lease       D&R Investments (1)            $   50,000 (4)    2009(3 ) Main Bldg.
  5260 Peachtree Industrial Blvd.,
  Atlanta
Lake Norman                            Lease       Phil M. and Quinton M. Gandy   $   40,000 (4)    2007(3 ) Main Bldg.
  Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle.......              and affiliates
  Chartwell Center Dr., Cornelius, NC
Lake Norman Dodge....................  Lease       Phil M. and Quinton M. Gandy   $   40,000 (4)    2007(3 ) Main Bldg.
                                                   and affiliates                                            Truck Center
  I-77 & Torrence Chapel Rd.,
  Cornelius, NC
KIA/VW of Chattanooga................  Lease       KIA Land Development (1)       $   11,070       2007(3 )  Main Bldg.
  6015 International Dr., Chattanooga
European Motors of Nashville.........  Lease       Third National Bank,           $   21,070       1998(3 )  Main Bldg.(6)
                                                   David P'Pool,
  630 Murfreeboro Pike, Nashville                  Stella P'Pool
European Motors......................  Lease       Nelson Bowers (1)              $   16,846 (4)    2007(3 ) Main Bldg.
  5949 Brainerd Rd., Chattanooga
Jaguar of Chattanooga................  Lease       JAG Properties LLC, Thomas     $   22,010       2017(3 )  Main Bldg.
                                                   Green, Jr. and
  5915 Brainerd Rd., Chattanooga                   Nelson Bowers (1)
Nelson Bowers Ford...................  Lease       Cleveland Properties LLC (1)   $   14,000       2011(3 )  Main Bldg.
  717 South Lee Hwy., Cleveland, TN
Nelson Bowers Dodge..................  Lease       Edward & Barbara Wright        $   16,800       2001(3 )  Main Bldg.
  402 West Martin Luther King Blvd.,
  Chattanooga
Cleveland Village Imports............  Lease       Thomas Green, Jr. and Nelson   $   11,000       1997(3 )  Main Bldg.(7)
                                                   Bowers (1)
  2490 & 2492 South Lee Hwy.,
  Cleveland, TN
Cleveland                              Lease       Robert G. Card, Jr.            $    8,900     Month to )  Main Bldg.
  Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle.......                                                             Month(3
  2496 South Lee Hwy., Cleveland, TN
Williams Motors......................  Lease       J.T. Williams                  $   14,000       1998(5 )  Main Bldg.
  803 North Anderson Rd., Rock Hill,
  SC
<CAPTION>
             Dealership                  Sq. Ft.       Acres
- -------------------------------------  -----------   ----------
<S>                                    <C>           <C>
Town & Country Ford..................       85,013        12.48
                                            24,768
  5401 East Independence Blvd.,
  Charlotte
Lone Star Ford.......................       79,725        24.76
                                             2,125
  8477 North Freeway, Houston               26,450
                                             1,500
Fort Mill Ford.......................       34,162        10.00
                                            11,275
  788 Gold Hill Rd., Fort Mill, SC
Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge....        9,809         5.50
                                             1,470
  3310 Hwy. 51, Fort Mill, SC
Town & Country Toyota................       50,800         5.70
                                            17,840
  9101 South Blvd., Charlotte
Frontier Oldsmobile-Cadillac.........       14,825         7.08
                                            11,250
  2501 Roosevelt Blvd., Monroe, NC           2,200
Ken Marks Ford.......................       79,100        22.00
  24825 US Hwy. 19 North, Clearwater
  &
  3925 Tampa Rd., Oldsmar, FL
Dyer Volvo...........................       60,000         6.00
  5260 Peachtree Industrial Blvd.,
  Atlanta
Lake Norman                                 26,000         6.00
  Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle.......
  Chartwell Center Dr., Cornelius, NC
Lake Norman Dodge....................       25,000         6.00
                                             5,000
  I-77 & Torrence Chapel Rd.,
  Cornelius, NC
KIA/VW of Chattanooga................        8,445         3.75
  6015 International Dr., Chattanooga
European Motors of Nashville.........       49,385         4.00
  630 Murfreeboro Pike, Nashville
European Motors......................       40,295        12.24
  5949 Brainerd Rd., Chattanooga
Jaguar of Chattanooga................       34,850         3.57
  5915 Brainerd Rd., Chattanooga
Nelson Bowers Ford...................       17,750         5.60
  717 South Lee Hwy., Cleveland, TN
Nelson Bowers Dodge..................       30,000         4.88
  402 West Martin Luther King Blvd.,
  Chattanooga
Cleveland Village Imports............       15,760         2.05
  2490 & 2492 South Lee Hwy.,
  Cleveland, TN
Cleveland                                   19,725         1.40
  Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle.......
  2496 South Lee Hwy., Cleveland, TN
Williams Motors......................       15,000(8)        3.0(8)
  803 North Anderson Rd., Rock Hill,
  SC
</TABLE>
                                                   (footnotes on following page)
                                       57
 
<PAGE>
- ---------------
(1) These lessors are affiliates of the Company's stockholders and/or executive
    officers. See "Risk Factors -- Potential Conflicts of Interest," "Certain
    Transactions -- Certain Dealership Leases" and "Principal Stockholders."
(2) All of the Company's leases are "triple net" leases and require the Company
    to pay all real estate taxes, maintenance and insurance costs for the
    property.
(3) Each of these leases provides for two renewal terms of five years each, at
    the option of the Company.
(4) Monthly rent expense based on estimate from the purchase agreement relating
    to the Acquisition.
(5) This lease provides for four renewal terms of one year each, at the option
    of the Company.
(6) European Motors of Nashville has entered into a 20-year lease with H.G. Hill
    Realty Company, an entity unaffiliated with the Company, regarding a new BMW
    facility to be constructed at a site separate from its existing facility.
    The monthly rent payments under this lease are not presently fixed and will
    depend upon the final construction costs of the new facility. The lease term
    will begin when the Company occupies these premises.
(7) Cleveland Village Imports also leases a used-car lot across the street from
    its main facility from individuals not affiliated with the Company for a
    term expiring in 2002 and providing for $3,000 in monthly rent.
(8) Estimated size.
     The Company's dealerships are generally located along major U.S. or
interstate highways. One of the principal factors considered by the Company in
evaluating an acquisition candidate is its location. The Company prefers to
acquire dealerships located along major thoroughfares, primarily interstate
highways with ease of access, which can be easily visited by prospective
customers.
     The Company owns certain of the real estate associated with Town & Country
Toyota and Fort Mill Ford. The remainder of the properties utilized by the
Company's dealership operations are leased as set forth in the foregoing table.
The Company believes that its facilities are adequate for its current needs. In
connection with its acquisition strategy, the Company intends to lease the real
estate associated with a particular dealership whenever practicable.
     Under the terms of its franchise agreements, the Company must maintain an
appropriate appearance and design of its facilities and is restricted in its
ability to relocate its dealerships. See " -- Relationships with Manufacturers."
Employees
     As of June 30, 1997 the Company employed 1,814 people, of whom
approximately 271 were employed in managerial positions, 654 were employed in
non-managerial sales positions, 387 were employed in non-managerial parts and
service positions and 502 were employed in administrative support positions.
     The Company believes that many dealerships in the retail automobile
industry have difficulty in attracting and retaining qualified personnel for a
number of reasons, including the historical inability of dealerships to provide
employees with an equity interest in the profitability of the dealerships. The
Company intends, upon completion of the Offering, to provide certain executive
officers, managers and other employees with stock options and all employees with
a stock purchase plan and believes this type of equity incentive will be
attractive to existing and prospective employees of the Company. See
"Management -- Stock Option Plan" and " -- Employee Stock Purchase Plan" and
"Risk Factors -- Dependence on Key Personnel and Limited Management and
Personnel Resources."
     The Company believes that its relationship with its employees is good. None
of the Company's employees is represented by a labor union. Because of its
dependence on the Manufacturers, however, the Company may be affected by labor
strikes, work slowdowns and walkouts at the Manufacturer's manufacturing
facilities. See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on Automobile Manufacturers."
Legal Proceedings and Insurance
     From time to time, the Company is named in claims involving the manufacture
of automobiles, contractual disputes and other matters arising in the ordinary
course of the Company's business. Currently, no legal proceedings are pending
against or involve the Company that, in the opinion of management, could
reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on the business,
financial condition or results of operations of the Company.
     Because of their vehicle inventory and nature of business, automobile
retail dealerships generally require significant levels of insurance covering a
broad variety of risks. The Company's insurance includes an umbrella policy as
well as insurance on its real property, comprehensive coverage for its vehicle
inventory, general liability insurance, employee dishonesty coverage and errors
and omissions insurance in connection with its vehicle sales and financing
activities.
                                       58
 
<PAGE>
                                   MANAGEMENT
Executive Officers and Directors; Key Personnel
     The executive officers, directors and key personnel of the Company, and
their ages as of the date of this Prospectus, are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Name                                     Age                               Position(s) with the Company
- -----                                  -------   --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                    <C>       <C>
O. Bruton Smith.....................        70   Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and Director*
Bryan Scott Smith...................        29   President, Chief Operating Officer and Director*
Nelson E. Bowers, II................        53   Executive Vice President and Director Nominee*
                                                 Chief Financial Officer, Vice President-Finance, Treasurer, Secretary and
                                                   Director*
Theodore M. Wright..................        35
William R. Brooks...................        47   Director
Jeffrey C. Rachor...................        35   Regional Vice President-Mid South Region
O. Ken Marks, Jr....................        35   Regional Vice President-Florida
Ivan A. Tufty.......................        57   Regional Vice President-Texas
William M. Sullivan.................        65   Regional Vice President-North and South Carolina
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
* Executive Officer
     O. Bruton Smith has been the Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and a
director of the Company since its organization in 1997 and presently is the
controlling stockholder of the Company through his direct and indirect ownership
of Class B Common Stock. Mr. Smith has been the president and controlling
stockholder of Sonic Financial since its formation, which prior to the
Reorganization owned a controlling interest in all of the Company's dealerships
except Town & Country Toyota and presently owns a controlling interest in the
Company's Common Stock. Mr. Smith, prior to the Reorganization, owned a
controlling interest in Town & Country Toyota. Mr. Smith currently is, and since
their acquisition by Sonic Financial has been, a director and the president of
each of the Company's dealerships. Mr. Smith has worked in the retail automobile
industry since 1966. Mr. Smith's initial term as a director of the Company will
expire at the annual meeting of stockholders of the Company to be held in 2000.
Mr. Smith is also the chairman and chief executive officer, a director and
controlling shareholder, either directly or through Sonic Financial, of Speedway
Motorsports, Inc. ("SMI"). SMI is a public company traded on the NYSE. Among
other things, it owns and operates the following NASCAR racetracks: Atlanta
Motor Speedway, Bristol Motor Speedway, Charlotte Motor Speedway, Sears Point
Raceway and Texas Motor Speedway. He is also the executive officer and a
director of each of SMI's operating subsidiaries. Under his employment agreement
with the Company, Mr. Smith is required to devote approximately 50% of his
business time to the Company's business.
     Bryan Scott Smith has been the President and Chief Operating Officer of the
Company since April 1997, and a director of the Company since its organization
in 1997. Mr. Smith, who is the son of Bruton Smith, has been the Vice President
since 1993 and, prior to the Reorganization, the minority owner of Town &
Country Ford. Mr. Smith joined the Company's predecessor in January 1991 on a
full-time basis as an assistant used car manager. In August of 1991, Mr. Smith
became the used car manager at Town & Country Ford. Mr. Smith was promoted to
General Manager of Town & Country Ford in November 1992 where he remained until
his appointment to President and Chief Operating Officer of the Company in April
of 1997. Mr. Smith's initial term as a director of the Company will expire at
the annual meeting of stockholders of the Company to be held in 1998.
     Nelson E. Bowers, II will be appointed the Executive Vice President and a
director of the Company upon consummation of the Bowers Acquisition. Mr. Bowers
owns a controlling interest in the dealerships that are the subject of the
Bowers Acquisition and has worked in the retail automobile industry since 1974.
Mr. Bowers has served on national dealer councils for BMW and Volvo and has
owned and operated dealerships since 1979. Several of the dealerships owned by
Mr. Bowers have been awarded the highest awards available from manufacturers for
customer satisfaction. Mr. Bowers' initial term as a director of the Company
will expire at the annual meeting of stockholders to be held in 1999.
     Theodore M. Wright has been the Chief Financial Officer, Vice
President-Finance, Treasurer and Secretary of the Company since April 1997, and
a director of the Company since June 1997. Before joining the Company, Mr.
Wright was a Senior Manager and in charge of the Columbia, South Carolina office
of Deloitte & Touche LLP. Prior to joining the Columbia office, Mr. Wright was a
Senior Manager in Deloitte & Touche LLP's National Office Accounting Research
and SEC Services Departments from 1994 to 1995. From 1992 to 1994 Mr. Wright was
an audit manager with Deloitte & Touche LLP. Mr. Wright's initial term as a
director of the Company will expire at the annual meeting of stockholders to be
held in 1999.
                                       59
 
<PAGE>
     William R. Brooks has been a director of the Company since its formation.
Mr. Brooks also served as the Company's Treasurer, Vice President and Secretary
from its organization in February 1997 to April 1997 when Mr. Wright was
appointed to those positions. Since December 1994, Mr. Brooks has been the Vice
President, Treasurer, Chief Financial Officer and a director of SMI. Mr. Brooks
also serves as an executive officer and a director for various operating
subsidiaries of SMI. Before the formation of SMI in December 1994, Mr. Brooks
was the Vice President of the Charlotte Motor Speedway and a Vice President and
a director of Atlanta Motor Speedway. Mr. Brooks joined Sonic Financial from
Price Waterhouse in 1983. At Sonic Financial, he was promoted from Manager to
Controller in 1985 and again to Chief Financial Officer in 1989. Mr. Brooks'
initial term as a director of the Company will expire at the annual meeting of
stockholders to be held in 2000.
     Jeffrey C. Rachor will be appointed Regional Vice President upon
consummation of the Bowers Acquisition. Mr. Rachor has over 13 years experience
in automobile retailing and has been the chief operating officer at the Bowers
Dealerships since 1989. During this period, Mr. Rachor has also served at
various times as the general manager of Toyota, Saturn and
Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle dealerships. Prior to joining the Bowers
organization, Mr. Rachor was an assistant regional manager with American Suzuki
Motor Corporation from 1987 to 1989 and a Metro Sales Manager and a District
Sales Manager with GM's Buick Motor Division from 1983 to 1987.
     O. Ken Marks, Jr. owns a controlling interest in Ken Marks Ford and has
operated that dealership as its chief executive since prior to 1992. Mr. Marks
is a Chairman's award winner from Ford and has over 13 years experience in auto
retailing. Ken Marks Ford is one of the top 100 automobile dealerships in the
United States and one of the 30 largest Ford dealerships. Mr. Marks will be
appointed a Regional Vice President upon consummation of the Offering.
     Ivan A. Tufty has been Executive Manager of Lone Star Ford since 1990 and
will be appointed a Regional Vice President upon consummation of the Offering.
Under Mr. Tufty's leadership, Lone Star Ford has been recognized as one of the
30 largest Ford dealerships and one of the 100 largest dealerships in the United
States. Mr. Tufty has over 40 years of experience in auto retailing and was a
dealer principal and equity owner for 12 years.
     William M. Sullivan has been Vice-President of Town & Country Ford since
prior to 1992 and will be appointed a Regional Vice President upon consummation
of the Offering. Mr. Sullivan has over 25 years experience in auto retailing as
an Executive Manager, head of F&I and in other roles.
     As soon as practicable after the Offering, the Company intends to name two
or three individuals not employed by or affiliated with the Company to the
Company's Board of Directors.
     The Board of Directors of the Company is divided into three classes, each
of which, after a transitional period, will serve for three years, with one
class being elected each year. The executive officers are elected annually by,
and serve at the discretion of, the Company's Board of Directors.
Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation
     Since the Company's organization in February 1997, all matters concerning
executive officer compensation have been addressed by the entire Board of
Directors. Bruton Smith, Scott Smith and Theodore Wright were executive officers
of the Company and, together with William R. Brooks, will constitute the entire
Board until the consummation of the Offering when Nelson Bowers, an executive
officer of the Company, is to be appointed. Bruton Smith serves as Chairman of
the Board of SMI. William R. Brooks, an executive officer of SMI, serves on the
Board of the Company. As soon as practicable after the Offering, the Company
intends to name at least two independent directors who will comprise the
Company's compensation committee. See "Management."
Limitations of Directors Liability
     The Certificate includes a provision that effectively eliminates the
liability of directors to the Company or to the Company's stockholders for
monetary damages for breach of the fiduciary duties of a director, except for
breaches of the duty of loyalty, acts or omissions not in good faith or which
involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law, certain actions
with respect to unlawful dividends, stock repurchases or redemptions and any
transaction from which the director derived an improper personal benefit. This
provision does not prevent stockholders from seeking nonmonetary remedies
covering any such action, nor does it affect liabilities under the federal
securities laws. The Company's Bylaws further provide that the Company shall
indemnify each of its directors and officers, to the fullest extent authorized
by Delaware Law, with respect to any threatened, pending or completed action,
suit or proceeding to which such person may be a party by reason of serving as a
director or officer. Delaware Law currently authorizes a corporation to
indemnify its directors and
                                       60
 
<PAGE>
officers against expenses (including attorney's fees), judgments, fines and
amounts paid in settlements actually and reasonably incurred by them in
connection with any action, suit or proceeding brought by a third party if such
officers or directors acted in good faith and in a manner they reasonably
believed to be in, or not opposed to, the best interests of the corporation and,
with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had no reason to believe
their conduct was unlawful. Indemnification is permitted in more limited
circumstances with respect to derivative actions. The Company believes that
these provisions of the Certificate and the Bylaws are necessary to attract and
retain qualified persons to serve as directors and officers.
Committees of the Board
     The Board of Directors will establish a Compensation Committee and an Audit
Committee consisting of independent directors upon the election of at least two
independent directors. The Compensation Committee will review and approve
compensation for the executive officers, and administer, and determine awards
under, the Stock Option Plan and any other incentive compensation plans for
employees of the Company. See " -- Stock Option Plan" and " -- Employee Stock
Purchase Plan." The Audit Committee will recommend the selection of auditors for
the Company and will review the results of the audit and other reports and
services provided by the Company's independent auditors. The Company has not
previously had either of these committees.
Director Compensation
     Members of the Board of Directors who are not employees of the Company will
be compensated for their services in amounts to be determined. The Company will
also reimburse all directors for their expenses incurred in connection with
their activities as directors of the Company. Directors who are also employees
of the Company receive no compensation for serving on the Board of Directors.
Executive Compensation
     Sonic was incorporated on January 31, 1997 and did not conduct any
operations prior to that time. The Company anticipates that during 1997 its most
highly compensated executive officers with annual salaries exceeding $100,000,
and their annual base salaries for 1997, will be: Bruton Smith -- $350,000,
Scott Smith -- $300,000, Nelson Bowers  -- $400,000, and Theodore
Wright -- $180,000.
     Set forth below is information for the years ended December 31, 1996, 1995
and 1994 with respect to compensation for services to the Company's predecessors
of the Company's executive officers.
                           Summary Compensation Table
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                Long-Term
                                                      Annual Compensation                  Compensation Awards
                                        -----------------------------------------------    -------------------
                                                                              Other         Number of Shares
                                                                              Annual           Underlying            All Other
Name and Principal Position(s)          Year    Salary (1)    Bonus (2)    Compensation        Options (4)        Compensation (5)
- -------------------------------------   -----   ----------    ---------    ------------    -------------------    ----------------
<S>                                     <C>     <C>           <C>          <C>             <C>                    <C>
O. Bruton Smith                          1996    $ 164,750           --      $ 33,350(3)              --                    --
  Chairman, Chief Executive Officer      1995      142,200           --        41,350(3)              --                    --
  and Director                           1994      142,200           --        41,000(3)              --                    --
Bryan Scott Smith                        1996    $  48,000    $ 230,714           (5)                 --                    --
  President, Chief                       1995       48,000      168,670           (5)                 --                    --
  Operating Officer                      1994       48,000      134,537           (5)                 --                    --
  and Director
</TABLE>
- ---------------
(1) Does not include the dollar value of perquisites and other personal
    benefits.
(2) The amounts shown are cash bonuses earned in the specified year and paid in
    the first quarter of the following year.
(3) The Company provides Mr. Smith with the use of automobiles for personal use,
    the annual cost of which is reflected as Other Annual Compensation.
(4) The Company's Stock Option Plan was adopted in September 1997. Therefore, no
    options were granted to any of the Company's executive officers in 1996,
    1995 or 1994.
(5) The aggregate amount of perquisites and other personal benefits received did
    not exceed the lesser of $50,000 or 10% of the total annual salary and bonus
    reported for such executive officer.
                                       61
 
<PAGE>
Employment Agreements
     The Company has entered into employment agreements with Messrs. Bruton
Smith, Scott Smith, Bowers, Wright, Marks and Rachor (the "Employment
Agreements"), effective upon consummation of the Offering, which provide for an
annual base salary and certain other benefits. Pursuant to the Employment
Agreements, the 1997 base salaries of Messrs. Bruton Smith, Scott Smith, Bowers,
Wright, Marks and Rachor will be $350,000, $300,000, $400,000, $180,000,
$48,000, and $150,000, respectively. The executives will also receive such
additional increases as may be determined by the Compensation Committee. The
Employment Agreements, except those of Messrs. Rachor and Marks, provide for the
payment of annual performance-based bonuses equal to a percentage of the
executive's base salary, upon achievement by the Company (or relevant region) of
certain performance objectives, based on the Company's pre-tax income, to be
established by the Compensation Committee. The Employment Agreements of Messrs.
Rachor and Marks provide for the payment of annual performance-based bonuses,
paid in equal installments on a monthly basis, equal to a percentage of the
pre-tax earnings of subsidiaries of the Company located within his regions of
responsibility, in the case of Mr. Rachor, and of Ken Marks Ford in the case of
Mr. Marks. See " -- Incentive Compensation Plan." Under the terms of the
Employment Agreements, the Company will employ Mr. Bruton Smith through November
2000. Under the terms of their respective Employment Agreements, the Company
will employ Messrs. Scott Smith, Bowers, Wright, Marks and Rachor for five years
or until their respective Employment Agreements are terminated by the Company or
the executive. Messrs. Scott Smith, Bowers, Wright, Marks and Rachor also
receive under their Employment Agreements, options pursuant to the Company's
Stock Option Plan, for 99,875 shares, 79,313 shares, 38,188 shares, 35,250
shares and 41,125 shares, of the Class A Common Stock, respectively, exercisable
at the initial public offering price, vesting in three equal annual installments
beginning October 1998 and expiring in October 2007.
     Each of the Employment Agreements contain similar noncompetition
provisions. These provisions, during the term of the Employment Agreement, (i)
prohibit the disclosure or use of confidential Company information, and (ii)
prohibit competition with the Company for the Company's employees and its
customers, interference with the Company's relationships with its vendors, and
employment with any competitor of the Company in specified territories. The
provisions referred to in (ii) above shall also apply for a period of two years
following the expiration or termination of an Employment Agreement. With respect
to Messrs. Bruton Smith, Scott Smith and Wright, the geographic restrictions
apply in any Standard Metropolitan Statistical Area ("SMSA") or county in which
the Company has a place of business at the time their employment ends. With
respect to Messrs. Bowers and Rachor, the restrictions apply only in the SMSA's
for Houston, Charlotte, Chattanooga, and Nashville, provided that such
noncompetition provisions do not apply to his operation of Saturn of
Chattanooga. With respect to Mr. Marks, the territorial restrictions apply only
in the SMSA's or counties in which the Company has a place of business and about
which Marks had access to confidential information or for which he had
operational or managerial involvement.
Stock Option Plan
     In October 1997, the Board of Directors and stockholders of the Company
adopted the Company's 1997 Stock Option Plan (the "Stock Option Plan") in order
to attract and retain key personnel. The following discussion of the material
features of the Stock Option Plan is qualified by reference to the text of such
Plan filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus
is a part.
     Under the Stock Option Plan, options to purchase up to an aggregate of
1,125,000 shares of Class A Common Stock may be granted to key employees of the
Company and its subsidiaries and to officers, directors, consultants and other
individuals providing services to the Company. Members of the Board of Directors
who serve on the Compensation Committee must qualify as "non-employee
directors," as that term is defined in Rule 16b-3 promulgated under the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.
     The Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors of the Company will
administer the Stock Option Plan and will determine, among other things, the
persons who are to receive options, the number of shares to be subject to each
option and the vesting schedule of options. The Board of Directors of the
Company will determine the terms and conditions upon which the Company may make
loans to enable an optionee to pay the exercise price of an option. In selecting
individuals for options and determining the terms thereof, the Compensation
Committee may consider any factors it considers relevant, including present and
potential contributions to the success of the Company. Options granted under the
Stock Option Plan must be exercised within a period fixed by the Compensation
Committee, which period may not exceed ten years from the date of grant of the
option or, in the case of incentive stock options ("ISOs") granted to any holder
on the date of grant of more than ten percent of the total combined voting power
of all classes of stock of the Company, five years from the date of grant of the
option. Options may be made exercisable in whole or in installments, as
determined by the Compensation Committee.
                                       62
 
<PAGE>
     Options generally may not be transferred other than by will or the laws of
descent and distribution and, during the lifetime of an optionee, options may be
exercised only by the optionee. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Compensation
Committee, in its absolute discretion, may grant transferable options if such
options are not ISOs. The exercise price of options that are not ISOs will be
determined at the discretion of the Compensation Committee. The exercise price
of ISOs may not be less than the market value of the Class A Common Stock on the
date of grant of the option. In the case of ISOs granted to any holder on the
date of grant of more than ten percent of the total combined voting power of all
classes of stock of the Company and its subsidiaries, the exercise price may not
be less than 110% of the market value per share of the Class A Common Stock on
the date of grant. Unless designated as "incentive stock options" intended to
qualify under Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the
"Code"), options granted under the Stock Option Plan are intended to be
"nonstatutory stock options" ("NSOs"). The exercise price may be paid in cash,
in shares of Class A Common Stock owned by the optionee, in NSOs granted under
the Stock Option Plan (except that the exercise price of an ISO may not be paid
in NSOs) or in any combination of cash, shares and NSOs.
     Options granted under the Stock Option Plan may include the right to
acquire a "reload" option. In such a case, if a participant pays all or part of
the exercise price of an option with shares of Class A Common Stock held by the
participant for at least six months, then, upon exercise of the option, the
participant is granted a second option to purchase, at the fair market value as
of the date of grant of the second option, the number of shares of Class A
Common Stock transferred to the Company by the participant in payment of the
exercise price of the original option. A reload option is not exercisable until
one year after the grant date of such reload option or the expiration date of
the original option. If the exercise price of a reload option is paid for with
shares of Class A Common Stock that have been held by the optionee for more than
six months, then another reload option will be issued. Shares of Class A Common
Stock covered by a reload option will not reduce the number of shares of Class A
Common Stock available under the Stock Option Plan.
     The Stock Option Plan provides that, in the event of changes in the
corporate structure of the Company or certain events affecting the shares of the
Company, adjustments will automatically be made in the number and kind of shares
available for issuance and in the number and kind of shares covered by
outstanding options. It further provides that, in connection with any merger or
consolidation in which the Company is not the surviving corporation and which
results in the holders of the outstanding voting securities of the Company
owning less than a majority of the surviving corporation or any sale or transfer
by the Company of all or substantially all its assets or any tender offer or
exchange offer for or the acquisition, directly or indirectly, by any person or
group of all or a majority of the then-outstanding voting securities of the
Company, all outstanding options under the Stock Option Plan will become
exercisable in full on and after (i) the 15th day prior to the effective date of
such merger, consolidation, sale, transfer or acquisition or (ii) the date of
commencement of such tender offer or exchange offer, as the case may be.
     The Board of Directors of the Company, on or before the consummation of the
Offering, intends to grant NSOs and ISOs to purchase an aggregate of 587,509
shares of Class A Common Stock under the Stock Option Plan to three executive
officers, five regional vice presidents and one dealer manager of the Company.
Messrs. Scott Smith, Bowers and Wright are to be granted NSOs to purchase 79,875
shares, 59,313 shares and 18,188 shares, respectively at an exercise price equal
to the public offering price of the Class A Common Stock sold in the Offering.
Messrs. Scott Smith, Bowers and Wright are also to be granted ISOs to purchase
20,000 shares, 20,000 shares and 20,000 shares, respectively, at an exercise
price equal to the public offering price of the Class A Common Stock sold in the
Offering. All of these options will become exercisable in three equal annual
installments beginning in October 1998 with the last installment vesting in
October 2000, and all these options will expire in October 2007. Consequently,
all executive officers as a group are to be granted NSOs to purchase an
aggregate of 157,376 shares and ISOs to purchase an aggregate of 60,000 shares.
Non-executive officer employees are to be granted NSOs and ISOs to purchase an
aggregate of 290,133 shares and 80,000 shares, respectively. See " -- Employment
Agreements."
     The issuance and exercise of ISOs have no federal income tax consequences
to the Company. While the issuance and exercise of ISOs generally have no
ordinary income tax consequences to the holder, upon the exercise of an ISO, the
holder will treat the excess of the fair market value on the date of exercise
over the exercise price as an item of tax adjustment for alternative minimum tax
purposes. If the holder of Class A Common Stock acquired upon the exercise of an
ISO disposes of such stock before the later of (i) two years following the grant
of the ISO and (ii) one year following the exercise of the ISO (a "Disqualifying
Disposition"), the holder will recognize ordinary income for federal income tax
purposes in an amount equal to the lesser of (i) the excess of the Class A
Common Stock's fair market value on the date of exercise over the option
exercise price, and (ii) the excess of the amount realized on disposition of the
Class A Common Stock over the option exercise price. Any additional gain upon
the disposition will be taxed as capital gains. The disposition of Class A
Common Stock acquired from the exercise of an ISO other than in a Disqualifying
Disposition will ordinarily result in capital gains or
                                       63
 
<PAGE>
loss to the holder for federal income tax purposes equal to the difference
between the amount realized on disposition of the Class A Common Stock and the
option exercise price. Any capital gain will be subject to reduced rates of tax
if such shares were held more than twelve months, and will be subject to further
reduced rates if such shares were held more than eighteen months. The Company
will be entitled to a compensation expense deduction for the Company's taxable
year in which the disposition occurs equal to the amount of ordinary income
recognized by the holder.
     The issuance of NSOs has no federal income tax consequences to the Company
or the holder. Upon the exercise of an NSO, the Company generally will be
allowed a federal income tax deduction equal to the amount by which the fair
market value of the underlying shares on the date of exercise exceeds the
exercise price. NSO holders will recognize ordinary income for federal income
tax purposes at the time of option exercise in the same amount. In the event of
a sale of shares acquired by exercise of a NSO, any appreciation or depreciation
after the exercise date generally will be taxed as capital gain or loss;
provided that any gain will be subject to reduced rates of tax if such shares
were held for more than twelve months and will be subject to further reduced
rates if such shares were held for more than eighteen months. The disposition of
shares acquired by exercise of a NSO will result in capital gains or losses to
the holder.
     The Company intends to register the shares underlying the Stock Option Plan
as required by the federal securities laws. If such registration is not
required, such shares may be issued upon option exercise in reliance upon the
private offering exemption codified in Section 4(2) of the Securities Act.
Resale of such shares may be permitted subject to the limitations of Rule 144.
Employee Stock Purchase Plan
     In October 1997, the Board of Directors and stockholders of the Company
adopted the Sonic Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the "ESPP"). The ESPP is
intended to promote the interests of the Company by providing employees of the
Company the opportunity to acquire a proprietary interest in the Company through
the purchase of Class A Common Stock. The following discussion of the material
features of the ESPP is qualified by reference to the text of such Plan filed in
an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus is a part.
     The ESPP is intended to qualify as an "employee stock purchase plan" under
Section 423 of the Code. The ESPP is administered by the Compensation Committee,
which, subject to the terms of the ESPP, has plenary authority in its discretion
to interpret and construe the ESPP. The Compensation Committee will construe the
provisions of the ESPP so as to extend and limit participation in a manner
consistent with the requirements of Section 423 of the Code. A total of 150,000
shares of Class A Common Stock have been reserved for purchase under the ESPP.
     On January 1 of each year during the term of the ESPP (the "Grant Date"),
all eligible employees electing to participate in the ESPP ("Participating
Employees") will be granted options to purchase shares of Class A Common Stock.
Prior to each Grant Date, the Compensation Committee will determine the number
of shares of Class A Common Stock available for purchase under each option, with
the same number of shares to be available under each option granted on the same
Grant Date. No Participating Employee may be granted an option which would
permit such employee to purchase stock under the ESPP and all other employee
stock purchase plans of the Company at a rate which exceeds $25,000 of the fair
market value of such stock (determined at the time such option is granted) for
each calendar year in which such option is outstanding at any time.
     A Participating Employee may elect to designate a limited percentage of
such employee's compensation (as defined in the ESPP) to be deferred by payroll
deduction as a contribution to the ESPP. A Participating Employee instead may
elect to make contributions by direct cash payment to the ESPP rather than by
payroll deduction. To the extent a Participating Employee has accumulated enough
funds, his or her contributions to the ESPP will be used to exercise the option
granted under the ESPP through purchases of Class A Common Stock on the last
business day of March, June, September and December on which the principal
trading market for the Class A Common Stock is open for trading and on any other
interim dates during the year which the Compensation Committee designates for
such purpose (the "Exercise Date"). Contributions which are not enough to
purchase a whole share of Class A Common Stock will be carried forward and
applied on the next Exercise Date in that calendar year; provided that
contributions remaining after the last Exercise Date of the calendar year may be
distributed to the Participating Employee at his election.
     The purchase price at which Class A Common Stock will be purchased through
the ESPP shall be 85% of the lesser of (i) the fair market value of the Class A
Common Stock on the applicable Grant Date, and (ii) the fair market value of the
Class A Common Stock on the applicable Exercise Date. Any option granted to a
Participating Employee will be exercised automatically on each Exercise Date
during the calendar year of the option's Grant Date in whole or in part such
that the Participating Employee's accumulated contributions as of such Exercise
Date, either through direct cash payment or payroll
                                       64
 
<PAGE>
deduction, will be applied to the purchase of the maximum number of whole shares
of Class A Common Stock that such contribution will permit at the applicable
option price, limited to the number of shares available for purchase under the
option.
     Any option granted to a Participating Employee will expire on the last
Exercise Date of the calendar year in which granted. However, if a Participating
Employee withdraws from the ESPP or terminates employment prior to such Exercise
Date, the option may expire earlier.
     Upon termination of a Participating Employee's employment for any reason
other than cause, death or leave of absence in excess of ninety days, such
employee may, at his election, request the return of contributions not yet used
to purchase Class A Common Stock or continue participation in the ESPP until the
Exercise Date next following the date of termination of employment such that any
unexpired option held will be exercised automatically on such Exercise Date. If
a Participating Employee dies while employed by the Company or prior to the
Exercise Date next following termination of employment, such employee's estate
will have the right to elect to withdraw all contributions not yet used to
purchase Class A Common Stock or to exercise the Participating Employee's option
for the purchase of Class A Common Stock on the Exercise Date next following the
date of such employee's death.
     The Board of Directors of the Company may at any time amend, suspend or
terminate the ESPP; provided, however, that the ESPP may not be amended to
increase the maximum number of shares of Class A Common Stock for which options
may be granted under the ESPP, other than in connection with a change in
capitalization, without obtaining the approval of Sonic stockholders.
     The ESPP is intended to meet the requirements of an "employee stock
purchase plan" under Section 423 of the Code. No federal taxable income will be
recognized by Participating Employees upon the grant of an option to purchase
Class A Common Stock under the ESPP. In addition, a Participating Employee will
not recognize federal taxable income on the exercise of an option granted under
the ESPP.
     If the Participating Employee holds shares of Class A Common Stock acquired
upon the exercise of an option granted under the ESPP until a date that is more
than two years from the grant date of the relevant option and one year from the
date of option exercise (or dies while owning such shares), the employee must
report as ordinary income in the year of disposition of the shares (or at death)
the lesser of (a) the excess of the fair market value of the shares at the time
of disposition (or death) over the option exercise price and (b) the excess of
the fair market value of the shares on the date the relevant option was granted
over the option exercise price. For this purpose, the option exercise price is
85% of the fair market value of the shares on the date the relevant option was
granted (assuming the shares are offered at a 15% discount). Any additional
income is treated as long-term capital gain. If these holding period
requirements are met, the Company is not entitled to any deduction for tax
purposes. If the Participating Employee does not meet the holding period
requirements, the employee recognizes at the time of disposition of the shares
ordinary income equal to the difference between the price paid for the shares
and the fair market value on the date of exercise, irrespective of the price at
which the employee disposes of the shares, and an amount equal to such ordinary
income is generally deductible by the Company. Any gain or loss realized on the
disposition of the shares will generally be capital gain or loss; provided that
any gain will be subject to reduced rates of tax if the shares were held for
more than twelve months and will be subject to further reduced rates if the
shares were held for more than eighteen months.
     Because the ESPP is based on voluntary participation, benefits thereunder
are not determinable.
     The Company intends to register the shares underlying the ESPP as required
by the federal securities laws. If such registration is not required, such
shares may be issued upon option exercise in reliance upon the private offering
exemption codified in Section 4(2) of the Securities Act. Resale of such shares
may be permitted subject to the limitations of Rule 144.
                                       65
 
<PAGE>
                              CERTAIN TRANSACTIONS
Registration Rights Agreement
     As part of the Reorganization, the Company entered into a Registration
Rights Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 (the "Registration Rights
Agreements") with Sonic Financial, Bruton Smith, Scott Smith and William S.
Egan. Sonic Financial, Bruton Smith, Scott Smith and Egan Group, LLC, an
assignee of Mr. Egan (the "Egan Group") currently are the owners of record of
4,440,625, 1,035,625, 478,125 and 295,625 shares of Class B Common Stock,
respectively. Upon the registration of any of their shares or as otherwise
provided in the Certificate, such shares will automatically be converted into a
like number of shares of Class A Common Stock. Subject to certain limitations,
the Registration Rights Agreements provide Sonic Financial, Bruton Smith, Scott
Smith and the Egan Group with certain piggyback registration rights that permit
them to have their shares of Common Stock, as selling security holders, included
in any registration statement pertaining to the registration of Class A Common
Stock for issuance by the Company or for resale by other selling security
holders, with the exception of registration statements on Forms S-4 and S-8
relating to exchange offers (and certain other transactions) and employee stock
compensation plans, respectively. These registration rights will be limited or
restricted to the extent an underwriter of an offering, if an underwritten
offering, or the Company's Board of Directors, if not an underwritten offering,
determines that the amount to be registered by Sonic Financial, Bruton Smith,
Scott Smith or the Egan Group would not permit the sale of Class A Common Stock
in the quantity and at the price originally sought by the Company or the
original selling security holders, as the case may be. The Registration Rights
Agreement expires on the tenth anniversary of the closing of the Offering. Sonic
Financial is controlled by the Company's Chairman and Chief Executive Officer,
Bruton Smith.
The Smith Advance
     In connection with the Fort Mill Acquisition, Mr. Smith advanced
approximately $3.5 million to the Company (the "Smith Advance"). The Smith
Advance was used by the Company to pay a portion of the cash consideration for
the Fort Mill Acquisition at closing. The Smith Advance is evidenced by a demand
note bearing interest at the minimum statutory rate of 3.83% per annum. The
Company anticipates seeking additional cash advances or credit support in the
form of guarantees or collateral from Mr. Smith in order to meet cash payment
obligations in the remaining Acquisitions which close prior to the consummation
of the Offering. The Company intends to repay the principal of and interest on
the Smith Advance and any similar future advances from Mr. Smith used to fund
the Acquisitions from the proceeds of this Offering.
The Smith Guaranties and Pledges
     Under the Six-Month Facility, Bruton Smith has guaranteed the obligations
of the Company and secured his guarantee with a pledge of shares of common stock
of Speedway Motorsports, Inc. owned directly by him. Under the Revolving
Facility, Mr. Smith guaranteed the obligations of the Company and such
obligations are further secured with a pledge of shares of common stock of
Speedway Motorsports, Inc. owned directly or indirectly by him. Mr. Smith has
pledged securities having an estimated value of approximately $40.0 million to
secure the Six-Month Facility (the "Six-Month Pledge"). Should NationsBank
foreclose on the Six-Month Pledge, the Company is under no obligation to repay
or reimburse Mr. Smith. Mr. Smith pledged securities indirectly owned by him
having an estimated value of approximately $50.0 million to secure the Initial
Loan Commitment under the Revolving Facility (the "Revolving Pledge"). If net
proceeds of the Offering to the Company are $70 million or greater, the
Revolving Pledge will be released pursuant to the terms of the Revolving
Facility. If net proceeds of the Offering to the Company are less than $70
million, Sonic Financial, a company controlled by Mr. Smith, will be required to
provide continued credit support for the Revolving Facility in the form of a
pledge of securities owned by Sonic Financial equal in value to three times the
amount of the shortfall between $70 million and the actual net proceeds of the
Offering to the Company. The Company will be under no obligation to repay or
reimburse Mr. Smith or Sonic Financial if Ford Motor Credit forecloses on the
Revolving Pledge. For further discussion of these lending arrangements, see
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources."
Certain Dealership Leases
     Certain of the properties leased by the Company's dealership subsidiaries
are owned by officers, directors or holders of 5% or more of the Common Stock of
the Company or their affiliates. These leases contain terms comparable to, or
more favorable to the Company than, terms that would be obtained from
unaffiliated third parties. Town & Country Ford operates at facilities leased
from STC Properties, a North Carolina joint venture ("STC"). Town & Country Ford
maintains a 5% undivided interest in STC and Sonic Financial owns the remaining
95% of STC. The STC lease on the Town & Country Ford facilities will expire in
October 2000. Annual payments under the STC lease were $510,085 for each of
1994, 1995 and 1996. Current minimum rent payments are $409,000 annually
($34,083 monthly) through 1999, and will be decreased to $340,833
                                       66
 
<PAGE>
in 2000, such rents being below market. When this lease expires, the Company
anticipates obtaining a long-term lease on the Town & Country Ford facility at
fair market rent.
     Lone Star Ford operates, in part, at facilities leased from Viking
Investments Associates, a Texas association ("Viking"), which is controlled by
Mr. Bruton Smith. The Viking lease on the Lone Star Ford property expires in
2005. Annual payments under the Viking lease were $351,420, $331,302 and
$360,000 for 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively. Minimum annual rents under this
lease are $360,000 ($30,000 monthly), such amount being below market. When this
lease expires, the Company anticipates obtaining a long-term lease on the Lone
Star Ford facility at fair market rent.
     The dealership leases discussed below will be executed and effective as of
the consummation of the Acquisitions. The terms of these leases are comparable
to terms that would be obtained from unaffiliated third parties because they
were negotiated at arms-length before the lessors became affiliated with the
Company.
     KIA of Chattanooga operates at facilities leased from KIA Land Development,
a company in which Nelson Bowers, the Company's Executive Vice President,
maintains an ownership interest. The Company negotiated this lease in connection
with the Bowers Acquisition. This triple net lease expires in 2007 and the
monthly rent will be $11,070 per month. The Company may renew this lease at its
option for two additional five year terms. At each renewal, the lessor may
adjust lease rents to reflect fair market rents for the property.
     European Motors operates at its Chattanooga facilities under a triple net
lease from Mr. Bowers. The Company negotiated this lease in connection with the
Bowers Acquisition. The European Motors lease expires in 2007 and provides for
monthly rent of $16,846. This lease also provides for renewals on terms
identical to the KIA of Chattanooga lease.
     Jaguar of Chattanooga operates at facilities leased from JAG Properties, a
company in which Mr. Bowers maintains an ownership interest. The Company
negotiated this lease in connection with the Bowers Acquisition. This triple net
lease expires in 2017 and provides for monthly rent of $22,010. The Company may
renew this lease on terms identical to the KIA of Chattanooga renewal options.
     Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle leases its facilities from Cleveland
Properties LLC, a limited liability company in which Mr. Bowers maintains an
ownership interest. The Company negotiated this lease in connection with the
Bowers Acquisition. This triple net lease expires in 2011, provides for monthly
rent of $14,000 and may be renewed on terms identical to the KIA of Chattanooga
lease.
     Cleveland Village Imports operates at facilities leased from Nelson Bowers
and another individual. Nelson Bowers, the Company's President and a director,
owns a 75% undivided interest in the land and buildings leased by Cleveland
Village Imports, with the remaining interests owned by an unrelated party. Such
land and buildings are leased under two leases: one is a triple net fixed lease
expiring on December 31, 1997 with rent of $8,000 per month and the other,
pertaining to a used car lot, is a month-to-month lease with rent of $3,000 per
month. In connection with the Bowers Acquisition, the lessors have agreed to
allow the expiration of these leases in October 1997, and to replace them with a
triple net lease at a negotiated rental rate for a 15-year initial term and two
five-year renewals at the option of the Company.
     Dyer Volvo operates at facilities leased from D&R Investments, an entity in
which Richard Dyer, the Company's Executive Manager for Dyer Volvo, maintains an
ownership interest. This triple net lease, negotiated by the Company in
connection with the Dyer Acquisition, expires in 2009 and provides for monthly
rent of $50,000. The Dyer Volvo lease also provides the Company with two
optional renewals of five years each with rent at each renewal being adjusted to
fair market rent.
     Ken Marks Ford ("KMF") operates at facilities leased from Marks Holding
Company, a corporation that is owned by Ken Marks, the Company's Regional Vice
President-Florida. In connection with the Ken Marks Acquisition, the lessor has
agreed to enter into a triple net lease with the Company as lessee at a
negotiated rental rate of $95,000 per month for an initial term expiring 2007
with two five-year renewals at the option of the Company.
Chartown Transactions
     Chartown is a general partnership engaged in real estate development and
management. Before the Reorganization, Town & Country Ford maintained a 49%
partnership interest in Chartown with the remaining 51% held by SMDA Properties,
LLC, a North Carolina limited liability company ("SMDA"). Mr. Smith owns an 80%
direct membership interest in SMDA with the remaining 20% owned indirectly
through Sonic Financial. In addition, Sonic Financial also held a demand
promissory note for approximately $1.6 million issued by Chartown (the "Chartown
Note"), which was uncollectible due to insufficient funds. As part of the
Reorganization, the Chartown Note was canceled and Town & Country Ford
transferred its partnership interest in Chartown to Sonic Financial for nominal
consideration. In connection with that transfer, Sonic Financial
                                       67
 
<PAGE>
agreed to indemnify Town & Country Ford for any and all obligations and
liabilities, whether known or unknown, relating to Chartown and Town & Country
Ford's ownership thereof.
The Bowers Volvo Note
     In connection with Volvo's approval of the Company's acquisition of a Volvo
franchise in the Bowers Acquisition, Volvo, among other things, conditioned its
approval upon Nelson Bowers, the Company's Executive Vice President and a
director nominee, acquiring and maintaining a 20% interest in the Company's
Sonic Automotive of Chattanooga, LLC ("Chattanooga Volvo") subsidiary that will
operate the Volvo franchise. Mr. Bowers will finance all of the purchase price
for this 20% interest by issuing a promissory note (the "Bowers Volvo Note") in
favor of Sonic Automotive of Nevada, Inc. ("Sonic Nevada"), the wholly-owned
subsidiary of the Company that controls a majority interest in Chattanooga
Volvo. The Bowers Volvo Note will be secured by Mr. Bowers' interest in
Chattanooga Volvo.
     The Bowers Volvo Note will be in a principal amount of $900,000 (subject to
adjustment following the closing of the Bowers Acquisition) and bear interest at
the lowest applicable federal rate as published by the U.S. Treasury Department
in effect on the date Mr. Bowers purchases his interest in Chattanooga Volvo.
Accrued interest will be payable annually. The operating agreement of
Chattanooga Volvo will provide that profits and distributions are to be
allocated first to Mr. Bowers to the extent of interest to be paid on the Bowers
Volvo Note and next to the other members of Chattanooga Volvo according to their
percentages of ownership. No other profits or any losses of Chattanooga Volvo
will be allocated to Mr. Bowers under this arrangement. Mr. Bowers' interest in
Chattanooga Volvo will be redeemed and the Bowers Volvo Note will be due and
payable in full when Volvo no longer requires Mr. Bowers to maintain his
interest in Chattanooga Volvo.
Other Transactions
     During each of the three years ended December 31, 1996, Town & Country Ford
paid $48,000 to Sonic Financial as a management fee. Sonic Financial's services
to Town & Country Ford have included performance of the following functions,
among others: maintenance of lender and creditor relationships; tax planning;
preparation of tax returns and representation in tax examinations; record
maintenance; internal audits and special audits; assistance to independent
public accountants; and litigation support to company counsel. Payments of fees
to and receipt of services from Sonic Financial ceased before the
Reorganization. Since that time, the Company has been providing these services
for itself and its subsidiaries, including Town and Country Ford.
     Beginning in early 1997, certain of the Sonic Dealerships have entered into
arrangements to sell to their customers credit life insurance policies
underwritten by American Heritage Life Insurance Company, an insurer
unaffiliated with Sonic ("American Heritage"). American Heritage in turn
reinsures all of these policies with Provident American Insurance Company, a
Texas insurance company ("Provident American"). Under these arrangements, the
Sonic Dealerships paid an aggregate of $140,000 to American Heritage in premiums
for these policies since January 1, 1997. The Company anticipates terminating
this arrangement with American Heritage by 1998. Provident American is a
wholly-owned subsidiary of Sonic Financial.
     Town & Country Ford and Lone Star Ford have each made several non-interest
bearing advances to Sonic Financial. As of June 30, 1997, Town & Country Ford
had made approximately $2.1 million of such advances. In preparation for the
Reorganization, a demand promissory note by Sonic Financial evidencing certain
of Town & Country Ford's advances in the amount of $1.6 million was canceled in
exchange for the redemption of certain shares of the capital stock of Town &
Country Ford held by Sonic Financial. As of June 30, 1997, Lone Star Ford had
made approximately $0.5 million of advances to Sonic Financial. In preparation
for the Reorganization, a demand promissory note by Sonic Financial evidencing
certain of Lone Star Ford's advances in the amount of $363,000 was canceled
pursuant to a dividend. At years ended December 31, 1996, 1995 and 1994, the
aggregate balances of such advances due from Sonic Financial were approximately
$2.5 million, $0 and $0, respectively.
     Certain subsidiaries of the Company (such subsidiaries together with the
Company and Sonic Financial being hereinafter referred to as the "Sonic Group")
have joined with Sonic Financial in filing consolidated federal income tax
returns for several years. Such subsidiaries will join with Sonic Financial in
filing for 1996 and for the period ending on June 30, 1997. Under applicable
federal tax law, each corporation included in Sonic Financial's consolidated
return is jointly and severally liable for any resultant tax. Under a tax
allocation agreement dated as of June 30, 1997, however, the Company agreed to
pay to Sonic Financial, in the event that additional federal income tax is
determined to be due, an amount equal to the Company's separate federal income
tax liability computed for all periods in which any member of the Sonic Group
has been a member of Sonic Financial's consolidated group less amounts
previously recorded by the Company. Also pursuant to such agreement, Sonic
Financial agreed to indemnify the Company for any additional amount determined
to be due from Sonic Financial's consolidated group in excess of the federal
income tax liability of the Sonic Group for such periods. The tax allocation
                                       68
 
<PAGE>
agreement establishes procedures with respect to tax adjustments, tax claims,
tax refunds, tax credits and other tax attributes relating to periods ending
prior to the time that the Sonic Group shall leave Sonic Financial's
consolidated group.
     The Company acquired the Sonic Dealerships in the Reorganization pursuant
to four separate stock subscription agreements (the "Subscription Agreements").
The Subscription Agreements provide for the acquisition of 100% of the capital
stock or membership interests, as the case may be, of each of the Sonic
Dealerships from Sonic Financial, Mr. Smith, the Egan Group (an assignee of Mr.
Egan) and Bryan Scott Smith in exchange for certain amounts of the Company's
issued and outstanding Class B Common Stock. See "Principal Stockholders."
     For additional information concerning related party transactions of the
Company, see Note (7) to the Combined and Consolidated Financial Statements of
Sonic and for the businesses being acquired in the Acquisitions, see "The
Acquisitions" and the notes to the historical financial statements for each
respective business acquired included in this Prospectus.
                                       69
<PAGE>
                             PRINCIPAL STOCKHOLDERS
     The following table sets forth certain information regarding the beneficial
ownership of the Company's Common Stock as of October 10, 1997 by (i) each
stockholder who is known by the Company to own beneficially more than five
percent of the outstanding Common Stock, (ii) each director of the Company,
(iii) each executive officer of the Company, and (iv) all directors and
executive officers of the Company as a group, and as adjusted to reflect the
sale by the Company of the shares of Class A Common Stock in this Offering.
Prior to this Offering, no shares of Class A Common Stock were issued and
outstanding. However, options to acquire 587,509 shares of Class A Common Stock
will be issued on or before the closing of the Offering to certain of the
Company's officers and employees, and the Dyer Warrant will be issued upon the
closing of the Dyer Acquisition. Holders of Class A Common Stock are entitled to
one vote per share on all matters submitted to a vote of the stockholders of the
Company. Holders of Class B Common Stock are entitled to ten votes per share on
all matters submitted to a vote of the stockholders, except that the Class B
Common Stock is entitled to only one vote per share with respect to any
transaction proposed or approved by the Board of Directors of the Company or
proposed by all the holders of the Class B Common Stock or as to which any
member of the Smith Group or any affiliate thereof has a material financial
interest other than as a then existing stockholder of the Company constituting a
(a) "going private" transaction (as defined herein), (b) disposition of
substantially all of the Company's assets, (c) transfer resulting in a change in
the nature of the Company's business, or (d) merger or consolidation in which
current holders of Common Stock would own less than 50% of the Common Stock
following such transaction. In the event of any transfer outside of the Smith
Group or the Smith Group holds less than 15% of the total number of shares of
Common Stock outstanding, such transferred shares or all shares, respectively,
of Class B Common Stock will automatically convert into an equal number of
shares of Class A Common Stock. See "Description of Capital Stock."
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                               Percentage of all
                                                                                                                  Outstanding
                                                                                                                  Common Stock
                                                                   Number of Shares     Number of Shares     ----------------------
                                                                   of Class A Common    of Class B Common     Before       After
Name (1)                                                              Stock Owned          Stock Owned       Offering   Offering(2)
- ----------                                                         -----------------    -----------------    --------   -----------
<S>                                                                <C>                  <C>                  <C>        <C>
O. Bruton Smith (3)(4)..........................................             --             5,476,250           87.6%       48.7%
Sonic Financial Corporation (3).................................             --             4,440,625           71.1%       39.5%
Bryan Scott Smith (3)(5)........................................             --               478,125            7.7%        4.3%
William R. Brooks (3)...........................................             --                    --          --          --
Theodore M. Wright (3)(5).......................................             --                    --          --          --
Nelson E. Bowers, II (3)(5).....................................             --                    --          --          --
All directors and executive officers as a group (10 persons)....             --             5,954,375          95.27%       52.9%
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Unless otherwise noted, each person has sole voting and investment power
    over the shares listed opposite his name subject to community property laws
    where applicable.
(2) The percentages of total voting power would be as follows: Bruton Smith,
    81.1%; Sonic Financial, 65.8%; Scott Smith, 7.1%; William Brooks, less than
    1%; Theodore Wright, less than 1%; Nelson E. Bowers, II, less than 1%; and
    all directors and executive officers as a group, 88.2%. Assumes the
    Underwriters' over-allotment option is not exercised.
(3) The address of such person is care of the Company at 5401 East Independence
    Boulevard, Charlotte, North Carolina 28218.
(4) The shares of Common Stock shown as owned by such person or group include
    all of the shares owned by Sonic Financial as indicated elsewhere in the
    table. Mr. Smith owns the substantial majority of Sonic Financial's
    outstanding capital stock.
(5) Does not give effect to options granted under the Company's Stock Option
    Plan to purchase shares of Class A Common Stock at the public offering price
    since none of such options become exercisable prior to October 1998. See
    "Management -- Stock Option Plan."
                                       70
 
<PAGE>
                          DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK
     The Company's authorized capital stock consists of (i) 50,000,000 shares of
Class A Common Stock, $.01 par value, (ii) 15,000,000 shares of Class B Common
Stock, $.01 par value, and (iii) 3,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock, $.10 par
value. Upon completion of this Offering, the Company will have 5,000,000
outstanding shares of Class A Common Stock and 6,250,000 outstanding shares of
Class B Common Stock and no outstanding shares of preferred stock (assuming the
Underwriters' over-allotment option is not exercised).
     The following summary description of the Company's capital stock does not
purport to be complete and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the
Company's Certificate, which is filed as an exhibit to the Registration
Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part, and Delaware Law. Reference is
made to such exhibit and Delaware Law for a detailed description of the
provisions thereof summarized below.
Common Stock
     The Company's Class A Common Stock and Class B Common Stock are equal in
all respects except for voting rights, conversion rights of the Class B Common
Stock and as required by law, as discussed more fully below.
  Voting Rights; Conversion of Class B Common Stock to Class A Common Stock
     The voting powers, preferences and relative rights of the Class A Common
Stock and the Class B Common Stock are subject to the following provisions.
Holders of Class A Common Stock have one vote per share on all matters submitted
to a vote of the stockholders of the Company. Holders of Class B Common Stock
are entitled to ten votes per share except as described below. Holders of all
classes of Common Stock entitled to vote will vote together as a single class on
all matters presented to the stockholders for their vote or approval except as
otherwise required by Delaware Law. There is no cumulative voting with respect
to the election of directors. In the event any shares of Class B Common Stock
held by a member of the Smith Group (as defined below) are transferred outside
of the Smith Group, such shares will automatically be converted into shares of
Class A Common Stock. In addition, if the total number of shares of Common Stock
held by members of the Smith Group is less than 15% of the total number of
shares of Common Stock outstanding, all of the outstanding shares of Class B
Common Stock automatically will be reclassified as Class A Common Stock. In any
merger, consolidation or business combination, the consideration to be received
per share by holders of Class A Common Stock must be identical to that received
by holders of Class B Common Stock, except that in any such transaction in which
shares of common stock are distributed, such shares may differ as to voting
rights to the extent that voting rights now differ between the classes of Common
Stock.
     Notwithstanding the foregoing, the holders of Class A Common Stock and
Class B Common Stock vote as a single class, with each share of each class
entitled to one vote per share, with respect to any transaction proposed or
approved by the Board of Directors of the Company or proposed by or on behalf of
holders of the Class B Common Stock or as to which any member of the Smith Group
or any affiliate thereof has a material financial interest other than as a then
existing stockholder of the Company constituting a (a) "going private"
transaction, (b) sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of the
Company's assets, (c) sale or transfer which would cause the nature of the
Company's business to be no longer primarily oriented toward automobile
dealership operations and related activities or (d) merger or consolidation of
the Company in which the holders of the Common Stock will own less than 50% of
the Common Stock following such transaction. A "going private" transaction is
defined as any "Rule 13e-3 Transaction," as such term is defined in Rule 13e-3
promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. An "affiliate" is defined
as (i) any individual or entity who or that, directly or indirectly, controls,
is controlled by, or is under common control with any member of the Smith Group,
(ii) any corporation or organization (other than the Company or a majority-owned
subsidiary of the Company) of which any member of the Smith Group is an officer
partner or is, directly or indirectly, the beneficial owner of 10% or more of
any class of voting securities, or in which any member of the Smith Group has a
substantial beneficial interest, (iii) a voting trust or similar arrangement
pursuant to which any member of the Smith Group generally controls the vote of
the shares of Common Stock held by or subject to such trust or arrangement, (iv)
any other trust or estate in which any member of the Smith Group has a
substantial beneficial interest or as to which any member of the Smith Group
serves as trustee or in a similar fiduciary capacity, or (v) any relative or
spouse of any member of the Smith Group or any relative of such spouse, who has
the same residence as any member of the Smith Group.
     As used in this Prospectus, the term the "Smith Group" consists of the
following persons: (i) Mr. Smith and his guardian, conservator, committee, or
attorney-in-fact; (ii) William S. Egan and his guardian, conservator, committee,
or attorney-in-fact; (iii) each lineal descendant of Messrs. Smith and Egan (a
"Descendant") and their respective guardians, conservators,
                                       71
 
<PAGE>
committees or attorneys-in-fact; and (iv) each "Family Controlled Entity" (as
defined below). The term "Family Controlled Entity" means (i) any not-for-profit
corporation if at least 80% of its board of directors is composed of Mr. Smith,
Mr. Egan and/or Descendants; (ii) any other corporation if at least 80% of the
value of its outstanding equity is owned by members of the Smith Group; (iii)
any partnership if at least 80% of the value of the partnership interests are
owned by members of the Smith Group; and (iv) any limited liability or similar
company if at least 80% of the value of the company is owned by members of the
Smith Group. For a discussion of the effects of the disproportionate voting
rights of the Common Stock, see "Risk Factors -- Concentration of Voting Power
and Antitakeover Provisions."
     Under the Company's Certificate and Delaware Law, the holders of Class A
Common Stock and/or Class B Common Stock are each entitled to vote as a separate
class, as applicable, with respect to any amendment to the Company's Certificate
that would increase or decrease the aggregate number of authorized shares of
such class, increase or decrease the par value of the shares of such class, or
modify or change the powers, preferences or special rights of the shares of such
class so as to affect such class adversely.
  Dividends
     Holders of the Class A Common Stock and the Class B Common Stock are
entitled to receive ratably such dividends, if any, as are declared by the
Company's Board of Directors out of funds legally available for that purpose,
provided, that dividends paid in shares of Class A Common Stock or Class B
Common Stock shall be paid only as follows: shares of Class A Common Stock shall
be paid only to holders of Class A Common Stock and shares of Class B Common
Stock shall be paid only to holders of Class B Common Stock. The Company's
Certificate provides that if there is any dividend, subdivision, combination or
reclassification of either class of Common Stock, a proportionate dividend,
subdivision, combination or reclassification of the other class of Common Stock
shall simultaneously be made.
  Other Rights
     Stockholders of the Company have no preemptive or other rights to subscribe
for additional shares. In the event of the liquidation, dissolution or winding
up of the Company, holders of Class A Common Stock and Class B Common Stock are
entitled to share ratably in all assets available for distribution to holders of
Common Stock after payment in full of creditors. No shares of any class of
Common Stock are subject to a redemption or a sinking fund. All outstanding
shares of Common Stock are, and all shares offered by this Prospectus will be,
when sold, validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.
  Transfer Agent and Registrar
     The Company has appointed First Union National Bank as the transfer agent
and registrar for the Class A Common Stock. The Company has not appointed a
transfer agent for the Class B Common Stock.
Preferred Stock
     No shares of preferred stock are outstanding. The Company's Certificate
authorizes the Board of Directors to issue up to 3,000,000 shares of preferred
stock in one or more series and to establish such designations and such relative
voting, dividend, liquidation, conversion and other rights, preferences and
limitations as the Board of Directors may determine without further approval of
the stockholders of the Company. The issuance of preferred stock by the Board of
Directors could, among other things, adversely affect the voting power of the
holders of Class A Common Stock and, under certain circumstances, make it more
difficult for a person or group to gain control of the Company. See "Risk
Factors -- Concentration of Voting Power and Anti-takeover Provisions."
     The issuance of any series of preferred stock, and the relative
designations, rights, preferences and limitations of such series, if and when
established, will depend upon, among other things, the future capital needs of
the Company, the then-existing market conditions and other factors that, in the
judgment of the Board of Directors, might warrant the issuance of preferred
stock. At the date of this Prospectus, there are no plans, agreements or
understandings for the issuance of any shares of preferred stock.
Delaware Law, Certain Charter and Bylaw Provisions and Certain Franchise
Agreement Provisions
     Certain provisions of Delaware Law and of the Company's Certificate and
Bylaws, summarized in the following paragraphs, may be considered to have an
antitakeover effect and may delay, deter or prevent a tender offer, proxy
contest or other takeover attempt that a stockholder might consider to be in
such stockholder's best interest, including such an attempt as might result in
payment of a premium over the market price for shares held by stockholders.
                                       72
 
<PAGE>
     Delaware Antitakeover Law. The Company, a Delaware corporation, is subject
to the provisions of Delaware Law, including Section 203. In general, Section
203 prohibits a public Delaware corporation from engaging in a "business
combination" with an "interested stockholder" for a period of three years after
the date of the transaction in which such person became an interested
stockholder unless: (i) prior to such date, the Board of Directors approved
either the business combination or the transaction which resulted in the
stockholder becoming an interested stockholder; or (ii) upon becoming an
interested stockholder, the stockholder then owned at least 85% of the voting
stock, as defined in Section 203; or (iii) subsequent to such date, the business
combination is approved by both the Board of Directors and by holders of at
least 66 2/3% of the corporation's outstanding voting stock, excluding shares
owned by the interested stockholder. For these purposes, the term "business
combination" includes mergers, asset sales and other similar transactions with
an "interested stockholder." An "interested stockholder" is a person who,
together with affiliates and associates, owns (or, within the prior three years,
did own) 15% or more of the corporation's voting stock. Although Section 203
permits a corporation to elect not to be governed by its provisions, the Company
to date has not made this election.
     Classified Board of Directors. The Company's Bylaws provide for the Board
of Directors to be divided into three classes of directors serving staggered
three-year terms. As a result, approximately one-third of the Board of Directors
will be elected each year. Classification of the Board of Directors expands the
time required to change the composition of a majority of directors and may tend
to discourage a takeover bid for the Company. Moreover, under Delaware Law, in
the case of a corporation having a classified board of directors, the
stockholders may remove a director only for cause. This provision, when coupled
with the provision of the Bylaws authorizing only the board of directors to fill
vacant directorships, will preclude stockholders of the Company from removing
incumbent directors without cause, simultaneously gaining control of the Board
of Directors by filing the vacancies with their own nominees. See
"Mangement -- Executive Officers and Directors; Key Personnel."
     Special Meetings of Stockholders. The Company's Bylaws provide that special
meetings of stockholders may be called only by the Chairman or by the Secretary
or any Assistant Secretary at the request in writing of a majority of the Board
of Directors of the Company. The Company's Bylaws also provide that no action
required to be taken or that may be taken at any annual or special meeting of
stockholders may be taken without a meeting; the powers of stockholders to
consent in writing, without a meeting, to the taking of any action is
specifically denied. These provisions may make it more difficult for
stockholders to take action opposed by the Board of Directors.
     Advance Notice Requirements for Stockholder Proposals and Director
Nominations. The Company's Bylaws provide that stockholders seeking to bring
business before an annual meeting of stockholders, or to nominate candidates for
election as directors at an annual or a special meeting of stockholders, must
provide timely notice thereof in writing. To be timely, a stockholder's notice
must be delivered to, or mailed and received at, the principal executive office
of the Company, (i) in the case of an annual meeting that is called for a date
that is within 30 days before or after the anniversary date of the immediately
preceding annual meeting of stockholders, not less than 60 days nor more than 90
days prior to such anniversary date, and, (ii) in the case of an annual meeting
that is called for a date that is not within 30 days before or after the
anniversary date of the immediately preceding annual meeting, or in the case of
a special meeting of stockholders called for the purpose of electing directors,
not later than the close of business on the tenth day following the day on which
notice of the date of the meeting was mailed or public disclosure of the date of
the meeting was made, whichever occurs first. The Bylaws also specify certain
requirements for a stockholder's notice to be in proper written form. These
provisions may preclude some stockholders from bringing matters before the
stockholders at an annual or special meeting or from making nominations for
directors at an annual or special meeting.
     Conflict of Interest Procedures. The Company's Certificate contains
provisions providing that transactions between the Company and its affiliates
must be no less favorable to the Company than would be available in transactions
involving arms'-length dealing with unrelated third parties. Moreover, any such
transaction involving aggregate payments in excess of $500,000 must be approved
by a majority of the Company's directors and a majority of the Company's
independent directors. Otherwise, the Company must obtain an opinion as to the
financial fairness of the transactions to be issued by an investment banking or
appraisal firm of national standing.
     Restrictions under Franchise Agreements. The Company's franchise agreements
impose restrictions on the transfer of the Common Stock. A number of
Manufacturers prohibit transactions which affect changes in management control
of the Company. For instance, Ford may cause the Company to sell or resign from
its Ford franchises if any person or entity acquires 15% or more of the
Company's voting securities. Likewise, General Motors, Toyota and Infiniti may
force the sale of their respective franchises if 20% or more of the Company's
voting securities are so acquired. Honda may force the sale of the Company's
Honda franchise if any person or entity, other than members of the Smith Group,
acquires 5% of the Common
                                       73
 
<PAGE>
Stock (10% if such entity is an institutional investor), and Honda deems such
person or entity to be unsatisfactory. Volkswagen has approved of the public
sale of only 25% of the voting control of the Company and requires prior
approval of any change in control or management of the Company that would affect
the Company's control or management of its Volkswagen franchisee subsidiaries.
Chrysler also has approved of the public sale of only 50% of the Common Stock
and requires prior approval of any future sales that would result in a change in
voting or managerial control of the Company. Such restrictions may prevent or
deter prospective acquirers from obtaining control of the Company. See "Risk
Factors -- Stock Ownership/Issuance Limits; Limitation on Ability to Issue
Additional Equity" and "Business -- Relationships with Manufacturers."
                                       74
 
<PAGE>
                        SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
     Upon completion of this Offering, the Company will have outstanding
5,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock (assuming no exercise of the
Underwriters' over-allotment option). All of such shares will be freely
transferable and may be resold without further registration under the Securities
Act, except for any shares purchased by an "affiliate" of the Company (as
defined by Rule 144), which shares will be subject to the resale limitations of
Rule 144. The 6,250,000 shares (the "Restricted Shares") of Class B Common Stock
outstanding, which are convertible into Class A Common Stock, are "restricted"
securities within the meaning of Rule 144 irrespective of whether the conversion
right is exercised. The 629,696 shares of Class A Common Stock, which underlie
options to be granted on or before the closing of the Offering under the
Company's Stock Option Plan and the Dyer Warrant, may be resold only pursuant to
a registration statement under the Securities Act or an applicable exemption
from registration thereunder such as an exemption provided by Rule 144.
     In general, under Rule 144 as currently in effect, a person (or persons
whose shares are aggregated) who has beneficially owned "restricted securities"
for at least one year may, under certain circumstances, resell within any
three-month period, such number of shares as does not exceed the greater of one
percent of the then-outstanding shares of Class A Common Stock or the average
weekly trading volume of Class A Common Stock during the four calendar weeks
prior to such resale. Rule 144 also permits, under certain circumstances, the
resale of shares without any quantity limitation by a person who has satisfied a
two-year holding period and who is not, and has not been for the preceding three
months, an affiliate of the Company. In addition, holding periods of successive
non-affiliate owners are aggregated for purposes of determining compliance with
these one- and two-year holding period requirements.
     Upon completion of this Offering, none of the 6,250,000 shares of Class B
Common Stock outstanding on the date of this Prospectus will have been held for
at least one year. Since all such shares are restricted securities, none of them
may be resold pursuant to Rule 144 upon completion of this Offering. Any
transfer of shares of the Class B Common Stock to any person other than a member
of the Smith Group will result in a conversion of such shares to Class A Common
Stock.
     The Restricted Shares will not be eligible for sale under Rule 144 until
the expiration of the one-year holding period from the date such Restricted
Shares were acquired.
     The availability of shares for sale or actual sales under Rule 144 and the
perception that such shares may be sold may have a material adverse effect on
the market price of the Class A Common Stock. Sales under Rule 144 also could
impair the Company's ability to market additional equity securities.
     Additionally, the Company has entered into the Registration Rights
Agreement with Sonic Financial, Bruton Smith, Scott Smith and William Egan. The
Registration Rights Agreement provides piggyback registration rights with
respect to 6,250,000 shares of Common Stock in the aggregate. For further
information regarding the Registration Rights Agreement, see "Certain
Transactions -- Registration Rights Agreements."
     The Company, all of the executive officers of the Company and the holders
of Class B Common Stock have agreed, subject to certain exceptions, not,
directly or indirectly, to (i) offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any
option or contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant
any option to purchase, right or warrant to purchase, or otherwise transfer or
dispose of any Class A Common Stock or securities convertible into or
exchangeable or exercisable for Class A Common Stock, including shares of Class
B Common Stock, or file a registration statement under the Securities Act with
respect to the foregoing, or (ii) enter into any swap or other agreement or
transaction that transfers, in whole or part, directly or indirectly, the
economic consequences of ownership of the Class A Common Stock, whether any such
swap or transaction described above is to be settled by delivery of Class A
Common Stock or such other securities, in cash or otherwise, for 180 days from
the date of this Prospectus without the prior written consent of Merrill Lynch;
provided that the Company may sell shares of Class A Common Stock to a third
party as consideration for the Company's acquisition from such third party of an
automobile dealership, so long as such third party executes a lock up agreement
on substantially the same terms described above for a period expiring 180 days
after the date of this Prospectus.
                                       75
 
<PAGE>
                       CERTAIN UNITED STATES FEDERAL TAX
                  CONSIDERATIONS FOR NON-UNITED STATES HOLDERS
     The following is a general discussion of certain United States federal
income and estate tax considerations with respect to the ownership and
disposition of Class A Common Stock applicable to Non-U.S. Holders. In general,
a "Non-U.S. Holder" is any holder other than (i) a citizen or resident of the
United States, (ii) a corporation or partnership created or organized in the
United States or under the laws of the United States or of any state (other than
any partnership treated as foreign under U.S. Treasury regulations), or (iii) an
estate or trust, the income of which is includable in gross income for United
States federal income tax purposes regardless of its source. This discussion is
based on current law, which is subject to change (possibly with retroactive
effect), and is for general information only. This discussion does not address
aspects of United States federal taxation other than income and estate taxation
and does not address all aspects of income and estate taxation or any aspects of
state, local or non-United States taxes, nor does it consider any specific facts
or circumstances that may apply to a particular Non-U.S. Holder (including
certain U.S. expatriates), and including the fact that in the case of a Non-U.S.
Holder that is a partnership, the U.S. tax consequences of holding and disposing
of shares of Common Stock may be affected by certain determinations made at the
partner level. This discussion also does not consider the tax consequences to
any person who is a shareholder, partner or beneficiary of a holder of Common
Stock. ACCORDINGLY, PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS ARE URGED TO CONSULT THEIR TAX
ADVISORS REGARDING THE UNITED STATES FEDERAL, STATE, LOCAL AND NON-UNITED STATES
INCOME AND OTHER TAX CONSIDERATIONS OF HOLDING AND DISPOSING OF SHARES OF CLASS
A COMMON STOCK.
     An individual may, subject to certain exceptions, be deemed to be a
resident alien (as opposed to a non-resident alien) by virtue of being present
in the United States for at least 31 days in the calendar year and for an
aggregate of at least 183 days during a three year period ending in the current
calendar year (counting for such purposes all of the days present in the current
year, one-third of the days present in the immediately preceding year, and
one-sixth of the days present in the second preceding year). Resident aliens are
subject to U.S. federal income tax as if they were U.S. citizens.
Dividends
     In general, dividends paid to a Non-U.S. Holder will be subject to United
States withholding tax at a 30% rate of the gross amount (or a lower rate
prescribed by an applicable income tax treaty) unless the dividends are either
(i) effectively connected with a trade or business carried on by the Non-U.S.
Holder within the United States, or (ii) if certain income tax treaties apply,
attributable to a permanent establishment in the United States maintained by the
Non-U.S. Holder. Dividends effectively connected with such a United States trade
or business or attributable to such a United States permanent establishment
generally will not be subject to United States withholding tax if the Non-U.S.
Holder files certain forms, including Internal Revenue Service Form 4224, with
the payor of the dividend, and generally will be subject to United States
federal income tax on a net income basis, in the same manner as if the Non-U.S.
Holder were a resident of the United States. A Non-U.S. Holder that is a
corporation may be subject to an additional branch profits tax at a rate of 30%
(or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty) on
the repatriation from the United States of its "effectively connected earnings
and profits," subject to certain adjustments. To determine the applicability of
a tax treaty providing for a lower rate of withholding, dividends paid to an
address in a foreign country are presumed under current Treasury regulations to
be paid to a resident of that country absent knowledge to the contrary. Recently
finalized Treasury regulations (the "Final Regulations"), which are to be
effective for payments made after December 31, 1998, however, generally would
require Non-U.S. Holders to file an I.R.S. Form W-8 to obtain the benefit of any
applicable tax treaty providing for a lower rate of withholding tax on
dividends. In addition, under the Final Regulations, in the case of Common Stock
held by a foreign partnership, (i) the certification requirements would
generally be applied to each partner, and (ii) the partnership would be required
to provide certain information, including a U.S. taxpayer identification number.
A look through rule will apply in the case of tiered partnerships. A Non-U.S.
Holder that is eligible for a reduced rate of U.S. withholding tax pursuant to a
tax treaty may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld by filing an
appropriate claim for refund with the Internal Revenue Service.
Gain on Sale or Other Disposition of Class A Common Stock
     In general, a Non-U.S. Holder will not be subject to United States federal
income tax on any gain realized upon the sale or other disposition of such
holder's shares of Class A Common Stock unless (i) the gain either is effective
connected with a trade or business carried on by the non-U.S. Holder within the
United States or, if certain income tax treaties apply, is attributable to a
permanent establishment in the United States maintained by the Non-U.S. Holder
(and, in either case, the branch profits tax discussed above may also apply if
the Non-U.S. Holder is a corporation); (ii) the Non-U.S. Holder is an individual
who holds shares of Class A Common Stock as a capital asset and is present in
the United States for 183 days or
                                       76
 
<PAGE>
more in the taxable year of disposition, and either (a) such individual has a
"tax home" (as defined for United States federal income tax purposes) in the
United States (unless the gain from the disposition is attributable to an office
or other fixed place of business maintained by such Non-U.S. Holder in a foreign
country and such gain has been subject to a foreign income tax equal to at least
10% of the gain derived form such disposition), or (b) the gain is attributable
to an office or other fixed place of business maintained by such individual in
the United States; or (iii) the Company is or has been a United States real
property holding corporation (a "USRPHC") for United States federal income tax
purposes (which the Company does not believe that it is or is likely to become)
at any time within the shorter of the five year period preceding such
disposition or such Non-U.S. Holder's holding period. If the Company were or
were to become a USRPHC at any time during this period, gains realized upon a
disposition of Class A Common Stock by a Non-U.S. Holder which did not directly
or indirectly own more than 5% of the Class A Common Stock during this period
generally would not be subject to United States federal income tax, provided
that the Class A Common Stock is regularly traded on an established securities
market.
Estate Tax
     Class A Common Stock owned or treated as owned by an individual who is not
a citizen or resident (as defined for United States federal estate tax purposes)
of the United States at the time of death will be includable in the individual's
gross estate for United States federal estate tax purposes unless an applicable
estate tax treaty provides otherwise, and therefore may be subject to United
States federal estate tax.
Backup Withholding, Information Reporting and Other Reporting Requirements
     The Company must report annually to the Internal Revenue Service and to
each Non-U.S. Holder the amount of dividends paid to, and the tax withheld with
respect to, each Non-U.S. Holder. These reporting requirements apply regardless
of whether withholding was reduced or eliminated by an applicable tax treaty.
Copies of this information also may be made available under the provisions of a
specific treaty or agreement with the tax authorities in the country in which
the Non-U.S. Holder resides or is established.
     Under certain circumstances, the IRS requires additional information
reporting and "backup withholding" at a rate of 31% with respect to certain
payments on Common Stock. Non-U.S. Holders of Common Stock generally would be
exempt from these IRS information reporting requirements and backup withholding
with respect to dividends payable on Common Stock.
     Under the Final Regulations (which are to be effective for payments made
after December 31, 1998) as a general matter, a withholding agent (whether U.S.
or foreign) must ascertain whether the payee is a U.S. or foreign person.
Determinations of payee status are generally made at each level of the chain of
payment, until, ultimately, the payment is made to the beneficial owner. In the
case of dividends and gross proceeds from publicly traded stocks, special rules
address the treatment of payments to foreign intermediaries (nominees, agents,
etc.) which govern when and how intermediaries can certify as to payee status on
behalf of a beneficial owner. If, under the Final Regulations, the withholding
agent must treat the payee as a foreign person, the withholding provisions
discussed above under "Dividends" (i.e., the 30% withholding tax regime) will
apply. Generally, to the extent such withholding is required, or is excused
based on documentation that must be provided, the information reporting and the
backup withholding requirements will not apply. See the discussion above under
"Dividends" with respect to the rules applicable to foreign partnerships under
the Final Regulations.
     Under current regulations, the payment of proceeds from the disposition of
Class A Common Stock to or through a United States office of a broker will be
subject to information reporting and backup withholding unless the beneficial
owner, under penalties of perjury, certifies, among other things, its status as
a Non-U.S. Holder or otherwise establishes an exemption. The payment of proceeds
from the disposition of Class A Common Stock to or through a non-U.S. office of
a non-U.S. broker generally will not be subject to backup withholding and
information reporting. However, in the case of proceeds from a disposition of
Class A Common Stock paid to or through a non-U.S. office of a broker that is
(i) a United States person, (ii) a "controlled foreign corporation" for United
States federal income tax purposes, or (iii) a foreign person 50% or more of
whose gross income from certain periods is effectively connected with a United
States trade or business, information reporting (but not backup withholding)
will apply unless the broker has documentary evidence in its files that the
owner is a Non-U.S. Holder (and the broker has no actual knowledge to the
contrary).
     Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld under the
backup withholding rules from a payment to a Non-U.S. Holder will be refunded or
credited against the Non-U.S. Holder's United States federal income tax
liability, if any, provided that the required information is furnished to the
Internal Revenue Service in a timely manner.
                                       77
 
<PAGE>
                                  UNDERWRITING
     Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated ("Merrill Lynch"),
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc. and Wheat, First Securities, Inc. are
acting as representatives (the "U.S. Representatives") of each of the
Underwriters named below (the "U.S. Underwriters"). Subject to the terms and
conditions set forth in a U.S. purchase agreement (the "U.S. Purchase
Agreement") among the Company and the U.S. Underwriters, and concurrently with
the sale of 1,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock to the International
Managers (as defined below), the Company has agreed to sell to the U.S.
Underwriters, and each of the U.S. Underwriters severally and not jointly has
agreed to purchase from the Company, the number of shares of Class A Common
Stock set forth opposite its name below.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                    Number of
             U.S. Underwriter                                                                                         Shares
                                                                                                                    ----------
<S>                                                                                                                 <C>
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
             Incorporated........................................................................................
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc...........................................................................
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.....................................................................................
                                                                                                                    ----------
             Total...............................................................................................    4,000,000
                                                                                                                    ----------
                                                                                                                    ----------
</TABLE>
 
     The Company has also entered into an international purchase agreement (the
"International Purchase Agreement") with certain underwriters outside the United
States and Canada (the "International Managers" and, together with the U.S.
Underwriters, the "Underwriters") for whom Merrill Lynch International,
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc. and Wheat, First Securities, Inc. are
acting as lead managers (the "Lead Managers"). Subject to the terms and
conditions set forth in the International Purchase Agreement, and concurrently
with the sale of 4,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock to the U.S.
Underwriters pursuant to the U.S. Purchase Agreement, the Company has agreed to
sell to the International Managers, and the International Managers severally and
not jointly have agreed to purchase from the Company, an aggregate of 1,000,000
shares of Class A Common Stock. The initial public offering price per share and
the underwriting discount per share of Class A Common Stock are identical under
the U.S. Purchase Agreement and the International Purchase Agreement.
     In the U.S. Purchase Agreement and the International Purchase Agreement,
the several U.S. Underwriters and the several International Managers,
respectively, have agreed, subject to the terms and conditions set forth
therein, to purchase all of the shares of Class A Common Stock being sold
pursuant to each such agreement if any of the shares of Class A Common Stock
being sold pursuant to such agreement are purchased. Under certain
circumstances, under the U.S. Purchase Agreement and the International Purchase
Agreement, the commitments of non-defaulting Underwriters may be increased. The
closings with respect to the sale of shares of Class A Common Stock to be
purchased by the U.S. Underwriters and International Managers are conditioned
upon one another.
     The U.S. Representatives have advised the Company that the U.S.
Underwriters propose initially to offer the shares of Class A Common Stock to
the public at the initial public offering price set forth on the cover page of
this Prospectus and to certain dealers at such price less a concession not in
excess of $       per share of Class A Common Stock. The U.S. Underwriters may
allow, and such dealers may reallow, a discount not in excess of $       per
share of Class A Common Stock to certain other dealers. After the initial public
offering, the public offering price, concession and discount may be changed.
     At the request of the Company, the Underwriters have reserved up to 5% of
the shares of Class A Common Stock for sale at the initial public offering
price, and otherwise on the same terms as sales pursuant to the Offering, to
directors, officers, employees, business associates and related persons of the
Company. The number of shares of Class A Common Stock available for sale to the
general public will be reduced to the extent such persons purchase such reserved
shares. Any
                                       78
 
<PAGE>
reserved shares which are not so purchased will be offered by the Underwriters
to the general public on the same basis as the other shares offered hereby.
     The Company, all of the executive officers of the Company and all the
holders of Class B Common Stock have agreed, subject to certain exceptions, not
to, directly or indirectly, (i) offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any
option or contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant
any option to purchase, right or warrant to purchase, or otherwise transfer or
dispose of any Class A Common Stock or securities convertible into or
exchangeable or exercisable for Class A Common Stock, including shares of Class
B Common Stock, or file a registration statement under the Securities Act with
respect to the foregoing or (ii) enter into any swap or other agreement or
transaction that transfers, in whole or part, directly or indirectly, the
economic consequence of ownership of the Class A Common Stock, whether any such
swap or transaction described above is to be settled by delivery of Class A
Common Stock or such securities, in cash or otherwise, without the prior written
consent of Merrill Lynch on behalf of the Underwriters, for a period of 180 days
after the date of this Prospectus; provided that the Company may sell shares of
Class A Common Stock to a third party as consideration for the Company's
acquisition from such third party of an automobile dealership, provided that
such third party executes a lock-up agreement on substantially the same terms
described above for a period expiring 180 days after the date of this
Prospectus.
     The Company has granted an option to the U.S. Underwriters, exercisable
within 30 days after the date of this Prospectus, to purchase up to an aggregate
of 600,000 additional shares of Class A Common Stock at the initial public
offering price set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus, less the
underwriting discount. The U.S. Underwriters may exercise this option only to
cover over-allotments, if any, made on the sale of the Class A Common Stock
offered hereby. To the extent that the U.S. Underwriters exercise this option,
each U.S. Underwriter will be obligated, subject to certain conditions, to
purchase a number of additional shares of Class A Common Stock proportionate to
such U.S. Underwriter's initial amount reflected in the foregoing table. The
Company also has granted an option to the International Managers, exercisable
within 30 days after the date of this Prospectus, to purchase up to an aggregate
of 150,000 additional shares of Class A Common Stock to cover over-allotments,
if any, on terms similar to those granted to the U.S. Underwriters.
     The U.S. Underwriters and the International Managers have entered into an
intersyndicate agreement (the "Intersyndicate Agreement") that provides for the
coordination of their activities. Pursuant to the Intersyndicate Agreement, the
U.S. Underwriters and the International Managers are permitted to sell shares of
Class A Common Stock to each other for purposes of resale at the initial public
offering price, less an amount not greater than the selling concession. Under
the terms of the Intersyndicate Agreement, the U.S. Underwriters and any dealer
to whom they sell shares of Class A Common Stock will not offer to sell or sell
shares of Class A Common Stock to persons who are non-U.S. or non-Canadian
persons or to persons they believe intend to resell to persons who are non-U.S.
or non-Canadian persons, and the International Managers and any dealer to whom
they sell shares of Class A Common Stock will not offer to sell or sell shares
of Class A Common Stock to U.S. persons or to Canadian persons or to persons
they believe intend to resell to U.S. or Canadian persons, except in the case of
transactions pursuant to the Intersyndicate Agreement.
     Prior to the Offering, there has been no public market for the Class A
Common Stock. The initial public offering price for the Class A Common Stock
will be determined by negotiation among the Company, the U.S. Representatives
and the Lead Managers. The factors considered in determining the initial public
offering price, in addition to prevailing market conditions, are price-earnings
ratios of publicly traded companies that the U.S. Representatives and the Lead
Managers believe to be comparable to the Company, certain financial information
of the Company, the history of, and the prospects for, the Company and the
industry in which it competes, an assessment of the Company's management, its
past and present operations, the prospects for and the timing of future revenues
of the Company, the present state of the Company's development, and the above
factors in relation to market values and various valuation measures of other
companies engaged in activities similar to the Company. There can be no
assurance that an active trading market will develop for the Class A Common
Stock or that the Class A Common Stock will trade in the public market
subsequent to the Offering made hereby at or above the initial public Offering
price.
     The Company has agreed to indemnify the U.S. Underwriters and the
International Managers against certain liabilities, including liabilities under
the Securities Act, or to contribute to payments which the U.S. Underwriters and
the International Managers may be required to make in respect thereof.
     The Class A Common Stock has been approved for listing on the NYSE, subject
to official notice of issuance, under the symbol "SAH." In order to meet the
requirements for listing of the Class A Common Stock on that exchange, the U.S.
Underwriters and the International Managers have undertaken to sell lots of 100
or more shares to a minimum of 2,000 beneficial holders.
                                       79
 
<PAGE>
     The U.S. Underwriters and the International Managers do not intend to
confirm sales of Class A Common Stock offered hereby to any accounts over which
they exercise discretionary authority.
     Until the distribution of the Class A Common Stock is completed, rules of
the Securities and Exchange Commission may limit the ability of the Underwriters
and certain selling group members to bid for and purchase the Class A Common
Stock. As an exception to these rules, the U.S. Representatives are permitted to
engage in certain transactions that stabilize the price of Class A Common Stock.
Such transactions consist of bids or purchases for the purpose of pegging,
fixing or maintaining the price of the Class A Common Stock.
     If the Underwriters create a short position in the Class A Common Stock in
connection with the Offering, i.e., if they sell more shares of Class A Common
Stock than are set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus, the U.S.
Representatives may reduce that short position by purchasing Class A Common
Stock in the open market. The U.S. Representatives may also elect to reduce any
short position by exercising all or part of the over-allotment option described
above.
     The U.S. Representatives may also impose a penalty bid on certain
Underwriters and selling group members. This means that if the U.S.
Representatives purchase shares of Class A Common Stock in the open market to
reduce the Underwriters' short position or to stabilize the price of the Class A
Common Stock, they may reclaim the amount of the selling concession from the
Underwriters and selling group members who sold those shares as part of the
Offering.
     In general, purchases of a security for the purpose of stabilization or to
reduce a short position could cause the price of the security to be higher than
it might be in the absence of such purchases. The imposition of a penalty bid
might also have an effect on the price of a security to the extent that it were
to discourage resales of the security.
     Neither the Company nor any of the Underwriters makes any representation or
prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any effect that the transactions
described above may have on the price of the Class A Common Stock. In addition,
neither the Company nor any of the Underwriters makes any representation that
the U.S. Representatives will engage in such transactions or that such
transactions, once commenced, will not be discontinued without notice.
     NationsBank, an affiliate of NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.,
loaned the Company $20 million under the Six-Month Facility to finance the Lake
Norman Acquisition and the Williams Acquisition. More than 10% of the net
proceeds of the Offering will be received by NationsBank by reason of the use of
such proceeds to repay a portion of such borrowings. Accordingly, the Offering
will be conducted in accordance with NASD Conduct Rule 2710(c)(8), which
requires that the public offering price of the Class A Common Stock be no higher
than the price recommended by a Qualified Independent Underwriter which has
participated in the preparation of the Registration Statement and performed its
usual standard of due diligence with respect thereto. Merrill Lynch will act as
the Qualified Independent Underwriter for the Offering, and the public offering
price will not be higher than the price recommended by Merrill Lynch.
                                       80
 
<PAGE>
                                 LEGAL MATTERS
     Parker, Poe, Adams & Bernstein L.L.P., Charlotte, North Carolina, counsel
to the Company, will render an opinion that the shares of Class A Common Stock
offered hereby, when issued and paid for in accordance with the terms of the
Underwriting Agreement, will be duly authorized, validly issued, fully paid and
nonassessable. Fried, Frank, Harris, Shriver & Jacobson (a partnership including
professional corporations), New York, New York, has served as counsel to the
Underwriters in connection with this Offering.
                                    EXPERTS
     The combined and consolidated financial statements of Sonic Automotive,
Inc. and Affiliated Companies, the financial statements of Dyer & Dyer, Inc.,
the combined financial statements of Bowers Automotive Group, the combined
financial statements of Lake Norman Dodge, Inc. and Affiliated Companies, and
the financial statements of Ken Marks Ford, Inc. included in this Prospectus
have been audited by Deloitte & Touche LLP, independent auditors, as stated in
their reports appearing herein, and are included in reliance upon the reports of
such firm given upon their authority as experts in accounting and auditing.
                             ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
     The Company has filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the
"SEC") a Registration Statement on Form S-1 under the Securities Act with
respect to the shares of Class A Common Stock offered hereby. This Prospectus
does not contain all of the information set forth in the Registration Statement
and the exhibits and schedules thereto. For further information with respect to
the Company and the shares of Class A Common Stock offered hereby, reference is
made to the Registration Statement, including the exhibits and schedules filed
as part thereof. Statements contained in this Prospectus as to the contents of
any contract or any other documents are not necessarily complete, and, in each
such instance, reference is made to the copy of the contract or document filed
as an exhibit to the Registration Statement, each such statement being qualified
in all respects by such reference thereto. The Registration Statement, together
with its exhibits and schedules, may be inspected at the Public Reference
Section of the SEC at Room 1024, 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549,
and at the regional offices of the SEC located at 7 World Trade Center, Suite
1300, New York, New York 10048 and at the Northwestern Atrium Center, 500 West
Madison Street, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661. Copies of all or any part
of such materials may be obtained from any such office upon payment of the fees
prescribed by the SEC. Such information may also be inspected and copied at the
office of the NYSE at 20 Broad Street, New York, New York 10005. The Commission
also maintains a Website (http://www.sec.gov.) that contains reports, proxy and
information statements and other information regarding registrants that file
electronically with the SEC.
                                       81
 
<PAGE>
                         INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                         Page
                                                                                                                         -----
<S>                                                                                                                      <C>
SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC. AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES:
  INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT........................................................................................     F-2
  COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:
     Combined and Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 1995 and 1996 and unaudited at June 30, 1997............     F-3
     Combined and Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996 and unaudited
      for the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997.................................................................     F-4
     Combined and Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity for the years ended
       December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996 and unaudited for the six months ended June 30, 1997..........................     F-5
     Combined and Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996 and
      unaudited for the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997.......................................................     F-6
     Notes to Combined and Consolidated Financial Statements..........................................................     F-7
DYER & DYER, INC.:
  INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT........................................................................................    F-16
  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:
     Balance Sheets at December 31, 1995 and 1996 and unaudited at June 30, 1997......................................    F-17
     Statements of Income and Retained Earnings for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996 and unaudited for
      the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997.....................................................................    F-18
     Statements of Stockholder's Equity for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996 and unaudited for the six
      months ended June 30, 1997......................................................................................    F-19
     Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996 and unaudited for the six months
      ended June 30, 1996 and 1997....................................................................................    F-20
     Notes to Financial Statements....................................................................................    F-21
BOWERS DEALERSHIPS AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES:
  INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT........................................................................................    F-25
  COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:
     Combined Balance Sheets at December 31, 1995 and 1996 and unaudited at June 30, 1997.............................    F-26
     Combined Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1996 and unaudited for the six months
      ended June 30, 1996 and 1997....................................................................................    F-27
     Combined Statements of Stockholders' Equity for the years ended
       December 31, 1995 and 1996 and unaudited for the six months ended June 30, 1997................................    F-28
     Combined Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1996 and unaudited for the six months
      ended June 30, 1996 and 1997....................................................................................    F-29
     Notes to Combined Financial Statements...........................................................................    F-30
LAKE NORMAN DODGE, INC. AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES:
  INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT........................................................................................    F-37
  COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:
     Combined Balance Sheets at December 31, 1996 and unaudited at June 30, 1997......................................    F-38
     Combined Statements of Income for the year ended December 31, 1996 and unaudited for the six months ended June
      30, 1996 and 1997...............................................................................................    F-39
     Combined Statements of Stockholders' Equity for the year ended December 31, 1996 and unaudited for the six months
      ended June 30, 1997.............................................................................................    F-40
     Combined Statements of Cash Flows for the year ended December 31, 1996 and unaudited for the six months ended
      June 30, 1996 and 1997..........................................................................................    F-41
     Notes to Combined Financial Statements...........................................................................    F-42
KEN MARKS FORD, INC.:
  INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT........................................................................................    F-46
  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:
     Balance Sheets at April 30, 1997 and unaudited at July 31, 1997..................................................    F-47
     Statements of Income for the year ended April 30, 1997 and unaudited for the three months ended July 31, 1996 and
      1997............................................................................................................    F-48
     Statements of Stockholders' Equity for the year ended April 30, 1997 and unaudited for the three months ended
      July 31, 1997...................................................................................................    F-49
     Statements of Cash Flows for the year ended April 30, 1997 and unaudited for the three months ended July 31, 1996
      and 1997........................................................................................................    F-50
     Notes to Financial Statements....................................................................................    F-51
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-1
 
<PAGE>
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
TO THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND STOCKHOLDERS OF
SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
Charlotte, North Carolina
  We have audited the accompanying combined balance sheets of Sonic Automotive,
Inc. and Affiliated Companies (the "Company"), which are under common ownership
and management, as of December 31, 1995 and 1996, and the related combined
statements of income, stockholders' equity, and cash flows for each of the three
years in the period ended December 31, 1996. These financial statements are the
responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.
  We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
  In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in
all material respects, the combined financial position of Sonic Automotive, Inc.
and Affiliated Companies as of December 31, 1995 and 1996, and the combined
results of their operations and their combined cash flows for each of the three
years in the period ended December 31, 1996 in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles.
DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
Charlotte, North Carolina
October 16, 1997
                                      F-2
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                    COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                  December 31, 1995 and 1996 and June 30, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                       December 31,
                                                                                ---------------------------      June 30,
                                                                                   1995            1996            1997
                                                                                -----------    ------------    ------------
<S>                                                                             <C>            <C>             <C>
                                                                                                               (Unaudited)
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and cash equivalents..................................................   $ 8,993,887    $  6,679,490    $  9,237,585
  Marketable equity securities...............................................       706,126         638,500         769,123
  Receivables (Note 5) (net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $160,031
     and $224,789 at December 31, 1995 and 1996,
     respectively)...........................................................     9,085,376      11,907,786      12,897,264
  Inventories (Notes 1, 3 and 5).............................................    51,347,994      71,549,716      73,409,956
  Deferred income taxes (Note 6).............................................       117,500         279,896         256,032
  Other current assets.......................................................       311,019         332,561         818,171
                                                                                -----------    ------------    ------------
     Total current assets....................................................    70,561,902      91,387,949      97,388,131
PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, NET (Notes 4 and 5)..................................     8,527,338      12,466,713      13,269,789
GOODWILL, NET (Note 1).......................................................            --       4,266,084       9,463,179
DUE FROM AFFILIATES (Note 7).................................................            --       2,465,929              --
OTHER ASSETS.................................................................       372,610         389,277         263,374
                                                                                -----------    ------------    ------------
TOTAL ASSETS.................................................................   $79,461,850    $110,975,952    $120,384,473
                                                                                -----------    ------------    ------------
                                                                                -----------    ------------    ------------
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
  Notes payable -- floor plan (Note 3).......................................   $45,151,111    $ 63,893,356    $ 67,855,408
  Trade accounts payable.....................................................     3,043,180       3,642,572       3,847,922
  Accrued interest...........................................................       503,391         521,190         491,341
  Other accrued liabilities..................................................     1,554,713       3,031,473       4,307,119
  Payable to affiliated companies (Note 7)...................................     2,000,000              --              --
  Payable to Company's Chairman (Note 2).....................................            --              --       3,500,000
  Current maturities of long-term debt.......................................       169,932         518,979         487,242
                                                                                -----------    ------------    ------------
     Total current liabilities...............................................    52,422,327      71,607,570      80,489,032
                                                                                -----------    ------------    ------------
LONG-TERM DEBT (Note 5)......................................................     3,560,766       5,285,862       5,137,210
PAYABLE TO AFFILIATED COMPANIES (Note 7).....................................     1,219,204         914,339         854,984
DEFERRED INCOME TAXES (Note 6)...............................................       777,600       1,059,380         930,923
INCOME TAX PAYABLE (Note 6)..................................................     4,976,276       5,499,777       4,565,796
MINORITY INTEREST (Note 1)...................................................       199,522         313,912              --
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Notes 7 and 10)
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (Notes 1, 8 and 9):
  Preferred stock, $.10 par, 3,000,000 shares authorized and unissued........            --              --              --
  Class A Common Stock, $.01 par, 50,000,000 shares authorized and
     unissued................................................................            --              --              --
  Class B Common Stock, $.01 par, 15,000,000 shares authorized,
     6,250,000 shares issued and outstanding.................................        62,500          62,500          62,500
  Paid-in capital............................................................     6,269,046      13,333,160      14,418,342
  Retained earnings..........................................................    10,010,097      12,993,014      14,023,119
  Unrealized loss on marketable equity securities............................       (35,488)        (93,562)        (97,433)
                                                                                -----------    ------------    ------------
     Total stockholders' equity..............................................    16,306,155      26,295,112      28,406,528
                                                                                -----------    ------------    ------------
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY...................................   $79,461,850    $110,975,952    $120,384,473
                                                                                -----------    ------------    ------------
                                                                                -----------    ------------    ------------
</TABLE>
 
          See notes to combined and consolidated financial statements.
                                      F-3
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                 COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
                  Years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996
                and the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        Year ended December 31,                Six months ended June 30,
                                              --------------------------------------------    ----------------------------
                                                  1994            1995            1996            1996            1997
                                              ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------
<S>                                           <C>             <C>             <C>             <C>             <C>
                                                                                                      (Unaudited)
REVENUES:
  Vehicle sales............................   $227,959,827    $267,307,949    $326,841,772    $164,332,724    $185,077,493
  Parts, service and collision repair......     33,984,096      35,859,960      42,643,812      21,005,202      22,906,377
  Finance and insurance....................      5,180,998       7,813,408       7,118,217       4,277,094       4,763,248
                                              ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------
     Total revenues........................    267,124,921     310,981,317     376,603,801     189,615,020     212,747,118
COST OF SALES..............................    233,011,078     270,878,010     331,047,060     167,191,296     188,422,240
                                              ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------
GROSS PROFIT...............................     34,113,843      40,103,307      45,556,741      22,423,724      24,324,878
SELLING, GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE
  EXPENSES.................................     24,631,532      29,343,430      33,677,529      16,590,478      18,413,226
DEPRECIATION AND AMORTIZATION..............        838,011         832,261       1,075,618         359,630         395,573
                                              ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------
OPERATING INCOME...........................      8,644,300       9,927,616      10,803,594       5,473,616       5,516,079
                                              ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------
OTHER INCOME AND EXPENSE:
  Interest expense, floor plan.............      3,000,622       4,504,526       5,968,430       2,800,778       3,017,903
  Interest expense, other..................        443,409         436,435         433,250         183,898         269,145
  Gain on sale of marketable equity
     securities............................             --         107,007         354,922         278,917         134,496
  Other income.............................        609,088         342,047         263,676          90,495         139,346
                                              ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------
     Total other expense...................      2,834,943       4,491,907       5,783,082       2,615,264       3,013,206
                                              ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------
INCOME BEFORE INCOME TAXES AND
  MINORITY INTEREST........................      5,809,357       5,435,709       5,020,512       2,858,352       2,502,873
PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES
  (Note 6).................................      2,118,004       2,175,680       1,923,205       1,093,034         916,172
                                              ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------
INCOME BEFORE MINORITY
  INTEREST.................................      3,691,353       3,260,029       3,097,307       1,765,318       1,586,701
MINORITY INTEREST IN EARNINGS
  OF SUBSIDIARY............................         15,564          22,167         114,390          40,612          46,993
                                              ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------
NET INCOME.................................   $  3,675,789    $  3,237,862    $  2,982,917    $  1,724,706    $  1,539,708
                                              ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------
                                              ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------    ------------
PRO FORMA NET INCOME PER SHARE
  (Note 1) (unaudited).....................                                   $       0.48                    $       0.25
                                                                              ------------                    ------------
                                                                              ------------                    ------------
PRO FORMA NUMBER OF SHARES
  USED TO COMPUTE PER SHARE
  DATA (Note 1) (unaudited)................                                      6,250,000                       6,250,000
                                                                              ------------                    ------------
                                                                              ------------                    ------------
</TABLE>
 
          See notes to combined and consolidated financial statements.
                                      F-4
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
          COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
                Years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996 and
                       the six months ended June 30, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             Class B                                          Unrealized Loss
                                                      Common Stock (Note 1)                                    on Marketable
                                                    -------------------------     Paid-in        Retained         Equity
                                                      Shares        Amount        Capital        Earnings       Securities
                                                    -----------   -----------   ------------   ------------   ---------------
<S>                                                 <C>           <C>           <C>            <C>            <C>
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1993......................    6,250,000   $    62,500   $  4,774,700   $  3,096,446     $        --
  Net income......................................           --            --             --      3,675,789              --
                                                    -----------   -----------   ------------   ------------   ---------------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1994......................    6,250,000        62,500      4,774,700      6,772,235              --
  Capital contribution............................           --            --      1,494,346             --              --
  Change in net unrealized loss on marketable
    equity
    securities....................................           --            --             --             --         (35,488)
  Net income......................................           --            --             --      3,237,862              --
                                                    -----------   -----------   ------------   ------------   ---------------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1995......................    6,250,000        62,500      6,269,046     10,010,097         (35,488)
  Capital contribution                                       --            --      7,064,114             --              --
  Change in net unrealized loss on marketable
    equity
    securities....................................           --            --             --             --         (58,074)
  Net income......................................           --            --             --      2,982,917              --
                                                    -----------   -----------   ------------   ------------   ---------------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1996......................    6,250,000        62,500     13,333,160     12,993,014         (93,562)
  Capital contribution (unaudited)................           --            --      3,208,510             --              --
  Stock redemption (unaudited) (Note 7)...........           --            --     (2,123,328)            --              --
  Dividend (unaudited) (Note 7)...................           --            --             --       (509,603)             --
  Change in net unrealized loss on
    marketable equity
    securities (unaudited)........................           --            --             --             --          (3,871)
  Net income (unaudited)..........................           --            --             --      1,539,708              --
                                                    -----------   -----------   ------------   ------------   ---------------
BALANCE AT JUNE 30, 1997 (UNAUDITED)..............    6,250,000   $    62,500   $ 14,418,342   $ 14,023,119     $   (97,433)
                                                    -----------   -----------   ------------   ------------   ---------------
                                                    -----------   -----------   ------------   ------------   ---------------
<CAPTION>
 
                                                        Total
                                                    Stockholders'
                                                        Equity
                                                    --------------
<S>                                                 <C>
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1993......................   $  7,933,646
  Net income......................................      3,675,789
                                                    --------------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1994......................     11,609,435
  Capital contribution............................      1,494,346
  Change in net unrealized loss on marketable
    equity
    securities....................................        (35,488)
  Net income......................................      3,237,862
                                                    --------------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1995......................     16,306,155
  Capital contribution                                  7,064,114
  Change in net unrealized loss on marketable
    equity
    securities....................................        (58,074)
  Net income......................................      2,982,917
                                                    --------------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1996......................     26,295,112
  Capital contribution (unaudited)................      3,208,510
  Stock redemption (unaudited) (Note 7)...........     (2,123,328)
  Dividend (unaudited) (Note 7)...................       (509,603)
  Change in net unrealized loss on
    marketable equity
    securities (unaudited)........................         (3,871)
  Net income (unaudited)..........................      1,539,708
                                                    --------------
BALANCE AT JUNE 30, 1997 (UNAUDITED)..............   $ 28,406,528
                                                    --------------
                                                    --------------
</TABLE>
 
          See notes to combined and consolidated financial statements.
                                      F-5
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
               COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                Years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996 and
                  the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    Year ended December 31,              Six months ended June 30,
                                                           ------------------------------------------    --------------------------
                                                              1994           1995            1996           1996           1997
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                        <C>            <C>            <C>             <C>            <C>
                                                                                                                (Unaudited)
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income............................................   $ 3,675,789    $ 3,237,862    $  2,982,917    $ 1,724,706    $ 1,539,708
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash
    provided by operating activities:
    Depreciation and amortization.......................       838,011        832,261       1,075,618        359,630        395,573
    Minority interest...................................        15,564         22,167         114,390         40,612         46,993
    Loss (gain) on disposal of property and equipment               --        (38,721)         79,660             --             --
    Gain on sale of marketable equity securities........            --       (107,007)       (354,922)      (278,917)      (134,496)
    Deferred income taxes...............................       258,400        450,400        (240,548)       (62,002)        23,864
    Changes in assets and liabilities that relate to
      operations:
      (Increase) decrease in receivables................    (2,091,063)      (228,084)     (2,420,651)       287,459       (989,478)
      (Increase) decrease in inventories................   (10,392,680)    (5,025,452)    (14,012,965)    (3,511,263)     2,799,710
      (Increase) decrease in other current assets.......       (66,945)        21,173         (10,455)      (189,391)      (483,564)
      Increase (decrease) in other non-current assets...          (679)       (14,104)        (69,883)         2,851        113,403
      Increase in notes payable-floor plan..............     9,489,146      3,431,241      12,984,772      4,117,088        290,190
      Increase (decrease) in accounts payable and
         accrued expenses...............................       676,526        (42,224)      1,439,486      1,285,875      1,309,913
      Increase (decrease) in income tax payable.........       558,254        500,780         523,501             --       (933,981)
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
         Total adjustments..............................      (715,466)      (197,570)       (891,997)     2,051,942      2,438,127
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
         Net cash provided by operating activities......     2,960,323      3,040,292       2,090,920      3,776,648      3,977,835
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchase of business, net of cash received............            --             --      (5,126,595)      (692,883)    (3,627,347)
  Purchases of property and equipment...................    (1,386,877)    (1,508,848)     (1,906,739)            --       (886,149)
  Proceeds from sale of property and equipment..........        32,162        556,789           4,036             --             --
  Purchase of marketable equity securities..............       (82,801)    (1,622,845)       (207,400)            --             --
  Proceeds from sales of marketable equity securities...            --      1,073,539         514,700         88,900             --
  Net (advances to) receipts from affiliate companies...      (295,578)     1,772,022      (4,770,794)    (3,251,199)        65,633
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
         Net cash provided by (used in) investing
           activities...................................    (1,733,094)       270,657     (11,492,792)    (3,855,182)    (4,447,863)
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Capital contributions.................................            --      1,494,346       7,064,114      1,000,000      3,208,510
  Proceeds from long-term debt..........................       107,284          2,899         599,206             --             --
  Payments of long-term debt............................      (441,500)      (269,254)       (575,845)      (468,970)      (180,387)
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
         Net cash provided by (used in) financing
           activities...................................      (334,216)     1,227,991       7,087,475        531,030      3,028,123
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH.........................       893,013      4,538,940      (2,314,397)       452,496      2,558,095
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING
  OF PERIOD.............................................     3,561,934      4,454,947       8,993,887      8,993,887      6,679,490
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF PERIOD................   $ 4,454,947    $ 8,993,887    $  6,679,490    $ 9,446,383    $ 9,237,585
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
                                                           -----------    -----------    ------------    -----------    -----------
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW
  INFORMATION -- Cash paid during the period for:
  Interest..............................................   $ 3,324,678    $ 4,776,504    $  6,488,657    $ 2,839,031    $ 3,320,996
  Income taxes..........................................   $   998,850    $ 1,522,100    $  2,042,268    $   834,000    $   930,000
</TABLE>
 
          See notes to combined and consolidated financial statements.
                                      F-6
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
            NOTES TO COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
1. DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
     Organization and Business -- Sonic Automotive, Inc ("Sonic" or the
"Company") was incorporated in the State of Delaware in February, 1997 in order
to effect a reorganization of certain affiliated companies (the
"Reorganization") and to undertake an initial public offering of Sonic's common
stock (the "Offering"). Sonic and affiliated companies (collectively, the
"Company") operate automobile dealerships in the Houston, Texas and Charlotte,
North Carolina metropolitan areas. The Company sells new and used cars and light
trucks, sells replacement parts, provides vehicle maintenance, warranty, paint
and repair services and arranges related financing and insurance. The financial
statements for the periods through June 30, 1997 represent the combined data for
the entities under common ownership and control which became subsidiaries of
Sonic pursuant to the Reorganization on June 30, 1997, including the following
entities:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                              <C>
Town and Country Ford, Inc....................................................   Charlotte
Lone Star Ford, Inc...........................................................   Houston
FMF Management, Inc. (d/b/a Fort Mill Ford)...................................   Charlotte
Town and Country Toyota, Inc..................................................   Charlotte
Frontier Oldsmobile-Cadillac, Inc.............................................   Charlotte
</TABLE>
 
     All material intercompany transactions have been eliminated in the combined
financial statements. Effective June 30, 1997, these five entities became
wholly-owned subsidiaries of Sonic through the exchange of their common stock or
membership interests for 6,250,000 shares of Sonic's Class B common stock having
a $.01 par value per share. On June 2, 1997 Sonic, through its wholly-owned
subsidiary, Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge, acquired certain dealership
assets and liabilities of Jeff Boyd Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge, Inc. (a previously
unrelated entity) for a total purchase price of approximately $3.7 million. The
unaudited consolidated financial statements as of and for the six months ended
June 30, 1997, which give effect to the Reorganization, include the accounts of
the above five entities and also include the accounts and results of operations
of Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge from the date of its acquisition.
     The Reorganization was accounted for at historical cost in a manner similar
to a pooling-of-interests as the entities were under the common management and
control of Mr. O. Bruton Smith. The acquisition of Jeff Boyd
Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge was accounted for as a purchase.
     Prior to the Reorganization, Town and Country Toyota, Inc. was 69% owned by
Mr. O. Bruton Smith, the Company's Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, Lone
Star Ford, Inc. and Frontier Oldsmobile -- Cadillac, Inc. were 100% owned by
Sonic Financial Corporation ("SFC"), which in turn is 100% owned by Mr. Smith
and related family trusts. Town and Country Ford, Inc. was owned 80% by SFC and
20% by Mr. Scott Smith (O. Bruton Smith's son). FMF Management, Inc. was owned
50% by SFC and 50% by Mr. O. Bruton Smith.
     In connection with the Reorganization, the Company purchased the 31%
minority interest in Town and Country Toyota, Inc. for $3.2 million in a
transaction accounted for using purchase accounting. On a pro forma basis for
the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997, revenues would have been unchanged
and net income and net income per share would not be materially different had
the acquisition of this minority interest occurred on January 1, 1996 and
January 1, 1997, respectively.
     In connection with the anticipated Offering, Sonic expects to issue shares
of its Class A common stock. The Class B common stock entitles the holder to ten
votes per share, except in certain circumstances, while the Class A common stock
entitles its holder to one vote per share.
     Pro Forma Net Income Per Share -- Pro forma net income per share in the
accompanying financial statements has been prepared based upon the shares
outstanding after the Reorganization and without giving effect to the issuance
of common stock related to the Offering.
     Revenue Recognition -- The Company records revenue when vehicles are
delivered to customers, and when vehicle service work is performed. Finance and
insurance commission revenue is recognized principally at the time the contract
is placed with the financial institution.
                                      F-7
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
      NOTES TO COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
1. DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING
POLICIES -- Continued
     Dealer Agreements -- The Company purchases substantially all of its new
vehicles from manufacturers at the prevailing prices charged by the manufacturer
to its franchised dealers. The Company's sales could be unfavorably impacted by
the manufacturer's unwillingness or inability to supply the dealership with an
adequate supply of new car inventory.
     Each dealership operates under a dealer agreement with the manufacturer
which generally restricts the location, management and ownership of the
respective dealership. The ability of the Company to acquire additional
franchises from a particular manufacturer may be limited due to certain
restrictions imposed by manufacturers. Additionally, the Company's ability to
enter into other significant acquisitions may be restricted and the acquisition
of the Company's stock by third parties may be limited by the terms of the
franchise agreement.
     Cash and Cash Equivalents -- The Company considers contracts in transit and
all highly liquid debt instruments with an initial maturity of three months or
less to be cash equivalents. Contracts in transit represent cash in transit to
the Company from finance companies related to vehicle purchases, and was
$2,644,804 and $5,222,589 at December 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
     Inventories -- In connection with the Offering, the Company intends to
convert from the last-in-first-out method (the "LIFO Method") of inventory
accounting to the first-in-first-out method (the "FIFO Method"), for its
inventories of new vehicles. In accordance with Accounting Principles Board
Opinion No. 20, "Accounting Changes", the accompanying financial statements and
related notes have been retroactively restated to reflect that change.
Accordingly, inventories of new vehicles, including demonstrators, and parts and
accessories are stated at the lower of FIFO cost or market. Inventories of used
vehicles are stated at the lower of specific cost or market.
     The new method of accounting for inventories of new vehicles was adopted to
provide a better matching of revenues and expenses in the future and to conform
with the predominant industry practice for automobile dealerships that are
publicly-held. The effect of the accounting change on net income as previously
reported is as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  1994          1995          1996
                                                               ----------    ----------    ----------
<S>                                                            <C>           <C>           <C>
Net income on a LIFO Basis..................................   $2,784,032    $2,437,915    $2,146,675
Adjustment for effect of a change in accounting principle
  that is applied retroactively.............................      891,757       799,947       836,242
                                                               ----------    ----------    ----------
  Net income as adjusted....................................   $3,675,789    $3,237,862    $2,982,917
                                                               ----------    ----------    ----------
                                                               ----------    ----------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
     Property and Equipment -- Property and equipment are stated at cost.
Depreciation is computed using straight-line and accelerated methods over the
estimated useful lives of the assets. The range of estimated useful lives is as
follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                Useful Lives
                                                                                -------------
<S>                                                                             <C>
Building.....................................................................        40
Office equipment and fixtures................................................        5-7
Parts and service equipment..................................................         5
Company vehicles.............................................................         5
</TABLE>
 
     Leasehold improvements are amortized over the lesser of the terms of their
respective leases or the estimated useful lives of the related assets.
     Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred.
Significant betterments are capitalized.
     Goodwill -- Goodwill represents the excess of purchase price over the
estimated fair value of the net assets acquired and is being amortized over a 40
year period. The cumulative amount of goodwill amortization at December 31, 1996
was approximately $98,000.
     The Company periodically reviews goodwill to assess recoverability. The
Company's policy is to compare the carrying value of goodwill with the expected
undiscounted cash flows from operations of the acquired business.
                                      F-8
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
      NOTES TO COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
1. DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING
POLICIES -- Continued
     Marketable Equity Securities -- The Company's marketable equity securities
are classified as "available for sale" and are not bought and held principally
for the purpose of selling them in the near term. As such, these securities are
reported at fair value, with unrealized gains and losses, net of tax, excluded
from earnings and reported as a separate component of stockholders' equity.
Realized gains and losses on sales of marketable equity securities are
determined using the specific identification method.
     Income Taxes -- Income taxes are provided for the tax effects of
transactions reported in the financial statements and consist of taxes currently
due plus deferred taxes related primarily to the capitalization of additional
inventory costs for income tax purposes, the recording of chargebacks and
repossession losses on the direct write-off method for income tax purposes, the
direct write-off of uncollectible accounts for income tax purposes, and the
accelerated depreciation method used for income tax purposes. The deferred tax
assets and liabilities represent the future tax return consequences of those
differences, which will either be taxable or deductible when the assets and
liabilities are recovered or settled. In addition, deferred tax assets are
recognized for state operating losses that are available to offset future
taxable income.
     Concentrations of Credit Risk -- Financial instruments which potentially
subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk consist principally of cash
on deposit with financial institutions. At times, amounts invested with
financial institutions may exceed FDIC insurance limits.
     Concentrations of credit risk with respect to receivables are limited
primarily to automobile manufacturers and financial institutions. Credit risk
arising from trade receivables from commercial customers is reduced by the large
number of customers comprising the trade receivables balances. Trade receivables
are concentrated in the Company's two market areas of Houston, Texas and
Charlotte, North Carolina metropolitan areas.
     Fair Value of Financial Instruments -- As of December 31, 1995 and 1996 the
fair values of the Company's financial instruments including receivables, due
from affiliates, notes payable-floor plan, trade accounts payable, payables to
affiliated companies and Company Chairman and long-term debt approximate their
carrying values.
     Use of Estimates -- The preparation of financial statements in conformity
with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make
estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of
the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses
during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
     Advertising -- The Company expenses advertising costs in the period
incurred. Advertising expense amounted to $3,765,363, $4,525,670 and $4,989,283
for 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
     Impairment of Long-Lived Assets -- Effective January 1, 1996, the Company
adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 121, Accounting for the Impairment of
Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed Of. This Statement
requires that long-lived assets be reviewed for impairment whenever events or
changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not
be recoverable. Adoption of SFAS No. 121 did not have a material impact on the
Company's results of operations, financial position, and cash flows.
     New Accounting Standards -- In February 1997, the Financial Accounting
Standards Board issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 128,
"Earnings Per Share." This Statement specifies the computation, presentation and
disclosure requirements for earnings per share. The Company believes that the
adoption of such Statement would not result in earnings per share materially
different than pro forma earnings per share presented in the accompanying
statements of income.
     In June 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of
Financial Accounting Standards No. 130, "Reporting Comprehensive Income." This
Standard establishes standards of reporting and display of comprehensive income
and its components in a full set of general-purpose financial statements. This
Statement will be effective for the Company's fiscal year ending December 31,
1998, and the Company does not intend to adopt this Statement prior to the
effective date. Had the Company early adopted this Statement, it would have
reported comprehensive income of $2,784,032, $2,402,427 and $2,088,601 for the
years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
                                      F-9
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
      NOTES TO COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
1. DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING
POLICIES -- Continued
     Interim Financial Information -- The accompanying unaudited financial
information for the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997 has been prepared on
substantially the same basis as the audited financial statements, and include
all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for
a fair presentation of the financial information set forth therein. The results
for interim periods are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected
for the entire fiscal year.
     Stock Split -- All share and per share amounts included in the accompanying
financial statements for all periods presented have been adjusted to reflect a
625 for 1 stock split of the Class B Common Stock effective as of October 16,
1997.
2. BUSINESS ACQUISITIONS
     In June 1997, the Company through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Fort Mill
Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge, acquired certain dealership assets and liabilities of
Jeff Boyd Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge for a total purchase price of $3.7 million. Of
the total purchase price of $3.7 million, $3.5 million was advanced to the
Company by Mr. O. Bruton Smith, with interest charged at 3.83%. It is
anticipated that this advance will be repaid in full with proceeds from the
Offering. Had the Offering occurred as of June 1997 (the date of the advance),
and this $3.5 million advance was repaid with the proceeds, supplemental pro
forma earnings per share, using weighted average shares of 6,294,872 would not
have resulted in a change to earnings per share as reported.
     This transaction was accounted for using purchase accounting and the
results of the operations of this dealership have been included from the date of
acquisition through June 30, 1997 in the accompanying Unaudited Combined and
Consolidated Statement of Income. Company management believes that on a
pro-forma basis, revenues, net income and earnings per share would not have been
materially affected assuming this acquisition had occurred on January 1, 1996.
The purchase price has been allocated to the assets and liabilities acquired at
their estimated fair market value at the acquisition date as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                            <C>
Working capital.............................................................   $  977,000
Property and equipment......................................................      250,000
Goodwill....................................................................    2,473,000
                                                                               ----------
Total.......................................................................   $3,700,000
                                                                               ----------
                                                                               ----------
</TABLE>
 
     In June, July and August the Company entered into definitive agreements to
purchase six additional dealership groups for an aggregate purchase price of
$94.8 million as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                           <C>
Bowers Dealerships..........................  Chattanooga, Tennessee
Lake Norman Dodge and Affiliates............  Cornelius, North Carolina
Ken Marks Ford..............................  Clearwater, Florida
Dyer Volvo..................................  Atlanta, Georgia
Jeff Boyd Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge...........  Fort Mill, South Carolina
Williams Motors, Inc........................  Rock Hill, South Carolina
</TABLE>
 
     The Lake Norman Dodge and Affiliates, Ken Marks Ford, Jeff Boyd
Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge and Williams Motors, Inc. acquisitions have been
consummated. The completion of the remaining acquisitions may be dependent upon
the successful completion of the Offering.
     In conjunction with the Lake Norman acquisition, the Company obtained a
short-term line of credit with aggregate principal availability of $20 million
maturing no later than February 15, 1998. The Company borrowed $18.2 million
against this line to fund the purchase of Lake Norman. See Note 5 for additional
information regarding this line of credit.
     In conjunction with the Ken Marks Acquisition, the Company obtained an
additional line of credit with an initial aggregate principal availability of
$26 million maturing (unless extended by the lender) on October 15, 1999. The
Company borrowed $25.5 million against this line to fund the purchase of Ken
Marks. See note 5 for additional information regarding this line of credit.
                                      F-10
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
      NOTES TO COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
2. BUSINESS ACQUISITIONS -- Continued
     On February 1, 1996, the Company acquired Fort Mill Ford for a total
purchase price of $5,741,114. The acquisition has been accounted for as a
purchase and the results of operations of Fort Mill Ford have been included in
the accompanying combined financial statements from the date of acquisition. The
purchase price has been allocated to the assets and liabilities acquired at
their estimated fair market value at the acquisition date as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                            <C>
Working capital.............................................................   $  822,000
Property and equipment......................................................    3,022,000
Goodwill....................................................................    4,364,000
Non-current liabilities assumed.............................................   (2,467,000)
                                                                               ----------
Total.......................................................................   $5,741,000
                                                                               ----------
                                                                               ----------
</TABLE>
 
     The following unaudited pro forma financial data is presented as if Fort
Mill Ford had been acquired at January 1, 1995. Pro forma results of operations
for 1996 are not presented because the acquisition occurred in February 1996,
and the pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 1996 would not be
materially different from the historical results presented:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 1995
                                                                             ------------
<S>                                                                          <C>
Revenues..................................................................   $345,198,523
Net income................................................................   $  2,874,909
Earnings per share........................................................   $       0.46
</TABLE>
 
     The pro forma information presented above is not necessarily indicative of
the operating results that would have occurred had Fort Mill Ford been acquired
on January 1, 1995. These results are also not necessarily indicative of the
results of future operations.
3. INVENTORIES AND RELATED NOTES PAYABLE -- FLOOR PLAN
     Inventories consist of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          December 31,
                                                                                   --------------------------     June 30,
                                                                                      1995           1996           1997
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                                <C>            <C>            <C>
                                                                                                                 (Unaudited)
New vehicles....................................................................   $37,895,075    $51,797,883    $56,126,061
Used vehicles...................................................................     8,913,145     14,372,285     11,826,874
Parts and accessories...........................................................     4,185,547      4,939,724      4,997,869
Other...........................................................................       354,227        439,824        459,152
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
Total...........................................................................   $51,347,994    $71,549,716    $73,409,956
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
     The inventory balance is generally reduced by manufacturer's purchase
discounts, and such reduction is not reflected in the related floor plan
liability. These manufacturer purchase discounts are standard in the industry,
typically occur on all new vehicle purchases, and are not used to offset the
related floor plan liability. These discounts are aggregated and generally paid
by the manufacturer on a quarterly basis. The related floor plan liability
becomes due as vehicles are sold.
     All new and certain used vehicles are pledged to collateralize floor plan
notes payable to financial institutions in the amount of $45,151,111 and
$63,893,356 at December 31, 1996. The floor plan notes bear interest, payable
monthly on the outstanding balance, at the prime rate plus 1% (9 1/4% at
December 31, 1995 and 1996). Total floor plan interest expense amounted to
$3,000,622, $4,504,526 and $5,968,430 in 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively. The
notes payable are due when the related vehicle is sold. As such, these floor
plan notes payable are shown as a current liability in the accompanying combined
and consolidated balance sheets.
                                      F-11
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
      NOTES TO COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
4. PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT
     Property and equipment is comprised of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          December 31,
                                                                                   --------------------------     June 30,
                                                                                      1995           1996           1997
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                                <C>            <C>            <C>
                                                                                                                 (Unaudited)
Land............................................................................   $ 1,477,795    $ 2,677,795    $ 2,677,795
Buildings and improvements......................................................     7,085,878     10,080,659     10,381,145
Office equipment and fixtures...................................................     2,442,965      2,036,980      2,360,424
Parts and service equipment.....................................................     2,955,729      2,866,291      2,941,456
Company vehicles................................................................       373,683        437,261        512,113
Construction in progress........................................................       265,677             --             --
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
Total, at cost..................................................................    14,601,727     18,098,986     18,872,933
Less accumulated depreciation...................................................    (6,074,389)    (5,632,273)    (5,603,144)
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
Property and equipment, net.....................................................   $ 8,527,338    $12,466,713    $13,269,789
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
5. LONG-TERM DEBT
     Long-term debt consists of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                           December 31,
                                                                                                     ------------------------
                                                                                                        1995          1996
                                                                                                     ----------    ----------
<S>                                                                                                  <C>           <C>
Note payable in monthly installments of $8,333 plus interest at the prime rate plus 1 1/2%,
  through July 2001, collateralized by accounts receivable, inventory and equipment...............   $       --    $  458,335
Mortgage payable in monthly installments of $12,222 plus interest at prime plus 3/4%, through May
  2004, collateralized by building................................................................           --     1,087,778
Unsecured note payable in monthly installments of $9,100, including interest at 8%, through March
  2004............................................................................................           --       599,238
Mortgage note payable in monthly installments of $4,203, including interest at 7%, through
  November 2008, collateralized by land and building..............................................      425,751       405,700
Mortgage note payable in monthly installments of $27,415 including interest at prime plus 1/2%,
  through April 2001, at which time remaining outstanding principal balance is due, collateralized
  by building.....................................................................................    3,135,379     3,062,926
Other notes payable...............................................................................      169,568       190,864
                                                                                                     ----------    ----------
                                                                                                      3,730,698     5,804,841
Less current maturities...........................................................................     (169,932)     (518,979)
                                                                                                     ----------    ----------
Long-term debt....................................................................................   $3,560,766    $5,285,862
                                                                                                     ----------    ----------
                                                                                                     ----------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
     Future maturities of debt at December 31, 1996 are as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                            <C>
Year ending December 31:
1997........................................................................   $  518,979
1998........................................................................      455,505
1999........................................................................      434,609
2000........................................................................      446,374
2001........................................................................    3,096,525
Thereafter..................................................................      852,849
                                                                               ----------
Total.......................................................................   $5,804,841
                                                                               ----------
                                                                               ----------
</TABLE>
 
     On August 28, 1997 the Company obtained a short term line of credit in an
aggregate principal amount of up to $20 million that matures no later than
February 15, 1998. This line of credit is payable upon maturity, bears interest
at a fixed rate of
                                      F-12
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
      NOTES TO COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
5. LONG-TERM DEBT -- Continued
7.75% per annum and is secured by certain assets of the Company's Chairman and
Chief Executive Officer. The Company borrowed $18.2 million on this line of
credit in connection with the Lake Norman Acquisition.
     On October 15, 1997 the Company obtained a two year line of credit with an
initial aggregate principal availability of $26 million that matures (unless
extended by the lender) on October 15, 1999. This revolving line of credit is
payable upon maturity, bears interest at a variable rate equal to the prime rate
(currently 8.5% per annum) and is secured by certain assets of the Company's
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. The Company borrowed $25.5 million on this
line of credit in connection with the Ken Marks Acquisition.
6. INCOME TAXES
     The provision (benefit) for income taxes consists of the following
components:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          1994          1995          1996
                                                                                       ----------    ----------    ----------
<S>                                                                                    <C>           <C>           <C>
Current:
  Federal...........................................................................   $1,814,944    $1,608,418    $1,855,901
  State.............................................................................       44,660       116,862       307,852
                                                                                       ----------    ----------    ----------
                                                                                        1,859,604     1,725,280     2,163,753
                                                                                       ----------    ----------    ----------
Deferred............................................................................      244,900       427,200      (189,179)
Change in valuation allowance.......................................................       13,500        23,200       (51,369)
                                                                                       ----------    ----------    ----------
  Total.............................................................................   $2,118,004    $2,175,680    $1,923,205
                                                                                       ----------    ----------    ----------
                                                                                       ----------    ----------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
     The reconciliation of the statutory federal income tax rate with the
Company's federal and state overall effective income tax rate is as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                        1994     1995     1996
                                                                                                        -----    -----    -----
<S>                                                                                                     <C>      <C>      <C>
Statutory federal rate...............................................................................   34.00%   34.00%   34.00%
State income taxes...................................................................................      --     3.84     3.60
Miscellaneous........................................................................................    2.46     2.19      .71
                                                                                                        -----    -----    -----
Effective tax rates..................................................................................   36.46%   40.03%   38.31%
                                                                                                        -----    -----    -----
                                                                                                        -----    -----    -----
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-13
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
      NOTES TO COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
6. INCOME TAXES -- Continued
     Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of the temporary
differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial
reporting purposes and the amounts used for tax purposes. Significant components
of the Company's deferred tax assets and liabilities as of December 31 are as
follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                      1995           1996
                                                                                                   -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                                                <C>            <C>
Deferred tax assets:
  Allowance for bad debts.......................................................................   $    62,300    $    85,992
  Inventory reserves............................................................................       126,400        160,820
  Net operating loss carryforwards..............................................................       183,800         74,931
  Other.........................................................................................         1,300         75,656
                                                                                                   -----------    -----------
  Total deferred tax assets.....................................................................       373,800        397,399
  Valuation allowance...........................................................................      (126,300)       (75,000)
                                                                                                   -----------    -----------
  Deferred tax assets, net......................................................................       247,500        322,399
                                                                                                   -----------    -----------
Deferred tax liabilities:
  Basis difference in fixed assets..............................................................      (155,200)      (556,384)
  Basis difference in equity investment.........................................................      (644,400)      (478,876)
  Other.........................................................................................      (108,000)       (66,623)
                                                                                                   -----------    -----------
Total deferred tax liability....................................................................      (907,600)    (1,101,883)
                                                                                                   -----------    -----------
Net deferred tax liability......................................................................   $  (660,100)   $  (779,484)
                                                                                                   -----------    -----------
                                                                                                   -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
     The net changes in the valuation allowance against deferred tax assets were
an increase of $23,200 for the year ended December 31, 1995 and a decrease of
($51,300) for the year ended December 31, 1996. The increase (decrease) was
related primarily to the generation (expiration) of state net operating loss
carryforwards. At December 31, 1996, the Company had state net operating loss
carryforwards of $1,259,000 which will expire between 1998 and 2002.
     A change to the FIFO from the LIFO method of inventory for new vehicles
resulted in an additional income tax liability. This liability was recorded as
$4,976,276 and $5,499,777 at December 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively and is
payable over a six year period beginning in January 1998.
     Certain subsidiaries of Sonic (such subsidiaries together with the Company
and Sonic Financial being hereinafter referred to as the "Sonic Group") have
joined with Sonic Financial in filing consolidated federal income tax returns
for several years. Such subsidiaries will join with Sonic Financial in filing
for 1996 and for the period ending on June 30, 1997. Under applicable federal
tax law, each corporation included in Sonic Financial's consolidated return is
jointly and severally liable for any resultant tax. Under a tax allocation
agreement dated as of June 30, 1997, however, the Company agreed to pay to Sonic
Financial, in the event that additional federal income tax is determined to be
due, an amount equal to the Company's separate federal income tax liability
computed for all periods in which any member of the Sonic Group has been a
member of Sonic Financial's consolidated group, less amounts previously recorded
by the Company. Also pursuant to such agreement, Sonic Financial agreed to
indemnify the Company for any additional amount determined to be due from Sonic
Financial's consolidated group in excess of the federal income tax liability of
the Sonic Group for such periods. The tax allocation agreement establishes
procedures with respect to tax adjustments, tax claims, tax refunds, tax credits
and other tax attributes relating to periods ending prior to the time that the
Sonic Group shall leave Sonic Financial's consolidated group.
7. RELATED PARTIES
   
     Town & Country Ford and Lone Star Ford have each made several non-interest
bearing advances to Sonic Financial. As of December 31, 1996, Town & Country
Ford had made $1,956,326 of such advances ($2,123,328 as of June 30, 1997). In
preparation for the Reorganization, a demand promissory note by Sonic Financial
evidencing certain of these advances was canceled in exchange for the redemption
of certain shares of the capital stock of Town & Country Ford held by Sonic
Financial. As of December 31, 1996, Lone Star Ford had made $509,603 of advances
to Sonic Financial. In preparation for
    
                                      F-14
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
      NOTES TO COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
7. RELATED PARTIES -- Continued
the Reorganization, a demand promissory note by Sonic Financial evidencing
certain of Lone Star Ford's advances was canceled pursuant to a dividend.
     The Company had amounts payable to affiliated companies of $3,219,204 and
$914,339, at December 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively. The balance, consisting
of non-interest bearing loans from affiliates, is classified as noncurrent based
upon its expected repayment date.
     Town & Country Ford, Inc. operates at facilities leased from an entity
owned 5% by Town & Country Ford, Inc. and 95% by Sonic Financial Corporation.
This lease expires in October 2000. Annual payments under this lease were
$510,085 for each of the 1994, 1995 and 1996 fiscal years. Current minimum rent
payments are $409,000 annually ($34,083 monthly) through 1999, and will be
decreased to $340,833 in 2000.
     Lone Star Ford operates in part from an entity controlled by the Company's
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. This lease expires in 2005. Annual
payments under this lease were $351,420, $331,302 and $360,000 for the 1994,
1995 and 1996 fiscal years, respectively. Current minimum rent payments are
$360,000 annually ($30,000 monthly).
     During each of the three years ended December 31, 1996, Town & Country Ford
paid $48,000 to Sonic Financial as a management fee. Sonic Financial's services
to Town & Country Ford have included performance of the following functions,
among others: maintenance of lender and creditor relationships; tax planning;
preparation of tax returns and representation in tax examinations; record
maintenance; internal audits and special audits; assistance to independent
public accountants; and litigation support to company counsel. Payments of fees
to and receipt of services from Sonic Financial ceased before the
Reorganization.
     Beginning in early 1997, certain of Sonic's dealerships have entered into
arrangements to sell to their customers credit life insurance policies
underwritten by American Heritage Life Insurance Company, an insurer
unaffiliated with Sonic ("American Heritage"). American Heritage in turn
reinsures all of these policies with Provident American Insurance Company, a
Texas insurance company ("Provident American") and a wholly-owned subsidiary of
Sonic Financial. Under these arrangements, the dealerships paid an aggregate of
$140,000 to American Heritage in premiums for these policies for the six months
ended June 30, 1997. The Company anticipates terminating this arrangement with
American Heritage by 1998.
   
     Chartown is a general partnership engaged in real estate development and
management. Before the Reorganization, Town & Country Ford maintained a 49%
partnership interest in Chartown with the remaining 51% held by SMDA Properties,
LLC, a North Carolina limited liability company ("SMDA"). The Company's Chairman
and Chief Executive Officer owns an 80% direct membership interest in SMDA with
the remaining 20% owned indirectly through Sonic Financial. In addition, Sonic
Financial also held a demand promissory note for $1,555,528 issued by Chartown
(the "Chartown Note"), which was uncollectible due to insufficient funds. As a
part of the Reorganization, the Chartown Note was cancelled and Town & Country
Ford transferred its partnership interest in Chartown to Sonic Financial for
nominal consideration. In connection with that transfer, Sonic Financial agreed
to indemnify Town & Country Ford for any and all obligations and liabilities,
whether known or unknown, relating to Chartown and Town & Country Ford's
ownership thereof. Town & Country Ford's recorded investment in Chartown was
nominal for all periods presented in the accompanying financial statements.
    
8. PREFERRED STOCK
     In 1997, the Company authorized 3,000,000 shares of "blank check" preferred
stock with such designations, rights and preferences as may be determined from
time to time by the Board of Directors. No preferred shares were issued and
outstanding at June 30, 1997.
9. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
     Substantially all of the employees of the Company are eligible to
participate in a 401(k) plan maintained by SFC. Contributions by the Company to
the plan were not significant in any period presented.
                                      F-15
 
<PAGE>
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
      NOTES TO COMBINED AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
9. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS -- Continued
     On October 9, 1997 the Company adopted the 1997 Stock Option Plan (the
"Plan"). Under the provisions of the Plan, options to purchase 1,125,000 shares
of Class A Common Stock may be granted to key employees of the Company and its
subsidiaries and to officers, directors, consultants and other individuals
providing services to the Company. The exercise price of the options may not be
less than the market value of the Class A Common Stock on the date of grant.
Vesting periods will range from 5 to 10 years. On or before consummation of the
Offering, the Board of Directors intends to grant options to purchase an
aggregate of 587,509 shares of Class A Common Stock under the Plan. The Company
intends to adopt the provisions of Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25
"Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees" to account for the Plan's
transactions.
     On October 9, 1997 the Company adopted the Sonic Employee Stock Purchase
Plan (the "ESPP"). The ESPP provides employees of the Company the opportunity to
purchase Class A Common Stock after completion of the Offering. Under the terms
of the ESPP, on January 1 of each year all eligible employees electing to
participate will be granted an option to purchase shares of Class A Common
Stock. The Company's Compensation Committee will annually determine the number
of shares of Class A Common Stock available for purchase under each option. The
purchase price at which Class A Common Stock will be purchased through the ESPP
will be 90% of the lesser of (i) the fair market value of the Class A Common
Stock on the applicable Grant Date and (ii) the fair market value of the Class A
Common Stock on the applicable Exercise Date. Options will expire on the last
exercise date of the calendar year in which granted. A total of 150,000 shares
of Class A Common Stock have been reserved for purchase under the ESPP.
10. CONTINGENCIES
     The Company is contingently liable for customer contracts placed with
financial institutions of approximately $675,000 and $741,000 at December 31,
1995 and 1996, respectively. However, the Company's potential loss is limited to
the difference between the present value of the installment contract at the date
of the repossession and the market value of the vehicle at the date of sale.
Other accrued liabilities include a provision for repossession losses. The
Company provides a reserve for repossession losses based on the ratio that
historical loss experience bears to the amount of outstanding customer
contracts.
     The Company has available $1,500,000 under draft-clearing credit lines with
a bank in order to immediately fund the Company's checking account for sold
vehicle contracts from other financial institutions. The Company is contingently
liable to the bank until the contracts are approved by the financial
institutions. At December 31, 1996, $151,227 was outstanding under these lines.
     In the event that the Company fails to close the acquisitions of Dyer
Volvo, Ken Marks Ford, and the Bowers Dealerships by certain dates, the Company
will be required to pay termination fees which total approximately $4.0 million.
     The Company is involved in various legal proceedings. Management believes
that the outcome of such proceedings will not have a materially adverse effect
on the Company's financial position or future results of operations and cash
flows.
                                      F-16
 
<PAGE>
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
TO THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND STOCKHOLDER OF
DYER & DYER, INC.
Atlanta, Georgia
  We have audited the accompanying balance sheets of Dyer & Dyer, Inc. (the
"Company") as of December 31, 1995 and 1996, and the related statements of
income, stockholder's equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the
period ended December 31, 1996. These financial statements are the
responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.
  We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
  In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in
all material respects, the financial position of Dyer & Dyer, Inc. as of
December 31, 1995 and 1996, and the results of their operations and their cash
flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1996 in
conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.
DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
Charlotte, North Carolina
August 7, 1997
                                      F-17
 
<PAGE>
                               DYER & DYER, INC.
                                 BALANCE SHEETS
                  December 31, 1995 and 1996 and June 30, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          December 31,
                                                                                   --------------------------     June 30,
                                                                                      1995           1996           1997
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                                <C>            <C>            <C>
                                                                                                                 (Unaudited)
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and cash equivalents.....................................................   $ 1,522,546    $   941,280    $   172,937
  Receivables...................................................................       432,779      1,213,846      2,535,230
  Inventories (Notes 1 and 2)...................................................     9,043,156     15,071,313     11,128,333
  Prepaid expenses..............................................................       274,998        103,958         32,267
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
       Total current assets.....................................................    11,273,479     17,330,397     13,868,767
PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, NET (Notes 1 and 3).....................................       774,909      1,279,774      1,156,207
OTHER ASSETS....................................................................       287,628        292,250        297,424
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
TOTAL ASSETS....................................................................   $12,336,016    $18,902,421    $15,322,398
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
  Notes payable, floor plan (Note 2)............................................   $ 2,610,935    $ 7,146,245    $ 5,533,925
  Trade accounts payable........................................................       511,292      1,131,472             --
  Income taxes payable (Notes 1 and 5)..........................................            --        238,712        238,712
  Accrued payroll and bonuses...................................................        82,183        229,297        277,377
  Other accrued liabilities.....................................................       196,537        261,932        235,360
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
       Total current liabilities................................................     3,400,947      9,007,658      6,285,374
INCOME TAXES PAYABLE (Note 5)...................................................        21,012        477,423        238,711
COMMITMENTS (Note 4)
STOCKHOLDER'S EQUITY:
  Common stock, $100 par value -- 3,000 shares authorized; 1,531 shares issued;
     781 shares outstanding.....................................................       153,100        153,100        153,100
  Paid-in capital...............................................................        27,623         27,623         27,623
  Retained earnings.............................................................    13,709,477     14,212,760     13,593,733
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
       Total....................................................................    13,890,200     14,393,483     13,774,456
  Less treasury stock (750 shares at cost)......................................    (4,976,143)    (4,976,143)    (4,976,143)
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
       Total stockholder's equity...............................................     8,914,057      9,417,340      8,798,313
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDER'S EQUITY......................................   $12,336,016    $18,902,421    $15,322,398
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                       See notes to financial statements.
                                      F-18
 
<PAGE>
                               DYER & DYER, INC.
                              STATEMENTS OF INCOME
                  Years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996
                and the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             Year ended December 31,             Six months ended June 30,
                                                    -----------------------------------------    --------------------------
                                                       1994           1995           1996           1996           1997
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                 <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>
                                                                                                        (Unaudited)
REVENUES:
  Vehicle sales..................................   $52,245,947    $52,613,480    $60,870,919    $30,767,026    $31,373,513
  Parts, service and collision repair............     8,680,440      9,097,763     11,163,230      5,481,708      5,960,212
  Finance and insurance..........................       203,198        404,505        542,474        213,711        128,911
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
       Total.....................................    61,129,585     62,115,748     72,576,623     36,462,445     37,462,636
COST OF SALES....................................    54,121,066     55,776,668     62,547,497     31,969,022     32,377,247
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
GROSS PROFIT.....................................     7,008,519      6,339,080     10,029,126      4,493,423      5,085,389
SELLING, GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSES.....     6,160,564      5,621,343      6,997,283      3,353,559      3,498,432
DEPRECIATION AND AMORTIZATION....................       123,228         90,538        126,359         45,451        150,621
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
OPERATING INCOME.................................       724,727        627,199      2,905,484      1,094,413      1,436,336
OTHER INCOME AND EXPENSE:
  Interest expense, floor plan...................        56,944        171,690        372,590        178,970        276,393
  Other income...................................       609,684        314,788        452,063        234,834        247,213
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
       Total other income (expense)..............       552,740        143,098         79,473         55,864        (29,180)
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
INCOME BEFORE INCOME TAXES.......................     1,277,467        770,297      2,984,957      1,150,277      1,407,156
PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES (Notes 1
  and 5).........................................       491,365        295,850        954,846        954,846             --
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
NET INCOME.......................................   $   786,102    $   474,447    $ 2,030,111    $   195,431    $ 1,407,156
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
PRO FORMA PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES (Note 5)....                                 $ 1,149,507    $   442,972    $   541,896
                                                                                  -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                  -----------    -----------    -----------
PRO FORMA NET INCOME (Note 5)....................                                 $ 1,835,450    $   707,305    $   865,260
                                                                                  -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                  -----------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                       See notes to financial statements
                                      F-19
 
<PAGE>
                               DYER & DYER, INC.
                       STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDER'S EQUITY
                  Years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996
                     and the six months ended June 30, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                    Total
                                                             Common     Paid-in     Treasury       Retained      Stockholder's
                                                             Stock      Capital       Stock        Earnings        Equity
                                                            --------    -------    -----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                         <C>         <C>        <C>            <C>            <C>
BALANCE
  DECEMBER 31, 1993......................................   $153,100    $27,623    $(4,976,143)   $12,448,928    $ 7,653,508
  Net income.............................................         --         --             --        786,102        786,102
                                                            --------    -------    -----------    -----------    -----------
BALANCE
  DECEMBER 31, 1994......................................    153,100     27,623     (4,976,143)    13,235,030      8,439,610
  Net income.............................................         --         --             --        474,447        474,447
                                                            --------    -------    -----------    -----------    -----------
BALANCE
  DECEMBER 31, 1995......................................    153,100     27,623     (4,976,143)    13,709,477      8,914,057
  Dividends..............................................         --         --             --     (1,526,828)    (1,526,828)
  Net income.............................................         --         --             --      2,030,111      2,030,111
                                                            --------    -------    -----------    -----------    -----------
BALANCE
  DECEMBER 31, 1996......................................    153,100     27,623     (4,976,143)    14,212,760      9,417,340
  Dividends (unaudited)..................................         --         --             --     (2,026,183)    (2,026,183)
  Net income (unaudited).................................         --         --             --      1,407,156      1,407,156
                                                            --------    -------    -----------    -----------    -----------
BALANCE
  JUNE 30, 1997 (unaudited)..............................   $153,100    $27,623    $(4,976,143)   $13,593,733    $ 8,798,313
                                                            --------    -------    -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                            --------    -------    -----------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                       See notes to financial statements.
                                      F-20
 
<PAGE>
                               DYER & DYER, INC.
                            STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                  Years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996
                and the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                     Six months ended June
                                                                 Year ended December 31,                      30,
                                                          --------------------------------------    ------------------------
                                                             1994          1995          1996          1996          1997
                                                          ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------
<S>                                                       <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
                                                                                                          (Unaudited)
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income...........................................   $  786,102    $  474,447    $2,030,111    $  195,431    $1,407,156
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash
     provided by operating activities:
     (Gain) loss on disposal of fixed assets...........        8,011        11,757        86,745            --          (116)
     Depreciation and amortization.....................      123,228        90,538       126,359        45,451       150,621
     Changes in assets and liabilities that relate to
       operations:
     (Increase) decrease in accounts receivable........     (390,834)      191,714      (768,730)      (39,751)   (1,355,959)
     (Increase) decrease in inventories................       11,184    (4,213,189)   (6,028,157)   (1,566,226)    3,942,980
     (Increase) decrease in prepaid expenses...........       79,966      (177,992)      171,040       218,576        71,691
     Increase (decrease) in notes payable,
       floor plan......................................     (127,470)    2,581,585     4,535,310       290,990    (1,612,320)
     Increase (decrease) in accounts payable...........        7,048       498,092       620,180      (376,134)   (1,131,472)
     Increase (decrease) in other accrued
       liabilities.....................................      105,201      (187,726)      147,106       170,944        25,008
     Increase (decrease) in income taxes payable.......      (20,682)        8,484       760,526       760,526      (242,212)
                                                          ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------
       Total adjustments...............................     (204,348)   (1,196,737)     (349,621)     (495,624)     (151,779)
                                                          ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------
       Net cash provided by (used) in operating
          activities...................................      581,754      (722,290)    1,680,490      (300,193)    1,255,377
                                                          ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchase of property and equipment...................      (18,485)     (181,259)     (717,969)      (14,013)      (26,938)
  Increase in cash value of life insurance.............      (15,398)      (26,316)       (4,622)       (2,311)       (5,174)
  Deposits held by financial institutions..............       13,001        10,849       (12,337)       22,238        34,575
                                                          ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------
       Net cash provided by (used) in investing
          activities...................................      (20,882)     (196,726)     (734,928)        5,914         2,463
                                                          ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Dividends paid.......................................           --            --    (1,526,828)     (759,810)   (2,026,183)
                                                          ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------
INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH............................      560,872      (919,016)     (581,266)   (1,054,089)     (768,343)
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AT BEGINNING OF PERIOD.......    1,880,690     2,441,562     1,522,546     1,522,546       941,280
                                                          ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AT END OF PERIOD.............   $2,441,562    $1,522,546    $  941,280    $  468,457    $  172,937
                                                          ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------
                                                          ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION:
  Cash paid during the period for:
     Interest..........................................   $   57,766    $  176,464    $  509,621    $  247,970    $  279,460
     Income taxes......................................   $  399,605    $  438,810    $   31,826    $   31,826    $  242,237
</TABLE>
 
                       See notes to financial statements.
                                      F-21
 
<PAGE>
                               DYER & DYER, INC.
                         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
     Organization and Business -- Dyer & Dyer, Inc. (the "Company") was
incorporated in South Carolina in 1978, and operates a Volvo automobile
dealership in Atlanta, Georgia. The Company sells new and used cars, sells
replacement parts, provides vehicle maintenance, warranty, paint and repair
services and arranges related financing and insurance.
     In August 1997, the Company signed a definitive purchase agreement whereby
its net assets would be acquired by Sonic Automotive, Inc. ("Sonic") for $18
million. This acquisition is to be effective prior to the completion of an
anticipated public offering of common stock by Sonic in 1997. In addition to the
$18 million, the Company's stockholder will receive a warrant entitling the
holder to acquire common stock of Sonic Automotive at an exercise price equal to
the public offering stock price.
     In connection with Volvo's approval of the sale of the Company to Sonic,
Volvo, among other things, conditioned its approval upon Richard Dyer, acquiring
and maintaining a 20% interest in the subsidiary of Sonic that will operate the
Volvo franchise. Mr. Dyer will finance all of the purchase price for this 20%
interest by the issuance of a promissory note to be secured by Mr. Dyers'
interest in the dealership. The principal amount of the note will be $3.6
million and it will bear interest at the lowest applicable federal rate, payable
annually. Mr. Dyers' interest in the dealership will be redeemed and the note
will be due and payable in full when Volvo no longer requires Mr. Dyer to
maintain his interest in the dealership.
     Revenue Recognition -- The Company records revenue when vehicles are
delivered to customers, and when vehicle service work is performed. Finance and
insurance commission revenue is recognized principally at the time the contract
is placed with the financial institution.
     Dealer Agreements -- The Company purchases substantially all of its new
vehicles from the manufacturer at the prevailing prices charged by the
manufacturer to its franchised dealers. The Company's sales could be unfavorably
impacted by the manufacturer's unwillingness or inability to supply the
dealership with an adequate supply of new car inventory.
     The dealership operates under a dealer agreement with the manufacturer
which generally restricts the location, management and ownership of the
dealership. The ability of the Company to acquire additional franchises may be
limited due to certain restrictions imposed by the manufacturer. Additionally,
the Company's ability to enter into significant acquisitions may be restricted
and the acquisition of the Company's stock by third parties may be limited by
the terms of the franchise agreement.
     The manufacturer has implemented various incentive programs for its dealers
that provide for specified payments to the dealers based on the results of
customer satisfaction surveys and the implementation of certain standardized
policies and procedures. These programs are for a limited duration and remain
subject to cancellation by the manufacturer at any time. Incentive payments
credited to cost of sales amounted to approximately $210,000, $267,000 and
$1,326,000 during 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively, and $290,000 and $912,000
for the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997, respectively.
     Cash and Cash Equivalents -- The Company considers contracts in transit and
all highly liquid debt instruments with an initial maturity of three months or
less to be cash equivalents. Contracts in transit represent cash in transit to
the Company from finance companies related to vehicle purchases, and was
approximately $1,522,000 and $934,000 at December 31, 1995 and 1996,
respectively, and $167,000 at June 30, 1997.
     Inventories -- Inventories of new vehicles, including demonstators, are
valued at the lower of last-in, first-out ("LIFO") cost or market. Inventories
of used vehicles are stated at the lower of first-in, first-out ("FIFO") cost or
market, and parts and accessories are stated at the lower of specific cost or
market.
     Property and Equipment -- Property and equipment are stated at cost.
Depreciation is computed using straight-line and accelerated methods over the
estimated useful lives of the assets. The range of estimated useful lives are as
follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                            Useful Lives
                                                                                            ------------
<S>                                                                                         <C>
Office equipment and fixtures............................................................     5-7
Parts and service equipment..............................................................      5
Company vehicles.........................................................................      5
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-22
 
<PAGE>
                               DYER & DYER, INC.
                   NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES -- Continued
     Leasehold improvements are amortized over the lesser of the terms of their
respective leases or the estimated useful lives of the related assets.
Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred. Significant
betterments are capitalized.
     Income Taxes -- For the years ended December 31, 1994 and 1995, the Company
was a C Corporation and, therefore, provided for income taxes using the balance
sheet method. There were no significant deferred tax assets and liabilities as
of December 31, 1995. Effective January 1, 1996, the Company elected to be
treated as an S Corporation for federal and state income tax purposes. As such
the Company's taxable income is included in the stockholder's annual income tax
return. Accordingly, no provision for federal or state income taxes has been
included in the Company's statements of income for the periods beginning after
December 31, 1995, except for the amounts associated with the Company's change
to an S corporation (See Note 5).
     Concentrations of Credit Risk -- Financial instruments which potentially
subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk consist principally of cash
on deposit with financial institutions. At times, amounts invested with
financial institutions may exceed FDIC insurance limits.
     Concentrations of credit risk with respect to receivables are limited
primarily to automobile manufacturers and financial institutions. Credit risk
arising from trade receivables from commercial customers is reduced by the large
number of customers comprising the trade receivables balances. Trade receivables
are concentrated in the Atlanta, Georgia area.
     Use of Estimates -- The preparation of financial statements in conformity
with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make
estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of
the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses
during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
     Advertising -- The Company expenses advertising costs in the period
incurred. Advertising expense approximated $709,000, $525,000 and $765,000
during 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
     Impairment of Long-Lived Assets -- Effective January 1, 1996, the Company
adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 121, Accounting for the Impairment of
Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed Of. This statement
requires that long-lived assets be reviewed for impairment whenever events or
changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not
be recoverable. Adoption of SFAS No. 121 did not have a material impact on the
Company's results of operations or financial position.
     Interim Financial Information -- The accompanying unaudited financial
information for the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997 has been prepared on
substantially the same basis as the audited financial statements, and include
all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for
a fair presentation of the financial information set forth therein. The results
of interim periods are not necessarily indicative of results to be expected for
the entire fiscal year.
2. INVENTORIES AND RELATED NOTES PAYABLE -- FLOOR PLAN
     Inventories consist of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          December 31,
                                                                                   --------------------------     June 30,
                                                                                      1995           1996           1997
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                                <C>            <C>            <C>
                                                                                                                 (Unaudited)
New vehicles....................................................................   $ 5,692,043    $ 7,980,256    $ 5,017,765
Used vehicles...................................................................     2,768,230      6,362,410      5,542,979
Parts and accessories...........................................................       503,490        586,129        420,959
Other...........................................................................        79,393        142,518        146,630
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
Total...........................................................................   $ 9,043,156    $15,071,313    $11,128,333
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
     At December 31, 1995 and 1996 and at June 30, 1997, the excess of current
replacement cost over the stated LIFO valuation of new vehicles, parts and
accessories amount to $2,387,114, $2,503,330 and $2,503,330 (unaudited),
respectively.
                                      F-23
 
<PAGE>
                               DYER & DYER, INC.
                   NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
2. INVENTORIES AND RELATED NOTES PAYABLE -- FLOOR PLAN -- Continued
     Had the Company used the FIFO method of valuing new vehicle, parts and
accessories inventory, pretax earnings would have been $1,335,380, $1,200,776
and $3,101,173 in 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
     All new and certain used vehicles are pledged to collateralize floor plan
notes payable to financial institutions in the amount of $2,610,935 and
$7,146,245 at December 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively. The floor plan notes
bear interest, payable monthly on the outstanding balance, at the prime rate
plus 1/2% to 1 1/2% (prime rate was 8.25% at December 31, 1996). Total floor
plan interest expense amounted to $56,944, $171,690 and $372,590 in 1994, 1995
and 1996, respectively. The notes payable are due when the related vehicle is
sold. As such, these floor plan notes payable are shown as a current liability
in the accompanying balance sheets.
3. PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT
     Property and equipment is comprised of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                             December 31,
                                                                                       ------------------------     June 30,
                                                                                          1995          1996          1997
                                                                                       ----------    ----------    ----------
<S>                                                                                    <C>           <C>           <C>
                                                                                                                   (Unaudited)
Leasehold improvements..............................................................   $1,479,385    $1,885,415    $1,885,415
Furniture and fixtures..............................................................    1,372,801     1,546,987     1,550,022
Other equipment.....................................................................      565,398       571,778       571,778
Computer equipment..................................................................      188,851       195,598       198,428
Service vehicles....................................................................      117,535       122,916       143,989
                                                                                       ----------    ----------    ----------
                                                                                        3,723,970     4,322,694     4,349,632
Less accumulated depreciation and amortization......................................   (2,949,061)   (3,042,920)   (3,193,425)
                                                                                       ----------    ----------    ----------
Property and equipment, net.........................................................   $  774,909    $1,279,774    $1,156,207
                                                                                       ----------    ----------    ----------
                                                                                       ----------    ----------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
4. LEASES
     The Company leases its business premises under noncancelable operating
leases for five to twenty-five year terms from a partnership partially owned by
the sole stockholder of the Company. Future minimum rental payments required
under noncancelable leases at December 31, 1996 are as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                        <C>
Year ending December 31:
1997....................................................................................   $  754,162
1998....................................................................................      756,956
1999....................................................................................      759,832
2000....................................................................................      762,800
2001....................................................................................      765,856
Thereafter..............................................................................    5,551,504
                                                                                           ----------
Total...................................................................................   $9,351,110
                                                                                           ----------
                                                                                           ----------
</TABLE>
 
     Rent expense approximated $711,000, $708,000 and $715,000 during 1994, 1995
and 1996, respectively.
                                      F-24
 
<PAGE>
                               DYER & DYER, INC.
                   NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
5. INCOME TAXES
     The provision for income taxes consists of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                      December 31,
                                                                                            --------------------------------
                                                                                              1994        1995        1996
                                                                                            --------    --------    --------
<S>                                                                                         <C>         <C>         <C>
Current:
  Federal................................................................................   $439,714    $231,720    $811,620
  State..................................................................................     47,463      40,864     143,226
                                                                                            --------    --------    --------
                                                                                             487,177     272,584     954,846
Deferred.................................................................................      4,188      23,266          --
                                                                                            --------    --------    --------
Total....................................................................................   $491,365    $295,850    $954,846
                                                                                            --------    --------    --------
                                                                                            --------    --------    --------
</TABLE>
 
     Effective with the Company's S Corporation election, it was required to
recapture its December 31, 1995 LIFO reserve of approximately $2,400,000 and pay
tax on that amount for both Federal and State income tax purposes. The taxes are
payable in four equal annual installments beginning March 15, 1996. This
conversion to S Corporation status resulted in the recognition of approximately
$955,000 in income tax expense.
     As a result of the Company's change to S Corporation status on January 1,
1996 (see Note 1), it is exposed to potential future taxes on built-in gains
which were present on the date of the conversion. If the planned acquisition of
the net assets of the Company described in Note 1 is consummated, the disposal
of tangible and intangible property which appreciated prior to the election of S
Corporation status will result in the assessment of the built-in gains tax.
     The pro forma provision for income taxes and the pro forma net income for
the year ended December 31, 1996 and the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997
reflect amounts that would have been recorded had the Company's income been
taxed for federal and state purposes as if it was a C Corporation.
6. RETIREMENT PLAN
     The Company has a contributory 401(k) plan covering substantially all
employees. Company contributions to the Plan are equal to 25% of the first 4% of
participant contributions. Company contributions amounted to $1,000, $18,000 and
$18,000 in 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
                                      F-25
 
<PAGE>
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
TO THE BOARDS OF DIRECTORS AND STOCKHOLDERS OF
BOWERS DEALERSHIPS AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
Chattanooga, Tennessee
     We have audited the accompanying combined balance sheets of Bowers
Dealerships and Affiliated Companies (the "Company"), which are under common
ownership and management, as of December 31, 1995 and 1996, and the related
combined statements of income, stockholders' equity, and cash flows for the
years then ended. These financial statements are the responsibility of the
Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these
financial statements based on our audits.
     We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
     In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly,
in all material respects, the combined financial position of Bowers Dealerships
and Affiliated Companies as of December 31, 1995 and 1996, and the combined
results of their operations and their combined cash flows for the years then
ended in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.
DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
Charlotte, North Carolina
August 7, 1997 (October 16, 1997 as to Note 1)
                                      F-26
 
<PAGE>
                               BOWERS DEALERSHIPS
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                            COMBINED BALANCE SHEETS
                  December 31, 1995 and 1996 and June 30, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          December 31,
                                                                                   --------------------------     June 30,
                                                                                      1995           1996           1997
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                                <C>            <C>            <C>
                                                                                                                 (Unaudited)
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and cash equivalents.....................................................   $ 1,385,006    $ 2,738,432    $ 4,766,608
  Receivables...................................................................     1,622,865      3,088,329      2,648,740
  Inventories (Note 3)..........................................................    10,752,116     19,605,557     30,948,007
  Other current assets (Note 7).................................................       994,715      2,067,241      2,778,937
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
       Total current assets.....................................................    14,754,702     27,499,559     41,142,292
PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, NET (Note4).............................................       870,400      3,825,229      4,105,822
GOODWILL, NET (Note 1)..........................................................       978,735      4,374,573      8,285,460
OTHER ASSETS....................................................................       560,729        564,240        658,529
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
TOTAL ASSETS....................................................................   $17,164,566    $36,263,601    $54,192,103
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
  Notes payable -- floor plan (Note 3)..........................................   $10,187,565    $16,695,482    $26,771,632
  Notes payable -- other (Note 6)...............................................     1,770,025      3,256,407      3,684,869
  Trade accounts payable........................................................       185,858      1,012,806      1,189,736
  Accrued interest..............................................................        69,164        105,505        178,143
  Other accrued liabilities.....................................................       580,745      1,397,118      1,424,075
  Current maturities of long-term debt..........................................       363,851        285,469        427,557
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
       Total current liabilities................................................    13,157,208     22,752,787     33,676,012
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
LONG-TERM DEBT (Note 6).........................................................       668,390      2,224,813      2,332,276
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Notes 5 and 10)
EQUITY
  Common stock of combined companies (Note 8):..................................       300,000        300,000        300,000
  Retained earnings and members' and partners' equity...........................     3,038,968     10,986,001     17,883,815
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
       Total equity.............................................................     3,338,968     11,286,001     18,183,815
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND EQUITY....................................................   $17,164,566    $36,263,601    $54,192,103
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                   See notes to combined financial statements
                                      F-27
 
<PAGE>
                               BOWERS DEALERSHIPS
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                         COMBINED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
                     Years ended December 31, 1995 and 1996
                and the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     Year ended December 31,      Six months ended June 30,
                                                    --------------------------    --------------------------
                                                       1995           1996           1996           1997
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                 <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>
                                                                                         (Unaudited)
REVENUES:
  Vehicle sales..................................   $67,318,855    $91,182,583    $37,133,540    $63,950,004
  Parts, service and collision repair............     3,939,295      7,969,924      3,337,725      9,107,226
  Finance and insurance..........................     1,843,590      2,337,303      1,107,834      1,496,912
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
       Total revenues............................    73,101,740    101,489,810     41,579,099     74,554,142
COST OF SALES....................................    63,581,225     87,756,814     35,532,069     63,945,021
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
GROSS PROFIT.....................................     9,520,515     13,732,996      6,047,030     10,609,121
SELLING, GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSES.....     8,004,120     11,807,108      5,080,153      8,293,720
DEPRECIATION AND AMORTIZATION....................       186,545        364,958        137,879        309,048
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
OPERATING INCOME.................................     1,329,850      1,560,930        828,998      2,006,353
OTHER INCOME AND EXPENSE:
  Interest expense, floor plan...................       964,399      1,177,603        569,072        880,676
  Interest expense, other........................        75,365        195,954         64,374        118,666
  Other income (expense).........................       (29,827)       120,511         21,714        421,730
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
       Total other expense.......................     1,069,591      1,253,046        611,732        577,612
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
INCOME BEFORE INCOME TAXES (Note 1)..............       260,259        307,884        217,266      1,428,741
PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES.......................        41,879         60,851         60,215         30,927
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
NET INCOME.......................................   $   218,380    $   247,033    $   157,051    $ 1,397,814
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
PRO FORMA PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES (Note 1)....   $   101,709    $   120,321    $    84,907    $   558,352
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
PRO FORMA NET INCOME (Note 1)....................   $   158,550    $   187,563    $   132,359    $   870,389
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                    -----------    -----------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                   See notes to combined financial statements
                                      F-28
 
<PAGE>
                               BOWERS DEALERSHIPS
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                         COMBINED STATEMENTS OF EQUITY
                     Years ended December 31, 1995 and 1996
                     and the six months ended June 30, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                   Retained
                                                                                                   Earnings
                                                                                                      and
                                                                                      Common       Members'
                                                                                     Stock of         and
                                                                                     Combined      Partners'        Total
                                                                                    Companies       Equity         Equity
                                                                                    ----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                                 <C>           <C>            <C>
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1994.....................................................   $  300,000    $ 1,032,746    $ 1,332,746
  Capital contribution...........................................................           --      1,787,842      1,787,842
  Net income.....................................................................           --        218,380        218,380
                                                                                    ----------    -----------    -----------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1995.....................................................      300,000      3,038,968      3,338,968
  Capital contribution...........................................................           --      7,700,000      7,700,000
  Net income.....................................................................           --        247,033        247,033
                                                                                    ----------    -----------    -----------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1996.....................................................      300,000     10,986,001     11,286,001
  Capital contribution (unaudited)...............................................           --      5,500,000      5,500,000
  Net income (unaudited).........................................................           --      1,397,814      1,397,814
                                                                                    ----------    -----------    -----------
BALANCE AT JUNE 30, 1997 (unaudited).............................................   $  300,000    $17,883,815    $18,183,815
                                                                                    ----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                    ----------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                  See notes to combined financial statements.
                                      F-29
 
<PAGE>
                               BOWERS DEALERSHIPS
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                       COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                   Years ended December 31, 1995 and 1996 and
                  the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                     Six months ended June
                                                                       Year ended December 31,                30,
                                                                      --------------------------    ------------------------
                                                                         1995           1996           1996          1997
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
<S>                                                                   <C>            <C>            <C>           <C>
                                                                                                          (Unaudited)
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income.......................................................   $   218,380    $   247,033    $  157,051    $1,397,814
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used
     in) operating activities:
     Depreciation and amortization.................................       186,545        364,958       137,879       309,048
     Changes in assets and liabilities that relate to operations:
       (Increase) decrease in receivables..........................       479,709     (1,465,463)      492,538       439,590
       (Increase) decrease in inventories..........................       149,322     (2,990,886)     (129,128)   (8,623,984)
       Increase in other current assets............................      (231,440)    (1,072,526)     (538,493)     (711,698)
       Increase in other non-current assets........................      (450,803)        (3,511)     (135,291)      (94,289)
       Increase (decrease) in notes payable -- floor plan..........      (198,815)     6,507,915     2,301,244    10,076,150
       Increase (decrease) in accounts payable and accrued
          expenses.................................................    (1,151,902)     1,679,663     1,073,370       276,524
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
          Total adjustments........................................    (1,217,384)     3,020,150     3,202,119     1,671,341
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
       Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities.........      (999,004)     3,267,183     3,359,170     3,069,155
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchase of business, net of cash received.......................            --     (9,840,438)   (4,790,970)   (6,718,465)
  Additions to property and equipment..............................      (263,811)    (2,737,742)   (2,850,697)     (500,528)
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
       Net cash used in investing activities.......................      (263,811)   (12,578,180)   (7,641,667)   (7,218,993)
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Capital contributions............................................     1,787,842      7,700,000     2,700,000     5,500,000
  Proceeds from long-term debt.....................................       272,084      1,872,169     1,872,169       500,000
  Payments of long-term debt.......................................      (797,363)      (394,129)     (114,690)     (250,448)
  Proceeds from notes payable -- other.............................     1,410,025      1,486,382     1,600,994       539,000
  Payments of notes payable -- other...............................      (220,000)            --            --      (110,538)
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
       Net cash provided by financing activities...................     2,452,588     10,664,422     6,058,473     6,178,014
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
NET INCREASE IN CASH...............................................     1,189,773      1,353,425     1,775,976     2,028,176
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF PERIOD.....................       195,234      1,385,007     1,385,007     2,738,432
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF PERIOD...........................   $ 1,385,007    $ 2,738,432    $3,160,983    $4,766,608
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
                                                                      -----------    -----------    ----------    ----------
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION --
  Cash paid during the period for:
  Interest.........................................................   $ 1,021,118    $ 1,337,216    $  649,259    $  926,704
  Income taxes.....................................................   $    96,391    $    76,081    $   35,636    $   27,620
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF NON-CASH TRANSACTIONS:
  Net liabilities recorded from combining affiliated companies.....   $   372,533    $        --    $       --    $       --
</TABLE>
 
                  See notes to combined financial statements.
                                      F-30
 
<PAGE>
                               BOWERS DEALERSHIPS
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                     NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
1. DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
     Organization and Business -- Bowers Dealerships and Affiliated Companies
(the "Company") operates automobile dealerships in the Chattanooga and
Nashville, Tennessee areas. The Company sells new and used cars and light
trucks, sells replacement parts, provides vehicle maintenance, warranty, paint
and repair services and arranges financing and insurance. As of December 31,
1996, the Company had eight dealership locations selling new vehicles
manufactured by BMW, Chrysler, Ford, Honda, Infiniti, Jaguar, and Volkswagen.
Subsequent to December 31, 1996 the Company acquired a Dodge dealership. (see
Note 2).
     The accompanying combined financial statements include the accounts of the
following entities:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                          Name                              Location              Structure
                         -----                             -----------    -------------------------
<S>                                                        <C>            <C>
Cleveland Village Imports, Inc..........................   Chattanooga          C Corporation
Nelson Bowers Ford, L.P.................................   Chattanooga       Limited Partnership
Infiniti of Chattanooga, Inc............................   Chattanooga          C Corporation
Cleveland Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC.............   Chattanooga    Limited Liability Company
Jaguar of Chattanooga, LLC..............................   Chattanooga    Limited Liability Company
KIA of Chattanooga......................................   Chattanooga    Limited Liability Company
European Motors of Nashville LLC........................   Nashville      Limited Liability Company
European Motors LLC.....................................   Chattanooga    Limited Liability Company
</TABLE>
 
     The combined financial statements have been prepared in connection with a
planned acquisition of the net assets of these entities and the aforementioned
Dodge dealership by Sonic Automotive ("Sonic"). Sonic will purchase the net
assets of the above entities for a total purchase price of $27.6 million,
comprised of $23.6 in cash and a $4 million note payable. This acquisition is to
be effective prior to the completion of an anticipated public offering of common
stock by Sonic in 1997. The accompanying combined financial statements reflect
the financial position, results of operations, and cash flows of each of the
above listed dealerships. The combination of these entities has been accounted
for at historical cost in a manner similar to a pooling-of-interest because the
entities are under common management and control. All material intercompany
transactions have been eliminated.
     In connection with Volvo's approval of the sale of the Company's Volvo
dealership to Sonic, Volvo, among other things, conditioned its approval upon
Nelson Bowers, acquiring and maintaining a 20% interest in the subsidiary of
Sonic that will operate the Volvo franchise. Mr. Bowers will finance all of the
purchase price for this 20% interest by issuing a promissory note to the
subsidiary of Sonic that controls the majority interest in Chattanooga Volvo.
This note will be secured by Mr. Bowers' interest in Chattanooga Volvo. The
principal amount of the note will be approximately $900,000 and it will bear
interest at the lowest applicable federal rate payable annually. Mr. Bowers'
interest in Chattanooga Volvo will be redeemed and this note will be due and
payable in full when Volvo no longer requires Mr. Bowers to maintain his
interest in Chattanooga Volvo.
     Revenue Recognition -- The Company records revenue when vehicles are
delivered to customers, and when vehicle service work is performed. Finance and
insurance commission revenue is recognized principally at the time the contract
is placed with the financial institution.
     Dealer Agreements -- The Company purchases substantially all of its new
vehicles from manufacturers at the prevailing prices charged by the manufacturer
to its franchised dealers. The Company's sales could be unfavorably impacted by
the manufacturer's unwillingness or inability to supply the dealership with an
adequate supply of new car inventory.
     Each dealership operates under a dealer agreement with the manufacturer
except Volkswagen of Nashville which operates under a management agreement which
generally restricts the location, management and ownership of the respective
dealership. The ability of the Company to acquire additional franchises from a
particular manufacturer may be limited due to certain restrictions imposed by
manufacturers. Additionally, the Company's ability to enter into significant
acquisitions may be restricted and the acquisition of the Company's stock by
third parties may be limited by the terms of the franchise agreement.
                                      F-31
 
<PAGE>
                               BOWERS DEALERSHIPS
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
1. DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING
POLICIES -- Continued
     Cash and Cash Equivalents -- The Company considers contracts in transit and
all highly liquid debt instruments with an initial maturity of three months or
less to be cash equivalents. Contracts in transit represent cash in transit to
the Company from finance companies related to a vehicle purchase, and was
$654,165 and $1,702,294 at December 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
     Inventories -- Inventories of new and used vehicles, including
demonstrators, are valued at the lower of first-in, first-out ("FIFO") cost or
market, and parts and accessories are stated at the lower of specific cost or
market.
     Property and Equipment -- Property and equipment are stated at cost.
Depreciation is computed using straight-line and accelerated methods over the
estimated useful lives of the assets. The range of estimated useful lives is as
follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                Useful Lives
                                                                                -------------
<S>                                                                             <C>
Building.....................................................................      31.5-39
Office equipment and fixtures................................................        5-7
Parts, service equipment and vehicles........................................         7
</TABLE>
 
     Leasehold improvements are amortized over the lesser of the terms of their
respective leases or the estimated useful lives of the related assets.
     Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred.
Significant betterments are capitalized.
     Goodwill -- Goodwill represents the excess of purchase price over the
estimated fair value of the net assets acquired and is being amortized over a 40
year period. The cumulative amount of goodwill amortization at December 31, 1995
and 1996 was $33,561 and $87,723, respectively.
     The Company periodically reviews goodwill for impairment by comparing the
carrying amount of goodwill with the estimated undiscounted future cash flows
from operations of the acquired business.
     Income Taxes -- With the exception of Infiniti of Chattanooga, Inc. and
Cleveland Village Imports, Inc., all entities included in the accompanying
combined financial statements are either S Corporations, Limited Partnerships or
Limited Liability Companies (LLC). As such, these entities do not pay Federal
corporate income taxes on their taxable income. In addition, the Limited
Partnerships and LLC's are not subject to state income taxes. The stockholders
or partners are liable for individual income taxes on their respective shares of
the Company's taxable income.
     Because Infiniti of Chattanooga, Inc. and Cleveland Village Imports, Inc.
is a C Corporation, federal and state income taxes are provided for in the
financial statements and consist of taxes currently due plus deferred taxes. In
addition, the S Corporations are subject to Tennessee income taxes which are
provided for in the financial statements. Income taxes are provided for income
taxes using the balance sheet method. Deferred taxes result primarily from
warranty accruals and the accelerated depreciation method used for income tax
purposes. The deferred tax assets and liabilities represent the future tax
return consequences of those differences, which will either be taxable or
deductible when the assets and liabilities are recovered or settled. In
addition, deferred tax assets are recognized for state operating losses that are
available to offset future taxable income.
     The pro forma provision for income taxes and the pro forma net income for
the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1996, and for the six months ended June
30, 1996 and 1997 reflect amounts that would have been recorded had the
Company's income been taxed for federal and state purposes as if it was a C
Corporation.
     Concentrations of Credit Risk -- Financial instruments which potentially
subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk consist principally of cash
deposits. At times, amounts invested with financial institutions may exceed FDIC
insurance limits.
                                      F-32
 
<PAGE>
                               BOWERS DEALERSHIPS
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
1. DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING
POLICIES -- Continued
     Concentrations of credit risk with respect to receivables are limited
primarily to automobile manufacturers and financial institutions. Credit risk
arising from trade receivables from commercial customers is reduced by the large
number of customers comprising the trade receivables balances. Trade receivables
are concentrated in the Company's two market areas of Chattanooga and Nashville,
Tennessee.
     Use of Estimates -- The preparation of financial statements in conformity
with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make
estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of
the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses
during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
     Advertising -- The Company expenses advertising costs in the period
incurred. Advertising expense amounted to $744,674 and $1,132,263 for 1995 and
1996, respectively.
     Impairment of Long-Lived Assets -- Effective January 1, 1996, the Company
adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 121, Accounting for the Impairment of
Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed Of. This statement
requires that long-lived assets be reviewed for impairment whenever events or
changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may be
impaired. Adoption of SFAS No. 121 did not have a material impact on the
Company's results of operations or financial position.
     Interim Financial Information -- The accompanying unaudited financial
information for the six months ended June 30, 1997 has been prepared on
substantially the same basis as the audited financial statements, and include
all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for
a fair presentation of the financial information set forth therein. The results
of interim periods are not necessarily indicative of results to be expected for
the entire fiscal year.
2. BUSINESS ACQUISITIONS
     European Motors LLC -- In May 1996, the Company acquired European Motors
LLC for a total purchase price of $4,790,970. The acquisition has been accounted
for as a purchase and the results of operations of European Motors LLC have been
included in the accompanying combined financial statements from the date of
acquisition. The total purchase price has been allocated to the assets and
liabilities acquired at their estiamted fair market value at acquisition date as
follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                            <C>
Inventory...................................................................   $3,840,970
Property and equipment......................................................      250,000
Goodwill....................................................................      700,000
                                                                               ----------
Total.......................................................................   $4,790,970
                                                                               ----------
                                                                               ----------
</TABLE>
 
     European Motors of Nashville, Inc. -- In October 1996, the Company acquired
European Motors of Nashville, Inc. The total purchase price was $5,049,468. The
acquisition has been accounted for using purchase accounting and the results of
operations of this dealership has been included in the accompanying combined
financial statements from the date of acquisition. The total purchase price has
been allocated to the assets and liabilities acquired at their estimated fair
market value at acquisition date as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                            <C>
Inventory...................................................................   $2,003,086
Property and equipment......................................................      296,382
Goodwill....................................................................    2,750,000
                                                                               ----------
Total.......................................................................   $5,049,468
                                                                               ----------
                                                                               ----------
</TABLE>
 
     Dodge of Chattanooga -- On March 1, 1997, the Company acquired Dodge of
Chattanooga for a total purchase price of $6,718,465. The acquisition has been
accounted for as a purchase and the results of operations of Dodge of
Chattanooga have been included in the accompanying unaudited combined financial
statements from the date of acquisition through June 30,
                                      F-33
 
<PAGE>
                               BOWERS DEALERSHIPS
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
2. BUSINESS ACQUISITIONS -- Continued
1997. The purchase price has been allocated to the assets and liabilities
acquired at their estimated fair market value at acquisition date as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                            <C>
Inventory...................................................................   $2,718,465
Goodwill....................................................................    4,000,000
                                                                               ----------
Total.......................................................................   $6,718,465
                                                                               ----------
                                                                               ----------
</TABLE>
 
     The following unaudited pro forma financial data is presented as if
European Motors of Nashville, Inc. and European Motors LLC were acquired on
January 1, 1995 and January 1, 1996, respectively.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    Year ended December 31,
                                                                  ----------------------------
                                                                      1995            1996
                                                                  ------------    ------------
<S>                                                               <C>             <C>
Revenues.......................................................   $130,223,683    $136,389,810
                                                                  ------------    ------------
                                                                  ------------    ------------
Net income.....................................................   $    694,050    $    476,033
                                                                  ------------    ------------
                                                                  ------------    ------------
</TABLE>
 
     The following unaudited pro forma financial data is presented as if Dodge
of Chattanooga, Inc. was acquired on January 1, 1996 and January 1, 1997,
respectively:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    Six months ended June 30,
                                                                    --------------------------
                                                                       1996           1997
                                                                    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                 <C>            <C>
Revenues.........................................................   $57,230,202    $78,452,142
                                                                    -----------    -----------
                                                                    -----------    -----------
Net income.......................................................   $   635,737    $ 1,404,814
                                                                    -----------    -----------
                                                                    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
     The pro forma information presented above is not necessarily indicative of
the operating results that would have occurred had European Motors of Nashville,
Inc. and European Motors LLC been acquired on January 1, 1995 and 1996,
respectively and Dodge of Chattanooga on January 1, 1996 and January 1, 1997.
These results are also not necessarily indicative of the results of future
operations.
3. INVENTORIES AND RELATED NOTES PAYABLE -- FLOOR PLAN
     Inventories consist of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          December 31,
                                                                                   --------------------------     June 30,
                                                                                      1995           1996           1997
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                                <C>            <C>            <C>
                                                                                                                 (Unaudited)
New vehicles....................................................................   $ 8,261,122    $13,622,029    $19,572,873
Used vehicles...................................................................     1,911,689      4,178,998      9,235,162
Parts and accessories...........................................................       564,263      1,707,880      1,837,802
Other...........................................................................        15,042         96,650        302,170
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
Total...........................................................................   $10,752,116    $19,605,557    $30,948,007
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
     All new and certain used vehicles are pledged to collateralize floor plan
notes payable to financial institutions in the amount of $10,187,565 and
$16,695,482 at December 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively. The floor plan notes
bear interest, that fluctuates with prime and are payable monthly on the
outstanding balance, ranging from 6.25% to 9.75% at December 31, 1996. Total
floor plan interest expense amounted to $964,399 and $1,177,603 in 1995 and
1996, respectively. The notes payable are due when the related vehicle is sold.
As such, these floor plan notes payable are shown as a current liability in the
accompanying combined balance sheets.
                                      F-34
 
<PAGE>
                               BOWERS DEALERSHIPS
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
4. PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT
     Property and equipment is comprised of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          December 31,
                                                                                   --------------------------     June 30,
                                                                                      1995           1996           1997
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                                <C>            <C>            <C>
                                                                                                                 (Unaudited)
Land............................................................................   $        --    $   608,307    $   638,557
Buildings and improvements......................................................        22,149      1,723,644      1,723,644
Office equipment and fixtures...................................................       844,823      1,208,546      1,422,551
Parts and service equipment.....................................................       630,827      1,200,983      1,491,388
Leasehold improvements..........................................................       254,693        262,260        262,261
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                     1,752,492      5,003,740      5,538,401
Less accumulated depreciation...................................................       882,092      1,178,511      1,432,579
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
Property and equipment, net.....................................................   $   870,400    $ 3,825,229    $ 4,105,822
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                   -----------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
5. OPERATING LEASES
     The Company leases its business premises under noncancelable operating
leases for one to twenty-six year terms. Future minimum rental payments required
under nonconcealable leases at December 31, 1996 are as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                            <C>
Year ending December 31:
1997........................................................................   $  929,765
1998........................................................................      687,431
1999........................................................................      387,120
2000........................................................................      387,120
2001........................................................................      387,120
Thereafter..................................................................    4,994,184
                                                                               ----------
Total.......................................................................   $7,772,740
                                                                               ----------
                                                                               ----------
</TABLE>
 
     Rent expense under these noncancelable leases amounted to $458,999 and
$740,187 during 1995 and 1996, respectively.
6. FINANCING ARRANGEMENTS
     Notes payable-other consists of a demand note to a bank and advances
principally from a stockholder. The stockholder advances are restricted to
investment in a cash management fund sponsored by finance companies. Other
current assets at December 31, 1995 and 1996 include $797,000 and $1,041,000,
respectively, of restricted cash in the cash management fund.
     Notes payable-other consist of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                               December 31,
                                                                         ------------------------     June 30,
                                                                            1995          1996          1997
                                                                         ----------    ----------    -----------
<S>                                                                      <C>           <C>           <C>
                                                                                                     (Unaudited)
Unsecured stockholder advances restricted for investment -- due on
  demand, interest ranging from 8.5% to 9.25%.........................   $  552,000    $1,041,000    $ 1,580,000
Other unsecured non-interest bearing stockholder advances due on
  demand..............................................................    1,218,025     2,215,407      2,104,869
                                                                         ----------    ----------    -----------
Notes payable -- other................................................   $1,770,025    $3,256,407    $ 3,684,869
                                                                         ----------    ----------    -----------
                                                                         ----------    ----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-35
 
<PAGE>
                               BOWERS DEALERSHIPS
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
6. FINANCING ARRANGEMENTS -- Continued
     Long-term debt consists of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                               December 31,
                                                                         ------------------------     June 30,
                                                                            1995          1996          1997
                                                                         ----------    ----------    -----------
<S>                                                                      <C>           <C>           <C>
                                                                                                     (Unaudited)
Mortgage note payable on land and building with a carrying value of
  $2,302,487, interest payable at 8.9%, due June 1, 2001..............   $       --    $1,799,152    $ 1,767,753
Note payable due to stockholder, interest payable at 9.5%, due
  December 31, 2001...................................................      564,000       564,000        564,000
Note payable related to purchase of dealership, due February 28,
  1999................................................................           --            --        333,333
Notes payable for equipment with a carrying value of $76,608, interest
  payable ranging from 9.6% to 11.18%, payable in full November 15,
  1997................................................................      109,380        76,199         45,332
Note payable on company owned vehicles, with a carrying value of
  approximately $20,253, bearing interest at 9.5%.....................      298,861        20,253             --
Note payable to an unrelated car dealership, due December 3, 1999.....       60,000        45,000         45,000
Note payable -- other.................................................           --         5,678          4,415
                                                                         ----------    ----------    -----------
                                                                          1,032,241     2,510,282      2,759,833
Less current maturities...............................................     (363,851)     (285,469)      (427,557)
                                                                         ----------    ----------    -----------
Long-term debt........................................................   $  668,390    $2,224,813    $ 2,332,276
                                                                         ----------    ----------    -----------
                                                                         ----------    ----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
     Future maturities of the above debt at December 31, 1996 are as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                            <C>
Year ending December 31:
1997........................................................................   $  285,469
1998........................................................................      259,650
1999........................................................................      372,930
2000........................................................................       89,829
2001........................................................................    1,502,404
                                                                               ----------
Total.......................................................................   $2,510,282
                                                                               ----------
                                                                               ----------
</TABLE>
 
7. RELATED PARTIES
     The Company operates certain dealerships at facilities leased from
affiliated companies. The leases are classified as operating leases. Future
minimum rent payments are $483,390 in 1997, $387,390 annually through 2001 and
$4,994,184 thereafter. Rent expense in 1995 and 1996 for these leases amounted
to $315,390 and $441,390, respectively.
     The Company has made non-interest bearing advances to stockholders totaling
$403,415, which was outstanding as of December 31, 1995 and 1996 and June 30,
1997, respectively. These amounts are reflected in other non-current assets in
the accompanying combined balance sheets.
     The Company also made advances to stockholders totaling $459,818, which
primarily relates to the purchase of real estate and the construction of a
facility owned by an entity affiliated through common ownership. This amount is
included in other current assets, as it is the opinion of Company management
that this amount will be collected in full by December 31, 1997.
     The Company purchases advertising services from an entity affiliated
through common ownership. Advertising expenses from services received from this
entity included in the accompanying statements of operations for the years ended
December 31, 1995 and 1996 was $422,777 and $412,982, respectively.
     The Company sells extended warranty contracts to customers related to
vehicle sales through warranty contracts procured from an entity affiliated
through common ownership. Total premiums paid to this affiliated entity for
these contracts totaled $389,620 and $453,850 for the years ended December 31,
1995 and 1996, respectively.
                                      F-36
 
<PAGE>
                               BOWERS DEALERSHIPS
                            AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
7. RELATED PARTIES -- Continued
     The Company purchases products and services from an entity affiliated
through common ownership relative to automobile etching and automobile pack
products sold to customers. Total products and services purchased for the years
ended December 31, 1995 and 1996 was $69,733 and $97,164 respectively.
     For the year ended December 31, 1996, the Company paid $23,760 for services
provided to an automobile auction entity which is related through common
ownership.
8. EQUITY
     During 1997, an entity affiliated through common ownership began paying the
salaries of certain executive officers and other selling, general and
administrative expenses relating to the Company. The affiliated company charged
the Company management fees during the six months ended June 30, 1997 totaling
$864,000 for the reimbursement of amounts paid by the affiliate on behalf of the
Company.
     The capital structure of the entities included in the combined financial
statements of the Company at December 31, 1995 is as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             Common Stock
                                                           -------------------------------------------------
                                                                                     Shares                     Retained Earnings
                                                            Par        Shares      Issued and                   and Members' and
                                                           Value     Authorized    Outstanding      Amount      Partners' Equity
                                                           ------    ----------    -----------    ----------    -----------------
<S>                                                        <C>       <C>           <C>            <C>           <C>
Cleveland Village Imports, Inc..........................   No par         2,000        2,000      $  300,000       $   552,817
Nelson Bowers Ford, L.P.................................                                                  --           759,039
Cleveland Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC.............                                                  --           562,328
Jaguar of Chattanooga, LLC..............................                                                  --         1,164,784
                                                                                                  ----------    -----------------
                                                                                                  $  300,000       $ 3,038,968
                                                                                                  ----------    -----------------
                                                                                                  ----------    -----------------
</TABLE>
 
     The capital structure of the entities included in the combined financial
statements of the Company at December 31, 1996 is as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             Common Stock
                                                           -------------------------------------------------
                                                                                     Shares                     Retained Earnings
                                                            Par        Shares      Issued and                   and Members' and
                                                           Value     Authorized    Outstanding      Amount      Partners' Equity
                                                           ------    ----------    -----------    ----------    -----------------
<S>                                                        <C>       <C>           <C>            <C>           <C>
Cleveland Village Imports, Inc..........................   No par         2,000        2,000      $  300,000       $   563,672
Nelson Bowers Ford, L.P.................................                                                  --           699,958
Cleveland Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC.............                                                  --           417,300
Jaguar of Chattanooga, LLC..............................                                                  --         1,141,782
European Motors of Nashville, LLC.......................                                                  --         5,014,936
European Motors LLC.....................................                                                  --         3,148,353
                                                                                                  ----------    -----------------
                                                                                                  $  300,000       $10,986,001
                                                                                                  ----------    -----------------
                                                                                                  ----------    -----------------
</TABLE>
 
9. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
     In April 1997, the Company established a 401(k) plan, whereby substantially
all of the employees of the company meeting certain service requirements are
eligible to participate. Contributions by the Company to the plan were not
significant in any period presented.
10. CONTINGENCIES
     The Company is involved in various legal proceedings. Management believes
that the outcome of such proceedings will not have a materially adverse effect
on the Company's financial position or future results of operations and cash
flows.
                                      F-37
 
<PAGE>
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
TO THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND STOCKHOLDERS OF
LAKE NORMAN DODGE, INC.
Cornelius, North Carolina
     We have audited the accompanying combined balance sheet of Lake Norman
Dodge, Inc. and Affiliated Companies (the "Company"), which are under common
ownership and management, as of December 31, 1996, and the related combined
statements of income, stockholders' equity, and cash flows for the year then
ended. These combined financial statements are the responsibility of the
Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these
financial statements based on our audit.
     We conducted our audit in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the combined financial statements are free of
material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence
supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit
also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates
made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement
presentation. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our
opinion.
     In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly,
in all material respects, the combined financial position of Lake Norman Dodge,
Inc. and Affiliated Companies as of December 31, 1996, and the combined results
of their operations and their combined cash flows for the year then ended in
conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.
DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
Charlotte, North Carolina
August 7, 1997
(September 29, 1997 as to Note 1)
                                      F-38
 
<PAGE>
                LAKE NORMAN DODGE, INC. AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                            COMBINED BALANCE SHEETS
                      December 31, 1996 and June 30, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                   December
                                                                                                      31,         June 30,
                                                                                                     1996           1997
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                                               <C>            <C>
                                                                                                                 (Unaudited)
ASSETS (Note 4)
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and cash equivalents....................................................................   $ 3,491,358    $ 3,466,789
  Receivables..................................................................................     1,998,315      2,535,247
  Inventories (Note 2).........................................................................    23,603,843     22,778,488
  Prepaid expenses.............................................................................            --        243,870
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
     Total current assets......................................................................    29,093,516     29,024,394
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, NET (Note 3)...........................................................       485,880        566,875
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
OTHER ASSETS (NOTE 6):
  Due from employees...........................................................................       281,497        302,628
  Due from related partnership.................................................................       159,554        159,554
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
     Total other assets........................................................................       441,051        462,182
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
TOTAL ASSETS...................................................................................   $30,020,447    $30,053,451
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
  Notes payable-floor plan (Note 2)............................................................   $25,957,314    $25,865,010
  Trade accounts payable.......................................................................     1,364,121      1,351,664
  Note payable to bank (Note 4)................................................................        68,168         27,644
  Other accrued liabilities....................................................................       765,620        472,485
  Current maturities of long-term debt.........................................................       142,857         71,429
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
     Total current liabilities.................................................................    28,298,080     27,788,232
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
LONG-TERM DEBT (Note 4)........................................................................       785,715        785,714
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
COMMITMENTS (Note 5)
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
  Common stock of combined companies...........................................................        75,000         75,000
  Paid-in capital..............................................................................       600,009        600,009
  Retained earnings............................................................................       261,643        804,496
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
     Total stockholders' equity................................................................       936,652      1,479,505
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY.....................................................   $30,020,447    $30,053,451
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                  See notes to combined financial statements.
                                      F-39
 
<PAGE>
                LAKE NORMAN DODGE, INC. AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                         COMBINED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
    Year ended December 31, 1996 and six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                   Year Ended     Six months ended June 30,
                                                                                  December 31,    --------------------------
                                                                                      1996           1996           1997
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                               <C>             <C>            <C>
                                                                                                         (Unaudited)
REVENUES:
  Vehicle sales................................................................   $124,538,878    $55,071,168    $69,798,274
  Finance and insurance........................................................      3,617,296      1,773,355      1,949,987
  Parts and service............................................................      9,543,187      4,371,529      5,321,329
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
     Total revenues............................................................    137,699,361     61,216,052     77,069,590
COST OF SALES..................................................................    121,806,212     53,845,015     68,272,355
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
GROSS PROFIT...................................................................     15,893,149      7,371,037      8,797,235
SELLING, GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSES...................................     14,215,002      6,736,729      6,937,071
DEPRECIATION AND AMORTIZATION..................................................         88,987         37,414         46,900
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
OPERATING INCOME...............................................................      1,589,160        596,894      1,813,264
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
OTHER INCOME AND EXPENSE:
  Interest expense, floor plan.................................................      1,552,250        588,951      1,185,518
  Interest expense, other......................................................         49,540          2,880         67,647
  Other income.................................................................        257,747        113,277        176,322
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
     Total other expense.......................................................      1,344,043        478,554      1,076,843
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
NET INCOME.....................................................................   $    245,117    $   118,340    $   736,421
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
PRO FORMA INCOME TAX PROVISION
  (Note 1).....................................................................   $     97,213    $    46,934    $   292,138
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
PRO FORMA NET INCOME
  (Note 1).....................................................................   $    147,904    $    71,406    $   444,283
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                  See notes to combined financial statements.
                                      F-40
 
<PAGE>
                LAKE NORMAN DODGE, INC. AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                  COMBINED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
        Year ended December 31, 1996 and six months ended June 30, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                     Common Stock                                    Total
                                                                 --------------------    Paid-in     Retained    Stockholders'
                                                                  Shares      Amount     Capital     Earnings        Equity
                                                                 ---------    -------    --------    --------    --------------
<S>                                                              <C>          <C>        <C>         <C>         <C>
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1995..................................          75    $75,000    $475,009    $728,963      $1,278,972
  Capital contribution........................................          --         --     125,000          --         125,000
  Net income..................................................          --         --          --     245,117         245,117
  Distributions to owners.....................................          --         --          --    (712,437)       (712,437)
                                                                 ---------    -------    --------    --------    --------------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1996..................................          75     75,000     600,009     261,643         936,652
  Net income (unaudited)......................................          --         --          --     736,421         736,421
  Distributions to owners (unaudited).........................          --         --          --    (193,568)       (193,568)
                                                                 ---------    -------    --------    --------    --------------
BALANCE AT JUNE 30, 1997 (unaudited)..........................          75    $75,000    $600,009    $804,496      $1,479,505
                                                                 ---------    -------    --------    --------    --------------
                                                                 ---------    -------    --------    --------    --------------
</TABLE>
 
                  See notes to combined financial statements.
                                      F-41
 
<PAGE>
                LAKE NORMAN DODGE, INC. AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                       COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
  Year ended December 31, 1996 and the six months ended June 30, 1996 and 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                    Six months ended June 30,
                                                                                  Year ended        --------------------------
                                                                              December 31, 1996        1996           1997
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                           <C>                   <C>            <C>
                                                                                                           (Unaudited)
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income...............................................................      $    245,117       $   118,340    $   736,421
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in)
     operating activities:
     Bad debts and repossessions...........................................            44,523                --          9,910
     Depreciation and amortization expense.................................            88,987            37,414         46,900
     Increase in LIFO reserve..............................................           169,316           177,898        324,486
     Changes in assets and liabilities that relate to operations:
       Increase in receivable..............................................          (533,128)         (417,366)      (546,842)
       Increase (decrease) in inventories..................................       (10,887,995)        1,039,475        500,867
       Increase (decrease) in prepaid expenses.............................            15,895          (271,689)      (243,870)
       (Increase) decrease in accounts payable.............................           109,802          (240,517)       (12,456)
       (Increase) decrease in notes payable floor plan.....................        13,226,616           547,291        (92,304)
       (Increase) decrease in other accrued liabilities....................           488,012         1,281,747       (293,135)
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
          Total adjustments................................................         2,722,028         2,154,253       (306,444)
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
          Net cash provided by operating activities........................         2,967,145         2,272,593        429,977
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchases of property and equipment......................................          (282,711)         (141,084)      (127,895)
  Advances to employees -- net.............................................           (86,179)          (87,558)       (21,131)
  Advances to related partnership -- net...................................          (159,553)               --             --
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
          Net cash used in investing activities............................          (528,443)         (228,642)      (149,026)
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Proceeds from bank note..................................................           100,000           100,000             --
  Payments on bank note....................................................           (69,331)          (30,214)       (40,524)
  Proceeds from long-term debt.............................................         1,000,000         1,000,000             --
  Payments on long-term debt...............................................           (71,429)               --        (71,428)
  Capital contribution.....................................................           125,000                --             --
  Distributions to owners..................................................          (712,437)         (540,205)      (193,568)
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
          Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities..............           371,803           529,581       (305,520)
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH............................................         2,810,505         2,573,532        (24,569)
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF PERIOD.............................           680,853           680,853      3,491,358
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF PERIOD...................................      $  3,491,358       $ 3,254,385    $ 3,466,789
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION:
  Cash paid during the period for interest.................................      $  1,601,790       $   591,831    $ 1,253,165
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
                                                                              ------------------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                  See notes to combined financial statements.
                                      F-42
 
<PAGE>
                LAKE NORMAN DODGE, INC. AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
                     NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
1. DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
     Organization and Business -- Lake Norman Dodge, Inc. and Affiliated
Companies' (the "Company") operates two automobile dealerships in the Charlotte,
North Carolina area. The Company sells new and used cars and light trucks, sells
replacement parts, provides vehicle maintenance, warranty, paint and repair
services and arranges related financing and insurance.
     The combined financial statements include the accounts of Lake Norman
Dodge, Inc. ("LND") and its subsidiary, Lake Norman
Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, LLC ("LNCPJE") and certain proprietorships of Phil
Gandy and Quinton Gandy. LND is 100% owned by Phil Gandy and Quinton Gandy. All
significant intercompany balances and planned transactions have been eliminated
in combination.
     The combined financial statements have been prepared in connection with a
planned acquisition of the net assets of these entities by Sonic Automotive,
Inc. ("Sonic"). In May 1997, the Company signed a definitive purchase agreement
whereby its outstanding capital stock would be acquired by Sonic for
$18,200,000. This acquisition was consummated on September 29, 1997, and is
being done in contemplation of an anticipated public offering of common stock by
Sonic in 1997.
     The accompanying combined financial statements reflect the financial
position, results of operations, and cash flows of each of the above listed
entities. The combination of these entities has been accounted for at historical
cost in a manner similar to a pooling-of-interest because the entities are under
common management and control. All material intercompany transactions have been
eliminated.
     LNCPJE was organized on March 18, 1996, as a North Carolina limited
liability company and commenced operations on July 1, 1996. The certain
proprietorships of Phil Gandy and Quinton Gandy include commissions earned
related to sales of extended warranty contracts through LND and LNCPJE, which
were paid directly to Phil Gandy and Quinton Gandy at the option of LND and
LNCPJE. Earned commissions relating to the sales of these contracts reflect a
recurring transaction relating to the dealerships and therefore these
proprietorships have been included in the accompanying combined financial
statements.
     Revenue Recognition -- The Company records revenue when vehicles are
delivered to customers, and when vehicle service work is performed. Finance and
insurance commission revenue is recognized principally at the time the contract
is placed with the financial institutions.
     Dealer Agreements -- The Company purchases substantially all of its new
vehicles from manufacturers at the prevailing prices charged by the manufacturer
to its franchised dealers. The Company's sales could be unfavorably impacted by
the manufacturers' unwillingness or inability to supply the dealership with an
adequate supply of new car inventory.
     Each dealership operates under a dealer agreement with the manufacturer
which generally restricts the location, management and ownership of the
respective dealership. The ability of the Company to acquire additional
franchises from a particular manufacturer may be limited due to certain
restrictions imposed by manufacturers. Additionally, the Company's ability to
enter into significant acquisitions may be restricted and the acquisition of the
Company's stock by third parties may be limited by the terms of the franchise
agreement.
     Cash and Cash Equivalents -- The Company considers contracts in transit and
all highly liquid debt instruments with an initial maturity of three months or
less to be cash equivalents. Contracts in transit represent cash in transit to
the Company from finance companies related to vehicle purchases, and was
$2,110,467 at December 31, 1996.
     Inventories -- Inventories of new vehicles, including demonstrators, are
valued at the lower of last-in, first-out ("LIFO") cost or market. Inventories
of used vehicles are stated at the lower of first-in, first-out ("FIFO") cost or
market, and parts and accessories are stated at the lower of specific cost or
market.
     Property and Equipment -- Property and equipment are stated at cost.
Depreciation is computed over the estimated useful lives of the assets using
primarily accelerated methods. The range of estimated useful lives is as
follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 Useful lives
                                                                                 ------------
<S>                                                                              <C>
Parts and service equipment...................................................       5 years
Office equipment and fixtures.................................................     5-7 years
Company vehicles..............................................................       5 years
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-43
 
<PAGE>
                LAKE NORMAN DODGE, INC. AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
1. DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING
POLICIES -- Continued
Leasehold improvements are amortized over the lesser of the terms of their
respective leases or the estimated useful lives of the related assets.
     Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred.
Significant betterments are capitalized.
     Income Taxes -- LND has elected to be treated as an S Corporation for
federal and state income tax purposes, and LNCPJE is a limited liability company
(LLC). As such the stockholders and members, respectively, include their pro
rata share of the Company's taxable income for the year in their individual
income tax returns. The proprietorship income of Phil and Quinton Gandy combined
herein is also included in their personal income tax returns. Accordingly, no
provision for federal or state income taxes has been included in the
accompanying combined statement of income.
     The pro forma provision for income taxes and the pro forma net income for
the year ended December 31, 1996 and for the six months ended June 30, 1996 and
1997 reflect amounts that would have been recorded had the Company's income been
taxed for federal and state purposes as if it was a C Corporation.
     Concentrations of Credit Risk -- Financial instruments which potentially
subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk consist principally of cash
deposits. At times, amounts invested with financial institutions may exceed FDIC
insurance limits.
     Concentrations of credit risk with respect to receivables are limited
primarily to automobile manufacturers and financial institutions. Credit risk
arising from trade receivables from commercial customers is reduced by the large
number of customers comprising the trade receivables balances. Trade receivables
are concentrated in the Charlotte, North Carolina metropolitan area.
     Use of Estimates -- The preparation of financial statements in conformity
with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make
estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of
the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses
during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
     Advertising Costs -- The Company expenses all costs of advertising when
incurred. Advertising costs of $1,828,534 are included in operating expenses for
1996.
     Interim Financial Information -- The accompanying unaudited financial
information for the six months ended June 30, 1997 has been prepared on
substantially the same basis as the audited financial statements, and include
all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for
a fair presentation of the financial information set forth therein. The results
for interim periods are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected
for the entire fiscal year.
     The combined statement of income for the year ended December 31, 1996
includes expenses approximating $1,200,000 for discretionary bonuses to
stockholders determined at year end. Of this amount approximately $565,000 was
incurred through June 30, 1996. Given the planned acquisition by Sonic, it is
uncertain if a similar discretionary bonus will be awarded in 1997. As such, no
bonus has been accrued through June 30, 1997.
2. INVENTORIES AND RELATED NOTES PAYABLE -- FLOORPLAN
     Inventories consist of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                  December 31,     June 30,
                                                                                                      1996           1997
                                                                                                  ------------    -----------
<S>                                                                                               <C>             <C>
                                                                                                                  (Unaudited)
New vehicles...................................................................................   $ 16,617,268    $18,626,219
Used vehicles..................................................................................      6,437,598      3,720,437
Parts and accessories..........................................................................        548,977        431,832
                                                                                                  ------------    -----------
Total..........................................................................................   $ 23,603,843    $22,778,488
                                                                                                  ------------    -----------
                                                                                                  ------------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
     Had the Company used the FIFO method of valuing new vehicle inventory,
inventories would have been $1,564,142 higher and net income would have been
$414,432 as of and for the year ended December 31, 1996. The inventory balance
is generally reduced by the manufacturer's purchase discounts and such reduction
is not reflected in the related floor plan
                                      F-44
 
<PAGE>
                LAKE NORMAN DODGE, INC. AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
2. INVENTORIES AND RELATED NOTES PAYABLE -- FLOORPLAN -- Continued
liability. These manufacturer purchase discounts are standard in the industry,
typically occur on all new vehicle purchases, and are not used to offset the
related floor plan liability. These discounts are aggregated and generally paid
by the manufacturer on a quarterly basis. The related floor plan liability
becomes due as vehicles are sold.
     All new and certain used vehicles are pledged to collateralize floor plan
notes payable to financial institutions in the amount of $25,957,314 at December
31, 1996. The floor plan notes bear interest, payable monthly on the outstanding
balance, at the prime rate plus 0.5% (8.75% at December 31, 1996). Total floor
plan interest expense amounted to $1,552,250 in 1996. The notes payable are due
when the related vehicle is sold. As such, these floor plan notes payable are
shown as a current liability in the accompanying balance sheet.
3. PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT
     Property and equipment is comprised of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            December 31,     June 30,
                                                                                1996           1997
                                                                            ------------    ----------
<S>                                                                         <C>             <C>
                                                                                            (Unaudited)
Service equipment........................................................    $  309,944     $  373,652
Parts and accessory equipment............................................        35,480         38,876
Vehicles.................................................................        11,809         53,898
Furniture and fixtures...................................................       212,155        278,479
Leasehold improvements...................................................       460,097        497,345
                                                                            ------------    ----------
                                                                              1,029,485      1,242,250
Less accumulated depreciation............................................      (543,605)      (675,375)
                                                                            ------------    ----------
Property and equipment, net..............................................    $  485,880     $  566,875
                                                                            ------------    ----------
                                                                            ------------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
4. NOTE PAYABLE TO BANK AND LONG-TERM DEBT
     The note payable with a balance of $68,168 at December 31, 1996 is due in
monthly installments of $7,172, including interest at 8.25%, through October,
1997. The note is collateralized by modular buildings used in Company
operations.
     In July, 1996, the Company borrowed $1,000,000 from Chrysler Financial
Corporation. Payments of $11,905 plus interest at prime plus .5% (8.75% at
December 31, 1996) are due monthly, through July, 2003. The loan is
collateralized by a security interest in all assets of LNCPJE. Principal is due
as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                              <C>
Year ending December 31:
1997..........................................................................   $142,857
1998..........................................................................    142,857
1999..........................................................................    142,857
2000..........................................................................    142,857
2001..........................................................................    142,857
2002..........................................................................    142,857
Thereafter....................................................................     71,430
                                                                                 --------
                                                                                  928,572
Less current maturities.......................................................    142,857
                                                                                 --------
Long-term debt................................................................   $785,715
                                                                                 --------
                                                                                 --------
</TABLE>
 
5. OPERATING LEASES
     The Company leases its operating facilities from its shareholders under
three separate leases expiring March, 2000 and June, 2001. Monthly payments
under these leases at December 31, 1996, total $83,000. One of these leases has
an option for renewal for two additional five year terms. The Company pays all
operating costs such as utilities, repairs, maintenance and
                                      F-45
 
<PAGE>
                LAKE NORMAN DODGE, INC. AND AFFILIATED COMPANIES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
5. OPERATING LEASES -- Continued
insurance relating to these facilities. Total payments made to related parties
under these leases in 1996 were $786,000 exclusive of operating costs.
     At December 31, 1996 future minimum rental payments under these operating
leases are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Year
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                                            <C>
1997........................................................................   $  996,000
1998........................................................................      996,000
1999........................................................................      996,000
2000........................................................................      564,000
2001........................................................................      210,000
                                                                               ----------
       Total................................................................   $3,762,000
                                                                               ----------
                                                                               ----------
</TABLE>
 
     The Company leases automobiles through Chrysler Finance under twenty-four
and thirty-six month agreements expiring at various dates. The Company pays
monthly rental of varying amounts. In addition, the Company pays all operating
costs, including insurance, repairs, and maintenance. Payments under automobile
leases were $170,800 in 1996.
     At December 31, 1996, minimum future lease payments under these leases are
as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                              <C>
1997..........................................................................   $216,000
1998..........................................................................     81,000
                                                                                 --------
       Total..................................................................   $297,000
                                                                                 --------
                                                                                 --------
</TABLE>
 
6. RELATED PARTIES
     Due from Related Parties -- Due from employees includes $219,878 due from
shareholders. These amounts bear interest at the prevailing U. S. Treasury rates
for short-term debt, are noncollateralized and have no specific repayment terms.
     Amounts due from related partnership are noninterest bearing,
noncollateralized and have no specific repayment terms.
7. EMPLOYEE SAVINGS PLAN
     The Company operates a savings plan under Section 401(k) of the Internal
Revenue Code. This plan allows employees to defer a portion of their income on a
pre-tax basis through plan contributions. The Company makes matching
contributions up to 2% of employee salary. Company contributions to the plan in
1996 totaled $56,800. The Company also paid plan expenses of $1,312.
                                      F-46
 
<PAGE>
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
TO THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND STOCKHOLDERS OF
KEN MARKS FORD, INC.
Clearwater, Florida
  We have audited the accompanying balance sheet of Ken Marks Ford, Inc. (the
"Company") as of April 30, 1997, and the related statements of income,
stockholders' equity, and cash flows for the year then ended. These financial
statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on
our audit.
  We conducted our audit in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
  In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in
all material respects, the financial position of Ken Marks Ford, Inc. as of
April 30, 1997, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the
year then ended in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.
DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
Charlotte, North Carolina
August 26, 1997 (October 15, 1997 as to Note 1)
                                      F-47
 
<PAGE>
                              KEN MARKS FORD, INC.
                                 BALANCE SHEETS
                        April 30, 1997 and July 31, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                   April 30,      July 31,
                                                                                                     1997           1997
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                                               <C>            <C>
                                                                                                                 (Unaudited)
ASSETS (Note 4)
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and cash equivalents....................................................................   $ 2,504,102    $ 2,937,429
  Receivables..................................................................................     2,374,483      1,558,416
  Inventories (Note 2).........................................................................    11,216,499     11,809,574
  Prepaid expenses and other current assets....................................................       529,633        265,122
  Deferred income taxes (Note 5)...............................................................        91,742         91,742
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
     TOTAL CURRENT ASSETS......................................................................    16,716,459     16,662,283
PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT (Note 3)................................................................       470,738        530,257
OTHER ASSETS...................................................................................        14,000         14,000
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
TOTAL ASSETS...................................................................................   $17,201,197    $17,206,540
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
  Notes payable -- floor plan (Note 2).........................................................   $12,557,574    $12,720,185
  Trade accounts payable.......................................................................       678,252        691,537
  Accrued payroll and bonuses..................................................................       836,425        718,767
  Other accrued liabilities (Note 7)...........................................................       777,388        541,500
  Allowance for insurance, service contract and finance income chargebacks.....................       224,544        224,544
  Income tax payable (Note 5)..................................................................        15,161              0
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
     TOTAL CURRENT LIABILITIES.................................................................    15,089,344     14,896,533
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
DEFERRED INCOME TAXES (Note 5).................................................................        17,705         17,705
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Notes 6 and 7)
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
  Common stock, $1.00 par value, 500 shares authorized and issued..............................           500            500
  Paid-in capital..............................................................................       423,800        423,800
  Retained earnings............................................................................     1,669,848      1,868,002
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
     Total stockholders' equity................................................................     2,094,148      2,292,302
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY.....................................................   $17,201,197    $17,206,540
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
                                                                                                  -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                       See notes to financial statements.
                                      F-48
 
<PAGE>
                              KEN MARKS FORD, INC.
                              STATEMENTS OF INCOME
    Year ended April 30, 1997 and three months ended July 31, 1996 and 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                   Three months ended July
                                                                                   Year Ended                31,
                                                                                   April 30,      --------------------------
                                                                                      1997           1996           1997
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                               <C>             <C>            <C>
                                                                                                         (Unaudited)
REVENUES:
  Vehicle sales................................................................   $130,045,246    $33,823,641    $33,167,639
  Parts, service and collision repairs.........................................     13,116,124      3,660,782      2,930,561
  Finance and insurance........................................................      2,188,071        596,854        529,109
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
     Total revenues............................................................    145,349,441     38,081,277     36,627,309
COST OF SALES..................................................................    126,870,910     33,111,680     32,195,397
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
GROSS PROFIT...................................................................     18,478,531      4,969,597      4,431,912
SELLING, GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSES (Note 7)..........................     15,743,940      4,034,940      3,644,179
DEPRECIATION AND AMORTIZATION..................................................        100,771         20,846         20,302
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
OPERATING INCOME...............................................................      2,633,820        913,811        767,431
OTHER INCOME AND EXPENSE:
  Interest expense, floor plan (Note 2)........................................      2,008,468        480,132        485,358
  Other income.................................................................        140,916         16,189         40,654
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
     Total other income and expense............................................      1,867,552        463,943        444,704
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
INCOME BEFORE INCOME TAXES.....................................................        766,268        449,868        322,727
PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES (Note 5)............................................        295,988        173,649        124,573
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
NET INCOME.....................................................................   $    470,280    $   276,219    $   198,154
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
                                                                                  ------------    -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
                       See notes to financial statements.
                                      F-49
 
<PAGE>
                              KEN MARKS FORD, INC.
                       STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
         Year ended April 30, 1997 and three months ended July 31, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                     Total
                                                                             Common    Paid-in      Retained     Stockholders'
                                                                             Stock     Capital      Earnings        Equity
                                                                             ------    --------    ----------    -------------
<S>                                                                          <C>       <C>         <C>           <C>
BALANCE
  APRIL 30, 1996..........................................................    $ 500    $423,800    $1,219,568     $  1,643,868
  Dividends...............................................................       --          --       (20,000)         (20,000)
  Net income..............................................................       --          --       470,280          470,280
                                                                             ------    --------    ----------    -------------
BALANCE
  APRIL 30, 1997..........................................................    $ 500    $423,800    $1,669,848     $  2,094,148
  Net income (unaudited)..................................................       --          --       198,154          198,154
                                                                             ------    --------    ----------    -------------
BALANCE
  JULY 31, 1997 (unaudited)...............................................    $ 500    $423,800    $1,868,002     $  2,292,302
                                                                             ------    --------    ----------    -------------
                                                                             ------    --------    ----------    -------------
</TABLE>
 
                       See notes to financial statements.
                                      F-50
 
<PAGE>
                              KEN MARKS FORD, INC.
                            STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                Year ended April 30, 1997 and three months ended
                             July 31, 1996 and 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                     Three months ended July 31,
                                                                                     Year ended      ---------------------------
                                                                                   April 30, 1997               1996
                                                                                   --------------    ---------------------------
<S>                                                                                <C>               <C>
                                                                                                             (Unaudited)
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income....................................................................    $    470,280             $   276,219
                                                                                   --------------          -------------
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating
     activities:
     Depreciation and amortization..............................................         100,771                  20,846
     Deferred income taxes......................................................          13,763                   6,600
     Loss on disposal of property and equipment.................................          45,192                      --
     Change in operating assets and liabilities:
       (Increase) decrease in accounts receivable...............................      (1,033,143)                323,213
       (Increase) decrease in inventories.......................................       5,197,288               1,129,058
       (Increase) decrease in prepaid expenses..................................         429,467                (595,810)
       Decrease in due from related parties.....................................         134,141                      --
       Increase (decrease) in notes payable, floor plan.........................      (3,401,971)               (663,355)
       Increase in trade accounts payable.......................................         322,319                 219,902
       Decrease in accrued payroll and bonuses..................................        (284,875)               (400,442)
       Increase (decrease) in accrued expenses and other payables...............        (848,544)                484,719
       Decrease in allowance for insurance, service contract and finance income
          chargebacks...........................................................         (85,107)                     --
       Increase (decrease) in income tax payable................................         (39,839)                112,049
                                                                                   --------------          -------------
          Total adjustments.....................................................         549,462                 636,780
                                                                                   --------------          -------------
     Net cash provided by operating activities..................................       1,019,742                 912,999
                                                                                   --------------          -------------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchases of property and equipment...........................................        (183,674)                 (5,060)
                                                                                   --------------          -------------
     Net cash used in investing activities......................................        (183,674)                 (5,060)
                                                                                   --------------          -------------
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Dividends paid to stockholders................................................         (20,000)                     --
                                                                                   --------------          -------------
     Net cash used in financing activities......................................         (20,000)                     --
                                                                                   --------------          -------------
NET INCREASE IN CASH............................................................         816,068                 907,939
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF YEAR....................................       1,688,034               1,688,034
                                                                                   --------------          -------------
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF YEAR..........................................    $  2,504,102             $ 2,595,973
                                                                                   --------------          -------------
                                                                                   --------------          -------------
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION:
  Cash paid during the year for:
     Interest...................................................................    $  2,008,468             $   480,132
     Income taxes...............................................................    $    322,064             $    55,000
<CAPTION>
 
                                                                                             1997
 
                                                                                  ---------------------------
 
<S>                                                                                <C>
 
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income....................................................................          $   198,154
 
                                                                                        -------------
 
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating
     activities:
     Depreciation and amortization..............................................               20,302
 
     Deferred income taxes......................................................                   --
 
     Loss on disposal of property and equipment.................................                   --
 
     Change in operating assets and liabilities:
       (Increase) decrease in accounts receivable...............................              816,067
 
       (Increase) decrease in inventories.......................................             (593,075)
 
       (Increase) decrease in prepaid expenses..................................              264,511
 
       Decrease in due from related parties.....................................                   --
 
       Increase (decrease) in notes payable, floor plan.........................              162,611
 
       Increase in trade accounts payable.......................................               13,285
 
       Decrease in accrued payroll and bonuses..................................             (117,658)
 
       Increase (decrease) in accrued expenses and other payables...............             (235,888)
 
       Decrease in allowance for insurance, service contract and finance income
          chargebacks...........................................................                   --
 
       Increase (decrease) in income tax payable................................              (15,161)
 
                                                                                        -------------
 
          Total adjustments.....................................................              314,994
 
                                                                                        -------------
 
     Net cash provided by operating activities..................................              513,148
 
                                                                                        -------------
 
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchases of property and equipment...........................................              (79,821)
 
                                                                                        -------------
 
     Net cash used in investing activities......................................              (79,821)
 
                                                                                        -------------
 
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Dividends paid to stockholders................................................                   --
 
                                                                                        -------------
 
     Net cash used in financing activities......................................                   --
 
                                                                                        -------------
 
NET INCREASE IN CASH............................................................              433,327
 
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF YEAR....................................            2,504,102
 
                                                                                        -------------
 
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF YEAR..........................................          $ 2,937,429
 
                                                                                        -------------
 
                                                                                        -------------
 
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION:
  Cash paid during the year for:
     Interest...................................................................          $   485,358
 
     Income taxes...............................................................          $   144,000
 
</TABLE>
 
                       See notes to financial statements.
                                      F-51
 
<PAGE>
                              KEN MARKS FORD, INC.
                         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
1. DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
     Organization and Business -- Ken Marks Ford, Inc. (the "Company") operates
an automobile dealership in the Tampa-Clearwater areas in Florida. The Company
sells new and used cars, sells replacement parts, provides vehicle maintenance,
warranty, paint and repair services and arranges related financing and
insurance.
     In July 1997, the Company signed a definitive purchase agreement whereby
its outstanding capital stock would be acquired by Sonic Automotive, Inc.
("Sonic") for $25,482,500. This acquisition was consummated on October 15, 1997,
and is being done in contemplation of an anticipated public offering of common
stock by Sonic Automotive, Inc. in 1997.
     Revenue Recognition -- The Company records revenue when vehicles are
delivered to customers, and when vehicle service work is performed. Finance and
insurance commission revenue is recognized principally at the time the contract
is placed with the financial institution.
     Dealer Agreements -- The Company purchases substantially all of its new
vehicles from manufacturers at the prevailing prices charged by the manufacturer
to its franchised dealers. The Company's sales could be unfavorably impacted by
the manufacturer's unwillingness or inability to supply the dealership with an
adequate supply of new car inventory. Each dealership operates under a dealer
agreement with the manufacturer. These agreements generally restrict the
location, management and ownership of the respective dealership.
     Cash and Cash Equivalents -- The Company considers contracts in transit and
all highly liquid debt instruments with an initial maturity of three months or
less to be cash equivalents. Contracts in transit represent cash in transit to
the Company from finance companies related to vehicle purchases, and was
approximately $628,000 at April 30, 1997.
     Inventories -- Inventories of new vehicles, including demonstrators, are
valued at the lower of last-in, first-out ("LIFO") cost or market. Inventories
of parts and accessories are valued on a LIFO basis using the Current Year Parts
Price Index. Inventories of used vehicles are valued on a specific
identification basis.
     Property and Equipment -- Property and equipment are stated at cost.
     Depreciation is computed using straight-line and accelerated methods over
the estimated useful lives of the assets. The range of estimated useful lives is
as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                           Useful Lives
                                                                                           ------------
<S>                                                                                        <C>
Leasehold improvements..................................................................    18-31 years
Machinery and equipment.................................................................      5-7 years
Furniture and fixtures..................................................................      5-7 years
</TABLE>
 
     Income Taxes -- Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are determined
based on the difference between financial reporting and tax basis of assets and
liabilities, and are measured using the enacted tax rates and laws that will be
in effect when the differences are expected to reverse.
     Concentrations of Credit Risk -- Financial instruments which potentially
subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk consist principally of cash
deposits. At times, amounts invested with financial institutions may exceed FDIC
insurance limits.
     Concentrations of credit risk with respect to receivables are limited
primarily to automobile manufacturers and financial institutions. Credit risk
arising from trade receivables from commercial customers is reduced by the large
number of customers comprising the trade receivables balance. Trade receivables
are concentrated in the Tampa-Clearwater metropolitan area.
     Use of Estimates -- The preparation of financial statements in conformity
with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make
estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of
the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses
during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from these estimates.
                                      F-52
 
<PAGE>
                              KEN MARKS FORD, INC.
                   NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
1. DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING
POLICIES -- Continued
     Advertising -- The Company expenses advertising costs in the period
incurred. Advertising expenses approximated $991,000 for the year ended April
30, 1997.
2. INVENTORIES AND RELATED NOTES PAYABLE -- FLOOR PLAN
     Inventories consist of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           April 30,      July 31,
                                                                             1997           1997
                                                                          -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                       <C>            <C>
                                                                                         (Unaudited)
New vehicles...........................................................   $ 8,477,840    $ 9,270,932
Used vehicles..........................................................     2,341,929      2,193,166
Parts and accessories..................................................       396,730        345,476
                                                                          -----------    -----------
Total..................................................................   $11,216,499    $11,809,574
                                                                          -----------    -----------
                                                                          -----------    -----------
</TABLE>
 
     At April 30, 1997, the excess of current replacement cost over the stated
LIFO valuation of new vehicles, parts and accessories amounts to $2,749,237. The
inventory balance generally is reduced by the manufacturer's purchase discounts,
and such reduction is not reflected in the related floor plan liability. These
manufacturer purchase discounts are standard in the industry, typically occur on
all new vehicle purchases, and are not used to offset the related floor plan
liability. These discounts are aggregated and generally paid by the manufacturer
on a quarterly basis. The related floor plan liability becomes due as vehicles
are sold.
     Had the Company used the FIFO method of valuing new vehicle, parts and
accessories inventory, pretax earnings would have been $949,454 for the year
ended April 30, 1997.
     All new vehicles are pledged to collateralize floor plan notes payable to
financial institutions in the amount of $12,557,574 at April 30, 1997. The floor
plan notes bear interest, payable monthly on the outstanding balance, at the
prime rate plus 1% (9.5% at April 30, 1997). Total floor plan interest expense
amounted to $2,008,468 during the year ended April 30, 1997. The notes payable
become due when the related vehicle is sold. As such, these floor plan notes
payable are shown as a current liability in the accompanying balance sheet.
     Certain inventory items collateralize the revolving line of credit
described in Note 4. All new vehicles and demonstrators and substantially all
parts and accessories are purchased from Ford Motor Company.
3. PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT
     Property and equipment is comprised of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             April 30,      July 31,
                                                                                1997          1997
                                                                             ----------    ----------
<S>                                                                          <C>           <C>
                                                                                           (Unaudited)
Parts and service equipment...............................................   $  333,063    $  340,284
Furniture and fixtures....................................................      400,152       409,991
Leasehold improvements....................................................      481,815       544,576
                                                                             ----------    ----------
                                                                              1,215,030     1,294,851
Less accumulated depreciation.............................................     (744,292)     (764,594)
                                                                             ----------    ----------
Property and equipment, net...............................................   $  470,738    $  530,257
                                                                             ----------    ----------
                                                                             ----------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-53
 
<PAGE>
                              KEN MARKS FORD, INC.
                   NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- Continued
4. FINANCING ARRANGEMENT
     The Company has a revolving line of credit with Ford Motor Credit
Corporation in the amount of $2,500,000. At April 30, 1997, no amount was
outstanding relating to this line of credit, which is collateralized by personal
guarantees from the stockholders and the net assets of the Company.
5. INCOME TAXES
     The provision for income taxes consists of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                             April 30,
                                                                                               1997
                                                                                             ---------
<S>                                                                                          <C>
Current taxes.............................................................................   $ 282,225
Deferred taxes............................................................................      13,763
                                                                                             ---------
Provision for income taxes................................................................   $ 295,988
                                                                                             ---------
                                                                                             ---------
</TABLE>
 
     Deferred income tax assets and liabilities consist of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                              April 30,
                                                                                                1997
                                                                                              ---------
<S>                                                                                           <C>
Deferred tax asset -- current, primarily from differences relating to finance and insurance
  reserves and allowance for bad debts.....................................................    $ 91,742
Deferred tax liability -- long-term, primarily from differences relating to depreciation...     (17,705)
                                                                                              ---------
Net deferred tax asset.....................................................................    $ 74,037
                                                                                              ---------
                                                                                              ---------
</TABLE>
 
6. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
     Ford Motor Company (FMC) owns vehicles which are used as short-term rentals
for which the Company pays FMC monthly fees. A portion of the fees are applied
against the purchase price the Company must pay for the vehicles when they are
no longer used for rental. The contingent liability to FMC to purchase the
vehicles under this program was approximately $1,771,000 at April 30, 1997.
     The Company is a defendant in various legal proceedings incurred in the
normal course of business. Management believes that the outcome of such
proceedings will not have a materially adverse effect on the Company's financial
position or future operations and cashflows.
7. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
     The Company leases its operating facility from a corporation which is owned
by the Company's stockholders. The lease is currently on a month-to-month basis.
Rent charged to expense under this lease was $359,630 for the year ended April
30, 1997. In addition, management fees of $675,000 for the year ended April 30,
1997 were paid by the Company to the above corporation and are included in
selling, general and administrative expenses. In addition, related party
payables of $270,000 were included in other accrued liabilities at April 30,
1997.
                                      F-54
 
<PAGE>
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
     No dealer, salesperson, or any other individual has been authorized to give
any information or to make any representations not contained in this Prospectus
in connection with the offering covered by this Prospectus. If given or made,
such information or representations must not be relied upon as having been
authorized by the Company or the Underwriters. This Prospectus does not
constitute an offer to sell or a solicitation of an offer to buy the Class A
Common Stock in any jurisdiction where, or to any person to whom, it is unlawful
to make such offer or solicitation. Neither the delivery of this Prospectus nor
any sale made hereunder shall, under any circumstances, create an implication
that there has not been any change in the facts set forth in this Prospectus or
in the affairs of the Company since the date hereof.
                               -----------------
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        Page
                                                        ----
<S>                                                     <C>
Prospectus Summary...................................      3
Risk Factors.........................................      9
The Reorganization...................................     19
The Acquisitions.....................................     19
Use of Proceeds......................................     23
Dividend Policy......................................     23
Capitalization.......................................     24
Dilution.............................................     25
Selected Combined And Consolidated Financial Data....     26
Pro Forma Combined and Consolidated Financial Data...     28
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
  Condition and Results of Operations................     36
Business.............................................     43
Management...........................................     59
Certain Transactions.................................     66
Principal Stockholders...............................     70
Description of Capital Stock.........................     71
Shares Eligible for Future Sale......................     75
Certain United States Federal Tax Considerations for
  Non-United States Holders..........................     76
Underwriting.........................................     79
Legal Matters........................................     82
Experts..............................................     82
Additional Information...............................     82
Index to Financial Statements........................    F-1
</TABLE>
 
     Until     , 1997 (25 days after the date of this Prospectus), all dealers
effecting transactions in the Class A Common Stock, whether or not participating
in this distribution, may be required to deliver a Prospectus. This delivery
requirement is in addition to the obligation of dealers to deliver a Prospectus
when acting as Underwriters and with respect to their unsold allotments or
subscriptions.
                                5,000,000 Shares
 
                          (Sonic Automotive Inc. logo)

                              Class A Common Stock
                               -----------------
                                   PROSPECTUS
                               -----------------
                              Merrill Lynch & Co.
                    NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
                           Wheat First Butcher Singer
                                          , 1997
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
<PAGE>

               [ALTERNATE PAGE FOR INTERNATIONAL PROSPECTUS]

(A redherring appears on the left hand side of this page, rotated 90 degrees. 
Text follows.)

Information contained herein is subject to completion or amendment. A
registration statement relating to these securities has been filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission. These securities may not be sold nor may 
offers to buy be accepted prior to the time the registration statement becomes 
effective. This Prospectus shall not constitute an offer to sell or the 
solicitation of an offer to buy nor shall there be any sale of these 
securities in any State in which such offer, solicitation or sale would be 
unlawful prior to registration or qualification under the securities laws 
of any such State.


   
                             SUBJECT TO COMPLETION
                 PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUS DATED NOVEMBER 5, 1997
    
PROSPECTUS
                                5,000,000 Shares

                           (Sonic Automotive Inc. logo)
 
                              Class A Common Stock
                            ------------------------
     All of the 5,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock, par value $.01 per
share (the "Class A Common Stock"), offered hereby are being sold by Sonic
Automotive, Inc. ("Sonic" or the "Company"). Of the 5,000,000 shares of Class A
Common Stock offered hereby, 1,000,000 shares are being offered for sale
initially outside the United States and Canada by the International Managers (as
defined herein) and 4,000,000 shares are being offered for sale initially in a
concurrent offering in the United States and Canada by the U.S. Underwriters (as
defined herein). The initial public offering price and the aggregate
underwriting discount per share will be identical for both the International
Offering and the U.S. Offering. See "Underwriting."
     Each share of Class A Common Stock entitles its holder to one vote per
share. Each share of Class B Common Stock, par value $.01 per share (the "Class
B Common Stock," and together with the Class A Common Stock, the "Common
Stock"), entitles the holder to ten votes per share, except in certain limited
circumstances. All of the shares of Class B Common Stock are held by the members
of the Smith Group (as defined herein), who are all of the stockholders of the
Company prior to the consummation of the Offering. After consummation of the
Offering, the Smith Group will beneficially own shares representing
approximately 92.6% of the combined voting power of the Company's Common Stock
(approximately 91.6% if the Underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised in
full). See "Description of Capital Stock -- Common Stock."
     Prior to the Offerings, there has been no public market for the Class A
Common Stock. It is currently estimated that the initial public offering price
will be between $12.00 and $14.00 per share. For a discussion of factors to be
considered in determining the initial public offering price, see "Underwriting."
     The Class A Common Stock has been approved for listing on the New York
Stock Exchange, subject to official notice of issuance, under the symbol "SAH."
     See "Risk Factors" beginning on page 9 for a discussion of certain factors
that should be considered by prospective purchasers of the Class A Common Stock
offered hereby.
                            ------------------------
THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES
  AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS
    THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES
     COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS
        PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL
                                      OFFENSE.
[CAPTION]
<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>                       <C>                       <C>
                                                                Price to                Underwriting              Proceeds to
                                                                 Public                 Discount (1)              Company (2)
<S>                                                     <C>                       <C>                       <C>
Per Share...........................................               $                         $                         $
Total (3)...........................................               $                         $                         $
</TABLE>
(1) The Company has agreed to indemnify the several Underwriters against certain
    liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, as
    amended. See "Underwriting."
(2) Before deducting expenses payable by the Company estimated at $2,000,000.
(3) The Company has granted to the International Managers and the U.S.
    Underwriters options to purchase up to an additional 150,000 and 600,000
    shares of Class A Common Stock, respectively, in each case exercisable
    within 30 days of the date hereof and solely to cover over-allotments, if
    any. If such options are exercised in full, the total Price to Public,
    Underwriting Discount and Proceeds to Company will be $       , $       and
    $       , respectively. See "Underwriting."
                            ------------------------
     The shares of Class A Common Stock are being offered by the several
Underwriters, subject to prior sale, when, as and if issued to and accepted by
them, subject to approval of certain legal matters by counsel for the
Underwriters and certain other conditions. The Underwriters reserve the right to
withdraw, cancel or modify such offer and to reject orders in whole or in part.
It is expected that delivery of the shares of Class A Common Stock will be made
in New York, New York on or about        , 1997.
                            ------------------------
Merrill Lynch International
                      NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
                                                      Wheat First Butcher Singer
                            ------------------------
                 The date of this Prospectus is        , 1997.
 
<PAGE>

               [ALTERNATE PAGE FOR INTERNATIONAL PROSPECTUS]

                               PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
     The following summary is qualified in its entirety by, and should be read
in conjunction with, the more detailed information and financial statements
(including the notes thereto) appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus. References
in this Prospectus to "Sonic" or the "Company" (i) are to Sonic Automotive, Inc.
and, unless the context indicates otherwise, its consolidated subsidiaries and
their respective predecessors, (ii) give effect to a recently completed
Reorganization (as defined below) of the Company, and (iii) assume that the
Company has consummated the acquisition of the assets or all the capital stock
of six additional dealerships or dealership groups, as described herein, in
North Carolina, Tennessee, Florida, Georgia and South Carolina (the
"Acquisitions"). See "The Acquisitions." References to the "Offering" are to the
offering of 1,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock made hereby outside the
United States and Canada by the International Managers (the "International
Offering") and the concurrent offering of 4,000,000 shares of Class A Common
Stock in the United States and Canada by the U.S. Underwriters (the "U.S.
Offering"), collectively. References to the "Underwriters" are to the
International Managers and the U.S. Underwriters, collectively. Unless otherwise
indicated, all information in this Prospectus (a) gives retroactive effect to a
625-for-1 stock split (effected in the form of a stock dividend) of the
Company's Class B Common Stock to be consummated prior to the consummation of
the Offering (the "Stock Split") and (b) assumes that the Underwriters'
over-allotment option is not exercised. The Acquisitions will be consummated on
or before the closing of the Offering.
                                  The Company
     The Company is one of the leading automotive retailers in the United
States, operating 23 dealership franchises, four standalone used vehicle
facilities and seven collision repair centers in the southeastern and
southwestern United States. Sonic sells new and used cars and light trucks,
sells replacement parts, provides vehicle maintenance, warranty, paint and
repair services and arranges related financing and insurance ("F&I") for its
automotive customers. The Company's business is geographically diverse, with
dealership operations in the Charlotte, Chattanooga, Nashville,
Tampa-Clearwater, Houston and Atlanta markets, each of which the Company
believes is experiencing favorable demographic trends. Sonic sells 15 domestic
and foreign brands, which consist of BMW, Cadillac, Chrysler, Dodge, Ford,
Honda, Infiniti, Jaguar, Jeep, KIA, Oldsmobile, Plymouth, Toyota, Volkswagen and
Volvo. In several of its markets, the Company has a significant market share for
new cars and light trucks, including 13.7% in Charlotte and 9.1% in Chattanooga
in 1996. Pro forma for the Acquisitions, the Company had revenues of $899.6
million and retail unit sales of 24,206 new and 13,475 used vehicles in 1996.
The Company believes that in 1996, based on pro forma retail unit sales, it
would have been one of the ten largest dealer groups out of a total of more than
15,000 dealer groups in the United States.
     The Company's founder and Chief Executive Officer, O. Bruton Smith, has
over 30 years of automotive retailing experience. In addition, the Company's
other executive officers, regional vice presidents and executive managers have
on average 18 years of automotive retailing experience. The Company's
dealerships are among those dealerships that have won the highest attainable
awards from various manufacturers measuring quality and customer satisfaction.
These awards include the Five Star Award from Chrysler, the Chairman's Award
from Ford, the President's Award from BMW and the President's Circle Award from
Infiniti. In addition, the Company was named to Ford's Top 100 Club, which
consists of Ford's top 100 retailers based on retail volume and consumer
satisfaction.
     The Company intends to pursue an acquisition growth strategy led by a
management team that has experience in the consolidation of automotive retailing
as well as motorsports businesses. Bruton Smith, who is also the Chief Executive
Officer of Speedway Motorsports, Inc., the owner and operator of several
motorsports facilities, first entered the automotive retailing business in the
mid-1960's. Mr. Smith will devote approximately 50% of his business time to the
Company. Since 1990, Mr. Smith has successfully acquired three dealerships and
increased his dealerships' revenues from $199.4 million in 1992 to $376.6
million in 1996, without giving effect to the Acquisitions. In the Tennessee
market, Nelson E. Bowers, II, the Company's Executive Vice President, has
acquired or opened eight dealerships since 1992 and increased revenues
(primarily through acquisitions) of the dealership group to be acquired by the
Company from $13.2 million in 1992 to $101.5 million in 1996. No assurance can
be given that Messrs. Smith and Bowers will be successful in acquiring or
opening new dealerships for the Company or increasing the Company's revenues.
     The Company believes the competitive advantages which differentiate it from
its local competitors include the reputation of the Company's management in the
automotive retailing industry, regional and national economies of scale, brand
and geographic diversity, and the established customer base and local name
recognition of the Company's dealerships. The Company has developed and
implemented several growth strategies to capitalize on these competitive
advantages. One of these is to continue to expand its operations in the
Southeast and Southwest by acquiring additional dealerships both within its
current markets and in new markets. The Company also is seeking additional
growth from the increased sale of higher margin products and services such as
wholesale parts, after-market products, collision repair services and F&I.
     The Company believes that an opportunity exists for dealership groups with
significant equity capital and experience in identifying, acquiring and
professionally managing dealerships, to acquire additional dealerships and
capitalize on changes in
                                       3
 
<PAGE>

               [ALTERNATE PAGE FOR INTERNATIONAL PROSPECTUS]


                                  UNDERWRITING
     Merrill Lynch International, NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc. and
Wheat, First Securities, Inc. are acting as lead managers (the "Lead Managers")
for each of the International Managers named below (the "International
Managers"). Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in an international
purchase agreement (the "International Purchase Agreement") among the Company
and the International Managers and concurrently with the sale of 4,000,000
shares of Class A Common Stock to the U.S. Underwriters (as defined below), the
Company has agreed to sell to the International Managers, and each of the
International Managers severally and not jointly has agreed to purchase from the
Company, the number of shares of Class A Common Stock set forth opposite its
name below.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                    Number of
             International Manager                                                                                    Shares
                                                                                                                    ----------
<S>                                                                                                                 <C>
Merrill Lynch International......................................................................................
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc...........................................................................
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.....................................................................................
                                                                                                                    ----------
             Total...............................................................................................    1,000,000
                                                                                                                    ----------
                                                                                                                    ----------
</TABLE>
 
     The Company has also entered into a U.S. purchase agreement (the "U.S.
Purchase Agreement") with certain underwriters in the United States and Canada
(the "U.S. Underwriters" and, together with the International Managers, the
"Underwriters"), for whom Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated
("Merrill Lynch"), NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc. and Wheat, First
Securities, Inc. are acting as representatives (the "U.S. Representatives").
Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the U.S. Purchase Agreement,
and concurrently with the sale of 1,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock to
the International Managers pursuant to the International Purchase Agreement, the
Company has agreed to sell to the U.S. Underwriters, and the U.S. Underwriters
severally and not jointly have agreed to purchase from the Company, an aggregate
of 4,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock. The initial public offering price
per share of Class A Common Stock and the underwriting discount per share of
Class A Common Stock are identical under the International Purchase Agreement
and the U.S. Purchase Agreement.
     In the International Purchase Agreement and the U.S. Purchase Agreement,
the several International Managers and the several U.S. Underwriters,
respectively, have agreed, subject to the terms and conditions set forth
therein, to purchase all of the shares of Class A Common Stock being sold
pursuant to each such agreement if any of the shares of Class A Common Stock
being sold pursuant to such agreement are purchased. Under certain
circumstances, under the International Purchase Agreement and the U.S. Purchase
Agreement, the commitments of non-defaulting Underwriters may be increased. The
closings with respect to the sale of shares of Class A Common Stock to be
purchased by the International Managers and the U.S. Underwriters are
conditioned upon one another.
     The Lead Managers have advised the Company that the International Managers
propose initially to offer the shares of Class A Common Stock to the public at
the initial public offering price set forth on the cover page of this
Prospectus, and to certain dealers at such price less a concession not in excess
of $     per share of Class A Common Stock. The International Managers may
allow, and such dealers may reallow, a discount not in excess of $     per share
of Class A Common Stock on sales to certain other dealers. After the initial
public offering, the public offering price, concession and discount may be
changed.
     At the request of the Company, the Underwriters have reserved up to 5% of
the shares of Class A Common Stock for sale at the initial public offering
price, and otherwise on the same terms as sales pursuant to the Offering, to
directors, officers, employees, business associates and related persons of the
Company. The number of shares of Class A Common Stock available for sale to the
general public will be reduced to the extent such persons purchase such reserved
shares. Any
                                       78
 
<PAGE>

               [ALTERNATE PAGE FOR INTERNATIONAL PROSPECTUS]


reserved shares which are not so purchased will be offered by the Underwriters
to the general public on the same basis as the other shares offered hereby.
     The Company, all of the executive officers of the Company and all the
holders of Class B Common Stock have agreed, subject to certain exceptions, not
to, directly or indirectly, (i) offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any
option or contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant
any option to purchase, right or warrant to purchase or otherwise transfer or
dispose of any Class A Common Stock or securities convertible into or
exchangeable or exercisable for Class A Common Stock, including shares of Class
B Common Stock, or file a registration statement under the Securities Act with
respect to the foregoing or (ii) enter into any swap or other agreement or
transaction that transfers, in whole or part, directly or indirectly, the
economic consequence of ownership of the Class A Common Stock, whether any such
swap or transaction described above is to be settled by delivery of Class A
Common Stock or such other securities, in cash or otherwise without the prior
written consent of Merrill Lynch on behalf of the Underwriters, for a period of
180 days after the date of this Prospectus; provided that the Company may sell
shares of Class A Common Stock to a third party as consideration for the
Company's acquisition from such third party of an automobile dealership,
provided that such third party executes a lock-up agreement on substantially the
same terms described above for a period expiring 180 days after the date of this
Prospectus.
     The Company has granted an option to the International Managers,
exercisable within 30 days after the date of this Prospectus, to purchase up to
an aggregate of 150,000 additional shares of Class A Common Stock at the initial
public offering price set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus, less the
underwriting discount. The International Managers may exercise this option only
to cover over-allotments, if any, made on the sale of the Class A Common Stock
offered hereby. To the extent that the International Managers exercise this
option, each International Manager will be obligated, subject to certain
conditions, to purchase a number of additional shares of Class A Common Stock
proportionate to such International Manager's initial amount reflected in the
foregoing table. The Company also has granted options to the U.S. Underwriters,
exercisable within 30 days after the date of this Prospectus, to purchase up to
an aggregate of 600,000 additional shares of Class A Common Stock to cover
over-allotments, if any, on terms similar to those granted to the International
Managers.
     The International Managers and the U.S. Underwriters have entered into an
intersyndicate agreement (the "Intersyndicate Agreement") that provides for the
coordination of their activities. Pursuant to the Intersyndicate Agreement, the
International Managers and the U.S. Underwriters are permitted to sell shares of
Class A Common Stock to each other for purposes of resale at the initial public
offering price, less an amount not greater than the selling concession. Under
the terms of the Intersyndicate Agreement, the U.S. Underwriters and any dealer
to whom they sell shares of Class A Common Stock will not offer to sell or sell
shares of Class A Common Stock to persons who are non-U.S. or non-Canadian
persons or to persons they believe intend to resell to persons who are non-U.S.
or non-Canadian persons, and the International Managers and any dealer to whom
they sell shares of Class A Common Stock will not offer to sell or sell shares
of Class A Common Stock to U.S. persons or to Canadian persons or to persons
they believe intend to resell to U.S. persons or Canadian persons, except in the
case of transactions pursuant to the Intersyndicate Agreement.
     Prior to the Offering, there has been no public market for the Class A
Common Stock. The initial public offering price for the Class A Common Stock
will be determined by negotiation among the Company, the U.S. Representatives
and the Lead Managers. The factors considered in determining the initial public
offering price, in addition to prevailing market conditions, are price-earnings
ratios of publicly traded companies that the U.S. Representatives and the Lead
Managers believe to be comparable to the Company, certain financial information
of the Company, the history of, and the prospects for, the Company and the
industry in which it competes, an assessment of the Company's management, its
past and present operations, the prospects for and the timing of future revenues
of the Company, the present state of the Company's development, and the above
factors in relation to market values and various valuation measures of other
companies engaged in activities similar to the Company. There can be no
assurance that an active trading market will develop for the Class A Common
Stock or that the Class A Common Stock will trade in the public market
subsequent to the Offering made hereby at or above the initial public offering
price.
     The Company has agreed to indemnify the International Managers and the U.S.
Underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the
Securities Act, or to contribute to payments which the International Managers or
the U.S. Underwriters may be required to make in respect thereof.
     The Class A Common Stock has been approved for listing on the NYSE, subject
to official notice of issuance, under the symbol "SAH." In order to meet the
requirements for listing of the Class A Common Stock on that exchange, the U.S.
Underwriters and the International Managers have undertaken to sell lots of 100
or more shares to a minimum of 2,000 beneficial holders.
                                       79
 
<PAGE>

               [ALTERNATE PAGE FOR INTERNATIONAL PROSPECTUS]

     The International Managers and the U.S. Underwriters do not intend to
confirm sales of Class A Common Stock offered hereby to any accounts over which
they exercise discretionary authority.
     Until the distribution of the Class A Common Stock is completed, rules of
the Securities and Exchange Commission may limit the ability of the Underwriters
and certain selling group members to bid for and purchase the Class A Common
Stock. As an exception to these rules, the U.S. Representatives are permitted to
engage in certain transactions that stabilize the price of Class A Common Stock.
Such transactions consist of bids or purchases for the purpose of pegging,
fixing or maintaining the price of the Class A Common Stock.
     If the Underwriters create a short position in the Class A Common Stock in
connection with the Offering, i.e., if they sell more shares of Class A Common
Stock than are set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus, the U.S.
Representatives may reduce that short position by purchasing Class A Common
Stock in the open market. The U.S. Representatives may also elect to reduce any
short position by exercising all or part of the over-allotment option described
above.
     The U.S. Representatives may also impose a penalty bid on certain
Underwriters and selling group members. This means that if the U.S.
Representatives purchase shares of Class A Common Stock in the open market to
reduce the Underwriters' short position or to stabilize the price of the Class A
Common Stock, they may reclaim the amount of the selling concession from the
Underwriters and selling group members who sold those shares as part of the
Offering.
     In general, purchases of a security for the purpose of stabilization or to
reduce a short position could cause the price of the security to be higher than
it might be in the absence of such purchases. The imposition of a penalty bid
might also have an effect on the price of a security to the extent that it were
to discourage resales of the security.
     Neither the Company nor any of the Underwriters makes any representation or
prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any effect that the transactions
described above may have on the price of the Class A Common Stock. In addition,
neither the Company nor any of the Underwriters makes any representation that
the U.S. Representatives will engage in such transactions or that such
transactions, once commenced, will not be discontinued without notice.
     Each International Manager has agreed that (i) it has not offered or sold,
and, for a period of six months from the date of this Prospectus, will not offer
or sell, to persons in the United Kingdom, other than to persons whose ordinary
activities involve them in acquiring, holding, managing or disposing of
investments (as principal or agent) for the purpose of their businesses or
otherwise in circumstances which have not resulted and will not result in an
offer to the public in the United Kingdom within the meaning of the Public
Offers of Securities Regulations 1995; (ii) it has complied with and will comply
with all applicable provisions of the Financial Services Act 1986 with respect
to anything done by it in relation to the shares of Class A Common Stock in,
from or otherwise involving the United Kingdom; and (iii) it has only issued or
passed on and will only issue or pass on in the United Kingdom any document
received by it in connection with the issue of shares of Class A Common Stock to
a person who is of a kind described in Article 11(3) of the Financial Services
Act 1986 (Investment Advertisements) (Exemptions) Order 1996, or is a person to
whom such document may otherwise lawfully be issued or passed on.
     No action has been or will be taken in any jurisdiction (except in the
United States) that would permit a public offering of the shares of Class A
Common Stock, or the possession, circulation or distribution of this Prospectus
or any other material relating to the Company or shares of Class A Common Stock
in any jurisdiction where action for that purpose is required. Accordingly, the
shares of Class A Common Stock may not be offered or sold, directly or
indirectly, and neither this Prospectus nor any other offering material or
advertisements in connection with the shares of Class A Common Stock may be
distributed or published, in or from any country or jurisdiction except in
compliance with any applicable rules and regulations of any such country or
jurisdiction.
     Purchasers of the shares offered hereby may be required to pay stamp taxes
and other charges in accordance with the laws and practices of the country of
purchase in addition to the offering price set forth on the cover page hereof.
     NationsBank, an affiliate of NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.,
loaned the Company $20 million under the Six-Month Facility to finance the Lake
Norman Acquisition and the Williams Acquisition. More than 10% of the net
proceeds of the Offering will be received by NationsBank by reason of the use of
such proceeds to repay a portion of such borrowings. Accordingly, the Offering
will be conducted in accordance with NASD Conduct Rule 2710(c)(8), which
requires that the public offering price of the Class A Common Stock be no higher
than the price recommended by a Qualified Independent Underwriter which has
participated in the preparation of the Registration Statement and performed its
usual standard of due diligence with respect thereto. Merrill Lynch will act as
the Qualified Independent Underwriter for the Offering, and the public offering
price will not be higher than the price recommended by Merrill Lynch.
                                       80
 
<PAGE>

               [ALTERNATE PAGE FOR INTERNATIONAL PROSPECTUS]

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------
     No dealer, salesperson, or any other individual has been authorized to give
any information or to make any representations not contained in this Prospectus
in connection with the offering covered by this Prospectus. If given or made,
such information or representations must not be relied upon as having been
authorized by the Company or the Underwriters. This Prospectus does not
constitute an offer to sell or a solicitation of an offer to buy the Class A
Common Stock in any jurisdiction where, or to any person to whom, it is unlawful
to make such offer or solicitation. Neither the delivery of this Prospectus nor
any sale made hereunder shall, under any circumstances, create an implication
that there has not been any change in the facts set forth in this Prospectus or
in the affairs of the Company since the date hereof.
     In this Prospectus, references to "dollars" and "$" are to United States
dollars.
                               -----------------
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        Page
                                                        ----
<S>                                                     <C>
Prospectus Summary...................................      3
Risk Factors.........................................      9
The Reorganization...................................     19
The Acquisitions.....................................     19
Use of Proceeds......................................     23
Dividend Policy......................................     23
Capitalization.......................................     24
Dilution.............................................     25
Selected Combined And Consolidated Financial Data....     26
Pro Forma Combined and Consolidated Financial Data...     28
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
  Condition and Results of Operations................     36
Business.............................................     43
Management...........................................     59
Certain Transactions.................................     66
Principal Stockholders...............................     70
Description of Capital Stock.........................     71
Shares Eligible for Future Sale......................     75
Certain United States Federal Tax Considerations for
  Non-United States Holders..........................     76
Underwriting.........................................     78
Legal Matters........................................     81
Experts..............................................     81
Additional Information...............................     81
Index to Financial Statements........................    F-1
</TABLE>
 
     Until     , 1997 (25 days after the date of this Prospectus), all dealers
effecting transactions in the Class A Common Stock, whether or not participating
in this distribution, may be required to deliver a Prospectus. This delivery
requirement is in addition to the obligation of dealers to deliver a Prospectus
when acting as Underwriters and with respect to their unsold allotments or
subscriptions.
                                5,000,000 Shares

                          (Sonic Automotive Inc. logo)
 
                              Class A Common Stock
                               -----------------
                                   PROSPECTUS
                               -----------------
                          Merrill Lynch International
                    NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
                           Wheat First Butcher Singer
                                          , 1997
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
<PAGE>
                                    PART II
                     INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
Item 13. Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution.
     The following table sets forth the expenses to be borne by the Registrant
in connection with the issuance and distribution of the securities being
registered hereby other than underwriting discounts and commissions. All the
amounts shown are estimates, except for the registration fee with the Securities
and Exchange Commission, the NASD filing fee and the NYSE fees.
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                        <C>
SEC Registration fee....................................................................   $   31,516
NASD filing fee.........................................................................       10,900
NYSE fees...............................................................................       84,600
Transfer agent and registrar fees.......................................................       15,000
Accounting fees and expenses............................................................      950,000
Legal fees and expenses.................................................................      450,000
"Blue Sky" fees and expenses (including legal fees).....................................       15,000
Costs of printing and engraving.........................................................      325,000
Miscellaneous...........................................................................      117,984
                                                                                           ----------
Total...................................................................................   $2,000,000
                                                                                           ----------
                                                                                           ----------
</TABLE>
 
Item 14. Indemnification of Directors and Officers.
     The Registrant's Bylaws effectively provide that the Registrant shall, to
the full extent permitted by Section 145 of the General Corporation Law of the
State of Delaware, as amended from time to time ("Section 145"), indemnify all
persons whom it may indemnify pursuant thereto. In addition, the Registrant's
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation eliminates personal liability
of its directors to the full extent permitted by Section 102(b)(7) of the
General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, as amended from time to time
("Section 102(b)(7)").
     Section 145 permits a corporation to indemnify its directors and officers
against expenses (including attorney's fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid
in settlements actually and reasonably incurred by them in connection with any
action, suit or proceeding brought by a third party if such directors or
officers acted in good faith and in a manner they reasonably believed to be in
or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation and, with respect to any
criminal action or proceeding, had no reason to believe their conduct was
unlawful. In a derivative action, indemnification may be made only for expenses
actually and reasonably incurred by directors and officers in connection with
the defense or settlement of an action or suit and only with respect to matter
as to which they shall have acted in good faith and in a manner they reasonably
believed to be in or not opposed to the best interest of the corporation, except
that no indemnification shall be made if such person shall have been adjudged
liable to the corporation, unless and only to the extent that the court in which
the action or suit was brought shall determine upon application that the
defendant officers or directors are reasonably entitled to indemnify for such
expenses despite such adjudication of liability.
     Section 102(b)(7) provides that a corporation may eliminate or limit the
personal liability of a director to the corporation or its stockholders for
monetary damages for reach of fiduciary duty as a director, provided that such
provision shall not eliminate or limit the liability of a director (i) for any
breach of the director's duty of loyalty to the corporation or its stockholders,
(ii) for acts or omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional
misconduct or a knowing violation of law, (iii) for willful or negligent conduct
in paying dividends or repurchasing stock out of other than lawfully available
funds or (iv) for any transaction from which the director derived an improper
personal benefit. No such provisions shall eliminate or limit the liability of a
director for any act or omission occurring prior to the date when such provision
becomes effective.
     The Company intends to obtain, prior to the effective date of the
Registration Statement, insurance against liabilities under the Securities Act
of 1933 for the benefit of its officers and directors.
   
     Section 7 of the Purchase Agreements (filed as Exhibits 1.1 and 1.2 to this
Registration Statement) provide that the Underwriters severally and not jointly
will indemnify and hold harmless the Registrant and each director, officer or
controlling person of the Registrant from and against any liability caused by
any statement or omission in the Registration Statement or Prospectus based upon
information furnished to the Registrant by the Underwriters for use therein.
    
Item 15. Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities.
     Except as hereinafter set forth, there have been no sales of unregistered
securities by the Registrant within the past there years.
     As of January 30, 1997, as part of the original organization of the
Company, the Registrant issued to Sonic Financial Corporation 100 shares of
Common Stock of the Company (the "Original Shares") in exchange for $500 in
cash.
                                      II-1
 
<PAGE>
     As of June 30, 1997, as part of the Reorganization, the Registrant issued
to (i) its Chief Executive Officer, Bruton Smith, 1,657 shares of the
Registrant's Class B Common Stock in exchange for all his interests in Town &
Country Toyota and Fort Mill Ford, (ii) Sonic Financial Corporation 7,105 shares
of its Class B Common Stock in exchange for all its interests in the Original
Shares, Town & Country Ford, Fort Mill Ford, Lone Star Ford and Frontier
Plymouth-Oldsmobile-Cadillac, (iii) William S. Egan 473 shares of its Class B
Common Stock in exchange for all his interest in Town & Country Toyota, and (iv)
Bryan Scott Smith 765 shares of its Class B Common Stock in exchange for all his
interests in Town & Country Ford and Fort Mill Ford. Also, in connection with
the Dyer Acquisition, the Company will issue the Dyer Warrant. In each such
transaction, the securities were not or will not be registered under the
Securities Act, in reliance upon the exemption from registration provided by
Section 4(2) of said Act in view of the sophistication of the foregoing
purchasers, their access to material information, the disclosures actually made
to them by the Registrant and the absence of any general solicitation or
advertising.
     On or before the consummation of the Offering, the Registrant will issue to
nine of its officers and employees, pursuant to the Registrant's Stock Option
Plan, options to purchase 562,500 shares of Class A Common Stock in the
aggregate and will dividend to holders of its Class B Common Stock 6,240,000
shares of Class B Common Stock in the aggregate. Such securities will not be
registered under the Securities Act because such grants and dividend will be
without consideration to the Registrant and, consequently, do not constitute
offers or sales within the meaning of Section 5 of the Securities Act.
Item 16. Exhibits.
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Exhibit No.                                                  Description
- -----------   ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<C>           <S>
     1.1      Form of U.S. Purchase Agreement
     1.2      Form of International Purchase Agreement
     3.1*     Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company
     3.2*     Bylaws of the Company
     4.1*     Form of Class A Common Stock Certificate
     4.2*     Registration Rights Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 among the Company, O. Bruton Smith, Bryan Scott
              Smith, William S. Egan and Sonic Financial Corporation
     5.1*     Form of opinion letter of Parker, Poe, Adams & Bernstein L.L.P. regarding the legality of the securities
              to be registered
    10.1*     Form of Lease Agreement to be entered into between the Company (or its subsidiaries) and Nelson E. Bowers,
              II or his affiliates
    10.2*     Form of Lease Agreement to be entered into between the Company (or its subsidiaries) and Marks Holding
              Company, Inc.
    10.3*     Lease Agreement dated as of January 1, 1995 between Lone Star Ford, Inc. and Viking Investment Associates
    10.4*     Lease Agreement dated as of October 23, 1979 between O. Bruton Smith, Bonnie Smith and Town and Country
              Ford, Inc.
    10.5*     North Carolina Warranty Deed dated as of April 24, 1987 between O. Bruton Smith and Bonnie Smith, as
              Grantors and STC Properties, as Grantee
    10.6*     Lease dated January 13, 1995 between JAG Properties LLC and Jaguar of Chattanooga LLC
    10.7*     Lease dated October 18, 1991 by and between Nelson E. Bowers II, Thomas M. Green, Jr., and Infiniti of
              Chattanooga, Inc.
    10.8*     Amendment to Lease Agreement dated as of January 13, 1995 among Nelson E. Bowers II, Thomas M. Green, Jr.,
              JAG Properties LLC and Infiniti of Chattanooga, Inc.
    10.9*     Lease dated March 15, 1996 between Cleveland Properties LLC and Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle LLC
   10.10*     Lease Agreement dated January 2, 1993 among Nelson E. Bowers II, Thomas M. Green, Jr. and Cleveland
              Village Imports, Inc.
   10.11*     Ford Motor Credit Company Automotive Wholesale Plan Application for Wholesale Financing dated August 10,
              1972 by Lone Star Ford, Inc.
   10.12*     Ford Motor Credit Company Automotive Wholesale Plan Application for Wholesale Financing and Security
              Agreement dated August 22, 1984 by Town and Country Ford, Inc.
   10.13*     Wholesale Floor Plan Security Agreement dated October 5, 1990 between Marcus David Corporation (d/b/a Town
              & Country Toyota) and World Omni Financial Corp.
   10.14*     Demand Promissory Note dated October 5, 1990 of Marcus David Corporation (d/b/a Town & Country Toyota) in
              favor of World Omni Financial Corp.
   10.15*     Security Agreement & Master Credit Agreement (Non-Chrysler Corporation Dealer) dated April 21, 1995
              between Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle LLC and Chrysler Credit Corporation
</TABLE>
    
                                      II-2
 
<PAGE>
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Exhibit No.                                                  Description
- -----------   ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<C>           <S>
   10.15a*    Promissory Note dated April 21, 1995 in favor of Chrysler Credit Corporation by Cleveland Chrysler
              Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC
   10.16*     Security Agreement & Master Credit Agreement dated April 21, 1995 between Saturn of Chattanooga, Inc. and
              Chrysler Credit Corporation
   10.16a*    Promissory Note dated April 21, 1995 in favor of Chrysler Credit Corporation by Saturn of Chattanooga,
              Inc.
   10.17*     Security Agreement & Master Credit Agreement (Non-Chrysler Corporation Dealer) dated April 24, 1995
              between Nelson Bowers Ford, L.P. and Chrysler Credit Corporation
   10.17a*    Promissory Note dated April 21, 1995 in favor of Chrysler Credit Corporation by Nelson Bowers Ford L.P.
   10.18*     Floor Plan Agreement dated May 6, 1996 between European Motors, LLC and NationsBank, N.A.
   10.19*     Floor Plan Agreement dated April 11, 1996 between KIA of Chattanooga, LLC and NationsBank, N.A.
   10.19a*    Security Agreement dated April 11, 1996 between KIA of Chattanooga, LLC and NationsBank, N.A.
   10.20*     Floor Plan Agreement dated October 17, 1996 between European Motors of Nashville, LLC and NationsBank,
              N.A.
   10.20a*    Security Agreement dated October 17, 1996 between European Motors of Nashville, LLC and NationsBank, N.A.
   10.21*     Floor Plan Agreement dated March 5, 1997 between Nelson Bowers Dodge, LLC (d/b/a Dodge of Chattanooga) and
              NationsBank, N.A.
   10.22*     Security Agreement and Master Credit Agreement dated May 15, 1996 between Lake Norman Chrysler Plymouth
              Jeep Eagle, LLC and Chrysler Financial Corporation
   10.22a*    Promissory Note dated May 15, 1996 in favor of Chrysler Financial Corporation by Lake Norman Chrysler
              Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC
   10.23*     Security Agreement & Capital Loan Agreement dated May 15, 1996 between Lake Norman Dodge, Inc and Chrysler
              Financial Corp.
   10.23a*    Promissory Note dated May 15, 1996 in favor of Chrysler Financial Corporation by Lake Norman Dodge, Inc.
   10.23b*    Promissory Note dated May 15, 1996 in favor of Chrysler Financial Corporation by Lake Norman Dodge, Inc.
   10.24*     Security Agreement and Master Credit Agreement (Non-Chrysler Corporation Dealer) dated May 15, 1996
              between Lake Norman Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC and Chrysler Financial Corporation
   10.24a*    Promissory Note dated May 15, 1996 in favor of Chrysler Financial Corporation by Lake Norman Chrysler
              Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC
   10.25*     Floor Plan Agreement dated September 1, 1996 between NationsBank, N.A. and Dyer & Dyer, Inc.
   10.25a*    Security Agreement dated September 1, 1996 between NationsBank, N.A. and Dyer & Dyer, Inc.
   10.26*     Security Agreement and Master Credit Agreement (Non-Chrysler Corporation Dealer) dated April 21, 1995
              between Cleveland Village Imports, Inc. (d/b/a Cleveland Village Honda, Inc.) and Chrysler Credit
              Corporation
   10.27*     Jaguar Credit Corporation Automotive Wholesale Plan Application for Wholesale Financing and Security
              Agreement dated March 14, 1995 by Jaguar of Chattanooga LLC
   10.28*     Assignment of Joint Venturer Interest in Chartown dated as of June 30, 1997 among Town and Country Ford,
              Inc., SMDA LLC and Sonic Financial Corporation
   10.29*     Form of Employment Agreement between the Company and O. Bruton Smith
   10.30*     Form of Employment Agreement between the Company and Bryan Scott Smith
   10.31*     Form of Employment Agreement between the Company and Theodore M. Wright
   10.32*     Form of Employment Agreement between the Company and Nelson E. Bowers, II
   10.33*     Tax Allocation Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 between the Company and Sonic Financial Corporation
   10.34*     Form of Sonic Automotive, Inc. Stock Option Plan
   10.35*     Form of Sonic Automotive, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan
   10.36*     Subscription Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 between O. Bruton Smith and the Company
   10.37*     Subscription Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 between Sonic Financial Corporation and the Company
   10.38*     Subscription Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 between Bryan Scott Smith and the Company
   10.39*     Subscription Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 between William S. Egan and the Company
   10.40*     Asset Purchase Agreement dated as of May 27, 1997 by and among Sonic Auto World, Inc., Lake Norman Dodge,
              Inc., Lake Norman Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle LLC, Quinton M. Gandy and Phil M. Gandy, Jr. (confidential
              portions omitted and filed separately with the SEC)
</TABLE>
    
                                      II-3
 
<PAGE>
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Exhibit No.                                                  Description
- -----------   ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<C>           <S>
   10.41*     Asset Purchase Agreement dated as of June 24, 1997 by and among Sonic Auto World, Inc., Kia of
              Chattanooga, LLC, European Motors of Nashville, LLC, European Motors, LLC, Jaguar of Chattanooga LLC,
              Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle LLC, Nelson Bowers Dodge, LLC, Cleveland Village Imports, Inc.,
              Saturn of Chattanooga, Inc., Nelson Bowers Ford, L.P., Nelson E. Bowers II, Jeffrey C. Rachor, and the
              other shareholders named herein (confidential portions omitted and filed separately with the SEC)
   10.41a*    Amendment to Asset Purchase Agreement dated October 16, 1997 re: Bowers Acquisition
   10.42*     Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of July 29, 1997 between Sonic Auto World, Inc. and Ken Marks, Jr., O.K.
              Marks, Sr. and Michael J. Marks (confidential portions omitted and filed separately with the SEC)
   10.43*     Asset Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1997 by and among Sonic Automotive, Inc., Dyer & Dyer, Inc.
              and Richard Dyer (confidential portions omitted and filed separately with the SEC)
   10.43a*    Amendment to Asset Purchase Agreement dated October 16, 1997 re: Dyer Acquisition
   10.44*     Security Agreement and Master Credit Agreement dated April 21, 1995 between Cleveland Chrysler Plymouth
              Jeep Eagle and Chrysler Credit Corporation
   10.45*     Promissory Note dated as of August 28, 1997 by Sonic Automotive, Inc. in favor of NationsBank, N.A.
   10.46*     Credit Agreement dated October 15, 1997 by and between Sonic Automotive, Inc. and Ford Motor Credit
              Company
   10.47*     Automotive Wholesale Plan Application For Wholesale Financing And Security Agreement dated June 29, 1982
              between Ford Motor Credit Company and O.K. Marks Ford, Inc.
   10.48      Supplemental Agreement between the Company and Ford Motor Company
   10.49      Agreement between Toyota Motors Sales USA and the Company
   10.50      Ford Sales and Service Agreement with Town and Country Ford
   10.51      Ford Sales and Service Agreement with Lone Star Ford
   10.52      Ford Sales and Service Agreement with Fort Mill Ford
   10.53      Ford Sales and Service Agreement with Ken Marks Ford
   10.54      Ford Sales and Service Agreement with Nelson Bowers Ford
   10.55      Chrysler Sales and Service Agreement with Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge
   10.56      Plymouth Sales and Service Agreement with Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge
   10.57      Dodge Sales and Service Agreement with Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge
   10.58      Dodge Sales and Service Agreement with Sonic Dodge, LLC d/b/a Lake Norman Dodge
   10.59      Chrysler Sales and Service Agreement with Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, LLC d/b/a Lake Norman
              Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.60      Plymouth Sales and Service Agreement with Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, LLC d/b/a Lake Norman
              Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.61      Jeep Sales and Service Agreement with Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, LLC d/b/a Lake Norman
              Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.62      Chrysler Sales and Service Agreement with Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.63      Plymouth Sales and Service Agreement with Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.64      Jeep Sales and Service Agreement with Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.65      Dodge Sales and Service Agreement with Nelson Bowers Dodge
   10.66      Volvo Authorized Retailer Agreement with European Motors, LLC
              d/b/a Volvo of Chattanooga
   10.67      Volvo Sales Agreement with Dyer & Dyer, Inc.
   10.68      Toyota Dealer Agreement with Marcus David Corporation d/b/a Town
              & Country Toyota
    21.1      Subsidiaries of the Company
    23.1      Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP
    23.2      Consent of Parker, Poe, Adams & Bernstein L.L.P. (included in Exhibit 5.1 to this Registration Statement)
      24*     Power of Attorney (included on the signature page to this Registration Statement)
      27*     Financial Data Schedule
    99.1*     Consent of Nelson E. Bowers, II
    99.2      Reserve Share Program Documentation
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------------
   
 * Filed previously.
    
                                      II-4
 
<PAGE>
   
Item 17. Undertakings.
    
     The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes to provide to the
Underwriters, at the closing or closings specified in the Purchase Agreement,
certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as may be
required by the Underwriters in order to permit prompt delivery to each
purchaser.
     The undersigned Registrant hereby further undertakes that:
     (1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of
1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this
Registration Statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of
prospectus filed by the Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h)
under the Securities Act shall be deemed part of this Registration Statement as
of the time it was declared effective.
     (2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act
of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall
be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered
therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be
the initial bona fide offering thereof.
     Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act
of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the
Registrant pursuant to the foregoing, or otherwise, the Registrant has been
advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such
indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is,
therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against
such liabilities (other than the payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred
or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the Registrant in the
successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such
director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being
registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter
has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate
jurisdiction the question of whether such indemnification by it is against
public policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final
adjudication of such issue.
                                      II-5
 
<PAGE>
   
                                   SIGNATURES
    
   
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant
has duly caused this Amendment to the Registration Statement to be signed on its
behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in Charlotte, North
Carolina on November 5, 1997.
    
                                         SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
                                         By: /s/______THEODORE M. WRIGHT________
                                                    Theodore M. Wright
                                               Vice President, Treasurer and
                                                  Chief Financial Officer
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Amendment to
the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the
capacities and on the date indicated:
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                      Signature                                            Title                             Date
- ------------------------------------------------------  -------------------------------------------   -------------------
<S>                                                     <C>                                           <C>
                         /s/*                           Chairman and Chief Executive Officer          November 5, 1997
                   O. Bruton Smith                        (principal executive officer)
                         /s/*                           President, Chief Operating Officer            November 5, 1997
                  Bryan Scott Smith                       and Director
                /s/THEODORE M. WRIGHT                   Vice President, Treasurer,                    November 5, 1997
                  Theodore M. Wright                      Chief Financial Officer
                                                          (principal financial and
                                                          accounting officer) and
                                                          Director
                         /s/*                           Director                                      November 5, 1997
                  William R. Brooks
              *By: /s/THEODORE M. WRIGHT
                  Theodore M. Wright
            (Attorney-in-fact for each of
                the persons indicated)
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      II-6
 
<PAGE>
                                 EXHIBIT INDEX
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                               Sequential
Exhibit No.                                            Description                                              Page No.
- -----------   ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------   ----------
<C>           <S>                                                                                              <C>
     1.1      Form of U.S. Purchase Agreement
     1.2      Form of International Purchase Agreement
     3.1*     Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company
     3.2*     Bylaws of the Company
     4.1*     Form of Class A Common Stock Certificate
     4.2*     Registration Rights Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 among the Company, O. Bruton Smith,
              Bryan Scott Smith, William S. Egan and Sonic Financial Corporation
     5.1*     Form of opinion letter of Parker, Poe, Adams & Bernstein L.L.P. regarding the legality of the
              securities to be registered
    10.1*     Form of Lease Agreement to be entered into between the Company (or its subsidiaries) and
              Nelson E. Bowers, II or his affiliates
    10.2*     Form of Lease Agreement to be entered into between the Company (or its subsidiaries) and Marks
              Holding Company, Inc.
    10.3*     Lease Agreement dated as of January 1, 1995 between Lone Star Ford, Inc. and Viking Investment
              Associates
    10.4*     Lease Agreement dated as of October 23, 1979 between O. Bruton Smith, Bonnie Smith and Town
              and Country Ford, Inc.
    10.5*     North Carolina Warranty Deed dated as of April 24, 1987 between O. Bruton Smith and Bonnie
              Smith, as Grantors and STC Properties, as Grantee
    10.6*     Lease dated January 13, 1995 between JAG Properties LLC and Jaguar of Chattanooga LLC
    10.7*     Lease dated October 18, 1991 by and between Nelson E. Bowers II, Thomas M. Green, Jr., and
              Infiniti of Chattanooga, Inc.
    10.8*     Amendment to Lease Agreement dated as of January 13, 1995 among Nelson E. Bowers II, Thomas M.
              Green, Jr., JAG Properties LLC and Infiniti of Chattanooga, Inc.
    10.9*     Lease dated March 15, 1996 between Cleveland Properties LLC and Cleveland Chrysler-
              Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle LLC
   10.10*     Lease Agreement dated January 2, 1993 among Nelson E. Bowers II, Thomas M. Green, Jr. and
              Cleveland Village Imports, Inc.
   10.11*     Ford Motor Credit Company Automotive Wholesale Plan Application for Wholesale Financing dated
              August 10, 1972 by Lone Star Ford, Inc.
   10.12*     Ford Motor Credit Company Automotive Wholesale Plan Application for Wholesale Financing and
              Security Agreement dated August 22, 1984 by Town and Country Ford, Inc.
   10.13*     Wholesale Floor Plan Security Agreement dated October 5, 1990 between Marcus David Corporation
              (d/b/a Town & Country Toyota) and World Omni Financial Corp.
   10.14*     Demand Promissory Note dated October 5, 1990 of Marcus David Corporation (d/b/a Town & Country
              Toyota) in favor of World Omni Financial Corp.
   10.15*     Security Agreement & Master Credit Agreement (Non-Chrysler Corporation Dealer) dated April 21,
              1995 between Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle LLC and Chrysler Credit Corporation
   10.15a*    Promissory Note dated April 21, 1995 in favor of Chrysler Credit Corporation by Cleveland
              Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC
   10.16*     Security Agreement & Master Credit Agreement dated April 21, 1995 between Saturn of
              Chattanooga, Inc. and Chrysler Credit Corporation
   10.16a*    Promissory Note dated April 21, 1995 in favor of Chrysler Credit Corporation by Saturn of
              Chattanooga, Inc.
   10.17*     Security Agreement & Master Credit Agreement (Non-Chrysler Corporation Dealer) dated April 24,
              1995 between Nelson Bowers Ford, L.P. and Chrysler Credit Corporation
   10.17a*    Promissory Note dated April 21, 1995 in favor of Chrysler Credit Corporation by Nelson Bowers
              Ford L.P.
   10.18*     Floor Plan Agreement dated May 6, 1996 between European Motors, LLC and NationsBank, N.A.
   10.19*     Floor Plan Agreement dated April 11, 1996 between KIA of Chattanooga, LLC and NationsBank,
              N.A.
   10.19a*    Security Agreement dated April 11, 1996 between KIA of Chattanooga, LLC and NationsBank, N.A.
</TABLE>
    
 
<PAGE>
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                               Sequential
Exhibit No.                                            Description                                              Page No.
- -----------   ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------   ----------
<C>           <S>                                                                                              <C>
   10.20*     Floor Plan Agreement dated October 17, 1996 between European Motors of Nashville, LLC and
              NationsBank, N.A.
   10.20a*    Security Agreement dated October 17, 1996 between European Motors of Nashville, LLC and
              NationsBank, N.A.
   10.21*     Floor Plan Agreement dated March 5, 1997 between Nelson Bowers Dodge, LLC (d/b/a Dodge of
              Chattanooga) and NationsBank, N.A.
   10.22*     Security Agreement and Master Credit Agreement dated May 15, 1996 between Lake Norman Chrysler
              Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC and Chrysler Financial Corporation
   10.22a*    Promissory Note dated May 15, 1996 in favor of Chrysler Financial Corporation by Lake Norman
              Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC
   10.23*     Security Agreement & Capital Loan Agreement dated May 15, 1996 between Lake Norman Dodge, Inc
              and Chrysler Financial Corp.
   10.23a*    Promissory Note dated May 15, 1996 in favor of Chrysler Financial Corporation by Lake Norman
              Dodge, Inc.
   10.23b*    Promissory Note dated May 15, 1996 in favor of Chrysler Financial Corporation by Lake Norman
              Dodge, Inc.
   10.24*     Security Agreement and Master Credit Agreement (Non-Chrysler Corporation Dealer) dated May 15,
              1996 between Lake Norman Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC and Chrysler Financial Corporation
   10.24a*    Promissory Note dated May 15, 1996 in favor of Chrysler Financial Corporation by Lake Norman
              Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle, LLC
   10.25*     Floor Plan Agreement dated September 1, 1996 between NationsBank, N.A. and Dyer & Dyer, Inc.
   10.25a*    Security Agreement dated September 1, 1996 between NationsBank, N.A. and Dyer & Dyer, Inc.
   10.26*     Security Agreement and Master Credit Agreement (Non-Chrysler Corporation Dealer) dated April
              21, 1995 between Cleveland Village Imports, Inc. (d/b/a Cleveland Village Honda, Inc.) and
              Chrysler Credit Corporation
   10.27*     Jaguar Credit Corporation Automotive Wholesale Plan Application for Wholesale Financing and
              Security Agreement dated March 14, 1995 by Jaguar of Chattanooga LLC
   10.28*     Assignment of Joint Venturer Interest in Chartown dated as of June 30, 1997 among Town and
              Country Ford, Inc., SMDA LLC and Sonic Financial Corporation
   10.29*     Form of Employment Agreement between the Company and O. Bruton Smith
   10.30*     Form of Employment Agreement between the Company and Bryan Scott Smith
   10.31*     Form of Employment Agreement between the Company and Theodore M. Wright
   10.32*     Form of Employment Agreement between the Company and Nelson E. Bowers, II
   10.33*     Tax Allocation Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 between the Company and Sonic Financial
              Corporation
   10.34*     Form of Sonic Automotive, Inc. Stock Option Plan
   10.35*     Form of Sonic Automotive, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan
   10.36*     Subscription Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 between O. Bruton Smith and the Company
   10.37*     Subscription Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 between Sonic Financial Corporation and the
              Company
   10.38*     Subscription Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 between Bryan Scott Smith and the Company
   10.39*     Subscription Agreement dated as of June 30, 1997 between William S. Egan and the Company
   10.40*     Asset Purchase Agreement dated as of May 27, 1997 by and among Sonic Auto World, Inc., Lake
              Norman Dodge, Inc., Lake Norman Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle LLC, Quinton M. Gandy and Phil M.
              Gandy, Jr. (confidential portions omitted and filed separately with the SEC)
   10.41*     Asset Purchase Agreement dated as of June 24, 1997 by and among Sonic Auto World, Inc., Kia of
              Chattanooga, LLC, European Motors of Nashville, LLC, European Motors, LLC, Jaguar of
              Chattanooga LLC, Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle LLC, Nelson Bowers Dodge, LLC,
              Cleveland Village Imports, Inc., Saturn of Chattanooga, Inc., Nelson Bowers Ford, L.P., Nelson
              E. Bowers II, Jeffrey C. Rachor, and the other shareholders named herein (confidential
              portions omitted and filed separately with the SEC)
   10.41a*    Amendment to Asset Purchase Agreement dated October 16, 1997 re: Bowers Acquisition
</TABLE>
    
 
<PAGE>
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                               Sequential
Exhibit No.                                            Description                                              Page No.
- -----------   ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------   ----------
<C>           <S>                                                                                              <C>
   10.42*     Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of July 29, 1997 between Sonic Auto World, Inc. and Ken
              Marks, Jr., O.K. Marks, Sr. and Michael J. Marks (confidential portions omitted and filed
              separately with the SEC)
   10.43*     Asset Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1997 by and among Sonic Automotive, Inc., Dyer &
              Dyer, Inc. and Richard Dyer (confidential portions omitted and filed separately with the SEC)
   10.43a*    Amendment to Asset Purchase Agreement dated October 16, 1997 re: Dyer Acquisition
   10.44*     Security Agreement and Master Credit Agreement dated April 21, 1995 between Cleveland Chrysler
              Plymouth Jeep Eagle and Chrysler Credit Corporation
   10.45*     Promissory Note dated as of August 28, 1997 by Sonic Automotive, Inc. in favor of NationsBank,
              N.A.
   10.46*     Credit Agreement dated October 15, 1997 by and between Sonic Automotive, Inc. and Ford Motor
              Credit Company
   10.47*     Automotive Wholesale Plan Application For Wholesale Financing And Security Agreement dated
              June 29, 1982 between Ford Motor Credit Company and O.K. Marks Ford, Inc.
   10.48      Supplemental Agreement between the Company and Ford Motor Company
   10.49      Agreement between Toyota Motors Sales USA and the Company
   10.50      Ford Sales and Service Agreement with Town and Country Ford
   10.51      Ford Sales and Service Agreement with Lone Star Ford
   10.52      Ford Sales and Service Agreement with Fort Mill Ford
   10.53      Ford Sales and Service Agreement with Ken Marks Ford
   10.54      Ford Sales and Service Agreement with Nelson Bowers Ford
   10.55      Chrysler Sales and Service Agreement with Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge
   10.56      Plymouth Sales and Service Agreement with Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge
   10.57      Dodge Sales and Service Agreement with Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge
   10.58      Dodge Sales and Service Agreement with Sonic Dodge, LLC d/b/a Lake Norman Dodge
   10.59      Chrysler Sales and Service Agreement with Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, LLC d/b/a Lake
              Norman Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.60      Plymouth Sales and Service Agreement with Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, LLC d/b/a Lake
              Norman Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.61      Jeep Sales and Service Agreement with Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, LLC d/b/a Lake
              Norman Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.62      Chrysler Sales and Service Agreement with Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.63      Plymouth Sales and Service Agreement with Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.64      Jeep Sales and Service Agreement with Cleveland Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle
   10.65      Dodge Sales and Service Agreement with Nelson Bowers Dodge
   10.66      Volvo Authorized Retailer Agreement with European Motors, LLC
              d/b/a Volvo of Chattanooga
   10.67      Volvo Sales Agreement with Dyer & Dyer, Inc.
   10.68      Toyota Dealer Agreement with Marcus David Corporation
              d/b/a Town & Country Toyota
    21.1      Subsidiaries of the Company
    23.1      Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP
    23.2      Consent of Parker, Poe, Adams & Bernstein L.L.P. (included in Exhibit 5.1 to this Registration
              Statement)
      24*     Power of Attorney (included on the signature page to this Registration Statement)
      27*     Financial Data Schedule
    99.1*     Consent of Nelson E. Bowers, II
    99.2      Reserve Share Program Documentation
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------------
   
 * Filed previously.
    
 


   
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                  EXHIBIT 1.1

                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.

                             A Delaware corporation


                    5,000,000 Shares of Class A Common Stock



                             U.S. PURCHASE AGREEMENT
















Dated:  November [   ], 1997


========================================================================


<PAGE>


                                Table of Contents
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                               Page

<S>                                                                                                             <C>
     SECTION 1. Representations and Warranties....................................................................4
         (a) Representations and Warranties by the Company........................................................4
                (i) Compliance with Registration Requirements.....................................................4
                (ii) Independent Accountants......................................................................5
                (iii) Financial Statements........................................................................5
                (iv) No Material Adverse Change in Business.......................................................5
                (v) Good Standing of the Company..................................................................6
                (vi) Good Standing of Subsidiaries................................................................6
                (vii) Capitalization..............................................................................6
                (viii) Authorization of Agreement.................................................................7
                (ix) Authorization and Description of Securities..................................................7
                (x) Absence of Defaults and Conflicts.............................................................7
                (xi) Absence of Labor Dispute.....................................................................8
                (xii) Absence of Proceedings......................................................................8
                (xiii) Accuracy of Exhibits.......................................................................8
                (xiv) Possession of Intellectual Property.........................................................8
                (xv) Absence of Further Requirements..............................................................8
                (xvi) Possession of Licenses and Permits..........................................................9
                (xvii) Title to Property..........................................................................9
                (xviii) Investment Company Act....................................................................9
                (xix) Environmental Laws.........................................................................10
                (xx) Registration Rights.........................................................................10
                (xxi) Income Taxes...............................................................................10
                (xxii) Internal Controls.........................................................................11
                (xxiii) Insurance................................................................................11
                (xxiv) Offering Material.........................................................................11
                (xxv) Suppliers..................................................................................11
                (xxvi) Related Party Transactions................................................................11
                (xxvii) Reorganization...........................................................................12
                (xxviii) Pending Acquisitions....................................................................12
                (xxix) Franchise Agreements......................................................................12
                (xxx) Credit Agreement...........................................................................12
         (b) Officer's Certificates..............................................................................12

     SECTION 2. Sale and Delivery to  Underwriters; Closing......................................................13
         (a) Initial Securities..................................................................................13
         (b) Option Securities...................................................................................13
         (c) Payment.............................................................................................13
         (d) Denominations; Registration.........................................................................14

                                      -1-

<PAGE>

         (e) Appointment of Qualified Independent Underwriter....................................................14

     SECTION 3. Covenants of the Company.........................................................................14
         (a) Compliance with Securities Regulations and Commission Requests......................................14
         (b) Filing of Amendments................................................................................15
         (c) Delivery of Registration Statements.................................................................15
         (d) Delivery of Prospectus..............................................................................15
         (e) Continued Compliance with Securities Laws...........................................................16
         (f) Blue Sky Qualifications.............................................................................16
         (g) Rule 158............................................................................................16
         (h) Use of Proceeds.....................................................................................17
         (i) Listing.............................................................................................17
         (j) Restriction on Sale of Securities...................................................................17
         (k) Reporting Requirements..............................................................................17
         (l) Compliance with NASD Rules..........................................................................17

     SECTION 4. Payment of Expenses..............................................................................18
         (a) Expenses............................................................................................18
         (b) Termination of Agreement............................................................................18

     SECTION 5. Conditions of U.S. Underwriters' Obligations.....................................................19
         (a) Effectiveness of Registration Statement.............................................................19
         (b) Opinion of Counsel for Company......................................................................19
         (c) Opinion of Counsel for U.S. Underwriters............................................................19
         (d) Officers' Certificate...............................................................................20
         (e) Accountant's Comfort Letter.........................................................................20
         (f) Bring-down Comfort Letter...........................................................................20
         (g) Approval of Listing.................................................................................20
         (h) No Objection........................................................................................20
         (i) Lock-up Agreement...................................................................................21
         (j) Acquisition Agreements..............................................................................21
         (k) Reorganization......................................................................................21
         (l) Manufacturers' Consents.............................................................................21
         (m)  Credit Agreement...................................................................................21
         (n)  Subscription Agreements............................................................................21
         (o) Purchase of Initial International Securities........................................................21
         (p)  Additional Documents...............................................................................22
         (q) Conditions to Purchase of U.S. Option Securities....................................................22
         (r) Termination of Agreement............................................................................23

     SECTION 6. Indemnification..................................................................................23
         (a) Indemnification of U.S. Underwriters................................................................23
         (b) Indemnification of Company, Directors and Officers..................................................24
         (c) Actions against Parties; Notification...............................................................24
         (d) Settlement without Consent if Failure to Reimburse..................................................25
         (e) Indemnification for Reserved Securities.............................................................25

     SECTION 7. Contribution.....................................................................................25


                                      -2-
<PAGE>

     SECTION 8. Representations, Warranties and Agreements to Survive Delivery...................................27

     SECTION 9. Termination Agreement............................................................................27
         (a) Termination; General................................................................................27
         (b) Liabilities.........................................................................................27

     SECTION 10. Default by One or More of the U.S. Underwriters.................................................27

     SECTION 11. Notices.........................................................................................28

     SECTION 12. Parties.........................................................................................28

     SECTION 13 Governing Law and Time...........................................................................29

     SECTION 14 Effect of Headings...............................................................................29




         SCHEDULES
                  SCHEDULE A - LIST OF UNDERWRITERS.........................................................SCH A-1
                  SCHEDULE B - PRICING INFORMATION..........................................................SCH B-1
                  SCHEDULE C - LIST OF PERSONS SUBJECT TO LOCK-UP...........................................SCH C-1

         EXHIBITS...............................................................................................A-1
                  EXHIBIT A -  FORM OF OPINION OF COMPANY'S COUNSEL.............................................A-1
                  EXHIBIT B - FORM OF LOCK-UP LETTER............................................................B-1
                  EXHIBIT C - REORGANIZATION DOCUMENTS..........................................................C-1
</TABLE>

                                      -3-
<PAGE>

                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.

                             A Delaware corporation

                         Shares of Class A Common Stock

                            Par Value $0.01 Per Share

                             U.S. PURCHASE AGREEMENT

                                                             November [  ], 1997

MERRILL LYNCH & CO.
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                     Incorporated
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.
  as U.S. Representatives of the several U.S. Underwriters
c/o  Merrill Lynch & Co.
       Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                            Incorporated
North Tower
World Financial Center
New York, New York  10281-1209

Ladies and Gentlemen:

         Sonic  Automotive,   Inc.,  a  Delaware  corporation  (the  "Company"),
confirms its agreement with Merrill Lynch & Co., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner &
Smith  Incorporated  ("Merrill  Lynch") and each of the other U.S.  Underwriters
named in Schedule A hereto (collectively,  the "U.S.  Underwriters",  which term
shall also  include  any  underwriter  substituted  as  hereinafter  provided in
Section 10 hereof), for whom Merrill Lynch,  NationsBanc  Montgomery Securities,
Inc. and Wheat, First Securities,  Inc. are acting as  representatives  (in such
capacity, the "U.S. Representatives"), with respect to the issue and sale by the
Company  and the  purchase by the U.S  Underwriters,  acting  severally  and not
jointly,  of the respective numbers of shares of Class A Common Stock, par value
$0.01 per share, of the Company  ("Common  Stock") set forth in said Schedule A,
and with  respect to the grant by the Company to the U.S.  Underwriters,  acting
severally  and not  jointly,  of the option  described in Section 2(b) hereof to
purchase all or any part of 600,000  additional  shares of Common Stock to cover
over-allotments,  if any. The  aforesaid

                                      -1-

<PAGE>

4,000,000 shares of Common Stock (the "Initial U.S. Securities") to be purchased
by the U.S.  Underwriters  and all or any part of the  600,000  shares of Common
Stock subject to the option  described in Section 2(b) hereof (the "U.S.  Option
Securities") are hereinafter called, collectively, the "U.S. Securities".

         It is  understood  that the Company is  concurrently  entering  into an
agreement  dated  the  date  hereof  (the  "International  Purchase  Agreement")
providing for the offering by the Company of an aggregate of 1,000,000 shares of
Common Stock (the "Initial International  Securities") through arrangements with
certain  underwriters  outside the United States and Canada (the  "International
Managers")  for  which  Merrill  Lynch  International,   NationsBanc  Montgomery
Securities,  Inc. and Wheat, First Securities,  Inc. are acting as lead managers
(the  "Lead  Managers")  and  the  grant  by the  Company  to the  International
Managers,  acting severally and not jointly, of an option to purchase all or any
part of the International Managers' pro rata portion of up to 150,000 additional
shares  of  Common   Stock   solely  to  cover   overallotments,   if  any  (the
"International Option Securities" and, together with the U.S. Option Securities,
the  "Option  Securities").   The  Initial  International   Securities  and  the
International  Option  Securities  are  hereinafter  called  the  "International
Securities".  It is understood that the Company is not obligated to sell and the
U.S.  Underwriters  are not obligated to purchase,  any Initial U.S.  Securities
unless  all  of  the  Initial  International  Securities  are  contemporaneously
purchased by the International Managers.

         The U.S.  Underwriters and the  International  Managers are hereinafter
collectively  called the  "Underwriters",  the Initial U.S.  Securities  and the
Initial  International   Securities  are  hereinafter  collectively  called  the
"Initial Securities",  and the U.S. Securities, and the International Securities
are hereinafter collectively called the "Securities".

         The  Underwriters  will  concurrently   enter  into  an  Intersyndicate
Agreement of even date herewith (the "Intersyndicate  Agreement")  providing for
the  coordination  of  certain  transactions  among the  Underwriters  under the
direction  of  Merrill  Lynch  & Co.,  Merrill  Lynch,  Pierce,  Fenner  & Smith
Incorporated (in such capacity, the "Global Coordinator").

         The Company  understands that the U.S.  Underwriters  propose to make a
public offering of the U.S. Securities as soon as the U.S.  Representatives deem
advisable after this Agreement has been executed and delivered.

         The  Company and the U.S.  Underwriters  agree that up to [ ] shares of
the Initial  U.S.  Securities  to be  purchased  by the U.S.  Underwriters  (the
"Reserved Securities") shall be reserved for sale by the Underwriters to certain
eligible  employees and persons having business  relationships with the Company,
as part of the  distribution of the Securities by the  Underwriters,  subject to
the  terms  of  this   Agreement,   the  applicable   rules,   regulations   and
interpretations of the National Association of Securities Dealers,  Inc. and all
other applicable  laws, rules and regulations.  To the extent that such Reserved
Securities are not orally confirmed for purchase by such eligible  employees and
persons having business  relationships  with the Company by the end of the first
business day after the date of this Agreement,  such Reserved  Securities may be
offered to the public as part of the public offering contemplated hereby.

                                      -2-
<PAGE>

         The Company has filed with the Securities and Exchange  Commission (the
"Commission") a registration  statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-33295) covering the
registration of the Securities under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the
"1933 Act"),  including  the related  preliminary  prospectus  or  prospectuses.
Promptly after execution and delivery of this Agreement, the Company will either
(i) prepare and file a prospectus in accordance with the provisions of Rule 430A
("Rule 430A") of the rules and regulations of the Commission  under the 1933 Act
(the "1933 Act  Regulations")  and paragraph (b) of Rule 424 ("Rule  424(b)") of
the 1933 Act  Regulations  or (ii) if the  Company has elected to rely upon Rule
434 ("Rule 434") of the 1933 Act  Regulations,  prepare and file a term sheet (a
"Term Sheet") in accordance with the provisions of Rule 434 and Rule 424(b). Two
forms of prospectus  are to be used in connection  with the offering and sale of
the  Securities:  one  relating  to the  U.S.  Securities  (the  "Form  of  U.S.
Prospectus")  and one  relating to the  International  Securities  (the "Form of
International Prospectus"). The Form of U.S. Prospectus is identical to the Form
of  International  Prospectus,  except for their  respective  front cover pages,
first  page of  "Prospectus  Summary,"  "Underwriting"  sections  and back cover
pages.  The  information  included  in any such  prospectus  or in any such Term
Sheet, as the case may be, that was omitted from such registration  statement at
the time it became effective but that is deemed to be part of such  registration
statement at the time it became  effective (a) pursuant to paragraph (b) of Rule
430A is referred to as "Rule 430A  Information" or (b) pursuant to paragraph (d)
of Rule 434 is  referred  to as "Rule 434  Information."  Each  Prospectus  used
before such  registration  statement became  effective,  and any prospectus that
omitted,  as applicable,  the Rule 430A Information or the Rule 434 Information,
that was used after such  effectiveness  and prior to the execution and delivery
of  this  Agreement,   is  herein  called  a  "preliminary   prospectus."   Such
registration statement,  including the exhibits thereto and schedules thereto at
the time it became  effective and including  the Rule 430A  Information  and the
Rule  434  Information,  as  applicable,  is  herein  called  the  "Registration
Statement." Any registration statement filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) of the 1933
Act  Regulations  is  herein  referred  to  as  the  "Rule  462(b)  Registration
Statement,"  and after  such  filing  the term  "Registration  Statement"  shall
include  the  Rule  462(b)  Registration  Statement.  The  final  Form  of  U.S.
Prospectus  and the Final  Form of  International  Prospectus  in the form first
furnished to the  Underwriters  for use in  connection  with the offering of the
Securities  are  herein  called  the "U.S.  Prospectus"  and the  "International
Prospectus," respectively,  and collectively, the "Prospectuses." If Rule 434 is
relied on, the term "U.S. Prospectus" and "International Prospectus" shall refer
to the  preliminary  U.S.  Prospectus  dated  October 17,  1997 and  preliminary
International  Prospectus  dated October 17, 1997,  respectively,  each together
with the applicable  Term Sheet and all references in this Agreement to the date
of the  Prospectuses  shall  mean the date of the  applicable  Term  Sheet.  For
purposes of this Agreement,  all references to the Registration  Statement,  any
preliminary prospectus, the U.S. Prospectus, the International Prospectus or any
Term Sheet or any  amendment  or  supplement  to any of the  foregoing  shall be
deemed to include the copy filed with the Commission  pursuant to its Electronic
Data Gathering, Analysis and Retrieval system ("EDGAR").

         SECTION 1.        Representations and Warranties.

         (a)  Representations  and  Warranties  by  the  Company.   The  Company
represents and warrants to each U.S.  Underwriter  as of the date hereof,  as of
the Closing  Time  referred to in


                                      -3-
<PAGE>

Section  2(c) hereof,  and as of each Date of Delivery  (if any)  referred to in
Section 2(b), hereof and agrees with each U.S. Underwriter, as follows:

                  (i) Compliance  with  Registration  Requirements.  Each of the
         Registration  Statement and any Rule 462(b) Registration  Statement has
         become  effective  under the 1933 Act and no stop order  suspending the
         effectiveness  of  the  Registration   Statement  or  any  Rule  462(b)
         Registration  Statement  has  been  issued  under  the  1933 Act and no
         proceedings for that purpose have been instituted or are pending or, to
         the knowledge of the Company,  are contemplated by the Commission,  and
         any request on the part of the Commission  for  additional  information
         has been complied with.

                  At the respective times the Registration  Statement,  any Rule
         462(b) Registration Statement and any post-effective amendments thereto
         became  effective  and at the  Closing  Time (and,  if any U.S.  Option
         Securities are purchased,  at the Date of Delivery),  the  Registration
         Statement,  the Rule 462(b)  Registration  Statement and any amendments
         and  supplements  thereto  complied  and will  comply  in all  material
         respects  with  the  requirements  of the  1933  Act and the  1933  Act
         Regulations  and did not and will not contain an untrue  statement of a
         material  fact or omit to state a material  fact  required to be stated
         therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, and
         the  Prospectuses,  any  preliminary  prospectuses  and any  supplement
         thereto or  prospectus  wrapper  prepared in connection  therewith,  at
         their  respective  times of issuance and at the Closing Time,  complied
         and will comply in all material  respects with any  applicable  laws or
         regulations of foreign jurisdictions in which the Prospectuses and such
         preliminary  prospectuses,  as amended or supplemented,  if applicable,
         are  distributed  in  connection  with the offer  and sale of  Reserved
         Securities.  Neither the Prospectuses nor any amendments or supplements
         thereto   (including   any  prospectus   wrapper),   at  the  time  the
         Prospectuses  or any amendments or supplements  thereto were issued and
         at the Closing Time (and, if any U.S. Option  Securities are purchased,
         at the Date of Delivery),  included or will include an untrue statement
         of a material  fact or  omitted  or will omit to state a material  fact
         necessary in order to make the statements  therein, in the light of the
         circumstances  under which they were made, not misleading.  If Rule 434
         is used, the Company will comply with the  requirements of Rule 434 and
         the Prospectuses shall not be "materially  different",  as such term is
         used in Rule 434, from the  prospectuses  included in the  Registration
         Statement  at the time it became  effective.  The  representations  and
         warranties  in this  subsection  shall  not apply to  statements  in or
         omissions from the Registration  Statement or the U.S.  Prospectus made
         in reliance upon and in conformity  with  information  furnished to the
         Company  in  writing  by  any  U.S.   Underwriter   through   the  U.S.
         Representatives  expressly for use in the Registration Statement or the
         U.S. Prospectus.

                  Each preliminary prospectus and the prospectuses filed as part
         of the  Registration  Statement as  originally  filed or as part of any
         amendment  thereto,  or filed  pursuant to Rule 424 under the 1933 Act,
         complied  when so  filed  in all  material  respects  with the 1933 Act
         Regulations  and  each  preliminary  prospectus  and  the  Prospectuses
         delivered to the  Underwriters for use in connection with this offering
         was identical to the  

                                      -4-
<PAGE>


         electronically transmitted copies thereof filed with the Commission
         pursuant to EDGAR, except to the extent permitted by Regulation S-T.

                  (ii)  Independent  Accountants.  The accountants who certified
         the  financial  statements  and  supporting  schedules  included in the
         Registration  Statement are independent  public accountants as required
         by the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act Regulations.

                  (iii) Financial Statements.  The financial statements included
         in the Registration  Statement and the Prospectuses,  together with the
         related schedules and notes,  present fairly the financial  position of
         the Company and its  consolidated  subsidiaries  at the dates indicated
         and the statement of operations, stockholders' equity and cash flows of
         the  Company  and  its   consolidated   subsidiaries  for  the  periods
         specified;  said financial  statements have been prepared in conformity
         with generally  accepted  accounting  principles  ("GAAP") applied on a
         consistent  basis  throughout  the  periods  involved.  The  supporting
         schedules  included in the  Registration  Statement  present  fairly in
         accordance with GAAP the information required to be stated therein. The
         selected financial data and the summary financial  information included
         in the  Prospectuses  present fairly the information  shown therein and
         have been  compiled  on a basis  consistent  with  that of the  audited
         financial  statements included in the Registration  Statement.  The pro
         forma  financial  statements and the related notes thereto  included in
         the  Registration  Statement and the  Prospectuses  present  fairly the
         information  shown therein,  have been prepared in accordance  with the
         Commission's  rules and guidelines  with respect to pro forma financial
         statements  and have been  properly  compiled  on the  bases  described
         therein,  and the  assumptions  used  in the  preparation  thereof  are
         reasonable  and the  adjustments  used therein are  appropriate to give
         effect to the transactions and circumstances referred to therein.

                  (iv)  No  Material  Adverse  Change  in  Business.  Since  the
         respective  dates as of which  information is given in the Registration
         Statement and the Prospectuses, except as otherwise stated therein, (A)
         there has been no material  adverse change in the condition,  financial
         or otherwise,  earnings,  business affairs or business prospects of the
         Company and its subsidiaries  considered as one enterprise,  whether or
         not arising in the  ordinary  course of business (a  "Material  Adverse
         Effect"),  (B) there  have  been no  transactions  entered  into by the
         Company or any of its  subsidiaries,  other than those in the  ordinary
         course of business,  which are material with respect to the Company and
         its subsidiaries  considered as one enterprise,  and (C) there has been
         no dividend or distribution  of any kind declared,  paid or made by the
         Company on any class of its capital stock.

                  (v) Good  Standing of the  Company.  The Company has been duly
         organized  and is validly  existing as a  corporation  in good standing
         under the laws of the State of  Delaware  and has  corporate  power and
         authority to own,  lease and operate its  properties and to conduct its
         business  as  described  in  the  Prospectuses  or  as  proposed  to be
         conducted  and to enter into and  perform  its  obligations  under this
         Agreement;  and the Company is duly qualified as a foreign  corporation
         to transact business and is in good

                                      -5-

 
<PAGE>

         standing in each other jurisdiction in which such qualification is
         required, whether by reason of the ownership or leasing of property or
         the conduct of business, except where the failure so to qualify or to
         be in good standing would not result in a Material Adverse Effect.

                  (vi) Good Standing of Subsidiaries. All of the subsidiaries of
         the Company  (each a  "Subsidiary")  have been duly  organized  and are
         validly  existing as a corporation  in good standing  under the laws of
         the  jurisdiction  of  its  incorporation,   has  corporate  power  and
         authority to own,  lease and operate its  properties and to conduct its
         business as described in the  Prospectuses  and is duly  qualified as a
         foreign  corporation  to transact  business and is in good  standing in
         each jurisdiction in which such  qualification is required,  whether by
         reason of the  ownership  or  leasing  of  property  or the  conduct of
         business,  except  where the  failure  so to  qualify  or to be in good
         standing  would not  result in a  Material  Adverse  Effect;  except as
         otherwise  disclosed in the Registration  Statement,  all of the issued
         and  outstanding  capital stock of each such  Subsidiary  has been duly
         authorized and validly issued, is fully paid and  non-assessable and is
         owned by the Company, directly or through subsidiaries,  free and clear
         of any security interest, mortgage, pledge, lien, encumbrance, claim or
         equity;  none  of  the  outstanding  shares  of  capital  stock  of any
         Subsidiary  was issued in violation of the preemptive or similar rights
         of any securityholder of such Subsidiary.  The only subsidiaries of the
         Company are the subsidiaries listed on Exhibit 21.1 to the Registration
         Statement.

                  (vii) Capitalization.  The authorized,  issued and outstanding
         capital stock of the Company is as set forth in the Prospectuses in the
         column entitled "Actual" under the caption "Capitalization" (except for
         subsequent issuances,  if any, pursuant to this Agreement,  pursuant to
         reservations,  agreements or employee  benefit plans referred to in the
         Prospectuses  or pursuant to the exercise of convertible  securities or
         options  referred  to in the  Prospectuses).  The  shares of issued and
         outstanding  capital stock of the Company have been duly authorized and
         validly  issued  and are  fully  paid and  non-assessable;  none of the
         outstanding  shares  of  capital  stock of the  Company  was  issued in
         violation  of  the   preemptive   or  other   similar   rights  of  any
         securityholder of the Company.

                  (viii)  Authorization  of  Agreement.  This  Agreement and the
         International  Purchase  Agreement have been duly authorized,  executed
         and delivered by the Company.

                  (ix)   Authorization   and  Description  of  Securities.   The
         Securities  have  been duly  authorized  for  issuance  and sale to the
         Underwriters   pursuant  to  this  Agreement  against  payment  of  the
         consideration set forth herein, will be validly issued,  fully paid and
         non-assessable;  the Common Stock conforms to all  statements  relating
         thereto  contained in the Prospectus and such  description  conforms to
         the rights set forth in the instruments defining the same; no holder of
         the Securities will be subject to personal liability by reason of being
         such a holder; and the issuance of the Securities is not subject to the
         preemptive  or  other  similar  rights  of  any  securityholder  of the
         Company.

                                      -6-
<PAGE>

                  (x) Absence of Defaults and Conflicts. Neither the Company nor
         any of its subsidiaries is in violation of its charter or by-laws or in
         default in the performance or observance of any obligation,  agreement,
         covenant or condition contained in any contract,  franchise  agreement,
         indenture,  mortgage,  deed of trust, loan or credit  agreement,  note,
         lease or other  agreement or  instrument to which the Company or any of
         its subsidiaries is a party or by which it or any of them may be bound,
         or to  which  any of the  property  or  assets  of the  Company  or any
         subsidiary  is subject  (collectively,  "Agreements  and  Instruments")
         except for such  defaults  that would not result in a Material  Adverse
         Effect;  and the execution,  delivery and performance of this Agreement
         and the  International  Purchase  Agreement and the consummation of the
         transactions  contemplated  in this  Agreement,  and the  International
         Purchase  Agreement and in the  Registration  Statement  (including the
         issuance and sale of the  Securities  and the use of the proceeds  from
         the sale of the Securities as described in the  Prospectuses  under the
         caption  "Use of  Proceeds",  the  reorganization  as  described in the
         Prospectuses  (the  "Reorganization"),  entering  into the Bank  Credit
         Agreement and  consummating  the  Acquisitions)  and  compliance by the
         Company with its obligations under this Agreement and the International
         Purchase Agreement have been duly authorized by all necessary corporate
         action and do not and will not,  whether  with or without the giving of
         notice or passage of time or both, conflict with or constitute a breach
         of, or default or Repayment  Event (as defined below) under,  or result
         in the creation or imposition of any lien,  charge or encumbrance  upon
         any  property or assets of the Company or any  subsidiary  pursuant to,
         the  Agreements  and  Instruments,  nor will such action  result in any
         violation of the provisions of the charter or by-laws of the Company or
         any  subsidiary  or any  applicable  law,  statute,  rule,  regulation,
         judgment,   order,  writ  or  decree  of  any  government,   government
         instrumentality or court, domestic or foreign, having jurisdiction over
         the Company or any  subsidiary  or any of their  assets,  properties or
         operations.  As used  herein,  a  "Repayment  Event" means any event or
         condition  which  gives  the  holder of any  note,  debenture  or other
         evidence of indebtedness (or any person acting on such holder's behalf)
         the right to require the repurchase,  redemption or repayment of all or
         a portion of such indebtedness by the Company or any subsidiary.

                  (xi)  Absence  of Labor  Dispute.  No labor  dispute  with the
         employees of the Company or any subsidiary  exists or, to the knowledge
         of the  Company,  is  imminent,  and the  Company  is not  aware of any
         existing or imminent  labor  disturbance by the employees of any of its
         or any subsidiary's  principal suppliers,  manufacturers,  customers or
         contractors,  which,  in any case, may reasonably be expected to result
         in a Material Adverse Effect.

                  (xii)  Absence  of  Proceedings.  There  is no  action,  suit,
         proceeding,  inquiry or investigation before or brought by any court or
         governmental agency or body, domestic or foreign,  now pending,  or, to
         the  knowledge of the  Company,  threatened,  against or affecting  the
         Company or any  subsidiary,  which is required to be  disclosed  in the
         Registration  Statement  (other than as  disclosed  therein),  or which
         might reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect, or
         which might  reasonably be expected to materially and adversely  affect
         the   properties  or  assets  thereof  or  the   consummation   of  the

                                      -7-
<PAGE>



         transactions  contemplated  in this  Agreement  and  the  International
         Purchase Agreement or the performance by the Company of its obligations
         hereunder  or  thereunder;  the  aggregate  of  all  pending  legal  or
         governmental  proceedings  to which the Company or any  subsidiary is a
         party or of which  any of their  respective  property  or assets is the
         subject  which  are  not  described  in  the  Registration   Statement,
         including ordinary routine litigation incidental to the business, could
         not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

                  (xiii)  Accuracy  of  Exhibits.  There  are  no  contracts  or
         documents  which  are  required  to be  described  in the  Registration
         Statement or the  Prospectuses or to be filed as exhibits thereto which
         have not been so described and filed as required.

                  (xiv) Possession of Intellectual Property. The Company and its
         subsidiaries  own or  possess,  or can  acquire  on  reasonable  terms,
         adequate  patents,  patent rights,  licenses,  inventions,  copyrights,
         know-how   (including  trade  secrets  and  other   unpatented   and/or
         unpatentable  proprietary  or  confidential  information,   systems  or
         procedures),   trademarks,   service   marks,   trade  names  or  other
         intellectual property (collectively, "Intellectual Property") necessary
         to carry on the business now operated by them,  and neither the Company
         nor any of its  subsidiaries  has  received  any notice or is otherwise
         aware of any infringement of or conflict with asserted rights of others
         with  respect  to  any  Intellectual   Property  or  of  any  facts  or
         circumstances  which would render any Intellectual  Property invalid or
         inadequate  to  protect  the  interest  of  the  Company  or any of its
         subsidiaries  therein,  and  which  infringement  or  conflict  (if the
         subject of any unfavorable  decision,  ruling or finding) or invalidity
         or inadequacy,  singly or in the aggregate,  would result in a Material
         Adverse Effect.


                          (xv) Absence of Further Requirements.  No filing with,
         or authorization,  approval,  consent,  license,  order,  registration,
         qualification  or decree of,  any court or  governmental  authority  or
         agency is necessary or required for the  performance  by the Company of
         its obligations hereunder, in connection with the offering, issuance or
         sale of the  Securities  under  this  Agreement  and the  International
         Purchase Agreement or the consummation of the transactions contemplated
         by this Agreement and the International Purchase Agreement,  except (i)
         such as have been already obtained or as may be required under the 1933
         Act or the 1933 Act Regulations and foreign or state securities or blue
         sky  laws  and  (ii)  such as have  been  obtained  under  the laws and
         regulations  of  jurisdictions  outside the United  States in which the
         Reserved Securities are offered.

                 (xvi)  Possession of Licenses and Permits.  The Company and its
         subsidiaries possess such permits,  licenses,  approvals,  consents and
         other authorizations (collectively,  "Governmental Licenses") issued by
         the appropriate federal, state, local or foreign regulatory agencies or
         bodies  necessary to conduct the  business  now  operated by them;  the
         Company  and its  subsidiaries  are in  compliance  with the  terms and
         conditions of all such Governmental Licenses,  except where the failure
         so to comply  would not,  singly or in the  aggregate,  have a Material
         Adverse Effect; all of the Governmental  Licenses are valid and in full
         force and  effect,  except  when the  invalidity  of such  Governmental

                                      -8-
<PAGE>


         Licenses  or the  failure of such  Governmental  Licenses to be in full
         force and effect would not have a Material Adverse Effect;  and neither
         the  Company nor any of its  subsidiaries  has  received  any notice of
         proceedings  relating to the  revocation  or  modification  of any such
         Governmental Licenses which, singly or in the aggregate, if the subject
         of an  unfavorable  decision,  ruling  or  finding,  would  result in a
         Material Adverse Effect.

                 (xvii) Title to Property. The Company and its subsidiaries have
         good and marketable title to all real property owned by the Company and
         its  subsidiaries and good title to all other properties owned by them,
         in each case, free and clear of all mortgages, pledges, liens, security
         interests, claims, restrictions or encumbrances of any kind except such
         as (a) are described in the  Prospectuses  or (b) do not,  singly or in
         the aggregate,  materially affect the value of such property and do not
         interfere with the use made and proposed to be made of such property by
         the  Company  or any of its  subsidiaries;  and all of the  leases  and
         subleases material to the business of the Company and its subsidiaries,
         considered as one enterprise, and under which the Company or any of its
         subsidiaries  holds properties  described in the  Prospectuses,  are in
         full force and effect,  and neither the Company nor any  subsidiary has
         any notice of any material  claim of any sort that has been asserted by
         anyone adverse to the rights of the Company or any subsidiary under any
         of the leases or subleases mentioned above, or affecting or questioning
         the  rights  of  the  Company  or  such  subsidiary  to  the  continued
         possession of the leased or subleased  premises under any such lease or
         sublease.

                  (xviii)  Investment Company Act.. The Company is not, and upon
         the issuance and sale of the Securities as herein  contemplated and the
         application  of  the  net  proceeds   therefrom  as  described  in  the
         Prospectuses  will  not  be,  an  "investment  company"  or  an  entity
         "controlled" by an "investment company as such terms are defined in the
         Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the "1940 Act").

                  (xix)   Environmental   Laws.   Except  as  described  in  the
         Registration  Statement  and  except  as would  not,  singly  or in the
         aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Effect, (A) neither the Company
         nor any of its  subsidiaries  is in violation  of any  federal,  state,
         local or foreign  statute,  law,  rule,  regulation,  ordinance,  code,
         policy  or  rule  of  common  law or  any  judicial  or  administrative
         interpretation thereof, including any judicial or administrative order,
         consent,  decree or judgment,  relating to pollution or  protection  of
         human health, the environment (including,  without limitation,  ambient
         air, surface water, groundwater,  land surface or subsurface strata) or
         wildlife,  including, without limitation, laws and regulations relating
         to  the  release  or  threatened  release  of  chemicals,   pollutants,
         contaminants, wastes, toxic substances, hazardous substances, petroleum
         or petroleum products  (collectively,  "Hazardous Materials") or to the
         manufacture,   processing,   distribution,   use,  treatment,  storage,
         disposal,  transport or handling of Hazardous Materials  (collectively,
         "Environmental  Laws"),  (B) the Company and its subsidiaries  have all
         permits,  authorizations  and approvals  required  under any applicable
         Environmental Laws and are each in compliance with their  requirements,
         (C) there are no pending or  threatened  administrative,  regulatory or
         judicial  actions,  suits,  demands,  demand  letters,  claims,  liens,
         notices of  noncompliance  or violation,  investigation  or


                                      -9-
<PAGE>

         proceedings relating to any Environmental Law against the Company or
         any of its subsidiaries and (D) there are no events or circumstances
         that might reasonably be expected to form the basis of an order for
         clean-up or remediation, or an action, suit or proceeding by any
         private party or governmental body or agency, against or affecting the
         Company or any of its subsidiaries relating to Hazardous Materials or
         any Environmental Laws.

                  (xx)   Registration   Rights.   There  are  no  persons   with
         registration  rights or other  similar  rights  to have any  securities
         registered   pursuant  to  the  Registration   Statement  or  otherwise
         registered by the Company under the 1933 Act.

                  (xxi)  Income  Taxes.  All United  States  federal  income tax
         returns of the Company and its subsidiaries required by law to be filed
         have  been  filed  (taking  into  account  extensions  granted  by  the
         applicable  federal  governmental  agency)  and all taxes shown by such
         returns or otherwise  assessed,  which are due and  payable,  have been
         paid,  except for such taxes,  if any, as are being  contested  in good
         faith and as to which adequate  reserves have been provided.  All other
         corporate  franchise  and income tax  returns  of the  Company  and its
         subsidiaries required to be filed pursuant to applicable foreign, state
         or local law have been  filed,  except  insofar as the  failure to file
         such  returns  would not  individually  or in the  aggregate  have in a
         material  adverse  effect on the condition  (financial  or  otherwise),
         earnings, business affairs or business prospects of the Company and its
         subsidiaries,  considered  together  as one  enterprise,  and all taxes
         shown on such returns or otherwise  assessed  which are due and payable
         have been paid,  except for such taxes,  if any, as are being contested
         in good faith and as to which adequate reserves have been provided. The
         charges,  accruals  and reserves on the books of the Company in respect
         of any income and  corporation  tax liability for any years not finally
         determined are adequate to meet any assessments or  re-assessments  for
         additional income tax for any years not finally  determined,  except to
         the extent of any  inadequacy  that  would not have a material  adverse
         effect on the condition  (financial or otherwise),  earnings,  business
         affairs or business  prospects  of the  Company  and its  subsidiaries,
         considered together as one enterprise.

                  (xxii)  Internal  Controls.  The Company and its  subsidiaries
         maintain  (and in the  future  will  maintain)  a  system  of  internal
         accounting  controls  sufficient to provide reasonable  assurances that
         (A) transactions are executed in accordance with  management's  general
         or specific  authorization;  (B) transactions are recorded as necessary
         to permit  preparation of financial  statements in conformity with GAAP
         and to  maintain  accountability  for  assets;  (C) access to assets is
         permitted  only in  accordance  with  management's  general or specific
         authorization;  and (D)  the  recorded  accountability  for  assets  is
         compared  with  the  existing   assets  at  reasonable   intervals  and
         appropriate action is taken with respect to any differences.

                  (xxiii)  Insurance.  The Company and its subsidiaries carry or
         are entitled to the benefits of insurance,  with financially  sound and
         reputable  insurers,  in such  amounts  and


                                      -10-

<PAGE>



         covering such risks as is generally maintained by companies of
         established repute engaged in the same or similar business, and all
         such insurance is in full force and effect.

                  (xxiv) Offering Material. The Company has not distributed and,
         prior to the later to occur of (i) the Closing Time and (ii) completion
         of the distribution of the Securities, will not distribute any offering
         material in  connection  with the offering  and sale of the  Securities
         other than the Registration  Statement,  any preliminary  prospectuses,
         the Prospectuses or other materials,  if any, permitted by the 1933 Act
         and approved by the Representative(s).

                  (xxv) Suppliers.  No supplier of merchandise to the Company or
         any of its  subsidiaries  has ceased  shipments of  merchandise  to the
         Company,  other  than in the  normal and  ordinary  course of  business
         consistent with past  practices,  which cessation would not result in a
         Material Adverse Effect.

                  (xxvi)  Related  Party  Transactions.  There  are no  business
         relationships or related party  transactions of the nature described in
         Item 404 of  Regulation  S-K involving the Company or any of businesses
         being  acquired  pursuant  to  the  Acquisitions  (as  defined  in  the
         Prospectuses)  and any person  described in such Item that are required
         to be disclosed in the  Registration  Statement and which have not been
         so disclosed.

                  (xxvii) Reorganization.  The representations and warranties of
         the   Company   contained   in  the   Reorganization   documents   (the
         "Reorganization  Agreements") as set forth in Exhibit C hereto are true
         and correct as of the date hereof and the Reorganization Agreements are
         enforceable against the Company.  All of the transactions  contemplated
         by such agreements  have been  consummated in accordance with the terms
         as described therein (and as described in the Prospectuses) and none of
         such  agreements  have been amended or modified since the date of their
         execution.

         (xxviii) Pending  Acquisitions.  Each of the agreements  (collectively,
         the  "Acquisition  Agreements")  governing  the  Acquisitions  that are
         contemplated  to occur on or  before  the  Closing  Date has been  duly
         authorized,  executed  and  delivered  by  each  of  the  parties,  and
         constitutes a legally  valid and binding  obligation of the Company and
         to the  Company's  knowledge  is  enforceable  against  each such party
         thereto  in  accordance  with its  terms;  except as  described  in the
         Prospectuses, each of the representations and warranties of the Company
         and its subsidiaries  and, to the best of the Company's  knowledge,  of
         each of the other parties set forth in the  Acquisition  Agreements was
         true and correct at the time such  representations  and warranties were
         made and will be true and correct at and as of the Closing Date and the
         Company has received manufacturers consents to all of the Acquisitions.

         (xxix) Franchise  Agreements.  Each franchise  agreement,  in each case
         between a Subsidiary and the applicable Manufacturer (as defined in the
         Prospectuses)  has  been  duly  authorized  by  the  Company  and  such
         Subsidiaries,  and, as of the  Closing  Date,  the  Company  shall have
         obtained  all  consents,   authorizations   and   approvals   from  the


                                      -11-
<PAGE>


         Manufacturers  required  to  conduct  the  Acquisitions  and the public
         offering of Common Stock as  contemplated  hereby except for Jaguar and
         Kia.

            (xxx)  Credit  Agreement.  The Company has all  necessary  corporate
         power and  authority  to execute,  deliver and perform its  obligations
         under the New Credit  Agreement,  between  the  Company  and Ford Motor
         Credit Company (the "New Credit  Agreement")  and the credit  agreement
         between the Company  and  NationsBank  N.A.  (the  "NationsBank  Credit
         Agreement");  the  New  Credit  Agreement  and the  NationsBank  Credit
         Agreement  have been duly  authorized,  executed  and  delivered by the
         Company, are in the forms heretofore delivered to you, constitute valid
         and binding obligations of the Company, enforceable against the Company
         in  accordance  with its terms;  and at the Closing  Date,  the Company
         shall be able to make borrowings thereunder.

         (b) Officer's  Certificates.  Any certificate  signed by any officer of
the Company or any of its subsidiaries delivered to the Global Coordinator,  the
U.S. Representatives,  or to counsel for the U.S. Underwriters shall be deemed a
representation  and warranty by the Company to each U.S.  Underwriter  as to the
matters covered thereby.

         SECTION 2.        Sale and Delivery to  Underwriters; Closing.

         (a)  Initial  Securities.  On  the  basis  of the  representations  and
warranties  herein contained and subject to the terms and conditions  herein set
forth,  the Company agrees to sell to each U.S.  Underwriter,  severally and not
jointly,  and each  U.S.  Underwriter,  severally  and not  jointly,  agrees  to
purchase  from the Company,  at the price per share set forth in Schedule B, the
number of Initial U.S.  Securities  set forth in Schedule A opposite the name of
such U.S.  Underwriter,  plus any additional  number of Initial U.S.  Securities
which such U.S.  Underwriter  may become  obligated to purchase  pursuant to the
provisions of Section 10 hereof.

         (b) Option Securities. In addition, on the basis of the representations
and warranties  herein contained and subject to the terms and conditions  herein
set  forth,  the  Company  hereby  grants an  option  to the U.S.  Underwriters,
severally  and not jointly,  to purchase up to an additional  600,000  shares of
Common  Stock at the price per share set forth in Schedule B, less an amount per
share  equal to any  dividends  or  distributions  declared  by the  Company and
payable on the  Initial  U.S.  Securities  but not  payable  on the U.S.  Option
Securities.  The option hereby granted will expire 30 days after the date hereof
and may be  exercised in whole or in part from time to time only for the purpose
of covering  over-allotments  which may be made in connection  with the offering
and  distribution  of the  Initial  U.S.  Securities  upon  notice by the Global
Coordinator to the Company setting forth the number of U.S. Option Securities as
to which the several U.S.  Underwriters  are then  exercising the option and the
time and date of payment and delivery for such U.S. Option Securities.  Any such
time and date of delivery for the Option Securities (a "Date of Delivery") shall
be determined by the Global Coordinator,  but shall not be later than seven full
business  days after the exercise of said option,  nor in any event prior to the
Closing Time, as  hereinafter  defined.  If the option is exercised as to all or
any portion of the U.S. Option Securities, each of the U.S. Underwriters, acting
severally and not jointly,  will purchase that proportion of the total number of
U.S.  Option  Securities  then being  purchased 

                                      -12-
<PAGE>


which the number of Initial U.S. Securities set forth in Schedule A opposite the
name of such U.S. Underwriter bears to the total number of Initial U.S.
Securities, subject in each case to such adjustments as the Global Coordinator
in their discretion shall make to eliminate any sales or purchases of fractional
shares.

         (c)  Payment  Payment  of the  purchase  price  for,  and  delivery  of
certificates for, the Initial  Securities shall be made at the offices of Fried,
Frank, Harris, Shriver & Jacobson, One New York Plaza, New York, NY 10004, or at
such  other  place as shall be agreed  upon by the  Global  Coordinator  and the
Company, at 9:00 A.M. (Eastern time) on the third (fourth, if the pricing occurs
after  4:30 P.M.  (Eastern  time) on any given day  business  day after the date
hereof  (unless  postponed in accordance  with the provisions of Section 10), or
such  other time not later  than ten  business  days after such date as shall be
agreed upon by the Global  Coordinator  and the  Company  (such time and date of
payment and delivery being herein called "Closing Time").

         In addition, in the event that any or all of the U.S. Option Securities
are purchased by the U.S.  Underwriters,  payment of the purchase price for, and
delivery of certificates  for, such U.S. Option  Securities shall be made at the
above-mentioned  offices,  or at such other place as shall be agreed upon by the
Global Coordinator and the Company, on each Date of Delivery as specified in the
notice from the Global Coordinator to the Company.

         Payment  shall be made to the Company by wire  transfer of  immediately
available funds to a bank account designated by the Company, against delivery to
the U.S. Representatives for the respective accounts of the U.S. Underwriters of
certificates  for the U.S.  Securities to be purchased by them. It is understood
that each U.S.  Underwriter  has  authorized the U.S.  Representatives,  for its
account,  to accept  delivery of,  receipt for, and make payment of the purchase
price for, the Initial U.S.  Securities and the U.S. Option Securities,  if any,
which  it has  agreed  to  purchase.  Merrill  Lynch,  individually  and  not as
representative  of the U.S.  Underwriters,  may (but shall not be obligated  to)
make payment of the purchase  price for the Initial U.S.  Securities or the U.S.
Option Securities,  if any, to be purchased by any U.S.  Underwriter whose funds
have not been received by the Closing Time or the relevant Date of Delivery,  as
the case may be, but such payment shall not relieve such U.S.
Underwriter from its obligations hereunder.

         (d)  Denominations;  Registration.  Certificates  for the Initial  U.S.
Securities  and  the  U.S.  Option   Securities,   if  any,  shall  be  in  such
denominations  and  registered  in such  names as the U.S.  Representatives  may
request in writing at least one full business day before the Closing Time or the
relevant Date of Delivery,  as the case may be. The certificates for the Initial
U.S.  Securities and the U.S. Option Securities,  if any, will be made available
for  examination  and packaging by the U.S.  Representatives  in The City of New
York not later than 10:00 A.M.  (Eastern  time) on the business day prior to the
Closing Time or the relevant Date of Delivery, as the case may be.

         (e)  Appointment  of  Qualified  Independent  Underwriter.  The Company
hereby  confirms its  engagement  of Merrill  Lynch as, and Merrill Lynch hereby
confirms  its  agreement  with the Company to render  services  as, a "qualified
independent underwriter" within the 

                                      -13-
<PAGE>


meaning of Rule 2720 of the Conduct Rules of the National Association of
Securities Dealers, Inc. with respect to the offering and sale of the U.S.
Securities. Merrill Lynch, solely in its capacity as qualified independent
underwriter and not otherwise, is referred to herein as the "Independent
Underwriter."

         SECTION 3.  Covenants of the Company.  The Company covenants with each
    U.S. Underwriter as follows:

                  (a)  Compliance  with  Securities  Regulations  and Commission
         Requests.  The Company,  subject to Section 3(b),  will comply with the
         requirements  of Rule 430A or Rule 434, as applicable,  and will notify
         the Global Coordinator immediately,  and confirm the notice in writing,
         (i) when any  post-effective  amendment to the  Registration  Statement
         shall become  effective,  or any supplement to the  Prospectuses or any
         amended  Prospectuses shall have been filed, (ii) of the receipt of any
         comments from the  Commission,  (iii) of any request by the  Commission
         for any  amendment to the  Registration  Statement or any  amendment or
         supplement to the Prospectuses or for additional information,  and (iv)
         of the  issuance by the  Commission  of any stop order  suspending  the
         effectiveness of the Registration  Statement or of any order preventing
         or  suspending  the  use  of  any  preliminary  prospectus,  or of  the
         suspension of the  qualification of the Securities for offering or sale
         in  any  jurisdiction,  or of  the  initiation  or  threatening  of any
         proceedings for any of such purposes.  The Company will promptly effect
         the filings necessary  pursuant to Rule 424(b) and will take such steps
         as it  deems  necessary  to  ascertain  promptly  whether  the  form of
         prospectus  transmitted  for filing  under Rule 424(b) was received for
         filing by the  Commission  and,  in the event that it was not,  it will
         promptly file such  prospectus.  The Company will make every reasonable
         effort to prevent the issuance of any stop order and, if any stop order
         is issued,  to obtain the  lifting  thereof  at the  earliest  possible
         moment.

                  (b) Filing of  Amendments.  The  Company  will give the Global
         Coordinator notice of its intention to file or prepare any amendment to
         the  Registration  Statement  (including any filing under Rule 462(b)),
         any Term Sheet or any  amendment,  supplement or revision to either the
         prospectus included in the Registration Statement at the time it became
         effective or to the Prospectuses,  will furnish the Global  Coordinator
         with copies of any such documents a reasonable  amount of time prior to
         such  proposed  filing or use, as the case may be, and will not file or
         use any such  document to which the Global  Coordinator  or counsel for
         the U.S. Underwriters shall object.

                  (c)  Delivery  of  Registration  Statements.  The  Company has
         furnished or will deliver to the U.S.  Representatives  and counsel for
         the  U.S.   Underwriters,   without   charge,   signed  copies  of  the
         Registration  Statement  as  originally  filed  and of  each  amendment
         thereto   (including   exhibits  filed  therewith  or  incorporated  by
         reference  therein) and signed copies of all consents and  certificates
         of experts, and will also deliver to the U.S. Representatives,  without
         charge,  a conformed copy of the  Registration  Statement as originally
         filed and of each amendment thereto (without  exhibits) for each of the
         U.S.  Underwriters.  The copies of the Registration  Statement and each
         amendment  thereto 


                                      -14-
<PAGE>


         furnished to the Underwriters will be identical to the electronically
         transmitted copies thereof filed with the Commission pursuant to EDGAR,
         except to the extent permitted by Regulation S-T.

                  (d)  Delivery of  Prospectuses.  The Company has  delivered to
         each  U.S.  Underwriter,   without  charge,  as  many  copies  of  each
         preliminary  prospectus as such U.S. Underwriter  reasonably requested,
         and the Company hereby  consents to the use of such copies for purposes
         permitted  by the 1933  Act.  The  Company  will  furnish  to each U.S.
         Underwriter, without charge, during the period when the U.S. Prospectus
         is  required  to be  delivered  under  the 1933  Act or the  Securities
         Exchange  Act of 1934 (the "1934  Act"),  such  number of copies of the
         U.S.  Prospectus (as amended or supplemented) as such U.S.  Underwriter
         may  reasonably  request.  The U.S.  Prospectus  and any  amendments or
         supplements  thereto  furnished  to  the  U.S.   Underwriters  will  be
         identical to the  electronically  transmitted copies thereof filed with
         the  Commission  pursuant to EDGAR,  except to the extent  permitted by
         Regulation S-T.

                  (e) Continued  Compliance  with  Securities  Laws. The Company
         will  comply  with the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act  Regulations  so as to
         permit  the  completion  of  the  distribution  of  the  Securities  as
         contemplated in this Agreement,  the International  Purchase  Agreement
         and in the  Prospectuses.  If at any time when a prospectus is required
         by the  1933  Act to be  delivered  in  connection  with  sales  of the
         Securities,  any event shall occur or condition shall exist as a result
         of  which it is  necessary,  in the  opinion  of  counsel  for the U.S.
         Underwriters or for the Company, to amend the Registration Statement or
         amend or supplement any Prospectus in order that the Prospectuses  will
         not include any untrue statements of a material fact or omit to state a
         material  fact  necessary in order to make the  statements  therein not
         misleading in the light of the circumstances existing at the time it is
         delivered to a purchaser,  or if it shall be necessary,  in the opinion
         of such counsel,  at any such time to amend the Registration  Statement
         or amend or  supplement  any  Prospectus  in order to  comply  with the
         requirements of the 1933 Act or the 1933 Act  Regulations,  the Company
         will promptly prepare and file with the Commission,  subject to Section
         3(b),  such amendment or supplement as may be necessary to correct such
         statement  or omission  or to make the  Registration  Statement  or the
         Prospectuses  comply  with  such  requirements,  and the  Company  will
         furnish  to the  U.S.  Underwriters  such  number  of  copies  of  such
         amendment or supplement as the U.S.
         Underwriters may reasonably request.

                  (f) Blue Sky  Qualifications.  The  Company  will use its best
         efforts,  in  cooperation  with the U.S.  Underwriters,  to qualify the
         Securities for offering and sale under the applicable  securities  laws
         of such states and other  jurisdictions  as the Global  Coordinator may
         designate and to maintain such qualifications in effect for a period of
         not less  than one year  from the  later of the  effective  date of the
         Registration  Statement  and any Rule  462(b)  Registration  Statement;
         provided,  however, that the Company shall not be obligated to file any
         general  consent  to  service  of  process  or to  qualify as a foreign
         corporation or as a dealer in securities in any  jurisdiction  in which
         it is not so qualified  or to subject  itself to taxation in respect of
         doing  business in any  jurisdiction  in which it is 


                                      -15-
<PAGE>


         not otherwise so subject. In each jurisdiction in which the Securities
         have been so qualified, the Company will file such statements and
         reports as may be required by the laws of such jurisdiction to continue
         such qualification in effect for a period of not less than one year
         from the effective date of the Registration Statement and any Rule
         462(b) Registration Statement.

                  (g) Rule 158.  The  Company  will  timely  file  such  reports
         pursuant to the 1934 Act as are  necessary  in order to make  generally
         available to its  securityholders  as soon as  practicable  an earnings
         statement for the purposes of, and to provide the benefits contemplated
         by, the last paragraph of Section 11(a) of the 1933 Act.

                  (h) Use of  Proceeds.  The Company  will use the net  proceeds
         received by it from the sale of the Securities in the manner  specified
         in the Prospectuses under "Use of Proceeds".

                  (i)  Listing.  The Company will use its best efforts to effect
         the listing of the Common Stock  (including the  Securities) on the New
         York Stock Exchange (the "NYSE").

                  (j) Restriction on Sale of Securities.  During a period of 180
         days from the date of the Prospectus, the Company will not, without the
         prior  written  consent  of the Global  Coordinator,  (i)  directly  or
         indirectly,  offer,  pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any option or
         contract to purchase,  purchase  any option or contract to sell,  grant
         any  option,  right or warrant to  purchase  or  otherwise  transfer or
         dispose of any share of Common Stock or any securities convertible into
         or   exercisable  or   exchangeable   for  Common  Stock  or  file  any
         registration  statement  under the 1933 Act with  respect to any of the
         foregoing  or (ii)  enter into any swap or any other  agreement  or any
         transaction  that  transfers,   in  whole  or  in  part,   directly  or
         indirectly,  the economic consequence of ownership of the Common Stock,
         whether any such swap or  transaction  described  in clause (i) or (ii)
         above is to be  settled  by  delivery  of  Common  Stock or such  other
         securities,  in cash or  otherwise.  The foregoing  sentence  shall not
         apply to the Securities to be sold hereunder or under the International
         Purchase Agreement;  provided that the Company may sell shares of Class
         A Common  Stock to a third  party as  consideration  for the  Company's
         acquisition  from such third party of a car  dealership,  provided that
         such third party executes a lock-up agreement on substantially the same
         terms  described above for a period expiring 180 days after the date of
         the Prospectuses.

                  (k)  Reporting  Requirements.  The Company,  during the period
         when the Prospectus are required to be delivered  under the 1933 Act or
         the 1934 Act,  will file all  documents  required  to be filed with the
         Commission pursuant to the 1934 Act within the time periods required by
         the  1934  Act  and  the  rules  and   regulations  of  the  Commission
         thereunder.

                  (l) Compliance with NASD Rules. The Company hereby agrees that
         it will ensure  that the  Reserved  Securities  will be  restricted  as
         required by the National  

                                      -16-
<PAGE>

         Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. (the "NASD") or the NASD rules
         from sale, transfer, assignment, pledge or hypothecation for a period
         of three months following the date of this Agreement. The Underwriters
         will notify the Company as to which persons will need to be so
         restricted. At the request of the Underwriters, the Company will direct
         the transfer agent to place a stop transfer restriction upon such
         securities for such period of time. Should the Company release, or seek
         to release, from such restrictions any of the Reserved Securities, the
         Company agrees to reimburse the Underwriters for any reasonable
         expenses (including, without limitation, legal expenses) they incur in
         connection with such release.

         SECTION 4. Payment of Expenses.  (a) Expenses. The Company will pay all
expenses  incident to the performance of its  obligations  under this Agreement,
including (i) the preparation, printing and filing of the Registration Statement
(including  financial  statements and exhibits) as originally  filed and of each
amendment  thereto,   (ii)  the  preparation,   printing  and  delivery  to  the
Underwriters of this Agreement,  any Agreement among Underwriters and such other
documents as may be required in connection  with the offering,  purchase,  sale,
issuance or delivery of the  Securities,  (iii) the  preparation,  issuance  and
delivery of the certificates for the Securities to the  Underwriters,  including
any stock or other transfer taxes and any stamp or other duties payable upon the
sale,  issuance  or  delivery  of the  Securities  to the  Underwriters  and the
transfer of  securities  between  the U.S.  Underwriters  and the  International
Managers, (iv) the fees and disbursements of the Company's counsel,  accountants
and other advisors,  (v) the  qualification  of the Securities  under securities
laws in accordance with the provisions of Section 3(f) hereof,  including filing
fees and the reasonable fees and  disbursements  of counsel for the Underwriters
in connection  therewith and in connection  with the preparation of the Blue Sky
Survey  and any  supplement  thereto,  (vi) the  printing  and  delivery  to the
Underwriters of copies of each  preliminary  prospectus,  any Term Sheets and of
the  Prospectuses  and  any  amendments  or  supplements   thereto,   (vii)  the
preparation, printing and delivery to the Underwriters of copies of the Blue Sky
Survey and any supplement thereto,  (viii) the fees and expenses of any transfer
agent or registrar for the  Securities and (ix) the filing fees incident to, and
the  reasonable  fees  and  disbursements  of  counsel  to the  Underwriters  in
connection with, the review by the National  Association of Securities  Dealers,
Inc.  (the "NASD") of the terms of the sale of the  Securities  and (x) the fees
and expenses  incurred in connection  with the listing of the  Securities on the
NYSE and all costs and  expenses  of the  Underwriters,  including  the fees and
disbursements  of counsel  for the  Underwriters,  in  connection  with  matters
related to the Reserved  Securities which are designated by the Company for sale
to employees  and others  having a business  relationship  with the Company.  In
addition, the Company will pay all expenses above $90,000 incurred in connection
with the  lodging,  meals and travel  costs  incurred by or on behalf of Company
officers and the Underwriters in connection with the road show  presentations to
prospective  purchasers of the Securities.  The Underwriters  will pay the first
$90,000 of such expenses.

         (b)  Termination  of Agreement.  If this Agreement is terminated by the
U.S.  Representatives  in accordance with the provisions of Section 5 or Section
9(a)(i)  hereof,  the Company shall reimburse the U.S.  Underwriters  for all of
their out-of-pocket expenses, including the reasonable fees and disbursements of
counsel for the U.S. Underwriters.

                                      -17-


<PAGE>


         SECTION 5. Conditions of U.S. Underwriters' Obligations. The
obligations of the several Underwriters hereunder are subject to the accuracy of
the representations and warranties of the Company contained in Section 1 hereof
or in certificates of any officer of the Company or any subsidiary of the
Company delivered pursuant to the provisions hereof, to the performance by the
Company of its covenants and other obligations hereunder, and to the following
further conditions:

                  (a) Effectiveness of Registration Statement. The Registration
         Statement, including any Rule 462(b) Registration Statement, has become
         effective and at Closing Time no stop order suspending the
         effectiveness of the Registration Statement shall have been issued
         under the 1933 Act or proceedings therefor initiated or threatened by
         the Commission, and any request on the part of the Commission for
         additional information shall have been complied with to the reasonable
         satisfaction of counsel to the U.S. Underwriters. A prospectus
         containing the Rule 430A Information shall have been filed with the
         Commission in accordance with Rule 424(b) (or a post-effective
         amendment providing such information shall have been filed and declared
         effective in accordance with the requirements of Rule 430A) or, if the
         Company has elected to rely upon Rule 434, a Term Sheet shall have been
         filed with the Commission in accordance with Rule 424(b).

                  (b) Opinion of Counsel for Company. At Closing Time, the U.S.
         Representatives shall have received the favorable opinion, dated as of
         Closing Time, of Parker, Poe, Adams & Bernstein LLP, counsel for the
         Company, in form and substance satisfactory to counsel for the U.S.
         Underwriters, together with signed or reproduced copies of such letter
         for each of the other U.S. Underwriters to the effect set forth in
         Exhibit A hereto and to such further effect as counsel to the U.S.
         Underwriters may reasonably request.

                  In addition, at Closing Time, the U.S. Representatives shall
         have received a signed copy of the opinions rendered by Parker, Poe,
         Adams & Bernstein LLP pursuant to the New Credit Agreement, the
         NationsBank Credit Agreement and the Acquisition Agreements,
         accompanied by a letter dated as of the date of such opinions stating
         that the Underwriters may rely on such opinions as if they were
         addressed to the Underwriters.

                  (c) Opinion of Counsel for U.S. Underwriters. At Closing Time,
         the U.S. Representatives shall have received the favorable opinion,
         dated as of Closing Time, of Fried, Frank, Harris, Shriver & Jacobson,
         counsel for the U.S. Underwriters, together with signed or reproduced
         copies of such letter for each of the other U.S. Underwriters with
         respect to the matters set forth in clauses (i), (ii), (v), (vi)
         (solely as to preemptive or other similar rights arising by operation
         of law or under the charter or by-laws of the Company), (viii) through
         (x), inclusive, (xii), (xiv) (solely as to the information in the
         Prospectus under "Description of Capital Stock--Common Stock") and the
         penultimate paragraph of Exhibit A hereto. In giving such opinion such
         counsel may rely, as to all matters governed by the laws of
         jurisdictions other than the law of the State of New York and the
         federal law of the United States and the General Corporation Law of the
         State of

                                      -18-

<PAGE>

         Delaware, upon the opinions of counsel satisfactory to the U.S.
         Representatives which may include counsel to the Company. Such counsel
         may also state that, insofar as such opinion involves factual matters,
         they have relied, to the extent they deem proper, upon certificates of
         officers of the Company and its subsidiaries and certificates of public
         officials.

                  (d) Officers' Certificate. At Closing Time, there shall not
         have been, since the date hereof or since the respective dates as of
         which information is given in the Prospectus, any material adverse
         change in the condition, financial or otherwise, or in the earnings,
         business affairs or business prospects of the Company and its
         subsidiaries considered as one enterprise, whether or not arising in
         the ordinary course of business, and the U.S. Representatives shall
         have received a certificate of the President of the Company and of the
         chief financial or chief accounting officer of the Company, dated as of
         Closing Time, to the effect that (i) there has been no such material
         adverse change, (ii) the representations and warranties in Section 1(a)
         hereof are true and correct with the same force and effect as though
         expressly made at and as of Closing Time, (iii) the Company has
         complied with all agreements and satisfied all conditions on its part
         to be performed or satisfied at or prior to Closing Time, and (iv) no
         stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement
         has been issued and no proceedings for that purpose have been
         instituted or are pending or are contemplated by the Commission.

                  (e) Accountant's Comfort Letter. At the time of the execution
         of this Agreement, the U.S. Representatives shall have received from
         Deloitte & Touche LLP a letter dated such date, in form and substance
         satisfactory to the U.S. Representatives, together with signed or
         reproduced copies of such letter for each of the other U.S.
         Underwriters containing statements and information of the type
         ordinarily included in accountants' "comfort letters" to underwriters
         with respect to the financial statements and certain financial
         information contained in the Registration Statement and the
         Prospectuses.

                  (f) Bring-down Comfort Letter. At Closing Time, the
         Representatives shall have received from Deloitte & Touche LLP a
         letter, dated as of Closing Time, to the effect that they reaffirm the
         statements made in the letter furnished pursuant to subsection (e) of
         this Section, except that the specified date referred to shall be a
         date not more than three business days prior to Closing Time.

                  (g) Approval of Listing. At Closing Time, the Securities shall
         have been approved for listing on the NYSE, subject only to official
         notice of issuance.

                  (h) No Objection. The NASD has confirmed that it has not
         raised any objection with respect to the fairness and reasonableness of
         the underwriting terms and arrangements.

                                      -19-

<PAGE>

                  (i) Lock-up Agreements. At the date of this Agreement, the
         U.S. Representatives shall have received an agreement substantially in
         the form of Exhibit B hereto signed by the persons listed on Schedule C
         hereto.

                  (j) Acquisition Agreements. The acquisitions contemplated by
         the Acquisition Agreements shall have been consummated in accordance
         with the terms described therein and there have been no amendments or
         modifications to the Acquisition Agreements since the date of their
         execution without the consent of the U.S. Representatives and no
         conditions to the Acquisitions shall have been waived without the
         consent of the U.S. Representatives.


                  (k) Reorganization. The Reorganization (as described in the
         Prospectuses) shall have been consummated in accordance with the terms
         as described therein and in the Reorganization Documents and there have
         been no amendments or modifications to the Reorganization Documents
         since the date of their execution.

                  (l) Manufacturers' Consents. The U.S. Representatives shall
         have received on or as of the Closing Date, as the case may be, a
         certificate, in a form and substance satisfactory to the U.S.
         Representative, of two executive officers of the Company certifying
         that each of the Company and its subsidiaries owns, possesses or has
         obtained all required consents and approvals from all Manufacturers
         with respect to the Acquisitions and the public offering of Common
         Stock hereunder and such consents and approvals shall be in a form
         satisfactory to the U.S. Representatives other than Jaguar and Kia.

                  (m) Credit Agreement. The New Credit Agreement and the
         NationsBank Credit Agreement shall have been entered into at or prior
         to Closing Time. The Company has obtained or assumed floor plan
         financing for each of the dealerships acquired in the Acquisitions in
         form and substance satisfactory to the U.S. Representatives and in
         accordance with the pro forma presentation in the Prospectuses.

                  (n) Subscription Agreements. The subscription agreements and
         related promissory notes relating to the sale of a 20% interest in the
         Company's Dyer Volvo and Volvo of Chattanooga dealerships to Richard
         Dyer and Nelson Bowers, respectively, are substantially in the form
         provided and there have been no amendments or modifications to such
         agreements and related notes since the date of their execution.

                  (o) Purchase of Initial International Securities.
         Contemporaneously with the purchase by the U.S. Underwriters of the
         Initial U.S. Securities under this Agreement, the International
         Managers shall have purchased the Initial International Securities
         under the International Purchase Agreement.

                  (p) Additional Documents. At Closing Time and at each Date of
         Delivery, counsel for the Underwriters shall have been furnished with
         such documents and opinions as they may require for the purpose of
         enabling them to pass upon the issuance and sale of the Securities as
         herein contemplated, or in order to evidence the accuracy of any of

                                      -20-

<PAGE>

         the representations or warranties, or the fulfillment of any of the
         conditions, herein contained; and all proceedings taken by the Company
         in connection with the issuance and sale of the Securities as herein
         contemplated shall be satisfactory in form and substance to the U.S.
         Representatives and counsel for the U.S. Underwriters.

                  (q) Conditions to Purchase of U.S. Option Securities. In the
         event that the U.S. Underwriters exercise their option provided in
         Section 2(b) hereof to purchase all or any portion of the U.S. Option
         Securities, the representations and warranties of the Company contained
         herein and the statements in any certificates furnished by the Company
         or any subsidiary of the Company hereunder shall be true and correct as
         of each Date of Delivery and, at the relevant Date of Delivery, the
         U.S. Representatives shall have received:

                  (i)      Officers' Certificate. A certificate, dated such Date
                           of Delivery,  of the President or a Vice President of
                           the  Company  and of the  chief  financial  or  chief
                           accounting officer of the Company confirming that the
                           certificate delivered at the Closing Time pursuant to
                           Section  5(d) hereof  remains  true and correct as of
                           such Date of Delivery.

                  (ii)     Opinion of Counsel for Company. The favorable opinion
                           of Parker,  Poe, Adams & Bernstein  LLP,  counsel for
                           the Company,  in form and substance  satisfactory  to
                           counsel  for the  Underwriters,  dated  such  Date of
                           Delivery,  relating  to the Option  Securities  to be
                           purchased on such Date of Delivery  and  otherwise to
                           the same  effect as the  opinion  required by Section
                           5(b) hereof.

                  (iii)    Opinion  of  Counsel  for  U.S.   Underwriters.   The
                           favorable opinion of Fried, Frank, Harris,  Shriver &
                           Jacobson,  counsel for the U.S.  Underwriters,  dated
                           such Date of  Delivery,  relating to the U.S.  Option
                           Securities  to be  purchased on such Date of Delivery
                           and  otherwise  to the  same  effect  as the  opinion
                           required by Section 5(c) hereof.

                  (iv)     Bring-down  Comfort Letter.  A letter from Deloitte &
                           Touche LLP, in form and substance satisfactory to the
                           U.S. Representatives and dated such Date of Delivery,
                           substantially  in the same form and  substance as the
                           letter furnished to the U.S. Representatives pursuant
                           to Section  5(f) hereof,  except that the  "specified
                           date"  in  the  letter  furnished  pursuant  to  this
                           paragraph  shall be a date not more  than  five  days
                           prior to such Date of Delivery.

                  (r) Termination of Agreement. If any condition specified in
         this Section shall not have been fulfilled when and as required to be
         fulfilled, this Agreement, or, in the case of any condition to the
         purchase of U.S. Option Securities on a Date of Delivery which is after
         the Closing Time, the obligations of the several U.S. Underwriters to
         purchase the relevant Option Securities, may be terminated by the U.S.
         Representatives

                                      -21-

<PAGE>

         by notice to the Company at any time at or prior to Closing Time or
         such Date of Delivery, as the case may be, and such termination shall
         be without liability of any party to any other party except as provided
         in Section 4 and except that Sections 1, 6, 7 and 8 shall survive any
         such termination and remain in full force and effect.

         SECTION 6.        Indemnification.

         (a) Indemnification of U.S. Underwriters. The Company agrees to
indemnify and hold harmless each U.S. Underwriter and each person, if any, who
controls any U.S. Underwriter within the meaning of Section 15 of the 1933 Act
or Section 20 of the 1934 Act as follows:

                  (i) against any and all loss, liability, claim, damage and
         expense whatsoever, as incurred, arising out of any untrue statement or
         alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in the
         Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto), including the Rule
         430A Information and the Rule 434 Information, if applicable, or the
         omission or alleged omission therefrom of a material fact required to
         be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not
         misleading or arising out of any untrue statement or alleged untrue
         statement of a material fact included in any preliminary prospectus or
         the Prospectuses (or any amendment or supplement thereto), or the
         omission or alleged omission therefrom of a material fact necessary in
         order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances
         under which they were made, not misleading;

                  (ii) against any and all loss, liability, claim, damage and
         expense whatsoever, as incurred, to the extent of the aggregate amount
         paid in settlement of any litigation, or any investigation or
         proceeding by any governmental agency or body, commenced or threatened,
         or of any claim whatsoever based upon any such untrue statement or
         omission provided that (subject to Section 6(d) below) any such
         settlement is effected with the written consent of the Company; and

                  (iii) against any and all expense whatsoever, as incurred
         (including the fees and disbursements of counsel chosen by Merrill
         Lynch), reasonably incurred in investigating, preparing or defending
         against any litigation, or any investigation or proceeding by any
         governmental agency or body, commenced or threatened, or any claim
         whatsoever based upon any such untrue statement or omission or any such
         alleged untrue statement or omission, to the extent that any such
         expense is not paid under (i) or (ii) above;

provided,  however,  that this indemnity  agreement shall not apply to any loss,
liability,  claim,  damage or expense to the  extent  arising  out of any untrue
statement or omission or alleged  untrue  statement or omission made in reliance
upon and in conformity with written information  furnished to the Company by any
U.S.  Underwriter  through  the U.S.  Representatives  expressly  for use in the
Registration  Statement  (or any  amendment  thereto),  including  the Rule 430A
Information  and the Rule 434  Information,  if applicable,  or any  preliminary
prospectus or the U.S. Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto).

                                      -22-

<PAGE>

         (b) Indemnification of Company, Directors and Officers. Each U.S.
Underwriter severally agrees to indemnify and hold harmless the Company, its
directors, each of its officers who signed the Registration Statement, and each
person, if any, who controls the Company within the meaning of Section 15 of the
1933 Act or Section 20 of the 1934 Act against any and all loss, liability,
claim, damage and expense described in the indemnity contained in subsection (a)
of this Section, as incurred, but only with respect to untrue statements or
omissions, or alleged untrue statements or omissions, made in the Registration
Statement (or any amendment thereto), including the Rule 430A Information and
the Rule 434 Information, if applicable, or any preliminary U.S. prospectus or
the U.S. Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto) in reliance upon
and in conformity with written information furnished to the Company by such U.S.
Underwriter through the U.S. Representatives expressly for use in the
Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto) or such preliminary prospectus
or the U.S. Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto).

         (c) Actions against Parties; Notification. Each indemnified party shall
give notice as promptly as reasonably practicable to each indemnifying party of
any action commenced against it in respect of which indemnity may be sought
hereunder, but failure to so notify an indemnifying party shall not relieve such
indemnifying party from any liability hereunder to the extent it is not
materially prejudiced as a result thereof and in any event shall not relieve it
from any liability which it may have otherwise than on account of this indemnity
agreement. In the case of parties indemnified pursuant to Section 6(a) above,
counsel to the indemnified parties shall be selected by Merrill Lynch, and, in
the case of parties indemnified pursuant to Section 6(b) above, counsel to the
indemnified parties shall be selected by the Company. An indemnifying party may
participate at its own expense in the defense of any such action; provided,
however, that counsel to the indemnifying party shall not (except with the
consent of the indemnified party) also be counsel to the indemnified party. In
no event shall the indemnifying parties be liable for fees and expenses of more
than one counsel (in addition to any local counsel) separate from their own
counsel for all indemnified parties in connection with any one action or
separate but similar or related actions in the same jurisdiction arising out of
the same general allegations or circumstances. No indemnifying party shall,
without the prior written consent of the indemnified parties, settle or
compromise or consent to the entry of any judgment with respect to any
litigation, or any investigation or proceeding by any governmental agency or
body, commenced or threatened, or any claim whatsoever in respect of which
indemnification or contribution could be sought under this Section 6 or Section
7 hereof (whether or not the indemnified parties are actual or potential parties
thereto), unless such settlement, compromise or consent (i) includes an
unconditional release of each indemnified party from all liability arising out
of such litigation, investigation, proceeding or claim and (ii) does not include
a statement as to or an admission of fault, culpability or a failure to act by
or on behalf of any indemnified party.

         (d) Settlement without Consent if Failure to Reimburse. If at any time
an indemnified party shall have requested an indemnifying party to reimburse the
indemnified party for fees and expenses of counsel, such indemnifying party
agrees that it shall be liable for any settlement of the nature contemplated by
Section 6(a) (ii) or (iii) effected without its written consent if (i) such
settlement is entered into more than 45 days after receipt by such indemnifying
party of the

                                      -23-

<PAGE>

aforesaid request, (ii) such indemnifying party shall have received notice of
the terms of such settlement at least 30 days prior to such settlement being
entered into and (iii) such  indemnifying  party shall not have reimbursed such
indemnified party in accordance with such request prior to the date of such
settlement.

         (e) Indemnification for Reserved Securities. In connection with the
offer and sale of the Reserved Securities, the Company agrees, promptly upon a
request, in writing to indemnify and hold harmless the Underwriters from and
against any and all losses, liabilities, claims, damages and expenses incurred
by them as a result of the failure of eligible directors, officers, employees,
business associates and related persons of the Company to pay for and accept
delivery of Reserved Securities which, by the end of the first business day
following the date of this Agreement, were subject to a properly confirmed
agreement to purchase.

         SECTION 7. Contribution. If the indemnification provided for in Section
6 hereof is for any reason unavailable to or insufficient to hold harmless an
indemnified party in respect of any losses, liabilities, claims, damages or
expenses referred to therein, then each indemnifying party shall contribute to
the aggregate amount of such losses, liabilities, claims, damages and expenses
incurred by such indemnified party, as incurred, (i) in such proportion as is
appropriate to reflect the relative benefits received by the Company on the one
hand and the U.S. Underwriters on the other hand from the offering of the
Securities pursuant to this Agreement or (ii) if the allocation provided by
clause (i) is not permitted by applicable law, in such proportion as is
appropriate to reflect not only the relative benefits referred to in clause (i)
above but also the relative fault of the Company on the one hand and of the
Underwriters on the other hand in connection with the statements or omissions
which resulted in such losses, liabilities, claims, damages or expenses, as well
as any other relevant equitable considerations.

         The relative benefits received by the Company on the one hand and the
U.S. Underwriters on the other hand in connection with the offering of the U.S.
Securities pursuant to this Agreement shall be deemed to be in the same
respective proportions as the total net proceeds from the offering of the U.S.
Securities pursuant to this Agreement (before deducting expenses) received by
the Company and the total underwriting discount received by the U.S.
Underwriters, in each case as set forth on the cover of the U.S. Prospectus, or,
if Rule 434 is used, the corresponding location on the Term Sheet, bear to the
aggregate initial public offering price of the U.S. Securities as set forth on
such cover.

         The relative fault of the Company on the one hand and the U.S.
Underwriters on the other hand shall be determined by reference to, among other
things, whether any such untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact
or omission or alleged omission to state a material fact relates to information
supplied by the Company or by the U.S. Underwriters and the parties' relative
intent, knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent
such statement or omission.

         The Company and the U.S. Underwriters agree that it would not be just
and equitable if contribution pursuant to this Section 7 were determined by pro
rata allocation (even if the U.S. Underwriters were treated as one entity for
such purpose) or by any other method of allocation

                                      -24-

<PAGE>

which does not take account of the equitable considerations referred to above in
this Section 7. The aggregate amount of losses, liabilities, claims, damages and
expenses incurred by an indemnified party and referred to above in this Section
7 shall be deemed to include any legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by
such indemnified party in investigating, preparing or defending against any
litigation, or any investigation or proceeding by any governmental agency or
body, commenced or threatened, or any claim whatsoever based upon any such
untrue or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission.

         Notwithstanding the provisions of this Section 7, no U.S. Underwriter
shall be required to contribute any amount in excess of the amount by which the
total price at which the U.S. Securities underwritten by it and distributed to
the public were offered to the public exceeds the amount of any damages which
such U.S. Underwriter has otherwise been required to pay by reason of any such
untrue or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission.

         No person guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the meaning of
Section 11(f) of the 1933 Act) shall be entitled to contribution from any person
who was not guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation.

         For purposes of this Section 7, each person, if any, who controls a
U.S. Underwriter within the meaning of Section 15 of the 1933 Act or Section 20
of the 1934 Act shall have the same rights to contribution as such U.S.
Underwriter, and each director of the Company, each officer of the Company who
signed the Registration Statement, and each person, if any, who controls the
Company within the meaning of Section 15 of the 1933 Act or Section 20 of the
1934 Act shall have the same rights to contribution as the Company. The U.S.
Underwriters' respective obligations to contribute pursuant to this Section 7
are several in proportion to the number of Initial U.S. Securities set forth
opposite their respective names in Schedule A hereto and not joint.

         SECTION 8. Representations, Warranties and Agreements to Survive
Delivery. All representations, warranties and agreements contained in this
Agreement or in certificates of officers of the Company or any of its
subsidiaries submitted pursuant hereto, shall remain operative and in full force
and effect, regardless of any investigation made by or on behalf of any U.S.
Underwriter or controlling person, or by or on behalf of the Company, and shall
survive delivery of the Securities to the U.S. Underwriters.

         SECTION 9. Termination of Agreement.

         (a) Termination; General. The U.S. Representatives may terminate this
Agreement, by notice to the Company, at any time at or prior to Closing Time (i)
if there has been, since the time of execution of this Agreement or since the
respective dates as of which information is given in the Prospectus, any
material adverse change in the condition, financial or otherwise, or in the
earnings, business affairs or business prospects of the Company and its
subsidiaries considered as one enterprise, whether or not arising in the
ordinary course of business, or (ii) if there has occurred any material adverse
change in the financial markets in the United States or the international
financial markets, any outbreak of hostilities or escalation thereof or other

                                      -25-

<PAGE>

calamity or crisis or any change or development involving a prospective change
in national or international political, financial or economic conditions, in
each case the effect of which is such as to make it, in the judgment of the U.S.
Representatives, impracticable to market the Securities or to enforce contracts
for the sale of the Securities, or (iii) if trading in any securities of the
Company has been suspended or materially limited by the Commission, or the NYSE,
if trading generally on the American Stock Exchange or the NYSE or in the Nasdaq
National Market has been suspended or materially limited, or minimum or maximum
prices for trading have been fixed, or maximum ranges for prices have been
required, by any of said exchanges or by such system or by order of the
Commission, the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. or any other
governmental authority, or (iv) if a banking moratorium has been declared by
either Federal or New York authorities.

         (b) Liabilities. If this Agreement is terminated pursuant to this
Section, such termination shall be without liability of any party to any other
party except as provided in Section 4 hereof, and provided further that Sections
1, 6, 7 and 8 shall survive such termination and remain in full force and
effect.

         SECTION 10. Default by One or More of the U.S. Underwriters. If one or
more of the U.S. Underwriters shall fail at Closing Time or a Date of Delivery
to purchase the Securities which it or they are obligated to purchase under this
Agreement (the "Defaulted Securities"), the U.S. Representatives shall have the
right, within 24 hours thereafter, to make arrangements for one or more of the
non-defaulting U.S. Underwriters, or any other underwriters, to purchase all,
but not less than all, of the Defaulted Securities in such amounts as may be
agreed upon and upon the terms herein set forth; if, however, the U.S.
Representatives shall not have completed such arrangements within such 24-hour
period, then:

                  (a) if the number of Defaulted  Securities does not exceed 10%
         of the number of U.S.  Securities to be purchased on such date, each of
         the non-defaulting U.S. Underwriters shall be obligated,  severally and
         not  jointly,  to purchase the full amount  thereof in the  proportions
         that their respective  underwriting  obligations  hereunder bear to the
         underwriting obligations of all non-defaulting U.S. Underwriters, or

                  (b) if the number of Defaulted  Securities  exceeds 10% of the
         number of U.S.  Securities to be purchased on such date, this Agreement
         or, with respect to any Date of Delivery which occurs after the Closing
         Time, the obligation of the Underwriters to purchase and of the Company
         to sell the Option  Securities to be purchased and sold on such Date of
         Delivery  shall  terminate   without  liability  on  the  part  of  any
         non-defaulting U.S. Underwriter.

         No action taken pursuant to this Section shall relieve any defaulting
U.S. Underwriter from liability in respect of its default.

         In the event of any such default which does not result in a termination
of this Agreement or, in the case of a Date of Delivery which is after the
Closing Time, which does not result in a termination of the obligation of the
U.S. Underwriters to purchase and the Company to sell the

                                      -26-

<PAGE>

relevant U.S. Option Securities, as the case may be, either the U.S.
Representatives or the Company shall have the right to postpone Closing Time or
the relevant Date of Delivery, as the case may be, for a period not exceeding
seven days in order to effect any required changes in the Registration Statement
or Prospectus or in any other documents or arrangements. As used herein, the
term " U.S. Underwriter" includes any person substituted for a U.S. Underwriter
under this Section 10.

         SECTION 11. Notices. All notices and other communications hereunder
shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given if mailed or
transmitted by any standard form of telecommunication. Notices to the U.S.
Underwriters shall be directed to the U.S. Representatives at North Tower, World
Financial Center, New York, New York 10281-1201, attention of Joel Van Dusen;
with a copy to Stuart Gelfond, Esq., Fried, Frank, Harris, Shriver & Jacobson,
One New York Plaza, New York, New York 10004; and notices to the Company shall
be directed to it at Sonic Automotive, Inc., 5401 East Independence Boulevard,
P.O. Box 18747, Charlotte, North Carolina 28218, attention of Theodore Wright;
with a copy to Gary C. Ivey, Esq., Parker, Poe, Adams & Bernstein L.L.P, 2500
Charlotte Plaza, Charlotte, North Carolina 28244.

         SECTION 12. Parties. This Agreement shall each inure to the benefit of
and be binding upon the U.S. Underwriters and the Company and their respective
successors. Nothing expressed or mentioned in this Agreement is intended or
shall be construed to give any person, firm or corporation, other than the U.S.
Underwriters and the Company and their respective successors and the controlling
persons and officers and directors referred to in Sections 6 and 7 and their
heirs and legal representatives, any legal or equitable right, remedy or claim
under or in respect of this Agreement or any provision herein contained. This
Agreement and all conditions and provisions hereof are intended to be for the
sole and exclusive benefit of the U.S. Underwriters and the Company and their
respective successors, and said controlling persons and officers and directors
and their heirs and legal representatives, and for the benefit of no other
person, firm or corporation. No purchaser of Securities from any U.S.
Underwriter shall be deemed to be a successor by reason merely of such purchase.

         SECTION 13. GOVERNING LAW AND TIME. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY
AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK. SPECIFIED
TIMES OF DAY REFER TO NEW YORK CITY TIME.

         SECTION 14. Effect of Headings. The Article and Section headings herein
and the Table of Contents are for convenience only and shall not affect the
construction hereof.


                                      -27-



<PAGE>


         If the foregoing is in accordance with your understanding of our
agreement, please sign and return to the Company a counterpart hereof, whereupon
this instrument, along with all counterparts, will become a binding agreement
between the U.S. Underwriters and the Company in accordance with its terms.
   
                                          Very truly yours,

                                          SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC



                                          By
                                               Title:

 CONFIRMED AND ACCEPTED,
as of the date first above written:


MERRILL LYNCH & CO.
MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH
             INCORPORATED
NATIONSBANC MONTGOMERY SECURITIES, INC.
WHEAT, FIRST SECURITIES, INC.

By: MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH
             INCORPORATED


By
                       Authorized Signatory


For themselves and as U.S. Representatives of the other U.S. Underwriters named
in Schedule A hereto

                                      -28-

<PAGE>


                                   SCHEDULE A

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           Number of
                                                                         Initial U.S.
        Name of U.S. Underwriter                                          Securities
<S>                                                                      <C>
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
            Incorporated...........................................
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.............................
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.

Total..............................................................
                                                                           4,000,000
</TABLE>

                                      -1-

<PAGE>
                                   SCHEDULE B

                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.

                    4,000,000 Shares of Class A Common Stock

                           (Par Value $0.01 Per Share)

                  1. The initial  public  offering  price per share for the U.S.
         Securities, determined as provided in said Section 2, shall be $ [ ].

                  2. The purchase price per share for the U.S.  Securities to be
         paid by the several U.S.  Underwriters  shall be $ [ ], being an amount
         equal to the initial  public  offering price set forth above less $ [ ]
         per  share;  provided  that the  purchase  price per share for any U.S.
         Option  Securities  purchased  upon the exercise of the  over-allotment
         option  described  in  Section  2(b)  shall be reduced by an amount per
         share equal to any dividends or  distributions  declared by the Company
         and payable on the Initial U.S.  Securities but not payable on the U.S.
         Option Securities.

                                      -1-

<PAGE>

                                   SCHEDULE C


O. Bruton Smith

B. Scott Smith

William R. Brooks

Sonic Financial Corporation

Nelson E. Bowers, II

Theodore M. Wright

Jeffrey C. Rachor

O. Ken Marks, Jr.

Ivan A. Tufty

William M. Sullivan

William S. Egan

Richard S. Dyer

                                      -1-

<PAGE>

                                                                       Exhibit A


                                October [ ], 1997

MERRILL LYNCH & CO.
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
         Incorporated
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.
  as U.S. Representatives of the several
  U.S. Underwriters

Merrill Lynch International
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.
  as Lead Managers of the several
  Managers

c/o  Merrill Lynch & Co.
     Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                 Incorporated
North Tower
World Financial Center
New York, New York  10281-1209

Ladies and Gentlemen:


         We have  acted as  counsel  for  Sonic  Automotive,  Inc.,  a  Delaware
corporation (the "Company") in connection with the underwritten  public offering
of up to 5,750,000 shares (the "Shares") of Class A Common Stock, par value $.01
per share (the "Common Stock"),  of the Company, of which 750,000 shares will be
sold pursuant to the exercise of an over-allotment option. This opinion is being
delivered  to you pursuant to (i) Section  5(b) of the U.S.  Purchase  Agreement
between the U.S. Underwriters named in Schedule A thereto and the Company (the "
U.S. Purchase  Agreement") and (ii) Section 5(b) of the  International  Purchase
Agreement between the International Managers named in Schedule A thereto and the
Company (the  "International  Purchase  Agreement " and  together  with the U.S.
Purchase  Agreement,  the "Purchase  Agreements").  All  capitalized  terms used
herein that are defined in, or by reference in, the Purchase  Agreement have the
meanings  assigned  to  such  terms  therein  or by  reference  therein,  unless
otherwise defined herein.

                                      -1-

<PAGE>

         In  connection  with  this  opinion,  we  have  (i)  investigated  such
questions  of  law,   (ii)  examined   originals  or  certified,   conformed  or
reproduction  copies of such agreements,  instruments,  documents and records of
the Company, such certificates of public officials and such other documents, and
(iii) received such information from officers and representatives of the Company
as we have deemed necessary or appropriate for the purposes of this opinion.

                  In all such examinations, we have assumed the legal capacity
of all natural persons executing Documents, the genuineness of all signatures,
the authenticity of original and certified documents and the conformity to
original or certified documents of all copies submitted to us as conformed or
reproduction copies.

                  To the extent it may be relevant to the opinions expressed
herein, we have assumed that the parties to the Documents other than the Company
have the power and authority to enter into and perform such documents and to
consummate the transactions contemplated thereby, that the Documents have been
duly authorized, executed and delivered by, and constitute legal, valid and
binding obligations of such parties enforceable against such parties in
accordance with their terms, and that such parties will comply with all of their
obligations under the Documents and all laws applicable thereto.

Based upon the foregoing,  and subject to the  limitations,  qualifications  and
assumptions set forth herein, we are of the opinion that:

                  (i) The  Company  has been duly  incorporated  and is  validly
         existing as a corporation  in good standing under the laws of the State
         of Delaware.

                  (ii) The Company has  corporate  power and  authority  to own,
         lease and  operate  its  properties  and to  conduct  its  business  as
         described in the Prospectus or as proposed to be conducted and to enter
         into and perform its obligations under the Purchase Agreement.

                  (iii) The Company is duly  qualified as a foreign  corporation
         to transact business and is in good standing in each state set forth on
         Schedule A to the opinion.

                  (iv) The authorized,  issued and outstanding  capital stock of
         the Company is as set forth in the  Prospectuses in the column entitled
         "Actual"  under the caption  "Capitalization"  (except  for  subsequent
         issuances,  if any, pursuant to the Purchase  Agreements or pursuant to
         reservations,  agreements or employee  benefit plans referred to in the
         Prospectus  or options  referred to in the  Prospectus);  the shares of
         issued and  outstanding  capital  stock have been duly  authorized  and
         validly issued and are fully paid and  non-assessable;  and none of the
         outstanding  shares  of  capital  stock of the  Company  was  issued in
         violation  of  the   preemptive   or  other   similar   rights  of  any
         securityholder of the Company.

                                      -2-

<PAGE>

                  (v) The  Securities to be purchased by the  Underwriters  from
         the Company  have been duly  authorized  for  issuance  and sale to the
         Underwriters pursuant to the Purchase Agreements,  and, when issued and
         delivered by the Company  pursuant to the Purchase  Agreements  against
         payment of the consideration set forth in the Purchase Agreements, will
         be validly  issued and fully paid and  non-assessable  and no holder of
         the Securities is or will be subject to personal liability by reason of
         being such a holder.

                  (vi) The  issuance  of the  Securities  is not  subject to the
         preemptive  or  other  similar  rights  of  any  securityholder  of the
         Company.

                  (vii)  Each  Subsidiary  has  been  duly  incorporated  and is
         validly  existing as a corporation  in good standing  under the laws of
         the  jurisdiction  of  its  incorporation,   has  corporate  power  and
         authority to own,  lease and operate its  properties and to conduct its
         business as described in the  Prospectuses  and is duly  qualified as a
         foreign  corporation  to transact  business and is in good  standing in
         each jurisdiction in which such  qualification is required,  whether by
         reason of the  ownership  or  leasing  of  property  or the  conduct of
         business,  except  where the  failure  so to  qualify  or to be in good
         standing  would not  result in a  Material  Adverse  Effect;  except as
         otherwise  disclosed in the Registration  Statement,  all of the issued
         and  outstanding  capital  stock  of  each  Subsidiary  has  been  duly
         authorized and validly issued, is fully paid and non-assessable and, to
         the best of our knowledge, is owned by the Company, directly or through
         subsidiaries,  and except as  described in the  Prospectuses,  free and
         clear of any security interest,  mortgage,  pledge, lien,  encumbrance,
         claim or equity,  and except as described in the Prospectuses,  none of
         the outstanding shares of capital stock of any Subsidiary was issued in
         violation of the preemptive or similar rights of any  securityholder of
         such Subsidiary.

                  (viii)  The  Purchase  Agreements  have been duly  authorized,
         executed and delivered by the Company.

                  (ix) The  Registration  Statement has been declared  effective
         under the 1933 Act; any required  filing of the Prospectus  pursuant to
         Rule  424(b) has been made in the  manner  and  within the time  period
         required by Rule  424(b);  and, to the best of our  knowledge,  no stop
         order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement or any
         Rule 462(b)  Registration  Statement has been issued under the 1933 Act
         and no proceedings for that purpose have been instituted or are pending
         or threatened by the Commission.

                  (x) The  Registration  Statement,  including  any Rule  462(b)
         Registration  Statement,  the Rule  430A  Information  and the Rule 434
         Information,  as  applicable,  the  Prospectuses  and each amendment or
         supplement to the Registration Statement and the Prospectuses as of its
         effective  or issue  date  (other  than the  financial  statements  and
         supporting schedules included therein or omitted therefrom, as to which
         we need  express  no  opinion)  complied  as to  form  in all  material
         respects  with  the  requirements  of the  1933  Act and the  1933  Act
         Regulations.

                  (xi) If Rule 434 has been relied upon, the  Prospectuses  were
         not "materially  different," as such term is used in Rule 434, from the
         prospectuses  included  in the  Registration  Statement  at the time it
         became effective.

                                      -3-

<PAGE>

                  (xii) The form of  certificate  used to  evidence  the  Common
         Stock complies in all material  respects with all applicable  statutory
         requirements,  with any  applicable  requirements  of the  charter  and
         by-laws  of the  Company  and the  requirements  of the New York  Stock
         Exchange.

                  (xiii) To the best of our  knowledge,  there is not pending or
         threatened any action, suit, proceeding,  inquiry or investigation,  to
         which  the  Company  or any  subsidiary  is a party,  or to  which  the
         property of the Company or any subsidiary is subject, before or brought
         by any court or governmental agency or body, domestic or foreign, which
         might reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect, or
         which might  reasonably be expected to materially and adversely  affect
         the   properties  or  assets  thereof  or  the   consummation   of  the
         transactions contemplated in the Purchase Agreements or the performance
         by the Company of its obligations thereunder.

                  (xiv) The information in the Prospectuses  under  "Description
         of Capital Stock--Common Stock", "Business--Governmental Regulation and
         Environmental Matters ",  "Business--Legal  Proceedings and Insurance",
         "Description   of   Capital   Stock--Preferred   Stock",   and  in  the
         Registration Statement under Item 14, to the extent that it constitutes
         matters of law,  summaries of legal matters,  the Company's charter and
         bylaws or legal proceedings, or legal conclusions, has been reviewed by
         us and is correct in all material respects.

                  (xv) To the best of our  knowledge,  there are no  statutes or
         regulations that are required to be described in the Prospectuses  that
         are not described as required.

                  (xvi) All  descriptions  in the  Prospectuses of contracts and
         other  documents to which the Company or its  subsidiaries  are a party
         are accurate in all material  respects;  to the best of our  knowledge,
         there  are  no  franchises,   contracts,  indentures,  mortgages,  loan
         agreements, notes, leases or other instruments required to be described
         or referred to in the Registration Statement or to be filed as exhibits
         thereto  other than those  described or referred to therein or filed or
         incorporated  by reference as exhibits  thereto,  and the  descriptions
         thereof or references thereto are correct in all material respects.

                  (xvii) To the best of our  knowledge,  neither the Company nor
         any subsidiary is in violation of its charter or by-laws and no default
         by the  Company  or any  subsidiary  exists in the due  performance  or
         observance of any material obligation, agreement, covenant or condition
         contained in any item that is listed on Exhibit B to this opinion.

                  (xviii) No filing with, or authorization,  approval,  consent,
         license, order, registration,  qualification or decree of, any court or
         governmental authority or agency, domestic or foreign (other than under
         the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act Regulations, which have been obtained, or
         as may be required under the securities or blue sky laws of the various
         states,  as to  which we need  express  no  opinion)  is  necessary  or
         required  in  connection  with  the due  authorization,  execution  and
         delivery of the Purchase Agreement or for the offering,  issuance, sale
         or delivery of the Securities.

                  (xix) The execution,  delivery and performance of the Purchase
         Agreements  and  the  consummation  of  the  Acquisitions  transactions
         contemplated in Purchase Agreements

                                      -4-

<PAGE>

         (including the issuance and sale of the Securities, and the use of the
         proceeds from the sale of the Securities as described in the
         Prospectuses under the caption "Use Of Proceeds") and the consummation
         of the Acquisitions and the financing thereof and compliance by the
         Company with its obligations under the Purchase Agreements do not and
         will not, whether with or without the giving of notice or lapse of time
         or both, conflict with or constitute a breach of, or default or
         Repayment Event (as defined in Section 1(a)(x) of the Purchase
         Agreements) under or result in the creation or imposition of any lien,
         charge or encumbrance upon any property or assets of the Company or any
         subsidiary pursuant to any contract, indenture, mortgage, deed of
         trust, loan or credit agreement, note, lease or any other agreement or
         instrument, known to us, to which the Company or any subsidiary is a
         party or by which it or any of them may be bound, or to which any of
         the property or assets of the Company or any subsidiary is subject, nor
         will such action result in any violation of the provisions of the
         charter or by-laws of the Company or any subsidiary, or any applicable
         law, statute, rule, regulation, judgment, order, writ or decree, known
         to us, of any government, government instrumentality or court, domestic
         or foreign, having jurisdiction over the Company or any subsidiary or
         any of their respective properties, assets or operations.

                  (xx)  To the  best of our  knowledge,  there  are no  persons,
         except as disclosed in the Prospectuses,  with  registration  rights or
         other similar rights to have any securities  registered pursuant to the
         Registration Statement or otherwise registered by the Company under the
         1933 Act.

                  (xxi) The Company is not an "investment  company" or an entity
         "controlled"  by an "investment  company," as such terms are defined in
         the 1940 Act.

                  (xxii) To the best of our knowledge,  the Company contained in
         the Reorganization  documents as set forth in Exhibit C of the Purchase
         Agreements have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by each of
         the  parties  thereto  and  constitute  a  legally  valid  and  binding
         obligation  of the  Company and is  enforceable  against the Company in
         accordance with their terms.

                  (xxiii) To the best of our knowledge,  each of the Acquisition
         Agreements governing the acquisitions that are contemplated to occur on
         or before  the  Closing  Date has been duly  authorized,  executed  and
         delivered by the Company,  and  constitutes a legally valid and binding
         obligation  of the  Company and is  enforceable  against the Company in
         accordance with its terms.

                  (xxiv) To the best of our knowledge, each franchise agreement,
         in each case between a Subsidiary and the applicable  Manufacturer  (as
         defined in the  Prospectuses)  has been duly  authorized by the Company
         and such  Subsidiaries,  enforceable in accordance with its terms,  and
         the Company has obtained all  consents,  authorizations  and  approvals
         from the  Manufacturers  required to conduct the  Acquisitions  and the
         public  offering  of Common  Stock as  contemplated  hereby  other than
         Jaguar and Kia.

                  (xxv)  To the  best  of our  knowledge,  the  Company  has all
         necessary corporate power and authority to execute, deliver and perform
         its  obligations  under the New Credit  Agreement  and the  NationsBank
         Credit  Agreement;  and the New Credit  Agreement  and

                                      -5-
<PAGE>

         the NationsBank Credit Agreement have been duly authorized, executed
         and delivered by the Company, are in the form heretofore delivered to
         you, and constitute valid and binding obligations of the Company,
         enforceable against the Company in accordance with its terms, except as
         enforcement thereof may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency,
         reorganization or other similar laws relating to or affecting
         enforcement of creditors' rights generally or by general principles of
         equity.

                  Nothing  has  come  to our  attention  that  would  lead us to
         believe  that the  Registration  Statement  or any  amendment  thereto,
         including  the Rule  430A  Information  and Rule  434  Information  (if
         applicable),  (except for financial  statements and schedules and other
         financial data included  therein or omitted  therefrom,  as to which we
         need make no statement), at the time such Registration Statement or any
         such amendment  became  effective,  contained an untrue  statement of a
         material fact or omitted to state a material fact required to be stated
         therein or necessary to make the  statements  therein not misleading or
         that the  Prospectuses  or any amendment or supplement  thereto (except
         for  financial  statements  and  schedules  and  other  financial  data
         included  therein  or  omitted  therefrom,  as to which we need make no
         statement),  at the time the Prospectuses  were issued, at the time any
         such amended or  supplemented  prospectus  was issued or at the Closing
         Time,  included or includes an untrue  statement of a material  fact or
         omitted or omits to state a material  fact  necessary  in order to make
         the statements  therein,  in the light of the circumstances under which
         they were made, not misleading.


                                       Very truly yours
                               PARKER, POE, ADAMS & BERNSTEIN L.L.P.

                               By:_______________________________________

                                      -6-

<PAGE>

                                                                       Exhibit B


                                October [ ], 1997


MERRILL LYNCH & CO.
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
           Incorporated
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.
  as U.S. Representatives of the several
  U.S. Underwriters to be named in the
  within-mentioned U.S. Purchase Agreement

Merrill Lynch International
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.
  as Lead Managers of the several
  Managers to be named in the within-
  mentioned International Purchase Agreement

c/o  Merrill Lynch & Co.
       Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
           Incorporated
North Tower
World Financial Center
New York, New York  10281-1209

         Re:      Proposed Public Offering by Sonic Automotive, Inc.

Dear Sirs:

         The  undersigned,  a stockholder  [and an officer  and/or  director] of
Sonic Automotive, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company"), understands that
Merrill  Lynch  & Co.,  Merrill  Lynch,  Pierce,  Fenner  &  Smith  Incorporated
("Merrill  Lynch"),  NationsBanc  Montgomery  Securities,  Inc. and Wheat, First
Securities,  Inc.  propose to enter into a U.S.  Purchase  Agreement  (the "U.S.
Purchase   Agreement")  with  the  Company,  and  Merrill  Lynch  International,
NationsBanc  Montgomery  Securities,  Inc.  and Wheat,  First  Securities,  Inc.
propose to enter into an International  Purchase  Agreement (the  "International
Purchase  Agreement")  with the Company,  providing  for the public  offering of
shares (the "Securities") of the Company's Class A

                                      -1-

<PAGE>

common stock, par value $0.01 per share (the "Common Stock"). In recognition of
the benefit that such an offering will confer upon the undersigned as a
stockholder [and an officer and/or director] of the Company, and for other good
and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby
acknowledged, the undersigned agrees with each underwriter to be named in the
U.S. Purchase Agreement and with each manager to be named in the International
Purchase Agreement that, during a period of 180 days from the date of the U.S.
Purchase Agreement and the International Purchase Agreement, the undersigned
will not, without the prior written consent of Merrill Lynch, directly or
indirectly, (i) offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any option or
contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant any option,
right or warrant for the sale of, or otherwise dispose of or transfer any shares
of the Company's Common Stock or any securities convertible into or exchangeable
or exercisable for Common Stock, whether now owned or hereafter acquired by the
undersigned or with respect to which the undersigned has or hereafter acquires
the power of disposition, or file any registration statement under the
Securities Act of 1933, as amended, with respect to any of the foregoing or (ii)
enter into any swap or any other agreement or any transaction that transfers, in
whole or in part, directly or indirectly, the economic consequence of ownership
of the Common Stock, whether any such swap or transaction is to be settled by
delivery of Common Stock or other securities, in cash or otherwise.

                                              Very truly yours,



                                              Signature:

                                              Print Name:


                                      -2-

    
<PAGE>



   
                                   EXHIBIT 1.2

========================================================================



                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.

                             A Delaware corporation

                    5,000,000 Shares of Class A Common Stock

                        INTERNATIONAL PURCHASE AGREEMENT

Dated:  November [   ], 1997

========================================================================


<PAGE>



                                TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                                                           PAGE

     SECTION 1. Representations and Warranties................................3

         (a) Representations and Warranties by the Company....................3
                (i) Compliance with Registration Requirements.................3
                (ii) Independent Accountants..................................4
                (iii) Financial Statements....................................4
                (iv) No Material Adverse Change in Business...................5
                (v) Good Standing of the Company..............................5
                (vi) Good Standing of Subsidiaries............................5
                (vii) Capitalization..........................................6
                (viii) Authorization of Agreement.............................6
                (ix) Authorization and Description of Securities..............6
                (x) Absence of Defaults and Conflicts.........................6
                (xi) Absence of Labor Dispute.................................7
                (xii) Absence of Proceedings..................................7
                (xiii) Accuracy of Exhibits...................................7
                (xiv) Possession of Intellectual Property.....................7
                (xv) Absence of Further Requirements..........................8
                (xvi) Possession of Licenses and Permits......................8
                (xvii) Title to Property......................................8
                (xviii) Investment Company Act................................8
                (xix) Environmental Laws......................................9
                (xx) Registration Rights......................................9
                (xxi) Income Taxes............................................9
                (xxii) Internal Controls.....................................10
                (xxiii) Insurance............................................10
                (xxiv) Offering Material.....................................10
                (xxv) Suppliers..............................................10
                (xxvi) Related Party Transactions............................10
                (xxvii) Reorganization.......................................10
                (xxviii) Pending Acquisitions................................10
                (xxix) Franchise Agreements..................................11
                (xxx) Credit Agreement.......................................11

         (b) Officer's Certificates..........................................11

     SECTION 2. Sale and Delivery to International Managers; Closing.........11

         (a) Initial Securities..............................................11
         (b) Option Securities...............................................11
         (c) Payment.........................................................12
         (d) Denominations; Registration.....................................13

                                      -1-
<PAGE>

         (e) Appointment of Qualified Independent Underwriter................13

     SECTION 3. Covenants of the Company.....................................13

         (a) Compliance with Securities Regulations and 
               Commission Requests...........................................13
         (b) Filing of Amendments............................................13
         (c) Delivery of Registration Statements.............................14
         (d) Delivery of Prospectus..........................................14
         (e) Continued Compliance with Securities Laws.......................14
         (f) Blue Sky Qualifications.........................................15
         (g) Rule 158........................................................15
         (h) Use of Proceeds.................................................15
         (i) Listing.........................................................15
         (j) Restriction on Sale of Securities...............................15
         (k) Reporting Requirements..........................................16
         (l) Compliance with NASD Rules......................................16

     SECTION 4. Payment of Expenses..........................................16

         (a) Expenses........................................................16
         (b) Termination of Agreement........................................17

     SECTION 5. Conditions of International Managers' Obligations............17

         (a)  Effectiveness of Registration Statement........................17
         (b)  Opinion of Counsel for Company.................................17
         (c)  Opinion of Counsel for International Managers..................18
         (d)  Officers' Certificate..........................................18
         (e)  Accountant's Comfort Letter....................................18
         (f)   Bring-down Comfort Letter.....................................18
         (g)  Approval of Listing............................................19
         (h)  No Objection...................................................19
         (i)   Lock-up Agreement.............................................19
         (j)   Acquisition Agreements........................................19
         (k)  Reorganization.................................................19
         (l)   Manufacturers' Consents.......................................19
         (m) Credit Agreement................................................19
         (n)  Subscription Agreements........................................19
         (o)  Purchase of Initial International Securities...................19
         (o)  Additional Documents...........................................20
         (p)  Conditions to Purchase of International Option Securities......20
         (q)  Termination of Agreement.......................................20

     SECTION 6. Indemnification..............................................21

         (a) Indemnification of International Managers.......................21
         (b) Indemnification of Company, Directors and Officers..............22
         (c) Actions against Parties; Notification...........................22
         (d) Settlement without Consent if Failure to Reimburse..............22
         (e) Indemnification for Reserved Securities.........................23

     SECTION 7. Contribution.................................................23

                                      -2-
<PAGE>

     SECTION 8. Representations, Warranties and Agreements to 
                  Survive Delivery...........................................24

     SECTION 9. Termination Agreement........................................24

         (a) Termination; General............................................24
         (b) Liabilities.....................................................25

     SECTION 10. Default by One or More of the International Managers........25

     SECTION 11. Notices.....................................................26

     SECTION 12. Parties.....................................................26

     SECTION 13 Governing Law and Time.......................................26

     SECTION 14 Effect of Headings...........................................26

         SCHEDULES

                  SCHEDULE A - LIST OF INTERNATIONAL MANAGERS...........SCH A-1
                  SCHEDULE B - PRICING INFORMATION......................SCH B-1
                  SCHEDULE C - LIST OF PERSONS SUBJECT TO LOCK-UP.......SCH C-1

         EXHIBITS.......................................................... A-1

                  EXHIBIT A -  FORM OF OPINION OF COMPANY'S COUNSEL.........A-1
                  EXHIBIT B - FORM OF LOCK-UP LETTER........................B-1
                  EXHIBIT C - REORGANIZATION DOCUMENTS......................C-1



                                      -3-
<PAGE>


                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.

                             A Delaware corporation

                         Shares of Class A Common Stock

                            Par Value $0.01 Per Share

                        INTERNATIONAL PURCHASE AGREEMENT

                                                           November [  ], 1997

MERRILL LYNCH INTERNATIONAL
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.

  as Lead Managers of the several International Managers
c/o  Merrill Lynch International
Ropemaker Place
25 Ropemaker Street

London ECSY 9LY

ENGLAND

Ladies and Gentlemen:

         Sonic Automotive, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company"),
confirms its agreement with Merrill Lynch International ("Merrill Lynch") and
each of the other international underwriters named in Schedule A hereto
(collectively, the "International Managers", which term shall also include any
underwriter substituted as hereinafter provided in Section 10 hereof), for whom
Merrill Lynch, NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc. and Wheat, First
Securities, Inc. are acting as representatives (in such capacity, the "Lead
Managers"), with respect to the issue and sale by the Company and the purchase
by the International Managers, acting severally and not jointly, of the
respective numbers of shares of Class A Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share,
of the Company ("Common Stock") set forth in said Schedule A, and with respect
to the grant by the Company to the International Managers, acting severally and
not jointly, of the option described in Section 2(b) hereof to purchase all or
any part of 150,000 additional shares of Common Stock to cover over-allotments,
if any. The aforesaid 1,000,000 shares of Common Stock (the "Initial
International Securities") to be purchased by the International Managers and all
or any part of the 150,000 shares of Common Stock subject to the option
described in Section 2(b) hereof (the "International Option Securities") are
hereinafter called, collectively, the "International Securities".


                                      -1-
<PAGE>

         It is understood that the Company is concurrently entering into an
agreement dated the date hereof (the "U.S. Purchase Agreement") providing for
the offering by the Company of an aggregate of 4,000,000 shares of Common Stock
(the "Initial U.S. Securities") through arrangements with certain underwriters
in the United States (the "U.S. Underwriters") for which Merrill Lynch & Co.,
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, NationsBanc Montgomery
Securities, Inc. and Wheat, First Securities, Inc. are acting as representatives
(the "U.S. Representatives") and the grant by the Company to the U.S.
Underwriters, acting severally and not jointly, of an option to purchase all or
any part of the U.S. Underwriters' pro rata portion of up to 600,000 additional
shares of Common Stock solely to cover overallotments, if any (the "U.S. Option
Securities" and, together with the International Option Securities, the "Option
Securities"). The Initial U.S. Securities and the U.S. Option Securities are
hereinafter called the "U.S. Securities". It is understood that the Company is
not obligated to sell and the International Managers are not obligated to
purchase, any Initial International Securities unless all of the Initial U.S.
Securities are contemporaneously purchased by the U.S. Underwriters.

         The U.S. Underwriters and the International Managers are hereinafter
collectively called the "Underwriters", the Initial U.S. Securities and the
Initial International Securities are hereinafter collectively called the
"Initial Securities", and the U.S. Securities, and the International Securities
are hereinafter collectively called the "Securities".

         The Underwriters will concurrently enter into an Intersyndicate
Agreement of even date herewith (the "Intersyndicate Agreement") providing for
the coordination of certain transactions among the Underwriters under the
direction of Merrill Lynch & Co., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated (in such capacity, the "Global Coordinator").

         The Company understands that the International Managers propose to make
a public offering of the International Securities as soon as the Lead Managers
deem advisable after this Agreement has been executed and delivered.

         The Company has filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the
"Commission") a registration statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-33295) covering the
registration of the Securities under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the
"1933 Act"), including the related preliminary prospectus or prospectuses.
Promptly after execution and delivery of this Agreement, the Company will either
(i) prepare and file a prospectus in accordance with the provisions of Rule 430A
("Rule 430A") of the rules and regulations of the Commission under the 1933 Act
(the "1933 Act Regulations") and paragraph (b) of Rule 424 ("Rule 424(b)") of
the 1933 Act Regulations or (ii) if the Company has elected to rely upon Rule
434 ("Rule 434") of the 1933 Act Regulations, prepare and file a term sheet (a
"Term Sheet") in accordance with the provisions of Rule 434 and Rule 424(b). Two
forms of prospectus are to be used in connection with the offering and sale of
the Securities: one relating to the U.S. Securities (the "Form of U.S.
Prospectus") and one relating to the International Securities (the "Form of
International Prospectus"). The Form of International Prospectus is identical to
the Form of U.S. Prospectus, except for their respective front cover pages,
first page of "Prospectus Summary," "Underwriting" sections and back cover
pages. The information included in any such prospectus or in any such Term
Sheet, as the case may be, that was omitted from such registration statement at
the time it became effective but that is deemed to be part of such registration
statement at the 


                                      -2-
<PAGE>

time it became effective (a) pursuant to paragraph (b) of Rule 430A is referred
to as "Rule 430A Information" or (b) pursuant to paragraph (d) of Rule 434 is
referred to as "Rule 434 Information." Each Prospectus used before such 
registration statement became effective, and any prospectus that omitted, 
as applicable, the Rule 430A Information or the Rule 434 Information, that 
was used after such effectiveness and prior to the execution and delivery
of this Agreement, is herein called a "preliminary prospectus." Such
registration statement, including the exhibits thereto and schedules thereto at
the time it became effective and including the Rule 430A Information and the
Rule 434 Information, as applicable, is herein called the "Registration
Statement." Any registration statement filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) of the 1933
Act Regulations is herein referred to as the "Rule 462(b) Registration
Statement," and after such filing the term "Registration Statement" shall
include the Rule 462(b) Registration Statement. The final Form of U.S.
Prospectus and the Final Form of International Prospectus in the form first
furnished to the Underwriters for use in connection with the offering of the
Securities are herein called the "U.S. Prospectus" and the "International
Prospectus," respectively, and collectively, the "Prospectuses." If Rule 434 is
relied on, the term "U.S. Prospectus" and "International Prospectus" shall refer
to the preliminary U.S. Prospectus dated October 23, 1997 and preliminary
International Prospectus dated October 23, 1997, respectively, each together
with the applicable Term Sheet and all references in this Agreement to the date
of the Prospectuses shall mean the date of the applicable Term Sheet. For
purposes of this Agreement, all references to the Registration Statement, any
preliminary prospectus, the U.S. Prospectus, the International Prospectus or any
Term Sheet or any amendment or supplement to any of the foregoing shall be
deemed to include the copy filed with the Commission pursuant to its Electronic
Data Gathering, Analysis and Retrieval system ("EDGAR").

         SECTION 1.        Representations and Warranties.

         (a) Representations and Warranties by the Company. The Company
represents and warrants to each International Manager as of the date hereof, as
of the Closing Time referred to in Section 2(c) hereof, and as of each Date of
Delivery (if any) referred to in Section 2(b), hereof and agrees with each
International Manager, as follows:

                  (i) Compliance with Registration Requirements. Each of the
         Registration Statement and any Rule 462(b) Registration Statement has
         become effective under the 1933 Act and no stop order suspending the
         effectiveness of the Registration Statement or any Rule 462(b)
         Registration Statement has been issued under the 1933 Act and no
         proceedings for that purpose have been instituted or are pending or, to
         the knowledge of the Company, are contemplated by the Commission, and
         any request on the part of the Commission for additional information
         has been complied with.

                  At the respective times the Registration Statement, any Rule
         462(b) Registration Statement and any post-effective amendments thereto
         became effective and at the Closing Time (and, if any International
         Option Securities are purchased, at the Date of Delivery), the
         Registration Statement, the Rule 462(b) Registration Statement and any
         amendments and supplements thereto complied and will comply in all
         material respects with the requirements of the 1933 Act and the 1933
         Act Regulations and did not and will not contain an untrue statement of
         a material fact or omit to state a material fact required to

                                      -3-
<PAGE>

         be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not
         misleading, and the Prospectuses, any preliminary prospectuses and any
         supplement thereto or prospectus wrapper prepared in connection
         therewith, at their respective times of issuance and at the Closing
         Time, complied and will comply in all material respects with any
         applicable laws or regulations of foreign jurisdictions in which the
         Prospectuses and such preliminary prospectuses, as amended or
         supplemented, if applicable, are distributed in connection with the
         offer and sale of Reserved Securities. Neither the Prospectuses nor any
         amendments or supplements thereto (including any prospectus wrapper),
         at the time the Prospectuses or any amendments or supplements thereto
         were issued and at the Closing Time (and, if any International Option
         Securities are purchased, at the Date of Delivery), included or will
         include an untrue statement of a material fact or omitted or will omit
         to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements
         therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made,
         not misleading. If Rule 434 is used, the Company will comply with the
         requirements of Rule 434 and the Prospectuses shall not be "materially
         different", as such term is used in Rule 434, from the prospectuses
         included in the Registration Statement at the time it became effective.
         The representations and warranties in this subsection shall not apply
         to statements in or omissions from the Registration Statement or the
         Prospectuses made in reliance upon and in conformity with information
         furnished to the Company in writing by any Underwriter through the Lead
         Managers or the U.S. Representatives expressly for use in the
         Registration Statement or the Prospectuses.

         Each preliminary prospectus and the prospectuses filed as part
         of the Registration Statement as originally filed or as part of any
         amendment thereto, or filed pursuant to Rule 424 under the 1933 Act,
         complied when so filed in all material respects with the 1933 Act
         Regulations and each preliminary prospectus and the Prospectuses
         delivered to the Underwriters for use in connection with this offering
         was identical to the electronically transmitted copies thereof filed
         with the Commission pursuant to EDGAR, except to the extent permitted
         by Regulation S-T.

                  (ii) Independent Accountants. The accountants who certified
         the financial statements and supporting schedules included in the
         Registration Statement are independent public accountants as
         required by the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act Regulations.

                  (iii) Financial Statements. The financial statements included
         in the Registration Statement and the Prospectuses, together with the
         related schedules and notes, present fairly the financial position of
         the Company and its consolidated subsidiaries at the dates indicated
         and the statement of operations, stockholders' equity and cash flows of
         the Company and its consolidated subsidiaries for the periods
         specified; said financial statements have been prepared in conformity
         with generally accepted accounting principles ("GAAP") applied on a
         consistent basis throughout the periods involved. The supporting
         schedules included in the Registration Statement present fairly in
         accordance with GAAP the information required to be stated therein. The
         selected financial data and the summary financial information included
         in the Prospectuses present fairly the information shown therein and
         have been compiled on a basis consistent with that of the audited
         financial 


                                      -4-
<PAGE>

         statements included in the Registration Statement. The pro forma
         financial statements and the related notes thereto included in
         the Registration Statement and the Prospectuses present fairly the
         information shown therein, have been prepared in accordance with the
         Commission's rules and guidelines with respect to pro forma financial
         statements and have been properly compiled on the bases described
         therein, and the assumptions used in the preparation thereof are
         reasonable and the adjustments used therein are appropriate to give
         effect to the transactions and circumstances referred to therein.

                  (iv) No Material Adverse Change in Business. Since the
         respective dates as of which information is given in the Registration
         Statement and the Prospectuses, except as otherwise stated therein, (A)
         there has been no material adverse change in the condition, financial
         or otherwise, earnings, business affairs or business prospects of the
         Company and its subsidiaries considered as one enterprise, whether or
         not arising in the ordinary course of business (a "Material Adverse
         Effect"), (B) there have been no transactions entered into by the
         Company or any of its subsidiaries, other than those in the ordinary
         course of business, which are material with respect to the Company and
         its subsidiaries considered as one enterprise, and (C) there has been
         no dividend or distribution of any kind declared, paid or made by the
         Company on any class of its capital stock.

                  (v) Good Standing of the Company. The Company has been duly
         organized and is validly existing as a corporation in good standing
         under the laws of the State of Delaware and has corporate power and
         authority to own, lease and operate its properties and to conduct its
         business as described in the Prospectuses or as proposed to be
         conducted and to enter into and perform its obligations under this
         Agreement; and the Company is duly qualified as a foreign corporation
         to transact business and is in good standing in each other jurisdiction
         in which such qualification is required, whether by reason of the
         ownership or leasing of property or the conduct of business, except
         where the failure so to qualify or to be in good standing would not
         result in a Material Adverse Effect.

                  (vi) Good Standing of Subsidiaries. All of the subsidiaries of
         the Company (each a "Subsidiary") have been duly organized and are
         validly existing as a corporation in good standing under the laws of
         the jurisdiction of its incorporation, has corporate power and
         authority to own, lease and operate its properties and to conduct its
         business as described in the Prospectuses and is duly qualified as a
         foreign corporation to transact business and is in good standing in
         each jurisdiction in which such qualification is required, whether by
         reason of the ownership or leasing of property or the conduct of
         business, except where the failure so to qualify or to be in good
         standing would not result in a Material Adverse Effect; except as
         otherwise disclosed in the Registration Statement, all of the issued
         and outstanding capital stock of each such Subsidiary has been duly
         authorized and validly issued, is fully paid and non-assessable and is
         owned by the Company, directly or through subsidiaries, free and clear
         of any security interest, mortgage, pledge, lien, encumbrance, claim or
         equity; none of the outstanding shares of capital stock of any
         Subsidiary was issued in violation of the preemptive or similar rights
         of any securityholder of such Subsidiary. The only subsidiaries of the
         Company are the subsidiaries listed on Exhibit 21.1 to the Registration
         Statement.

                                      -5-
<PAGE>

                  (vii) Capitalization. The authorized, issued and outstanding
         capital stock of the Company is as set forth in the Prospectuses in the
         column entitled "Actual" under the caption "Capitalization" (except for
         subsequent issuances, if any, pursuant to this Agreement, pursuant to
         reservations, agreements or employee benefit plans referred to in the
         Prospectuses or pursuant to the exercise of convertible securities or
         options referred to in the Prospectuses). The shares of issued and
         outstanding capital stock of the Company have been duly authorized and
         validly issued and are fully paid and non-assessable; none of the
         outstanding shares of capital stock of the Company was issued in
         violation of the preemptive or other similar rights of any
         securityholder of the Company.

                  (viii) Authorization of Agreement. This Agreement and the U.S.
         Purchase Agreement have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by
         the Company.

                  (ix) Authorization and Description of Securities. The
         Securities have been duly authorized for issuance and sale to the
         Underwriters pursuant to this Agreement against payment of the
         consideration set forth herein, will be validly issued, fully paid and
         non-assessable; the Common Stock conforms to all statements relating
         thereto contained in the Prospectus and such description conforms to
         the rights set forth in the instruments defining the same; no holder of
         the Securities will be subject to personal liability by reason of being
         such a holder; and the issuance of the Securities is not subject to the
         preemptive or other similar rights of any securityholder of the
         Company.

                  (x) Absence of Defaults and Conflicts. Neither the Company nor
         any of its subsidiaries is in violation of its charter or by-laws or in
         default in the performance or observance of any obligation, agreement,
         covenant or condition contained in any contract, franchise agreement,
         indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan or credit agreement, note,
         lease or other agreement or instrument to which the Company or any of
         its subsidiaries is a party or by which it or any of them may be bound,
         or to which any of the property or assets of the Company or any
         subsidiary is subject (collectively, "Agreements and Instruments")
         except for such defaults that would not result in a Material Adverse
         Effect; and the execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement
         and the U.S. Purchase Agreement and the consummation of the
         transactions contemplated in this Agreement, and the U.S. Purchase
         Agreement and in the Registration Statement (including the issuance and
         sale of the Securities and the use of the proceeds from the sale of the
         Securities as described in the Prospectuses under the caption "Use of
         Proceeds", the reorganization as described in the Prospectuses (the
         "Reorganization"), entering into the Bank Credit Agreement and
         consummating the Acquisitions) and compliance by the Company with its
         obligations under this Agreement and the U.S. Purchase Agreement have
         been duly authorized by all necessary corporate action and do not and
         will not, whether with or without the giving of notice or passage of
         time or both, conflict with or constitute a breach of, or default or
         Repayment Event (as defined below) under, or result in the creation or
         imposition of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any property or
         assets of the Company or any subsidiary pursuant to, the Agreements and
         Instruments, nor will such action result in any violation of the
         provisions of the charter or by-laws of the Company or any subsidiary
         or any applicable law, statute, rule, regulation, judgment, order, writ
         or decree of any government, government instrumentality or court,
         domestic or 


                                      -6-
<PAGE>

         foreign, having jurisdiction over the Company or any
         subsidiary or any of their assets, properties or operations. As used
         herein, a "Repayment Event" means any event or condition which gives
         the holder of any note, debenture or other evidence of indebtedness (or
         any person acting on such holder's behalf) the right to require the
         repurchase, redemption or repayment of all or a portion of such
         indebtedness by the Company or any subsidiary.

                  (xi) Absence of Labor Dispute. No labor dispute with the
         employees of the Company or any subsidiary exists or, to the knowledge
         of the Company, is imminent, and the Company is not aware of any
         existing or imminent labor disturbance by the employees of any of its
         or any subsidiary's principal suppliers, manufacturers, customers or
         contractors, which, in any case, may reasonably be expected to result
         in a Material Adverse Effect.

                  (xii) Absence of Proceedings. There is no action, suit,
         proceeding, inquiry or investigation before or brought by any court or
         governmental agency or body, domestic or foreign, now pending, or, to
         the knowledge of the Company, threatened, against or affecting the
         Company or any subsidiary, which is required to be disclosed in the
         Registration Statement (other than as disclosed therein), or which
         might reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect, or
         which might reasonably be expected to materially and adversely affect
         the properties or assets thereof or the consummation of the
         transactions contemplated in this Agreement and the U.S. Purchase
         Agreement or the performance by the Company of its obligations
         hereunder or thereunder; the aggregate of all pending legal or
         governmental proceedings to which the Company or any subsidiary is a
         party or of which any of their respective property or assets is the
         subject which are not described in the Registration Statement,
         including ordinary routine litigation incidental to the business, could
         not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

                  (xiii) Accuracy of Exhibits. There are no contracts or
         documents which are required to be described in the Registration
         Statement or the Prospectuses or to be filed as exhibits thereto which
         have not been so described and filed as required.

                  (xiv) Possession of Intellectual Property. The Company and its
         subsidiaries own or possess, or can acquire on reasonable terms,
         adequate patents, patent rights, licenses, inventions, copyrights,
         know-how (including trade secrets and other unpatented and/or
         unpatentable proprietary or confidential information, systems or
         procedures), trademarks, service marks, trade names or other
         intellectual property (collectively, "Intellectual Property") necessary
         to carry on the business now operated by them, and neither the Company
         nor any of its subsidiaries has received any notice or is otherwise
         aware of any infringement of or conflict with asserted rights of others
         with respect to any Intellectual Property or of any facts or
         circumstances which would render any Intellectual Property invalid or
         inadequate to protect the interest of the Company or any of its
         subsidiaries therein, and which infringement or conflict (if the
         subject of any unfavorable decision, ruling or finding) or invalidity
         or inadequacy, singly or in the aggregate, would result in a Material
         Adverse Effect.


                                      -7-
<PAGE>

                  (xv) Absence of Further Requirements. No filing with, or
         authorization, approval, consent, license, order, registration,
         qualification or decree of, any court or governmental authority or
         agency is necessary or required for the performance by the Company of
         its obligations hereunder, in connection with the offering, issuance or
         sale of the Securities under this Agreement and the U.S. Purchase
         Agreement or the consummation of the transactions contemplated by this
         Agreement and the U.S. Purchase Agreement, except (i) such as have been
         already obtained or as may be required under the 1933 Act or the 1933
         Act Regulations and foreign or state securities or blue sky laws and
         (ii) such as have been obtained under the laws and regulations of
         jurisdictions outside the United States in which the Reserved
         Securities are offered.

                  (xvi) Possession of Licenses and Permits. The Company and its
         subsidiaries possess such permits, licenses, approvals, consents and
         other authorizations (collectively, "Governmental Licenses") issued by
         the appropriate federal, state, local or foreign regulatory agencies or
         bodies necessary to conduct the business now operated by them; the
         Company and its subsidiaries are in compliance with the terms and
         conditions of all such Governmental Licenses, except where the failure
         so to comply would not, singly or in the aggregate, have a Material
         Adverse Effect; all of the Governmental Licenses are valid and in full
         force and effect, except when the invalidity of such Governmental
         Licenses or the failure of such Governmental Licenses to be in full
         force and effect would not have a Material Adverse Effect; and neither
         the Company nor any of its subsidiaries has received any notice of
         proceedings relating to the revocation or modification of any such
         Governmental Licenses which, singly or in the aggregate, if the subject
         of an unfavorable decision, ruling or finding, would result in a
         Material Adverse Effect.

                  (xvii) Title to Property. The Company and its subsidiaries
         have good and marketable title to all real property owned by the
         Company and its subsidiaries and good title to all other properties
         owned by them, in each case, free and clear of all mortgages, pledges,
         liens, security interests, claims, restrictions or encumbrances of any
         kind except such as (a) are described in the Prospectuses or (b) do
         not, singly or in the aggregate, materially affect the value of such
         property and do not interfere with the use made and proposed to be made
         of such property by the Company or any of its subsidiaries; and all of
         the leases and subleases material to the business of the Company and
         its subsidiaries, considered as one enterprise, and under which the
         Company or any of its subsidiaries holds properties described in the
         Prospectuses, are in full force and effect, and neither the Company nor
         any subsidiary has any notice of any material claim of any sort that
         has been asserted by anyone adverse to the rights of the Company or any
         subsidiary under any of the leases or subleases mentioned above, or
         affecting or questioning the rights of the Company or such subsidiary
         to the continued possession of the leased or subleased premises under
         any such lease or sublease.

                  (xviii) Investment Company Act. The Company is not, and upon
         the issuance and sale of the Securities as herein contemplated and the
         application of the net proceeds therefrom as described in the
         Prospectuses will not be, an "investment company" or an entity
         "controlled" by an "investment company as such terms are defined in the
         Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the "1940 Act").

                                      -8-
<PAGE>

                  (xix) Environmental Laws. Except as described in the
         Registration Statement and except as would not, singly or in the
         aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Effect, (A) neither the Company
         nor any of its subsidiaries is in violation of any federal, state,
         local or foreign statute, law, rule, regulation, ordinance, code,
         policy or rule of common law or any judicial or administrative
         interpretation thereof, including any judicial or administrative order,
         consent, decree or judgment, relating to pollution or protection of
         human health, the environment (including, without limitation, ambient
         air, surface water, groundwater, land surface or subsurface strata) or
         wildlife, including, without limitation, laws and regulations relating
         to the release or threatened release of chemicals, pollutants,
         contaminants, wastes, toxic substances, hazardous substances, petroleum
         or petroleum products (collectively, "Hazardous Materials") or to the
         manufacture, processing, distribution, use, treatment, storage,
         disposal, transport or handling of Hazardous Materials (collectively,
         "Environmental Laws"), (B) the Company and its subsidiaries have all
         permits, authorizations and approvals required under any applicable
         Environmental Laws and are each in compliance with their requirements,
         (C) there are no pending or threatened administrative, regulatory or
         judicial actions, suits, demands, demand letters, claims, liens,
         notices of noncompliance or violation, investigation or proceedings
         relating to any Environmental Law against the Company or any of its
         subsidiaries and (D) there are no events or circumstances that might
         reasonably be expected to form the basis of an order for clean-up or
         remediation, or an action, suit or proceeding by any private party or
         governmental body or agency, against or affecting the Company or any of
         its subsidiaries relating to Hazardous Materials or any Environmental
         Laws.

                  (xx) Registration Rights. There are no persons with
         registration rights or other similar rights to have any securities
         registered pursuant to the Registration Statement or otherwise
         registered by the Company under the 1933 Act.

                  (xxi) Income Taxes. All United States federal income tax
         returns of the Company and its subsidiaries required by law to be filed
         have been filed (taking into account extensions granted by the
         applicable federal governmental agency) and all taxes shown by such
         returns or otherwise assessed, which are due and payable, have been
         paid, except for such taxes, if any, as are being contested in good
         faith and as to which adequate reserves have been provided. All other
         corporate franchise and income tax returns of the Company and its
         subsidiaries required to be filed pursuant to applicable foreign, state
         or local law have been filed, except insofar as the failure to file
         such returns would not individually or in the aggregate have in a
         material adverse effect on the condition (financial or otherwise),
         earnings, business affairs or business prospects of the Company and its
         subsidiaries, considered together as one enterprise, and all taxes
         shown on such returns or otherwise assessed which are due and payable
         have been paid, except for such taxes, if any, as are being contested
         in good faith and as to which adequate reserves have been provided. The
         charges, accruals and reserves on the books of the Company in respect
         of any income and corporation tax liability for any years not finally
         determined are adequate to meet any assessments or re-assessments for
         additional income tax for any years not finally determined, except to
         the extent of any inadequacy that would not have a material adverse
         effect on the condition (financial or otherwise), earnings, business
         affairs or 

                                      -9-
<PAGE>

         business prospects of the Company and its subsidiaries, considered 
         together as one enterprise.

                  (xxii) Internal Controls. The Company and its subsidiaries
         maintain (and in the future will maintain) a system of internal
         accounting controls sufficient to provide reasonable assurances that
         (A) transactions are executed in accordance with management's general
         or specific authorization; (B) transactions are recorded as necessary
         to permit preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP
         and to maintain accountability for assets; (C) access to assets is
         permitted only in accordance with management's general or specific
         authorization; and (D) the recorded accountability for assets is
         compared with the existing assets at reasonable intervals and
         appropriate action is taken with respect to any differences.

                  (xxiii) Insurance. The Company and its subsidiaries carry or
         are entitled to the benefits of insurance, with financially sound and
         reputable insurers, in such amounts and covering such risks as is
         generally maintained by companies of established repute engaged in the
         same or similar business, and all such insurance is in full force and
         effect.

                  (xxiv) Offering Material. The Company has not distributed and,
         prior to the later to occur of (i) the Closing Time and (ii) completion
         of the distribution of the Securities, will not distribute any offering
         material in connection with the offering and sale of the Securities
         other than the Registration Statement, any preliminary prospectuses,
         the Prospectuses or other materials, if any, permitted by the 1933 Act
         and approved by the Lead Managers.

                  (xxv) Suppliers. No supplier of merchandise to the Company or
         any of its subsidiaries has ceased shipments of merchandise to the
         Company, other than in the normal and ordinary course of business
         consistent with past practices, which cessation would not result in a
         Material Adverse Effect.

                  (xxvi) Related Party Transactions. There are no business
         relationships or related party transactions of the nature described in
         Item 404 of Regulation S-K involving the Company or any of businesses
         being acquired pursuant to the Acquisitions (as defined in the
         Prospectuses) and any person described in such Item that are required
         to be disclosed in the Registration Statement and which have not been
         so disclosed.

                  (xxvii) Reorganization. The representations and warranties of
         the Company contained in the Reorganization documents (the
         "Reorganization Agreements") as set forth in Exhibit C hereto are true
         and correct as of the date hereof and the Reorganization Agreements are
         enforceable against the Company. All of the transactions contemplated
         by such agreements have been consummated in accordance with the terms
         as described therein (and as described in the Prospectuses) and none of
         such agreements have been amended or modified since the date of their
         execution.

                  (xxviii) Pending Acquisitions. Each of the agreements
         (collectively, the "Acquisition Agreements") governing the Acquisitions
         that are contemplated to occur on 


                                      -10-
<PAGE>

         or before the Closing Date has been duly authorized, executed and
         delivered by each of the parties, and constitutes a legally valid and
         binding obligation of the Company and to the Company's knowledge is
         enforceable against each such party thereto in accordance with its
         terms; except as described in the Prospectuses, each of the
         representations and warranties of the Company and its subsidiaries and,
         to the best of the Company's knowledge, of each of the other parties
         set forth in the Acquisition Agreements was true and correct at the
         time such representations and warranties were made and will be true and
         correct at and as of the Closing Date and the Company has received
         manufacturers consents to all of the Acquisitions.

              (xxix) Franchise Agreements. Each franchise agreement, in each
         case between a Subsidiary and the applicable Manufacturer (as defined
         in the Prospectuses) has been duly authorized by the Company and such
         Subsidiaries, and, as of the Closing Date, the Company shall have
         obtained all consents, authorizations and approvals from the
         Manufacturers required to conduct the Acquisitions and the public
         offering of Common Stock as contemplated hereby except for Jaguar and
         Kia.

              (xxx) Credit Agreement. The Company has all necessary corporate
         power and authority to execute, deliver and perform its obligations
         under the New Credit Agreement, between the Company and Ford Motor
         Credit Company (the "New Credit Agreement") and the credit agreement
         between the Company and NationsBank N.A. (the "NationsBank Credit
         Agreement"); the New Credit Agreement and the NationsBank Credit
         Agreement have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by the
         Company, are in the forms heretofore delivered to you, constitute valid
         and binding obligations of the Company, enforceable against the Company
         in accordance with its terms; and at the Closing Date, the Company
         shall be able to make borrowings thereunder.

         (b) Officer's Certificates. Any certificate signed by any officer of
the Company or any of its subsidiaries delivered to the Global Coordinator, the
Lead Managers, or to counsel for the International Managers shall be deemed a
representation and warranty by the Company to each International Managers as to
the matters covered thereby.

         SECTION 2.        Sale and Delivery to International Managers; Closing.

         (a) Initial Securities. On the basis of the representations and
warranties herein contained and subject to the terms and conditions herein set
forth, the Company agrees to sell to each International Manager, severally and
not jointly, and each International Manager, severally and not jointly, agrees
to purchase from the Company, at the price per share set forth in Schedule B,
the number of Initial International Securities set forth in Schedule A opposite
the name of such International Manager, plus any additional number of Initial
International Securities which such International Manager may become obligated
to purchase pursuant to the provisions of Section 10 hereof.

         (b) Option Securities. In addition, on the basis of the representations
and warranties herein contained and subject to the terms and conditions herein
set forth, the Company hereby grants an option to the International Managers,
severally and not jointly, to purchase up to an 

                                      -11-
<PAGE>

additional 150,000 shares of Common Stock at the price per share set forth in
Schedule B, less an amount per share equal to any dividends or distributions
declared by the Company and payable on the Initial International Securities but
not payable on the International Option Securities. The option hereby granted
will expire 30 days after the date hereof and may be exercised in whole or in
part from time to time only for the purpose of covering over-allotments which
may be made in connection with the offering and distribution of the Initial
International Securities upon notice by the Global Coordinator to the Company
setting forth the number of International Option Securities as to which the
several International Managers are then exercising the option and the time and
date of payment and delivery for such International Option Securities. Any such
time and date of delivery for the International Option Securities (a "Date of
Delivery") shall be determined by the Global Coordinator, but shall not be later
than seven full business days after the exercise of said option, nor in any
event prior to the Closing Time, as hereinafter defined. If the option is
exercised as to all or any portion of the International Option Securities, each
of the International Managers, acting severally and not jointly, will purchase
that proportion of the total number of International Option Securities then
being purchased which the number of Initial International Securities set forth
in Schedule A opposite the name of such International Managers bears to the
total number of Initial International Securities, subject in each case to such
adjustments as the Global Coordinator in their discretion shall make to
eliminate any sales or purchases of fractional shares.

         (c) Payment. Payment of the purchase price for, and delivery of
certificates for, the Initial Securities shall be made at the offices of Fried,
Frank, Harris, Shriver & Jacobson, One New York Plaza, New York, NY 10004, or at
such other place as shall be agreed upon by the Global Coordinator and the
Company, at 9:00 A.M. (Eastern time) on the third (fourth, if the pricing occurs
after 4:30 P.M. (Eastern time) on any given day) business day after the date
hereof (unless postponed in accordance with the provisions of Section 10), or
such other time not later than ten business days after such date as shall be
agreed upon by the Global Coordinator and the Company (such time and date of
payment and delivery being herein called "Closing Time").

         In addition, in the event that any or all of the International Option
Securities are purchased by the International Managers, payment of the purchase
price for, and delivery of certificates for, such International Option
Securities shall be made at the above-mentioned offices, or at such other place
as shall be agreed upon by the Global Coordinator and the Company, on each Date
of Delivery as specified in the notice from the Global Coordinator to the
Company.

         Payment shall be made to the Company by wire transfer of immediately
available funds to a bank account designated by the Company, against delivery to
the Lead Managers for the respective accounts of the International Managers of
certificates for the International Securities to be purchased by them. It is
understood that each International Manager has authorized the Lead Manager, for
its account, to accept delivery of, receipt for, and make payment of the
purchase price for, the Initial International Securities and the International
Option Securities, if any, which it has agreed to purchase. Merrill Lynch,
individually and not as representative of the International Managers, may (but
shall not be obligated to) make payment of the purchase price for the Initial
International Securities or the International Option Securities, if any, to be
purchased by any International Managers whose funds have not been received by
the Closing 


                                      -12-
<PAGE>

Time or the relevant Date of Delivery, as the case may be, but such payment
shall not relieve such International Managers from its obligations hereunder.

         (d) Denominations; Registration. Certificates for the Initial
International Securities and the International Option Securities, if any, shall
be in such denominations and registered in such names as the Lead Managers may
request in writing at least one full business day before the Closing Time or the
relevant Date of Delivery, as the case may be. The certificates for the Initial
International Securities and the International Option Securities, if any, will
be made available for examination and packaging by the Lead Managers in The City
of New York not later than 10:00 A.M. (Eastern time) on the business day prior
to the Closing Time or the relevant Date of Delivery, as the case may be.

         (e) Appointment of Qualified Independent Underwriter. The Company 
hereby confirms its engagement of Merrill Lynch as, and Merrill Lynch hereby 
confirms its agreement with the Company to render services as, a "qualified 
independent underwriter" within the meaning of Rule 2720 of the Conduct Rules of
the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. with respect to the 
offering and sale of the U.S. Securities. Merrill Lynch, solely in its capacity
as qualified independent underwriter and not otherwise, is referred to herein as
the "Independent Underwriter."

         SECTION 3. Covenants of the  Company.  The Company  covenants  with 
each  International  Manager as  follows:

                  (a) Compliance with Securities Regulations and Commission
         Requests. The Company, subject to Section 3(b), will comply with the
         requirements of Rule 430A or Rule 434, as applicable, and will notify
         the Global Coordinator immediately, and confirm the notice in writing,
         (i) when any post-effective amendment to the Registration Statement
         shall become effective, or any supplement to the Prospectuses or any
         amended Prospectuses shall have been filed, (ii) of the receipt of any
         comments from the Commission, (iii) of any request by the Commission
         for any amendment to the Registration Statement or any amendment or
         supplement to the Prospectuses or for additional information, and (iv)
         of the issuance by the Commission of any stop order suspending the
         effectiveness of the Registration Statement or of any order preventing
         or suspending the use of any preliminary prospectus, or of the
         suspension of the qualification of the Securities for offering or sale
         in any jurisdiction, or of the initiation or threatening of any
         proceedings for any of such purposes. The Company will promptly effect
         the filings necessary pursuant to Rule 424(b) and will take such steps
         as it deems necessary to ascertain promptly whether the form of
         prospectus transmitted for filing under Rule 424(b) was received for
         filing by the Commission and, in the event that it was not, it will
         promptly file such prospectus. The Company will make every reasonable
         effort to prevent the issuance of any stop order and, if any stop order
         is issued, to obtain the lifting thereof at the earliest possible
         moment.

                  (b) Filing of Amendments. The Company will give the Global
         Coordinator notice of its intention to file or prepare any amendment to
         the Registration Statement (including any filing under Rule 462(b)),
         any Term Sheet or any amendment, supplement 

                                      -13-
<PAGE>

         or revision to either the prospectus included in the Registration
         Statement at the time it became effective or to the Prospectuses, will
         furnish the Global Coordinator with copies of any such documents a
         reasonable amount of time prior to such proposed filing or use, as the
         case may be, and will not file or use any such document to which the
         Global Coordinator or counsel for the International Managers shall
         object.

                  (c) Delivery of Registration Statements. The Company has
         furnished or will deliver to the Lead Managers and counsel for the
         International Managers, without charge, signed copies of the
         Registration Statement as originally filed and of each amendment
         thereto (including exhibits filed therewith or incorporated by
         reference therein) and signed copies of all consents and certificates
         of experts, and will also deliver to the Lead Managers, without charge,
         a conformed copy of the Registration Statement as originally filed and
         of each amendment thereto (without exhibits) for each of the
         International Managers. The copies of the Registration Statement and
         each amendment thereto furnished to the Underwriters will be identical
         to the electronically transmitted copies thereof filed with the
         Commission pursuant to EDGAR, except to the extent permitted by
         Regulation S-T.

                  (d) Delivery of Prospectus. The Company has delivered to each
         International Manager, without charge, as many copies of each
         preliminary prospectus as such International Manager reasonably
         requested, and the Company hereby consents to the use of such copies
         for purposes permitted by the 1933 Act. The Company will furnish to
         each International Manager, without charge, during the period when the
         International Prospectus is required to be delivered under the 1933 Act
         or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the "1934 Act"), such number of
         copies of the International Prospectus (as amended or supplemented) as
         such International Manager may reasonably request. The International
         Prospectus and any amendments or supplements thereto furnished to the
         International Managers will be identical to the electronically
         transmitted copies thereof filed with the Commission pursuant to EDGAR,
         except to the extent permitted by Regulation S-T.

                  (e) Continued Compliance with Securities Laws. The Company
         will comply with the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act Regulations so as to
         permit the completion of the distribution of the Securities as
         contemplated in this Agreement, the U.S. Purchase Agreement and in the
         Prospectuses. If at any time when a prospectus is required by the 1933
         Act to be delivered in connection with sales of the Securities, any
         event shall occur or condition shall exist as a result of which it is
         necessary, in the opinion of counsel for the International Managers or
         for the Company, to amend the Registration Statement or amend or
         supplement any Prospectus in order that the Prospectuses will not
         include any untrue statements of a material fact or omit to state a
         material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein not
         misleading in the light of the circumstances existing at the time it is
         delivered to a purchaser, or if it shall be necessary, in the opinion
         of such counsel, at any such time to amend the Registration Statement
         or amend or supplement any Prospectus in order to comply with the
         requirements of the 1933 Act or the 1933 Act Regulations, the Company
         will promptly prepare and file with the Commission, subject to Section
         3(b), such amendment or supplement as may be necessary to correct such

                                      -14-
<PAGE>

         statement or omission or to make the Registration Statement or the
         Prospectuses comply with such requirements, and the Company will
         furnish to the International Managers such number of copies of such
         amendment or supplement as the International Managers may reasonably
         request.

                  (f) Blue Sky Qualifications. The Company will use its best
         efforts, in cooperation with the International Managers, to qualify the
         Securities for offering and sale under the applicable securities laws
         of such states and other jurisdictions as the Global Coordinator may
         designate and to maintain such qualifications in effect for a period of
         not less than one year from the later of the effective date of the
         Registration Statement and any Rule 462(b) Registration Statement;
         provided, however, that the Company shall not be obligated to file any
         general consent to service of process or to qualify as a foreign
         corporation or as a dealer in securities in any jurisdiction in which
         it is not so qualified or to subject itself to taxation in respect of
         doing business in any jurisdiction in which it is not otherwise so
         subject. In each jurisdiction in which the Securities have been so
         qualified, the Company will file such statements and reports as may be
         required by the laws of such jurisdiction to continue such
         qualification in effect for a period of not less than one year from the
         effective date of the Registration Statement and any Rule 462(b)
         Registration Statement.

                  (g) Rule 158. The Company will timely file such reports
         pursuant to the 1934 Act as are necessary in order to make generally
         available to its securityholders as soon as practicable an earnings
         statement for the purposes of, and to provide the benefits contemplated
         by, the last paragraph of Section 11(a) of the 1933 Act.

                  (h) Use of Proceeds. The Company will use the net proceeds
         received by it from the sale of the Securities in the manner specified
         in the Prospectuses under "Use of Proceeds".

                  (i) Listing. The Company will use its best efforts to effect
         the listing of the Common Stock (including the Securities) on the New
         York Stock Exchange (the "NYSE").

                  (j) Restriction on Sale of Securities. During a period of 180
         days from the date of the Prospectus, the Company will not, without the
         prior written consent of the Global Coordinator, (i) directly or
         indirectly, offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any option or
         contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant
         any option, right or warrant to purchase or otherwise transfer or
         dispose of any share of Common Stock or any securities convertible into
         or exercisable or exchangeable for Common Stock or file any
         registration statement under the 1933 Act with respect to any of the
         foregoing or (ii) enter into any swap or any other agreement or any
         transaction that transfers, in whole or in part, directly or
         indirectly, the economic consequence of ownership of the Common Stock,
         whether any such swap or transaction described in clause (i) or (ii)
         above is to be settled by delivery of Common Stock or such other
         securities, in cash or otherwise. The foregoing sentence shall not
         apply to the Securities to be sold hereunder or under the International
         Purchase Agreement; provided that the Company may sell 

                                      -15-
<PAGE>

         shares of Class A Common Stock to a third party as consideration for
         the Company's acquisition from such third party of a car dealership,
         provided that such third party executes a lock-up agreement on
         substantially the same terms described above for a period expiring 180
         days after the date of the Prospectuses.

                  (k) Reporting Requirements. The Company, during the period
         when the Prospectus are required to be delivered under the 1933 Act or
         the 1934 Act, will file all documents required to be filed with the
         Commission pursuant to the 1934 Act within the time periods required by
         the 1934 Act and the rules and regulations of the Commission
         thereunder.

                  (l) Compliance with NASD Rules. The Company hereby agrees that
         it will ensure that the Reserved Securities will be restricted as
         required by the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. (the
         "NASD") or the NASD rules from sale, transfer, assignment, pledge or
         hypothecation for a period of three months following the date of this
         Agreement. The Underwriters will notify the Company as to which persons
         will need to be so restricted. At the request of the Underwriters, the
         Company will direct the transfer agent to place a stop transfer
         restriction upon such securities for such period of time. Should the
         Company release, or seek to release, from such restrictions any of the
         Reserved Securities, the Company agrees to reimburse the Underwriters
         for any reasonable expenses (including, without limitation, legal
         expenses) they incur in connection with such release.

         SECTION 4. Payment of Expenses. (a) Expenses. The Company will pay all
expenses incident to the performance of its obligations under this Agreement,
including (i) the preparation, printing and filing of the Registration Statement
(including financial statements and exhibits) as originally filed and of each
amendment thereto, (ii) the preparation, printing and delivery to the
Underwriters of this Agreement, any Agreement among Underwriters and such other
documents as may be required in connection with the offering, purchase, sale,
issuance or delivery of the Securities, (iii) the preparation, issuance and
delivery of the certificates for the Securities to the Underwriters, including
any stock or other transfer taxes and any stamp or other duties payable upon the
sale, issuance or delivery of the Securities to the Underwriters and the
transfer of securities between the U.S. Underwriters and the International
Managers, (iv) the fees and disbursements of the Company's counsel, accountants
and other advisors, (v) the qualification of the Securities under securities
laws in accordance with the provisions of Section 3(f) hereof, including filing
fees and the reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel for the Underwriters
in connection therewith and in connection with the preparation of the Blue Sky
Survey and any supplement thereto, (vi) the printing and delivery to the
Underwriters of copies of each preliminary prospectus, any Term Sheets and of
the Prospectuses and any amendments or supplements thereto, (vii) the
preparation, printing and delivery to the Underwriters of copies of the Blue Sky
Survey and any supplement thereto, (viii) the fees and expenses of any transfer
agent or registrar for the Securities and (ix) the filing fees incident to, and
the reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel to the Underwriters in
connection with, the review by the National Association of Securities Dealers,
Inc. (the "NASD") of the terms of the sale of the Securities and (x) the fees
and expenses incurred in connection with the listing of the Securities on the
NYSE and all costs and expenses of the Underwriters, including the fees and
disbursements of counsel 

                                      -16-
<PAGE>

for the Underwriters, in connection with matters related to the Reserved
Securities which are designated by the Company for sale to employees and others
having a business relationship with the Company. In addition, the Company will
pay all expenses above $90,000 incurred in connection with the lodging, meals
and travel costs incurred by or on behalf of Company officers and the
Underwriters in connection with the road show presentations to prospective
purchasers of the Securities. The Underwriters will pay the first $90,000 of
such expenses.

         (b) Termination of Agreement. If this Agreement is terminated by the
Lead Managers in accordance with the provisions of Section 5 or Section 9(a)(i)
hereof, the Company shall reimburse the International Managers for all of their
out-of-pocket expenses, including the reasonable fees and disbursements of
counsel for the International Managers.

         SECTION 5 Conditions of International Managers' Obligations.
The obligations of the several Underwriters hereunder are subject to the
accuracy of the representations and warranties of the Company contained in
Section 1 hereof or in certificates of any officer of the Company or any
subsidiary of the Company delivered pursuant to the provisions hereof, to the
performance by the Company of its covenants and other obligations hereunder, and
to the following further conditions:

                  (a) Effectiveness of Registration Statement. The Registration
         Statement, including any Rule 462(b) Registration Statement, has become
         effective and at Closing Time no stop order suspending the
         effectiveness of the Registration Statement shall have been issued
         under the 1933 Act or proceedings therefor initiated or threatened by
         the Commission, and any request on the part of the Commission for
         additional information shall have been complied with to the reasonable
         satisfaction of counsel to the International Managers. A prospectus
         containing the Rule 430A Information shall have been filed with the
         Commission in accordance with Rule 424(b) (or a post-effective
         amendment providing such information shall have been filed and declared
         effective in accordance with the requirements of Rule 430A) or, if the
         Company has elected to rely upon Rule 434, a Term Sheet shall have been
         filed with the Commission in accordance with Rule 424(b).

                  (b) Opinion of Counsel for Company. At Closing Time, the Lead
         Managers shall have received the favorable opinion, dated as of Closing
         Time, of Parker, Poe, Adams & Bernstein LLP, counsel for the Company,
         in form and substance satisfactory to counsel for the International
         Managers, together with signed or reproduced copies of such letter for
         each of the other International Managers to the effect set forth in
         Exhibit A hereto and to such further effect as counsel to the
         International Managers may reasonably request.

                  In addition, at Closing Time, the Lead Managers shall have
         received a signed copy of the opinions rendered by Parker, Poe, Adams &
         Bernstein LLP pursuant to the New Credit Agreement, the NationsBank
         Credit Agreement and the Acquisition Agreements, accompanied by a
         letter dated as of the date of such opinions stating that the
         Underwriters may rely on such opinions as if they were addressed to the
         Underwriters.

                                      -17-
<PAGE>

                  (c) Opinion of Counsel for International Managers. At Closing
         Time, the Lead Managers shall have received the favorable opinion,
         dated as of Closing Time, of Fried, Frank, Harris, Shriver & Jacobson,
         counsel for the International Managers, together with signed or
         reproduced copies of such letter for each of the other International
         Managers with respect to the matters set forth in clauses (i), (ii),
         (v), (vi) (solely as to preemptive or other similar rights arising by
         operation of law or under the charter or by-laws of the Company),
         (viii) through (x), inclusive, (xii), (xiv) (solely as to the
         information in the Prospectus under "Description of Capital
         Stock--Common Stock") and the penultimate paragraph of Exhibit A
         hereto. In giving such opinion such counsel may rely, as to all matters
         governed by the laws of jurisdictions other than the law of the State
         of New York and the federal law of the United States and the General
         Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, upon the opinions of counsel
         satisfactory to the Lead Managers which may include counsel to the
         Company. Such counsel may also state that, insofar as such opinion
         involves factual matters, they have relied, to the extent they deem
         proper, upon certificates of officers of the Company and its
         subsidiaries and certificates of public officials.

                  (d) Officers' Certificate. At Closing Time, there shall not
         have been, since the date hereof or since the respective dates as of
         which information is given in the Prospectus, any material adverse
         change in the condition, financial or otherwise, or in the earnings,
         business affairs or business prospects of the Company and its
         subsidiaries considered as one enterprise, whether or not arising in
         the ordinary course of business, and the Lead Managers shall have
         received a certificate of the President of the Company and of the chief
         financial or chief accounting officer of the Company, dated as of
         Closing Time, to the effect that (i) there has been no such material
         adverse change, (ii) the representations and warranties in Section 1(a)
         hereof are true and correct with the same force and effect as though
         expressly made at and as of Closing Time, (iii) the Company has
         complied with all agreements and satisfied all conditions on its part
         to be performed or satisfied at or prior to Closing Time, and (iv) no
         stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement
         has been issued and no proceedings for that purpose have been
         instituted or are pending or are contemplated by the Commission.

                  (e) Accountant's Comfort Letter. At the time of the execution
         of this Agreement, the Lead Managers shall have received from Deloitte
         & Touche LLP a letter dated such date, in form and substance
         satisfactory to the Lead Managers, together with signed or reproduced
         copies of such letter for each of the other International Managers
         containing statements and information of the type ordinarily included
         in accountants' "comfort letters" to underwriters with respect to the
         financial statements and certain financial information contained in the
         Registration Statement and the Prospectuses.

                  (f) Bring-down Comfort Letter. At Closing Time, the Lead
         Managers shall have received from Deloitte & Touche LLP a letter, dated
         as of Closing Time, to the effect that they reaffirm the statements
         made in the letter furnished pursuant to subsection (e) of this
         Section, except that the specified date referred to shall be a date not
         more than three business days prior to Closing Time.

                                      -18-
<PAGE>

                  (g) Approval of Listing. At Closing Time, the Securities shall
         have been approved for listing on the NYSE, subject only to official
         notice of issuance.

                  (h) No Objection. The NASD has confirmed that it has not
         raised any objection with respect to the fairness and reasonableness of
         the underwriting terms and arrangements.

                  (i) Lock-up Agreement. At the date of this Agreement, the Lead
         Managers shall have received an agreement substantially in the form of
         Exhibit B hereto signed by the persons listed on Schedule C hereto.

                  (j) Acquisition Agreements. The acquisitions contemplated by
         the Acquisition Agreements shall have been consummated in accordance
         with the terms described therein and there have been no amendments or
         modifications to the Acquisition Agreements since the date of their
         execution without the consent of the Lead Managers and no conditions to
         the Acquisitions shall have been waived without the consent of the Lead
         Managers.

                  (k) Reorganization. The Reorganization (as described in the
         Prospectuses) shall have been consummated in accordance with the terms
         as described therein and in the Reorganization Documents and there have
         been no amendments or modifications to the Reorganization Documents
         since the date of their execution.

                  (l) Manufacturers' Consents. The Lead Managers shall have
         received on or as of the Closing Date, as the case may be, a
         certificate, in a form and substance satisfactory to the Lead Managers,
         of two executive officers of the Company certifying that each of the
         Company and its subsidiaries owns, possesses or has obtained all
         required consents and approvals from all Manufacturers with respect to
         the Acquisitions and the public offering of Common Stock hereunder and
         such consents and approvals shall be in a form satisfactory to the Lead
         Managers other than Jaguar and Kia.

                  (m) Credit Agreement. The New Credit Agreement and the
         NationsBank Credit Agreement shall have been entered into at or prior
         to Closing Time. The Company has obtained or assumed floor plan
         financing for each of the dealerships acquired in the Acquisitions in
         form and substance satisfactory to the Lead Managers and in accordance
         with the pro forma presentation in the Prospectuses.

                  (n) Subscription Agreements. The subscription agreements and
         related promissory notes relating to the sale of a 20% interest in the
         Company's Dyer Volvo and Volvo of Chattanooga dealerships to Richard
         Dyer and Nelson Bowers, respectively, are substantially in the form
         provided and there have been no amendments or modifications to such
         agreements and related notes since the date of their execution.

                  (o) Purchase of Initial International Securities.
         Contemporaneously with the purchase by the International Managers of
         the Initial International Securities under this Agreement, the U.S.
         Underwriters shall have purchased the Initial U.S. Securities under the
         U.S. Purchase Agreement.


                                      -19-
<PAGE>

                  (p) Additional Documents. At Closing Time and at each Date of
         Delivery, counsel for the Underwriters shall have been furnished with
         such documents and opinions as they may require for the purpose of
         enabling them to pass upon the issuance and sale of the Securities as
         herein contemplated, or in order to evidence the accuracy of any of the
         representations or warranties, or the fulfillment of any of the
         conditions, herein contained; and all proceedings taken by the Company
         in connection with the issuance and sale of the Securities as herein
         contemplated shall be satisfactory in form and substance to the Lead
         Managers and counsel for the International Managers.

                  (q) Conditions to Purchase of International Option Securities.
         In the event that the International Managers exercise their option
         provided in Section 2(b) hereof to purchase all or any portion of the
         International Option Securities, the representations and warranties of
         the Company contained herein and the statements in any certificates
         furnished by the Company or any subsidiary of the Company hereunder
         shall be true and correct as of each Date of Delivery and, at the
         relevant Date of Delivery, the Lead Managers shall have received:

                  (i)      Officers' Certificate. A certificate, dated such Date
                           of Delivery, of the President or a Vice President of
                           the Company and of the chief financial or chief
                           accounting officer of the Company confirming that the
                           certificate delivered at the Closing Time pursuant to
                           Section 5(d) hereof remains true and correct as of
                           such Date of Delivery.

                  (ii)     Opinion of Counsel for Company. The favorable opinion
                           of Parker, Poe, Adams & Bernstein LLP, counsel for
                           the Company, in form and substance satisfactory to
                           counsel for the Underwriters, dated such Date of
                           Delivery, relating to the Option Securities to be
                           purchased on such Date of Delivery and otherwise to
                           the same effect as the opinion required by Section
                           5(b) hereof.

                  (iii)    Opinion of Counsel for International Managers. The
                           favorable opinion of Fried, Frank, Harris, Shriver &
                           Jacobson, counsel for the International Managers,
                           dated such Date of Delivery, relating to the
                           International Option Securities to be purchased on
                           such Date of Delivery and otherwise to the same
                           effect as the opinion required by Section 5(c)
                           hereof.

                  (iv)     Bring-down Comfort Letter. A letter from Deloitte &
                           Touche LLP, in form and substance satisfactory to the
                           Lead Managers and dated such Date of Delivery,
                           substantially in the same form and substance as the
                           letter furnished to the Lead Managers pursuant to
                           Section 5(f) hereof, except that the "specified date"
                           in the letter furnished pursuant to this paragraph
                           shall be a date not more than five days prior to such
                           Date of Delivery.

         (r) Termination of Agreement. If any condition specified in this
         Section shall not have been fulfilled when and as required to be
         fulfilled, this Agreement, or, in the case of any condition to the
         purchase of International Option Securities on a Date of Delivery 

                                      -20-
<PAGE>

         which is after the Closing Time, the obligations of the several
         International Managers to purchase the relevant International Option
         Securities, may be terminated by the Lead Managers by notice to the
         Company at any time at or prior to Closing Time or such Date of
         Delivery, as the case may be, and such termination shall be without
         liability of any party to any other party except as provided in Section
         4 and except that Sections 1, 6, 7 and 8 shall survive any such
         termination and remain in full force and effect.

         SECTION 6. Indemnification.

         (a) Indemnification of International Managers. The Company agrees to
indemnify and hold harmless each International Manager and each person, if any,
who controls any International Manager within the meaning of Section 15 of the
1933 Act or Section 20 of the 1934 Act as follows:

                  (i) against any and all loss, liability, claim, damage and
         expense whatsoever, as incurred, arising out of any untrue statement or
         alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in the
         Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto), including the Rule
         430A Information and the Rule 434 Information, if applicable, or the
         omission or alleged omission therefrom of a material fact required to
         be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not
         misleading or arising out of any untrue statement or alleged untrue
         statement of a material fact included in any preliminary prospectus or
         the Prospectuses (or any amendment or supplement thereto), or the
         omission or alleged omission therefrom of a material fact necessary in
         order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances
         under which they were made, not misleading;

                  (ii) against any and all loss, liability, claim, damage and
         expense whatsoever, as incurred, to the extent of the aggregate amount
         paid in settlement of any litigation, or any investigation or
         proceeding by any governmental agency or body, commenced or threatened,
         or of any claim whatsoever based upon any such untrue statement or
         omission provided that (subject to Section 6(d) below) any such
         settlement is effected with the written consent of the Company; and

                  (iii) against any and all expense whatsoever, as incurred
         (including the fees and disbursements of counsel chosen by Merrill
         Lynch), reasonably incurred in investigating, preparing or defending
         against any litigation, or any investigation or proceeding by any
         governmental agency or body, commenced or threatened, or any claim
         whatsoever based upon any such untrue statement or omission or any such
         alleged untrue statement or omission, to the extent that any such
         expense is not paid under (i) or (ii) above;

PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that this indemnity agreement shall not apply to any loss,
liability, claim, damage or expense to the extent arising out of any untrue
statement or omission or alleged untrue statement or omission made in reliance
upon and in conformity with written information furnished to the Company by any
Underwriter through the Lead Managers or the U.S. Representatives expressly for
use in the Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto), including the Rule
430A Information and the Rule 434 Information, if applicable, or any preliminary
prospectus or the International Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement
thereto).

                                      -21-
<PAGE>

         (b) Indemnification of Company, Directors and Officers. Each
International Manager severally agrees to indemnify and hold harmless the
Company, its directors, each of its officers who signed the Registration
Statement, and each person, if any, who controls the Company within the meaning
of Section 15 of the 1933 Act or Section 20 of the 1934 Act against any and all
loss, liability, claim, damage and expense described in the indemnity contained
in subsection (a) of this Section, as incurred, but only with respect to untrue
statements or omissions, or alleged untrue statements or omissions, made in the
Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto), including the Rule 430A
Information and the Rule 434 Information, if applicable, or any preliminary
International Prospectus or the International Prospectus (or any amendment or
supplement thereto) in reliance upon and in conformity with written information
furnished to the Company by such International Manager through the Lead Managers
expressly for use in the Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto) or
such preliminary prospectus or the International Prospectus (or any amendment or
supplement thereto).

         (c) Actions against Parties; Notification. Each indemnified party shall
give notice as promptly as reasonably practicable to each indemnifying party of
any action commenced against it in respect of which indemnity may be sought
hereunder, but failure to so notify an indemnifying party shall not relieve such
indemnifying party from any liability hereunder to the extent it is not
materially prejudiced as a result thereof and in any event shall not relieve it
from any liability which it may have otherwise than on account of this indemnity
agreement. In the case of parties indemnified pursuant to Section 6(a) above,
counsel to the indemnified parties shall be selected by Merrill Lynch, and, in
the case of parties indemnified pursuant to Section 6(b) above, counsel to the
indemnified parties shall be selected by the Company. An indemnifying party may
participate at its own expense in the defense of any such action; provided,
however, that counsel to the indemnifying party shall not (except with the
consent of the indemnified party) also be counsel to the indemnified party. In
no event shall the indemnifying parties be liable for fees and expenses of more
than one counsel (in addition to any local counsel) separate from their own
counsel for all indemnified parties in connection with any one action or
separate but similar or related actions in the same jurisdiction arising out of
the same general allegations or circumstances. No indemnifying party shall,
without the prior written consent of the indemnified parties, settle or
compromise or consent to the entry of any judgment with respect to any
litigation, or any investigation or proceeding by any governmental agency or
body, commenced or threatened, or any claim whatsoever in respect of which
indemnification or contribution could be sought under this Section 6 or Section
7 hereof (whether or not the indemnified parties are actual or potential parties
thereto), unless such settlement, compromise or consent (i) includes an
unconditional release of each indemnified party from all liability arising out
of such litigation, investigation, proceeding or claim and (ii) does not include
a statement as to or an admission of fault, culpability or a failure to act by
or on behalf of any indemnified party.

         (d) Settlement without Consent if Failure to Reimburse. If at any time
an indemnified party shall have requested an indemnifying party to reimburse the
indemnified party for fees and expenses of counsel, such indemnifying party
agrees that it shall be liable for any settlement of the nature contemplated by
Section 6(a) (ii) or (iii) effected without its written consent if (i) such
settlement is entered into more than 45 days after receipt by such indemnifying
party of the aforesaid request, (ii) such indemnifying party shall have received
notice of the terms of such settlement at least 30 days prior to such settlement
being entered into and (iii) such indemnifying 



                                      -22-
<PAGE>

party shall not have reimbursed such indemnified party in accordance with such
request prior to the date of such settlement.

         (e) Indemnification for Reserved Securities. In connection with the
offer and sale of the Reserved Securities, the Company agrees, promptly upon a
request, in writing to indemnify and hold harmless the Underwriters from and
against any and all losses, liabilities, claims, damages and expenses incurred
by them as a result of the failure of eligible directors, officers, employees,
business associates and related persons of the Company to pay for and accept
delivery of Reserved Securities which, by the end of the first business day
following the date of this Agreement, were subject to a properly confirmed
agreement to purchase.

         SECTION 7. Contribution. If the indemnification provided for in
Section 6 hereof is for any reason unavailable to or insufficient to hold
harmless an indemnified party in respect of any losses, liabilities, claims,
damages or expenses referred to therein, then each indemnifying party shall
contribute to the aggregate amount of such losses, liabilities, claims, damages
and expenses incurred by such indemnified party, as incurred, (i) in such
proportion as is appropriate to reflect the relative benefits received by the
Company on the one hand and the International Managers on the other hand from
the offering of the International Securities pursuant to this Agreement or (ii)
if the allocation provided by clause (i) is not permitted by applicable law, in
such proportion as is appropriate to reflect not only the relative benefits
referred to in clause (i) above but also the relative fault of the Company on
the one hand and of the International Managers on the other hand in connection
with the statements or omissions which resulted in such losses, liabilities,
claims, damages or expenses, as well as any other relevant equitable
considerations.

         The relative benefits received by the Company on the one hand and the
International Managers on the other hand in connection with the offering of the
International pursuant to this Agreement shall be deemed to be in the same
respective proportions as the total net proceeds from the offering of the
International Securities pursuant to this Agreement (before deducting expenses)
received by the Company and the total underwriting discount received by the
International Managers, in each case as set forth on the cover of the
International Prospectus, or, if Rule 434 is used, the corresponding location on
the Term Sheet, bear to the aggregate initial public offering price of the
International Securities as set forth on such cover.

         The relative fault of the Company on the one hand and the International
Managers on the other hand shall be determined by reference to, among other
things, whether any such untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact
or omission or alleged omission to state a material fact relates to information
supplied by the Company or by the International Managers and the parties'
relative intent, knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or
prevent such statement or omission.

         The Company and the International Managers agree that it would not be
just and equitable if contribution pursuant to this Section 7 were determined by
pro rata allocation (even if International Managers were treated as one entity
for such purpose) or by any other method of allocation which does not take
account of the equitable considerations referred to above in this Section 7. The
aggregate amount of losses, liabilities, claims, damages and expenses incurred
by an indemnified party and referred to above in this Section 7 shall be deemed
to include any legal 


                                      -23-
<PAGE>

or other expenses reasonably incurred by such indemnified party in
investigating, preparing or defending against any litigation, or any
investigation or proceeding by any governmental agency or body, commenced or
threatened, or any claim whatsoever based upon any such untrue or alleged untrue
statement or omission or alleged omission.

         Notwithstanding the provisions of this Section 7, no International
Managers shall be required to contribute any amount in excess of the amount by
which the total price at which the International Securities underwritten by it
and distributed to the public were offered to the public exceeds the amount of
any damages which such International Managers has otherwise been required to pay
by reason of any such untrue or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged
omission.

         No person guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the meaning of
Section 11(f) of the 1933 Act) shall be entitled to contribution from any person
who was not guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation.

         For purposes of this Section 7, each person, if any, who controls an
International Manager within the meaning of Section 15 of the 1933 Act or
Section 20 of the 1934 Act shall have the same rights to contribution as such
International Manager, and each director of the Company, each officer of the
Company who signed the Registration Statement, and each person, if any, who
controls the Company within the meaning of Section 15 of the 1933 Act or Section
20 of the 1934 Act shall have the same rights to contribution as the Company.
The International Managers' respective obligations to contribute pursuant to
this Section 7 are several in proportion to the number of Initial International
Securities set forth opposite their respective names in Schedule A hereto and
not joint.

         SECTION 8. Representations, Warranties and Agreements to Survive
Delivery. All representations, warranties and agreements contained in this
Agreement or in certificates of officers of the Company or any of its
subsidiaries submitted pursuant hereto, shall remain operative and in full force
and effect, regardless of any investigation made by or on behalf of any
International Manager or controlling person, or by or on behalf of the Company,
and shall survive delivery of the Securities to the International Managers.

         SECTION 9. Termination of Agreement.

         (a) Termination; General. The Lead Managers may terminate this
Agreement, by notice to the Company, at any time at or prior to Closing Time (i)
if there has been, since the time of execution of this Agreement or since the
respective dates as of which information is given in the International
Prospectus, any material adverse change in the condition, financial or
otherwise, or in the earnings, business affairs or business prospects of the
Company and its subsidiaries considered as one enterprise, whether or not
arising in the ordinary course of business, or (ii) if there has occurred any
material adverse change in the financial markets in the United States or the
international financial markets, any outbreak of hostilities or escalation
thereof or other calamity or crisis or any change or development involving a
prospective change in national or international political, financial or economic
conditions, in each case the effect of which is such as to make it, in the
judgment of the Lead Managers, impracticable to market the Securities or to
enforce contracts 


                                      -24-
<PAGE>

for the sale of the Securities, or (iii) if trading in any securities of the
Company has been suspended or materially limited by the Commission, or the NYSE,
if trading generally on the American Stock Exchange or the NYSE or in the Nasdaq
National Market has been suspended or materially limited, or minimum or maximum
prices for trading have been fixed, or maximum ranges for prices have been
required, by any of said exchanges or by such system or by order of the
Commission, the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. or any other
governmental authority, or (iv) if a banking moratorium has been declared by
either Federal or New York authorities.

         (b) Liabilities. If this Agreement is terminated pursuant to this
Section, such termination shall be without liability of any party to any other
party except as provided in Section 4 hereof, and provided further that Sections
1, 6, 7 and 8 shall survive such termination and remain in full force and
effect.

         SECTION 10. Default by One or More of the International Managers.
If one or more of the International Managers shall fail at Closing Time or a
Date of Delivery to purchase the Securities which it or they are obligated to
purchase under this Agreement (the "Defaulted Securities"), the Lead Managers
shall have the right, within 24 hours thereafter, to make arrangements for one
or more of the non-defaulting International Managers, or any other underwriters,
to purchase all, but not less than all, of the Defaulted Securities in such
amounts as may be agreed upon and upon the terms herein set forth; if, however,
the Lead Managers shall not have completed such arrangements within such 24-hour
period, then:

                  (a) if the number of Defaulted Securities does not exceed 10%
         of the number of International Securities to be purchased on such date,
         each of the non-defaulting International Managers shall be obligated,
         severally and not jointly, to purchase the full amount thereof in the
         proportions that their respective underwriting obligations hereunder
         bear to the underwriting obligations of all non-defaulting
         International Managers, or

                  (b) if the number of Defaulted Securities exceeds 10% of the
         number of International Securities to be purchased on such date, this
         Agreement or, with respect to any Date of Delivery which occurs after
         the Closing Time, the obligation of the International Managers to
         purchase and of the Company to sell the Option Securities to be
         purchased and sold on such Date of Delivery shall terminate without
         liability on the part of any non-defaulting International Manager.

         No action taken pursuant to this Section shall relieve any defaulting
International Manager from liability in respect of its default.

         In the event of any such default which does not result in a termination
of this Agreement or, in the case of a Date of Delivery which is after the
Closing Time, which does not result in a termination of the obligation of the
International Manager to purchase and the Company to sell the relevant
International Option Securities, as the case may be, either the Lead Managers or
the Company shall have the right to postpone Closing Time or the relevant Date
of Delivery, as the case may be, for a period not exceeding seven days in order
to effect any required changes in the Registration Statement or Prospectus or in
any other documents or arrangements. As used 


                                      -25-
<PAGE>

herein, the term "International Manager" includes any person substituted for an
International Manager under this Section 10.

         SECTION 11. Notices. All notices and other communications
hereunder shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given if
mailed or transmitted by any standard form of telecommunication. Notices to the
International Managers shall be directed to the Lead Managers at North Tower,
World Financial Center, New York, New York 10281-1201, attention of Joel Van
Dusen; with a copy to Stuart Gelfond, Esq., Fried, Frank, Harris, Shriver &
Jacobson, One New York Plaza, New York, New York 10004; and notices to the
Company shall be directed to it at Sonic Automotive, Inc., 5401 East
Independence Boulevard, P.O. Box 18747, Charlotte, North Carolina 28218,
attention of Theodore Wright; with a copy to Gary C. Ivey, Esq., Parker, Poe,
Adams & Bernstein L.L.P, 2500 Charlotte Plaza, Charlotte, North Carolina 28244.

         SECTION 12. Parties. This Agreement shall each inure to the
benefit of and be binding upon the International Managers and the Company and
their respective successors. Nothing expressed or mentioned in this Agreement is
intended or shall be construed to give any person, firm or corporation, other
than the International Managers and the Company and their respective successors
and the controlling persons and officers and directors referred to in Sections 6
and 7 and their heirs and legal representatives, any legal or equitable right,
remedy or claim under or in respect of this Agreement or any provision herein
contained. This Agreement and all conditions and provisions hereof are intended
to be for the sole and exclusive benefit of the International Managers and the
Company and their respective successors, and said controlling persons and
officers and directors and their heirs and legal representatives, and for the
benefit of no other person, firm or corporation. No purchaser of Securities from
any International Managers shall be deemed to be a successor by reason merely of
such purchase.

         SECTION 13. GOVERNING LAW AND TIME. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY
AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK. SPECIFIED
TIMES OF DAY REFER TO NEW YORK CITY TIME.

         SECTION 14. Effect of Headings. The Article and Section headings
herein and the Table of Contents are for convenience only and shall not affect
the construction hereof.

                                      -26-
<PAGE>


         If the foregoing is in accordance with your understanding of our
agreement, please sign and return to the Company a counterpart hereof, whereupon
this instrument, along with all counterparts, will become a binding agreement
between the U.S. Underwriters and the Company in accordance with its terms.

                                    Very truly yours,

                                    SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC

                                    By
                                       ----------------------------------------
                                        Title:

 CONFIRMED AND ACCEPTED, as of the date first above written:

MERRILL LYNCH INTERNATIONAL
NATIONSBANC MONTGOMERY SECURITIES, INC.
WHEAT, FIRST SECURITIES, INC.

By: MERRILL LYNCH INTERNATIONAL

By
   --------------------------------
        Authorized Signatory

For themselves and as Lead Managers of the other International Managers named in
Schedule A hereto


                                      -27-
<PAGE>

                                   SCHEDULE A

                                                                Number of
                                                               Initial
       Name of International Manager                           International
                                                               Securities

Merrill International.................................
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc................

Wheat, First Securities, Inc.

Total.................................................
                                                                ---------
                                                                1,000,000
                                                                =========
                                      -1-
<PAGE>


                                   SCHEDULE B

                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.

                    1,000,000 Shares of Class A Common Stock

                           (Par Value $0.01 Per Share)


                  1. The initial public offering price per share for the
         Securities, determined as provided in said Section 2, shall be $ [ ].

                  2. The purchase price per share for the International
         Securities to be paid by the several International Managers shall be $
         [ ], being an amount equal to the initial public offering price set
         forth above less $ [ ] per share; provided that the purchase price per
         share for any International Option Securities purchased upon the
         exercise of the over-allotment option described in Section 2(b) shall
         be reduced by an amount per share equal to any dividends or
         distributions declared by the Company and payable on the Initial
         International Securities but not payable on the International Option
         Securities.

                                      -1-

<PAGE>

                                   SCHEDULE C

O. Bruton Smith

B. Scott Smith

William R. Brooks

Sonic Financial Corporation

Nelson E. Bowers, II

Theodore M. Wright

Jeffrey C. Rachor

O. Ken Marks, Jr.

Ivan A. Tufty

William M. Sullivan

William S. Egan

Richard S. Dyer

                                      -1-
<PAGE>


                                                                    Exhibit A

                                October [ ], 1997

MERRILL LYNCH & CO.
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                     Incorporated
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.
  as U.S. Representatives of the several
  U.S. Underwriters
Merrill Lynch International
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.
  as Lead Managers of the several
  Managers
c/o  Merrill Lynch & Co.
       Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                            Incorporated
North Tower
World Financial Center
New York, New York  10281-1209

Ladies and Gentlemen:

         We have acted as counsel for Sonic Automotive, Inc., a Delaware
corporation (the "Company") in connection with the underwritten public offering
of up to 5,750,000 shares (the "Shares") of Class A Common Stock, par value $.01
per share (the "Common Stock"), of the Company, of which 750,000 shares will be
sold pursuant to the exercise of an over-allotment option. This opinion is being
delivered to you pursuant to (i) Section 5(b) of the U.S. Purchase Agreement
between the U.S. Underwriters named in Schedule A thereto and the Company (the 
"U.S. Purchase Agreement") and (ii) Section 5(b) of the International Purchase
Agreement between the International Managers named in Schedule A thereto and the
Company (the "International Purchase Agreement " and together with the U.S.
Purchase Agreement, the "Purchase Agreements"). All capitalized terms used
herein that are defined in, or by reference in, the Purchase Agreement have the
meanings assigned to such terms therein or by reference therein, unless
otherwise defined herein.

         In connection with this opinion, we have (i) investigated such
questions of law, (ii) examined originals or certified, conformed or
reproduction copies of such agreements, instruments, documents and records of
the Company, such certificates of public officials and such 

                                       -1
<PAGE>

other documents, and (iii) received such information from officers and
representatives of the Company as we have deemed necessary or appropriate for
the purposes of this opinion.

                  In all such examinations, we have assumed the legal capacity
of all natural persons executing Documents, the genuineness of all signatures,
the authenticity of original and certified documents and the conformity to
original or certified documents of all copies submitted to us as conformed or
reproduction copies.

                  To the extent it may be relevant to the opinions expressed
herein, we have assumed that the parties to the Documents other than the Company
have the power and authority to enter into and perform such documents and to
consummate the transactions contemplated thereby, that the Documents have been
duly authorized, executed and delivered by, and constitute legal, valid and
binding obligations of such parties enforceable against such parties in
accordance with their terms, and that such parties will comply with all of their
obligations under the Documents and all laws applicable thereto.

Based upon the foregoing, and subject to the limitations, qualifications and
assumptions set forth herein, we are of the opinion that:

                  (i) The Company has been duly incorporated and is validly
         existing as a corporation in good standing under the laws of the State
         of Delaware.

                  (ii) The Company has corporate power and authority to own,
         lease and operate its properties and to conduct its business as
         described in the Prospectus or as proposed to be conducted and to enter
         into and perform its obligations under the Purchase Agreement.

                  (iii) The Company is duly qualified as a foreign corporation
         to transact business and is in good standing in each state set forth on
         Schedule A to the opinion.

                  (iv) The authorized, issued and outstanding capital stock of
         the Company is as set forth in the Prospectuses in the column entitled
         "Actual" under the caption "Capitalization" (except for subsequent
         issuances, if any, pursuant to the Purchase Agreements or pursuant to
         reservations, agreements or employee benefit plans referred to in the
         Prospectus or options referred to in the Prospectus); the shares of
         issued and outstanding capital stock have been duly authorized and
         validly issued and are fully paid and non-assessable; and none of the
         outstanding shares of capital stock of the Company was issued in
         violation of the preemptive or other similar rights of any
         securityholder of the Company.

                  (v) The Securities to be purchased by the Underwriters from
         the Company have been duly authorized for issuance and sale to the
         Underwriters pursuant to the Purchase Agreements, and, when issued and
         delivered by the Company pursuant to the Purchase Agreements against
         payment of the consideration set forth in the Purchase Agreements, will
         be validly issued and fully paid and non-assessable and no holder of
         the Securities is or will be subject to personal liability by reason of
         being such a holder.

                  (vi)     The  issuance  of the  Securities  is not  subject to
         the preemptive or other similar rights of any securityholder of the 
         Company.


                                      -2-
<PAGE>

                  (vii) Each Subsidiary has been duly incorporated and is
         validly existing as a corporation in good standing under the laws of
         the jurisdiction of its incorporation, has corporate power and
         authority to own, lease and operate its properties and to conduct its
         business as described in the Prospectuses and is duly qualified as a
         foreign corporation to transact business and is in good standing in
         each jurisdiction in which such qualification is required, whether by
         reason of the ownership or leasing of property or the conduct of
         business, except where the failure so to qualify or to be in good
         standing would not result in a Material Adverse Effect; except as
         otherwise disclosed in the Registration Statement, all of the issued
         and outstanding capital stock of each Subsidiary has been duly
         authorized and validly issued, is fully paid and non-assessable and, to
         the best of our knowledge, is owned by the Company, directly or through
         subsidiaries, and except as described in the Prospectuses, free and
         clear of any security interest, mortgage, pledge, lien, encumbrance,
         claim or equity, and except as described in the Prospectuses, none of
         the outstanding shares of capital stock of any Subsidiary was issued in
         violation of the preemptive or similar rights of any securityholder of
         such Subsidiary.

                  (viii) The Purchase Agreements have been duly authorized,
         executed and delivered by the Company.

                  (ix) The Registration Statement has been declared effective
         under the 1933 Act; any required filing of the Prospectus pursuant to
         Rule 424(b) has been made in the manner and within the time period
         required by Rule 424(b); and, to the best of our knowledge, no stop
         order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement or any
         Rule 462(b) Registration Statement has been issued under the 1933 Act
         and no proceedings for that purpose have been instituted or are pending
         or threatened by the Commission.

                  (x) The Registration Statement, including any Rule 462(b)
         Registration Statement, the Rule 430A Information and the Rule 434
         Information, as applicable, the Prospectuses and each amendment or
         supplement to the Registration Statement and the Prospectuses as of its
         effective or issue date (other than the financial statements and
         supporting schedules included therein or omitted therefrom, as to which
         we need express no opinion) complied as to form in all material
         respects with the requirements of the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act
         Regulations.

                  (xi) If Rule 434 has been relied upon, the Prospectuses were
         not "materially different," as such term is used in Rule 434, from the
         prospectuses included in the Registration Statement at the time it
         became effective.

                  (xii) The form of certificate used to evidence the Common
         Stock complies in all material respects with all applicable statutory
         requirements, with any applicable requirements of the charter and
         by-laws of the Company and the requirements of the New York Stock
         Exchange.

                  (xiii) To the best of our knowledge, there is not pending or
         threatened any action, suit, proceeding, inquiry or investigation, to
         which the Company or any subsidiary is a party, or to which the
         property of the Company or any subsidiary is subject, before or brought
         by any court or governmental agency or body, domestic or foreign, which
         might reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect, 
         or which might reasonably 


                                       -3-
<PAGE>

         be expected to materially and adversely affect the properties or assets
         thereof or the consummation of the transactions contemplated in the 
         Purchase Agreements or the performance by the Company of its 
         obligations thereunder.

                  (xiv) The information in the Prospectuses under "Description
         of Capital Stock--Common Stock", "Business--Governmental Regulation and
         Environmental Matters ", "Business--Legal Proceedings and Insurance",
         "Description of Capital Stock--Preferred Stock", and in the
         Registration Statement under Item 14, to the extent that it constitutes
         matters of law, summaries of legal matters, the Company's charter and
         bylaws or legal proceedings, or legal conclusions, has been reviewed by
         us and is correct in all material respects.

                  (xv) To the best of our knowledge, there are no statutes or
         regulations that are required to be described in the Prospectuses that
         are not described as required.

                  (xvi) All descriptions in the Prospectuses of contracts and
         other documents to which the Company or its subsidiaries are a party
         are accurate in all material respects; to the best of our knowledge,
         there are no franchises, contracts, indentures, mortgages, loan
         agreements, notes, leases or other instruments required to be described
         or referred to in the Registration Statement or to be filed as exhibits
         thereto other than those described or referred to therein or filed or
         incorporated by reference as exhibits thereto, and the descriptions
         thereof or references thereto are correct in all material respects.

                  (xvii) To the best of our knowledge, neither the Company nor
         any subsidiary is in violation of its charter or by-laws and no default
         by the Company or any subsidiary exists in the due performance or
         observance of any material obligation, agreement, covenant or condition
         contained in any item that is listed on Exhibit B to this opinion.

                  (xviii) No filing with, or authorization, approval, consent,
         license, order, registration, qualification or decree of, any court or
         governmental authority or agency, domestic or foreign (other than under
         the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act Regulations, which have been obtained, or
         as may be required under the securities or blue sky laws of the various
         states, as to which we need express no opinion) is necessary or
         required in connection with the due authorization, execution and
         delivery of the Purchase Agreement or for the offering, issuance, sale
         or delivery of the Securities.

                  (xix) The execution, delivery and performance of the Purchase
         Agreements and the consummation of the Acquisitions transactions
         contemplated in Purchase Agreements (including the issuance and sale of
         the Securities, and the use of the proceeds from the sale of the
         Securities as described in the Prospectuses under the caption "Use Of
         Proceeds") and the consummation of the Acquisitions and the financing
         thereof and compliance by the Company with its obligations under the
         Purchase Agreements do not and will not, whether with or without the
         giving of notice or lapse of time or both, conflict with or constitute
         a breach of, or default or Repayment Event (as defined in Section
         1(a)(x) of the Purchase Agreements) under or result in the creation or
         imposition of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any property or
         assets of the Company or any subsidiary pursuant to any contract,
         indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan or credit agreement, note,
         lease or any other agreement or instrument, known to us, to which the
         Company or any subsidiary is a party or by which it or any of them may
         be bound, or to which any of the property or 


                                       -4
<PAGE>

         assets of the Company or any subsidiary is subject, nor will such 
         action result in any violation of the provisions of the charter or 
         by-laws of the Company or any subsidiary, or any applicable law, 
         statute, rule, regulation, judgment, order, writ or decree, known to 
         us, of any government, government instrumentality or court, domestic 
         or foreign, having jurisdiction over the Company or any subsidiary or 
         any of their respective properties, assets or operations.

                  (xx) To the best of our knowledge, there are no persons,
         except as disclosed in the Prospectuses, with registration rights or
         other similar rights to have any securities registered pursuant to the
         Registration Statement or otherwise registered by the Company under the
         1933 Act.

                  (xxi) The Company is not an "investment company" or an entity
         "controlled" by an "investment company," as such terms are defined in
         the 1940 Act.

                  (xxii) To the best of our knowledge, the Reorganization
         documents as set forth in Exhibit C of the Purchase Agreements have
         been duly authorized, executed and delivered by each of the parties
         thereto and constitute a legally valid and binding obligation of the
         Company and are enforceable against the Company in accordance with
         their terms.

                  (xxiii) To the best of our knowledge, each of the Acquisition
         Agreements governing the acquisitions that are contemplated to occur on
         or before the Closing Date has been duly authorized, executed and
         delivered by the Company, and constitutes a legally valid and binding
         obligation of the Company and is enforceable against the Company in
         accordance with its terms.

                  (xxiv) To the best of our knowledge, each franchise agreement,
         in each case between a Subsidiary and the applicable Manufacturer (as
         defined in the Prospectuses) has been duly authorized by the Company
         and such Subsidiaries, enforceable in accordance with its terms, and
         the Company has obtained all consents, authorizations and approvals
         from the Manufacturers required to conduct the Acquisitions and the
         public offering of Common Stock as contemplated hereby other than
         Jaguar and Kia.

                  (xxv) To the best of our knowledge, the Company has all
         necessary corporate power and authority to execute, deliver and perform
         its obligations under the New Credit Agreement and the NationsBank
         Credit Agreement; and the New Credit Agreement and the NationsBank
         Credit Agreement have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by
         the Company, are in the form heretofore delivered to you, and
         constitute valid and binding obligations of the Company, enforceable
         against the Company in accordance with its terms, except as enforcement
         thereof may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization or
         other similar laws relating to or affecting enforcement of creditors'
         rights generally or by general principles of equity.

                  Nothing has come to our attention that would lead us to
         believe that the Registration Statement or any amendment thereto,
         including the Rule 430A Information and Rule 434 Information (if
         applicable), (except for financial statements and schedules and other
         financial data included therein or omitted therefrom, as to which we
         need make no statement), at the time such Registration Statement or any
         such amendment became 

                                       -5
<PAGE>

         effective, contained an untrue statement of a material fact or omitted
         to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to
         make the statements therein not misleading or that the Prospectuses or
         any amendment or supplement thereto (except for financial statements
         and schedules and other financial data included therein or omitted
         therefrom, as to which we need make no statement), at the time the
         Prospectuses were issued, at the time any such amended or supplemented
         prospectus was issued or at the Closing Time, included or includes an
         untrue statement of a material fact or omitted or omits to state a
         material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in
         the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not
         misleading.

                                    Very truly yours
                                    PARKER, POE, ADAMS & BERNSTEIN L.L.P.

                                    By:______________________________________


                                      -6-
<PAGE>
                                                                     Exhibit B

                                October [ ], 1997

MERRILL LYNCH & CO.

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                     Incorporated
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.
  as U.S. Representatives of the several
  U.S. Underwriters to be named in the
  within-mentioned U.S. Purchase Agreement

Merrill Lynch International
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc.
Wheat, First Securities, Inc.
  as Lead Managers of the several
  Managers to be named in the within-
  mentioned International Purchase Agreement

c/o  Merrill Lynch & Co.
       Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                            Incorporated

North Tower
World Financial Center

New York, New York  10281-1209

         Re:      Proposed Public Offering by Sonic Automotive, Inc.

Dear Sirs:

         The undersigned, a stockholder [and an officer and/or director] of
Sonic Automotive, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company"), understands that
Merrill Lynch & Co., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated
("Merrill Lynch"), NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc. and Wheat, First
Securities, Inc. propose to enter into a U.S. Purchase Agreement (the "U.S.
Purchase Agreement") with the Company, and Merrill Lynch International,
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities, Inc. and Wheat, First Securities, Inc.
propose to enter into an International Purchase Agreement (the "International
Purchase Agreement") with the Company, providing for the public offering of
shares (the "Securities") of the Company's Class A common stock, par value $0.01
per share (the "Common Stock"). In recognition of the benefit that such 



                                       -1-
<PAGE>

an offering will confer upon the undersigned as a stockholder [and an officer
and/or director] of the Company, and for other good and valuable consideration,
the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the undersigned
agrees with each underwriter to be named in the U.S. Purchase Agreement and with
each manager to be named in the International Purchase Agreement that, during a
period of 180 days from the date of the U.S. Purchase Agreement and the
International Purchase Agreement, the undersigned will not, without the prior
written consent of Merrill Lynch, directly or indirectly, (i) offer, pledge,
sell, contract to sell, sell any option or contract to purchase, purchase any
option or contract to sell, grant any option, right or warrant for the sale of,
or otherwise dispose of or transfer any shares of the Company's Common Stock or
any securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for Common Stock,
whether now owned or hereafter acquired by the undersigned or with respect to
which the undersigned has or hereafter acquires the power of disposition, or
file any registration statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended,
with respect to any of the foregoing or (ii) enter into any swap or any other
agreement or any transaction that transfers, in whole or in part, directly or
indirectly, the economic consequence of ownership of the Common Stock, whether
any such swap or transaction is to be settled by delivery of Common Stock or
other securities, in cash or otherwise.

                                 Very truly yours,

                                 Signature:
                                           ------------------------------------
                                 Print Name:
                                            -----------------------------------

                                      -2-
    
<PAGE>

   


                        Supplemental Terms and Conditions

         This Agreement is made this 19th day of September, 1997 by and between
Ford Motor Company, a Delaware corporation with its principal place of business
at The American Road, Dearborn, Michigan (hereinafter called "Ford"), and Sonic
Automotive, Inc., a Delaware corporation with its principal place of business at
5401 E. Independence Blvd., Charlotte, NC 28212 (hereinafter called "Sonic
Automotive").

                                    AGREEMENT

     1. Definitions. For purposes hereof, the following definitions shall apply:

     a. "Agreement" shall mean the Ford, Lincoln or Mercury Sales and Service
Agreement.

     b. "General Manager" shall mean the person designated by Sonic Automotive
pursuant to paragraph F (ii) of the Agreement with full day to day management
authority and approved by Ford in writing.

     c. "Securities Act" shall mean the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

     d. "Exchange Act" shall mean the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended.

     e. "SEC" shall mean the Securities and Exchange Commission.

     f. "Dealership" shall mean each Ford, Mercury or Lincoln authorized
dealership owned or controlled directly or indirectly by Sonic Automotive.

     g. "Delegation Certificate" shall be the instrument executed by an
authorized officer of Sonic Automotive granting full day to day operational and
management control of the Dealership to the General Manager.

     h. "CSI" shall mean the Customer Satisfaction Index used by Ford to measure
customer satisfaction in terms of the selling process as well as after sales
service, as such may be modified from time to time by Ford.

     i. "Supplemental Terms" shall mean these Supplemental Terms and Conditions.

     2. Scope. Sonic Automotive has indicated that it will seek to acquire or to
apply for Ford, Mercury and Lincoln authorized dealerships. In order to simplify
future discussions and to avoid any misunderstanding, these Supplemental Terms
are intended to apply to those situations where Ford is willing to approve Sonic
Automotive (or its designated wholly-owned or controlled direct or indirect
subsidiary) as the purchaser of the capital stock or assets of a Ford, Mercury
or Lincoln authorized dealership or where it is willing to enter into an
Agreement with Sonic Automotive with respect to a new dealership location.


<PAGE>



                                        2


In each situation where Ford is willing to enter into an Agreement, Sonic
Automotive will cause the Dealership to execute an Agreement and will cause such
Dealership to be bound by these Supplemental Terms.

     3. Sole Ownership. To maintain financial and operational autonomy and
accountability, each Dealership will be a separate corporation with the Ford,
Mercury and/or Lincoln dealership operation being its sole business unless
otherwise agreed in writing by Ford; provided, however, that if, at the time of
acquisition of any Dealership, such Dealership is not a separate corporation,
Sonic Automotive will use reasonable efforts to cause the Dealership to be held
as a separate corporation as soon as practicable. Sonic Automotive shall furnish
to Ford a copy of the certificate of incorporation and bylaws of each
Dealership. As is required of all Ford authorized dealerships, each Dealership
shall submit monthly financial and operating performance data to Ford.

     4. Capitalization. Each Dealership will be separately and fully capitalized
to ensure the maintenance of net cash, working capital and operating investment
in accordance with Ford guidelines. Other than through dividends permitted by
the law of the state of incorporation of each Dealership, the effect of which
shall not impair the ability of the Dealership to meet the above mentioned Ford
capitalization guidelines, or through arms-length transactions, all cash and
other assets generated by each Dealership will remain within the Dealership and
none of the assets of any Dealership owned or controlled by Sonic Automotive
shall be used directly or indirectly to secure the debt or liability of Sonic
Automotive or any other Dealership or other business owned or controlled by
Sonic Automotive; provided, however, that nothing herein shall prevent the cross
collateralization of capital stock or assets among the Dealerships owned by
Sonic Automotive.

     5. General Manager. Sonic Automotive shall delegate in writing the complete
day to day management control of each Dealership to the General Manager of such
Dealership whose appointment shall be subject to Ford's prior written approval
which shall not be unreasonably withheld. The General Manager shall be
designated in paragraph F (ii) of the Agreement and shall have full managerial
authority and accountability for operating the Dealership in accordance with the
terms of the Agreement and the Supplemental Terms. Each person nominated by
Sonic Automotive as a General Manager must have substantial, successful retail
automotive experience and must meet Ford's high standards for moral and ethical
behavior. Upon the appointment of a General Manager, a copy of the Delegation
Certificate shall be submitted to Ford. All proposed changes to the Delegation
Certificate shall be in writing, submitted to Ford and subject to Ford's prior
written approval. Sonic Automotive will notify Ford and obtain Ford's prior
written approval of any proposed change to the General Manager, such approval
not to be unreasonably withheld. Sonic Automotive shall have the right to
appoint an interim General Manager as a temporary replacement for any General
Manager who is terminated for cause or who voluntarily resigns, in each case
without the prior written approval of Ford. In the event that an interim General
Manager is appointed, Sonic Automotive shall work with Ford to appoint a
permanent General Manager within 90 days after the appointment of the interim
General Manager. In addition to meeting the criteria Ford customarily applies to
new dealer candidates, the General Manager will be assigned to the Dealership
for a sufficient time (being a minimum of 3 years unless otherwise agreed by
Ford in writing) to allow the



<PAGE>



                                        3


General Manager to develop and maintain ties to the local community evidenced by
involvement in community civic and charitable organizations. The General Manager
must reside in the Dealer Locality as required by the Agreement.

     6. Compensation Plans. Sonic Automotive will cause each Dealership to
provide to its General Manager and other key employees of the Dealership, as
deemed appropriate, as part of their compensation, incentive programs that will
provide specific financial rewards to the General Manager and such other
employees that are payable to them at least annually and are based upon the
achievement and maintenance by the Dealership of the long term and short term
operating performance objectives described in paragraph 7 hereof.

     7. Performance Criteria. Should any Dealership fail to meet reasonable
performance criteria established by Ford relating to such matters as sales
performance, CSI and such other performance criteria that Ford may reasonably
apply to all its authorized dealers, Ford will have the right to implement the
following procedure. Ford shall notify Sonic Automotive and the General Manager
in writing of such failure and shall grant Sonic Automotive and the General
Manager 90 days to either cure the failure in total or, with respect to sales
performance and CSI only, to present to Ford evidence of progress to cure the
failure indicating in Ford's reasonable judgment that the failure will be cured
within one year of Ford's notice. Should the failure not be cured within the
above period, persons delegated with authority from Sonic Automotive immediately
shall meet with authorized personnel from Ford to arrange for the orderly and
expeditious replacement of the General Manager. Should agreement not be reached
upon the identity of an appropriate replacement General Manager within 90 days
of the end of the cure period, Ford may terminate the Agreement with immediate
effect. Requirements that each Dealership consistently meet or exceed Ford's
regional average retail car and truck market share and comparable dealer group
average customer satisfaction ratings, as measured by CSI or other criteria
established by Ford, shall be considered reasonable performance requirements.
Ford will not unreasonably withhold its consent to the appointment of an
appropriate replacement General Manager.

     8. Additional Appointments. Should any Dealership fail to maintain for any
12 month period the level of CSI at substantially the same level that was
reported for such Dealership as of the date of its acquisition by Sonic
Automotive, Sonic Automotive shall not seek or apply for another Ford authorized
dealership until such time as such level of CSI is restored to Ford's reasonable
satisfaction. Ford will provide each Dealership a report monthly, summarizing
its CSI performance for the preceding month and for the calendar year to date.
Sonic Automotive may not acquire more than two Ford and two Lincoln Mercury
dealerships within any single twelve-month period. Further, unless otherwise
agreed by Ford in writing, Sonic Automotive shall not seek or apply for a Ford
authorized dealership if, once owning such dealership, Sonic Automotive would
own or control, directly or indirectly, the lesser of (a) 15 Ford and 15 Lincoln
Mercury Dealerships or (b) that number of Ford authorized dealerships with total
retail sales of new vehicles in the immediately preceding calendar year of more
than 2% of the total Ford and Lincoln Mercury branded vehicles sold at retail in
the United States; provided, however, that in no event shall Sonic Automotive
seek or apply for a Ford authorized dealership in any market area, as defined
from time to time by Ford for its dealership network, that would result in



<PAGE>



                                        4


Sonic Automotive owning or controlling, directly or indirectly, more than one
Ford authorized dealership in those market areas having 3 or less Ford
authorized dealerships in them, or in Sonic Automotive owning or controlling,
directly or indirectly, more than 25% of the Ford authorized dealerships in
market areas, as defined from time to time by Ford for its dealership network,
having 4 or more authorized Ford dealerships in them, it being understood that
this proviso is intended to apply separately to Ford and to Lincoln Mercury
dealerships. Should the above limitations be reached, Ford will give
consideration to extending the limitations, other than the limitation relating
to individual market areas, should circumstances warrant it. However, Ford's
refusal to extend any limitation shall be deemed to be a reasonable action by
Ford.

     9. Major Changes. Sonic Automotive shall submit to Ford copies of all
effective registration statements and final reports, proxies and information
statements it files with the SEC pursuant to the Securities Act or the Exchange
Act within five (5) business days of filing with the SEC. Sonic Automotive,
shall submit to Ford all filings submitted to the SEC by third parties that are
required to disclose significant holdings or substantial acquisitions of, or
changes in, the ownership of the voting securities (or other securities
convertible into voting securities) of Sonic Automotive including, without
limitation, Schedules 13D or 13G. Should any SEC filing disclose that (a) a
person, entity or group has a binding agreement to acquire, or has acquired,
voting securities (or other securities convertible into voting securities) of
Sonic Automotive that would place 15% or more of the voting securities (or other
securities convertible into voting securities) of Sonic Automotive into the
hands of such person, entity or group, or (b) a person or entity that owns or
controls fifteen percent (15%) of the voting securities (or other securities
convertible into voting securities) of Sonic Automotive intends or may intend to
acquire additional voting securities (or other securities convertible into
voting securities) of Sonic Automotive, or (c) an extraordinary corporate
transaction, such as a merger, reorganization or liquidation, involving Sonic
Automotive or any of its subsidiaries is planned or anticipated or (d) a sale or
transfer of a material amount of assets of Sonic Automotive, or any of its
subsidiaries, is planned or anticipated, or (e) a change has been made or is
planned to be made in the Board of Directors or management of Sonic Automotive
or (f) any other material change in Sonic Automotive's business or corporate
structure or (g) any action similar to those noted above, Sonic Automotive shall
provide 30 days prior written notice to Ford describing the matter disclosed in
such filing in detail. If any such action is believed by Ford in its reasonable
judgment to have a material and adverse effect on its reputation in the market
place with respect to an action described in (e), (f), or (g) or with respect to
the other actions should Ford reasonably conclude that such action will not be
compatible with the interests of Ford, Sonic Automotive agrees that within 90
days of Ford's notice thereof, Sonic Automotive shall sell or cause to be sold
one or more of the Dealerships, as specified in the notice, to Ford or its
designee at fair market value, determined in accordance with Attachment A or
resign the Agreements, or provide evidence to Ford that the proposed action
which gave rise to the issuance of Ford's notice will not take place. Should
Sonic Automotive enter into an agreement to transfer the assets or capital stock
of any Dealership to a third party, Ford's right of first refusal provided in
paragraph 24(b) of the Agreement shall apply.

     10. Exclusive Dealership Facilities. Each Dealership shall operate as an
exclusive fully-dedicated Ford and/or Mercury and/or Lincoln dealership, as the
case may be, and



<PAGE>



                                        5


Sonic Automotive will not accept a sales and service agreement with any other
automobile manufacturer or importer or allow the merchandising, display, sale or
service of new vehicles other than Ford, Mercury or Lincoln vehicles at the
facilities and locations approved by Ford and used by any Dealership for the
conduct of its business ("Ford Approved Facilities"). Unless otherwise agreed in
writing, should Sonic Automotive acquire a Dealership having a sales and service
agreement with a competitive automobile manufacturer or importer and related
sales and service operations at the Ford Approved Facilities, it shall cause the
Dealership to relocate such competitive sales and service operations from the
Ford Approved Facilities within one year of acquisition; provided, however, that
Ford shall grant Sonic Automotive additional time to effect such relocation if
Ford believes Sonic Automotive is making reasonable progress in so doing. No
Dealership will merchandise, display or sell new Ford, Mercury or Lincoln
vehicles at any unauthorized location including those owned or controlled by
Sonic Automotive. In conducting its advertising programs each Dealership shall
portray the products it is authorized to sell and service under the Agreement in
a distinctive manner taking care not to mingle such advertising with advertising
of competitive make new vehicles or used vehicles.

     11. Advertising. Sonic Automotive recognizes the benefit of local
cooperative advertising and has indicated that it will cause each Dealership to
become a fully participating member of the local Ford, Lincoln or Mercury dealer
advertising group (FDAF/LMDA).

     12. Auctions. Used vehicle purchases from Ford sponsored auctions will be
governed by a separate "Sponsored Auction Agreement" which will be executed by
each Dealership.

     13. Dealership Name. The trade name and corporate name of each Dealership
will be subject to Ford's approval and will not include any reference to any
non-Ford, Mercury or Lincoln make vehicle.

     14. Site Control. Any existing agreement covering a Dealership or its
assets relating to site control will be assumed by Sonic Automotive and shall
remain in full force and effect.

     15. Dispute Settlement. Any dispute concerning the Agreement or the
Supplemental Terms shall be resolved using the arbitration plan described in
paragraph 18 of the Agreement; provided, however, that notwithstanding anything
in the Agreement to the contrary, the use of such Plan shall be mandatory and
not optional and; provided, further, that no dispute need be brought before the
Ford Dealer Policy Board.

     16. Agreement and Supplemental Terms. Sonic Automotive confirms that the
provisions of these Supplemental Terms are material to its relationship with
Ford and that a failure by Sonic Automotive to fully comply with any material
term hereof, after having been given a reasonable opportunity to cure such
failure, will constitute good and just cause for Ford, in its discretion, to
terminate the Agreement and these Supplemental Terms with immediate effect.



<PAGE>



                                       6


     17. Binding Effect. These Supplemental Terms are intended to modify certain
provisions of the Agreement and to be incorporated as a part of the Agreement.
Should there be an inconsistency between the terms of these Supplemental Terms
and any provision of the Agreement, the terms of these Supplemental Terms shall
apply.

     18. Parent-Subsidiary. Sonic Automotive shall cause each Dealership to
carry out the actions and to assume the responsibilities provided herein.

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Sonic Automotive and Ford, through their authorized
officers, have set there hands on the day and year above written.


Ford Motor Company                    Sonic Automotive


By: /s/ ILLEGIBLE                     By:      /s/ O. Bruton Smith
   ---------------------                  -------------------------------------
Its: Assistant Secretary              Its: Chairman and Chief Executive Officer



<PAGE>



                                        7



                                                                    ATTACHMENT A


The Fair Market Value shall be determined as follows:

     (a) Within 10 days after Ford has given notice to Sonic Automotive of its
intention to cause Sonic Automotive to sell one or more Dealerships (herein
called the "Valuation Date"), Ford and Sonic Automotive each shall designate a
nationally recognized investment banking firm ("Investment Banker"). If either
Ford or Sonic Automotive shall fail to designate an Investment Banker within
such 10-day period, the Investment Banker designated by the other party shall
determine the Fair Market Value, and such determination shall be binding on the
parties.

     (b) Within 30 days after the Valuation Date, each Investment Banker shall
submit to Ford and Sonic Automotive its written determination of the Fair Market
Value of the Dealership or group of Dealerships. If only one Investment Banker
submits a written determination within such 30-day period, the Fair Market Value
shall be deemed to be the value stated in such determination.

     (c) If the two values established by the first two Investment Bankers are
within ten percent (10%) of one another (as measured from the lower value), the
average of the two values shall be deemed to be the Fair Market Value. If the
two values established by the Investment Bankers differ by more than ten percent
(10%) (measured from the lower value), the first two Investment Bankers shall,
within 10 days of the Valuation Date, jointly select a third Investment Banker
meeting the criteria specified in paragraph (a) who shall submit to Ford and
Sonic Automotive a written determination of the Fair Market Value of the
Dealership or group of Dealerships within 30 days of its appointment. If the
first two Investment Bankers fail to appoint the third Investment Banker within
the period specified, such appointment shall be made by the American Arbitration
Association. The average of the two valuations that are closer in value shall be
deemed to be the Fair Market Value of the Dealership or group of Dealerships.

     (d) Ford and Sonic Automotive each shall bear the expense of the Investment
Banker hired by it and shall share equally in the expense of the third
Investment Banker.

    

   

                                AGREEMENT BETWEEN
                        TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
                                       AND
                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.


Agreement,  dated September 23, 1997,  entered between Sonic  Automotive,  Inc.,
("Sonic"), a Delaware corporation,  with its principal place of business at 5401
Independence  Blvd.,  Charlotte,  NC,  28212,  and Toyota Motor  Sales,  U.S.A.,
Inc.("TMS"),  a California corporation,  with its principal place of business at
19001 South Western Avenue, Torrance, CA, 90509.

WHEREAS,  Sonic is currently the owner,  directly or through its  Affiliates (as
defined in Paragraph 1 below) of Town & Country Toyota; and

WHEREAS, Sonic may wish to acquire, directly or through an Affiliate, additional
Toyota and Lexus dealerships; and

WHEREAS,  Sonic  wants  to  issue  stock  in a  public  offering  of  securities
anticipated to be traded on the New York Stock Exchange; and

WHEREAS,  TMS has advised  Sonic of TMS' policy  limiting the number of commonly
owned or  controlled,  directly  or through an  Affiliate  (as  defined  below),
dealerships by a single entity, which is currently as follows:

A.   TOYOTA

          A single  entity  shall not hold an  ownership  interest,  directly or
          through  an  Affiliate,  in  more  than:  (a) the  greater  of one (1)
          dealership  or 20% of the  Toyota  dealer  count in a  "Metro"  market
          ("Metro" markets are multiple Toyota dealership  markets as defined by
          TMS);  (b) the  lesser  of five (5)  dealerships  or 5% of the  Toyota
          dealerships in any Toyota Region ("Toyota Region"  currently  includes
          nine  TMS  Regions,   Central   Atlantic   Toyota,   Southeast  Toyota
          Distributors,  Inc., and Gulf States Toyota); and (c) seven (7) Toyota
          dealerships nationally.



<PAGE>



     LEXUS

          A single  entity  shall not hold an  ownership  interest,  directly or
          through an Affiliate,  in more than: (a) two (2) Lexus  dealerships in
          any Area ("Area"  currently  includes Eastern,  Southern,  Central and
          Western); and (b) three (3) Lexus dealerships nationally.

     "Affiliate" of, or a person or entity "affiliated" with, a specified person
     or entity,  means a person or entity that directly or  indirectly,  through
     one or more intermediaries,  controls, is controlled by, or is under common
     control  with,  the  person or entity  specified.  For the  purpose of this
     definition,   the  term  "control"   (including  the  terms  "controlling,"
     "controlled  by" and "under  common  control  with") means the  possession,
     directly or  indirectly,  or the power to direct or cause the  direction of
     the  management  and  policies of a person or entity,  whether  through the
     ownership of securities, by contract or otherwise.

B.   In order for an entity to acquire  additional Toyota or Lexus  dealerships,
     within the limits of this Agreement,  each Toyota or Lexus dealership which
     it owns,  directly or through an Affiliate,  must: a) be in full compliance
     with  all  of the  terms  of  its  Dealer  Agreement;  b)  meet  all of the
     applicable  Toyota or Lexus Market  Representation  policies and standards;
     and c) meet applicable performance criteria for the most recent twelve (12)
     month period.

C.   In  order to allow  TMS  sufficient  time to  evaluate  performance  at its
     existing  dealerships,  an entity may not acquire any additional  Toyota or
     Lexus  dealership  within  nine {9)  months of its prior  acquisition  of a
     similar make dealership.

D.   If the purchase of any Toyota or Lexus dealership would result in exceeding
     the  limits  set forth in  Paragraph  1 above,  TMS will  reject a dealer's
     application  for approval of the ownership  transfer until such time as the
     dealer shall divest  itself of the  appropriate  number of  dealerships  to
     bring it into compliance with the requirements of this Agreement.



<PAGE>



WHEREAS,  Sonic and TMS are willing to resolve these issues in  accordance  with
the terms set forth herein,

NOW THEREFORE, Sonic and TMS agree as follows:

1.   CHANGE IN OWNERSHIP OF SONIC

     TMS shall have the right to approve any ownership or voting rights of Sonic
     of twenty  percent (20%) or greater by any  individual or entity;  PROVIDED
     HOWEVER,  that if TMS reasonably  determines that such individual or entity
     is  unqualified  to own a Toyota  or  Lexus  dealership,  or has  interests
     incompatible  with TMS, and such transfer is effected,  Sonic must,  within
     ninety (90) days from the date of notification by TMS of its determination,
     either:  a) transfer  the assets of its Toyota and Lexus  dealerships  to a
     third party  acceptable  to TMS; b)  voluntarily  terminate  its Toyota and
     Lexus  Dealership  Agreements;  or c) demonstrate  that such  individual or
     entity in fact owns less that 20% of the  outstanding  shares of Sonic,  or
     does not have 20% of the voting rights in Sonic.

2.   OWNERSHIP OF CONTIGUOUS DEALERSHIPS

     Sonic shall not own contiguous  dealerships (as that term is defined in the
     applicable  Toyota  or  Lexus  Dealer  Agreement  or  policy)  with  common
     boundaries.

3.   SEPARATE ENTITIES FOR EACH TOYOTA AND LEXUS DEALERSHIP

     Sonic  shall  create  separate  legal  entities  for each  Toyota and Lexus
     dealership which it owns, directly or through an Affiliate,  shall obtain a
     separate  motor vehicle  license for each  dealership,  and shall  maintain
     separate financial statements for each such dealership. Consistent with TMS
     policy,  the name  "Toyota" or "Lexus," as  applicable  shall appear in the
     d/b/a of each dealership.

4.   FACILITY STANDARDS

     In no  instance  shall a Toyota or Lexus  dealership  or any  department(s)
     thereof  be  dualled  with any  other  brand  without  TMS'  prior  written
     approval.



                                       3
<PAGE>



5.   GENERAL MANAGERS

     Each Toyota and Lexus  dealership owned or controlled by Sonic shall have a
     qualified,  approved  (subject to the exception noted in Paragraph 6 below)
     General  Manager.  Each General  Manager  shall work at the Toyota or Lexus
     dealership premises,  shall devote all of his/her efforts to the management
     of the dealership and shall have no other business  interests or management
     responsibilities.

6.   APPROVAL OF THE GENERAL MANAGER

     Whenever Sonic  nominates a new General  Manager  candidate for a Toyota or
     Lexus  dealership,  TMS  shall  have  the  right  to  withhold  a  decision
     concerning approval or rejection of the candidate for a period of up to one
     year, at its sole  discretion;  PROVIDED,  HOWEVER,  that the candidate may
     operate  in the  capacity  of General  Manager  until TMS has  approved  or
     rejected him/her.

7.   LIMITATIONS ON THE AUTHORITY OF THE GENERAL MANAGER

     Sonic  shall  advise  TMS  of  the  limitations,  by  category  and,  where
     applicable,  by specific  action,  on the authority of the General  Manager
     regarding  the operation of the  dealership,  and shall provide the name of
     the  individual at Sonic who has such authority with respect to each listed
     category or specific action, in accordance with Paragraph 8 below.

8.   IDENTIFICATION OF SONIC CONTACT OFFICIAL

     Sonic shall identify, in each Toyota and Lexus Dealer Agreement,  the Sonic
     executive  (other  than the  General  Manager of the  dealership)  who will
     respond directly to any Toyota or Lexus concerns regarding the operation or
     performance of the dealership, which executive will have full authority, in
     accordance with Sonic management policies,  to resolve issues raised by TMS
     in connection with the operation of the dealership.



                                       4
<PAGE>



9.   SELLING TOYOTA AND LEXUS PRODUCTS

     Sonic  shall  make  available  to the  customers  at its  Toyota  and Lexus
     dealerships,  all Toyota products,  including  vehicles,  Genuine Parts and
     Accessories,  retail  financing  (whether  for  purchases  or  leases)  and
     extended service contracts.

10.  REPRESENTATION ON TOYOTA AND LEXUS DEALER ORGANIZATIONS

     No more than one  representative  each from the  Toyota,  and,  separately,
     Lexus,  dealerships owned, directly or through an Affiliate,  by Sonic, may
     serve on the National Dealer Council or any future Toyota or Lexus national
     board(s) which may be established, and no more than one representative each
     may serve on either a Regional or Area Dealer  Council,  or Toyota or Lexus
     Dealer Association Board of Directors.

11.  DEALERSHIP PERSONNEL TRAINING

     Sonic shall not substitute  training courses or  certification  programs of
     its own for those  provided or sponsored by TMS without the prior  approval
     of TMS.

12.  PUBLIC OFFERING OF SECURITIES BY SONIC

     TMS shall not object to a public offering of securities by Sonic so long as
     the  limitations on ownership of voting control of Sonic  contained in this
     agreement are not exceeded or breached in any way. In addition,  TMS hereby
     approves the  increase to 100% in equity  interest in each Toyota and Lexus
     dealership  in which  subsidiaries  of Sonic  now  have a  majority  equity
     interest.

13.  FINANCIAL DISCLOSURES

     Sonic shall provide TMS with copies of all  information and materials filed
     with the Securities  Exchange  Commission,  including,  but not limited to,
     quarterly and annual financial  statement  filings,  prospectuses and other
     materials related to Sonic.



                                       5
<PAGE>



14.  PROSPECTUS DISCLAIMER AND INDEMNIFICATION AND HOLD HARMLESS AGREEMENT

     Sonic shall place in its registration statement and its prospectus, as well
     as in any other  document  offering  shares  in Sonic to public or  private
     investors, the following disclaimer:

          No  Manufacturer  (as defined in this  Prospectus)  has been involved,
          directly or indirectly,  in the  preparation of this  Prospectus or in
          the  Offering  being  made  hereby.   No  Manufacturer  has  made  any
          statements or  representations  in connection with the Offering or has
          provided any  information  or materials  that were used in  connection
          with the Offering,  and no Manufacturer has any responsibility for the
          accuracy or completeness of this Prospectus.

     Sonic shall  indemnify  and hold  harmless TMS pursuant to the terms of the
     Indemnification  and Hold  Harmless  Agreement set forth in Attachment 1 to
     this Agreement.

15.  SOLE AGREEMENT OF THE PARTIES

     There are no prior  agreements or  understandings,  either oral or written,
     between the Parties affecting this Agreement, except as otherwise specified
     or referred to in this Agreement.  No change or addition to, or deletion of
     any portion of this  Agreement  shall be valid or binding  upon the parties
     hereto  unless  approved  in  writing  signed by an  officer of each of the
     parties hereto.

16.  SEVERABILITY

     If any provision of this Agreement  should be held invalid or unenforceable
     for any reason  whatsoever,  or conflicts  with any  applicable  law,  this
     Agreement will be considered  divisible as to such  provision(s),  and such
     provision(s)  will be  deemed  amended  to comply  with such law,  or if it
     (they) cannot be so amended without  materially  affecting the tenor of the
     Agreement,  then it (they) will be deemed  



                                       6
<PAGE>



     deleted from this Agreement in such  jurisdiction,  and in either case, the
     remainder of the Agreement will be valid and binding.

17.  NO IMPLIED WAIVERS

     The failure of either party at any time to require performance by the other
     party of any  provision  herein  shall in no way  affect  the right of such
     party to require such  performance  an any time  thereafter,  nor shall any
     waiver by any party of a breach of any provision herein constitute a waiver
     of any succeeding breach of the same or any other provision, nor constitute
     a waiver of the provision itself.

18.  TMS POLICIES

     This Agreement refers to certain policies and standards. Sonic acknowledges
     that  these  policies  and  standards  are  prepared  by TMS  in  its  sole
     discretion  based  upon  TMS'  evaluation  of  the  marketplace.   TMS  may
     reasonably amend its policies and standards from time to time

19.  APPLICABLE LAW

     This Agreement shall be governed by and construed  according to the laws of
     California.

20.  BENEFIT

     This  Agreement is entered into by and between TMS and Sonic for their sole
     and mutual  benefit.  Neither this  Agreement  nor any  specific  provision
     contained  in it is intended or shall be construed to be for the benefit of
     any third party.

21.  NOTICE TO THE PARTIES

     Any notices  permitted or required under the terms of this Agreement  shall
     be directed to the  following  respective  addresses of the parties,  or if
     either of the parties  shall have  specified  another  address by notice in
     writing to the other party, then to the address last specified:




                                       7
<PAGE>



     TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
     19001 South Western Avenue
     Torrance, California 90509

     SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
     P.O. Box 18747
     Charlotte, NC 28218

IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the parties have  executed  this  Agreement as of the date
first above written.

                                             SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.


                                             BY: /s/ O. Bruton Smith
                                                 ------------------------------

                                             ITS: Chief Executive Officer
                                                  -----------------------------


                                             TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.


                                             BY:
                                                -------------------------------

                                             ITS:
                                                 ------------------------------




                                       8
    

   


                            [LOGO]Ford Motor Company
                               Charlotte District

                        Ford Sales and Service Agreement


AGREEMENT  made as of the 24th day of Feb,  1978,  by and 
between  Town & Country Ford, Inc.
                   (Name of Entity)

a North Carolina corporation
(State  whether an individual,            (if the latter, show name of the state
 partnership or  corporation)                     in which incorporated)

doing business as Town & Country Ford, Inc.
                      (Trade Name)

and with a principal place of business at  4120 E. Independence Blvd.
                                               (Street Address)

Charlotte           Mecklenburg           North Carolina            28205
(City)             (County)              (State)                   (Zip Code)

(hereafter called the "Dealer") and Ford Motor Company,  a Delaware  corporation
with its principal place of business at Dearborn,  Michigan  (hereinafter called
the "Company").

                                    PREAMBLE

     The  purpose  of  this  agreement  is to (i)  establish  the  Dealer  as an
authorized  dealer in COMPANY PRODUCTS  including  VEHICLES (as herein defined),
(ii) set forth the respective  responsibilities  of the Company in producing and
selling  those  products  to the  Dealer  and of the  Dealer  in  reselling  and
providing  service  for them and (iii)  recognize  the  interdependence  of both
parties in achieving their mutual objectives of satisfactory sales,  service and
profits by continuing to develop and retain a broad base of satisfied  owners of
COMPANY PRODUCTS.

     In entering into this agreement,  the Company and the Dealer recognize that
the success of the Company and of each of its authorized dealers depends largely
on the reputation and competitiveness of COMPANY PRODUCTS and dealers' services,
and on how well each fulfills its responsibilities under this agreement.

     It is the opinion of the Company that sales and service of COMPANY PRODUCTS
usually  can best be  provided  to the  public  through a system of  independent
franchised dealers,  with each dealer fulfilling its responsibilities in a given
locality  from  properly   located,   adequate,   well-equipped  and  attractive
dealerships,  which are staffed by competent  personnel  and  provided  with the
necessary  working  capital.  The Dealer  recognizes  that,  in such a franchise
system,  the Company  must plan for the  establishment  and  maintenance  of the
numbers,  locations and sizes of dealers  necessary for  satisfactory and proper
sales and  service  representa-



                                        i
FD925
GEN. SALE 1-76



<PAGE>



tion in each  market area as it exists and as it develops  and  changes.  At the
same  time,  the  Company  endeavors  to  provide  each  of its  dealers  with a
reasonable  profit  opportunity  based on the potential for sales and service of
COMPANY PRODUCTS within its locality.

     The Company endeavors to make available to its dealers a variety of quality
products,  responsive to broad wants and needs of the buying  public,  which are
attractively  styled, of sound engineering design and produced on a timely basis
at competitive  prices.  The  development,  production and sale of such products
require that the Company and its  manufacturing  sources  make large  continuing
investments in plants,  equipment,  tools and other facilities,  engineering and
styling research and development,  quality control procedures, trained personnel
and marketing  programs.  Heavy commitments must also be made in advance for raw
materials  and finished  parts.  For purposes of making  these  investments  and
commitments,  planning  production and estimating costs for setting prices,  the
Company assumes in advance an estimated volume of sales for each of it products.
Within each year, it develops production  schedules from orders submitted by its
franchised  dealers and its and their best  estimates  of the market  demand for
COMPANY PRODUCTS.

     In  turn,  each  of  the  Company's   franchised  dealers  makes  important
investments or commitments in retail sales and service facilities and equipment,
in working  capital,  in inventories  of vehicles,  parts and  accessories,  and
trained sales and service  personnel based on annual planning  volumes for their
markets.

     If  satisfactory  volumes  for  either  the  Company  or a  dealer  are not
realized,  each may suffer because of  commitments  already made and the cost of
manufacturing  and of selling  each product may be  increased.  Each dealer must
give the Company orders for the products needed to serve its market. The Company
seeks to adjust  production  schedules,  to the extent feasible,  to fill dealer
orders,  and to allocate fairly any product in short supply, but inevitably both
the  Company  and its  dealers  suffer loss of profits to the extent they cannot
meet market  demands.  Thus, the automotive  business is a high risk business in
which the Company,  its  manufacturing  sources and its dealers can succeed only
through  cooperative  and  competitive  effort  in  their  respective  areas  of
manufacturing, sales, service and customer satisfaction.

     Since it is the dealer who deals  directly  with,  and develops the sale of
COMPANY PRODUCTS to, the consuming public, the Company  substantially  relies on
its dealers to provide  successful sales and merchandising  programs,  competent
service operations and effective owner relations  programs.  To do this, dealers
must carry out their  responsibilities of establishing and maintaining  adequate
wholesale and retail finance plans,  new and used vehicle sales programs,  parts
and service sales programs, personnel training and supportive capitalization and
working capital.  To assist its dealers in these  responsibilities,  the Company
establishes and periodically  updates standards of operation and planning guides
based on its experience and current conditions. It also offers sales and service
training courses,  advice as to facilities,  counseling in the various phases of
dealership  operations and,  through other  agreements and the activities of its
affiliates,  assistance in financing, new and used vehicle merchandising,  parts
and service merchandising, leasing, daily rentals and facilities development. It
also conducts national advertising, promotional and other marketing programs and
assists dealers in developing complementary group and individual programs.

     To enable the Company to provide such  assistance,  it requires  dealers to
submit uniform and accurate sales, operating and financial reports from which it
can derive and disseminate  analytical and comparative operating data and advice
to dealers.  The Company also solicits dealers to bring to its attention through
their  National  Dealer  Council  organization  any mutual  dealer  problems  or
complaints as they arise.

     Because the Company relies heavily on its dealers for success,  it reserves
the  right to cease  doing  business  with any  dealer  who is not  contributing
sufficiently to such success. Similarly, the Company recognizes that its dealers
look to it to provide competitive products and programs and that, if it does not
do so, any dealer may elect to cease doing business with the Company.

     The Company has elected to enter into this  agreement  with the Dealer with
confidence in the Dealer's integrity and ability, its intention to carry out its
responsibilities  set  forth  in this  agreement,  and  its  desire  


                                       ii


<PAGE>



to provide courteous,  competent and satisfying sales and service representation
to consumers for COMPANY PRODUCTS,  and in reliance upon its  representations as
to the persons who will  participate  in the  ownership  and  management  of the
dealership.

     The Dealer has elected to enter into this  agreement  with the Company with
confidence in its integrity  and ability,  its intention to provide  competitive
products  and assist the Dealer to market them  successfully,  and its desire to
maintain high quality dealers.
     
     Both parties  recognize the rights of the Dealer and the Company under this
agreement are defined and limited by the terms of this  agreement and applicable
law. 

     The  Company  and the Dealer  further  acknowledge  that  their  methods of
operation and business  practices have an important  effect on the reputation of
the Dealer,  the Company,  COMPANY PRODUCTS and other franchised  dealers of the
Company.  The Company and the Dealer also acknowledge that certain practices are
detrimental  to their  interests,  such as  deceptive,  misleading  or confusing
advertising,  pricing,  merchandising or business practices,  or misrepresenting
the characteristics, quality, condition or origin of any item of sale.

     It is the  expectation  of each of the parties  that by entering  into this
agreement,  and by the full  and  faithful  observance  and  performance  of its
duties, a mutually satisfactory relationship will be established and maintained.

     IN CONSIDERATION of the mutual agreements and  acknowledgments  hereinafter
made, the parties hereto agree as follows:

     A. The Company hereby appoints the Dealer as an authorized dealer at retail
in VEHICLES and at retail and wholesale in other COMPANY PRODUCTS and grants the
Dealer the privilege of buying COMPANY PRODUCTS from the Company for sale in its
DEALERSHIP OPERATIONS (as herein defined). The Company also grants to the Dealer
the privilege of displaying, at approved locations(s),  the Company's trademarks
and trade names applicable to COMPANY  PRODUCTS.  The Dealer hereby accepts such
appointment.

     B.  Subject  to and in  accordance  with the terms and  conditions  of this
agreement,  the Company shall sell COMPANY PRODUCTS to the Dealer and the Dealer
shall purchase COMPANY PRODUCTS from the Company.

     C. The Ford  Motor  Company  Ford  Sales  and  Service  Agreement  Standard
Provisions  (Form  "FD925-A Gen. Sale 1-76"),  a duplicate  original of which is
attached to the Dealer's  duplicate  original of this agreement,  have been read
and agreed to by the Company and by the Dealer, and such Standard Provisions and
any duly executed and delivered supplement or amendment thereto, are hereby made
a part of this  agreement  with the same force and effect as if set forth herein
in full.

     D. This  agreement  shall  bind the  Company  when it bears  the  facsimile
signature of the General Manager, and the manual countersignature of the General
Sales Manager,  Market  Representation  Manager, or a Regional or District Sales
Manager, of the Ford Division of the Company and a duplicate original thereof is
delivered personally or by mail to the Dealer or the Dealer's principal place of
business.

     E. The Dealer  acknowledges that (i) this agreement may be executed only in
the manner  provided  in  paragraph  D hereof,  (ii) no one  except the  General
Manager, The General Sales Manager, or Market Representation Manager of the Ford
Division of the  Company,  or the  Secretary  or an  Assistant  Secretary of the
Company,  is authorized to make or execute any other  agreement  relating to the
subject  matter  hereof on behalf of the  Company,  or in any manner to enlarge,
vary or modify the terms of this  agreement,  and then only by an  instrument in
writing, and (iii) no one except the General Manager of the Ford Division of the
Company,  or  the  Secretary  or an  Assistant  Secretary  of  the  Company,  is
authorized to terminate this  agreement on behalf of the Company,  and then only
by an instrument in writing.

     F. In view of the personal  nature of this agreement and its objectives and
purposes,  the Company expressly  reserves to itself the right to execute a Ford
Sales and Service  Agreement with  individuals  or other  entities  specifically
selected and approved by the Company. Accordingly, this agreement and the rights
and  privileges   conferred  on  the  Dealer  hereunder  are  not  transferable,
assignable or salable by the Dealer and no property right or interest, direct or
indirect,  is sold,  conveyed or transferred to the Dealer under this agreement.
This  agreement has been entered into by the Company with the Dealer in reliance
(i) upon the representation and


                                      iii



<PAGE>





agreement that the following  person(s),  and only the following person(s) shall
be the principal owners of the Dealer:

  NAME                        HOME                               PERCENTAGE
                              ADDRESS                            OF INTEREST
Bruton Smith                  Rockford, Ill.                     80
                             
(ii) upon the representation and agreement that the following person(s) and only
the following person(s),  shall have full managerial authority for the operating
management of the Dealer in the performance of this agreement:

  NAME                        HOME                               TITLE
                              ADDRESS
Bruton Smith                  Rockford, Ill.                     President

and (iii) upon  representation and agreement that the following  person(s),  and
only the following person(s), shall be the remaining owners of the Dealer:


NAME                          HOME                               PERCENTAGE
                              ADDRESS                            OF INTEREST
Anne K. Davis                 Charlotte, N.C.                    20


The Dealer shall give the Company  prior  notice of any  proposed  change in the
said  ownership or managerial  authority,  and immediate  notice of the death or
incapacity  of any such person.  No such change or notice,  and no assignment of
this agreement or of any right or interest  herein,  shall be effective  against
the  Company  unless  and  until  embodied  in an  appropriate  amendment  to or
assignment of this agreement, as the case may be, duly executed and delivered by
the Company and by the Dealer.  The Company shall not unreasonably  withhold its
consent to any such change.

     G. (Strike out either subparagraph (1) or (2)whichever is not applicable.)

     (1)  This agreement shall continue in force and effect from the date of its
          execution  until  terminated  by either party under the  provisions of
          paragraph 17 hereof.
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

     H.  Both the  Company  and the  Dealer  assume  and  agree to carry out and
perform their respective responsibilities under this agreement.

     IN WITNESS  WHEREOF the parties hereto have duly executed this agreement in
duplicate as of the day and year first above written.
                                 
[LOGO] Ford Motor Company                    Town & Country Ford, Inc.
                                             (Dealers Trade Name)
Countersigned by

/s/ [ILLEGIBLE]                              By:/s/ Bruton Smith               
- -----------------------------                ------------------------------     
General Manager, Ford Division               (Title) President                  
                                             

Countersigned by

/s/ [ILLEGIBLE]                    
- -----------------------------      
Distric Sales manager              


                                       iv

                                             
<PAGE>


                                        Date December 1, 1983


To:  Mr. J.R. Slough
     District Sales Manager
     Ford Division Ford Motor Company
     P.O. Box 220307
     Charlotte, North Carolina 28222


In  accordance  with  your  request,  we are  furnishing  you  herewith  certain
information concerning the present ownership and management of our dealership.

Principal Owners:                       Names and Titles         % of Ownership
- -----------------                       ----------------         --------------
                                        Bruton Smith                  100



Persons(s) Having Full Managerial
Authority and Responsibility:           Bruton Smith



Nominee Successor (if any):
- ---------------------------



If Above Manager Does Not Own
Majority Interest in the Dealership
Does He Have Buy-Out Option:
- -----------------------------------     Yes_____  No_____

Dealership is Operating as a:
- -----------------------------           Propietorship ___

                                        Partnership   ___

                                        Corporation   _X_



Trade Name Incorrect: _____

Address Incorrect:    _____



                                        Town & Country Ford, Inc
                                        ---------------------------------------
                                        (Dealership Trade Name)

                                        5401 East Independence Blvd.
                                        ---------------------------------------
                                        (Dealership Street Address)

                                        Charlotte, N.C. 28212
                                        ---------------------------------------
                                        (City and State)

                                        By /s/ Bruton Smith
                                           ------------------------------------
                                           (Signature and Title) President


<PAGE>


(LOGO) Ford Motor Company                                      
                               Charlotte District

                                  Amendment To

FORD SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT                        dated February 24, 1978
FOREIGN VEHICLE SALES AGREEMENT (COURIER)               dated February 24, 1978
FOREIGN VEHICLE SALES AGREEMENT (FIESTA)                dated February 24, 1978

[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX


SUPPLEMENTAL AGREEMENT, made at Dearborn, Michigan  as of this 27th day  of Jan,
1984 by and between Town & Country Ford, Inc.
                    (Name of Entity)

a North Carolina Corporation
(State whether partnership or corporation) (If the latter, show name of state in
                                                        which incorporated) 
doing business as Town & Country Ford, Inc.
                   (Trade Name)

and with a principal place of business at  5401 E. Independence Boulevard
                                             (Street Address)

Charlotte           Mecklenburg              North Carolina      28205
(City)              (County)                 (State)             (Zip Code)

(hereinafter called the "Dealer") and Ford Motor Company, a Delaware corporation
with its principal place of business at Dearborn,  Michigan  (hereinafter called
the "Company").

     The parties hereto have previously  entered into the above designated Sales
and Service or Sales  Agreements  (hereinafter  "Agreements")  and now desire to
make certain changes therein.

     NOW,  THEREFORE, in consideration  of these  premises,  the parties  hereto
mutually agree that said  Agreements be amended by changing  Paragraph F to read
as follows:

     F. In view of the personal nature of these  Agreements and their objectives
and purposes, the Company expressly reserves to itself the right to execute said
Agreements with individuals or other entities specifically selected and approved
by the Company.  Accordingly,  these  Agreements  and the rights and  privileges
conferred on the Dealer hereunder are not transferable, assignable or salable by
the Dealer and  no property  right or  interest,  direct or  indirect,  is sold,
conveyed or transferred to the Dealer under these  Agreements.  These Agreements
have been  entered  into by the Company with the Dealer in reliance (i) upon the
representation  and  agreement  that  the  following  person(s),  and  only  the
following person(s), shall be the principal owners of the Dealer:

                              HOME                               PERCENTAGE
NAME                          ADDRESS                            OF INTEREST

Bruton Smith                  Charlotte, North Carolina               100

(ii) upon the  representation  and agreement that the following  person(s),  and
only the  following  person(s),  shall have full  managerial  authority  for the
operating management of the Dealer in the performance of these Agreements:

                              HOME
NAME                          ADDRESS                            TITLE

Bruton Smith                  Charlotte, North Carolina          President


<PAGE>



and (iii) upon the  representation  and agreement that the following  person(s),
and only the following person(s), shall be the remaining owners of the Dealer:

                              HOME                               PERCENTAGE
NAME                          ADDRESS                            OF INTEREST

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------


     The Dealer shall give the Company  prior  notice of any proposed  change in
the said ownership or managerial  authority of said Dealer, and immediate notice
of the death or incapacity of any such person. No such change or notice,  and no
amendment or assignment of these  Agreements or of any right or interest herein,
shall  be  effective  against  the  Company  unless  and  until  embodied  in an
appropriate  amendment to or assignment of these  Agreements as the case may be,
duly executed and delivered by the Company and by the Dealer.  The Company shall
not  unreasonably  withhold  its consent to any such  change.  If the  Company's
restriction  regarding  amendment or assignment  of these  Agreements is illegal
under a valid law of any jurisdiction  where such change is to take place,  this
amendment will be modified to the minimum  extent  necessary to comply with such
law if it was effective on the date of execution of these Agreements.

     This  Supplemental  Agreement  is subject  to all the terms and  conditions
contained in said Agreements, except insofar as such terms and conditions may be
inconsistent with the express terms hereof.

     IN WITNESS  WHEREOF the parties  hereto have executed this  Agreement as of
the day and year first above  written and the Company is  authorized  to deliver
the same to the Dealer by placing the Dealer's copy thereof in the United States
Mail,  duly  stamped  and  addressed  to the  Dealer at his  principal  place of
business, or by delivery to such place of business or to the Dealer in person.


FORD MOTOR COMPANY                      Town & Country Ford, Inc.
                                        ----------------------------------------
                                                 (Dealer's Trade Name)


By /s/ [ILLEGIBLE]                      By /s/ Bruton Smith
   --------------------------              -------------------------------------
     Assistant Secretary                   Bruton Smith, President


- ----------------------------------------

- ----------------------------------------

- ----------------------------------------


<PAGE>


(LOGO) Ford Motor Company                                      

                                 Atlanta Region

                                  Amendment To

FORD SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT                        dated February 24, 1978
FOREIGN VEHICLE SALES AGREEMENT (COURIER)               dated February 24, 1978
FOREIGN VEHICLE SALES AGREEMENT (FIESTA)                dated February 24, 1978

[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX


SUPPLEMENTAL AGREEMENT, made at Dearborn, Michigan  as of this 17th day  of Nov,
1993, by and between Town & Country Ford, Inc.
                    (Name of Entity)

              Corporation                               North Carolina
(State whether partnership or corporation) (If the latter, show name of state in
                                                        which incorporated) 
doing business as Town & Country Ford, Inc.
                   (Trade Name)

and with a principal place of business at  5401 E. Independence Boulevard
                                             (Street Address)

Charlotte           Mecklenburg              North Carolina      28205
(City)              (County)                 (State)             (Zip Code)

(hereinafter called the "Dealer") and Ford Motor Company, a Delaware corporation
with its principal place of business at Dearborn,  Michigan  (hereinafter called
the "Company").

     The parties hereto have previously  entered into the above designated Sales
and Service or Sales  Agreements  (hereinafter  "Agreements")  and now desire to
make certain changes therein.

     NOW,  THEREFORE, in consideration  of these  premises,  the parties  hereto
mutually agree that said  Agreements be amended by changing  Paragraph F to read
as follows:

     F. In view of the personal nature of these  Agreements and their objectives
and purposes, the Company expressly reserves to itself the right to execute said
Agreements with individuals or other entities specifically selected and approved
by the Company.  Accordingly,  these  Agreements  and the rights and  privileges
conferred on the Dealer hereunder are not transferable, assignable or salable by
the Dealer and  no property  right or  interest,  direct or  indirect,  is sold,
conveyed or transferred to the Dealer under these  Agreements.  These Agreements
have been  entered  into by the Company with the Dealer in reliance (i) upon the
representation  and  agreement  that  the  following  person(s),  and  only  the
following person(s), shall be the principal owners of the Dealer:

                              HOME                               PERCENTAGE
NAME                          ADDRESS                            OF INTEREST

Bruton Smith                  2259 Sharon Lane                        80%
                              Charlotte, NC 28211

Scott Smith                   2259 Sharon Lane                        20%
                              Charlotte, NC 28211

(ii) upon the  representation  and agreement that the following  person(s),  and
only the  following  person(s),  shall have full  managerial  authority  for the
operating management of the Dealer in the performance of these Agreements:

                              HOME
NAME                          ADDRESS                            TITLE

Bruton Smith                  2259 Sharon Lane                   President
                              Charlotte, NC 28211

Scott Smith                   2259 Sharon Lane                   Vice President
                              Charlotte, NC 28211

    

                                                      



                        [LOGO]Ford Marketing Corporation

                                Houston District

                        Ford Sales and Service Agreement


AGREEMENT  made as of the 30th day of August,  1972,  by and 
between  Lone Star Ford, Inc.
           (Name of Entity)

                               a Texas Corporation
(State  whether an individual,            (if the latter, show name of the state
 partnership or  corporation)                     in which incorporated)

doing business as Lone Star Ford, Inc. and with 
                     (Trade Name)

a principal place of business at   8477 North Freeway
                                    (Street Address)

Houston            Harris                Texas                     77037
(City)             (County)              (State)                   (Zip Code)

(hereafter called the "Dealer") and Ford Motor Company,  a Delaware  corporation
with its principal place of business at Dearborn,  Michigan  (hereinafter called
the "Company").

                                    PREAMBLE

     The  purpose  of  this  agreement  is to (i)  establish  the  Dealer  as an
authorized  dealer in COMPANY PRODUCTS  including  VEHICLES (as herein defined),
(ii) set forth the respective  responsibilities  of the Company in producing and
selling  those  products  to the  Dealer  and of the  Dealer  in  reselling  and
providing  service  for them and (iii)  recognize  the  interdependence  of both
parties in achieving their mutual objectives of satisfactory sales,  service and
profits by continuing to develop and retain a broad base of satisfied  owners of
COMPANY PRODUCTS.

     In entering into this agreement,  the Company and the Dealer recognize that
the success of the Company and of each of its authorized dealers depends largely
on the reputation and competitiveness of COMPANY PRODUCTS and dealers' services,
and on how well each fulfills its responsibilities under this agreement.

     It is the opinion of the Company that sales and service of COMPANY PRODUCTS
usually  can best be  provided  to the  public  through a system of  independent
franchised dealers,  with each dealer fulfilling its responsibilities in a given
locality  from  properly   located,   adequate,   well-equipped  and  attractive
dealerships,  which are staffed by competent  personnel  and  provided  with the
necessary  working  capital.  The Dealer  recognizes  that,  in such a franchise
system,  the Company  must plan for the  establishment  and  maintenance  of the
numbers,  locations and sizes of dealers  necessary for  satisfactory and proper
sales and  service  representa-



                                        i
[LOGO] FORD
FD925
GEN. SALE 1-72



<PAGE>



tion in each  market area as it exists and as it develops  and  changes.  At the
same  time,  the  Company  endeavors  to  provide  each  of its  dealers  with a
reasonable  profit  opportunity  based on the potential for sales and service of
COMPANY PRODUCTS within its locality.

     The Company endeavors to make available to its dealers a variety of quality
products,  responsive to broad wants and needs of the buying  public,  which are
attractively  styled, of sound engineering design and produced on a timely basis
at competitive  prices.  The  development,  production and sale of such products
require that the Company and its  manufacturing  sources  make large  continuing
investments in plants,  equipment,  tools and other facilities,  engineering and
styling research and development,  quality control procedures, trained personnel
and marketing  programs.  Heavy commitments must also be made in advance for raw
materials  and finished  parts.  For purposes of making  these  investments  and
commitments,  planning  production and estimating costs for setting prices,  the
Company  assumes  in  advance  an  estimated  volume  of  sales  for each of its
products.  Within  each year,  it  develops  production  schedules  from  orders
submitted  by its  franchised  dealers and its and their best  estimates  of the
market demand for COMPANY PRODUCTS.

     In  turn,  each  of  the  Company's   franchised  dealers  makes  important
investments or commitments in retail sales and service facilities and equipment,
in working  capital,  in inventories  of vehicles,  parts and  accessories,  and
trained sales and service  personnel based on annual planning  volumes for their
markets.

     If  satisfactory  volumes  for  either  the  Company  or a  dealer  are not
realized,  each may suffer because of  commitments  already made and the cost of
manufacturing  and of selling  each  product may be  increased.  Each month each
dealer must give the Company orders for the products needed to serve his market.
During the month each dealer should submit specific orders for products  covered
by his basic order. If dealers' specific orders for any product are greater than
or different  from their basic orders,  the Company  seeks to adjust  production
schedules to the extent  feasible,  and to allocate  fairly any product in short
supply,  but inevitably  both the Company and its dealers suffer loss of profits
to the extent they cannot meet market demands.  Thus, the automotive business is
a high risk  business in which the Company,  its  manufacturing  sources and its
dealers can succeed only through  cooperative  and  competitive  effort in their
respective areas of manufacturing, sales, service and customer satisfaction.

     Since it is the dealer who deals  directly  with,  and develops the sale of
COMPANY PRODUCTS to, the consuming public, the Company  substantially  relies on
its dealers to provide  successful sales and merchandising  programs,  competent
service operations and effective owner relations  programs.  To do this, dealers
must carry out their  responsibilities of establishing and maintaining  adequate
wholesale and retail finance plans,  new and used vehicle sales programs,  parts
and service sales programs, personnel training and supportive capitalization and
working capital.  To assist its dealers in these  responsibilities,  the Company
establishes and periodically  updates standards of operation and planning guides
based on its experience and current conditions. It also offers sales and service
training courses,  advice as to facilities,  counseling in the various phases of
dealership  operations and,  through other  agreements and the activities of its
affiliates,  assistance in financing, new and used vehicle merchandising,  parts
and service merchandising, leasing, daily rentals and facilities development. It
also conducts national advertising, promotional and other marketing programs and
assists dealers in developing complementary group and individual programs.

     To enable the Company to provide such  assistance,  it requires  dealers to
submit uniform and accurate sales, operating and financial reports from which it
can derive and disseminate  analytical and comparative operating data and advice
to dealers.  The Company also solicits dealers to bring to its attention through
their  National  Dealer  Council  organization  any mutual  dealer  problems  or
complaints as they arise.

     Because the Company relies heavily on its dealers for success,  it reserves
the  right to cease  doing  business  with any  dealer  who is not  contributing
sufficiently to such success. Similarly, the Company recognizes that its dealers
look to it to provide competitive products and programs and that, if it does not
do so, any dealer may elect to cease doing business with the Company.

     The Company has elected to enter into this  agreement  with the Dealer with
confidence in the Dealer's integrity and ability, his intention to carry out his
responsibilities  set  forth  in this  agreement,  and  his  desire  


                                       ii


<PAGE>



to provide courteous,  competent and satisfying sales and service representation
to consumers for COMPANY PRODUCTS,  and in reliance upon its  representations as
to the persons who will  participate  in the  ownership  and  management  of the
dealership.

     The Dealer has elected to enter into this  agreement  with the Company with
confidence in its integrity  and ability,  its intention to provide  competitive
products  and assist the Dealer to market them  successfully,  and its desire to
maintain high quality dealers.
     
     Both parties  recognize the rights of the Dealer and the Company under this
agreement are defined and limited by the terms of this  agreement and applicable
law. 

     The  Company  and the Dealer  further  acknowledge  that  their  methods of
operation and business  practices have an important  effect on the reputation of
the Dealer,  the Company,  COMPANY PRODUCTS and other franchised  dealers of the
Company.  The Company and the Dealer also acknowledge that certain practices are
detrimental  to their  interests,  such as  deceptive,  misleading  or confusing
advertising,  pricing,  merchandising or business practices,  or misrepresenting
the characteristics, quality, condition or origin of any item of sale.

     It is the  expectation  of each of the parties  that by entering  into this
agreement,  and by the full  and  faithful  observance  and  performance  of its
duties, a mutually satisfactory relationship will be established and maintained.

     IN CONSIDERATION of the mutual agreements and  acknowledgments  hereinafter
made, the parties hereto agree as follows:

     A. The Company hereby appoints the Dealer as an authorized dealer at retail
in VEHICLES and at retail and wholesale in other COMPANY PRODUCTS and grants the
Dealer the privilege of buying COMPANY PRODUCTS from the Company for sale in its
DEALERSHIP OPERATIONS (as herein defined). The Company also grants to the Dealer
the privilege of displaying, at approved locations(s),  the Company's trademarks
and trade names applicable to COMPANY  PRODUCTS.  The Dealer hereby accepts such
appointment.

     B.  Subject  to and in  accordance  with the terms and  conditions  of this
agreement,  the Company shall sell COMPANY PRODUCTS to the Dealer and the Dealer
shall purchase COMPANY PRODUCTS from the Company.

     C. The Ford Marketing Corporation Ford Sales and Service Agreement Standard
Provisions  (Form "FD925-A  GEN.SALE  4-72"),  a duplicate  original of which is
attached to the Dealer's  duplicate  original of this agreement,  have been read
and agreed to by the Company and by the Dealer, and such Standard Provisions and
any duly executed and delivered supplement or amendment thereto, are hereby made
a part of this  agreement  with the same force and effect as if set forth herein
in full.

     D. This  agreement  shall  bind the  Company  when it bears  the  facsimile
signature of the General Manager, and the manual countersignature of the General
Sales Manager,  Market  Representation  Manager, or a Regional or District Sales
Manager, of the Ford Division of the Company and a duplicate original thereof is
delivered personally or by mail to the Dealer or the Dealer's principal place of
business.

     E. The Dealer  acknowledges that (i) this agreement may be executed only in
the manner  provided  in  paragraph  D hereof,  (ii) no one  except the  General
Manager, the General Sales Manager, or Market Representation Manager of the Ford
Division of the  Company,  or the  Secretary  or an  Assistant  Secretary of the
Company,  is authorized to make or execute any other  agreement  relating to the
subject  matter  hereof on behalf of the  Company,  or in any manner to enlarge,
vary or modify the terms of this  agreement,  and then only by an  instrument in
writing, and (iii) no one except the General Manager of the Ford Division of the
Company,  or  the  Secretary  or an  Assistant  Secretary  of  the  Company,  is
authorized to terminate this  agreement on behalf of the Company,  and then only
by an instrument in writing.

     F. In view of the personal  nature of this agreement and its objectives and
purposes,  the Company expressly  reserves to itself the right to execute a Ford
Sales and Service  Agreement with  individuals  or other  entities  specifically
selected and approved by the Company. Accordingly, this agreement and the rights
and  privileges   conferred  on  the  Dealer  hereunder  are  not  transferable,
assignable or salable by the Dealer and no property right or interest, direct or
indirect,  is sold,  conveyed or transferred to the Dealer under this agreement.
This  agreement has been entered into by the Company with the Dealer in reliance
(i) upon the representation and


                                      iii



<PAGE>




agreement that the following  person(s),  and only the following person(s) shall
be the principal owners of the Dealer:

  NAME                        HOME                               PERCENTAGE
                              ADDRESS                            OF INTEREST
Bruton Smith                  Rockford, Illinois                      95%

                             
(ii) upon the representation and agreement that the following person(s) and only
the following person(s),  shall have full managerial authority for the operating
management of the Dealer in the performance of this agreement,

  NAME                        HOME                               TITLE
                              ADDRESS
Charles A. West               Houston, Texas                     Vice President

and (iii) upon  representation and agreement that the following  person(s),  and
only the following person(s), shall be the remaining owners of the Dealer


NAME                          HOME                               PERCENTAGE
                              ADDRESS                            OF INTEREST
Charles A. West               Houston, Texas                          5%


The Dealer shall give the Company  prior  notice of any  proposed  change in the
said  ownership or managerial  authority,  and immediate  notice of the death or
incapacity  of any such person.  No such change or notice,  and no assignment of
this agreement or of any right or interest  herein,  shall be effective  against
the  Company  unless  and  until  embodied  in an  appropriate  amendment  to or
assignment of this agreement, as the case may be, duly executed and delivered by
the Company and by the Dealer.  The Company shall not unreasonably  withhold its
consent to any such change.

     G. (Strike out either subparagraph (1) or (2) whichever is not applicable.)

     (1)  This agreement shall continue in force and effect from the date of its
          execution  until  terminated  by either party under the  provisions of
          paragraph 17 hereof.

[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
       XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
       XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

     H.  Both the  Company  and the  Dealer  assume  and  agree to carry out and
perform their respective responsibilities under this agreement.

     IN WITNESS  WHEREOF the parties hereto have duly executed this agreement in
duplicate as of the day and year first above written.
                                 
[LOGO] Ford Marketing Corporation            Lone Star Ford, Inc.
/s/ [ILLEGIBLE]                              (Dealers Trade Name)

General Manager, Ford Division               By: /s/ Bruton Smith
                                                 ------------------------------
                                                 Bruton Smith
                                                (Title) President
                                                        -----------------------
Countersigned by

/s/ D.M. Shultz                            
- -----------------------------              
D.M. Shultz
District Sales Manager                     
                                           
                                       iv
                                             
    

   


                            [LOGO]Ford Motor Company
                                 Atlanta Region

                        Ford Sales and Service Agreement


AGREEMENT  made as of the 27th day of August, 1996,  by and 
between  Fort Mill Ford LLC
                   (Name of Entity)

Limited Liability Corporation                            South Carolina
(State  whether an individual,                 (Show name of the State in which
 partnership or  corporation)                        incorporated or registered)

doing business as Fort Mill Ford 
                    (Trade Name)

and with a principal place of business at 788 Gold Hill Road
                                           (Street Address)

Fort Mill           York                  SC                        29715
(CITY)             (COUNTY)              (STATE)                   (ZIP-CODE)

(hereafter called the "Dealer") and Ford Motor Company,  a Delaware  corporation
with its principal place of business at Dearborn,  Michigan  (hereinafter called
the "Company").

                                   -PREAMBLE-

     The  purpose  of  this  agreement  is to (i)  establish  the  Dealer  as an
authorized  dealer in COMPANY PRODUCTS  including  VEHICLES (as herein defined),
(ii) set forth the respective  responsibilities  of the Company in producing and
selling  those  products  to the  Dealer  and of the  Dealer  in  reselling  and
providing  service  for them and (iii)  recognize  the  interdependence  of both
parties in achieving their mutual objectives of satisfactory sales,  service and
profits by continuing to develop and retain a broad base of satisfied  owners of
COMPANY PRODUCTS.

     In entering into this agreement,  the Company and the Dealer recognize that
the success of the Company and of each of its authorized dealers depends largely
on the reputation and competitiveness of COMPANY PRODUCTS and dealers' services,
and on how well each fulfills its responsibilities under this agreement.

     It is the opinion of the Company that sales and service of COMPANY PRODUCTS
usually  can best be  provided  to the  public  through a system of  independent
franchised dealers,  with each dealer fulfilling its responsibilities in a given
locality  from  properly   located,   adequate,   well-equipped  and  attractive
dealerships,  which are staffed by competent  personnel  and  provided  with the
necessary  working  capital.  The Dealer  recognizes  that,  in such a franchise
system,  the Company  must plan for the  establishment  and  maintenance  of the
numbers,  locations and sizes of dealers  necessary for  satisfactory and proper
sales and  service  representation  in each  market  area as it exists and as it
develops and changes. At the same time, the Company endeavors to provide each of
its dealers with a reasonable  profit  opportunity  based on the  potential  for
sales and service of COMPANY PRODUCTS within its locality.



FD925
GEN. SALE 9/94



<PAGE>



     The Company endeavors to make available to its dealers a variety of quality
products,  responsive to broad wants and needs of the buying  public,  which are
attractively  styled, of sound engineering design and produced on a timely basis
at competitive  prices.  The  development,  production and sale of such products
require that the Company and its  manufacturing  sources  make large  continuing
investments in plants,  equipment,  tools and other facilities,  engineering and
styling research and development,  quality control procedures, trained personnel
and marketing  programs.  Heavy commitments must also be made in advance for raw
materials  and finished  parts.  For purposes of making  these  investments  and
commitments,  planning  production and estimating costs for setting prices,  the
Company assumes in advance an estimated volume of sales for each of it products.
Within each year, it develops production  schedules from orders submitted by its
franchised  dealers and its and their best  estimates  of the market  demand for
COMPANY PRODUCTS.

     In  turn,  each  of  the  Company's   franchised  dealers  makes  important
investments or commitments in retail sales and service facilities and equipment,
in working  capital,  in inventories  of vehicles,  parts and  accessories,  and
trained sales and service  personnel based on annual planning  volumes for their
markets.

     If  satisfactory  volumes  for  either  the  Company  or a  dealer  are not
realized,  each may suffer because of  commitments  already made and the cost of
manufacturing  and of selling  each product may be  increased.  Each dealer must
give the Company orders for the products needed to serve its market. The Company
seeks to adjust  production  schedules,  to the extent feasible,  to fill dealer
orders,  and to allocate fairly any product in short supply, but inevitably both
the  Company  and its  dealers  suffer loss of profits to the extent they cannot
meet market  demands.  Thus, the automotive  business is a high risk business in
which the Company,  its  manufacturing  sources and its dealers can succeed only
through  cooperative  and  competitive  effort  in  their  respective  areas  of
manufacturing, sales, service and customer satisfaction.

     Because it is the dealer who deals  directly with, and develops the sale of
COMPANY PRODUCTS to the consuming public,  the Company  substantially  relies on
its dealers to provide  successful sales and merchandising  programs,  competent
service operations and effective owner relations  programs.  To do this, dealers
must carry out their  responsibilities of establishing and maintaining  adequate
wholesale and retail finance plans,  new and used vehicle sales programs,  parts
and service sales programs, personnel training and supportive capitalization and
working capital.  To assist its dealers in these  responsibilities,  the Company
establishes and periodically  updates standards of operation and planning guides
based on its experience and current conditions. It also offers sales and service
training courses,  advice as to facilities,  counseling in the various phases of
new and used vehicle merchandising,  parts and service  merchandising,  leasing,
daily rentals and facilities development. It also conducts national advertising,
promotional  and other  marketing  programs  and assists  dealers in  developing
complementary group and individual programs.

     To enable the Company to provide such  assistance,  it requires  dealers to
submit uniform and accurate sales, operating and financial reports from which it
can derive and disseminate  analytical and comparative operating data and advice
to dealers.  The Company also solicits dealers to bring to its attention through
their  National  Dealer  Council  organization  any mutual  dealer  problems  or
complaints as they arise.

     Because the Company relies heavily on its dealers for success,  it reserves
the  right to cease  doing  business  with any  dealer  who is not  contributing
sufficiently to such success. Similarly, the Company recognizes that its dealers
look to it to provide competitive products and programs and that, if it does not
do so, any dealer may elect to cease doing business with the Company.

     The Company has elected to enter into this  agreement  with the Dealer with
confidence in the Dealer's integrity and ability, its intention to carry out its
responsibilities  set  forth  in this  agreement,  and  its  desire  to  provide
courteous,   competent  and  satisfying  sales  and  service  representation  to
consumers for COMPANY PRODUCTS,  and in reliance upon its  representations as to
the  persons  who  will  participate  in the  ownership  and  management  of the
dealership.

     The Dealer has elected to enter into this  agreement  with the Company with
confidence in its integrity  and ability,  its intention to provide  competitive
products  and assist the Dealer to market them  successfully,  and its desire to
maintain high quality dealers.


                                       ii


<PAGE>


     
     Both parties  recognize the rights of the Dealer and the Company under this
agreement are defined and limited by the terms of this  agreement and applicable
law.  The  Company  and the Dealer  further  acknowledge  that their  methods of
operation and business  practices have an important  effect on the reputation of
the Dealer,  the Company,  COMPANY PRODUCTS and other franchised  dealers of the
Company.  The Company and the Dealer also acknowledge that certain practices are
detrimental  to their  interests,  such as  deceptive,  misleading  or confusing
advertising,  pricing,  merchandising or business practices,  or misrepresenting
the characteristics, quality, condition or origin of any item of sale.

     It is the  expectation  of each of the parties  that by entering  into this
agreement,  and by the full  and  faithful  observance  and  performance  of its
duties, a mutually satisfactory relationship will be established and maintained.

                            -TERMS OF THE AGREEMENT-

     IN CONSIDERATION of the mutual agreements and  acknowledgments  hereinafter
made, the parties hereto agree as follows:

     A. The Company hereby appoints the Dealer as an authorized dealer at retail
in VEHICLES and at retail and wholesale in other COMPANY PRODUCTS and grants the
Dealer the privilege of buying COMPANY PRODUCTS from the Company for sale in its
DEALERSHIP OPERATIONS (as herein defined). The Company also grants to the Dealer
the privilege of displaying, at approved locations(s),  the Company's trademarks
and trade names applicable to COMPANY  PRODUCTS.  The Dealer hereby accepts such
appointment.

     B.  Subject  to and in  accordance  with the terms and  conditions  of this
agreement,  the Company shall sell COMPANY PRODUCTS to the Dealer and the Dealer
shall purchase COMPANY PRODUCTS from the Company.

     C. The Ford  Motor  Company  Ford  Sales  and  Service  Agreement  Standard
Provisions (Form  "FD925-A"),  a duplicate  original of which is attached to the
Dealer's duplicate  original of this agreement,  have been read and agreed to by
the  Company  and by the  Dealer,  and  such  Standard  Provisions  and any duly
executed and delivered  supplement or amendment thereto,  are hereby made a part
of this agreement with the same force and effect as if set forth herein in full.

     D. This  agreement  shall  bind the  Company  when it bears  the  facsimile
signature of the General Manager, and the manual countersignature of the General
Sales Manager,  Market  Representation  Manager, or a Regional or District Sales
Manager, of the Ford Division of the Company and a duplicate original thereof is
delivered personally or by mail to the Dealer or the Dealer's principal place of
business.

     E. The Dealer  acknowledges that (i) this agreement may be executed only in
the manner  provided  in  paragraph  D hereof,  (ii) no one  except the  General
Manager, The General Sales Manager, or Market Representation Manager of the Ford
Division of the  Company,  or the  Secretary  or an  Assistant  Secretary of the
Company,  is authorized to make or execute any other  agreement  relating to the
subject  matter  hereof on behalf of the  Company,  or in any manner to enlarge,
vary or modify the terms of this  agreement,  and then only by an  instrument in
writing, and (iii) no one except the General Manager of the Ford Division of the
Company,  or  the  Secretary  or an  Assistant  Secretary  of  the  Company,  is
authorized to terminate this  agreement on behalf of the Company,  and then only
by an instrument in writing.

     F. In view of the personal  nature of this agreement and its objectives and
purposes,  the Company expressly  reserves to itself the right to execute a Ford
Sales and Service  Agreement with  individuals  or other  entities  specifically
selected and approved by the Company. Accordingly, this agreement and the rights
and  privileges   conferred  on  the  Dealer  hereunder  are  not  transferable,
assignable or salable by the Dealer and no property right or interest, direct or
indirect,  is sold,  conveyed or transferred to the Dealer under this agreement.
This  agreement has been entered into by the Company with the Dealer in reliance
(i) upon the representation and agreement that the following person(s), and only
the following person(s) shall be the principal owners of the Dealer:



                                      iii

FD925
GEN. SALE 9/94



<PAGE>



  NAME                           HOME                            PERCENTAGE
                                 ADDRESS                         OF INTEREST

FMF Management, Inc.             5501 East Independence Blvd.    80
                                 Charlotte, NC 28218

Bryan Scott Smith                1820 Dilworth Road West         20
                                 Charlotte, NC 28203

                                      
(ii) upon the representation and agreement that the following person(s) and only
the following person(s),  shall have full managerial authority for the operating
management of the Dealer in the performance of this agreement,

  NAME                           HOME                            TITLE
                                 ADDRESS

O. Bruton Smith                  2259 Sharon Lane                President
                                 Charlotte, NC 28211     

Bryan Scott Smith                1820 Dilworth Road West         Vice-President
                                 Charlotte, NC 28203    
                                 
and (iii) upon  representation and agreement that the following  person(s),  and
only the following person(s), shall be the remaining owners of the Dealer


NAME                          HOME                                    PERCENTAGE
                             ADDRESS                                 OF INTEREST

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

The Dealer shall give the Company  prior  notice of any  proposed  change in the
said  ownership or managerial  authority,  and immediate  notice of the death or
incapacity  of any such person.  No such change or notice,  and no assignment of
this agreement or of any right or interest  herein,  shall be effective  against
the  Company  unless  and  until  embodied  in an  appropriate  amendment  to or
assignment of this agreement, as the case may be, duly executed and delivered by
the Company and by the Dealer.  The Company shall not unreasonably  withhold its
consent to any such change.

     G. (Strike out either subparagraph (1) or (2)whichever is not applicable.)

     (1)  This agreement shall continue in force and effect from the date of its
          execution  until  terminated  by either party under the  provisions of
          paragraph 17 hereof.
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

     H.  Both the  Company  and the  Dealer  assume  and  agree to carry out and
perform their respective responsibilities under this agreement.

     The parties hereto have duly executed this agreement in duplicate as of the
day and year first above written.

[LOGO] Ford Motor Company
                                 
      /s/ILLEGIBLE                         Fort Mill Ford
      ----------------                    (Dealers Trade Name)


General Manager, Ford Division             By:
                                              ---------------------------------
Countersigned by                          (Title)/s/ O. Bruton Smith President
      /s/ILLEGIBLE                        
      -------------                       By /s/ Bryan Scott Smith
                                              ---------------------------------
                                          (Title) Vice President


                                       iv

<PAGE>


(LOGO) Ford Motor Company
                                 Atlanta Region

                                   Addendum To

FORD SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT                                   Dated 8-27-96

[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

by and between Fort Mill Ford LLC
              (Name of Dealership Entity)

Limited Liability Corporation         in the State of      South Carolina
(State whether Partnership or Corporation)          (Show Name of State in which
                                                     incorporated or registered)
doing business as Fort Mill Ford
                   (Trade Name)

(the "Dealer") and Ford Motor Company, a Delaware corporation (the "Company").


THE PARTIES AGREE that the following addendum to Paragraph (F) containing clause
(i)(a) is annexed and made part of the Agreements.


F(i)(a) upon the  representation  and  agreement  that the  following  person(s)
and/or entity(ies),  and only the following person(s) and/or entity(ies),  shall
have ownership  interests in the principal owner(s) referred to in clause (i) of
this Paragraph F:
                                     
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
NAME OF PRINCIPAL OWNER(S)        
WHICH ARE PARTNERSHIPS OR            NAME AND ADDRESS OF PERSON(S) OF ENTITY(IES)          PERCENTAGE      
    CORPORATIONS                  HAVING OWNERSHIP INTEREST(S) IN PRINCIPAL OWNER(S)      OF OWNERSHIP     
(STATE OF INCORPORATION)                 (INDICATE STOCKHOLDER OR PARTNER)                  INTEREST       
                                                                                         


<S>                                          <C>                                               <C> 
FMF Management, Inc.                         O. Bruton Smith, (Stockholder)
SC                                           2259 Sharon Lane, Charlotte, NC 28211             100
</TABLE>


The  provisions  of this  paragraph  F  requiring  notice to and  consent by the
Company to any changes in ownership  shall apply to any change in the  person(s)
or entity(ies)  having an ownership interest in the principal owner(s) set forth
in this clause F(i)(a).

IN WITNESS WHEREOF,  The Company and the Dealer have duly executed this addendum
in duplicate as of the 27th day of Aug, 1996.

FORD MOTOR COMPANY                      Fort Mill Ford
                                        (Dealer's Trade Name)


By /s/ILLEGIBLE                         By /s/ O. Bruton Smith, President
   ---------------------                   ------------------------------------
                                           (Signature and Title)

By /s/ILLEGIBLE                         By Bryan Scott Smith, Vice President
   ---------------------                   ------------------------------------
   Assistant Secretary                     (Signature and Title)

FD925-AD 9/89

    

   

                            [LOGO]Ford Motor Company
                              Jacksonville District
                        Ford Sales and Service Agreement


AGREEMENT  made as of the 11th day of November,  1982,  by and 
between  Ken Marks Ford, Inc.

                   (Name of Entry)

                              a Florida Corporation
(State  whether an individual,            (if the latter, show name of the state
 partnership or  corporation)                     in which incorporated)

doing business as Ken Marks Ford, Inc. and with 
                      (Trade Name)

a principal place of business at   814 Cleveland Street
                                               (Street Address)

Clearwater         Pinellas               Florida                   33515
(CITY)             (COUNTY)              (STATE)                   (ZIP-CODE)

(hereafter called the "Dealer") and Ford Motor Company,  a Delaware  corporation
with its principal place of business at Dearborn,  Michigan  (hereinafter called
the "Company").

                                    PREAMBLE

     The  purpose  of  this  agreement  is to (i)  establish  the  Dealer  as an
authorized  dealer in COMPANY PRODUCTS  including  VEHICLES (as herein defined),
(ii) set forth the respective  responsibilities  of the Company in producing and
selling  those  products  to the  Dealer  and of the  Dealer  in  reselling  and
providing  service  for them and (iii)  recognize  the  interdependence  of both
parties in achieving their mutual objectives of satisfactory sales,  service and
profits by continuing to develop and retain a broad base of satisfied  owners of
COMPANY PRODUCTS.

     In entering into this agreement,  the Company and the Dealer recognize that
the success of the Company and of each of its authorized dealers depends largely
on the reputation and competitiveness of COMPANY PRODUCTS and dealers' services,
and on how well each fulfills its responsibilities under this agreement.

     It is the opinion of the Company that sales and service of COMPANY PRODUCTS
usually  can best be  provided  to the  public  through a system of  independent
franchised dealers,  with each dealer fulfilling its responsibilities in a given
locality  from  properly   located,   adequate,   well-equipped  and  attractive
dealerships,  which are staffed by competent  personnel  and  provided  with the
necessary  working  capital.  The Dealer  recognizes  that,  in such a franchise
system,  the Company  must plan for the  establishment  and  maintenance  of the
numbers,  locations and sizes of dealers  necessary for  satisfactory and proper
sales and  service  representa-



                                        i
FD925
GEN. SALE 1-76



<PAGE>



tion in each  market area as it exists and as it develops  and  changes.  At the
same  time,  the  Company  endeavors  to  provide  each  of its  dealers  with a
reasonable  profit  opportunity  based on the potential for sales and service of
COMPANY PRODUCTS within its locality.

     The Company endeavors to make available to its dealers a variety of quality
products,  responsive to broad wants and needs of the buying  public,  which are
attractively  styled, of sound engineering design and produced on a timely basis
at competitive  prices.  The  development,  production and sale of such products
require that the Company and its  manufacturing  sources  make large  continuing
investments in plants,  equipment,  tools and other facilities,  engineering and
styling research and development,  quality control procedures, trained personnel
and marketing  programs.  Heavy commitments must also be made in advance for raw
materials  and finished  parts.  For purposes of making  these  investments  and
commitments,  planning  production and estimating costs for setting prices,  the
Company assumes in advance an estimated volume of sales for each of it products.
Within each year, it develops  production  schedules from basic orders submitted
by its  franchised  dealers  for the  following  month  and its and  their  best
estimates of the market for subsequent months.

     In  turn,  each  of  the  Company's   franchised  dealers  makes  important
investments or commitments in retail sales and service facilities and equipment,
in working  capital,  in inventories  of vehicles,  parts and  accessories,  and
trained sales and service  personnel based on annual planning  volumes for their
markets.

     If  satisfactory  volumes  for  either  the  Company  or a  dealer  are not
realized,  each may suffer because of  commitments  already made and the cost of
manufacturing  and of selling  each  product may be  increased.  Each month each
dealer must give the Company orders for the products needed to serve his market.
During the month each dealer should submit specific orders for products  covered
by his basic order. If dealer's specific orders for any product are greater than
or different  from their basic orders,  the Company  seeks to revise  production
schedules to the extent  feasible,  and to allocate  fairly any product in short
supply,  but inevitably  both the Company and its dealers suffer loss of profits
to the extent they cannot meet market demands.  Thus, the automotive business is
a high risk  business in which the Company,  its  manufacturing  sources and its
dealers can succeed only through  cooperative  and  competitive  effort in their
respective areas of manufacturing, sales, service and customer satisfaction.

     Since it is the dealer who deals  directly  with,  and develops the sale of
COMPANY PRODUCTS to the consuming public,  the Company  substantially  relies on
its dealers to provide  successful sales and merchandising  programs,  competent
service operations and effective owner relations  programs.  To do this, dealers
must carry out their  responsibilities of establishing and maintaining  adequate
wholesale and retail finance plans,  new and used vehicle sales programs,  parts
and service sales programs, personnel training and supportive capitalization and
working capital.  To assist its dealers in these  responsibilities,  the Company
establishes and periodically  updates standards of operation and planning guides
based on its experience and current conditions. It also offers sales and service
training courses,  advice as to facilities,  counseling in the various phases of
dealership  operations and,  through other  agreements and the activities of its
affiliates,  assistance in financing, new and used vehicle merchandising,  parts
and service merchandising, leasing, daily rentals and facilities development. It
also conducts national advertising, promotional and other marketing programs and
assists dealers in developing complementary group and individual programs.

     To enable the Company to provide such  assistance,  it requires  dealers to
submit uniform and accurate sales, operating and financial reports from which it
can derive and disseminate  analytical and comparative operating data and advice
to dealers.  The Company also solicits dealers to bring to its attention through
their  National  Dealer  Council  organization  any mutual  dealer  problems  or
complaints as they arise.

     Because the Company relies heavily on its dealers for success,  it reserves
the  right to cease  doing  business  with any  dealer  who is not  contributing
sufficiently to such success. Similarly, the Company recognizes that its dealers
look to it to provide competitive products and programs and that, if it does not
do so, any dealer may elect to cease doing business with the Company.

     The Company has elected to enter into this  agreement  with the Dealer with
confidence in the Dealer's integrity and ability, his intention to carry out his
responsibilities  set  forth  in this  agreement,  and  his  desire  


                                       ii


<PAGE>



to provide courteous,  competent and satisfying sales and service representation
to consumers for COMPANY PRODUCTS,  and in reliance upon his  representations as
to the persons who will  participate  in the  ownership  and  management  of the
dealership.

     The Dealer has elected to enter into this  agreement  with the Company with
confidence in its integrity  and ability,  its intention to provide  competitive
products  and assist the Dealer to market them  successfully,  and its desire to
maintain high quality dealers.
     
     Both parties  recognize the rights of the Dealer and the Company under this
agreement are defined and limited by the terms of this  agreement and applicable
law. 

     The  Company  and the Dealer  further  acknowledge  that  their  methods of
operation and business  practices have an important  effect on the reputation of
the Dealer,  the Company,  COMPANY PRODUCTS and other franchised  dealers of the
Company.  The Company and the Dealer also acknowledge that certain practices are
detrimental  to their  interests,  such as  deceptive,  misleading  or confusing
advertising,  pricing,  merchandising or business practices,  or misrepresenting
the characteristics, quality, condition or origin of any item of sale.

     It is the  expectation  of each of the parties  that by entering  into this
agreement,  and by the full  and  faithful  observance  and  performance  of its
duties, a mutually satisfactory relationship will be established and maintained.

     IN CONSIDERATION of the mutual agreements and  acknowledgments  hereinafter
made, the parties hereto agree as follows:

     A. The Company hereby appoints the Dealer as an authorized dealer at retail
in VEHICLES and at retail and wholesale in other COMPANY PRODUCTS and grants the
Dealer the privilege of buying COMPANY PRODUCTS from the Company for sale in its
DEALERSHIP OPERATIONS (as herein defined). The Company also grants to the Dealer
the privilege of displaying, at approved locations(s),  the Company's trademarks
and trade names applicable to COMPANY  PRODUCTS.  The Dealer hereby accepts such
appointment.

     B.  Subject  to and in  accordance  with the terms and  conditions  of this
agreement,  the Company shall sell COMPANY PRODUCTS to the Dealer and the Dealer
shall purchase COMPANY PRODUCTS from the Company.

     C. The Ford  Motor  Company  Ford  Sales  and  Service  Agreement  Standard
Provisions  (Form  "FD925-A GEN. SALE 1-76"),  a duplicate  original of which is
attached to the Dealer's  duplicate  original of this agreement,  have been read
and agreed to by the Company and by the Dealer, and such Standard Provisions and
any duly executed and delivered supplement or amendment thereto, are hereby made
a part of this  agreement  with the same force and effect as if set forth herein
in full.

     D. This  agreement  shall  bind the  Company  when it bears  the  facsimile
signature of the General Manager, and the manual countersignature of the General
Sales Manager,  Market  Representation  Manager, or a Regional or District Sales
Manager, of the Ford Division of the Company and a duplicate original thereof is
delivered personally or by mail to the Dealer or the Dealer's principal place of
business.

     E. The Dealer  acknowledges that (i) this agreement may be executed only in
the manner  provided  in  paragraph  D hereof,  (ii) no one  except the  General
Manager, the General Sales Manager, or Market Representation Manager of the Ford
Division of the  Company,  or the  Secretary  or an  Assistant  Secretary of the
Company,  is authorized to make or execute any other  agreement  relating to the
subject  matter  hereof on behalf of the  Company,  or in any manner to enlarge,
vary or modify the terms of this  agreement,  and then only by an  instrument in
writing, and (iii) no one except the General Manager of the Ford Division of the
Company,  or  the  Secretary  or an  Assistant  Secretary  of  the  Company,  is
authorized to terminate this  agreement on behalf of the Company,  and then only
by an instrument in writing.

     F. In view of the personal  nature of this agreement and its objectives and
purposes,  the Company expressly  reserves to itself the right to execute a Ford
Sales and Service  Agreement with  individuals  or other  entities  specifically
selected and approved by the Company. Accordingly, this agreement and the rights
and  privileges   conferred  on  the  Dealer  hereunder  are  not  transferable,
assignable or salable by the Dealer and no property right or interest, direct or
indirect,  is sold,  conveyed or transferred to the Dealer under this agreement.
This  agreement has been entered into by the Company with the Dealer in reliance
(i) upon the representation and


                                      iii



<PAGE>




agreement that the following  person(s),  and only the following person(s) shall
be the principal owners of the Dealer:

  NAME                        HOME                               PERCENTAGE
                              ADDRESS                            OF INTEREST
O.K. Marks                    3053 Eagles Landing Circle W.      100.0
                              Clearwater, FL 33519               
                             
(ii) upon the representation and agreement that the following person(s) and only
the following person(s),  shall have full managerial authority for the operating
management of the Dealer in the performance of this agreement,

  NAME                        HOME                               TITLE
                              ADDRESS
O.K. Marks                    3053 Eagles Landing Circle W.      President
                              Clearwater, FL 33519               
                             

and (iii) upon  representation and agreement that the following  person(s),  and
only the following person(s), shall be the remaining owners of the Dealer


NAME                          HOME                                    PERCENTAGE
                             ADDRESS                                 OF INTEREST

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


The Dealer shall give the Company  prior  notice of any  proposed  change in the
said  ownership or managerial  authority,  and immediate  notice of the death or
incapacity  of any such person.  No such change or notice,  and no assignment of
this agreement or of any right or interest  herein,  shall be effective  against
the  Company  unless  and  until  embodied  in an  appropriate  amendment  to or
assignment of this agreement, as the case may be, duly executed and delivered by
the Company and by the Dealer.  The Company shall not unreasonably  withhold its
consent to any such change.

     G. (Strike out either subparagraph (1) or (2) whichever is not applicable.)

     (1)  This agreement shall continue in force and effect from the date of its
          execution  until  terminated  by either party under the  provisions of
          paragraph 17 hereof.

[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
       XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
       XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

     H.  Both the  Company  and the  Dealer  assume  and  agree to carry out and
perform their respective responsibilities under this agreement.

     The parties hereto have duly executed this agreement in duplicate as of the
day and year first above written.
                                 
[LOGO] Ford Motor Company                    Ken Marks Ford, Inc.
                                             (Dealer's Trade Name)
Countersigned by

/s/ [ILLEGIBLE]                              By:/s/ O. Ken Marks               
- -----------------------------                ------------------------------     
District Sales Manager                       (Title) President                
                                             
                                             
<PAGE>


(LOGO) Ford Motor Company
                                 Orlando Region

                                   Addendum To

FORD SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT                        dated November 11, 1982
FOREIGN VEHICLE SALES AGREEMENT (COURIER)               dated November 11, 1982
FOREIGN VEHICLE SALES AGREEMENT (FIESTA)                dated November 11, 1982

[INIT] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
       XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
       XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX


SUPPLEMENTAL AGREEMENT, made at Dearborn, Michigan  as of this 13th day of June,
1994 by and between Ken Marks Ford, Inc.
                    (Name of Entity)

               Corporation                                 Florida
(State whether Partnership or Corporation)    (If the latter, show name of the
                                                  state which Incorporated) 
doing business as Ken Marks Ford, Inc.
                   (Trade Name)

and with a principal place of business at  24825 U.S. Highway 19 North
                                             (Street Address)

Clearwater          Pinellas                 Florida             34623-3999
(City)              (County)                 (State)             (Zip Code)

(hereinafter called the "Dealer") and Ford Motor Company, a Delaware corporation
with its principal place of business at Dearborn,  Michigan  (hereinafter called
the "Company").

     The parties hereto have previously  entered into the above designated Sales
and Service or Sales  Agreements  (hereinafter  "Agreements")  and now desire to
make certain changes therein.

     NOW,  THEREFORE, in consideration  of these  premises,  the parties  hereto
mutually agree that said  Agreements be amended by changing  Paragraph F to read
as follows:

     F. In view of the personal nature of these  Agreements and their objectives
and purposes, the Company expressly reserves to itself the right to execute said
Agreements with individuals or other entities specifically selected and approved
by the Company.  Accordingly,  these  Agreements  and the rights and  privileges
conferred on the Dealer hereunder are not transferable, assignable or salable by
the Dealer and  no property  right or  interest,  direct or  indirect,  is sold,
conveyed or transferred to the Dealer under these  Agreements.  These Agreements
have been  entered  into by the Company with the Dealer in reliance (i) upon the
representation  and  agreement  that  the  following  person(s),  and  only  the
following person(s), shall be the principal owners of the Dealer:

                              HOME                               PERCENTAGE
NAME                          ADDRESS                            OF INTEREST

O. Ken Marks, Jr.             2408 Hampton Lane West             52%
                              Safety Harbor, FL 34695

Michael J. Marks              2481 NE Coachman Road, #215        25%
                              Clearwater, FL 34625

O. K. Marks, Sr.              P.O. Box 428                       23%
                              Ozona, FL 34660                    


(ii) upon the  representation  and agreement that the following  person(s),  and
only the  following  person(s),  shall have full  managerial  authority  for the
operating management of the Dealer in the performance of these Agreements:

                              HOME
NAME                          ADDRESS                            TITLE

Ken Marks, Jr.                2408 Hampton Lane West             President
                              Safety Harbor, FL 34695
                              


<PAGE>



and (iii) upon the  representation  and agreement that the following  person(s),
and only the following person(s), shall be the remaining owners of the Dealer

                              HOME                               PERCENTAGE
NAME                          ADDRESS                            OF INTEREST

None



     The Dealer shall give the Company  prior  notice of any proposed  change in
the said ownership or managerial  authority of said Dealer, and immediate notice
of the death or incapacity of any such person. No such change or notice,  and no
amendment or assignment of these  Agreements or of any right or interest herein,
shall  be  effective  against  the  Company  unless  and  until  embodied  in an
appropriate  amendment to or assignment of these  Agreements as the case may be,
duly executed and delivered by the Company and by the Dealer.  The Company shall
not  unreasonably  withhold  its consent to any such  change.  If the  Company's
restriction  regarding  amendment or assignment  of these  Agreements is illegal
under a valid law of any jurisdiction  where such change is to take place,  this
amendment will be modified to the minimum  extent  necessary to comply with such
law if it was effective on the date of execution of these Agreements.

     This  Supplemental  Agreement  is subject  to all the terms and  conditions
contained in said Agreements, except insofar as such terms and conditions may be
inconsistent with the express terms hereof.

     IN WITNESS  WHEREOF the parties  hereto have executed this  Agreement as of
the day and year first above  written and the Company is  authorized  to deliver
the same to the Dealer by placing the Dealer's copy thereof in the United States
Mail,  duly  stamped  and  addressed  to the  Dealer at his  principal  place of
business, or by delivery to such place of business or to the Dealer in person.


FORD MOTOR COMPANY                      Ken Marks Ford, Inc.
                                        ----------------------------------------
                                                 (Dealer's Trade Name)


By [ILLEGIBLE]                          By /s/ O. Ken Marks, Jr.
   --------------------------              -------------------------------------
     Assistant Secretary                   O. Ken Marks, Jr., President


- ----------------------------------------

- ----------------------------------------

/s/ Mack Ratchford
- ----------------------------------------
Mack Ratchford
Regional Sales Manager


    

   


                            [LOGO]Ford Motor Company
                                Atlanta District
                        Ford Sales and Service Agreement


AGREEMENT  made as of the 7th day of June,  1993,  by and 
between  Nelson Bowers Ford, L.P.

                   (Name of Entry)

      Limited Partnership                            Tennessee
(State  whether an individual,            (if the latter, show name of the state
 partnership or  corporation)                     in which incorporated)

doing business as Nelson Bowers Ford and with 
                      (Trade Name)

a principal place of business at 717 South Lee Highway P.O. Box 4288
                                               (Street Address)

Cleveland           Bradley             Tennessee                  37320-4288
(CITY)             (COUNTY)              (STATE)                   (ZIP-CODE)

(hereafter called the "Dealer") and Ford Motor Company,  a Delaware  corporation
with its principal place of business at Dearborn,  Michigan  (hereinafter called
the "Company").

                                    PREAMBLE

     The  purpose  of  this  agreement  is to (i)  establish  the  Dealer  as an
authorized  dealer in COMPANY PRODUCTS  including  VEHICLES (as herein defined),
(ii) set forth the respective  responsibilities  of the Company in producing and
selling  those  products  to the  Dealer  and of the  Dealer  in  reselling  and
providing  service  for them and (iii)  recognize  the  interdependence  of both
parties in achieving their mutual objectives of satisfactory sales,  service and
profits by continuing to develop and retain a broad base of satisfied  owners of
COMPANY PRODUCTS.

     In entering into this agreement,  the Company and the Dealer recognize that
the success of the Company and of each of its authorized dealers depends largely
on the reputation and competitiveness of COMPANY PRODUCTS and dealers' services,
and on how well each fulfills its responsibilities under this agreement.

     It is the opinion of the Company that sales and service of COMPANY PRODUCTS
usually  can best be  provided  to the  public  through a system of  independent
franchised dealers,  with each dealer fulfilling its responsibilities in a given
locality  from  properly   located,   adequate,   well-equipped  and  attractive
dealerships,  which are staffed by competent  personnel  and  provided  with the
necessary  working  capital.  The Dealer  recognizes  that,  in such a franchise
system,  the Company  must plan for the  establishment  and  maintenance  of the
numbers,  locations and sizes of dealers  necessary for  satisfactory and proper
sales and  service  representation  in each  market  area as it exists and as it
develops and changes. At the same time, the Company endeavors to provide each of
its dealers with a reasonable  profit  opportunity  based on the  potential  for
sales and service of COMPANY PRODUCTS within its locality.

     The Company endeavors to make available to its dealers a variety of quality
products,  responsive to broad wants and needs of the buying  public,  which are
attractively styled, of sound engineering


FD925
GEN. SALE 10-87
(wpa 6/89)


<PAGE>




design and produced on a timely basis at competitive  prices.  The  development,
production  and  sale  of  such  products  require  that  the  Company  and  its
manufacturing  sources make large continuing  investments in plants,  equipment,
tools and other  facilities,  engineering and styling  research and development,
quality control  procedures,  trained  personnel and marketing  programs.  Heavy
commitments  must also be made in advance for raw materials and finished  parts.
For purposes of making these  investments and commitments,  planning  production
and  estimating  costs for setting  prices,  the  Company  assumes in advance an
estimated volume of sales for each of it products. Within each year, it develops
production schedules from orders submitted by its franchised dealers and its and
their best estimates of the market demand for COMPANY PRODUCTS.

     In  turn,  each  of  the  Company's   franchised  dealers  makes  important
investments or commitments in retail sales and service facilities and equipment,
in working  capital,  in inventories  of vehicles,  parts and  accessories,  and
trained sales and service  personnel based on annual planning  volumes for their
markets.

     If  satisfactory  volumes  for  either  the  Company  or a  dealer  are not
realized,  each may suffer because of  commitments  already made and the cost of
manufacturing  and of selling  each product may be  increased.  Each dealer must
give the Company orders for the products needed to serve its market. The Company
seeks to adjust  production  schedules,  to the extent feasible,  to fill dealer
orders,  and to allocate fairly any product in short supply, but inevitably both
the  Company  and its  dealers  suffer loss of profits to the extent they cannot
meet market  demands.  Thus, the automotive  business is a high risk business in
which the Company,  its  manufacturing  sources and its dealers can succeed only
through  cooperative  and  competitive  effort  in  their  respective  areas  of
manufacturing, sales, service and customer satisfaction.

     Because it is the dealer who deals  directly with, and develops the sale of
COMPANY PRODUCTS to the consuming public,  the Company  substantially  relies on
its dealers to provide  successful sales and merchandising  programs,  competent
service operations and effective owner relations  programs.  To do this, dealers
must carry out their  responsibilities of establishing and maintaining  adequate
wholesale and retail finance plans,  new and used vehicle sales programs,  parts
and service sales programs, personnel training and supportive capitalization and
working capital.  To assist its dealers in these  responsibilities,  the Company
establishes and periodically  updates standards of operation and planning guides
based on its experience and current conditions. It also offers sales and service
training courses,  advice as to facilities,  counseling in the various phases of
new and used vehicle merchandising,  parts and service  merchandising,  leasing,
daily rentals and facilities development. It also conducts national advertising,
promotional  and other  marketing  programs  and assists  dealers in  developing
complementary group and individual programs.

     To enable the Company to provide such  assistance,  it requires  dealers to
submit uniform and accurate sales, operating and financial reports from which it
can derive and disseminate  analytical and comparative operating data and advice
to dealers.  The Company also solicits dealers to bring to its attention through
their  National  Dealer  Council  organization  any mutual  dealer  problems  or
complaints as they arise.

     Because the Company relies heavily on its dealers for success,  it reserves
the  right to cease  doing  business  with any  dealer  who is not  contributing
sufficiently to such success. Similarly, the Company recognizes that its dealers
look to it to provide competitive products and programs and that, if it does not
do so, any dealer may elect to cease doing business with the Company.

     The Company has elected to enter into this  agreement  with the Dealer with
confidence in the Dealer's integrity and ability, its intention to carry out its
responsibilities  set  forth  in this  agreement,  and  its  desire  to  provide
courteous,   competent  and  satisfying  sales  and  service  representation  to
consumers for COMPANY PRODUCTS,  and in reliance upon its  representations as to
the  persons  who  will  participate  in the  ownership  and  management  of the
dealership.

     The Dealer has elected to enter into this  agreement  with the Company with
confidence in its


                                       ii


<PAGE>


integrity and ability, its intention to provide competitive products and assist
the Dealer to market them successfully,  and its desire to maintain high quality
dealers.
     
     Both parties  recognize the rights of the Dealer and the Company under this
agreement are defined and limited by the terms of this  agreement and applicable
law.  The  Company  and the Dealer  further  acknowledge  that their  methods of
operation and business  practices have an important  effect on the reputation of
the Dealer,  the Company,  COMPANY PRODUCTS and other franchised  dealers of the
Company.  The Company and the Dealer also acknowledge that certain practices are
detrimental  to their  interests,  such as  deceptive,  misleading  or confusing
advertising,  pricing,  merchandising or business practices,  or misrepresenting
the characteristics, quality, condition or origin of any item of sale.

     It is the  expectation  of each of the parties  that by entering  into this
agreement,  and by the full  and  faithful  observance  and  performance  of its
duties, a mutually satisfactory relationship will be established and maintained.

     IN CONSIDERATION of the mutual agreements and  acknowledgments  hereinafter
made, the parties hereto agree as follows:

     A. The Company hereby appoints the Dealer as an authorized dealer at retail
in VEHICLES and at retail and wholesale in other COMPANY PRODUCTS and grants the
Dealer the privilege of buying COMPANY PRODUCTS from the Company for sale in its
DEALERSHIP OPERATIONS (as herein defined). The Company also grants to the Dealer
the privilege of displaying, at approved locations(s),  the Company's trademarks
and trade names applicable to COMPANY  PRODUCTS.  The Dealer hereby accepts such
appointment.

     B.  Subject  to and in  accordance  with the terms and  conditions  of this
agreement,  the Company shall sell COMPANY PRODUCTS to the Dealer and the Dealer
shall purchase COMPANY PRODUCTS from the Company.

     C. The Ford  Motor  Company  Ford  Sales  and  Service  Agreement  Standard
Provisions (Form  "FD925-A"),  a duplicate  original of which is attached to the
Dealer's duplicate  original of this agreement,  have been read and agreed to by
the  Company  and by the  Dealer,  and  such  Standard  Provisions  and any duly
executed and delivered  supplement or amendment thereto,  are hereby made a part
of this agreement with the same force and effect as if set forth herein in full.

     D. This  agreement  shall  bind the  Company  when it bears  the  facsimile
signature of the General Manager, and the manual countersignature of the General
Sales Manager,  Market  Representation  Manager, or a Regional or District Sales
Manager, of the Ford Division of the Company and a duplicate original thereof is
delivered personally or by mail to the Dealer or the Dealer's principal place of
business.

     E. The Dealer  acknowledges that (i) this agreement may be executed only in
the manner  provided  in  paragraph  D hereof,  (ii) no one  except the  General
Manager, The General Sales Manager, or Market Representation Manager of the Ford
Division of the  Company,  or the  Secretary  or an  Assistant  Secretary of the
Company,  is authorized to make or execute any other  agreement  relating to the
subject  matter  hereof on behalf of the  Company,  or in any manner to enlarge,
vary or modify the terms of this  agreement,  and then only by an  instrument in
writing, and (iii) no one except the General Manager of the Ford Division of the
Company,  or  the  Secretary  or an  Assistant  Secretary  of  the  Company,  is
authorized to terminate this  agreement on behalf of the Company,  and then only
by an instrument in writing.

     F. In view of the personal  nature of this agreement and its objectives and
purposes,  the Company expressly  reserves to itself the right to execute a Ford
Sales and Service  Agreement with  individuals  or other  entities  specifically
selected and approved by the Company. Accordingly, this agreement and the rights
and  privileges   conferred  on  the  Dealer  hereunder  are  not  transferable,
assignable or salable by the Dealer and no property right or interest, direct or
indirect,  is sold,  conveyed or transferred to the Dealer under this agreement.
This agreement has been entered into by the


                                      iii

FD925
GEN. SALE 10-87
(wpa 6/89)


<PAGE>




                                                                COPY OF ORIGINAL

Company with the Dealer in reliance (i) upon the  representation  and  agreement
that the  following  person(s),  and only the following  person(s)  shall be the
principal owners of the Dealer:

  NAME                                HOME                          PERCENTAGE
                                      ADDRESS                       OF INTEREST
NEBCO of Southeast Tennessee, Inc.    633 Chestnut St., Ste. 900        10%
                                      Chattanooga, TN 37450
                                      
Nelson E. Bowers, II                  217 Colmore Circle                42%
                                      Lookout Mtn, TN 37350
                                      
(ii) upon the representation and agreement that the following person(s) and only
the following person(s),  shall have full managerial authority for the operating
management of the Dealer in the performance of this agreement,

  NAME                           HOME                               TITLE
                                 ADDRESS
Nelson E. Bowers, II             217 Colmore Circle         President of General
                                 Lookout Mtn, TN 37350             Partner

John Larry Williams              6220 Shallowford Rd        General Manager
                                 Chattanooga, TN 37421

and (iii) upon  representation and agreement that the following  person(s),  and
only the following person(s), shall be the remaining owners of the Dealer


NAME                          HOME                                    PERCENTAGE
                             ADDRESS                                 OF INTEREST
Frank E. Fowler         1213 Ft. Stephenson Oval, Lookout Mtn, TN        16%
                                                            37350
DeWayne B. McCamish     205 Primrose Way, Signal Mtn, TN 37377           16%

Rex Allen               57 Cool Springs Rd., Signal Mtn, TN 37377        16%

The Dealer shall give the Company  prior  notice of any  proposed  change in the
said  ownership or managerial  authority,  and immediate  notice of the death or
incapacity  of any such person.  No such change or notice,  and no assignment of
this agreement or of any right or interest  herein,  shall be effective  against
the  Company  unless  and  until  embodied  in an  appropriate  amendment  to or
assignment of this agreement, as the case may be, duly executed and delivered by
the Company and by the Dealer.  The Company shall not unreasonably  withhold its
consent to any such change.

     G. (Strike out either subparagraph (1) or (2)whichever is not applicable.)

     (1)  This agreement shall continue in force and effect from the date of its
          execution  until  terminated  by either party under the  provisions of
          paragraph 17 hereof.
[NEB] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[NEB] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[NEB] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

     H.  Both the  Company  and the  Dealer  assume  and  agree to carry out and
perform their respective responsibilities under this agreement.

     The parties hereto have duly executed this agreement in duplicate as of the
day and year first above written.
                                 
      /s/ILLEGIBLE                          Nelson Bowers Ford
      ----------------                       (Dealers Trade Name)
[LOGO] Ford Motor Company

General Manager, Ford Division                By:/s/Nelson E. Bowers
                                             ------------------------------
Countersigned by                             (Title)President OF General Partner
      /s/ILLEGIBLE                           NEBCO of Southeast Tennessee, INC.
      ----------------


<PAGE>


(LOGO) Ford Motor Company
                                Atlanta District

                                   Addendum To

FORD SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT                                    Dated 6-7-93

[NEB] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[NEB] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[NEB] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
[NEB] XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

by and between Nelson Bowers Ford, L.P.
                    (Name of Entity)
A Partnership in the State of Tennessee
(State whether Partnership or Corporation) (If the latter, show Name of State in
                                                        which Incorporated) 
doing business as Nelson Bowers Ford
                   (Trade Name)

(the "Dealer") and Ford Motor Company, a Delaware corporation (the "Company").


THE PARTIES AGREE that the following addendum to Paragraph (F) containing clause
(i)(a) is annexed and made part of the Agreements.


F(i)(a) upon the  representation  and  agreement  that the  following  person(s)
and/or entity(ies),  and only the following person(s) and/or entity(ies),  shall
have ownership  interests in the principal owner(s) referred to in clause (i) of
this Paragraph F:
                                     
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                     
                                     NAME AND ADDRESS OF PERSON(S) OF ENTITY(IES)          PERCENTAGE     
NAME OF PRINCIPAL OWNER(S)        HAVING OWNERSHIP INTEREST(S) IN PRINCIPAL OWNER(S)      OF OWNERSHIP    
(STATE OF INCORPORATION)                 (INDICATE STOCKHOLDER OR PARTNER)                  INTEREST   
                                                                                         


<S>                                          <C>                                               <C> 
NEBCO of Southeast                           Nelson E. Bowers, II                              100%
Tennessee, Inc.                              217 Colmore Circle
(A Corporation of the                        Lookout Mountain, TN 37350
State of Tennessee)
</TABLE>


The  provisions  of this  paragraph  F  requiring  notice to and  consent by the
Company to any changes in ownership  shall apply to any change in the  person(s)
or entity(ies)  having an ownership interest in the principal owner(s) set forth
in this clause F(i)(a).

IN WITNESS WHEREOF,  The Company and the Dealer have duly executed this addendum
in duplicate as of the 7th day of June, 1993.

FORD MOTOR COMPANY                                   Nelson Bowers Ford
                                                     (Dealer's Trade Name)


By /s/ILLEGIBLE                                      By:/s/Nelson Bowers
   ---------------------                                ------------------------
   Assistant Secretary                                  (Signature and Title)

/s/ILLEGIBLE
- ------------------

FD925-AD 9/89
(wpa 6/89)

    

   
                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                    CHRYSLER

                           SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT

                    Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge, Inc.
                   (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

located at 3310 Highway 51 at Carowinds,          Fort Mill,    South Carolina,
                 (STREET)                           (CITY)          (STATE)
a(n)  corporation,  
    (INDIVIDUAL, CORPORATION OR PARTNERSHIP)     hereinafter  called DEALER, and

Chrysler Corporation, a Delaware corporation,  hereinafter sometimes referred to
as "CC", have entered into this Chrysler  Corporation Chrysler Sales and Service
Agreement,  hereinafter  referred to as  "Agreement",  the terms of which are as
follows:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     INTRODUCTION

The purpose of the  relationship  established  by this Agreement is to provide a
means for the sale and service of specified Chrysler vehicles and the sale of CC
vehicle  parts  and  accessories  in  a  manner  that  will  maximize   customer
satisfaction and be of benefit to DEALER and CC.

While  the  following  provisions,  each of which is  material,  set  forth  the
undertakings of this relationship,  the success of those undertakings rests on a
recognition  of the  mutuality  of  interests  of DEALER and CC, and a spirit of
understanding  and  cooperation by both parties in the day to day performance of
their respective functions.  As a result of such considerations,  CC has entered
into this  Agreement  in reliance  upon and has placed its trust in the personal
abilities,  expertise,  knowledge and integrity of DEALER's principal owners and
management  personnel,  which CC  anticipates  will enable DEALER to perform the
personal services contemplated by this Agreement.

It is the mutual  goal of this  relationship  to promote the sale and service of
specified  CC  products  by  maintaining  and  advancing  their  excellence  and
reputation by earning,  holding and  furthering the public regard for CC and all
CC dealers.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1  PRODUCTS COVERED

DEALER has the right to order and  purchase  from CC and to sell at retail  only
those  specific  models of CC vehicles,  sometimes  referred to as "specified CC
vehicles,"   listed  on  the  Motor  Vehicle   Addendum,   attached  hereto  and
incorporated herein by reference. CC may change the models of CC vehicles listed
on the Motor Vehicle Addendum by furnishing  DEALER a superseding  Motor Vehicle
Addendum.  Such a  superseding  Motor  Vehicle  Addendum  will not be  deemed or
construed or to be an amendment to this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2  DEALER'S MANAGEMENT

CC has  entered  into this  Agreement  relying on the  active,  substantial  and
continuing personal participation in the management of DEALER's organization by:

                NAME                                     POSITION

         William Saddler Anderson                      General Manager
         ------------------------                      -------------------

         Bryan Scott Smith                             Vice President
         ------------------------                      -------------------


<PAGE>


DEALER represents and warrants that at least one of the above-named  individuals
will be physically  present at the DEALER's facility  (sometimes  referred to as
"Dealership Facilities") during most of its operating hours  and will manage all
of DEALER's  business  relating to the sale and service of CC  products.  DEALER
shall not change the personnel  holding the above  described  position(s) or the
nature and extent of his/her/their  management  participation  without the prior
written approval of CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3  DEALER'S CAPITAL STOCK OR PARTNERSHIP INTEREST

If DEALER is a corporation or partnership, DEALER represents and agrees that the
persons named below own beneficially  the capital stock or partnership  interest
of DEALER in the percentages  indicated below.  DEALER warrants there will be no
change  affecting  more than 50% of the ownership  interest of DEALER,  nor will
there be any other change in the  ownership  interest of DEALER which may affect
the managerial control of DEALER without CC's prior written approval.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                    Voting           Non-Voting                 Partnership               Active
         Name                       Stock              Stock                      Interest                Yes/No

<S>                                     <C>           <C>                       <C>                       <C>   
Sonic Auto World, Inc.                  100.00%                %                           %                  No
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
                                              %                %                           %        
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
                                              %                %                           %        
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
                                              %                %                           %        
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
                                              %                %                           %        
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
Total                                   100.00%                %                           %
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
</TABLE>

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4  SALES LOCALITY

DEALER shall have the  non-exclusive  right,  subject to the  provisions of this
Agreement,  to purchase from CC those new specified CC vehicles,  vehicle parts,
accessories  and other CC products  for resale at the  DEALER's  facilities  and
location described in the Dealership Facilities and Location Addendum,  attached
hereto  and  incorporated   herein  by  reference.   DEALER  will  actively  and
effectively  sell and promote the retail sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts and
accessories in DEALER's Sales Locality.  As used herein,  "Sales Locality" shall
mean the area  designated  in  writing  to DEALER by CC from time to time as the
territory of DEALER's responsibility for the sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts
and  accessories,  although  DEALER is free to sell said  products to  customers
wherever  they may be located.  Said Sales  Locality may be shared with other CC
dealers of the same line-make as CC determines to be appropriate.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
5  ADDITIONAL TERMS AND PROVISIONS

The additional terms and provisions set forth in the document entitled "Chrysler
Corporation Sales and Service Agreement  Additional Terms and Provisions" marked
"Form 91 (C-P-D)," as may  hereafter be amended from time to time,  constitute a
part of this  Agreement with the same force and effect as if set forth at length
herein,  and the term  "this  Agreement"  includes  said  additional  terms  and
provisions.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6  FORMER AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR STATEMENTS

This  Chrysler  Corporation  Chrysler  Sales  and  Service  Agreement  and other
documents (or their  successors as  specifically  provided for herein) which are
specifically  incorporated  herein by reference  constitute the entire agreement
between the parties relating to the purchase by DEALER of those new specified CC
vehicles,  parts  and  accessories  from  CC  for  resale;  and it  cancels  and
supersedes  all  earlier  agreements,  written  or oral,  between  CC and DEALER
relating to the purchase by DEALER of Chrysler vehicles,  parts and accessories,
except for (a)  amounts  owing by CC to DEALER,  such as payments  for  warranty
service performed and incentive  programs,  or (b) amounts owing or which may be
determined to be owed, as a result of an audit or investigation, by DEALER to CC
due to DEALER's purchase from CC of vehicles, parts, accessories and other goods
or services, or (c) amounts


<PAGE>


DEALER owes to CC, as a result of other extensions of credit by CC to DEALER. No
representations  or statements,  other than those  expressly set forth herein or
those set forth in the applications for this Agreement submitted to CC by DEALER
or  DEALER's  representatives,  are made or relied  upon by any party  hereto in
entering into this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7  WAIVER AND MODIFICATION

No  waiver,  modification  or change of any of the  terms of this  Agreement  or
change or  erasure of any  printed  part of this  Agreement  or  addition  to it
(except the filling in of blank spaces and lines) will be valid or binding on CC
unless  approved in writing by the President or a Vice President or the National
Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
8  AMENDMENT

DEALER and CC recognize that this Agreement does not have an expiration date and
will continue in effect unless  terminated under the limited  circumstances  set
forth in Paragraph 28. DEALER and CC further recognize that the passage of time,
changes  in  the  industry,   ways  of  doing  business  and  other   unforeseen
circumstances  may  cause CC to  determine  that it should  amend  all  Chrysler
Corporation Chrysler Sales and Service Agreements.  Therefore,  CC will have the
right to amend this  Agreement to the extent that CC deems  advisable,  provided
that CC makes the same  amendment  in Chrysler  Corporation  Chrysler  Sales and
Service  Agreements  generally.  Each such  amendment will be issued in a notice
sent by  certified  mail or  delivered  in person to  DEALER  and  signed by the
President  or a Vice  President  or the  National  Dealer  Placement  Manager of
Chrysler  Corporation.  Thirty-five  (35) days after mailing or delivery of such
notice to DEALER, this Agreement will be deemed amended in the manner and to the
extent set forth in the notice.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
9  ARBITRATION

Any and all disputes  arising out of or in connection  with the  interpretation,
performance or non-performance of this Agreement or any and all disputes arising
out of or in connection  with  transactions in any way related to this Agreement
(including,  but not limited to, the validity,  scope and enforceability of this
arbitration provision, or disputes under rights granted pursuant to the statutes
of the state in which  DEALER  is  licensed)  shall be  finally  and  completely
resolved by arbitration pursuant to the arbitration laws of the United States of
America as codified in Title 9 of the United States Code, ss.ss.1-14,  under the
Rules  of  Commercial  Arbitration  of  the  American  Arbitration   Association
(hereinafter  referred to as the "Rules") by a majority vote of a panel of three
arbitrators.  One arbitrator will be selected by DEALER  (DEALER's  arbitrator).
One arbitrator will be selected by CC (CC's arbitrator).  These arbitrators must
be  selected  by the  respective  parties  within ten (10)  business  days after
receipt by either DEALER or CC of a written notification from the other party of
a decision to arbitrate a dispute  pursuant to this Agreement.  Should either CC
or DEALER fail to select an arbitrator within said ten-day period, the party who
so fails to  select  an  arbitrator  will have its  arbitrator  selected  by the
American  Arbitration  Association  upon the application of the other party. The
third   arbitrator   must  be  an  individual  who  is  familiar  with  business
transactions and be a licensed  attorney  admitted to the practice of law within
the United States of America,  or a judge. The third arbitrator will be selected
by DEALER's and CC's  arbitrators.  If said arbitrators  cannot agree on a third
arbitrator  within thirty (30) days from the date of the appointment of the last
selected  arbitrator,  then either  DEALER's or CC's arbitrator may apply to the
American  Arbitration  Association to appoint said third arbitrator  pursuant to
the  criteria  set  forth  above.  The  arbitration   panel  shall  conduct  the
proceedings pursuant to the then existing Rules.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any provision of the Rules conflict
with any provision of this  Paragraph 9, the provisions of this Paragraph 9 will
be controlling.

CC and DEALER agree to facilitate the  arbitration  by: (a) each party paying to
the American  Arbitration  Association  one-half  (1/2) of the required  deposit
before the proceedings commence;  (b) making available to one another and to the
arbitration  panel,  for inspection and  photocopying  all documents,  books and
records,  if  determined by the  arbitrator  to be relevant to the dispute;  (c)
making available to one another and to the arbitration panel personnel  directly
or indirectly under their control,  for testimony during hearings and prehearing
proceedings  if  determined  by the  arbitration  panel  to be  relevant  to the
dispute; (d) conducting  arbitration hearings to the greatest extent possible on
consecutive   business  days;  and  (e)  strictly  observing  the  time  periods
established  by the  Rules or by the  arbitration  panel for the  submission  of
evidence and of briefs.


<PAGE>


Unless  otherwise  agreed  by CC  and  DEALER,  a  stenographic  record  of  the
arbitration  shall be made and a  transcript  thereof  shall be ordered for each
party, with each party paying one-half (1/2) of the total cost of such recording
and transcription.  The stenographer shall be state-certified,  if certification
is made by the  state,  and the  party  to whom it is most  convenient  shall be
responsible  for securing and notifying such  stenographer of the time and place
of the arbitration hearing(s).

If the arbitration  provision is invoked when the dispute between the parties is
either the legality of  terminating  this Agreement or of adding a new CC dealer
of the same line-make or relocating an existing CC dealer of the same line-make,
CC will stay the  implementation  of the decision to terminate this Agreement or
add such new CC dealer or approve the relocation of an existing CC dealer of the
same  line-make  until  the  decision  of the  arbitrator  has  been  announced,
providing  DEALER does not in any way attempt to avoid the  obligations  of this
Paragraph  9,  in  which  case  the  decision  at  issue  will  be   immediately
implemented.

Except as limited hereby, the arbitration panel shall have all powers of law and
equity, which it can lawfully assume, necessary to resolve the issues in dispute
including,  without  limiting the generality of the foregoing,  making awards of
compensatory  damages,  issuing both  prohibitory  and  mandatory  orders in the
nature of  injunctions  and compelling the production of documents and witnesses
for pre-arbitration  discovery and/or presentation at the arbitration hearing on
the merits of the case. The arbitration  panel shall not have legal or equitable
authority to issue a mandatory or  prohibitory  order which:  (a) extends or has
effect  beyond the  subject  matter of this  Agreement,  or (b) will  govern the
activities  of either  party for a period of more than two years;  nor shall the
arbitration panel have authority to award punitive, consequential or any damages
whatsoever  beyond or in  addition  to the  compensatory  damages  allowed to be
awarded under this Agreement.

The decision of the arbitration panel shall be in written form and shall include
findings of fact and conclusions of law.

It is the intent and desire of DEALER and CC to hereby and forever  renounce and
reject any and all recourse to litigation  before any judicial or administrative
forum and to accept  the award of the  arbitration  panel as final and  binding,
subject to no judicial or  administrative  review,  except on those  grounds set
forth in 9 USC sections 10 and 11.  Judgment on the award  and/or  orders may be
entered in any court having  jurisdiction  over the parties or their assets.  In
the final award  and/or  order,  the  arbitration  panel shall  divide all costs
(other than attorney fees, which shall be borne by the party incurring such fees
and other costs  specifically  provided for herein)  incurred in conducting  the
arbitration  in  accordance  with  what the  arbitration  panel  deems  just and
equitable under the circumstances. The fees of DEALER's arbitrator shall be paid
by DEALER. The fees of CC's arbitrator shall be paid by CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10  SIGNATURE

This  Agreement  becomes  valid  only  when  signed by the  President  or a Vice
President or the National Dealer Placement  Manager of Chrysler  Corporation and
by a duly authorized officer or executive of DEALER if a corporation;  or by one
of  the  general  partners  of  DEALER  if a  partnership;  or by  DEALER  if an
individual.

IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the parties  hereto have  signed this  Agreement  which is
finally executed at Auburn Hills, Michigan, in triplicate, on June 04, 1997.

                                     Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge, Inc.
                                     -------------------------------------------
                                     (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

                                     By: /s/ O. Bruton Smith
                                         ---------------------------------------
                                         (Individual Duly Authorized to Sign)

                                         ---------------------------------------
                                                      (Title)

                                                CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                     By: /s/ ILLEGIBLE
                                         ---------------------------------------
                                                 National Dealer
                                                Placement Manager
                                         ---------------------------------------
                                                      (Title)

    

   


                              Chrysler Corporation

                                    Plymouth

                           SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT

                     Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge, Inc.
                  (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

located at  3310 Highway 51 & Carowinds       Fort Mill,        South  Carolina
                     (STREET)                   (CITY)              (STATE)

a(n)                  Corporation,              hereinafter called  DEALER and 
      (INDIVIDUAL, CORPORATION OR PARTNERSHIP)

Chrysler Corporation, a Delaware corporation,  hereinafter sometimes referred to
as "CC", have entered into this Chrysler  Corporation Plymouth Sales and Service
Agreement,  hereinafter  referred to as  "Agreement",  the terms of which are as
follows:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     INTRODUCTION

The purpose of the  relationship  established  by this Agreement is to provide a
means for the sale and service of specified Plymouth vehicles and the sale of CC
vehicle  parts  and  accessories  in  a  manner  that  will  maximize   customer
satisfaction and be of benefit to DEALER and CC.

While  the  following  provisions,  each of which is  material,  set  forth  the
undertakings of this relationship,  the success of those undertakings rests on a
recognition  of the  mutuality  of  interests  of DEALER and CC, and a spirit of
understanding  and  cooperation by both parties in the day to day performance of
their respective functions.  As a result of such considerations,  CC has entered
into this  Agreement  in reliance  upon and has placed its trust in the personal
abilities,  expertise,  knowledge and integrity of DEALER's principal owners and
management  personnel,  which CC  anticipates  will enable DEALER to perform the
personal services contemplated by this Agreement.

It is the mutual  goal of this  relationship  to promote the sale and service of
specified  CC  products  by  maintaining  and  advancing  their  excellence  and
reputation by earning,  holding and  furthering the public regard for CC and all
CC dealers.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1  PRODUCTS COVERED

DEALER has the right to order and  purchase  from CC and to sell at retail  only
those  specific  models of CC vehicles,  sometimes  referred to as "specified CC
vehicles,"   listed  on  the  Motor  Vehicle   Addendum,   attached  hereto  and
incorporated herein by reference. CC may change the models of CC vehicles listed
on the Motor Vehicle Addendum by furnishing  DEALER a superseding  Motor Vehicle
Addendum.  Such a  superseding  Motor  Vehicle  Addendum  will not be  deemed or
construed to be an amendment to this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2  DEALER'S MANAGEMENT

CC has  entered  into this  Agreement  relying on the  active,  substantial  and
continuing personal participation in the management of DEALER's organization by:

                NAME                                        POSITION

     William Saddler Anderson                           General Manager
- --------------------------------------           -------------------------------
         Bryan Scott Smith                               Vice President
- --------------------------------------           -------------------------------


<PAGE>



DEALER represents and warrants that at least one of the above-named  individuals
will be physically  present at the DEALER's facility  (sometimes  referred to as
"Dealership  Facilities") during most of its operating hours and will manage all
of DEALER's  business  relating to the sale and service of CC  products.  DEALER
shall not change the personnel  holding the above  described  position(s) or the
nature and extent of his/her/their  management  participation  without the prior
written approval of CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3  DEALER'S CAPITAL STOCK OR PARTNERSHIP INTEREST

If DEALER is a corporation or partnership, DEALER represents and agrees that the
persons named below own beneficially  the capital stock or partnership  interest
of DEALER in the percentages  indicated below.  DEALER warrants there will be no
change  affecting  more than 50% of the ownership  interest of DEALER,  nor will
there be any other change in the  ownership  interest of DEALER which may affect
the managerial control of DEALER without CC's prior written approval.

                           Voting     Non-Voting     Partnership    Active
         Name              Stock        Stock          Interest     Yes/No
Sonic Auto World, Inc.     100.00                                     No
- ----------------------  -----------%  -----------%  -------------%  -----

- ----------------------  -----------%  -----------%  -------------%  -----

- ----------------------  -----------%  -----------%  -------------%  -----

- ----------------------  -----------%  -----------%  -------------%  -----

- ----------------------  -----------%  -----------%  -------------%  -----
Total                      100.00
- ----------------------  -----------%  -----------%  -------------%


- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4  SALES LOCALITY

DEALER shall have the  non-exclusive  right,  subject to the  provisions of this
Agreement,  to purchase from CC those new specified CC vehicles,  vehicle parts,
accessories  and other CC products  for resale at the  DEALER's  facilities  and
location described in the Dealership Facilities and Location Addendum,  attached
hereto  and  incorporated   herein  by  reference.   DEALER  will  actively  and
effectively  sell and promote the retail sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts and
accessories in DEALER's Sales Locality.  As used herein,  "Sales Locality" shall
mean the area  designated  in  writing  to DEALER by CC from time to time as the
territory of DEALER's responsibility for the sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts
and  accessories,  although  DEALER is free to sell said  products to  customers
wherever  they may be located.  Said Sales  Locality may be shared with other CC
dealers of the same line-make as CC determines to be appropriate.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
5  ADDITIONAL TERMS AND PROVISIONS

The additional terms and provisions set forth in the document entitled "Chrysler
Corporation Sales and Service Agreement  Additional Terms and Provisions" marked
"Form 91 (C-P-D)," as may  hereafter be amended from time to time,  constitute a
part of this  Agreement with the same force and effect as if set forth at length
herein,  and the term  "this  Agreement"  includes  said  additional  terms  and
provisions.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6  FORMER AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR STATEMENTS

This  Chrysler  Corporation  Plymouth  Sales  and  Service  Agreement  and other
documents (or their  successors as  specifically  provided for herein) which are
specifically  incorporated  herein by reference  constitute the entire agreement
between the parties relating to the purchase by DEALER of those new specified CC
vehicles,  parts  and  accessories  from  CC  for  resale;  and it  cancels  and
supersedes  all  earlier  agreements,  written  or oral,  between  CC and DEALER
relating to the purchase by DEALER of Plymouth vehicles,  parts and accessories,
except for (a)  amounts  owing by CC to DEALER,  such as payments  for  warranty
service performed and incentive  programs,  or (b) amounts owing or which may be
determined to be owed, as a result of an audit or investigation, by DEALER to CC
due to DEALER's purchase from CC of vehicles, parts, accessories and other goods
or services, or (c) amounts


<PAGE>



DEALER owes to CC, as a result of other extensions of credit by CC to DEALER. No
representations  or statements,  other than those  expressly set forth herein or
those set forth in the applications for this Agreement submitted to CC by DEALER
or  DEALER's  representatives,  are made or relied  upon by any party  hereto in
entering into this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7  WAIVER AND MODIFICATION

No  waiver,  modification  or change of any of the  terms of this  Agreement  or
change or  erasure of any  printed  part of this  Agreement  or  addition  to it
(except the filling in of blank spaces and lines) will be valid or binding on CC
unless  approved in writing by the President or a Vice President or the National
Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
8  AMENDMENT

DEALER and CC recognize that this Agreement does not have an expiration date and
will continue in effect unless  terminated under the limited  circumstances  set
forth in Paragraph 28. DEALER and CC further recognize that the passage of time,
changes  in  the  industry,   ways  of  doing  business  and  other   unforeseen
circumstances  may  cause CC to  determine  that it should  amend  all  Chrysler
Corporation Sales and Service Agreements.  Therefore,  CC will have the right to
amend this  Agreement to the extent that CC deems  advisable,  provided  that CC
makes the same amendment in Chrysler  Corporation  Sales and Service  Agreements
generally. Each such amendment will be issued in a notice sent by certified mail
or delivered in person to DEALER and signed by the President or a Vice President
or the National Dealer Placement  Manager of Chrysler  Corporation.  Thirty-five
(35) days after  mailing or delivery of such  notice to DEALER,  this  Agreement
will be deemed amended in the manner and to the extent set forth in the notice.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
9  ARBITRATION

Any and all disputes  arising out of or in connection  with the  interpretation,
performance or non-performance of this Agreement or any and all disputes arising
out of or in connection  with  transactions in any way related to this Agreement
(including,  but not limited to, the validity,  scope and enforceability of this
arbitration provision, or disputes under rights granted pursuant to the statutes
of the state in which  DEALER  is  licensed)  shall be  finally  and  completely
resolved by arbitration pursuant to the arbitration laws of the United States of
America as codified in Title 9 of the United States Code, ss. ss.1-14, under the
Rules  of  Commercial  Arbitration  of  the  American  Arbitration   Association
(hereinafter  referred to as the "Rules") by a majority vote of a panel of three
arbitrators.  One arbitrator will be selected by DEALER  (DEALER's  arbitrator).
One arbitrator will be selected by CC (CC's arbitrator).  These arbitrators must
be  selected  by the  respective  parties  within ten (10)  business  days after
receipt by either DEALER or CC of a written notification from the other party of
a decision to arbitrate a dispute  pursuant to this Agreement.  Should either CC
or DEALER fail to select an arbitrator within said ten-day period, the party who
so fails to  select  an  arbitrator  will have its  arbitrator  selected  by the
American  Arbitration  Association  upon the application of the other party. The
third   arbitrator   must  be  an  individual  who  is  familiar  with  business
transactions and be a licensed  attorney  admitted to the practice of law within
the United States of America,  or a judge. The third arbitrator will be selected
by DEALER's and CC's  arbitrators.  If said arbitrators  cannot agree on a third
arbitrator  within thirty (30) days from the date of the appointment of the last
selected  arbitrator,  then either  DEALER's or CC's arbitrator may apply to the
American  Arbitration  Association to appoint said third arbitrator  pursuant to
the  criteria  set  forth  above.  The  arbitration   panel  shall  conduct  the
proceedings pursuant to the then existing Rules.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any provision of the Rules conflict
with any provision of this  Paragraph 9, the provisions of this Paragraph 9 will
be controlling.

CC and DEALER agree to facilitate the  arbitration  by: (a) each party paying to
the American  Arbitration  Association  one-half  (1/2) of the required  deposit
before the proceedings commence;  (b) making available to one another and to the
arbitration  panel,  for inspection and  photocopying  all documents,  books and
records,  if  determined by the  arbitrator  to be relevant to the dispute;  (c)
making available to one another and to the arbitration panel personnel  directly
or indirectly under their control,  for testimony during hearings and prehearing
proceedings  if  determined  by the  arbitration  panel  to be  relevant  to the
dispute; (d) conducting  arbitration hearings to the greatest extent possible on
consecutive   business  days;  and  (e)  strictly  observing  the  time  periods
established  by the  Rules or by the  arbitration  panel for the  submission  of
evidence and of briefs.


<PAGE>



Unless  otherwise  agreed  by CC  and  DEALER,  a  stenographic  record  of  the
arbitration  shall be made and a  transcript  thereof  shall be ordered for each
party, with each party paying one-half (1/2) of the total cost of such recording
and transcription.  The stenographer shall be state-certified,  if certification
is made by the  state,  and the  party  to whom it is most  convenient  shall be
responsible  for securing and notifying such  stenographer of the time and place
of the arbitration hearing(s).

If the arbitration  provision is invoked when the dispute between the parties is
either the legality of  terminating  this Agreement or of adding a new CC dealer
of the same line-make or relocating an existing CC dealer of the same line-make,
CC will stay the  implementation  of the decision to terminate this Agreement or
add such new CC dealer or approve the relocation of an existing CC dealer of the
same  line-make  until  the  decision  of the  arbitrator  has  been  announced,
providing  DEALER does not in any way attempt to avoid the  obligations  of this
Paragraph  9,  in  which  case  the  decision  at  issue  will  be   immediately
implemented.

Except as limited hereby, the arbitration panel shall have all powers of law and
equity, which it can lawfully assume, necessary to resolve the issues in dispute
including,  without  limiting the generality of the foregoing,  making awards of
compensatory  damages,  issuing both  prohibitory  and  mandatory  orders in the
nature of  injunctions  and compelling the production of documents and witnesses
for pre-arbitration  discovery and/or presentation at the arbitration hearing on
the merits of the case. The arbitration  panel shall not have legal or equitable
authority to issue a mandatory or  prohibitory  order which:  (a) extends or has
effect  beyond the  subject  matter of this  Agreement,  or (b) will  govern the
activities  of either  party for a period of more than two years;  nor shall the
arbitration panel have authority to award punitive, consequential or any damages
whatsoever  beyond or in  addition  to the  compensatory  damages  allowed to be
awarded under this Agreement.

The decision of the arbitration panel shall be in written form and shall include
findings of fact and conclusions of law.

It is the intent and desire of DEALER and CC to hereby and forever  renounce and
reject any and all recourse to litigation  before any judicial or administrative
forum and to accept  the award of the  arbitration  panel as final and  binding,
subject to no judicial or  administrative  review,  except on those  grounds set
forth in 9 USC ss.10 and  ss.11.  Judgment  on the award  and/or  orders  may be
entered in any court having  jurisdiction  over the parties or their assets.  In
the final award  and/or  order,  the  arbitration  panel shall  divide all costs
(other than attorney fees, which shall be borne by the party incurring such fees
and other costs  specifically  provided for herein)  incurred in conducting  the
arbitration  in  accordance  with  what the  arbitration  panel  deems  just and
equitable under the circumstances. The fees of DEALER's arbitrator shall be paid
by DEALER. The fees of CC's arbitrator shall be paid by CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10. SIGNATURE.

This  Agreement  becomes  valid  only  when  signed by the  President  or a Vice
President or the National Dealer Placement  Manager of Chrysler  Corporation and
by a duly authorized officer or executive of DEALER if a corporation;  or by one
of  the  general  partners  of  DEALER  if a  partnership;  or by  DEALER  if an
individual.

IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the parties  hereto have  signed this  Agreement  which is
finally executed at Auburn Hills, Michigan, in triplicate, on June 04, 1997.

FORT MILL CHRYSLER-PLYMOUTH-DODGE, INC.
- -------------------------------------------
(DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

By: /s/   O. Bruton Smith
    ---------------------------------------
   (Individual Duly Authorized to Sign)

- -------------------------------------------
                 (Title)

            CHRYSLER CORPORATION

By: /s/ ILLEGIBLE
    ---------------------------------------
              National Dealer 
             Placement Manager
- -------------------------------------------
                 (Title)


    

   

                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                    DODGE

                           SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT

                     Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge, Inc.
                   (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

located at 3310 Highway 51 at Carowinds Boulevard    Fort Mill    South Carolina
                    (STREET)                          (CITY)        (STATE)

a(n)           Corporation                     hereinafter  called   DEALER  and
     (INDIVIDUAL, CORPORATION OR PARTNERSHIP)

Chrysler Corporation, a Delaware corporation,  hereinafter sometimes referred to
as "CC",  have entered into this  Chrysler  Corporation  Dodge Sales and Service
Agreement,  hereinafter  referred to as  "Agreement",  the terms of which are as
follows:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     INTRODUCTION

The purpose of the  relationship  established  by this Agreement is to provide a
means for the sale and service of  specified  Dodge  vehicles and the sale of CC
vehicle  parts  and  accessories  in  a  manner  that  will  maximize   customer
satisfaction and be of benefit to DEALER and CC.

While  the  following  provisions,  each of which is  material,  set  forth  the
undertakings of this relationship,  the success of those undertakings rests on a
recognition  of the  mutuality  of  interests  of DEALER and CC, and a spirit of
understanding  and  cooperation by both parties in the day to day performance of
their respective functions.  As a result of such considerations,  CC has entered
into this  Agreement  in reliance  upon and has placed its trust in the personal
abilities,  expertise,  knowledge and integrity of DEALER's principal owners and
management  personnel,  which CC  anticipates  will enable DEALER to perform the
personal services contemplated by this Agreement.

It is the mutual  goal of this  relationship  to promote the sale and service of
specified  CC  products  by  maintaining  and  advancing  their  excellence  and
reputation by earning,  holding and  furthering the public regard for CC and all
CC dealers.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1    PRODUCTS COVERED

DEALER has the right to order and  purchase  from CC and to sell at retail  only
those  specific  models of CC vehicles,  sometimes  referred to as "specified CC
vehicles,"   listed  on  the  Motor  Vehicle   Addendum,   attached  hereto  and
incorporated herein by reference. CC may change the models of CC vehicles listed
on the Motor Vehicle Addendum by furnishing  DEALER a superseding  Motor Vehicle
Addendum.  Such a  superseding  Motor  Vehicle  Addendum  will not be  deemed or
construed to be an amendment to this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2    DEALER'S MANAGEMENT

CC has  entered  into this  Agreement  relying on the  active,  substantial  and
continuing personal participation in the management of DEALER's organization by:

          NAME                                        POSITION

William Saddler Anderson                         General Manager
- -------------------------------------            ------------------------------

Bryan Scott Smith                                Vice President
- -------------------------------------            ------------------------------



<PAGE>



DEALER represents and warrants that at least one of the above-named  individuals
will be physically  present at the DEALER's facility  (sometimes  referred to as
"Dealership  Facilities") during most of its operating hours and will manage all
of DEALER's  business  relating to the sale and service of CC  products.  DEALER
shall not change the personnel  holding the above  described  position(s) or the
nature and extent of his/her/their  management  participation  without the prior
written approval of CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3    DEALER'S CAPITAL STOCK OR PARTNERSHIP INTEREST

If DEALER is a corporation or partnership, DEALER represents and agrees that the
persons named below own beneficially  the capital stock or partnership  interest
of DEALER in the percentages  indicated below.  DEALER warrants there will be no
change  affecting  more than 50% of the ownership  interest of DEALER,  nor will
there be any other change in the  ownership  interest of DEALER which may affect
the managerial control of DEALER without CC's prior written approval.

                              Voting      Non-Voting    Partnership     Active
         Name                  Stock        Stock         Interest      Yes/No

Sonic Auto World, Inc.         100.00 %            %              %        No
- -------------------------   ----------    ---------     ----------       ------
                                      %            %              %
- -------------------------   ----------    ---------     ----------       ------
                                      %            %              %
- -------------------------   ----------    ---------     ----------       ------
                                      %            %              %
- -------------------------   ----------    ---------     ----------       ------
Total                          100.00 %            %              %   
                            ----------    ---------     ----------      
                                                                  


- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4    SALES LOCALITY.

DEALER shall have the  non-exclusive  right,  subject to the  provisions of this
Agreement,  to purchase from CC those new specified CC vehicles,  vehicle parts,
accessories  and other CC products  for resale at the  DEALER's  facilities  and
location described in the Dealership Facilities and Location Addendum,  attached
hereto  and  incorporated   herein  by  reference.   DEALER  will  actively  and
effectively  sell and promote the retail sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts and
accessories in DEALER's Sales Locality.  As used herein,  "Sales Locality" shall
mean the area  designated  in  writing  to DEALER by CC from time to time as the
territory of DEALER's responsibility for the sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts
and  accessories,  although  DEALER is free to sell said  products to  customers
wherever  they may be located.  Said Sales  Locality may be shared with other CC
dealers of the same line-make as CC determines to be appropriate.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
5    ADDITIONAL TERMS AND PROVISIONS

The additional terms and provisions set forth in the document entitled "Chrysler
Corporation Sales and Service Agreement  Additional Terms and Provisions" marked
"Form 91 (C-P-D)," as may  hereafter be amended from time to time,  constitute a
part of this  Agreement with the same force and effect as if set forth at length
herein,  and the term  "this  Agreement"  includes  said  additional  terms  and
provisions.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6    FORMER AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR STATEMENTS

This Chrysler  Corporation Dodge Sales and Service Agreement and other documents
(or their successors as specifically provided for herein) which are specifically
incorporated  herein by reference  constitute the entire  agreement  between the
parties  relating to the purchase by DEALER of those new  specified CC vehicles,
parts and  accessories  from CC for resale;  and it cancels and  supersedes  all
earlier  agreements,  written or oral,  between CC and  DEALER  relating  to the
purchase  by DEALER of Dodge  vehicles,  parts and  accessories,  except for (a)
amounts owing by CC to DEALER,  such as payments for warranty service  performed
and  incentive  programs,  or (b) amounts owing or which may be determined to be
owed, as a result of an audit or investigation,  by DEALER to CC due to DEALER's
purchase from CC of vehicles, parts, accessories and other goods or services, or
(c) amounts DEALER owes


<PAGE>


to  CC,  as a  result  of  other  extensions  of  credit  by  CC to  DEALER.  No
representations  or statements,  other than those  expressly set forth herein or
those set forth in the applications for this Agreement submitted to CC by DEALER
or  DEALER's  representatives,  are made or relied  upon by any party  hereto in
entering into this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7    WAIVER AND MODIFICATION

No  waiver,  modification  or change of any of the  terms of this  Agreement  or
change or  erasure of any  printed  part of this  Agreement  or  addition  to it
(except the filling in of blank spaces and lines) will be valid or binding on CC
unless  approved in writing by the President or a Vice President or the National
Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
8    AMENDMENT

DEALER and CC recognize that this Agreement does not have an expiration date and
will continue in effect unless  terminated under the limited  circumstances  set
forth in Paragraph 28. DEALER and CC further recognize that the passage of time,
changes  in  the  industry,   ways  of  doing  business  and  other   unforeseen
circumstances  may  cause CC to  determine  that it should  amend  all  Chrysler
Corporation  Dodge Sales and  Service  Agreements.  Therefore,  CC will have the
right to amend this  Agreement to the extent that CC deems  advisable,  provided
that CC makes the same amendment in Chrysler Corporation Dodge Sales and Service
Agreements  generally.  Each such  amendment  will be issued in a notice sent by
certified mail or delivered in person to DEALER and signed by the President or a
Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.
Thirty-five  (35) days after mailing or delivery of such notice to DEALER,  this
Agreement  will be deemed  amended  in the manner and to the extent set forth in
the notice.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
9    ARBITRATION

Any and all disputes  arising out of or in connection  with the  interpretation,
performance or non-performance of this Agreement or any and all disputes arising
out of or in connection  with  transactions in any way related to this Agreement
(including,  but not limited to, the validity,  scope and enforceability of this
arbitration provision, or disputes under rights granted pursuant to the statutes
of the state in which  DEALER  is  licensed)  shall be  finally  and  completely
resolved by arbitration pursuant to the arbitration laws of the United States of
America as codified in Title 9 of the United States Code, ss.ss.1-14,  under the
Rules  of  Commercial  Arbitration  of  the  American  Arbitration   Association
(hereinafter  referred to as the "Rules") by a majority vote of a panel of three
arbitrators.  One arbitrator will be selected by DEALER  (DEALER's  arbitrator).
One arbitrator will be selected by CC (CC's arbitrator).  These arbitrators must
be  selected  by the  respective  parties  within ten (10)  business  days after
receipt by either DEALER or CC of a written notification from the other party of
a decision to arbitrate a dispute  pursuant to this Agreement.  Should either CC
or DEALER fail to select an arbitrator within said ten-day period, the party who
so fails to  select  an  arbitrator  will have its  arbitrator  selected  by the
American  Arbitration  Association  upon the application of the other party. The
third   arbitrator   must  be  an  individual  who  is  familiar  with  business
transactions and be a licensed  attorney  admitted to the practice of law within
the United States of America,  or a judge. The third arbitrator will be selected
by DEALER's and CC's  arbitrators.  If said arbitrators  cannot agree on a third
arbitrator  within thirty (30) days from the date of the appointment of the last
selected  arbitrator,  then either  DEALER's or CC's arbitrator may apply to the
American  Arbitration  Association to appoint said third arbitrator  pursuant to
the  criteria  set  forth  above.  The  arbitration   panel  shall  conduct  the
proceedings pursuant to the then existing Rules.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any provision of the Rules conflict
with any provision of this  Paragraph 9, the provisions of this Paragraph 9 will
be controlling.

CC and DEALER agree to facilitate the  arbitration  by: (a) each party paying to
the American  Arbitration  Association  one-half  (1/2) of the required  deposit
before the proceedings commence;  (b) making available to one another and to the
arbitration  panel,  for inspection and  photocopying  all documents,  books and
records,  if  determined by the  arbitrator  to be relevant to the dispute;  (c)
making available to one another and to the arbitration panel personnel  directly
or indirectly under their control,  for testimony during hearings and prehearing
proceedings  if  determined  by the  arbitration  panel  to be  relevant  to the
dispute; (d) conducting  arbitration hearings to the greatest extent possible on
consecutive   business  days;  and  (e)  strictly  observing  the  time  periods
established  by the  Rules or by the  arbitration  panel for the  submission  of
evidence and of briefs.


<PAGE>


Unless  otherwise  agreed  to by CC and  DEALER,  a  stenographic  record of the
arbitration  shall be made and a  transcript  thereof  shall be ordered for each
party, with each party paying one-half (1/2) of the total cost of such recording
and transcription.  The stenographer shall be state-certified,  if certification
is made by the  state,  and the  party  to whom it is most  convenient  shall be
responsible  for securing and notifying such  stenographer of the time and place
of the arbitration hearing(s).

If the arbitration  provision is invoked when the dispute between the parties is
either the legality of  terminating  this Agreement or of adding a new CC dealer
of the same line-make or relocating an existing CC dealer of the same line-make,
CC will stay the  implementation  of the decision to terminate this Agreement or
add such new CC dealer or approve the relocation of an existing CC dealer of the
same  line-make  until  the  decision  of the  arbitrator  has  been  announced,
providing  DEALER does not in any way attempt to avoid the  obligations  of this
Paragraph  9,  in  which  case  the  decision  at  issue  will  be   immediately
implemented.

Except as limited hereby, the arbitration panel shall have all powers of law and
equity, which it can lawfully assume, necessary to resolve the issues in dispute
including,  without  limiting the generality of the foregoing,  making awards of
compensatory  damages,  issuing both  prohibitory  and  mandatory  orders in the
nature of  injunctions  and compelling the production of documents and witnesses
for pre-arbitration  discovery and/or presentation at the arbitration hearing on
the merits of the case. The arbitration  panel shall not have legal or equitable
authority to issue a mandatory or  prohibitory  order which:  (a) extends or has
effect  beyond the  subject  matter of this  Agreement,  or (b) will  govern the
activities  of either  party for a period of more than two years;  nor shall the
arbitration panel have authority to award punitive, consequential or any damages
whatsoever  beyond or in  addition  to the  compensatory  damages  allowed to be
awarded under this Agreement.

The decision of the arbitration panel shall be in written form and shall include
findings of fact and conclusions of law.

It is the intent and desire of DEALER and CC to hereby and forever
renounce  and reject any and all recourse to  litigation  before any judicial or
administrative  forum and to accept the award of the arbitration  panel as final
and binding,  subject to no judicial or administrative  review,  except on those
grounds set forth in 9 USC ss.10 and ss.11.  Judgment on the award and/or orders
may be  entered  in any court  having  jurisdiction  over the  parties  or their
assets.  In the final award and/or order, the arbitration panel shall divide all
costs (other than  attorney  fees,  which shall be borne by the party  incurring
such  fees and  other  costs  specifically  provided  for  herein)  incurred  in
conducting the arbitration in accordance  with what the arbitration  panel deems
just and  equitable  under the  circumstances.  The fees of DEALER's  arbitrator
shall be paid by DEALER. The fees of CC's arbitrator shall be paid by CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10   SIGNATURE

This Agreement becomes valid only when signed by the President or a
Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler  Corporation
and by a duly authorized officer or executive of DEALER if a corporation;  or by
one of the  general  partners  of  DEALER if a  partnership;  or by DEALER if an
individual.

IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the parties  hereto have  signed this  Agreement  which is
finally executed at Auburn Hills, Michigan, in triplicate, on June 4, 1997.

                                  FORT MILL CHRYSLER-PLYMOUTH-DODGE, INC.
                                  ----------------------------------------------
                                   (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A/, if applicable)

                                  By: /s/ O. Bruton Smith
                                      ------------------------------------------
                                         (Individual Duly Authorized to Sign)


                                  ----------------------------------------------
                                                    (Title)

                                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                  By: /s/ [ILLEGIBLE]
                                     -------------------------------------------
                                                National Dealer
                                               Placement Manager
                                  ----------------------------------------------
                                                    (Title)

    

   
                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                      DODGE

                           SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT

         Sonic Dodge, L.L.C. dba Lake Norman Dodge located at 20700 Torrence
Chapel Road, Cornelius, North Carolina, a corporation, hereinafter called DEALER
and Chrysler Corporation, a Delaware corporation, hereinafter sometimes referred
to as "CC", have entered into this Chrysler Corporation Dodge Sales and Service
Agreement, hereinafter referred to as "Agreement", the terms of which are as
follows:

INTRODUCTION.

         The purpose of the relationship established by this Agreement is to
provide a means for the sale and service of specified Dodge vehicles and the
sale of CC vehicle parts and accessories in a manner that will maximize customer
satisfaction and be of benefit to DEALER and CC.

         While the following provisions, each of which is material, set forth
the undertakings of this relationship, the success of those undertakings rests
on a recognition of the mutuality of interests of DEALER and CC, and a spirit of
understanding and cooperation by both parties in the day to day performance of
their respective functions. As a result of such considerations, CC has entered
into this Agreement in reliance upon and has placed its trust in the personal
abilities, expertise, knowledge and integrity of DEALER's principal owners and
management personnel, which CC anticipates will enable DEALER to perform the
personal services contemplated by this Agreement.

         It is the mutual goal of this relationship to promote the sale and
service of specified CC products by maintaining and advancing their excellence
and reputation by earning, holding and furthering the public regard for CC and
all CC dealers.

1.       PRODUCTS COVERED.

         DEALER has the right to order and purchase from CC and to sell at
retail only those specific models of CC vehicles, sometimes referred to as
"specified CC vehicles," listed on the Motor Vehicle Addendum, attached hereto
and incorporated herein by reference. CC may change the models of CC vehicles
listed on the Motor Vehicle Addendum by furnishing DEALER a superseding Motor
Vehicle Addendum. Such a superseding Motor Vehicle Addendum will not be deemed
or construed or to be an amendment to this Agreement.

2.       DEALER'S MANAGEMENT.

         CC has entered into this Agreement relying on the active, substantial
and continuing personal participation in the management of DEALER's organization
by:



<PAGE>



                  NAME                                         POSITION

         Phil M. Gandy, III                                    General Manager

         Bryan Scott Smith                                     C.E.O.

         DEALER represents and warrants that at least one of the above-named
individuals will be physically present at the DEALER's facility (sometimes
referred to as "Dealership Facilities") during most of its operating hours and
will manage all of DEALER's business relating to the sale and service of CC
products. DEALER shall not change the personnel holding the above described
position(s) or the nature and extent of his/her/their management participation
without the prior written approval of CC.

3.       DEALER'S CAPITAL STOCK OR PARTNERSHIP INTEREST.

         If DEALER is a corporation or partnership, DEALER represents and agrees
that the persons named below own beneficially the capital stock or partnership
interest of DEALER in the percentages indicated below. DEALER warrants there
will be no change affecting more than 50% of the ownership interest of DEALER,
nor will there be any other change in the ownership interest of DEALER which may
affect the managerial control of DEALER without CC's prior written approval.

                          Voting       Non-Voting      Partnership      Active
         Name              Stock            Stock         Interest      Yes/No

Sonic Automotive, Inc.         100.00%               %                %   No
- ------------------------- -----------  --------------  ---------------  -------
- ------------------------- -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
- ------------------------- -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
- ------------------------- -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
- ------------------------- -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
Total                          100.00%               %                %
                          -----------  --------------  ---------------

4.       SALES LOCALITY.

         DEALER shall have the non-exclusive right, subject to the provisions of
this Agreement, to purchase from CC those new specified CC vehicles, vehicle
parts, accessories and other CC products for resale at the DEALER's facilities
and location described in the Dealership Facilities and Location Addendum,
attached hereto and incorporated herein by reference. DEALER will actively and
effectively sell and promote the retail sale of CC vehicles, vehicle parts and
accessories in DEALER's Sales Locality. As used herein, "Sales Locality" shall
mean the area designated in writing to DEALER by CC from time to time as the
territory of DEALER's responsibility for the sale of CC vehicles, vehicle parts
and accessories, although DEALER is free to sell said products to customers
wherever they may be located. Said Sales Locality may be shared with other CC
dealers of the same line-make as CC determines to be appropriate.

                                        2


<PAGE>



         5.       ADDITIONAL TERMS AND PROVISIONS.

         The additional terms and provisions set forth in the document entitled
"Chrysler Corporation Sales and Service Agreement Additional Terms and
Provisions" marked "Form 91 (C-P-D)," as may hereafter be amended from time to
time, constitute a part of this Agreement with the same force and effect as if
set forth at length herein, and the term "this Agreement" includes said
additional terms and provisions.

         6.       FORMER AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR STATEMENTS.

         This Chrysler Corporation Dodge Sales and Service Agreement and other
documents (or their successors as specifically provided for herein) which are
specifically incorporated herein by reference constitute the entire agreement
between the parties relating to the purchase by DEALER of those new specified CC
vehicles, parts and accessories from CC for resale; and it cancels and
supersedes all earlier agreements, written or oral, between CC and DEALER
relating to the purchase by DEALER of Dodge vehicles, parts and accessories,
except for (a) amounts owing by CC to DEALER, such as payments for warranty
service performed and incentive programs, or (b) amounts owing or which may be
determined to be owed, as a result of an audit or investigation, by DEALER to CC
due to DEALER's purchase from CC of vehicles, parts, accessories and other goods
or services, or (c) amounts DEALER owes to CC, as a result of other extensions
of credit by CC to DEALER. No representations or statements, other than those
expressly set forth herein or those set forth in the applications for this
Agreement submitted to CC by DEALER or DEALER's representatives, are made or
relied upon by any party hereto in entering into this Agreement.

         7.       WAIVER AND MODIFICATION.

         No waiver, modification or change of any of the terms of this Agreement
or change or erasure of any printed part of this Agreement or addition to it
(except the filling in of blank spaces and lines) will be valid or binding on CC
unless approved in writing by the President or a Vice President or the National
Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.

         8.       AMENDMENT.

         DEALER and CC recognize that this Agreement does not have an expiration
date and will continue in effect unless terminated under the limited
circumstances set forth in Paragraph 28. DEALER and CC further recognize that
the passage of time, changes in the industry, ways of doing business and other
unforeseen circumstances may cause CC to determine that it should amend all
Chrysler Corporation Dodge Sales and Service Agreements. Therefore, CC will have
the right to amend this Agreement to the extent that CC deems advisable,
provided that CC makes the same amendment in Chrysler Corporation Dodge Sales
and Service Agreements generally. Each such amendment will be issued in a notice
sent by certified mail or delivered in person to DEALER and signed by the
President or a Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of
Chrysler Corporation. Thirty-five (35) days after mailing or delivery of

                                        3


<PAGE>



such notice to DEALER, this Agreement will be deemed amended in the manner and
to the extent set forth in the notice.

9.       ARBITRATION.

         Any and all disputes arising out of or in connection with the
interpretation, performance or non-performance of this Agreement or any and all
disputes arising out of or in connection with transactions in any way related to
this Agreement (including, but not limited to, the validity, scope and
enforceability of this arbitration provision, or disputes under rights granted
pursuant to the statutes of the state in which DEALER is licensed) shall be
finally and completely resolved by arbitration pursuant to the arbitration laws
of the United States of America as codified in Title 9 of the United States
Code, ss.ss.1-14, under the Rules of Commercial Arbitration of the American
Arbitration Association (hereinafter referred to as the "Rules") by a majority
vote of a panel of three arbitrators. One arbitrator will be selected by DEALER
(DEALER's arbitrator). One arbitrator will be selected by CC (CC's arbitrator).
These arbitrators must be selected by the respective parties within ten (10)
business days after receipt by either DEALER or CC of a written notification
from the other party of a decision to arbitrate a dispute pursuant to this
Agreement. Should either CC or DEALER fail to select an arbitrator within said
ten-day period, the party who so fails to select an arbitrator will have its
arbitrator selected by the American Arbitration Association upon the application
of the other party. The third arbitrator must be an individual who is familiar
with business transactions and be a licensed attorney admitted to the practice
of law within the United States of America, or a judge. The third arbitrator
will be selected by DEALER's and CC's arbitrators. If said arbitrators cannot
agree on a third arbitrator within thirty (30) days from the date of the
appointment of the last selected arbitrator, then either DEALER's or CC's
arbitrator may apply to the American Arbitration Association to appoint said
third arbitrator pursuant to the criteria set forth above. The arbitration panel
shall conduct the proceedings pursuant to the then existing Rules.

         Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any provision of the Rules
conflict with any provision of this Paragraph 9, the provisions of this
Paragraph 9 will be controlling.

         CC and DEALER agree to facilitate the arbitration by: (a) each party
paying to the American Arbitration Association one-half (1/2) of the required
deposit before the proceedings commence; (b) making available to one another and
to the arbitration panel, for inspection and photocopying all documents, books
and records, if determined by the arbitrator to be relevant to the dispute; (c)
making available to one another and to the arbitration panel personnel directly
or indirectly under their control, for testimony during hearings and prehearing
proceedings if determined by the arbitration panel to be relevant to the
dispute; (d) conducting arbitration hearings to the greatest extent possible on
consecutive business days; and (e) strictly observing the time periods
established by the Rules or by the arbitration panel for the submission of
evidence and of briefs.

         Unless otherwise agreed to by CC and DEALER, a stenographic record of
the arbitration shall be made and a transcript thereof shall be ordered for each
party, with each party paying

                                        4


<PAGE>



one-half (1/2) of the total cost of such recording and transcription. The
stenographer shall be state-certified, if certification is made by the state,
and the party to whom it is most convenient shall be responsible for securing
and notifying such stenographer of the time and place of the arbitration
hearing(s).

         If the arbitration provision is invoked when the dispute between the
parties is either the legality of terminating this Agreement or of adding a new
CC dealer of the same line-make or relocating an existing CC dealer of the same
line-make, CC will stay the implementation of the decision to terminate this
Agreement or add such new CC dealer or approve the relocation of an existing CC
dealer of the same line-make until the decision of the arbitrator has been
announced, providing DEALER does not in any way attempt to avoid the obligations
of this Paragraph 9, in which case the decision at issue will be immediately
implemented.

         Except as limited hereby, the arbitration panel shall have all powers
of law and equity, which it can lawfully assume, necessary to resolve the issues
in dispute including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, making
awards of compensatory damages, issuing both prohibitory and mandatory orders in
the nature of injunctions and compelling the production of documents and
witnesses for pre-arbitration discovery and/or presentation at the arbitration
hearing on the merits of the case. The arbitration panel shall not have legal or
equitable authority to issue a mandatory or prohibitory order which: (a) extends
or has effect beyond the subject matter of this Agreement, or (b) will govern
the activities of either party for a period of more than two years; nor shall
the arbitration panel have authority to award punitive, consequential or any
damages whatsoever beyond or in addition to the compensatory damages allowed to
be awarded under this Agreement.

         The decision of the arbitration panel shall be in written form and
shall include findings of fact and conclusions of law.

         It is the intent and desire of DEALER and CC to hereby and forever
renounce and reject any and all recourse to litigation before any judicial or
administrative forum and to accept the award of the arbitration panel as final
and binding, subject to no judicial or administrative review, except on those
grounds set forth in 9 USC ss.10 and ss.11. Judgment on the award and/or orders
may be entered in any court having jurisdiction over the parties or their
assets. In the final award and/or order, the arbitration panel shall divide all
costs (other than attorney fees, which shall be borne by the party incurring
such fees and other costs specifically provided for herein) incurred in
conducting the arbitration in accordance with what the arbitration panel deems
just and equitable under the circumstances. The fees of DEALER's arbitrator
shall be paid by DEALER. The fees of CC's arbitrator shall be paid by CC.

10.      SIGNATURE.

         This Agreement becomes valid only when signed by the President or a
Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation
and by a duly authorized

                                        5


<PAGE>


officer or executive of DEALER if a corporation; or by one of the general
partners of DEALER if a partnership; or by DEALER if an individual.

         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have signed this Agreement which
is finally executed at Auburn Hills, Michigan, in triplicate, on September 29,
1997.

                                 SONIC DODGE, L.L.C.
                                 dba Lake Norman Dodge

                                 By: /s/   O. Bruton Smith
                                     --------------------------------
                                          (Individual Duly Authorized to Sign)

                                 ----------------------------------------------
                                                   (Title)

                                 CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                 By: /s/ V. W. Gray
                                     -------------------------------------------
                                          National Dealer Placement Manager
                                          --------------------------------------
                                                   (Title)

                                        6

    
<PAGE>


   
                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                    CHRYSLER

                           SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT

         Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, L.L.C. dba Lake Norman Chrysler
Plymouth Jeep located at 20435 Chartwell Center Drive, Cornelius, North
Carolina, a corporation hereinafter called DEALER, and Chrysler Corporation, a
Delaware corporation, hereinafter sometimes referred to as "CC", have entered
into this Chrysler Corporation Chrysler Sales and Service Agreement, hereinafter
referred to as "Agreement", the terms of which are as follows:

INTRODUCTION

         The purpose of the relationship established by this Agreement is to
provide a means for the sale and service of specified Chrysler vehicles and the
sale of CC vehicle parts and accessories in a manner that will maximize customer
satisfaction and be of benefit to DEALER and CC.

         While the following provisions, each of which is material, set forth
the undertakings of this relationship, the success of those undertakings rests
on a recognition of the mutuality of interests of DEALER and CC, and a spirit of
understanding and cooperation by both parties in the day to day performance of
their respective functions. As a result of such considerations, CC has entered
into this Agreement in reliance upon and has placed its trust in the personal
abilities, expertise, knowledge and integrity of DEALER's principal owners and
management personnel, which CC anticipates will enable DEALER to perform the
personal services contemplated by this Agreement.

         It is the mutual goal of this relationship to promote the sale and
service of specified CC products by maintaining and advancing their excellence
and reputation by earning, holding and furthering the public regard for CC and
all CC dealers.

1.       PRODUCTS COVERED

         DEALER has the right to order and purchase from CC and to sell at
retail only those specific models of CC vehicles, sometimes referred to as
"specified CC vehicles," listed on the Motor Vehicle Addendum, attached hereto
and incorporated herein by reference. CC may change the models of CC vehicles
listed on the Motor Vehicle Addendum by furnishing DEALER a superseding Motor
Vehicle Addendum. Such a superseding Motor Vehicle Addendum will not be deemed
or construed to be an amendment to this Agreement.

<PAGE>

2.       DEALER'S MANAGEMENT

         CC has entered into this Agreement relying on the active, substantial
and continuing personal participation in the management of DEALER's organization
by:

                  NAME                          POSITION

William Martin Sullivan                         General Manager

Bryan Scott Smith                               C.E.O.

         DEALER represents and warrants that at least one of the above named
individuals will be physically present at the DEALER's facility (sometimes
referred to as "Dealership Facilities") during most of its operating hours and
will manage all of DEALER's business relating to the sale and service of CC
products. DEALER shall not change the personnel holding the above described
position(s) or the nature and extent of his/her/their management participation
without the prior written approval of CC.

3.       DEALER'S CAPITAL STOCK OR PARTNERSHIP INTEREST

         If DEALER is a corporation or partnership, DEALER represents and agrees
that the persons named below own beneficially the capital stock or partnership
interest of DEALER in the percentages indicated below. DEALER warrants there
will be no change affecting more than 50% of the ownership interest of DEALER
nor will there be any other change in the ownership interest of DEALER which may
affect the managerial control of DEALER without CC's prior written approval.


                           Voting       Non-Voting      Partnership      Active
         Name               Stock            Stock         Interest      Yes/No

Sonic Automotive,Inc.           100.00%               %                %   No
- -------------------------  -----------  --------------  ---------------  -------
- -------------------------  -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
- -------------------------  -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
- -------------------------  -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
- -------------------------  -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
Total                           100.00%               %                %
                           -----------  --------------  ---------------

4.       SALES LOCALITY

         DEALER shall have the non-exclusive right, subject to the provisions of
this Agreement, to purchase from CC those new specified CC vehicles, vehicle
parts, accessories and other CC products for resale at the DEALER's facilities
and location described in the Dealership Facilities and Location Addendum,
attached hereto and incorporated herein by reference. DEALER will actively and
effectively sell and promote the retail sale of CC vehicles, vehicle parts and
accessories in DEALER's Sales Locality. As used herein, "Sales Locality" shall
mean the area designated in writing to DEALER by CC from time to time as the
territory of DEALER's responsibility for the sale of CC vehicles, vehicle parts
and accessories, although DEALER is free to sell said products to customers
wherever they may be located. Said Sales Locality may be shared with other CC
dealers of the same line-make as CC determines to be appropriate.


                                        2


<PAGE>



5.       ADDITIONAL TERMS AND PROVISIONS

         The additional terms and provisions set forth in the document entitled
"Chrysler Corporation Sales and Service Agreement Additional Terms and
Provisions" marked "Form 91 (C-P-D)," as may hereafter be amended from time to
time, constitute a part of this Agreement with the same force and effect as if
set forth at length herein, and the term "this Agreement" includes said
additional terms and provisions.

6.       FORMER AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR STATEMENTS

         This Chrysler Corporation Chrysler Sales and Service Agreement and
other documents, (or their successors as specifically provided for herein) which
are specifically incorporated herein by reference constitute the entire
agreement between the parties relating to the purchase by DEALER of those new
specified CC vehicles, parts and accessories from CC for resale; and it cancels
and supersedes all earlier agreements, written or oral, between CC and DEALER
relating to the purchase by DEALER of Chrysler vehicles, parts and accessories,
except for (a) amounts owing by CC to DEALER, such as payments for warranty
service performed and incentive programs, or (b) amounts owing or which may be
determined to be owed, as a result of an audit or investigation, by DEALER to CC
due to DEALER's purchase from CC of vehicles, parts, accessories and other goods
or services, or (c) amounts DEALER owes to CC as a result of other extensions of
credit by CC to DEALER. No representations or statements, other than those
expressly set forth herein or those set forth in the applications for this
Agreement submitted to CC by DEALER or DEALER's representatives, are made or
relied upon by any party hereto in entering into this Agreement.

7.       WAIVER AND MODIFICATION

         No waiver, modification or change of any of the terms of this Agreement
or change or erasure of any printed part of this Agreement or addition to it
(except the filling in of blank spaces and lines) will be valid or binding on CC
unless approved in writing by the President or a Vice President or the National
Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.

8.       AMENDMENT

         DEALER and CC recognize that this Agreement does not have an expiration
date and will continue in effect unless terminated under the limited
circumstances set forth in Paragraph 28. DEALER and CC further recognize that
the passage of time, changes in the industry, ways of doing business and other
unforeseen circumstances may cause CC to determine that it should amend all
Chrysler Corporation Chrysler Sales and Service Agreements. Therefore, CC will
have the right to amend this Agreement to the extent that CC deems advisable,
provided that CC makes the same amendment in Chrysler Corporation Chrysler Sales
and Service Agreements generally. Each such amendment will be issued in a notice
sent by certified mail or delivered in person to DEALER and signed by the
President or a Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of
Chrysler Corporation. Thirty-five (35) days after mailing or delivery of

                                       3


<PAGE>



such notice to DEALER, this Agreement will be deemed amended in the manner and
to the extent set forth in the notice.

9.       ARBITRATION

         Any and all disputes arising out of or in connection with the
interpretation, performance or non-performance of this Agreement or any and all
disputes arising out of or in connection with transactions in any way related to
this Agreement (including, but not limited to, the validity, scope and
enforceability of this arbitration provision, or disputes under rights granted
pursuant to the statutes of the state in which DEALER is licensed) shall be
finally and completely resolved by arbitration pursuant to the arbitration laws
of the United States of America as codified in Title 9 of the United States
Code, ss.ss.1-14, under the Rules of Commercial Arbitration of the American
Arbitration Association (hereinafter referred to as the "Rules") by a majority
vote of a panel of three arbitrators. One arbitrator will be selected by DEALER
(DEALER's arbitrator). One arbitrator will be selected by CC (CC's arbitrator).
These arbitrators must be selected by the respective parties within ten (10)
business days after receipt by either DEALER or CC of a written notification
from the other party of a decision to arbitrate a dispute pursuant to this
Agreement. Should either CC or DEALER fail to select an arbitrator within said
ten-day period, the party who so fails to select an arbitrator will have its
arbitrator selected by the American Arbitration Association upon the application
of the other party. The third arbitrator must be an individual who is familiar
with business transactions and be a licensed attorney admitted to the practice
of law within the United States of America, or a judge. The third arbitrator
will be selected by DEALER's and CC's arbitrators. If said arbitrators cannot
agree on a third arbitrator within thirty (30) days from the date of the
appointment of the last selected arbitrator, then either DEALER's or CC's
arbitrator may apply to the American Arbitration Association to appoint said
third arbitrator pursuant to the criteria set forth above. The arbitration panel
shall conduct the proceedings pursuant to the then existing Rules.

         Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any provision of the Rules
conflict with any provision of this Paragraph 9, the provisions of this
Paragraph 9 will be controlling.

         CC and DEALER agree to facilitate the arbitration by: (a) each party
paying to the American Arbitration Association one-half (1/2) of the required
deposit before the proceedings commence; (b) making available to one another and
to the arbitration panel, for inspection and photocopying all documents, books
and records, if determined by the arbitrator to be relevant to the dispute; (c)
making available to one another and to the arbitration panel personnel directly
or indirectly under their control, for testimony during hearings and prehearing
proceedings if determined by the arbitration panel to be relevant to the
dispute; (d) conducting arbitration hearings to the greatest extent possible on
consecutive business days; and (e) strictly observing the time periods
established by the Rules or by the arbitration panel for the submission of
evidence and of briefs.

         Unless otherwise agreed to by CC and DEALER, a stenographic record of
the arbitration shall be made and a transcript thereof shall be ordered for each
party, with each party paying

                                       4


<PAGE>



one-half (1/2) of the total cost of such recording and transcription. The
stenographer shall be state-certified, if certification is made by the state,
and the party to whom it is most convenient shall be responsible for securing
and notifying such stenographer of the time and place of the arbitration
hearing(s).

         If the arbitration provision is invoked when the dispute between the
parties is either the legality of terminating this Agreement or of adding a new
CC dealer of the same line-make or relocating an existing CC dealer of the same
line-make, CC will stay the implementation of the decision to terminate this
Agreement or add such new CC dealer or approve the relocation of an existing CC
dealer of the same line-make until the decision of the arbitrator has been
announced, providing DEALER does not in any way attempt to avoid the obligations
of this Paragraph 9, in which case the decision at issue will be immediately
implemented.

         Except as limited hereby, the arbitration panel shall have all powers
of law and equity, which it can lawfully assume, necessary to resolve the issues
in dispute including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, making
awards of compensatory damages, issuing both prohibitory and mandatory orders in
the nature of injunctions and compelling the production of documents and
witnesses for pre-arbitration discovery and/or presentation at the arbitration
hearing on the merits of the case. The arbitration panel shall not have legal or
equitable authority to issue a mandatory or prohibitory order which: (a) extends
or has effect beyond the subject matter of this Agreement, or (b) will govern
the activities of either party for a period of more than two years; nor shall
the arbitration panel have authority to award punitive, consequential or any
damages whatsoever beyond or in addition to the compensatory damages allowed to
be awarded under this Agreement.

         The decision of the arbitration panel shall be in written form and
shall include findings of fact and conclusions of law.

         It is the intent and desire of DEALER and CC to hereby and forever
renounce and reject any and all recourse to litigation before any judicial or
administrative forum and to accept the award of the arbitration panel as final
and binding, subject to no judicial or administrative review, except on those
grounds set forth in 9 USC ss.10 and ss.11. Judgment on the award and/or orders
may be entered in any court having jurisdiction over the parties or their
assets. In the final award and/or order, the arbitration panel shall divide all
costs (other than attorney fees, which shall be borne by the party incurring
such fees and other costs specifically provided for herein) incurred in
conducting the arbitration in accordance with what the arbitration panel deems
just and equitable under the circumstances. The fees of DEALER's arbitration
shall be paid by DEALER. The fees of CC's arbitrator shall be paid by CC.

10.      SIGNATURE

         This Agreement becomes valid only when signed by the President or a
Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation
and by a duly authorized

                                       5

<PAGE>


officer or executive of DEALER if a corporation; or by one of the general
partners of DEALER if a partnership; or by DEALER if an individual.

         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have signed this Agreement which
is finally executed at Auburn Hills, Michigan, in triplicate, on September 29,
1997.

                           SONIC CHRYSLER-PLYMOUTH-JEEP-EAGLE, L.L.C.
                           dba Lake Norman Chrysler Plymouth Jeep
                           -----------------------------------------------------
                                  (DEALER Firm Name and DBA if applicable)

                           By /s/ O. Bruton Smith
                              --------------------------------------------------
                                    (Individual Duly Authorized to Sign)

                           -----------------------------------------------------
                                               (Title)

                           CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                           By /s/ V. W. Gray
                              --------------------------------------------------
                                    National Dealer Placement Manager
                                    --------------------------------------------
                                                      (Title)

                                       6


<PAGE>
    

   

                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                    PLYMOUTH

                           SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT

         Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, L.L.C. dba Lake Norman Chrysler
Plymouth Jeep, located at 20435 Chartwell Center Drive, Cornelius, North
Carolina, a corporation, hereinafter called DEALER and Chrysler Corporation, a
Delaware corporation, hereinafter sometimes referred to as "CC", have entered
into this Chrysler Corporation Plymouth Sales and Service Agreement, hereinafter
referred to as "Agreement", the terms of which are as follows:

INTRODUCTION.

         The purpose of the relationship established by this Agreement is to
provide a means for the sale and service of specified Plymouth vehicles and the
sale of CC vehicle parts and accessories in a manner that will maximize customer
satisfaction and be of benefit to DEALER and CC.

         While the following provisions, each of which is material, set forth
the undertakings of this relationship, the success of those undertakings rests
on a recognition of the mutuality of interests of DEALER and CC, and a spirit of
understanding and cooperation by both parties in the day to day performance of
their respective functions. As a result of such considerations, CC has entered
into this Agreement in reliance upon and has placed its trust in the personal
abilities, expertise, knowledge and integrity of DEALER's principal owners and
management personnel, which CC anticipates will enable DEALER to perform the
personal services contemplated by this Agreement.

         It is the mutual goal of this relationship to promote the sale and
service of specified CC products by maintaining and advancing their excellence
and reputation by earning, holding and furthering the public regard for CC and
all CC dealers.

1.       PRODUCTS COVERED.

         DEALER has the right to order and purchase from CC and to sell at
retail only those specific models of CC vehicles, sometimes referred to as
"specified CC vehicles," listed on the Motor Vehicle Addendum, attached hereto
and incorporated herein by reference. CC may change the models of CC vehicles
listed on the Motor Vehicle Addendum by furnishing DEALER a superseding Motor
Vehicle Addendum. Such a superseding Motor Vehicle Addendum will not be deemed
or construed or to be an amendment to this Agreement.

                                      

<PAGE>

2.       DEALER'S MANAGEMENT.

         CC has entered into this Agreement relying on the active, substantial
and continuing personal participation in the management of DEALER's organization
by:

                  NAME                                        POSITION

         William Martin Sullivan                              General Manager

         Bryan Scott Smith                                    C.E.O.

         DEALER represents and warrants that at least one of the above-named
individuals will be physically present at the DEALER's facility (sometimes
referred to as "Dealership Facilities") during most of its operating h ours and
will manage all of DEALER's business relating to the sale and service of CC
products. DEALER shall not change the personnel holding the above described
position(s) or the nature and extent of his/her/their management participation
without the prior written approval of CC.

3.       DEALER'S CAPITAL STOCK OR PARTNERSHIP INTEREST.

         If DEALER is a corporation or partnership, DEALER represents and agrees
that the persons named below own beneficially the capital stock or partnership
interest of DEALER in the percentages indicated below. DEALER warrants there
will be no change affecting more than 50% of the ownership interest of DEALER,
nor will there be any other change in the ownership interest of DEALER which may
affect the managerial control of DEALER without CC's prior written approval.

                           Voting       Non-Voting      Partnership     Active
         Name               Stock            Stock         Interest     Yes/No

Sonic Automotive,Inc.          100.00%               %              %     No
_________________________  __________  ______________  _____________   ________
_________________________  __________% ______________% _____________%  ________
_________________________  __________% ______________% _____________%  ________
_________________________  __________% ______________% _____________%  ________
_________________________  __________% ______________% _____________%  ________
Total                          100.00%               %              %
                           __________  ______________  _____________

4.       SALES LOCALITY.

         DEALER shall have the non-exclusive right, subject to the provisions of
this Agreement, to purchase from CC those new specified CC vehicles, vehicle
parts, accessories and other CC products for resale at the DEALER's facilities
and location described in the Dealership Facilities and Location Addendum,
attached hereto and incorporated herein by reference. DEALER will actively and
effectively sell and promote the retail sale of CC vehicles, vehicle parts and
accessories in DEALER's Sales Locality. As used herein, "Sales Locality" shall
mean the area 

                                       2

<PAGE>

designated in writing to DEALER by CC from time to time as the territory of 
DEALER's responsibility for the sale of CC vehicles, vehicle parts and 
accessories, although DEALER is free to sell said products to customers 
wherever they may be located. Said Sales Locality may be shared with other CC 
dealers of the same line-make as CC determines to be appropriate.


         5.       ADDITIONAL TERMS AND PROVISIONS.

         The additional terms and provisions set forth in the document entitled
"Chrysler Corporation Sales and Service Agreement Additional Terms and
Provisions" marked "Form 91 (C-P-D)," as may hereafter be amended from time to
time, constitute a part of this Agreement with the same force and effect as if
set forth at length herein, and the term "this Agreement" includes said
additional terms and provisions.

         6.       FORMER AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR STATEMENTS.

         This Chrysler Corporation Plymouth Sales and Service Agreement and
other documents (or their successors as specifically provided for herein) which
are specifically incorporated herein by reference constitute the entire
agreement between the parties relating to the purchase by DEALER of those new
specified CC vehicles, parts and accessories from CC for resale; and it cancels
and supersedes all earlier agreements, written or oral, between CC and DEALER
relating to the purchase by DEALER of Plymouth vehicles, parts and accessories,
except for (a) amounts owing by CC to DEALER, such as payments for warranty
service performed and incentive programs, or (b) amounts owing or which may be
determined to be owed, as a result of an audit or investigation, by DEALER to CC
due to DEALER's purchase from CC of vehicles, parts, accessories and other goods
or services, or (c) amounts DEALER owes to CC, as a result of other extensions
of credit by CC to DEALER. No representations or statements, other than those
expressly set forth herein or those set forth in the applications for this
Agreement submitted to CC by DEALER or DEALER's representatives, are made or
relied upon by any party hereto in entering into this Agreement.

         7.       WAIVER AND MODIFICATION.

         No waiver, modification or change of any of the terms of this Agreement
or change or erasure of any printed part of this Agreement or addition to it
(except the filling in of blank spaces and lines) will be valid or binding on CC
unless approved in writing by the President or a Vice President or the National
Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.

         8.       AMENDMENT.

         DEALER and CC recognize that this Agreement does not have an expiration
date and will continue in effect unless terminated under the limited
circumstances set forth in Paragraph 28. DEALER and CC further recognize that
the passage of time, changes in the industry, ways of doing business and other
unforeseen circumstances may cause CC to determine that it should amend all
Chrysler Corporation Plymouth Sales and Service Agreements. Therefore, CC will

                                       3
<PAGE>

have the right to amend this Agreement to the extent that CC deems advisable,
provided that CC makes the same amendment in Chrysler Corporation Plymouth Sales
and Service Agreements generally. Each such amendment will be issued in a notice
sent by certified mail or delivered in person to DEALER and signed by the
President or a Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of
Chrysler Corporation. Thirty-five (35) days after mailing or delivery of 
such notice to DEALER, this Agreement will be deemed amended in the manner and 
to the extent set forth in the notice.

9.       ARBITRATION.

         Any and all disputes arising out of or in connection with the
interpretation, performance or non-performance of this Agreement or any and all
disputes arising out of or in connection with transactions in any way related to
this Agreement (including, but not limited to, the validity, scope and
enforceability of this arbitration provision, or disputes under rights granted
pursuant to the statutes of the state in which DEALER is licensed) shall be
finally and completely resolved by arbitration pursuant to the arbitration laws
of the United States of America as codified in Title 9 of the United States
Code, ss.ss.1-14, under the Rules of Commercial Arbitration of the American
Arbitration Association (hereinafter referred to as the "Rules") by a majority
vote of a panel of three arbitrators. One arbitrator will be selected by DEALER
(DEALER's arbitrator). One arbitrator will be selected by CC (CC's arbitrator).
These arbitrators must be selected by the respective parties within ten (10)
business days after receipt by either DEALER or CC of a written notification
from the other party of a decision to arbitrate a dispute pursuant to this
Agreement. Should either CC or DEALER fail to select an arbitrator within said
ten-day period, the party who so fails to select an arbitrator will have its
arbitrator selected by the American Arbitration Association upon the application
of the other party. The third arbitrator must be an individual who is familiar
with business transactions and be a licensed attorney admitted to the practice
of law within the United States of America, or a judge. The third arbitrator
will be selected by DEALER's and CC's arbitrators. If said arbitrators cannot
agree on a third arbitrator within thirty (30) days from the date of the
appointment of the last selected arbitrator, then either DEALER's or CC's
arbitrator may apply to the American Arbitration Association to appoint said
third arbitrator pursuant to the criteria set forth above. The arbitration panel
shall conduct the proceedings pursuant to the then existing Rules.

         Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any provision of the Rules
conflict with any provision of this Paragraph 9, the provisions of this
Paragraph 9 will be controlling.

         CC and DEALER agree to facilitate the arbitration by: (a) each party
paying to the American Arbitration Association one-half (1/2) of the required
deposit before the proceedings commence; (b) making available to one another and
to the arbitration panel, for inspection and photocopying all documents, books
and records, if determined by the arbitrator to be relevant to the dispute; (c)
making available to one another and to the arbitration panel personnel directly
or indirectly under their control, for testimony during hearings and prehearing
proceedings if determined by the arbitration panel to be relevant to the
dispute; (d) conducting arbitration hearings to the greatest extent possible on
consecutive business days; and (e) strictly observing


                                       4
<PAGE>

the time periods established by the Rules or by the arbitration panel for the 
submission of evidence and of briefs.

         Unless otherwise agreed to by CC and DEALER, a stenographic record of
the arbitration shall be made and a transcript thereof shall be ordered for each
party, with each party paying 

one-half (1/2) of the total cost of such recording and transcription. The 
stenographer shall be state-certified, if certification is made by the state, 
and the party to whom it is most convenient shall be responsible for securing 
and notifying such stenographer of the time and place of the arbitration 
hearing(s).

         If the arbitration provision is invoked when the dispute between the
parties is either the legality of terminating this Agreement or of adding a new
CC dealer of the same line-make or relocating an existing CC dealer of the same
line-make, CC will stay the implementation of the decision to terminate this
Agreement or add such new CC dealer or approve the relocation of an existing CC
dealer of the same line-make until the decision of the arbitrator has been
announced, providing DEALER does not in any way attempt to avoid the obligations
of this Paragraph 9, in which case the decision at issue will be immediately
implemented.

         Except as limited hereby, the arbitration panel shall have all powers
of law and equity, which it can lawfully assume, necessary to resolve the issues
in dispute including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, making
awards of compensatory damages, issuing both prohibitory and mandatory orders in
the nature of injunctions and compelling the production of documents and
witnesses for pre-arbitration discovery and/or presentation at the arbitration
hearing on the merits of the case. The arbitration panel shall not have legal or
equitable authority to issue a mandatory or prohibitory order which: (a) extends
or has effect beyond the subject matter of this Agreement, or (b) will govern
the activities of either party for a period of more than two years; nor shall
the arbitration panel have authority to award punitive, consequential or any
damages whatsoever beyond or in addition to the compensatory damages allowed to
be awarded under this Agreement.

         The decision of the arbitration panel shall be in written form and
shall include findings of fact and conclusions of law.

         It is the intent and desire of DEALER and CC to hereby and forever
renounce and reject any and all recourse to litigation before any judicial or
administrative forum and to accept the award of the arbitration panel as final
and binding, subject to no judicial or administrative review, except on those
grounds set forth in 9 USC ss.10 and ss.11. Judgment on the award and/or orders
may be entered in any court having jurisdiction over the parties or their
assets. In the final award and/or order, the arbitration panel shall divide all
costs (other than attorney fees, which shall be borne by the party incurring
such fees and other costs specifically provided for herein) incurred in
conducting the arbitration in accordance with what the arbitration panel deems
just and equitable under the circumstances. The fees of DEALER's arbitrator
shall be paid by DEALER. The fees of CC's arbitrator shall be paid by CC.


                                       5
<PAGE>

10.      SIGNATURE.

         This Agreement becomes valid only when signed by the President or a
Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation
and by a duly authorized officer or executive of DEALER if a corporation; or by
one of the general partners of DEALER if a partnership; or by DEALER if an 
individual.

         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have signed this Agreement which
is finally executed at Auburn Hills, Michigan, in triplicate, on September 29,
1997.

                             Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, L.L.C.
                             dba Lake Norman Chrysler Plymouth Jeep
                             ---------------------------------------------------
                             
                             By: /s/   O. Bruton Smith
                                 -----------------------------------------------
                                       (Individual Duly Authorized to Sign)

                              --------------------------------------------------
                                                  (Title)

                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                              By: /s/   V. W. Gray
                                  ----------------------------------------------
                                        National Dealer Placement Manager
                                        ----------------------------------------
                                                   (Title)

                                        6

    
<PAGE>


   
                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                      JEEP

                           SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT

         Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, L.L.C. dba Lake Norman Chrysler
Plymouth Jeep, located at 20435 Chartwell Center Drive, Cornelius, North
Carolina, a corporation, hereinafter called DEALER and Chrysler Corporation, a
Delaware corporation, hereinafter sometimes referred to as "CC", have entered
into this Chrysler Corporation Jeep Sales and Service Agreement, hereinafter
referred to as "Agreement", the terms of which are as follows:

INTRODUCTION.

         The purpose of the relationship established by this Agreement is to
provide a means for the sale and service of specified Jeep vehicles and the sale
of CC vehicle parts and accessories in a manner that will maximize customer
satisfaction and be of benefit to DEALER and CC.

         While the following provisions, each of which is material, set forth
the undertakings of this relationship, the success of those undertakings rests
on a recognition of the mutuality of interests of DEALER and CC, and a spirit of
understanding and cooperation by both parties in the day to day performance of
their respective functions. As a result of such considerations, CC has entered
into this Agreement in reliance upon and has placed its trust in the personal
abilities, expertise, knowledge and integrity of DEALER's principal owners and
management personnel, which CC anticipates will enable DEALER to perform the
personal services contemplated by this Agreement.

         It is the mutual goal of this relationship to promote the sale and
service of specified CC products by maintaining and advancing their excellence
and reputation by earning, holding and furthering the public regard for CC and
all CC dealers.

1.       PRODUCTS COVERED.

         DEALER has the right to order and purchase from CC and to sell at
retail only those specific models of CC vehicles, sometimes referred to as
"specified CC vehicles," listed on the Motor Vehicle Addendum, attached hereto
and incorporated herein by reference. CC may change the models of CC vehicles
listed on the Motor Vehicle Addendum by furnishing DEALER a superseding Motor
Vehicle Addendum. Such a superseding Motor Vehicle Addendum will not be deemed
or construed to be an amendment to this Agreement.

2.       DEALER'S MANAGEMENT.

         CC has entered into this Agreement relying on the active, substantial
and continuing personal participation in the management of DEALER's organization
by:

<PAGE>



                  NAME                                     POSITION

         William Martin Sullivan                           General Manager

         Bryan Scott Smith                                 C.E.O.

         DEALER represents and warrants that at least one of the above-named
individuals will be physically present at the DEALER's facility (sometimes
referred to as "Dealership Facilities") during most of its operating hours and
will manage all of DEALER's business relating to the sale and service of CC
products. DEALER shall not change the personnel holding the above described
position(s) or the nature and extent of his/her/their management participation
without the prior written approval of CC.

3.       DEALER'S CAPITAL STOCK OR PARTNERSHIP INTEREST.

         If DEALER is a corporation or partnership, DEALER represents and agrees
that the persons named below own beneficially the capital stock or partnership
interest of DEALER in the percentages indicated below. DEALER warrants there
will be no change affecting more than 50% of the ownership interest of DEALER,
nor will there be any other change in the ownership interest of DEALER which may
affect the managerial control of DEALER without CC's prior written approval.

                           Voting       Non-Voting      Partnership      Active
         Name               Stock            Stock         Interest      Yes/No

Sonic Automotive,Inc.           100.00%               %                %   No
- -------------------------  -----------  --------------  ---------------  -------
- -------------------------  -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
- -------------------------  -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
- -------------------------  -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
- -------------------------  -----------% --------------% ---------------% -------
Total                           100.00%               %                %
                           -----------  --------------  ---------------

4.       SALES LOCALITY.

         DEALER shall have the non-exclusive right, subject to the provisions of
this Agreement, to purchase from CC those new specified CC vehicles, vehicle
parts, accessories and other CC products for resale at the DEALER's facilities
and location described in the Dealership Facilities and Location Addendum,
attached hereto and incorporated herein by reference. DEALER will actively and
effectively sell and promote the retail sale of CC vehicles, vehicle parts and
accessories in DEALER's Sales Locality. As used herein, "Sales Locality" shall
mean the area designated in writing to DEALER by CC from time to time as the
territory of DEALER's responsibility for the sale of CC vehicles, vehicle parts
and accessories, although DEALER is free to sell said products to customers
wherever they may be located. Said Sales Locality may be shared with other CC
dealers of the same line-make as CC determines to be appropriate.


                                        2


<PAGE>



         5.       ADDITIONAL TERMS AND PROVISIONS.

         The additional terms and provisions set forth in the document entitled
"Chrysler Corporation Sales and Service Agreement Additional Terms and
Provisions" marked "Form 91 (J-E)," as may hereafter be amended from time to
time, constitute a part of this Agreement with the same force and effect as if
set forth at length herein, and the term "this Agreement" includes said
additional terms and provisions.

         6.       FORMER AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR STATEMENTS.

         This Chrysler Corporation Jeep Sales and Service Agreement and other
documents (or their successors as specifically provided for herein) which are
specifically incorporated herein by reference constitute the entire agreement
between the parties relating to the purchase by DEALER of those new specified CC
vehicles, parts and accessories from CC for resale; and it cancels and
supersedes all earlier agreements, written or oral, between CC and DEALER
relating to the purchase by DEALER of Jeep vehicles, parts and accessories,
except for (a) amounts owing by CC to DEALER, such as payments for warranty
service performed and incentive programs, or (b) amounts owing or which may be
determined to be owed, as a result of an audit or investigation, by DEALER to CC
due to DEALER's purchase from CC of vehicles, parts, accessories and other goods
or services, or (c) amounts DEALER owes to CC, as a result of other extensions
of credit by CC to DEALER. No representations or statements, other than those
expressly set forth herein or those set forth in the applications for this
Agreement submitted to CC by DEALER or DEALER's representatives, are made or
relied upon by any party hereto in entering into this Agreement.

         7.       WAIVER AND MODIFICATION.

         No waiver, modification or change of any of the terms of this Agreement
or change or erasure of any printed part of this Agreement or addition to it
(except the filling in of blank spaces and lines) will be valid or binding on CC
unless approved in writing by the President or a Vice President or the National
Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.

         8.       AMENDMENT.

         DEALER and CC recognize that this Agreement does not have an expiration
date and will continue in effect unless terminated under the limited
circumstances set forth in Paragraph 28. DEALER and CC further recognize that
the passage of time, changes in the industry, ways of doing business and other
unforeseen circumstances may cause CC to determine that it should amend all
Chrysler Corporation Jeep Sales and Service Agreements. Therefore, CC will have
the right to amend this Agreement to the extent that CC deems advisable,
provided that CC makes the same amendment in Chrysler Corporation Jeep Sales and
Service Agreements generally. Each such amendment will be issued in a notice
sent by certified mail or delivered in person to DEALER and signed by the
President or a Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of
Chrysler Corporation. Thirty-five (35) days after mailing or delivery of


                                        3


<PAGE>



such notice to DEALER, this Agreement will be deemed amended in the manner and
to the extent set forth in the notice.

9.       ARBITRATION.

         Any and all disputes arising out of or in connection with the
interpretation, performance or non-performance of this Agreement or any and all
disputes arising out of or in connection with transactions in any way related to
this Agreement (including, but not limited to, the validity, scope and
enforceability of this arbitration provision, or disputes under rights granted
pursuant to the statutes of the state in which DEALER is licensed) shall be
finally and completely resolved by arbitration pursuant to the arbitration laws
of the United States of America as codified in Title 9 of the United States
Code, ss.ss.1-14, under the Rules of Commercial Arbitration of the American
Arbitration Association (hereinafter referred to as the "Rules") by a majority
vote of a panel of three arbitrators. One arbitrator will be selected by DEALER
(DEALER's arbitrator). One arbitrator will be selected by CC (CC's arbitrator).
These arbitrators must be selected by the respective parties within ten (10)
business days after receipt by either DEALER or CC of a written notification
from the other party of a decision to arbitrate a dispute pursuant to this
Agreement. Should either CC or DEALER fail to select an arbitrator within said
ten-day period, the party who so fails to select an arbitrator will have its
arbitrator selected by the American Arbitration Association upon the application
of the other party. The third arbitrator must be an individual who is familiar
with business transactions and be a licensed attorney admitted to the practice
of law within the United States of America, or a judge. The third arbitrator
will be selected by DEALER's and CC's arbitrators. If said arbitrators cannot
agree on a third arbitrator within thirty (30) days from the date of the
appointment of the last selected arbitrator, then either DEALER's or CC's
arbitrator may apply to the American Arbitration Association to appoint said
third arbitrator pursuant to the criteria set forth above. The arbitration panel
shall conduct the proceedings pursuant to the then existing Rules.

         Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any provision of the Rules
conflict with any provision of this Paragraph 9, the provisions of this
Paragraph 9 will be controlling.

         CC and DEALER agree to facilitate the arbitration by: (a) each party
paying to the American Arbitration Association one-half (1/2) of the required
deposit before the proceedings commence; (b) making available to one another and
to the arbitration panel, for inspection and photocopying all documents, books
and records, if determined by the arbitrator to be relevant to the dispute; (c)
making available to one another and to the arbitration panel personnel directly
or indirectly under their control, for testimony during hearings and prehearing
proceedings if determined by the arbitration panel to be relevant to the
dispute; (d) conducting arbitration hearings to the greatest extent possible on
consecutive business days; and (e) strictly observing the time periods
established by the Rules or by the arbitration panel for the submission of
evidence and of briefs.

         Unless otherwise agreed to by CC and DEALER, a stenographic record of
the arbitration shall be made and a transcript thereof shall be ordered for each
party, with each party paying


                                        4


<PAGE>



one-half (1/2) of the total cost of such recording and transcription. The
stenographer shall be state-certified, if certification is made by the state,
and the party to whom it is most convenient shall be responsible for securing
and notifying such stenographer of the time and place of the arbitration
hearing(s).

         If the arbitration provision is invoked when the dispute between the
parties is either the legality of terminating this Agreement or of adding a new
CC dealer of the same line-make or relocating an existing CC dealer of the same
line-make, CC will stay the implementation of the decision to terminate this
Agreement or add such new CC dealer or approve the relocation of an existing CC
dealer of the same line-make until the decision of the arbitrator has been
announced, providing DEALER does not in any way attempt to avoid the obligations
of this Paragraph 9, in which case the decision at issue will be immediately
implemented.

         Except as limited hereby, the arbitration panel shall have all powers
of law and equity, which it can lawfully assume, necessary to resolve the issues
in dispute including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, making
awards of compensatory damages, issuing both prohibitory and mandatory orders in
the nature of injunctions and compelling the production of documents and
witnesses for pre-arbitration discovery and/or presentation at the arbitration
hearing on the merits of the case. The arbitration panel shall not have legal or
equitable authority to issue a mandatory or prohibitory order which: (a) extends
or has effect beyond the subject matter of this Agreement, or (b) will govern
the activities of either party for a period of more than two years; nor shall
the arbitration panel have authority to award punitive, consequential or any
damages whatsoever beyond or in addition to the compensatory damages allowed to
be awarded under this Agreement.

         The decision of the arbitration panel shall be in written form and
shall include findings of fact and conclusions of law.

         It is the intent and desire of DEALER and CC to hereby and forever
renounce and reject any and all recourse to litigation before any judicial or
administrative forum and to accept the award of the arbitration panel as final
and binding, subject to no judicial or administrative review, except on those
grounds set forth in 9 USC ss.10 and ss.11. Judgment on the award and/or orders
may be entered in any court having jurisdiction over the parties or their
assets. In the final award and/or order, the arbitration panel shall divide all
costs (other than attorney fees, which shall be borne by the party incurring
such fees and other costs specifically provided for herein) incurred in
conducting the arbitration in accordance with what the arbitration panel deems
just and equitable under the circumstances. The fees of DEALER's arbitrator
shall be paid by DEALER. The fees of CC's arbitrator shall be paid by CC.

10.      SIGNATURE.

         This Agreement becomes valid only when signed by the President or a
Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation
and by a duly authorized


                                                         5


<PAGE>


officer or executive of DEALER if a corporation; or by one of the general
partners of DEALER if a partnership; or by DEALER if an individual.

         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have signed this Agreement which
is finally executed at Auburn Hills, Michigan, in triplicate, on September 29,
1997.

                             Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, L.L.C.
                             dba Lake Norman Chrysler Plymouth Jeep

                             By: /s/   O. Bruton Smith
                                 -----------------------------------------------
                                      (Individual Duly Authorized to Sign)

                             ----------------------------------------------
                                               (Title)

                             CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                             By: /s/   V. W. Gray
                                 -----------------------------------------------
                                      National Dealer Placement Manager
                                      ------------------------------------------
                                                    (Title)

                                        6


<PAGE>
    

   
                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                    CHRYSLER

                           SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT

  Cleveland Chry Plym Jeep Eagle LLC dba Cleveland Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle
                   (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

located at  2496 S. Lee Highway                   Cleveland      TN 37311
                 (STREET)                         (CITY)         (STATE)

a(n) Corporation,                                hereinafter  called DEALER, and
    (INDIVIDUAL, CORPORATION OR PARTNERSHIP)

Chrysler Corporation, a Delaware corporation,  hereinafter sometimes referred to
as "CC", have entered into this Chrysler  Corporation Chrysler Sales and Service
Agreement,  hereinafter  referred to as  "Agreement",  the terms of which are as
follows:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     INTRODUCTION

The purpose of the  relationship  established  by this Agreement is to provide a
means for the sale and service of specified Chrysler vehicles and the sale of CC
vehicle  parts  and  accessories  in  a  manner  that  will  maximize   customer
satisfaction and be of benefit to DEALER and CC.

While  the  following  provisions,  each of which is  material,  set  forth  the
undertakings of this relationship,  the success of those undertakings rests on a
recognition  of the  mutuality  of  interests  of DEALER and CC, and a spirit of
understanding  and  cooperation by both parties in the day to day performance of
their respective functions.  As a result of such considerations,  CC has entered
into this  Agreement  in reliance  upon and has placed its trust in the personal
abilities,  expertise,  knowledge and integrity of DEALER's principal owners and
management  personnel,  which CC  anticipates  will enable DEALER to perform the
personal services contemplated by this Agreement.

It is the mutual  goal of this  relationship  to promote the sale and service of
specified  CC  products  by  maintaining  and  advancing  their  excellence  and
reputation by earning,  holding and  furthering the public regard for CC and all
CC dealers.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1  PRODUCTS COVERED

DEALER has the right to order and  purchase  from CC and to sell at retail  only
those  specific  models of CC vehicles,  sometimes  referred to as "specified CC
vehicles,"   listed  on  the  Motor  Vehicle   Addendum,   attached  hereto  and
incorporated herein by reference. CC may change the models of CC vehicles listed
on the Motor Vehicle Addendum by furnishing  DEALER a superseding  Motor Vehicle
Addendum.  Such a  superseding  Motor  Vehicle  Addendum  will not be  deemed or
construed or to be an amendment to this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2  DEALER'S MANAGEMENT

CC has  entered  into this  Agreement  relying on the  active,  substantial  and
continuing personal participation in the management of DEALER's organization by:

                NAME                                     POSITION


         Jeffrey C. Rachor                             GM/Member
         ------------------------                      -------------------

         ------------------------                      -------------------



<PAGE>


DEALER represents and warrants that at least one of the above-named  individuals
will be physically  present at the DEALER's facility  (sometimes  referred to as
"Dealership  Facilities") during most of its operating hours and will manage all
of DEALER's  business  relating to the sale and service of CC  products.  DEALER
shall not change the personnel  holding the above  described  position(s) or the
nature and extent of his/her/their  management  participation  without the prior
written approval of CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3  DEALER'S CAPITAL STOCK OR PARTNERSHIP INTEREST

If DEALER is a corporation or partnership, DEALER represents and agrees that the
persons named below own beneficially  the capital stock or partnership  interest
of DEALER in the percentages  indicated below.  DEALER warrants there will be no
change  affecting  more than 50% of the ownership  interest of DEALER,  nor will
there be any other change in the  ownership  interest of DEALER which may affect
the managerial control of DEALER without CC's prior written approval.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                    Voting              Non-Voting           Partnership            Active
         Name                       Stock                 Stock                Interest             Yes/No
                                                    
<S>                                     <C>              <C>                 <C>                    <C>   
Jeffrey C. Rachor                        5    %                   %                     %           Yes
- ----------------------------       -----------          ----------           -----------            --------
Nelson E. Bowers                        40    %                   %                     %           Yes
- ----------------------------       -----------          ----------           -----------            --------
John T. Lupton Trust                    50    %                   %                     %           No
- ----------------------------       -----------          ----------           -----------            --------
Frank E. Fowler                          5    %                   %                     %           No
- ----------------------------       -----------          ----------           -----------            --------
Total                                   100.00%                   %                     %
                                   -----------          ----------           -----------                    
</TABLE>                                            
                                                    
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4  SALES LOCALITY

DEALER shall have the  non-exclusive  right,  subject to the  provisions of this
Agreement,  to purchase from CC those new specified CC vehicles,  vehicle parts,
accessories  and other CC products  for resale at the  DEALER's  facilities  and
location described in the Dealership Facilities and Location Addendum,  attached
hereto  and  incorporated   herein  by  reference.   DEALER  will  actively  and
effectively  sell and promote the retail sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts and
accessories in DEALER's Sales Locality.  As used herein,  "Sales Locality" shall
mean the area  designated  in  writing  to DEALER by CC from time to time as the
territory of DEALER's responsibility for the sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts
and  accessories,  although  DEALER is free to sell said  products to  customers
wherever  they may be located.  Said Sales  Locality may be shared with other CC
dealers of the same line-make as CC determines to be appropriate.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
5  ADDITIONAL TERMS AND PROVISIONS

The additional terms and provisions set forth in the document entitled "Chrysler
Corporation Sales and Service Agreement  Additional Terms and Provisions" marked
"Form 91 (C-P-D)," as may  hereafter be amended from time to time,  constitute a
part of this  Agreement with the same force and effect as if set forth at length
herein,  and the term  "this  Agreement"  includes  said  additional  terms  and
provisions.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6  FORMER AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR STATEMENTS

This  Chrysler  Corporation  Chrysler  Sales  and  Service  Agreement  and other
documents (or their  successors as  specifically  provided for herein) which are
specifically  incorporated  herein by reference  constitute the entire agreement
between the parties relating to the purchase by DEALER of those new specified CC
vehicles,  parts  and  accessories  from  CC  for  resale;  and it  cancels  and
supersedes  all  earlier  agreements,  written  or oral,  between  CC and DEALER
relating to the purchase by DEALER of Chrysler vehicles,  parts and accessories,
except for (a)  amounts  owing by CC to DEALER,  such as payments  for  warranty
service performed and incentive  programs,  or (b) amounts owing or which may be
determined to be owed, as a result of an audit or investigation, by DEALER to CC
due to DEALER's purchase from CC of vehicles, parts, accessories and other goods
or services, or (c) amounts


<PAGE>


DEALER owes to CC, as a result of other extensions of credit by CC to DEALER. No
representations  or statements,  other than those  expressly set forth herein or
those set forth in the applications for this Agreement submitted to CC by DEALER
or  DEALER's  representatives,  are made or relied  upon by any party  hereto in
entering into this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7  WAIVER AND MODIFICATION

No  waiver,  modification  or change of any of the  terms of this  Agreement  or
change or  erasure of any  printed  part of this  Agreement  or  addition  to it
(except the filling in of blank spaces and lines) will be valid or binding on CC
unless  approved in writing by the President or a Vice President or the National
Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
8  AMENDMENT

DEALER and CC recognize that this Agreement does not have an expiration date and
will continue in effect unless  terminated under the limited  circumstances  set
forth in Paragraph 28. DEALER and CC further recognize that the passage of time,
changes  in  the  industry,   ways  of  doing  business  and  other   unforeseen
circumstances  may  cause CC to  determine  that it should  amend  all  Chrysler
Corporation Chrysler Sales and Service Agreements.  Therefore,  CC will have the
right to amend this  Agreement to the extent that CC deems  advisable,  provided
that CC makes the same  amendment  in Chrysler  Corporation  Chrysler  Sales and
Service  Agreements  generally.  Each such  amendment will be issued in a notice
sent by  certified  mail or  delivered  in person to  DEALER  and  signed by the
President  or a Vice  President  or the  National  Dealer  Placement  Manager of
Chrysler  Corporation.  Thirty-five  (35) days after mailing or delivery of such
notice to DEALER, this Agreement will be deemed amended in the manner and to the
extent set forth in the notice.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
9  ARBITRATION

Any and all disputes  arising out of or in connection  with the  interpretation,
performance or non-performance of this Agreement or any and all disputes arising
out of or in connection  with  transactions in any way related to this Agreement
(including,  but not limited to, the validity,  scope and enforceability of this
arbitration provision, or disputes under rights granted pursuant to the statutes
of the state in which  DEALER  is  licensed)  shall be  finally  and  completely
resolved by arbitration pursuant to the arbitration laws of the United States of
America as codified in Title 9 of the United States Code, ss.ss.1-14,  under the
Rules  of  Commercial  Arbitration  of  the  American  Arbitration   Association
(hereinafter  referred to as the "Rules") by a majority vote of a panel of three
arbitrators.  One arbitrator will be selected by DEALER  (DEALER's  arbitrator).
One arbitrator will be selected by CC (CC's arbitrator).  These arbitrators must
be  selected  by the  respective  parties  within ten (10)  business  days after
receipt by either DEALER or CC of a written notification from the other party of
a decision to arbitrate a dispute  pursuant to this Agreement.  Should either CC
or DEALER fail to select an arbitrator within said ten-day period, the party who
so fails to  select  an  arbitrator  will have its  arbitrator  selected  by the
American  Arbitration  Association  upon the application of the other party. The
third   arbitrator   must  be  an  individual  who  is  familiar  with  business
transactions and be a licensed  attorney  admitted to the practice of law within
the United States of America,  or a judge. The third arbitrator will be selected
by DEALER's and CC's  arbitrators.  If said arbitrators  cannot agree on a third
arbitrator  within thirty (30) days from the date of the appointment of the last
selected  arbitrator,  then either  DEALER's or CC's arbitrator may apply to the
American  Arbitration  Association to appoint said third arbitrator  pursuant to
the  criteria  set  forth  above.  The  arbitration   panel  shall  conduct  the
proceedings pursuant to the then existing Rules.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any provision of the Rules conflict
with any provision of this  Paragraph 9, the provisions of this Paragraph 9 will
be controlling.

CC and DEALER agree to facilitate the  arbitration  by: (a) each party paying to
the American  Arbitration  Association  one-half  (1/2) of the required  deposit
before the proceedings commence;  (b) making available to one another and to the
arbitration  panel,  for inspection and  photocopying  all documents,  books and
records,  if  determined by the  arbitrator  to be relevant to the dispute;  (c)
making available to one another and to the arbitration panel personnel  directly
or indirectly under their control,  for testimony during hearings and prehearing
proceedings  if  determined  by the  arbitration  panel  to be  relevant  to the
dispute; (d) conducting  arbitration hearings to the greatest extent possible on
consecutive   business  days;  and  (e)  strictly  observing  the  time  periods
established  by the  Rules or by the  arbitration  panel for the  submission  of
evidence and of briefs.


<PAGE>


Unless  otherwise  agreed  by CC  and  DEALER,  a  stenographic  record  of  the
arbitration  shall be made and a  transcript  thereof  shall be ordered for each
party, with each party paying one-half (1/2) of the total cost of such recording
and transcription.  The stenographer shall be state-certified,  if certification
is made by the  state,  and the  party  to whom it is most  convenient  shall be
responsible  for securing and notifying such  stenographer of the time and place
of the arbitration hearing(s).

If the arbitration  provision is invoked when the dispute between the parties is
either the legality of  terminating  this Agreement or of adding a new CC dealer
of the same line-make or relocating an existing CC dealer of the same line-make,
CC will stay the  implementation  of the decision to terminate this Agreement or
add such new CC dealer or approve the relocation of an existing CC dealer of the
same  line-make  until  the  decision  of the  arbitrator  has  been  announced,
providing  DEALER does not in any way attempt to avoid the  obligations  of this
Paragraph  9,  in  which  case  the  decision  at  issue  will  be   immediately
implemented.

Except as limited hereby, the arbitration panel shall have all powers of law and
equity, which it can lawfully assume, necessary to resolve the issues in dispute
including,  without  limiting the generality of the foregoing,  making awards of
compensatory  damages,  issuing both  prohibitory  and  mandatory  orders in the
nature of  injunctions  and compelling the production of documents and witnesses
for pre-arbitration  discovery and/or presentation at the arbitration hearing on
the merits of the case. The arbitration  panel shall not have legal or equitable
authority to issue a mandatory or  prohibitory  order which:  (a) extends or has
effect  beyond the  subject  matter of this  Agreement,  or (b) will  govern the
activities  of either  party for a period of more than two years;  nor shall the
arbitration panel have authority to award punitive, consequential or any damages
whatsoever  beyond or in  addition  to the  compensatory  damages  allowed to be
awarded under this Agreement.

The decision of the arbitration panel shall be in written form and shall include
findings of fact and conclusions of law.

It is the intent and desire of DEALER and CC to hereby and forever  renounce and
reject any and all recourse to litigation  before any judicial or administrative
forum and to accept  the award of the  arbitration  panel as final and  binding,
subject to no judicial or  administrative  review,  except on those  grounds set
forth in 9 USC ss.10 and  ss.11.  Judgment  on the award  and/or  orders  may be
entered in any court having  jurisdiction  over the parties or their assets.  In
the final award  and/or  order,  the  arbitration  panel shall  divide all costs
(other than attorney fees, which shall be borne by the party incurring such fees
and other costs  specifically  provided for herein)  incurred in conducting  the
arbitration  in  accordance  with  what the  arbitration  panel  deems  just and
equitable under the circumstances. The fees of DEALER's arbitrator shall be paid
by DEALER. The fees of CC's arbitrator shall be paid by CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10  SIGNATURE

This  Agreement  becomes  valid  only  when  signed by the  President  or a Vice
President or the National Dealer Placement  Manager of Chrysler  Corporation and
by a duly authorized officer or executive of DEALER if a corporation;  or by one
of  the  general  partners  of  DEALER  if a  partnership;  or by  DEALER  if an
individual.

IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the parties  hereto have  signed this  Agreement  which is
finally executed at AUBURN HILLS, Michigan, in triplicate, on APR 04 1996.

                                   Cleveland Chry Plym Jeep Eagle LLC
                                   dba Cleveland Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle
                                   ---------------------------------------------
                                   (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

                                   By  /s/ Nelson E. Bowers II
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                       (Individual Duly Authorized to Sign)

                                       Pres.
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                                    (Title)

                                               CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                   By  /s/ ILLEGIBLE
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                                  National Dealer
                                                 Placement Manager
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                                      (Title)
    

   
                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                    Plymouth

                           SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT

  Cleveland Chry Plym Jeep Eagle LLC dba Cleveland Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle
                   (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

located at  2496 S. Lee Highway                    Cleveland      TN 37311
                 (STREET)                         (CITY)         (STATE)

a(n) Corporation,                                hereinafter  called DEALER, and
    (INDIVIDUAL, CORPORATION OR PARTNERSHIP)

Chrysler Corporation, a Delaware corporation,  hereinafter sometimes referred to
as "CC", have entered into this Chrysler  Corporation Plymouth Sales and Service
Agreement,  hereinafter  referred to as  "Agreement",  the terms of which are as
follows:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     INTRODUCTION

The purpose of the  relationship  established  by this Agreement is to provide a
means for the sale and service of specified Plymouth vehicles and the sale of CC
vehicle  parts  and  accessories  in  a  manner  that  will  maximize   customer
satisfaction and be of benefit to DEALER and CC.

While  the  following  provisions,  each of which is  material,  set  forth  the
undertakings of this relationship,  the success of those undertakings rests on a
recognition  of the  mutuality  of  interests  of DEALER and CC, and a spirit of
understanding  and  cooperation by both parties in the day to day performance of
their respective functions.  As a result of such considerations,  CC has entered
into this  Agreement  in reliance  upon and has placed its trust in the personal
abilities,  expertise,  knowledge and integrity of DEALER's principal owners and
management  personnel,  which CC  anticipates  will enable DEALER to perform the
personal services contemplated by this Agreement.

It is the mutual  goal of this  relationship  to promote the sale and service of
specified  CC  products  by  maintaining  and  advancing  their  excellence  and
reputation by earning,  holding and  furthering the public regard for CC and all
CC dealers.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1  PRODUCTS COVERED

DEALER has the right to order and  purchase  from CC and to sell at retail  only
those  specific  models of CC vehicles,  sometimes  referred to as "specified CC
vehicles,"   listed  on  the  Motor  Vehicle   Addendum,   attached  hereto  and
incorporated herein by reference. CC may change the models of CC vehicles listed
on the Motor Vehicle Addendum by furnishing  DEALER a superseding  Motor Vehicle
Addendum.  Such a  superseding  Motor  Vehicle  Addendum  will not be  deemed or
construed or to be an amendment to this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2  DEALER'S MANAGEMENT

CC has  entered  into this  Agreement  relying on the  active,  substantial  and
continuing personal participation in the management of DEALER's organization by:

                NAME                                     POSITION


         Jeffrey C. Rachor                             GM/Member
         ------------------------                      -------------------

         ------------------------                      -------------------



<PAGE>


DEALER represents and warrants that at least one of the above-named  individuals
will be physically  present at the DEALER's facility  (sometimes  referred to as
"Dealership  Facilities") during most of its operating hours and will manage all
of DEALER's  business  relating to the sale and service of CC  products.  DEALER
shall not change the personnel  holding the above  described  position(s) or the
nature and extent of his/her/their  management  participation  without the prior
written approval of CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3  DEALER'S CAPITAL STOCK OR PARTNERSHIP INTEREST

If DEALER is a corporation or partnership, DEALER represents and agrees that the
persons named below own beneficially  the capital stock or partnership  interest
of DEALER in the percentages  indicated below.  DEALER warrants there will be no
change  affecting  more than 50% of the ownership  interest of DEALER,  nor will
there be any other change in the  ownership  interest of DEALER which may affect
the managerial control of DEALER without CC's prior written approval.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                    Voting           Non-Voting                 Partnership               Active
         Name                       Stock              Stock                      Interest                Yes/No

<S>                                     <C>           <C>                       <C>                       <C>   
Jeffrey C. Rachor                        5    %                %                           %              Yes
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
Nelson E. Bowers                        40    %                %                           %              Yes
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
John T. Lupton Trust                    50    %                %                           %              No
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
Frank E. Fowler                          5    %                %                           %              No
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
Total                                   100.00%                %                           %
                                   -----------       ----------                 -----------                       
</TABLE>

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4  SALES LOCALITY

DEALER shall have the  non-exclusive  right,  subject to the  provisions of this
Agreement,  to purchase from CC those new specified CC vehicles,  vehicle parts,
accessories  and other CC products  for resale at the  DEALER's  facilities  and
location described in the Dealership Facilities and Location Addendum,  attached
hereto  and  incorporated   herein  by  reference.   DEALER  will  actively  and
effectively  sell and promote the retail sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts and
accessories in DEALER's Sales Locality.  As used herein,  "Sales Locality" shall
mean the area  designated  in  writing  to DEALER by CC from time to time as the
territory of DEALER's responsibility for the sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts
and  accessories,  although  DEALER is free to sell said  products to  customers
wherever  they may be located.  Said Sales  Locality may be shared with other CC
dealers of the same line-make as CC determines to be appropriate.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
5  ADDITIONAL TERMS AND PROVISIONS

The additional terms and provisions set forth in the document entitled "Chrysler
Corporation Sales and Service Agreement  Additional Terms and Provisions" marked
"Form 91 (C-P-D)," as may  hereafter be amended from time to time,  constitute a
part of this  Agreement with the same force and effect as if set forth at length
herein,  and the term  "this  Agreement"  includes  said  additional  terms  and
provisions.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6  FORMER AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR STATEMENTS

This  Chrysler  Corporation  Plymouth  Sales  and  Service  Agreement  and other
documents (or their  successors as  specifically  provided for herein) which are
specifically  incorporated  herein by reference  constitute the entire agreement
between the parties relating to the purchase by DEALER of those new specified CC
vehicles,  parts  and  accessories  from  CC  for  resale;  and it  cancels  and
supersedes  all  earlier  agreements,  written  or oral,  between  CC and DEALER
relating to the purchase by DEALER of Plymouth vehicles,  parts and accessories,
except for (a)  amounts  owing by CC to DEALER,  such as payments  for  warranty
service performed and incentive  programs,  or (b) amounts owing or which may be
determined to be owed, as a result of an audit or investigation, by DEALER to CC
due to DEALER's purchase from CC of vehicles, parts, accessories and other goods
or services, or (c) amounts


<PAGE>


DEALER owes to CC, as a result of other extensions of credit by CC to DEALER. No
representations  or statements,  other than those  expressly set forth herein or
those set forth in the applications for this Agreement submitted to CC by DEALER
or  DEALER's  representatives,  are made or relied  upon by any party  hereto in
entering into this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7  WAIVER AND MODIFICATION

No  waiver,  modification  or change of any of the  terms of this  Agreement  or
change or  erasure of any  printed  part of this  Agreement  or  addition  to it
(except the filling in of blank spaces and lines) will be valid or binding on CC
unless  approved in writing by the President or a Vice President or the National
Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
8  AMENDMENT

DEALER and CC recognize that this Agreement does not have an expiration date and
will continue in effect unless  terminated under the limited  circumstances  set
forth in Paragraph 28. DEALER and CC further recognize that the passage of time,
changes  in  the  industry,   ways  of  doing  business  and  other   unforeseen
circumstances  may  cause CC to  determine  that it should  amend  all  Chrysler
Corporation Plymouth Sales and Service Agreements.  Therefore,  CC will have the
right to amend this  Agreement to the extent that CC deems  advisable,  provided
that CC makes the same  amendment  in Chrysler  Corporation  Plymouth  Sales and
Service  Agreements  generally.  Each such  amendment will be issued in a notice
sent by  certified  mail or  delivered  in person to  DEALER  and  signed by the
President  or a Vice  President  or the  National  Dealer  Placement  Manager of
Chrysler  Corporation.  Thirty-five  (35) days after mailing or delivery of such
notice to DEALER, this Agreement will be deemed amended in the manner and to the
extent set forth in the notice.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
9  ARBITRATION

Any and all disputes  arising out of or in connection  with the  interpretation,
performance or non-performance of this Agreement or any and all disputes arising
out of or in connection  with  transactions in any way related to this Agreement
(including,  but not limited to, the validity,  scope and enforceability of this
arbitration provision, or disputes under rights granted pursuant to the statutes
of the state in which  DEALER  is  licensed)  shall be  finally  and  completely
resolved by arbitration pursuant to the arbitration laws of the United States of
America as codified in Title 9 of the United States Code, ss.ss.1-14,  under the
Rules  of  Commercial  Arbitration  of  the  American  Arbitration   Association
(hereinafter  referred to as the "Rules") by a majority vote of a panel of three
arbitrators.  One arbitrator will be selected by DEALER  (DEALER's  arbitrator).
One arbitrator will be selected by CC (CC's arbitrator).  These arbitrators must
be  selected  by the  respective  parties  within ten (10)  business  days after
receipt by either DEALER or CC of a written notification from the other party of
a decision to arbitrate a dispute  pursuant to this Agreement.  Should either CC
or DEALER fail to select an arbitrator within said ten-day period, the party who
so fails to  select  an  arbitrator  will have its  arbitrator  selected  by the
American  Arbitration  Association  upon the application of the other party. The
third   arbitrator   must  be  an  individual  who  is  familiar  with  business
transactions and be a licensed  attorney  admitted to the practice of law within
the United States of America,  or a judge. The third arbitrator will be selected
by DEALER's and CC's  arbitrators.  If said arbitrators  cannot agree on a third
arbitrator  within thirty (30) days from the date of the appointment of the last
selected  arbitrator,  then either  DEALER's or CC's arbitrator may apply to the
American  Arbitration  Association to appoint said third arbitrator  pursuant to
the  criteria  set  forth  above.  The  arbitration   panel  shall  conduct  the
proceedings pursuant to the then existing Rules.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any provision of the Rules conflict
with any provision of this  Paragraph 9, the provisions of this Paragraph 9 will
be controlling.

CC and DEALER agree to facilitate the  arbitration  by: (a) each party paying to
the American  Arbitration  Association  one-half  (1/2) of the required  deposit
before the proceedings commence;  (b) making available to one another and to the
arbitration  panel,  for inspection and  photocopying  all documents,  books and
records,  if  determined by the  arbitrator  to be relevant to the dispute;  (c)
making available to one another and to the arbitration panel personnel  directly
or indirectly under their control,  for testimony during hearings and prehearing
proceedings  if  determined  by the  arbitration  panel  to be  relevant  to the
dispute; (d) conducting  arbitration hearings to the greatest extent possible on
consecutive   business  days;  and  (e)  strictly  observing  the  time  periods
established  by the  Rules or by the  arbitration  panel for the  submission  of
evidence and of briefs.


<PAGE>


Unless  otherwise  agreed  by CC  and  DEALER,  a  stenographic  record  of  the
arbitration  shall be made and a  transcript  thereof  shall be ordered for each
party, with each party paying one-half (1/2) of the total cost of such recording
and transcription.  The stenographer shall be state-certified,  if certification
is made by the  state,  and the  party  to whom it is most  convenient  shall be
responsible  for securing and notifying such  stenographer of the time and place
of the arbitration hearing(s).

If the arbitration  provision is invoked when the dispute between the parties is
either the legality of  terminating  this Agreement or of adding a new CC dealer
of the same line-make or relocating an existing CC dealer of the same line-make,
CC will stay the  implementation  of the decision to terminate this Agreement or
add such new CC dealer or approve the relocation of an existing CC dealer of the
same  line-make  until  the  decision  of the  arbitrator  has  been  announced,
providing  DEALER does not in any way attempt to avoid the  obligations  of this
Paragraph  9,  in  which  case  the  decision  at  issue  will  be   immediately
implemented.

Except as limited hereby, the arbitration panel shall have all powers of law and
equity, which it can lawfully assume, necessary to resolve the issues in dispute
including,  without  limiting the generality of the foregoing,  making awards of
compensatory  damages,  issuing both  prohibitory  and  mandatory  orders in the
nature of  injunctions  and compelling the production of documents and witnesses
for pre-arbitration  discovery and/or presentation at the arbitration hearing on
the merits of the case. The arbitration  panel shall not have legal or equitable
authority to issue a mandatory or  prohibitory  order which:  (a) extends or has
effect  beyond the  subject  matter of this  Agreement,  or (b) will  govern the
activities  of either  party for a period of more than two years;  nor shall the
arbitration panel have authority to award punitive, consequential or any damages
whatsoever  beyond or in  addition  to the  compensatory  damages  allowed to be
awarded under this Agreement.

The decision of the arbitration panel shall be in written form and shall include
findings of fact and conclusions of law.

It is the intent and desire of DEALER and CC to hereby and forever  renounce and
reject any and all recourse to litigation  before any judicial or administrative
forum and to accept  the award of the  arbitration  panel as final and  binding,
subject to no judicial or  administrative  review,  except on those  grounds set
forth in 9 USC ss.10 and  ss.11.  Judgment  on the award  and/or  orders  may be
entered in any court having  jurisdiction  over the parties or their assets.  In
the final award  and/or  order,  the  arbitration  panel shall  divide all costs
(other than attorney fees, which shall be borne by the party incurring such fees
and other costs  specifically  provided for herein)  incurred in conducting  the
arbitration  in  accordance  with  what the  arbitration  panel  deems  just and
equitable under the circumstances. The fees of DEALER's arbitrator shall be paid
by DEALER. The fees of CC's arbitrator shall be paid by CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10  SIGNATURE

This  Agreement  becomes  valid  only  when  signed by the  President  or a Vice
President or the National Dealer Placement  Manager of Chrysler  Corporation and
by a duly authorized officer or executive of DEALER if a corporation;  or by one
of  the  general  partners  of  DEALER  if a  partnership;  or by  DEALER  if an
individual.

IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the parties  hereto have  signed this  Agreement  which is
finally executed at AUBURN HILLS, Michigan, in triplicate, on APR 04 1996.

                                   Cleveland Chry Plym Jeep Eagle LLC
                                   dba Cleveland Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle
                                   ---------------------------------------------
                                   (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

                                   By  /s/ Nelson E. Bowers II
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                       (Individual Duly Authorized to Sign)

                                       Pres.
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                                     (Title)

                                               CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                   By  /s/ ILLEGIBLE
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                                 National Dealer
                                                Placement Manager
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                                      (Title)
    

   
                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                      Jeep

                           SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT

  Cleveland Chry Plym Jeep Eagle LLC dba Cleveland Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle
                   (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

located at  2496 S. Lee Highway                    Cleveland      TN 37311
                 (STREET)                         (CITY)         (STATE)

a(n) Corporation,                                hereinafter  called DEALER, and
    (INDIVIDUAL, CORPORATION OR PARTNERSHIP)

Chrysler Corporation, a Delaware corporation,  hereinafter sometimes referred to
as "CC",  have entered  into this  Chrysler  Corporation  Jeep Sales and Service
Agreement,  hereinafter  referred to as  "Agreement",  the terms of which are as
follows:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     INTRODUCTION

The purpose of the  relationship  established  by this Agreement is to provide a
means for the sale and service of  specified  Jeep  vehicles  and the sale of CC
vehicle  parts  and  accessories  in  a  manner  that  will  maximize   customer
satisfaction and be of benefit to DEALER and CC.

While  the  following  provisions,  each of which is  material,  set  forth  the
undertakings of this relationship,  the success of those undertakings rests on a
recognition  of the  mutuality  of  interests  of DEALER and CC, and a spirit of
understanding  and  cooperation by both parties in the day to day performance of
their respective functions.  As a result of such considerations,  CC has entered
into this  Agreement  in reliance  upon and has placed its trust in the personal
abilities,  expertise,  knowledge and integrity of DEALER's principal owners and
management  personnel,  which CC  anticipates  will enable DEALER to perform the
personal services contemplated by this Agreement.

It is the mutual  goal of this  relationship  to promote the sale and service of
specified  CC  products  by  maintaining  and  advancing  their  excellence  and
reputation by earning,  holding and  furthering the public regard for CC and all
CC dealers.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1  PRODUCTS COVERED

DEALER has the right to order and  purchase  from CC and to sell at retail  only
those  specific  models of CC vehicles,  sometimes  referred to as "specified CC
vehicles,"   listed  on  the  Motor  Vehicle   Addendum,   attached  hereto  and
incorporated herein by reference. CC may change the models of CC vehicles listed
on the Motor Vehicle Addendum by furnishing  DEALER a superseding  Motor Vehicle
Addendum.  Such a  superseding  Motor  Vehicle  Addendum  will not be  deemed or
construed or to be an amendment to this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2  DEALER'S MANAGEMENT

CC has  entered  into this  Agreement  relying on the  active,  substantial  and
continuing personal participation in the management of DEALER's organization by:

                NAME                                     POSITION


         Jeffrey C. Rachor                             GM/Member
         ------------------------                      -------------------

         ------------------------                      -------------------



<PAGE>


DEALER represents and warrants that at least one of the above-named  individuals
will be physically  present at the DEALER's facility  (sometimes  referred to as
"Dealership  Facilities") during most of its operating hours and will manage all
of DEALER's  business  relating to the sale and service of CC  products.  DEALER
shall not change the personnel  holding the above  described  position(s) or the
nature and extent of his/her/their  management  participation  without the prior
written approval of CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3  DEALER'S CAPITAL STOCK OR PARTNERSHIP INTEREST

If DEALER is a corporation or partnership, DEALER represents and agrees that the
persons named below own beneficially  the capital stock or partnership  interest
of DEALER in the percentages  indicated below.  DEALER warrants there will be no
change  affecting  more than 50% of the ownership  interest of DEALER,  nor will
there be any other change in the  ownership  interest of DEALER which may affect
the managerial control of DEALER without CC's prior written approval.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                    Voting           Non-Voting                 Partnership               Active
         Name                       Stock              Stock                      Interest                Yes/No

<S>                                     <C>           <C>                       <C>                       <C>   
Jeffrey C. Rachor                        5    %                %                           %              Yes
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
Nelson E. Bowers                        40    %                %                           %              Yes
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
John T. Lupton Trust                    50    %                %                           %              No
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
Frank E. Fowler                          5    %                %                           %              No
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
                                              %                %                           %        
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
Total                                   100.00%                %                           %
                                   -----------       ----------                 -----------                       
</TABLE>

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4  SALES LOCALITY

DEALER shall have the  non-exclusive  right,  subject to the  provisions of this
Agreement,  to purchase from CC those new specified CC vehicles,  vehicle parts,
accessories  and other CC products  for resale at the  DEALER's  facilities  and
location described in the Dealership Facilities and Location Addendum,  attached
hereto  and  incorporated   herein  by  reference.   DEALER  will  actively  and
effectively  sell and promote the retail sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts and
accessories in DEALER's Sales Locality.  As used herein,  "Sales Locality" shall
mean the area  designated  in  writing  to DEALER by CC from time to time as the
territory of DEALER's responsibility for the sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts
and  accessories,  although  DEALER is free to sell said  products to  customers
wherever  they may be located.  Said Sales  Locality may be shared with other CC
dealers of the same line-make as CC determines to be appropriate.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
5  ADDITIONAL TERMS AND PROVISIONS

The additional terms and provisions set forth in the document entitled "Chrysler
Corporation Sales and Service Agreement  Additional Terms and Provisions" marked
"Form 91 (J-E)," as may  hereafter  be amended  from time to time,  constitute a
part of this  Agreement with the same force and effect as if set forth at length
herein,  and the term  "this  Agreement"  includes  said  additional  terms  and
provisions.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6  FORMER AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR STATEMENTS

This Chrysler  Corporation Jeep Sales and Service  Agreement and other documents
(or their successors as specifically provided for herein) which are specifically
incorporated  herein by reference  constitute the entire  agreement  between the
parties  relating to the purchase by DEALER of those new  specified CC vehicles,
parts and  accessories  from CC for resale;  and it cancels and  supersedes  all
earlier  agreements,  written or oral,  between CC and  DEALER  relating  to the
purchase  by DEALER of Jeep  vehicles,  parts and  accessories,  except  for (a)
amounts owing by CC to DEALER,  such as payments for warranty service  performed
and  incentive  programs,  or (b) amounts owing or which may be determined to be
owed, as a result of an audit or investigation,  by DEALER to CC due to DEALER's
purchase from CC of vehicles, parts, accessories and other goods or services, or
(c) amounts DEALER


<PAGE>


owes to CC,  as a result of other  extensions  of  credit  by CC to  DEALER.  No
representations  or statements,  other than those  expressly set forth herein or
those set forth in the applications for this Agreement submitted to CC by DEALER
or  DEALER's  representatives,  are made or relied  upon by any party  hereto in
entering into this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7  WAIVER AND MODIFICATION

No  waiver,  modification  or change of any of the  terms of this  Agreement  or
change or  erasure of any  printed  part of this  Agreement  or  addition  to it
(except the filling in of blank spaces and lines) will be valid or binding on CC
unless  approved in writing by the President or a Vice President or the National
Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
8  AMENDMENT

DEALER and CC recognize that this Agreement does not have an expiration date and
will continue in effect unless  terminated under the limited  circumstances  set
forth in Paragraph 28. DEALER and CC further recognize that the passage of time,
changes  in  the  industry,   ways  of  doing  business  and  other   unforeseen
circumstances  may  cause CC to  determine  that it should  amend  all  Chrysler
Corporation Jeep Sales and Service Agreements. Therefore, CC will have the right
to amend this Agreement to the extent that CC deems advisable,  provided that CC
makes  the same  amendment  in  Chrysler  Corporation  Jeep  Sales  and  Service
Agreements  generally.  Each such  amendment  will be issued in a notice sent by
certified mail or delivered in person to DEALER and signed by the President or a
Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.
Thirty-five  (35) days after mailing or delivery of such notice to DEALER,  this
Agreement  will be deemed  amended  in the manner and to the extent set forth in
the notice.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
9  ARBITRATION

Any and all disputes  arising out of or in connection  with the  interpretation,
performance or non-performance of this Agreement or any and all disputes arising
out of or in connection  with  transactions in any way related to this Agreement
(including,  but not limited to, the validity,  scope and enforceability of this
arbitration provision, or disputes under rights granted pursuant to the statutes
of the state in which  DEALER  is  licensed)  shall be  finally  and  completely
resolved by arbitration pursuant to the arbitration laws of the United States of
America as codified in Title 9 of the United States Code, ss.ss.1-14,  under the
Rules  of  Commercial  Arbitration  of  the  American  Arbitration   Association
(hereinafter  referred to as the "Rules") by a majority vote of a panel of three
arbitrators.  One arbitrator will be selected by DEALER  (DEALER's  arbitrator).
One arbitrator will be selected by CC (CC's arbitrator).  These arbitrators must
be  selected  by the  respective  parties  within ten (10)  business  days after
receipt by either DEALER or CC of a written notification from the other party of
a decision to arbitrate a dispute  pursuant to this Agreement.  Should either CC
or DEALER fail to select an arbitrator within said ten-day period, the party who
so fails to  select  an  arbitrator  will have its  arbitrator  selected  by the
American  Arbitration  Association  upon the application of the other party. The
third   arbitrator   must  be  an  individual  who  is  familiar  with  business
transactions and be a licensed  attorney  admitted to the practice of law within
the United States of America,  or a judge. The third arbitrator will be selected
by DEALER's and CC's  arbitrators.  If said arbitrators  cannot agree on a third
arbitrator  within thirty (30) days from the date of the appointment of the last
selected  arbitrator,  then either  DEALER's or CC's arbitrator may apply to the
American  Arbitration  Association to appoint said third arbitrator  pursuant to
the  criteria  set  forth  above.  The  arbitration   panel  shall  conduct  the
proceedings pursuant to the then existing Rules.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any provision of the Rules conflict
with any provision of this  Paragraph 9, the provisions of this Paragraph 9 will
be controlling.

CC and DEALER agree to facilitate the  arbitration  by: (a) each party paying to
the American  Arbitration  Association  one-half  (1/2) of the required  deposit
before the proceedings commence;  (b) making available to one another and to the
arbitration  panel,  for inspection and  photocopying  all documents,  books and
records,  if  determined by the  arbitrator  to be relevant to the dispute;  (c)
making available to one another and to the arbitration panel personnel  directly
or indirectly under their control,  for testimony during hearings and prehearing
proceedings  if  determined  by the  arbitration  panel  to be  relevant  to the
dispute; (d) conducting  arbitration hearings to the greatest extent possible on
consecutive   business  days;  and  (e)  strictly  observing  the  time  periods
established  by the  Rules or by the  arbitration  panel for the  submission  of
evidence and of briefs.


<PAGE>


Unless  otherwise  agreed  by CC  and  DEALER,  a  stenographic  record  of  the
arbitration  shall be made and a  transcript  thereof  shall be ordered for each
party, with each party paying one-half (1/2) of the total cost of such recording
and transcription.  The stenographer shall be state-certified,  if certification
is made by the  state,  and the  party  to whom it is most  convenient  shall be
responsible  for securing and notifying such  stenographer of the time and place
of the arbitration hearing(s).

If the arbitration  provision is invoked when the dispute between the parties is
either the legality of  terminating  this Agreement or of adding a new CC dealer
of the same line-make or relocating an existing CC dealer of the same line-make,
CC will stay the  implementation  of the decision to terminate this Agreement or
add such new CC dealer or approve the relocation of an existing CC dealer of the
same  line-make  until  the  decision  of the  arbitrator  has  been  announced,
providing  DEALER does not in any way attempt to avoid the  obligations  of this
Paragraph  9,  in  which  case  the  decision  at  issue  will  be   immediately
implemented.

Except as limited hereby, the arbitration panel shall have all powers of law and
equity, which it can lawfully assume, necessary to resolve the issues in dispute
including,  without  limiting the generality of the foregoing,  making awards of
compensatory  damages,  issuing both  prohibitory  and  mandatory  orders in the
nature of  injunctions  and compelling the production of documents and witnesses
for pre-arbitration  discovery and/or presentation at the arbitration hearing on
the merits of the case. The arbitration  panel shall not have legal or equitable
authority to issue a mandatory or  prohibitory  order which:  (a) extends or has
effect  beyond the  subject  matter of this  Agreement,  or (b) will  govern the
activities  of either  party for a period of more than two years;  nor shall the
arbitration panel have authority to award punitive, consequential or any damages
whatsoever  beyond or in  addition  to the  compensatory  damages  allowed to be
awarded under this Agreement.

The decision of the arbitration panel shall be in written form and shall include
findings of fact and conclusions of law.

It is the intent and desire of DEALER and CC to hereby and forever  renounce and
reject any and all recourse to litigation  before any judicial or administrative
forum and to accept  the award of the  arbitration  panel as final and  binding,
subject to no judicial or  administrative  review,  except on those  grounds set
forth in 9 USC ss.10 and  ss.11.  Judgment  on the award  and/or  orders  may be
entered in any court having  jurisdiction  over the parties or their assets.  In
the final award  and/or  order,  the  arbitration  panel shall  divide all costs
(other than attorney fees, which shall be borne by the party incurring such fees
and other costs  specifically  provided for herein)  incurred in conducting  the
arbitration  in  accordance  with  what the  arbitration  panel  deems  just and
equitable under the circumstances. The fees of DEALER's arbitrator shall be paid
by DEALER. The fees of CC's arbitrator shall be paid by CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10  SIGNATURE

This  Agreement  becomes  valid  only  when  signed by the  President  or a Vice
President or the National Dealer Placement  Manager of Chrysler  Corporation and
by a duly authorized officer or executive of DEALER if a corporation;  or by one
of  the  general  partners  of  DEALER  if a  partnership;  or by  DEALER  if an
individual.

IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the parties  hereto have  signed this  Agreement  which is
finally executed at AUBURN HILLS, Michigan, in triplicate, on APR 04 1996.

                                   Cleveland Chry Plym Jeep Eagle LLC
                                   dba Cleveland Chrysler Plymouth Jeep Eagle
                                   ---------------------------------------------
                                   (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

                                   By: /s/ Nelson E. Bowers II
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                       (Individual Duly Authorized to Sign)

                                       Pres.
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                                    (Title)

                                             CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                   By: /s/ ILLEGIBLE
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                               National Dealer
                                              Placement Manager
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                                      (Title)
    

   
                              CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                      Dodge

                           SALES AND SERVICE AGREEMENT

               Nelson Bowers Dodge, LLC d/b/a Dodge of Chattanooga
                   (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

located at  402 West Martin Luther King Blvd.      Chattanooga    TN 37402
                 (STREET)                         (CITY)         (STATE)

a(n) Limited Liability Company               hereinafter  called DEALER, and
    (INDIVIDUAL, CORPORATION OR PARTNERSHIP)

Chrysler Corporation, a Delaware corporation,  hereinafter sometimes referred to
as "CC",  have entered into this  Chrysler  Corporation  Dodge Sales and Service
Agreement,  hereinafter  referred to as  "Agreement",  the terms of which are as
follows:

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     INTRODUCTION

The purpose of the  relationship  established  by this Agreement is to provide a
means for the sale and service of  specified  Dodge  vehicles and the sale of CC
vehicle  parts  and  accessories  in  a  manner  that  will  maximize   customer
satisfaction and be of benefit to DEALER and CC.

While  the  following  provisions,  each of which is  material,  set  forth  the
undertakings of this relationship,  the success of those undertakings rests on a
recognition  of the  mutuality  of  interests  of DEALER and CC, and a spirit of
understanding  and  cooperation by both parties in the day to day performance of
their respective functions.  As a result of such considerations,  CC has entered
into this  Agreement  in reliance  upon and has placed its trust in the personal
abilities,  expertise,  knowledge and integrity of DEALER's principal owners and
management  personnel,  which CC  anticipates  will enable DEALER to perform the
personal services contemplated by this Agreement.

It is the mutual  goal of this  relationship  to promote the sale and service of
specified  CC  products  by  maintaining  and  advancing  their  excellence  and
reputation by earning,  holding and  furthering the public regard for CC and all
CC dealers.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1  PRODUCTS COVERED

DEALER has the right to order and  purchase  from CC and to sell at retail  only
those  specific  models of CC vehicles,  sometimes  referred to as "specified CC
vehicles,"   listed  on  the  Motor  Vehicle   Addendum,   attached  hereto  and
incorporated herein by reference. CC may change the models of CC vehicles listed
on the Motor Vehicle Addendum by furnishing  DEALER a superseding  Motor Vehicle
Addendum.  Such a  superseding  Motor  Vehicle  Addendum  will not be  deemed or
construed or to be an amendment to this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2  DEALER'S MANAGEMENT

CC has  entered  into this  Agreement  relying on the  active,  substantial  and
continuing personal participation in the management of DEALER's organization by:

                NAME                                     POSITION


         Jeffrey C. Rachor                             General Manager
         ------------------------                      -------------------

         ------------------------                      -------------------



<PAGE>


DEALER represents and warrants that at least one of the above-named  individuals
will be physically  present at the DEALER's facility  (sometimes  referred to as
"Dealership  Facilities") during most of its operating hours and will manage all
of DEALER's  business  relating to the sale and service of CC  products.  DEALER
shall not change the personnel  holding the above  described  position(s) or the
nature and extent of his/her/their  management  participation  without the prior
written approval of CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3  DEALER'S CAPITAL STOCK OR PARTNERSHIP INTEREST

If DEALER is a corporation or partnership, DEALER represents and agrees that the
persons named below own beneficially  the capital stock or partnership  interest
of DEALER in the percentages  indicated below.  DEALER warrants there will be no
change  affecting  more than 50% of the ownership  interest of DEALER,  nor will
there be any other change in the  ownership  interest of DEALER which may affect
the managerial control of DEALER without CC's prior written approval.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                    Voting           Non-Voting                 Partnership               Active
         Name                       Stock              Stock                      Interest                Yes/No

<S>                                     <C>           <C>                       <C>                       <C>   
Jeffrey C. Rachor                        1.00 %                %                           %              Yes
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
Nelson E. Bowers                        49.00 %                %                           %              Yes
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
John T. Lupton Trust                    50.00 %                %                           %              No
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
                                              %                %                           %        
- ----------------------------       -----------       ----------                 -----------               --------
Total                                   100.00%                %                           %
                                   -----------       ----------                 -----------                       
</TABLE>

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4  SALES LOCALITY

DEALER shall have the  non-exclusive  right,  subject to the  provisions of this
Agreement,  to purchase from CC those new specified CC vehicles,  vehicle parts,
accessories  and other CC products  for resale at the  DEALER's  facilities  and
location described in the Dealership Facilities and Location Addendum,  attached
hereto  and  incorporated   herein  by  reference.   DEALER  will  actively  and
effectively  sell and promote the retail sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts and
accessories in DEALER's Sales Locality.  As used herein,  "Sales Locality" shall
mean the area  designated  in  writing  to DEALER by CC from time to time as the
territory of DEALER's responsibility for the sale of CC vehicles,  vehicle parts
and  accessories,  although  DEALER is free to sell said  products to  customers
wherever  they may be located.  Said Sales  Locality may be shared with other CC
dealers of the same line-make as CC determines to be appropriate.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
5  ADDITIONAL TERMS AND PROVISIONS

The additional terms and provisions set forth in the document entitled "Chrysler
Corporation Sales and Service Agreement  Additional Terms and Provisions" marked
"Form 91 (C-P-D)," as may  hereafter be amended from time to time,  constitute a
part of this  Agreement with the same force and effect as if set forth at length
herein,  and the term  "this  Agreement"  includes  said  additional  terms  and
provisions.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6  FORMER AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR STATEMENTS

This Chrysler  Corporation Dodge Sales and Service Agreement and other documents
(or their successors as specifically provided for herein) which are specifically
incorporated  herein by reference  constitute the entire  agreement  between the
parties  relating to the purchase by DEALER of those new  specified CC vehicles,
parts and  accessories  from CC for resale;  and it cancels and  supersedes  all
earlier  agreements,  written or oral,  between CC and  DEALER  relating  to the
purchase  by DEALER of Dodge  vehicles,  parts and  accessories,  except for (a)
amounts owing by CC to DEALER,  such as payments for warranty service  performed
and  incentive  programs,  or (b) amounts owing or which may be determined to be
owed, as a result of an audit or investigation,  by DEALER to CC due to DEALER's
purchase from CC of vehicles, parts, accessories and other goods or services, or
(c) amounts DEALER owes


<PAGE>


to  CC,  as a  result  of  other  extensions  of  credit  by  CC to  DEALER.  No
representations  or statements,  other than those  expressly set forth herein or
those set forth in the applications for this Agreement submitted to CC by DEALER
or  DEALER's  representatives,  are made or relied  upon by any party  hereto in
entering into this Agreement.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7  WAIVER AND MODIFICATION

No  waiver,  modification  or change of any of the  terms of this  Agreement  or
change or  erasure of any  printed  part of this  Agreement  or  addition  to it
(except the filling in of blank spaces and lines) will be valid or binding on CC
unless  approved in writing by the President or a Vice President or the National
Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
8  AMENDMENT

DEALER and CC recognize that this Agreement does not have an expiration date and
will continue in effect unless  terminated under the limited  circumstances  set
forth in Paragraph 28. DEALER and CC further recognize that the passage of time,
changes  in  the  industry,   ways  of  doing  business  and  other   unforeseen
circumstances  may  cause CC to  determine  that it should  amend  all  Chrysler
Corporation  Dodge Sales and  Service  Agreements.  Therefore,  CC will have the
right to amend this  Agreement to the extent that CC deems  advisable,  provided
that CC makes the same amendment in Chrysler Corporation Dodge Sales and Service
Agreements  generally.  Each such  amendment  will be issued in a notice sent by
certified mail or delivered in person to DEALER and signed by the President or a
Vice President or the National Dealer Placement Manager of Chrysler Corporation.
Thirty-five  (35) days after mailing or delivery of such notice to DEALER,  this
Agreement  will be deemed  amended  in the manner and to the extent set forth in
the notice.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
9  ARBITRATION

Any and all disputes  arising out of or in connection  with the  interpretation,
performance or non-performance of this Agreement or any and all disputes arising
out of or in connection  with  transactions in any way related to this Agreement
(including,  but not limited to, the validity,  scope and enforceability of this
arbitration provision, or disputes under rights granted pursuant to the statutes
of the state in which  DEALER  is  licensed)  shall be  finally  and  completely
resolved by arbitration pursuant to the arbitration laws of the United States of
America as codified in Title 9 of the United States Code, ss.ss.1-14,  under the
Rules  of  Commercial  Arbitration  of  the  American  Arbitration   Association
(hereinafter  referred to as the "Rules") by a majority vote of a panel of three
arbitrators.  One arbitrator will be selected by DEALER  (DEALER's  arbitrator).
One arbitrator will be selected by CC (CC's arbitrator).  These arbitrators must
be  selected  by the  respective  parties  within ten (10)  business  days after
receipt by either DEALER or CC of a written notification from the other party of
a decision to arbitrate a dispute  pursuant to this Agreement.  Should either CC
or DEALER fail to select an arbitrator within said ten-day period, the party who
so fails to  select  an  arbitrator  will have its  arbitrator  selected  by the
American  Arbitration  Association  upon the application of the other party. The
third   arbitrator   must  be  an  individual  who  is  familiar  with  business
transactions and be a licensed  attorney  admitted to the practice of law within
the United States of America,  or a judge. The third arbitrator will be selected
by DEALER's and CC's  arbitrators.  If said arbitrators  cannot agree on a third
arbitrator  within thirty (30) days from the date of the appointment of the last
selected  arbitrator,  then either  DEALER's or CC's arbitrator may apply to the
American  Arbitration  Association to appoint said third arbitrator  pursuant to
the  criteria  set  forth  above.  The  arbitration   panel  shall  conduct  the
proceedings pursuant to the then existing Rules.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any provision of the Rules conflict
with any provision of this  Paragraph 9, the provisions of this Paragraph 9 will
be controlling.

CC and DEALER agree to facilitate the  arbitration  by: (a) each party paying to
the American  Arbitration  Association  one-half  (1/2) of the required  deposit
before the proceedings commence;  (b) making available to one another and to the
arbitration  panel,  for inspection and  photocopying  all documents,  books and
records,  if  determined by the  arbitrator  to be relevant to the dispute;  (c)
making available to one another and to the arbitration panel personnel  directly
or indirectly under their control,  for testimony during hearings and prehearing
proceedings  if  determined  by the  arbitration  panel  to be  relevant  to the
dispute; (d) conducting  arbitration hearings to the greatest extent possible on
consecutive   business  days;  and  (e)  strictly  observing  the  time  periods
established  by the  Rules or by the  arbitration  panel for the  submission  of
evidence and of briefs.


<PAGE>


Unless  otherwise  agreed  by CC  and  DEALER,  a  stenographic  record  of  the
arbitration  shall be made and a  transcript  thereof  shall be ordered for each
party, with each party paying one-half (1/2) of the total cost of such recording
and transcription.  The stenographer shall be state-certified,  if certification
is made by the  state,  and the  party  to whom it is most  convenient  shall be
responsible  for securing and notifying such  stenographer of the time and place
of the arbitration hearing(s).

If the arbitration  provision is invoked when the dispute between the parties is
either the legality of  terminating  this Agreement or of adding a new CC dealer
of the same line-make or relocating an existing CC dealer of the same line-make,
CC will stay the  implementation  of the decision to terminate this Agreement or
add such new CC dealer or approve the relocation of an existing CC dealer of the
same  line-make  until  the  decision  of the  arbitrator  has  been  announced,
providing  DEALER does not in any way attempt to avoid the  obligations  of this
Paragraph  9,  in  which  case  the  decision  at  issue  will  be   immediately
implemented.

Except as limited hereby, the arbitration panel shall have all powers of law and
equity, which it can lawfully assume, necessary to resolve the issues in dispute
including,  without  limiting the generality of the foregoing,  making awards of
compensatory  damages,  issuing both  prohibitory  and  mandatory  orders in the
nature of  injunctions  and compelling the production of documents and witnesses
for pre-arbitration  discovery and/or presentation at the arbitration hearing on
the merits of the case. The arbitration  panel shall not have legal or equitable
authority to issue a mandatory or  prohibitory  order which:  (a) extends or has
effect  beyond the  subject  matter of this  Agreement,  or (b) will  govern the
activities  of either  party for a period of more than two years;  nor shall the
arbitration panel have authority to award punitive, consequential or any damages
whatsoever  beyond or in  addition  to the  compensatory  damages  allowed to be
awarded under this Agreement.

The decision of the arbitration panel shall be in written form and shall include
findings of fact and conclusions of law.

It is the intent and desire of DEALER and CC to hereby and forever  renounce and
reject any and all recourse to litigation  before any judicial or administrative
forum and to accept  the award of the  arbitration  panel as final and  binding,
subject to no judicial or  administrative  review,  except on those  grounds set
forth in 9 USC ss.10 and  ss.11.  Judgment  on the award  and/or  orders  may be
entered in any court having  jurisdiction  over the parties or their assets.  In
the final award  and/or  order,  the  arbitration  panel shall  divide all costs
(other than attorney fees, which shall be borne by the party incurring such fees
and other costs  specifically  provided for herein)  incurred in conducting  the
arbitration  in  accordance  with  what the  arbitration  panel  deems  just and
equitable under the circumstances. The fees of DEALER's arbitrator shall be paid
by DEALER. The fees of CC's arbitrator shall be paid by CC.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10  SIGNATURE

This  Agreement  becomes  valid  only  when  signed by the  President  or a Vice
President or the National Dealer Placement  Manager of Chrysler  Corporation and
by a duly authorized officer or executive of DEALER if a corporation;  or by one
of  the  general  partners  of  DEALER  if a  partnership;  or by  DEALER  if an
individual.

IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the parties  hereto have  signed this  Agreement  which is
finally executed at AUBURN HILLS, Michigan, in triplicate, on MAR 05 1997.

                                   Nelson Bowers Dodge, LLC
                                   dba Dodge of Chattanooga
                                   ---------------------------------------------
                                   (DEALER Firm Name and D/B/A, if applicable)

                                   By: /s/ Nelson E. Bowers II
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                       (Individual Duly Authorized to Sign)

                                       Chief Manager
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                                    (Title)

                                   CHRYSLER CORPORATION

                                   By: /s/ ILLEGIBLE
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                               National Dealer
                                              Placement Manager
                                       -----------------------------------------
                                                      (Title)
    

   
                                                              







                        Volvo Cars of North America, Inc.





                        ---------------------------------

                                   AUTHORIZED
                               RETAILER AGREEMENT

                        ---------------------------------







                                                                    [LOGO] VOLVO



<PAGE>


                                TABLE OF CONTENTS

                            I. BUSINESS RELATIONSHIP

The  Partners  agree  that a  climate  of  mutual  trust,  respect,  and  shared
information is  fundamental  to the joint pursuit of a shared vision,  which is
the foundation of this Agreement.

 1. TERM OF AGREEMENT .....................................................    3

 2. OWNERSHIP .............................................................    3

 3. MANAGEMENT ............................................................    4

 4. CHANGES IN OWNERSHIP OR MANAGEMENT ....................................    4

 5. LOCATION ..............................................................    5

 6. FACILITIES ............................................................    5

 7. CAPITALIZATION OF RETAILER ............................................    6

 8. DISPOSITION OF BUSINESS BY RETAILER ...................................    6

 9. SUCCESSION OF OWNERSHIP OR MANAGEMENT .................................    8

10. TERMINATION ...........................................................    9

11. DISPUTE RESOLUTION ....................................................   13


                     II. VOLVO CUSTOMER OWNERSHIP EXPERIENCE

The  Partners  agree that the  highest  priority  for  Retailer  and  Company is
providing a superior  ownership  experience  for Volvo  Customers.  This will be
achieved by providing unique customer value, and by treating Volvo customers and
prospective Volvo customers with honesty and integrity.

12. RETAILER BUSINESS PLAN ................................................   14

13. REVIEW AND UPDATE OF BUSINESS PLAN ....................................   14

14. VEHICLE SALES OR SERVICE IMPROVEMENT PLAN .............................   14

15. PRODUCT AVAILABILITY ..................................................   15

16. PURCHASE AND DELIVERY .................................................   15

17. PAYMENTS BY RETAILER ..................................................   16

18. INVENTORY OF COMPANY VEHICLES .........................................   16

19. DEMONSTRATORS .........................................................   17

20. BUSINESS HOURS ........................................................   17

21. PARTS AND ACCESSORIES .................................................   17

22. WARRANTIES ON COMPANY PRODUCTS ........................................   17

23. PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE ..................................................   18

24. REPAIR AND MAINTENANCE SERVICE ........................................   18

25. TRAINING ..............................................................   18


                                       ii


<PAGE>


                            III. OPERATING PROVISIONS

The  Partners  agree  that the  success  of  Volvo,  its  name,  trademarks  and
reputation is their joint responsibility.

26. USE OF VOLVO TRADEMARK ................................................   18

27. DISCONTINUANCE OF RIGHT TO USE TRADEMARK ..............................   19

28. LINES OF CREDIT .......................................................   20

29. ACCOUNTING AND RECORD KEEPING .........................................   20

30. RETAILER INFORMATION SYSTEMS ..........................................   20

31. CHANGE IN PRICES ......................................................   20

32. EXPORT OF COMPANY VEHICLES ............................................   20

33. FACTORY SUGGESTED PRICE LABELS ........................................   20

34. INDEMNIFICATION .......................................................   21

35. COMPLIANCE WITH LEGAL REQUIREMENTS ....................................   21

36. COMPLIANCE WITH CONSUMER PROTECTION LAWS AND REGULATIONS ..............   22

37. TRADE PRACTICES .......................................................   22

38. REPURCHASE OF COMPANY PRODUCTS BY THE COMPANY .........................   22


                          IV. MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

39. LICENSING REQUIREMENTS ................................................   23

40. INSURANCE .............................................................   23

41. TAXES .................................................................   23

42. WAIVER ................................................................   23

43. AGENCY ................................................................   23

44. SUBRETAILERS ..........................................................   24

45. ASSIGNMENT OF RIGHTS OR DELEGATION OF DUTIES ..........................   24

46. NOTICE AND SERVICE OF NOTICE ..........................................   24

47. APPLICABLE LAW AND SEVERABILITY .......................................   24

48. FINANCIAL INFORMATION .................................................   24

49. ENTIRE AGREEMENT ......................................................   24

50. NO FRANCHISE FEE OR ADDITIONAL PAYMENTS ...............................   24

51. CAPTIONS ..............................................................   25

52. TIME OF THE ESSENCE ...................................................   25

53. DATE OF PERFORMANCE ...................................................   25

54. RULES OF CONSTRUCTION .................................................   25


                                 V. DEFINITIONS

55. DEFINITIONS ...........................................................   25


                                      iii


<PAGE>


                          AUTHORIZED RETAILER AGREEMENT

This Authorized  Retailer Agreement  ("Agreement") is entered into this 7 day of
May  1996,  by and  between  Volvo  Cars of  North  America,  Inc.,  a  Delaware
corporation  with its principal  place of business at 7 Volvo Drive,  Rockleigh,
New Jersey,  07647 ("the  Company")  and European  Motors,  LLC,  d/b/a Volvo of
Chattanooga ("Retailer"), having its address at 5949 Brainerd Road, Chattanooga,
Tennesee 37421.

This  Agreement  delineates the rights and  responsibilities  of the Company and
Retailer,  who each  believe  that the goals  described  in the Preamble to this
Agreement  can be  achieved  while  providing  the  Company  and  Retailer  with
reasonable  profits,  and providing  Volvo  Customers with a superior  ownership
experience.

NOW,  THEREFORE,  in  consideration  of the mutual  promises  and other good and
valuable  consideration  referenced  herein,  the sufficiency of which is hereby
acknowledged, it is mutually agreed by the parties as follows;

                                    PREAMBLE

A.   MISSION

     The mission of Volvo Cars of North America, Inc., and its Retailer Partners
     is to  maximize  the  potential  of  Volvo  products,  by  identifying  and
     fulfilling clearly defined customer needs and demands.

     This will be achieved by:

          o    Providing  an  ownership  experience  regarded as superior in the
               industry.

          o    Developing and maintaining  financially  strong and  professional
               Retailers  that are either  exclusive,  or have Volvo products as
               their primary business.

          o    Developing a superior  organization  where  employees  strive for
               excellence  based  on  individual  motivation,  and TQM  oriented
               leadership; and

          o    Exploiting  Volvo  virtues  created by leadership in the areas of
               quality, safety and environmental care.

                                                          VCNA MISSION STATEMENT

                                                                   January, 1995

B.   VISION

     This Agreement is the very foundation of the partnership between Volvo Cars
     of  North  America,  Inc.  and its  Retailers.  It has been  carefully  and
     diligently  constructed by a team of equals,  representing both Partners in
     the spirit of fairness and cooperation.

     It  is  upon  this   foundation  we  will  strive  to  build  a  preeminent
     organization dedicated to fulfilling our joint vision:

     A seamless  manufacturer/retailer  commercial entity created and maintained
     by:

          o    Sharing in risks and rewards.

          o    Building of financial strength.

          o    Common "ownership" of the Volvo brand.

          o    Maximizing  the  potential  of Volvo  products  and  delivering a
               superior ownership experience.

     Consistent  with our vision,  we mutually  agree to conduct our  respective
     businesses with the highest level of integrity,  thereby  creating a strong
     perception of seamlessness in the eyes of our customers.

C.   PRINCIPLES OF OUR RELATIONSHIP

     Both  Partners  have  the  right to  expect  from  each  other  the  mutual
     commitment to and belief in the following Principles:

          o    That the  pursuit of the  Mission  Statement  and the Vision is a
               joint responsibility.

          o    That  the  overall  direction  of the  development  of the  name,
               trademarks and reputation of "Volvo" is a joint responsibility.

          o    That rewards be shared in relation to risks assumed.

          o    That the Volvo brand be further protected and developed.



                                       1
<PAGE>


          o    That people are important.

          o    That unique customer-value be provided.

          o    That disputes be resolved in a fair and equitable manner.

          o    That information be shared timely and accurately.

          o    That  honesty and  integrity  are  fundamental  to our conduct of
               business.

          o    That the commitment to and fulfillment of these principles is the
               foundation upon which the right to represent Volvo is awarded.

D.   RETAILER PARTICIPATION

     The strength of this  Agreement  is the  mutuality  principle.  It has been
     deliberately constructed to protect the interests of both Partners equally,
     for it is our mutual interests which make us strong.

     The  Company and  Retailer  agree that their  interests  must be aligned to
     attain these goals and achieve long term success in the automotive  market.
     These interests  include,  without  limitation,  the profitable  marketing,
     promoting,  selling  and  servicing  of  Company  Products  while  building
     superior levels of customer loyalty and  satisfaction  with the Company and
     Retailer.

     In  consideration  of  Retailers'  commitments,  and to  ensure a  mutually
     satisfactory  relationship  between Company and its Retailers,  the Company
     has   established    mechanisms   for   Retailer   participation   in   the
     decision-making  process  on  matters  significantly  affecting  Retailer's
     business.   Retailer   involvement   is  provided   through  six  principal
     mechanisms:  the Executive  Committee,  Regional Operating Teams,  Retailer
     Action Teams,  Performance  Enhancement  Teams,  the Market  Representation
     Panel, and the Mediation Panel.

     A.   EXECUTIVE COMMITTEE

          Guided by the  Mission  Statement,  Vision,  and the  Principles,  the
          Executive  Committee is a Volvo policy team whose primary focus is the
          future value of our business.

          Four Retailers  participate along with Company executives from various
          disciplines.  Retailer  participants  must have  previously  served as
          members of a Regional  Operating  Team,  are selected by the Executive
          Committee, and serve for staggered two-year terms.

     B.   REGIONAL OPERATING TEAMS

          The  Regional  Operating  Teams are  comprised  of an equal  number of
          Retailers and Company  representatives.  Regional Operating Teams deal
          with regional and local  business  issues in areas such as advertising
          and market support.

     C.   RETAILER ACTION TEAMS

          The  Executive  Committee  may  establish  Retailer  Action  Teams  as
          necessary,  to review certain specific business issues.  The Executive
          Committee will  determine the membership of each Retailer  Action Team
          and the scope of its assignment.

     D.   PERFORMANCE ENHANCEMENT TEAMS

          Performance  Enhancement Teams are comprised of 8-14 Retailers and two
          Company  representatives.  These  Retailer-managed teams focus on best
          practices sharing and team problem solving.

     E.   MARKET REPRESENTATION PANEL

          The Market Representation Panel, consisting of three Retailers (one of
          whom  is  from   the   Executive   Committee),   and   three   Company
          representatives (of which one is from the Executive  Committee) review
          and revise the criteria  used by the Company for awarding the Retailer
          Agreement.



                                       2
<PAGE>


     F.   MEDIATION PANEL

          The Mediation Panel is designed to help resolve certain disputes which
          may arise between a Retailer and the Company,  and is comprised of two
          Retailers, two Company  representatives,  and one member chosen by the
          Mediation Panel.

     Each of the above  committees,  teams,  and panels represent each Partner's
     belief in the mutuality principle and commitment to the future of the Volvo
     brand.

                            I. BUSINESS RELATIONSHIP

The  Partners  agree  that a  climate  of  mutual  trust,  respect,  and  shared
information is fundamental to the joint pursuit of a shared vision, which is the
foundation of this Agreement.

1.   TERM OF AGREEMENT

     This Agreement is for a five-year term,  beginning on the date it is signed
     by a Company Officer,  unless the parties mutually terminate in writing, or
     it is terminated as otherwise provided herein.

     If Retailer is not in material  breach of this  Agreement  when it expires,
     the  Company  will,  either  offer  Retailer  the then  current  Authorized
     Retailer Agreement,  or renew or extend this Agreement.  The Company agrees
     to notify Retailer in writing,  no later than one (1) year prior to the end
     of the term of this  Agreement,  in the  event  that the  Company  does not
     intend  to renew or  extend  this  Agreement,  or offer  Retailer  the then
     current Authorized Retailer Agreement.

     The  term of this  Agreement  may be  extended  only by  written  agreement
     between the parties,  signed by an Officer of the  Company.  If the parties
     continue their business  relationship  after this  Agreement  expires,  the
     relationship will be on a month-to-month basis only, and all other terms of
     this Agreement will be applicable.

2.   OWNERSHIP

     A.   Principal Owners.

     This Agreement is in the nature of a personal services contract between the
     Company and  Retailer.  The Company  enters into this  Agreement in express
     reliance on, and in consideration of, the expertise, reputation, character,
     integrity,   ability,   representations   and   professional  and  personal
     qualifications of the Principal Owner(s) listed below.

     In addition, the Company relies upon the fact that at all times during this
     Agreement's  term,  the  individuals   identified  below  will  remain  the
     Principal Owner(s) of Retailer, and that each is committed to achieving the
     goals  described in the Preamble to this  Agreement,  and  understands  and
     agrees to abide by the terms and conditions of this  Agreement:  

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                       PERCENTAGE OF
             NAME                                RESIDENTIAL ADDRESS                 OWNERSHIP INTEREST
<S>                                         <C>                                             <C>
     1. Nelson E. Bowers, II                217 Colmore Circle                              99%

     2. _____________________               Lookout Mountain, Tennessee 37350          _______________

     3. John T. Lupton                      Two Union Square

     4. _____________________               Chattanooga, Tennessee  37402              _______________
</TABLE>

     Retailer  represents  and  agrees  that the  person(s)  named as  Principal
     Owner(s)  above,  and only those  person(s),  will exercise the  ownership,
     control  and/or  management  of Retailer and that any change in  ownership,
     control or management  shall be made only in accordance  with,  and subject
     to, the terms and conditions of this Agreement.



                                       3
<PAGE>


     B.   Investors.


          The  following  person(s),  ("Investor(s)"),  also  has  an  ownership
          interest in Retailer:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                       PERCENTAGE OF
             NAME                                RESIDENTIAL ADDRESS                 OWNERSHIP INTEREST
<S>                                         <C>                                             <C>
     1. Same As Section IIA                 _______________________________________    _______________

     2. _____________________               _______________________________________    _______________

     3. _____________________               _______________________________________    _______________

     4. _____________________               _______________________________________    _______________
</TABLE>

     Retailer  represents and agrees that the person(s) named as investors above
     will not exercise control and/or management of Retailer's operations.

3.   MANAGEMENT

     The Company and Retailer agree that Retailer's success under this Agreement
     depends  upon  dedicated,  full  time,  professional,   qualified,  on-site
     management.  The  Company and  Retailer  agree that if no  Principal  Owner
     identified in Section 2A, either:  (i) maintains his or her principal place
     of  business  at the  Retailer  Facility;  or (ii) is  involved in Retailer
     Operations  on a full  time,  on-site,  day-to-day  basis,  except in those
     circumstances when Owner operates more than one Retail Facility in the same
     Area of Responsibility or Market Area, that full managerial authority shall
     be granted to the person named below (the "General Manager"), and that this
     General  Manager shall devote his or her personal  services on a full time,
     on-site,  day-to-day  basis to Retailer's  management  and  operation.  The
     Company enters into this Agreement in reliance on, and in  consideration of
     Retailer's  representation  that; (i) the General  Manager will possess the
     expertise, reputation,  character, integrity, ability, and professional and
     personal  qualifications  to  achieve  the  goals  and  objectives  of this
     Agreement;  (ii) he or she is committed to achieving the goals described in
     the Preamble to this Agreement;  and (iii) he or she understands and agrees
     to a bide by the terms and conditions of this Agreement.

     Retailer agrees that the General Manager identified in this Section 3 shall
     have an ownership interest in Retailer of at least twenty percent (20%).

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                       PERCENTAGE OF
             NAME                                RESIDENTIAL ADDRESS                 OWNERSHIP INTEREST
<S>                                         <C>                                             <C>

- ---------------------------------      --------------------------------------        ------------------

</TABLE>

4.   CHANGES IN OWNERSHIP OR MANAGEMENT

     Because this  Agreement is in the nature of a personal  services  contract,
     and the Company  has entered  into this  Agreement  in reliance  on, and in
     consideration of, the expertise, reputation, character, integrity, ability,
     representations  and  professional  and  personal   qualifications  of  the
     Principal Owners,  Investors and the General Manager identified in Sections
     2 and 3 above,  if Retailer  desires to make any change in: (i)  Retailer's
     ownership,  including,  but not limited to, any attempt to conduct a public
     offering  of  any  of  Retailer's  shares,  regardless  of  the  number  or
     percentage  of shares;  or (ii) the  relative  shares  among the  Principal
     Owners or other  investors  referenced in 2B, Retailer agrees to obtain the
     Company's written approval,  which shall not be unreasonably  withheld. The
     Company  recognizes  that  Retailer  may wish to make a public  offering of
     Retailer's  shares,  and that such a proposed offering of Retailer's shares
     shall not  constitute  the sole grounds upon which  Company may  reasonably
     withhold approval under this Section.

     Retailer  agrees that the  Company's  knowledge  of any change in ownership
     interest or  management  of Retailer  will not be a waiver of the Company's
     rights and/or Retailer's  obligations under this Section unless the Company
     has approved the change in writing.



                                       4
<PAGE>


5.   LOCATION

     In  consideration  of the Company  entering into this  Agreement,  Retailer
     agrees to at all times  establish  and  maintain  Retailer  Facilities  and
     Operations  in  accordance  with Company  Policies,  at only the  following
     location(s):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                  Location 1                            Location 2                       Location 3
<S>                          <C>                                  <C>                               <C>                       
A. New Car Sales             5949 Brainerd Road                   ______________________            ______________________    
   & Showroom                Chattanooga, Tennessee 37421         ______________________            ______________________
                             ______________________               ______________________            ______________________ 
                                                                      
                                                                      
                                                                      
                                                                      
B. Service,                  5949 Brainerd Road                   ______________________            ______________________
   Parts &                   Chattanooga, Tennessee 37421         ______________________            ______________________
   Accessories               ______________________               ______________________            ______________________     
                                                                  
                                                                  
                                                                  
                                                                  
C. Volvo Select              5949 Brainerd Road                   ______________________            ______________________
   Pre Owned Vehicles        Chattanooga, Tennessee 37421         ______________________            ______________________
   Display                   ______________________               ______________________            ______________________ 
                                                                  
                                                                  
                                                                  
                                                                  
D. Administrative Support    5949 Brainerd Road                   ______________________            ______________________
   Activities                Chattanooga, Tennessee 37421         ______________________            ______________________
                             ______________________               ______________________            ______________________ 
</TABLE>

6.   FACILITIES

     Retailer and the Company agree that  appropriate  Retailer  Facilities  are
     necessary to achieve the goals  described in the Preamble to this Agreement
     and to  provide  Volvo  Customers  with a  superior  ownership  experience.
     Retailer agrees to operate its Retailer  Facilities in accordance with this
     Agreement  and the then  current  Retailer  Facilities  Guide.  If Retailer
     operates  multiple  sales  and/or  service  facilities,  the  terms of this
     Agreement will apply to all Retailer Facilities.

     A.   Location.

          Retailer  will  provide  Retailer  Facilities  that:  (i) will  enable
          Retailer to perform its  responsibilities  under this Agreement;  (ii)
          are satisfactory in space, appearance, layout, equipment, and signage;
          and (ii) are in accordance with the then current  Retailer  Facilities
          Guide.  Retailer  will conduct its Retailer  Operations  only from the
          location(s) identified in Section 5.

     B.   Changes and Additions.

          Retailer will not move, relocate, or substantially change the usage of
          Retailer Facilities, nor will Retailer,  Principal Owner, Investor, or
          General Manager directly or indirectly  establish or operate any other
          locations or facilities for any of the Retailer Operations (or similar
          operations) contemplated by this Agreement without the Company's prior
          written  consent,  which will not be unreasonably  withheld.  Retailer
          agrees that all new Retailer Facilities shall conform to architecture,
          design and style  described  in the then current  Retailer  Facilities
          Guide.



                                       5
<PAGE>



          The Company and Retailer agree that any changes in Retailer Facilities
          will be reflected in a written  addendum to this  Agreement.  Retailer
          will promptly  correct any  deficiencies in Retailer's  performance of
          its responsibilities under this Section 6.

          Retailer  acknowledges  that the addition and  maintenance  of another
          line  of  vehicles   or  another   automobile   dealership   operating
          simultaneously  with its Retailer  Operations  at Retailer  Facilities
          could adversely affect  Retailer's sales and service  performance with
          respect  to Company  Products.  Accordingly,  Retailer  agrees to: (i)
          notify the Company in writing within ten (10) days of its execution of
          an  agreement  or letter of intent to add a new line of vehicles to be
          sold or serviced at Retailer Facilities; and (ii) obtain the Company's
          written approval which will not be unreasonably withheld.

     C.   Development of Market Studies.

          The  Company  may,  from  time to time,  conduct  studies  of  various
          geographic areas to evaluate market  conditions.  These market studies
          may,  where  appropriate,   evaluate  factors  including  geographical
          characteristics,  consumer shopping patterns, existence of competitive
          automobile  dealerships,  sales opportunities and service requirements
          of the geographic area in which Retailer's Area of  Responsibility  or
          Market Area is located,  trends in marketing  conditions,  current and
          prospective  trends  in  population,  income,  occupation,  and  other
          demographic  characteristics  which the  Company may  determine  to be
          relevant.   Based   upon  such   studies,   the   Company   will  make
          recommendations  concerning  the market and Retailer  Facilities.  The
          Company will give Retailer  prior notice of its intention to conduct a
          study which includes the geographic  area in which  Retailer's Area of
          Responsibility  or Market Area is  located.  Within 30 days of notice,
          Retailer  should  provide the Company  with all  information  Retailer
          believes relevant to the market study.

     D.   Evaluation of Retailer Facilities and Location.

          The Company will periodically  evaluate Retailer's  performance of its
          responsibilities  under  this  Section 6. In making  evaluations,  the
          Company  will  consider:  (i) the land  and  building  space  Retailer
          actually  dedicates to its performance under this Agreement;  (ii) the
          then  current  Retailer   Facilities  Guide;   (iii)  the  appearance,
          condition  and  layout of  Retailer  Facilities;  (iv) the  ability of
          Retailer  Facilities  to satisfy the sales  opportunities  and service
          requirements  of the Area of  Responsibility  or Market Area;  and (v)
          other factors that may directly  relate to Retailer's  performance  of
          its  responsibilities  under  this  Agreement.   Evaluations  prepared
          pursuant  to this  Section 6 will be  discussed  with and  provided to
          Retailer,  and Retailer may comment in writing within thirty (30) days
          of its receipt of an evaluation.

7.   CAPITALIZATION OF RETAILER

     Retailer  agrees  that its  ability to market,  promote,  sell and  service
     Company  Vehicles and provide  Volvo  customers  with a superior  ownership
     experience is dependent in part upon Retailer maintaining  adequate working
     capital to meet its  obligations  under its Business Plan. The Company will
     provide  Retailer  with a  Working  Capital  Guide to  assist  Retailer  in
     determining  its working  capital  requirements.  Retailer  agrees that the
     Company  may,  upon prior  written  notice,  reasonably  modify the Working
     Capital Guide.

8.   DISPOSITION OF BUSINESS BY RETAILER

     Retailer and the Company  agree that to achieve the goals  described in the
     Preamble to this  Agreement,  each  Authorized  Retailer shall be owned and
     operated by parties committed to achieving these same goals.

     Retailer agrees that this Agreement is in the nature of a personal services
     contract.  While the Company  acknowledges  that  Retailer has the right to
     sell or  otherwise  transfer  the stock  and/or  assets of the  dealership,
     Retailer acknowledges and agrees that this right is subject to this Section
     8.



                                       6
<PAGE>


     A.   General.

          The Company  recognizes  Retailer's  opportunity to sell or other wise
          dispose of all or substantially  all of Retailer's  assets  (including
          goodwill) related to Retailer's  obligations or performance under this
          Agreement at any time and on such terms and conditions as Retailer may
          decide to accept. Any transfer or sale of any stock of Retailer,  or a
          transfer  and/or  sale of a majority  of the assets of Retailer to any
          person or entity will be subject to the prior written  approval of the
          Company.  Retailer  agrees to provide the Company  with all  documents
          reasonably  necessary for the Company's  evaluation of any transfer of
          Retailer's stock or assets.  Retailer also agrees that the time period
          for the  Company's  review and  evaluation of any transfer of stock or
          assets  shall  not  begin  until  all  necessary  documents  have been
          submitted to the Company.  Subject to the Company's  rights in Section
          8B below, the Company will not unreasonably  withhold consent to enter
          into a new agreement with a buyer on terms  substantially  the same as
          the  provisions  of this  Agreement,  or the then  current  Authorized
          Retailer Agreement. Retailer agrees that if, in the Company's business
          judgment, a sale may adversely affect the Company's ability to achieve
          its goals described in the Preamble to this Agreement,  or the ability
          of the  proposed  retailer  to meet  the  obligations  under  the then
          current  Authorized  Retailer  Agreement,  the Company may  reasonably
          withhold approval.

     B.   Right of First Refusal.

          (i)  Request to Transfer.

               If Retailer  submits a written  request to transfer  stock and/or
               assets in Retailer as  described  in this  Section 8, the Company
               shall  have the right of first  refusal  or  option  to  purchase
               Retailer's stock and/or assets.  The Company must notify Retailer
               of its election to exercise  such right  within  thirty (30) days
               after receiving  Retailer's  complete  written  proposal.  If the
               Company  exercises  its  right  of  first  refusal,   this  shall
               supersede  any other right that  Retailer may have to transfer or
               otherwise dispose of its stock or assets.  The Company may assign
               its right or option to a third party.

          (ii) Bona Fide Agreement.

               If Retailer  enters into a bona fide  written  agreement  for the
               sale of its stock and/or assets,  the Company's  right under this
               Section 8 shall be a right of first refusal, enabling the Company
               to assume the buyer's rights and obligations under such agreement
               and cancel this Agreement and all rights granted  Retailer.  Upon
               the Company's  request,  Retailer agrees to provide all documents
               relating to the proposed transfer, including, without limitation,
               those reflecting any other agreements or  understandings  between
               the parties to the transfer agreement.

         (iii) Non Bona Fide Agreement.

               If Retailer fails to provide documentation as required in Section
               8B(ii), or states in writing that the requested  documents do not
               exist, the Company will  conclusively  presume that the agreement
               is not bona fide. If the Company determines that the agreement is
               not bona  fide,  the  Company  will have the  option to  purchase
               Retailer's stock and/or assets utilized in Retailer's Operations.
               The Company may also, but shall not be required to,  purchase any
               of  Retailer's  real  property or leasehold  interest  related to
               Retailer's Facilities.

          (iv) Purchase Price.

               If  Retailer  enters  into a bona  fide  written  agreement,  the
               Company  and  Retailer  agree that the  purchase  price and other
               terms of sale  under  the  right of first  refusal  will be those
               described in such  agreement  and any related  documents,  unless
               Retailer and the Company agree to other terms.  In the absence of
               a bona fide written  agreement,  the purchase price of Retailer's
               stock  and/or  assets,  excluding  new and  undamaged  parts  and
               accessories,  and other  essential  terms,  will be determined by
               good faith  negotiation  between  the  parties.  If an  agreement
               cannot be reached,  the  purchase  price and any other  essential
               terms  not  agreed  upon  will  be  determined   through  binding
               arbitration conducted by the American Arbitration Association.



                                       7
<PAGE>



               Each party agrees to pay its own attorneys'  fees associated with
               this arbitration. If the sale involves the sale of real property,
               Retailer  agrees to transfer the real property by warranty  deed,
               in recordable form,  conveying marketable title free and clear to
               the  Company.  If  the  sale  involves  the  sale,  transfer,  or
               assignment  of a  leasehold  interest,  Retailer  agrees to sell,
               transfer,   or  assign  such  interest  in  a  method   typically
               undertaken in similar commercial transactions.

          (v)  Assignments.

               If the Company  elects to exercise  its rights under this Section
               8, Retailer shall transfer or assign to the Company all licenses,
               authorizations,  permits,  and other documents typically required
               in similar  commercial  transactions,  and shall  grant all other
               necessary  approvals to conduct  Retailer  Operations in a manner
               similar to that immediately prior to the sale.

          (vi) Successors and Assigns.

               The Company's rights under this Agreement shall be binding on and
               enforceable  against  any  assignee or  successor  in interest of
               Retailer or any  purchaser of  Retailer's  stock  and/or  assets,
               unless the Company has  previously  approved the successor  under
               Section 9A.

     C.   Outstanding Obligations.

          Retailer  agrees  that all  outstanding  monetary  obligations  to the
          Company shall be paid prior to, or at the time of, transfer.

9.   SUCCESSION OF OWNERSHIP OR MANAGEMENT

     A.   Successor Addendum.

          Retailer  may  apply for a  successor  addendum  designating  proposed
          principal  owners  and/or  owners  of  a  successor   retailer  to  be
          established  if  this  Agreement  expires  because  of  the  Principal
          Owner(s)  death or  incapacity.  The Company may execute the successor
          addendum  if  the  proposed  successor  completes,  to  the  Company's
          satisfaction,   the  then  current  selection  process  to  become  an
          Authorized Retailer used by the Company.

     B.   Rights of Heirs.

          If  a  Principal  Owner(s)  or  General  Manager  (with  an  ownership
          interest) dies and his or her interest in Retailer's Operations passes
          directly to any heir who wishes to succeed to such  party's  interest,
          the Principal Owner's or General Manager's legal  representative  must
          notify the Company  within thirty (30) day's of the Principal  Owner's
          or General  Manager's death of such heir's or heirs' intent to succeed
          the Principal  Owner's or General Manager's  interest.  If a Principal
          Owner(s) or General Manager becomes incapacitated,  then the Principal
          Owner's or General  Manager's  legal  representative  must  notify the
          Company  within  thirty  (30)  days  of  the   determination  of  such
          incapacity  and  provide  the  Company  with  plans,  if  any,  for  a
          successor. The effect of notice of death or incapacity from either the
          Principal Owner's or General Manager's legal representative will be to
          suspend any notice of termination provided for in Section 10A (iv).

     C.   Rights of Remaining Owners and Investors.

          If this Agreement  would  otherwise  terminate  because of a Principal
          Owner's  death or  incapacity,  and  Retailer and the Company have not
          executed a  successor  addendum,  the  remaining  Principal  Owners or
          Investors,  if any, may propose a successor to continue the operations
          identified in this Agreement.  The proposal must be made in writing to
          the Company at least thirty (30) days prior to the termination of this
          Agreement.

          The  proposal  will be accepted if: (i) it meets the  requirements  of
          Section  2 with  regard  to  ownership;  (ii) the  proposed  successor
          successfully  completes the  Authorized  Retailer  selection  process;
          (iii) any proposed owner(s) satisfies applicable  Authorized  Retailer
          selection criteria; iv) the proposed successor retailer and/or the


                                       8
<PAGE>


          proposed  general  manager are ready,  willing and able to comply with
          the requirements of the then current  Authorized  Retailer  Agreement,
          and agree to implement  the Business  Plan;  and (v) all of the former
          Retailer's  outstanding  monetary obligations to the Company have been
          satisfied.

     D.   Limitation on Offers.

          The Company  will notify the  individual  or entity  making a proposal
          under  Sections  9A, B, or C in writing of the  decision on a proposal
          under this Section 9 within  sixty (60) day's after:  (i) Retailer has
          submitted all applications and information that the Company reasonably
          requested,  and (ii) the proposed retailer has successfully  completed
          the selection process to become an Authorized Retailer.  The Company's
          offer to enter into the then  current  authorized  Retailer  agreement
          under this Section 9 will automatically  expire if not accepted by the
          proposed  successor  retailer within sixty (60) days after it receives
          the offer.

     E.   New Successor Addendum.

          Retailer may cancel an executed  successor  addendum in writing at any
          time  prior to the  death or  incapacity  of a  Principal  Owner.  The
          Company may cancel an executed successor addendum only if the proposed
          Principal Owner(s) no longer meets the selection criteria to become an
          Authorized Retailer.  The parties may execute a superseding  successor
          addendum by agreement.

10.  TERMINATION.

     A.   Immediate Termination.

          This   Agreement   will  continue  in  force,   and  will  govern  all
          transactions  between the Company and  Retailer  until  terminated  in
          accordance  with this Section 10. Any  termination  of this  Agreement
          shall apply to all Retailer  Facilities.  The Company and Retailer may
          also terminate this Agreement by mutual written agreement at any time.

          Retailer may  terminate  this  Agreement at any time,  with or without
          reason,  by giving the Company sixty (60) days prior  written  notice.
          The  Company may  terminate  this  Agreement  upon  written  notice to
          Retailer  if  the  distribution  agreement  between  the  Company  and
          Manufacturer is terminated.

          Retailer and the Company  agree that certain  conduct  which is within
          Retailer's  control is so contrary to achieving the goals described in
          the  Preamble  to  this  Agreement,  and to the  spirit,  purpose  and
          objectives of this Agreement,  that any of the following  conduct will
          constitute  a  material  breach  of this  Agreement  and  justify  its
          immediate termination, upon written notice:

               (i) Change in the control, ownership or management of Retailer as
               described  in  Section  4 of this  Agreement  including,  without
               limitation,   an  attempted   public  offering  of  ownership  in
               Retailer, without the Company's prior written approval; or

               (ii) Sale, transfer, or assignment by Retailer of this Agreement,
               or any of the rights granted to it under this  Agreement,  or any
               transfer,  assignment  or  delegation  by  Retailer of any of the
               responsibilities  assigned  to a Retailer  under this  Agreement,
               without the Company's prior written approval; or

               (iii)  Sale,  transfer  or  assignment  by Retailer of any of the
               stock or substantially  all of the assets used by Retailer in its
               Volvo  operations,  without the Company's prior written approval;
               or

               (iv)  Subject  to the  provisions  in  Section 9, death or mental
               incapacity  of Retailer  (if  Retailer is an  individual)  or any
               person identified in Section 2 of this Agreement; or

               (v) Misrepresentation by Retailer concerning Retailer's ownership
               or  management,   or  any  material   misrepresentation   in  the
               application for this Agreement, or at any time thereafter; or



                                       9
<PAGE>



               (vi)  Undertaking  by  Retailer  or any of its  owners to conduct
               either  directly or indirectly,  any of Retailer's  Operations at
               locations other than those designated in this Agreement,  without
               the Company's prior written approval; or

               (vii) Willful misrepresentation by Retailer, or any of its agents
               or employees,  in any claim or application for  reimbursement by,
               or  payment  from the  Company,  including,  without  limitation,
               warranty claims,  goodwill payments,  incentives,  work performed
               pursuant to a recall,  pre-delivery inspection,  or for any other
               refund, credit, incentive, allowance, discount,  reimbursement or
               payment applied for or received under any Company program; or

               (viii) Knowing acceptance by Retailer of any payment for any work
               not  performed or contracted  for by Retailer in accordance  with
               this  Agreement,  or any  applicable  warranty  or other  Company
               Policies,  service  bulletin,  procedures or programs the Company
               may issue; or

               (ix) Filing by Retailer of a voluntary petition in bankruptcy, or
               the  filing of a petition  to have  Retailer  declared  bankrupt,
               providing the petition is not vacated within thirty (30) days; or
               any   adjudication  of  Retailer  as  bankrupt   pursuant  to  an
               involuntary  petition;  or  any  appointment  by  a  court  of  a
               temporary  or  permanent  receiver,  trustee,  or  custodian  for
               Retailer,  Retailer's assets or Retailer's business who shall not
               be  discharged  within  thirty  (30) days;  or  execution  of any
               assignment  for  the  benefit  of  creditors  provided  that  the
               assignment  is not set aside  within  thirty  (30)  days;  or any
               material levy under attachment, or by any process of law by which
               a third party acquires rights in or to the ownership or operation
               of any Retailer  Facility  provided  that the levy is not vacated
               within  thirty  (30)  day's;  or if  Retailer  is  unable to meet
               maturing  debts  on  terms  agreeable  to its  creditors;  or any
               dissolution of Retailer; or

               (x) Use by  Retailer  of any  unfair,  misleading,  deceptive  or
               fraudulent  advertising  or business  practice in the  marketing,
               sale  or  servicing  of any  Company  Product  or in any  program
               offered by Company; or

               (xi) Conviction of or entry of a judgment in a court of competent
               jurisdiction against a Retailer or any person named in Sections 2
               or 3,  of a  felony,  or any  unfair,  misleading,  deceptive  or
               fraudulent business practice; or

               (xii) Failure of Retailer to conduct its sales, service and parts
               operations  during the customary  business  hours of the trade in
               Retailer's  Area of  Responsibility  or Market  Area for five (5)
               consecutive  business  days,  unless  any  failure  is  caused by
               contingencies  beyond Retailer's  reasonable  control,  including
               strikes, civil war, riots, fires, floods,  earthquakes,  or other
               acts of God,  provided  that  Retailer  immediately  resumes  its
               customary  operation  after the cause of the closure or cessation
               of operation is removed; or

               (xiii)  Refusal  or  inability  by  Retailer  to pay  any  amount
               Retailer  owes to the Company  within  thirty (30) days after the
               Company  demands  payment  from  Retailer;  or 

               (xiv)  Failure  by  Retailer  to comply  with  Section 35 of this
               Agreement; or a 

               (xv)  Agreement,   combination,   understanding  or  contract  by
               Retailer,  whether oral or written,  with any other  corporation,
               person,  firm or other legal entity for the purpose of unlawfully
               fixing  prices of Company  Products,  or otherwise  violating any
               law; or

               (xvi)  Failure by Retailer to procure and maintain any license or
               other governmental  authorization necessary to operate as a Volvo
               Retailer; or

               (xvii)  Importation,  distribution  or sale of  Company  Products
               which are not originally  manufactured,  designed or intended for
               use in the United  States,  without the  Company's  prior written
               approval.



                                       10
<PAGE>


     B.   Sixty Day Cure Period Prior to Termination.

          The Company may also terminate this Agreement upon no less than thirty
          (30) days prior written  notice if Retailer fails to cure within sixty
          (60) days, to the Company's satisfaction,  any other material default
          in its  performance  under this  Agreement.  These  material  defaults
          include, without limitation, the following:

               (i) Any dispute,  disagreement,  or controversy  between or among
               persons  identified in Section 2 of this Agreement  which, in the
               Company's  reasonable  opinion,  adversely affects the ownership,
               operation, management, or business of Retailer or Company; or

               (ii)  Retention  by Retailer of any General  Manager,  who in the
               Company's  reasonable  opinion  is not  competent,  or no  longer
               possesses the requisite  qualifications for the position,  or who
               has acted in a manner contrary to the continued best interests of
               the Company or Retailer; or

               (iii)  Any  material   modification  or  change  in  the  use  of
               Retailer's  Facilities,   including,   without  limitation,   the
               addition or maintenance of another line of vehicles at Retailer's
               Facilities without the Company's prior written approval; or

               (iv)  Failure  by  Retailer  to  improve,  alter,  or modify  its
               Retailer  Facility  to  meet  the  requirements  in  the  Company
               Facilities Guide or other Company Policies, or which Retailer had
               agreed or  represented to the Company that Retailer would make or
               do; or

               (v)  Failure by Retailer  to  maintain  and employ in  Retailer's
               business  and  operations  under this  Agreement  sufficient  net
               working  capital  and net worth to  enable  Retailer  to  satisfy
               Retailer's responsibility under this Agreement; or

               (vi)  Failure  by  Retailer  to  update  its  Business   Plan  in
               accordance with Section 13; or

               (vii) Failure by Retailer to maintain  adequate flooring lines of
               credit for Company Vehicles; or

               (viii)  Failure by  Retailer  to  maintain  an  inventory  of new
               Company  Vehicles  of the  latest  model in  accordance  with the
               objectives agreed to by Retailer and the Company; or

               (ix)  Failure by  Retailer  to keep  available  at all times,  in
               excellent condition for demonstration  purposes, a representative
               number  and mix of the  latest  models  equipped  with the latest
               accessories offered by the Company; or

               (x)  Failure by  Retailer  to, at all times,  keep in  Retailer's
               Facilities),  an inventory of Genuine Volvo Parts and Accessories
               in  quantities  that  the  Company   reasonably   determines  are
               necessary to meet the current and reasonably  anticipated service
               requirements of Volvo Customers; or

               (xi) Failure by Retailer to keep records of its business relating
               to Company Products,  or any failure,  after reasonable notice to
               Retailer,  to submit Retailer's  accounts and records relating to
               the sale and servicing of Company Products,  or allow the Company
               to inspect its accounts and records; or

               (xii)  Failure  by  Retailer  to  furnish  the  Company,   within
               reasonable  time limits  specified by the  Company,  and on forms
               prescribed  by  or  acceptable  to  the  Company,  statements  of
               Retailer's financial condition and operating results; or

               (xiii)  Failure by  Retailer to furnish the Company on such forms
               and at such times as the Company may reasonably require,  reports
               of Retailer's  sales and  inventory of Company  Products and used
               automobiles; or

               (xiv)  Failure  by  Retailer  to  maintain  warranty  records  in
               accordance with the Company Policies; or

               (xv)  Negligent or willful  conduct by Retailer  that the Company
               determines,  in a reasonable  exercise of its  discretion,  to be
               harmful to the reputation of the Company,  Company  Products,  or
               Marks/Trademarks.



                                       11
<PAGE>



     C.   Failure to Meet Improvement Plan Objectives.

          If Retailer fails to cure  deficiencies  identified in the improvement
          plans  within the  periods  described  in Section  14, the Company may
          terminate  this  Agreement upon thirty (30) day's prior written notice
          to Retailer.

          If Retailer refuses to enter into the applicable improvement plan, the
          Company may terminate this Agreement in accordance with Section 10A.

     D.   Applicable Notice Provision for Termination.

          Retailer and the Company  acknowledge  that under  certain state laws,
          the time period required for notice of termination may vary from those
          described  herein.  Retailer and the Company agree that  statutory and
          regulatory  time  provisions,  when greater than those provided above,
          shall control as applicable.

     E.   Failure to Terminate Shall Not Constitute a Waiver.

          The  Company  may  terminate  this  Agreement   under  any  applicable
          provision which it elects,  notwithstanding the existence of any other
          grounds for termination, or the failure to refer to such other grounds
          for termination. The Company's failure to specify additional ground(s)
          for  termination  in its notice  shall not  preclude  the Company from
          later establishing, upon notice, that termination is also supported by
          such  additional  grounds,  without  regard to when  those  additional
          grounds were discovered.

     F.   Procedure on Termination.

          Termination  of this  Agreement  shall  end  Retailer's  status  as an
          Authorized  Retailer,  but shall not  affect any  liability  of either
          party to the  other  accruing  prior to the  date of  termination,  or
          arising out of Agreement.

          Upon termination  Retailer agrees to immediately:  (i) discontinue the
          use of any  trademarks  or trade  names made up in whole or in part of
          any trademark or tradename  belonging to the Company or  Manufacturer;
          (ii) remove all signs  containing any such  trademarks or trade names;
          and (iii) render unfit for the use originally  intended (or to certify
          to the Company that Retailer  will not use for the purpose  originally
          intended) any stationery,  printed matter,  or advertising  containing
          any such  trademarks  or trade names.  In addition,  Retailer will not
          represent or continue any practices which might make it appear that it
          is still an authorized Volvo retailer and will permanently discontinue
          any use of the word Volvo in Retailer's  corporate title, firm name or
          tradename and will  immediately take such steps as may be necessary or
          appropriate  in the opinion of the  Company to change  such  corporate
          title, firm name or tradename to eliminate the word Volvo, all without
          cost or expense to the Company.

          Upon  termination  under Section 10A, all unfilled  orders for Company
          Products will be deemed canceled.  Upon termination under Section 10B,
          the Company  will have the option to  complete or cancel all  unfilled
          orders for Company Products then pending and will have a similar right
          to complete or cancel any firm  orders  given after  notice and before
          termination.

          Upon  termination  of this  Agreement,  Retailer shall transfer to the
          Company:  (i) all orders for sale by Retailer of Company Products then
          pending with Retailer and all deposits  obtained whether in cash or in
          kind; (ii) all of Retailer's  warranty files regarding warranty claims
          on Company  Products;  (iii) all lists,  files and service  records of
          Volvo  Customers;  and  (iv)  all  technical  or  service  literature,
          advertising and other printed material  relating to Company  Products,
          including,  without  limitation,  sales instruction  manuals,  service
          manuals, and promotional materials. All warranty claims must be closed
          within thirty (30) days of such termination.

          After termination,  the Company's  acceptance of orders from Retailer,
          Retailer's  continuance of sale of Company Products,  or the Company's
          referral of  inquiries to Retailer or any  business  relations  either
          party has with the other will not be construed  either as a renewal of
          this Agreement or a waiver of the termination.  If the Company accepts
          any orders from Retailer after termination, all such transactions will
          be  governed  by the  terms  of  this  Agreement  applicable  to  such
          transactions, unless otherwise agreed in writing.



                                       12
<PAGE>



11.  DISPUTE RESOLUTION


     Retailer and the Company  recognize that certain disputes may arise between
     them as to application and  interpretation  of this Agreement,  the Company
     Policies, and the other controlling documents referenced in this Agreement.
     While  understanding that certain federal and state courts and agencies may
     be available to resolve any  disputes,  Retailer and the Company agree that
     it is in their mutual best  interests,  consistent with achieving the goals
     described  in the  Preamble  to this  Agreement,  and in the spirit of this
     Agreement, to attempt to resolve first through mediation,  described below,
     all disputes  arising from a notice of  termination as described in Section
     10. Each party agrees to pay its own  attorney's  fees,  costs and expenses
     associated with such mediation.

     A.   Non-Binding Mediation.

          Prior to  initiating  any  judicial,  agency  or other  administrative
          proceeding,  the  Company  and  Retailer  agree to mediate any dispute
          arising  from a notice of  termination  as  described  in Section  10.
          Mediation  shall be held at the  Company  regional  office  closest to
          Retailer, or at another mutually agreed upon location, and shall begin
          within  ten (10) days  after  receipt of  notice:  (i)  invoking  this
          Section 11; and (ii)  clearly  specifying  the nature of the  dispute.
          Mediation  shall not be binding  unless  first agreed to in writing by
          Retailer and the Company. Any mediation under this Section 11 shall be
          conducted  before a  Company/Retailer  Mediation Panel (the "Mediation
          Panel")  chosen by the  Company  and  Retailer  at least five (5) days
          before such mediation is scheduled to begin,  and shall be governed by
          the Company's Mediation Guidelines.

     B.   Mediation Panel.

          The  Mediation  Panel shall consist of: (i) two members of the Company
          management,  including one from Retailer's  region;  (ii) two Retailer
          Mediators, one of which shall be from Retailer's Region, but not by an
          Authorized  Retailer which has an Area of  Responsibility  in a Market
          Area  contiguous  to or in  competition  with  Retailer;  and (ii) one
          member chosen by the members identified in (i) and (ii). Within twenty
          (20) days of hearing the dispute, the Mediation Panel shall recommend,
          in writing, a solution to Retailer and the Company.  The parties agree
          that a majority vote of the Mediation  Panel shall be deemed to be the
          final decision of the Mediation Panel.  Each party shall have five (5)
          days to  accept or  reject  the  Mediation  Panel's  solution,  in its
          entirety.

     C.   No Waiver of Rights During Mediation.

          The  Company and  Retailer  agree that  neither  party shall waive any
          rights it may have under any federal or state law during the  pendency
          of any mediation under this Section 11.

     D.   Tolling.

          Each party agrees that  mediation  under this Section 11 will toll any
          applicable  statute of  limitations  during the mediation and solution
          review  periods  referenced  above.  If Retailer is required under any
          applicable state law to file a letter of protest before the completion
          of any mediation  contemplated  hereby,  nothing herein shall prohibit
          Retailer  from filing such  protest;  however,  Retailer must continue
          with the mediation procedures described in this Section 11.

     E.   Cost of Enforcement.

          If the parties are unable to resolve  disputes  under this Section 11,
          and a party  elects to initiate  administrative  proceedings  or civil
          litigation arising from such disputes,  the prevailing party shall, in
          addition to all other available  remedies,  be entitled to recover all
          of its  reasonable  attorneys'  fees,  court  costs  and  expenses  of
          litigation.



                                       13
<PAGE>


                     II. VOLVO CUSTOMER OWNERSHIP EXPERIENCE

The  Partners  agree that the  highest  priority  for  Retailer  and  Company is
providing a superior  ownership  experience  for Volvo  Customers.  This will be
achieved by providing unique customer value, and by treating Volvo Customers and
prospective Volvo customers with honesty and integrity.

12.  RETAILER BUSINESS PLAN

     Before entering into this Agreement, Retailer has provided the Company with
     a Business  Plan,  signed by all  Principal  Owners listed in Section 2A of
     this  Agreement,  and the  General  Manager  listed  in  Section  3 of this
     Agreement.  The Business Plan  addresses all areas of Retailer's  business,
     including, without limitation:

          o    Retailer's strategy for providing a superior ownership experience
               for Volvo Customers;

          o    Retailer's   strategy   for   developing   Retailer's   Area   of
               Responsibility or Market Area;

          o    A detailed  description  of Retailer's  sales  objectives and its
               method of achieving its objectives;

          o    A detailed  description of Retailer's  service objectives and its
               method of achieving its objectives;

          o    A detailed description of Retailer's Facilities;

          o    A complete  statement  of  Retailer's  ownership  and  management
               structure;

          o    A complete statement of Retailer's financial structure, including
               capitalization and lines of credit;

          o    Retailer's strategy for staffing and personnel development;

          o    Retailer's strategy for advertising, merchandising, and community
               relations; and

          o    Retailer's  strategy for other items as agreed to by Retailer and
               the Company.

     Retailer  further  agrees to develop its Area of  Responsibility  or Market
     Area  according to its Business  Plan,  and to fulfill its  commitments  as
     described in the Business Plan.

13.  REVIEW AND UPDATE OF BUSINESS PLAN

     Retailer's  performance  under this Agreement is essential to the effective
     representation of the Company in the marketing, promotion, sale and service
     of  Company  Products  and the  reputation  and  goodwill  of  other  Volvo
     retailers.  Retailer agrees to update and submit its written  Business Plan
     to the Company at least  annually,  or more often if the Company  requests.
     All Business  Plan  updates  shall  include  Retailer's  evaluation  of its
     performance  for the previous year, and any proposed  modifications  to the
     Business Plan.

     Retailer  and the  Company  agree  that  Retailer's  performance  shall  be
     evaluated  based on criteria  agreed to in Retailer's  Business Plan, or as
     updated. If Retailer and the Company agree that the changes to the proposed
     Business  Plan, or update are  necessary.  Retailer will make all necessary
     modifications, and resubmit the Business Plan, or update, for the Company's
     review and approval.  While  Retailer's  Business Plan is subject to update
     and  review,  the  Company  will  require  Retailer  to  modify  Retailer's
     Facilities only if the Company can show that a material change in marketing
     conditions warrants modification in Retailer's Facilities,

14.  VEHICLE SALES OR SERVICE IMPROVEMENT PLAN

     If the Company  determines  that  Retailer  has failed to meet any material
     provision of its Business  Plan,  or as updated,  Retailer  agrees to enter
     into a written  improvement  plan to cure any performance  deficiency.  The
     Company  agrees that:  (i)  Retailer  will have a minimum of six (6) months
     from execution of an improvement  plan to cure any performance  deficiency;
     and (ii) the Company will provide reasonable  assistance as the Company and
     Retailer agree upon in advance and in writing.


                                       14
<PAGE>


15.  PRODUCT AVAILABILITY

     The  Company  agrees to provide and  allocate  Company  Products  among its
     Retailers on a fair and equitable basis.

     Retailer  agrees  that,  because  Company  Products may not be available in
     sufficient  quantities  from time to time, the Company,  in the exercise of
     its reasonable  business  judgment,  may determine the manner and method of
     allocation  among the  Company's  Retailers  without any  liability  to the
     Company.

16.  PURCHASE AND DELIVERY

     A.   Retailer Purchases.

          (i)  Company Vehicles.

               From time to time the Company will advise  Retailer of the number
               and  model  lines  of  Company  Vehicle  which  the  Company  has
               available  for sale to  Retailer  and,  subject  to  Section  15,
               Retailer will have the right to purchase  such Company  Vehicles.
               The  Company  will  distribute  Company  Vehicles  to  Authorized
               Retailers in accordance with the Company's  written  distribution
               policies  and  procedures  in effect  from  time to time,  and in
               accordance with this Section 16.

          (ii) Genuine Volvo Parts and Accessories.

               Retailer  will submit  firm  orders for  Genuine  Volvo Parts and
               Accessories  to the  Company  in such  quantity  and  variety  to
               fulfill  Retailer's  obligations  under this Agreement.  Retailer
               will submit all orders in accordance with Company  Policies.  The
               Company  may  accept  orders in whole or in part, and all  orders
               shall be  effective  only upon  acceptance  by the  Company  (but
               without  necessity of any notice of  acceptance by the Company to
               Retailer).  Orders for Genuine Volvo Parts and Accessories  shall
               not be cancelable by Retailer  after  acceptance  and shipment by
               the Company, except as otherwise provided in this Agreement.

         (iii) Other Products and Services.

               Retailer may submit firm orders to the Company for other products
               and services the Company may offer for sale to Retailer from time
               to  time in such  quantity  and  variety  to  fulfill  Retailer's
               obligations under this Agreement. Retailer will submit all orders
               in  accordance  with Company  procedures.  The Company may accept
               orders in whole or in part,  and all  orders  shall be  effective
               only upon acceptance by the Company (but without necessity of any
               notice of  acceptance  by the  Company to  Retailer).  Orders for
               other  products and services  shall not be cancelable by Retailer
               after acceptance and shipment by the Company, except as otherwise
               set forth in this Agreement.

          (iv) Changes in Company Products.

               The Company may discontinue  the supply,  or change the design of
               component materials, of Company Products at any time. The Company
               will be under no  liability  to Retailer for any changes and will
               not be required,  as a result of any changes, to make any changes
               to Company Products previously  purchased by Retailer.  No change
               shall be  considered  a model year change  unless so specified by
               the Company.

     B.   Delays in Delivery.

          The  Company  will not be liable for  failure or delay in  delivery to
          Retailer  of Company  Products  if the  failure or delay is beyond the
          control, or without the fault or negligence of, the Company.

     C.   Passage of Title.

          Title to each Company Product Retailer  purchases under this Agreement
          shall pass to Retailer,  or to the finance  institution  designated by
          it,  upon  delivery to a carrier for  shipment  to  Retailer,  but the
          Company  shall retain a security  interest in, and right to repossess,
          any such Company Product described in Section 16E below.



                                       15
<PAGE>



     D.   Shipment of Company Products.

          (i)  Company Vehicles.

               The  Company  may  select the mode of  transportation,  route and
               point  of  origin  for  Company  Vehicles  shipped  to  Retailer.
               Retailer  will  pay to the  Company  the  applicable  destination
               charges  that the Company  establishes  for  Retailer for Company
               Vehicles  delivered to Retailer that are in effect at the time of
               shipment.  The  Company  will bear the risk of loss and damage to
               Company  Vehicles  until  delivery  to a  transport  carrier  for
               shipment;  however, the Company will, if requested by Retailer in
               a manner and within  the time as the  Company  shall from time to
               time  specify,  prosecute  for  and on  behalf  of  Retailer,  at
               Retailers  expense,  claims  against  the  responsible  transport
               carrier  for  loss  of  or  damage  to  Company  Vehicles  during
               transportation.

          (ii) Genuine Volvo Parts and Accessories.

               The Company  will ship  Genuine  Volvo Parts and  Accessories  to
               Retailer by whatever means of transportation,  by whatever route,
               and from whatever point the Company may select.  The Company will
               bear the risk of loss and  damage  to  Genuine  Volvo  Parts  and
               Accessories  until delivery to a transport  carrier for shipment;
               however,  the Company  will, if requested by Retailer in a manner
               and  within  the  time as the  Company  shall  from  time to time
               specify,  prosecute for and on behalf of Retailer,  at Retailer's
               expense,  claims against the  responsible  transport  carrier for
               loss of or damage to Genuine Volvo Parts and  Accessories  during
               transportation.

     E.   Security Interest.

          As security for full payment of all sums  Retailer owes to the Company
          under  this  Agreement,  whether  such sums are now,  or  subsequently
          become due and owing,  Retailer grants to the Company,  subject to any
          prior  perfected  secured  creditor's  security  interest,  a security
          interest in all  inventory,  including,  without  limitation,  Company
          Products and proceeds from sales or insurance, and all liens. Upon any
          non-payment or default in payment, the Company may accelerate any then
          existing debt and shall have all applicable rights, including, without
          limitation,  those  specified in the Uniform  Commercial  Code. If the
          Company  requests,  Retailer agrees to perfect the Company's  security
          interests.

     F.   Charges for Storage and Diversions.

          Retailer is responsible for, and will pay all charges,  for demurrage,
          storage and other expenses accruing after shipment to Retailer or to a
          carrier for transportation to Retailer. If diversions of shipments are
          made upon  Retailer's  request,  or are made by the Company because of
          Retailer's  failure  or  refusal  to accept  shipments  of  Retailer's
          orders, Retailer will pay all additional charges and expenses incident
          to such diversion.

17.  PAYMENTS BY RETAILER

     Payment for Company Products purchased by Retailer shall be made in cash in
     advance or by other payment  methods the Company  approves in writing.  The
     Company's receipt of any commercial paper will not constitute payment until
     collected in full.  Retailer will pay all collection  costs,  including but
     not  limited  to,   reasonable   attorneys'  fees,  costs  and  expense  of
     litigation.

18.  INVENTORY OF COMPANY VEHICLES

     Retailer will  maintain,  and the Company shall  supply,  a  representative
     inventory of new Company  Vehicles of the latest model in  accordance  with
     Retailer's  Business  Plan.  Retailer  shall  store and  maintain  such new
     Company Vehicles in accordance with Company Policies.


                                       16
<PAGE>


19.  DEMONSTRATORS

     Retailer  will keep  available  at all times,  in excellent  condition  for
     demonstration  purposes,  a  representative  number and mix of the  Company
     Vehicles of each of the latest models equipped with the latest accessories.

20.  BUSINESS HOURS

     Retailer  will  conduct  its  Retailer  Operations  during  hours which are
     reasonable and convenient for customers. All aspects of Retailer Facilities
     will be open for  business  during days and hours  reasonably  necessary to
     provide a superior customer experience,  and consistent with local practice
     in Retailer's Area of Responsibility or Market Area.

21.  PARTS AND ACCESSORIES

     A.   Inventory.

          Retailer  agrees to purchase and maintain at Retailer's  Facility,  in
          accordance with Company  Policies,  a sufficient  inventory of Genuine
          Volvo  Parts  and  Accessories  necessary  to  meet  the  current  and
          reasonably anticipated requirements of Volvo Customers.

     B.   Warranty Repairs.

          When  performing  warranty  repairs,  or other  repairs  paid for,  or
          reimbursed,  in whole or in part by the Company,  Retailer  shall only
          use Genuine Volvo Parts and Accessories.

     C.   Non-Genuine Volvo Parts and Accessories.

          When performing  repairs on any Company  Vehicle,  other than warranty
          repairs or repairs paid for, or reimbursed in whole or in part by, the
          Company,  Retailer  may sell and  install  non-Genuine Volvo Parts and
          Accessories.

     D.   Quality of Parts.

          If  Retailer  sells,  and/or  installs  non-Genuine  Volvo  Parts  and
          Accessories  during  repairs  or service  of  Company  Products  under
          Section 21C,  Retailer will not use parts or  accessories  that do not
          meet Company  standards or that could adversely  affect the mechanical
          operation, safety, integrity or reputation of Company Products.

     E.   Disclosure.

          If Retailer sells and/or  installs  non-Genuine  Parts and Accessories
          during repairs or service as described in Section 21C above.  Retailer
          will, prior to repair or installation,  conspicuously  disclose to the
          customer in writing on all copies of the  customer's  repair order and
          invoice the following:

          (i)  Those parts and accessories which are non-Genuine Volvo Parts and
               Accessories; and

          (ii) That  non-Genuine  Volvo Parts and Accessories are not covered by
               the Company or Manufacturer warranty.

22.  WARRANTIES ON COMPANY PRODUCTS

     The  Company  provides  a written  warranty  for the  Company  Products  it
     markets.  The  Company  and  Retailer  shall each  fulfill  promptly  their
     respective obligations under such warranties.

     Retailer  agrees to furnish each retail  purchaser or end user of a Company
     Vehicle  purchased from, or delivered by Retailer,  excepting used vehicles
     not covered  under the Volvo  Select Pre Owned  Program,  with such form of
     warranty and maintenance record, owner's manual, and/or other documentation
     then currently provided by the Company.

     EXCEPT AS OTHERWISE PROVIDED BY LAW, THE WRITTEN COMPANY WARRANTIES ARE THE
     ONLY  WARRANTIES  APPLICABLE  TO COMPANY  PRODUCTS.  EXCEPT FOR ITS LIMITED
     LIABILITY UNDER SUCH WRITTEN  WARRANTIES,  THE COMPANY AND  MANUFACTURER DO
     NOT ASSUME ANY OTHER



                                       17
<PAGE>


     WARRANTY, OBLIGATION OR LIABILITY, RETAILER IS NOT  AUTHORIZED TO CREATE OR
     ASSUME ANY  ADDITIONAL  WARRANTY  OBLIGATION  OR LIABILITY ON BEHALF OF THE
     COMPANY OR MANUFACTURER.  ANY SUCH  UNAUTHORIZED  ASSUMPTION OR CREATION OF
     OBLIGATIONS WITHOUT THE PRIOR WRITTEN AUTHORIZATION OF THE COMPANY SHALL BE
     THE SOLE RESPONSIBILITY OF RETAILER. AS TO RETAILER, THE WRITTEN WARRANTIES
     ARE IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT
     LIMITATION,  ANY  IMPLIED  WARRANTY  OF  MERCHANTABILITY  OR FITNESS  FOR A
     PARTICULAR  PURPOSE.  THE COMPANY  DISCLAIMS  ANY LIABILITY TO RETAILER FOR
     COMMERCIAL LOSSES BASED ON NEGLIGENCE OR MANUFACTURER'S STRICT LIABILITY OR
     ANY OTHER THEORY OF RECOVERY.

23.  PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE

     Retailer agrees to inspect, service, condition and prepare each new Company
     Vehicle  before  delivery  to a  customer  in  accordance  with  applicable
     pre-delivery  inspection,  service and conditioning standards and schedules
     the Company  furnishes  from time to time to Retailer,  and to perform such
     other normal  service and  conditioning  work as may be  prescribed  in the
     Company Policies.  Retailer will maintain adequate pre-delivery service and
     inspection records, and upon request,  Retailer will provide to the Company
     evidence that it has performed pre-delivery services.

24.  REPAIR AND MAINTENANCE SERVICE

     Retailer agrees to perform: (i) warranty service and repairs; (ii) services
     included in On Call(R) (or other roadside  assistance  plan the Company may
     offer from time to time);  (iii) extended  contract service  repairs;  (iv)
     recall and service campaign repairs;  (v) inventory  maintenance;  and (vi)
     other  maintenance  required  on Company  Products in  accordance  with the
     Company's then current  recommendations and  specifications,  regardless of
     where  customer  purchased  Company  Products.  Warranty,  recall,  service
     campaign and On Call services are provided for the customer's benefit,  and
     Retailer  agrees that the  customer  shall not be  obligated to pay for any
     charges for these  services for which Retailer is reimbursed by the Company
     or a third party designated by the Company.

25.  TRAINING

     Retailer and the Company  agree that ongoing  training and  development  of
     Retailer  employees is necessary to provide Volvo Customers with a superior
     ownership  experience,  and achieve the goals  described in the Preamble to
     this Agreement.  To help accomplish  this, the Company agrees to provide or
     make training programs available to Retailer, and Retailer will require all
     appropriate employees, as the Company may determine, to participate in such
     training  programs the Company  offers.  Retailer shall be responsible  for
     reasonable charges and expenses related to such training,  unless otherwise
     advised by the Company.


                            III. OPERATING PROVISIONS

The  Partners  agree  that the  success  of  Volvo,  its  name,  trademarks  and
reputation is their joint responsibility.

26.  USE OF VOLVO TRADEMARK

     Retailer  agrees  that  the  Company  has  been  authorized  by  AB  Volvo,
     Gothenburg,  Sweden,  to permit  Retailer to use the name "Volvo" under the
     following terms and conditions:

     A.   Ownership of Mark.

          AB Volvo is the owner of numerous  trademarks and trade names: (i) the
          name "Volvo" is a valid and existing  trademark  presently owned by AB
          Volvo and is  registered  by AB Volvo in the United  States Patent and
          Trademark  Office;  (ii) AB Volvo  presently has the sole right to use
          such trademarks (except to the extent that it has previously expressly
          authorized  others  to do so)  and to  authorize  others  to use  such
          trademarks;  and  (iii)  valuable  goodwill  has  accrued  to,  and is
          attached to, such trademarks.



                                       18
<PAGE>


     B.   Company Rights.

          The Company has been  granted the right to enforce  rights  associated
          with the  trademark  "Volvo" in the United  States.  In addition,  the
          Company's  rights  hereunder  shall  inure to the  benefit of, and are
          assignable to, any successor to its business.

     C.   Right to Use.

          During  the term of this  Agreement,  Retailer  has been  granted  the
          limited,  non-assignable,  non-exclusive right to use the name "Volvo"
          in the  tradename  used in  connection  with the sale and  service  of
          Company Products described in this Agreement.  Retailer will not claim
          or make any  attempt  to  register  any  corporate  or  other  name or
          trademark which includes the name "Volvo" in any place or office,  but
          Retailer  may, in connection  with  Retailer's  operations  under this
          Agreement and upon prior approval of the Company, register a tradename
          containing  the name "Volvo" where  registration  of businesses  under
          fictitious  names  are  conducted  as  required  by  law.  The  rights
          conferred herein will terminate upon termination of this Agreement.

     D.   Alterations.

          Retailer  will not alter any  Company  Product  furnished  under  this
          Agreement  or  change  or  substitute  any  of its  equipment,  nor do
          anything that will in any way infringe, impeach or lessen the value or
          validity of the trademarks associated with any Company Product.

     E.   Non-assignability.

          Retailer's   interest  in  this  trademark  license  is  personal  and
          non-assignable.

     F.   Assignability.

          All  rights  exercisable  by AB  Volvo  as the  owner  of the  "Volvo"
          trademark and tradenames shall, in the event of any assignment of such
          trademarks and tradenames,  be fully  exercisable by, and inure to the
          benefit of, the assignee.

27.  DISCONTINUANCE OF RIGHT TO USE TRADEMARK

     A.   Immediate Termination.

          The  permission  to use the  Trademarks  granted  in  Section  26 will
          terminate automatically if, at any time:

          (i)  Retailer  ceases  to act as an  Authorized  Retailer  in  Company
          Products;

          (ii)  Retailer  sells or  attempts  to sell  non-Company  Vehicles  or
          non-Genuine Volvo Parts and Accessories as Company Products;

          (iii)  Retailer  assigns or  attempts  to assign any  interest in this
          Agreement without the written consent of the Company; or

          (iv) This Agreement expires or is terminated pursuant to Sections 1 or
          10.

     B.   Delayed Termination.

          The Company or AB Volvo, upon thirty (30) days prior written notice to
          Retailer,  may  terminate  the  permission  given by Section 26 at any
          time.

     C.   Discontinue Use.

          Upon  termination of the rights  granted by Section 26,  Retailer will
          immediately  discontinue  the use of the name  "Volvo"  in  Retailer's
          tradename, and will also immediately discontinue the use of any signs,
          structures,  and forms of advertising based upon Retailer's  tradename
          which  include  the  name  "Volvo."   Immediately  after  termination,
          Retailer  will take all  necessary  and  appropriate  action to change
          Retailer's tradename to eliminate the name "Volvo" or any combination,
          variation,  or similar name.  Immediately after termination,  Retailer
          shall, at its expense,  remove any signage  containing or referring to
          the name "Volvo."



                                       19
<PAGE>


28.  LINES OF CREDIT

     During the term of this Agreement,  Retailer will maintain a line of credit
     with a responsible  financing institution at a level permitting Retailer to
     inventory Company Products commensurate with the Business Plan.

29.  ACCOUNTING AND RECORD KEEPING

     A.   Accounting.

          Retailer  will keep accurate  records of its business  relating to the
          marketing,  promoting,  selling  or  servicing  of  Company  Products.
          Retailer agrees to maintain a uniform  accounting system in accordance
          with Company Policies.

     B.   Inspection.

          During  regular  business  hours,  the Company  will have the right to
          inspect  Retailer  Facilities and to examine,  audit and make and take
          copies of all  records,  accounts  and  supporting  data  relating  to
          Retailer Operations.  Whenever reasonably  possible,  the Company will
          provide  Retailer  with advance  notice of an audit or  inspection  of
          Retailer  Facilities.  Retailer  may be  present  at any such audit or
          inspection.

     C.   Financial Statements.

          On or before the tenth (10th) day of each month, Retailer will deliver
          to the Company,  in a form prescribed by or acceptable to the Company,
          accurate  statements of the financial  condition and operating results
          of Retailer's  Operations with regard to Company  Products through the
          last day of the previous month.  Within ninety (90) days after the end
          of  Retailer's  fiscal year,  Retailer  shall provide the Company with
          financial  statements  that  have  been  reviewed  by  an  independent
          Certified Public  Accountant,  as well as a copy of such  accountant's
          review report.

     D.   Sales and Inventory Reports.

          Retailer  shall  furnish to the  Company,  on forms  prescribed  by or
          acceptable to the Company,  accurate  response of Retailer's sales and
          inventory of Company Products and Select Pre Owned Vehicles.

30.  RETAILER INFORMATION SYSTEMS

     Retailer  agrees to install and maintain,  at its expense,  electronic data
     processing  equipment and software  applications  that are compatible with,
     and supported by, the Company's  computer network and business  operational
     strategies, as the Company may determine from time to time.

31.  CHANGE IN PRICES

     Upon ten (10) days prior written notice to Retailer, the Company may change
     the Retailer Price and the Company's  charge for  distribution and delivery
     of any Company Vehicle.  Except with regard to any discounts  authorized in
     writing by the Company, the changed price and charge shall be the price and
     charge in effect,  and  delivery to  Retailer  shall be deemed to have been
     made and the order deemed to have been filled, upon Company's delivery to a
     transport  carrier for  delivery to Retailer or its  designee.  The Company
     will  provide  Retailer  with price  protection  for  Company  Vehicles  in
     accordance with the Company Policies.

32.  EXPORT OF COMPANY VEHICLES

     Retailer is authorized to sell Company  Products only to customers  located
     in the United States and agrees to abide by any export  policy  established
     by the Company.

33.  FACTORY SUGGESTED PRICE LABELS

     If Retailer  finds that any new Vehicle has been delivered to Retailer with
     an incorrect  label, or without a completed label affixed thereto  pursuant
     to the Federal  Automobile  Information  Disclosure Act, 15 U.S.C.  Section
     1232, as amended (the "Act"), Retailer will immediately notify the Company.
     If the Company  gives  written  instructions  to Retailer  with  respect to
     replacing  or  affixing  a label in a manner  that  conforms  with the Act,
     Retailer agrees to comply with such written instructions.



                                       20
<PAGE>


34.  INDEMNIFICATION

     A.   Indemnification by the Company.

          The Company will indemnify and hold Retailer harmless from any and all
          liability,  loss,  cost or  expense,  including,  without  limitation,
          reasonable  attorneys'  fees,  resulting from or relating to any legal
          action against Retailer by third parties  concerning  bodily injury or
          property damage arising out of an occurrence caused solely by a defect
          in the design or manufacture of a Company Product; provided,  however,
          Retailer  could not have  discovered  that  defect  in the  reasonable
          pre-delivery inspection or servicing of the Company Product.

          If any legal action  identified in this Section 34 is brought  against
          Retailer,  and if Retailer promptly notifies the Company in writing of
          the  commencement of the action and cooperates fully in the defense of
          the action as the Company may reasonably  require,  the Company agrees
          to  undertake,  at its sole  expense,  the  defense of said  action on
          behalf of Retailer when so requested by Retailer, and to indemnify and
          hold  Retailer  harmless  in the  event of an  adverse  judgment.  The
          Company  shall  have  the  right to  continue  the suit in the name of
          Retailer if the Company deems such action to be necessary.  Should the
          Company  refuse to  undertake  the  defense  on  behalf  of  Retailer,
          Retailer may conduct its own defense and, if the Company is determined
          to be solely  liable,  the Company shall be liable for the cost of the
          defense,  including,  without limitation,  reasonable attorneys' fees,
          court costs and  expenses of  litigation,  together  with any verdict,
          judgment or settlement paid by Retailer.

     B.   Indemnification by Retailer

          Retailer shall indemnify the Company and/or Manufacturer (for purposes
          of this  Section  34,  individually  and  collectively  referred to as
          "Indemnified  Party(ies)") and hold each of them harmless from any and
          all liability,  loss, cost or expense,  including,  without limitation
          reasonable  attorneys'  fees,  court  costs and  costs of  litigation,
          resulting  from or relating to any legal action against Volvo by third
          parties alleging or concerning:

               (i) Retailer's  failure to comply,  in whole or in part, with any
               obligations assumed by Retailer pursuant to this Agreement; or

               (ii) Retailer's  negligent or improper  inspection,  repairing or
               servicing of new or used Company Products; or

               (iii)  Retailer's  breach of any  contract  between  Retailer and
               Retailer's customer or supplier; or

               (iv) Retailer's unfair, misleading, deceptive or fraudulent trade
               practices.

          If any legal  action  arising  out of the  causes  specified  above is
          brought  against  any  Indemnified   Party,   and  provided  that  the
          Indemnified  Party  promptly  notifies  Retailer  in  writing  of  the
          commencement of any such action,  Retailer agrees to undertake, at its
          sole expense,  the defense of said action on behalf of the Indemnified
          Party when so  requested,  and to indemnify  and hold the  Indemnified
          Party harmless in the event of an adverse  judgment.  Should  Retailer
          refuse to undertake  the defense on behalf of the  Indemnified  Party,
          such party may conduct its own  defense and  Retailer  shall be liable
          for  the  cost  of  such  defense,   including,   without  limitation,
          reasonable  attorneys'  fees,  court  costs and  costs of  litigation,
          together  with  any  verdict,  judgment  or  settlement  paid  by  the
          Indemnified Party.

     C.   Joint Defense.

          Whenever  a legal  action  claims  liability  on the  part of both the
          Company,  as described in Section 34A, and  Retailer,  as described in
          Section 34B, each party shall be responsible for its own defense.  Any
          Indemnified  Party's or Retailer's  responsibility for its own defense
          pursuant to this  Section 34 shall in no way affect  their  respective
          obligations to indemnify and hold harmless.

35.  COMPLIANCE WITH LEGAL REQUIREMENTS

     Retailer  agrees to pay all taxes and to take all actions  required by law,
     including,  without  limitation,  those actions required to comply with the
     National  Traffic and Motor Vehicle  Safety Act of 1966, the Clean Air Act,
     the Consumer  Product  Safety Act, the  Magnuson-Moss  Warranty Act (all as
     amended from time to time), and any other federal, state or local leg-


                                       21
<PAGE>



     islation or regulation pertaining to safety, air pollution,  noise control,
     water  pollution,  handling,   transportation,   storage  and  disposal  of
     hazardous and non-hazardous  waste and materials,  warranties to consumers,
     the sale of Company  Vehicles,  or other  actions  which may be required of
     automobile retailers or which the Company may reasonably request.

36.  COMPLIANCE WITH CONSUMER PROTECTION LAWS AND REGULATIONS

     Because certain Volvo Customer  complaints may have legal significance for,
     or impose liability upon, Retailer and/or the Company under various "Repair
     or Replace" or other consumer  protection  laws and  regulations.  Retailer
     agrees to provide the Company  with prompt  notice of all such  complaints.
     Retailer agrees to take other steps as the Company may reasonably  require,
     including,  without  limitation,  providing  notice to Retailer's  regional
     office when a vehicle is brought into Retailer  which may become subject to
     such law or regulation  prior to a presumption  of liability  arising under
     such  law  or  regulation  from  the  inability  to  repair  or  correct  a
     nonconformity  or  condition  of a Vehicle.  Retailer  hereby  agrees to do
     nothing  to affect  adversely  the  Company's  rights  under  such laws and
     regulations, and recognizes that failure to comply with this Section 36 may
     result in a  chargeback  from the Company for monies  expended in remedying
     such complaints which in the reasonable  opinion of the Company were caused
     wholly or predominantly by Retailer.

37.  TRADE PRACTICES

     The Company and Retailer each recognize the importance of dealing with each
     other in an open and honest manner. In addition, each party understands the
     importance of treating Volvo Customers and prospective Volvo customers with
     the utmost respect and honesty.  Retailer agrees to conduct its business in
     a manner  which will  develop  and  maintain  superior  levels of  customer
     loyalty  and  satisfaction,  continually  striving  to  improve  Retailer's
     reputation,  the Company,  Company Products and the Volvo name,  trademarks
     and  service  marks.  Retailer  will not engage in any  unfair,  deceptive,
     misleading,   unethical,   fraudulent  or  otherwise  prohibited  practice.
     Retailer will immediately discontinue any such advertising or practice upon
     written notice of objection from the Company. Any notice by the Company and
     discontinuance  by Retailer will not prejudice any other rights the Company
     may have under this Agreement.

38.  REPURCHASE OF COMPANY PRODUCTS BY THE COMPANY

     Within sixty (60) days after  termination of this  Agreement  under Section
     10, the Company will repurchase the following:

          All new,  unused,  undamaged,  standard,  current  model year  Company
          Vehicles  with less than 200 miles which  Retailer  may own or have an
          interest in on the date of termination, at a price paid by Retailer to
          the Company for such Company  Vehicles less:  (i) any price  reduction
          allowance  credited or paid to Retailer (net discounts,  allowances or
          adjustments);  and (ii) transportation  charges paid by Retailer;

          All  current  model  year  demonstrator  vehicles  (as  defined by the
          Company) and registered  Volvo service  loaners which are no more than
          one year old;

          All new, unused,  standard,  current model year Company Vehicles which
          Retailer  may own or has an  interest  in on the date of  termination,
          which  were  received  by  Retailer  from  the  Company  in a  damaged
          condition and were not repaired by Retailer to standard condition,  at
          the price  specified in this Section 38, but  provided  that  Retailer
          shall subrogate all claims for the repair of such Company  Vehicles to
          the benefit of the Company;

          All new,  undamaged  Genuine Volvo Parts and  Accessories  offered for
          sale by the Company to its retailers on the date of termination  which
          Retailer may own or have an interest in on the date of termination, at
          the then  current  wholesale  price for such  Genuine  Volvo Parts and
          Accessories on the date of termination, less: (i) a handling charge of
          fifteen  (15%)  percent;  and (ii) any  charges  actually  paid by the
          Company for transportation to the Company; and

          All special tools,  signs, and other special equipment and information
          which are,  because of design,  applicable  only to Company  Products,
          which  Retailer  may  own  or  have  an  interest  in on the  date  of
          termination  and which are in useable  and good  condition  except for
          reasonable  wear and tear, at the price paid by Retailer  less: (i) an
          amount  equal  to the  accrued  straight  line  depreciation  on  such
          equipment during Retailer's (assumed) ownership, if such equipment has
          a useful  life of at least five years;  and (ii) any charges  actually
          paid by the  Company for the  transportation  of such  equipment  from
          Retailer's place of business to the Company's place of



                                       22
<PAGE>



          business.  Retailer will furnish to the Company satisfactory  evidence
          of the date on which Retailer  acquired an interest in such equipment,
          and of the price paid by Retailer.

     For purposes of this Section 38, Company Vehicles,  Genuine Volvo Parts and
     Accessories,  special tools and equipment  specified in the four  preceding
     paragraphs are referred to  collectively  in this Section 38 as "Repurchase
     Products."

     As a condition precedent to the Company's obligations under this Section 38
     to purchase the Repurchase Products,  Retailer shall permit the Company and
     Company's  designee or  designees,  to enter the Retailer  Facility at such
     time as the Company may reasonably determine, for the purpose of inspecting
     and/or  taking  an  inventory  of all or any  part of  Retailer's  stock of
     Company Products.

     In  connection  with the  Company's  purchase  of the  Repurchase  Products
     pursuant to this Section 38:

          (i) Retailer shall promptly  deliver such  Repurchase  Products to the
          Company;

          (ii)  Retailer  shall  comply  with  any and all  applicable  laws and
          requirements  which may be necessary or proper to transfer  good title
          to Repurchase  Products to the Company,  free and clear of any charge,
          lien, or encumbrance; and

          (iii) Promptly  following  Retailer's  fulfillment of its  obligations
          under  this  Section  38,  the  Company  shall  pay  Retailer  for the
          Repurchase  Products  acquired  by it  pursuant  to  this  Section  38
          (subject to all rights of set-off for any outstanding debt of Retailer
          to the Company).


                          IV. MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

39.  LICENSING REQUIREMENTS

     Retailer  will  procure and  maintain any  license(s)  or other  applicable
     governmental  authorization(s)  necessary to operate as a new motor vehicle
     retailer for Company Products.

40.  INSURANCE

     Retailer  will  acquire and  maintain  insurance  as follows:  (i) Worker's
     Compensation  insurance prescribed by law in the state in which Retailer is
     located, and Employers Liability  Insurance,  each with a limit of at least
     $500,000 per occurrence;  (ii) Comprehensive general liability insurance in
     a form approved by the Company with a combined  single limit of $1,000,000;
     (iii) automobile  liability insurance in the amount of at least $1,000,000;
     (iv) an umbrella policy to cover  comprehensive  general liability and auto
     insurance  in the amount of at least  $5,000,000;  (v)  Casualty  insurance
     insuring  Retailer  Facilities in an amount,  as determined by the Company,
     necessary  to repair any  casualty in an  expedited  manner  thus  enabling
     Retailer to continue  the sales and service of Company  Products;  and (vi)
     any other type of  insurance as may be deemed  reasonably  necessary by the
     Company.  From time to time, the Company reserves the right to modify these
     insurance  requirements  and limits in accordance with reasonably  accepted
     industry custom and practice.

41.  TAXES

     Retailer  will comply with all  applicable  laws  concerning  collection or
     payment by Retailer of taxes  applicable  to all  transactions  by Retailer
     concerning  Company  Products,  and  Retailer  shall  furnish  evidence  of
     compliance  to the  Company  within  thirty  (30) days after  delivery of a
     written request.

42.  WAIVER

     Failure  by either  party at any time to require  performance  by the other
     party, or to claim a breach of any provision of this Agreement, will not be
     construed  as  a  waiver  of  any   subsequent   breach,   nor  affect  the
     enforceability of any part of this Agreement, nor prejudice either party as
     regards to any subsequent action.

43.  AGENCY

     Retailer is an independently  operated business entity in which the Company
     has no ownership interest.  This Agreement does not make Retailer the legal
     representative  of the Company,  or in any way create the  relationship  of
     principal  and  agent  between  the  Company  and  Retailer,  nor does this
     Agreement create any fiduciary or employment  relationship between Retailer
     and the Company.  Retailer hereby agrees that it will not act or attempt to
     act, or represent



                                       23
<PAGE>


     itself directly or by implication, as agent of the Company or in any manner
     create or attempt to create any obligation on behalf of, or in the name of,
     the Company.

44.  SUBRETAILERS

     Retailer has no authority to establish an associate retailer or subretailer
     for Company Products.

45.  ASSIGNMENT OF RIGHTS OR DELEGATION OF DUTIES

     This  Agreement  is in the  nature of a  personal  services  agreement  and
     Retailer  has no  authority  to  assign  the  whole  or any  part  of  this
     Agreement,  or any right or interest  hereunder,  without the prior written
     consent of an Officer, which shall not be unreasonably withheld.

46.  NOTICE AND SERVICE OF NOTICE

     Notice from  Retailer to the Company will be effective  only if: (i) signed
     by the Principal Owner or General Manager; and (ii) directed to the Company
     President  or his  authorized  designee  Notice from the  Company  shall be
     effective  only if;  (i)  signed  by an  Officer;  and (ii)  directed  to a
     Principal Owner or General Manager at the Retailer's  address given on page
     1 of this  Agreement.  Any such  notice  shall be sent by  Certified  Mail.
     Return Receipt  Requested or by overnight mail or carrier  service.  In the
     case of  Certified  Mail,  notice shall be deemed given upon the earlier of
     actual  receipt or seven (7) days after such notice is sent. In the case of
     overnight  mail or carrier  service,  notice shall be deemed given upon the
     next  business  day  after  such  notice  is sent.  Notice  may be given by
     facsimile, but only with the written consent of the other party.

47.  APPLICABLE LAW AND SEVERABILITY

     This  Agreement  will be construed in  accordance  with New Jersey law with
     respect to its interpretation  and construction,  but in all other respects
     governed by the laws of the state of  Retailer's  Facilities  identified in
     Section  5.  If any  provision  of  this  Agreement  is  declared  invalid,
     unenforceable,  or prohibited  by the laws of the  applicable  state,  such
     provision shall be severable from the balance of this Agreement, which will
     remain in full force and  effect.  Should the  Company  determine  that any
     federal or state law or regulation, or any condition referred to in Section
     34 or 35  requires  a change or changes  in any of the  provisions  of this
     Agreement,  the Company may offer to  Retailer an  amendment  or an amended
     Agreement  embodying  such change or changes.  If Retailer fails to execute
     such  amendment or amended  Agreement  and return it to the Company  within
     thirty  (30) days  after it is  delivered  to  Retailer,  the  Company  may
     terminate this Agreement by giving notice to Retailer,  with termination to
     be effective upon receipt by Retailer of notice.

48.  FINANCIAL INFORMATION

     Retailer  agrees  that the  Company  may  provide  to, or obtain  financial
     information  from,  financial   institution(s)  which  have  an  actual  or
     prospective relationship with Retailer.

49.  ENTIRE AGREEMENT

     This Agreement supersedes all prior agreements between the parties relative
     to the sale and servicing of Company Products.  This Agreement contains the
     entire,  integrated  agreement  between  the  parties  and  any  amendment,
     modification,  or  waiver of any  provision  of this  Agreement  must be in
     writing  and signed by an  Officer,  and on behalf of  Retailer by a person
     identified in Section 2A.

50.  NO FRANCHISE FEE OR ADDITIONAL PAYMENTS

     Retailer  represents  and  warrants  that it has  paid  no fee,  nor has it
     provided any funds,  goods or services to any Company  employee or agent in
     lieu of a fee,  as  consideration  for the  Company's  entering  into  this
     Agreement,  and that the sole consideration for the Company's entering into
     this  Agreement  was  Retailer's  Principal  Owners' and General  Manager's
     abilities,   integrity,  assurances  of  personal  services  and  expressed
     intention to deal fairly and equitably  with the Company and the public and
     all  other  promises  recited  in this  Agreement.  In  addition,  Retailer
     represents  and  warrants  that  neither  it nor any  Principal  Owner  has
     received any  consideration,  except as described  in this  Agreement,  for
     entering into this Agreement.



                                       24
<PAGE>



51.  CAPTIONS

     The captions for the sections of this  Agreement  are for  convenience  and
     reference only and will not be construed to explain, modify, amplify or aid
     in the  interpretation,  construction  or meaning of the provisions of this
     Agreement, or be a part of this Agreement.

52.  TIME OF THE ESSENCE

     Time is of the essence with respect to each provision of this Agreement.

53.  DATE OF PERFORMANCE

     If any date for the  performance  of  obligations  by any party  under this
     Agreement  falls on any day that is not a business  day,  the date on which
     such  obligation is to be performed  will be deemed to be the next business
     day.

54.  RULES OF CONSTRUCTION

     The following rules shall apply to the construction and  interpretation  of
     this Agreement:

          A.  Singular  words  connote the plural number as well as the singular
          and vice  versa,  and the  masculine  includes  the  feminine  and the
          neuter.

          B. All references herein to particular articles, sections, subsections
          or exhibits are  references  to  articles,  sections,  subsections  or
          exhibits of this  Agreement.  

          C. Each party and its legal  counsel  have  reviewed  and  revised (or
          requested revisions of) this Agreement and, therefore, any usual rules
          of construction  requiring that ambiguities are to be resolved against
          a particular  party shall not be  applicable in the  construction  and
          interpretation of this Agreement.


                                 V. DEFINITIONS

55.  DEFINITIONS

     In addition to certain  terms  defined  elsewhere  in this  Agreement,  the
     following definitions shall apply throughout this Agreement:

          AREA OF  RESPONSIBILITY:  The  non-exclusive  area  that  the  Company
          designates  from  time  to  time  as  Retailer's   primary  geographic
          territory  for the  marketing,  promoting,  selling and  servicing  of
          Company products.

          AUTHORIZED RETAILER(S): Retailers authorized by the Company to conduct
          Retailer  Operations  in  connection  with the  marketing,  promoting,
          selling  and  servicing  of  Company  Products  pursuant  to the  then
          current, duly executed Authorized Retailer Agreement.

          BUSINESS PLAN: The written  business plan, in a form  satisfactory  to
          the  Company,  and any  updates  thereto,  produced  by  Retailer  and
          provided to the Company, which describes how Retailer will develop and
          maintain its Volvo business.

          COMPANY POLICY(IES): All guidelines,  regulations,  programs, manuals,
          bulletins,   policies,   and  procedures  and  subsequent   amendments
          established by the Company from time to time.

          COMPANY  PRODUCTS:  Company  Vehicles  and  Genuine  Volvo  Parts  and
          Accessories that bear the Volvo  trademark(s),  and special tools, all
          of which from time to time the Company may offer to Retailer.

          COMPANY  VEHICLES:   Volvo  passenger  cars  manufactured  by  or  for
          Manufacturer, and offered by the Company to Retailer for purchase.

          GENUINE  VOLVO PARTS AND  ACCESSORIES:  Those  parts and  accessories,
          bearing the  Marks/Trademarks,  manufactured by or for Manufacturer or
          the Company, and offered for sale to Retailer by the Company.

          MANUFACTURER:  Volvo  Car  Corporation,  Gothenburg,  Sweden,  and any
          affiliate or successor in  interest.  

          MARKET AREA: The non-exclusive area, encompassing one or more Areas of
          Responsibility,  that  the  Company  designates  from  time to time as
          Retailer's primary geographic territory for the marketing,  promoting,
          selling and servicing of Company products.



                                       25
<PAGE>



          MARK(S)/TRADEMARK(S):  Any  trademark or service mark that the Company
          either owns, or is authorized  to use and/or  license,  with rights of
          enforcement.

          MEDIATION  GUIDELINES:  The  policies to be  followed  in  mediating a
          dispute between the Company and Retailer as described in Section 11.

          MEDIATION  PANEL:  The  panel of Retail  Mediators,  as  described  in
          Section 11.

          OFFICER:  The president or any executive vice  president,  senior vice
          president or vice president of the Company.

          PARTNER(S)(SHIP)(ING):   The   terms   partnership,   partner(s)   and
          partnering, as used in this Agreement and the Preamble, shall refer to
          the  cooperative  and  mutually  advantageous  relationship  that this
          Agreement is intended to foster between the Company and Retailer.  The
          use of the  terms  partnership,  partner(s)  and  partnering  in  this
          Agreement  is not  intended  to  create a legal  partnership  or joint
          venture  between  the  parties  to this  Agreement.  The  Company  and
          Retailer  understand  that each party is and shall remain,  during the
          term of this  Agreement,  a wholly  independent  entity  and that this
          Agreement does not create a fiduciary or agency  relationship  between
          the parties.

          PRINCIPAL OWNER(S): Those owners of Retailer described in Section 2A.

          REMAINING  OWNER(S):  Those  owners of Retailer  that remain after the
          death or incapacity of a Principal Owner, as referenced in Section 11.

          REPURCHASE PRODUCTS: Company Products, described in Section 38.

          RETAILER:  The entity that is authorized to market,  promote, sell and
          service Company Products under this Agreement.

          RETAILER FACILITY(IES):  Retailer's land, buildings, improvements, and
          fixtures described in Section 6.

          RETAILER  FACILITIES GUIDE: The Company's guide for retail facilities,
          as such may be issued from time to time.

          RETAILER   MEDIATORS:   Retailers   selected  by  the  Company  and  a
          representative  group of Authorized Retailers to serve as mediators in
          the  resolution  of a dispute  between  the  Company and a Retailer in
          accordance with Section 11.

          RETAILER  OPERATIONS:  Retailer's  business of  marketing,  promoting,
          selling and servicing Company Products.

          VOLVO: A trademark,  tradename and service mark of AB Volvo, a Swedish
          corporation.

          VOLVO  CUSTOMER:  A person or  entity  that has  purchased,  leased or
          obtained service for, any Company Product.

          VOLVO  SELECT  PRE  OWNED  VEHICLE:  A Volvo  vehicle  that  has  been
          reconditioned  by a participating  Retailer in accordance with Company
          Policies.

          WORKING  CAPITAL  GUIDE:  The guide  produced by the Company to assist
          Retailer in  determining,  establishing,  modifying,  and  maintaining
          Retailer's   capital   necessary  to  provide  a  superior   ownership
          experience for Volvo Customers in Retailer's Area of Responsibility or
          Market Area.

This  Agreement will not be binding unless it bears the signatures of an Officer
on  behalf  of the  Company  and of a person  named in  Section  2A on behalf of
Retailer.

VOLVO CARS OF NORTH AMERICA, INC.            RETAILER  European Motors, LLC
                                               d/b/a   Volvo of Chattanooga

By:   /s/ Stephen J. Gamble                  By:  /s/ Nelson E. Bowers, II
     -------------------------------              ------------------------------
     Stephen J. Gamble                            Nelson E. Bowers, II
Title: Regional Vice President               Title: Cheif Manager
     -------------------------------              ------------------------------
     


                                       26
    

   



- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------













                                      Sales
                                    Agreement













                                                                           VOLVO


- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


<PAGE>



                        VOLVO CARS OF NORTH AMERICA, INC.


                                 SALES AGREEMENT

  This Agreement dated March 24, 1993, is made in triplicate by and between

                                Dyer & Dyer, Inc.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                (NAME OF ENTITY)

                          A South Carolina Corporation
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
            (STATE WHETHER AN INDIVIDUAL PARTNERSHIP OR CORPORATION,
            IF THE LATTER, SHOW NAME OF STATE IN WHICH INCORPORATED)

doing  business as              Dyer & Dyer, Inc.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                  (TRADE NAME)

located at          5260 Peachtree Industrial Boulevard           Chamblee
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                    (ADDRESS)                      (CITY)

  De Ka1b                            Georgia                        30341
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
  (COUNTY)                           (STATE)                      (ZIP CODE)

(hereinafter called "Dealer"), and Volvo Cars of North America, Inc., a Delaware
corporation with its principal place of business at Volvo Drive, Rockleigh,  New
Jersey 07647 (hereinafter called "Distributor").

                                    PREAMBLE

The  purpose of this  Agreement  is to  provide  for the sale and  servicing  of
Company  Products at retail by Dealer in Dealer's  Area of  Responsibility  in a
manner  that will best  serve the  interest  of the  retail  customer  and be of
benefit to Dealer and Distributor.

Attainment   of  the  purposes  of  this   Agreement   requires   understanding,
cooperation, mutual trust and confidence between the parties. Dealer has entered
into this Agreement  with  confidence in  Distributor's  integrity and expressed
intention  to deal  fairly with its  dealers  and the  public.  Distributor  has
entered into this Agreement with confidence in Dealer's integrity,  ability, and
expressed  intention to deal fairly with Distributor,  other authorized  dealers
and the public,  and in reliance upon Dealer's  undertaking to perform and carry
out the duties,  obligations and  responsibilities  of an authorized  Dealer set
forth in this Agreement.

The parties  recognize that public  confidence in Company Products is a valuable
component  in their  objectives  and  endeavors,  and that the  development  and
maintenance  of  public   confidence  in  Company  Products   requires  them  to
continuously  assure the public of  courteous,  fair  treatment  and  efficient,
dependable service. In order to promote and protect such public confidence,  and
to  promote  Company  Products,   Dealer  and  Distributor  will  conduct  their
businesses ethically and equitably.


                                                                               1

<PAGE>



PARAGRAPH I                   A.  Distributor   hereby  appoints  Dealer  as  an
                              authorized  dealer  in  Company  Products.  Dealer
                              hereby  accepts  such  appointment  and  agrees to
                              perform     the    duties,     obligations     and
                              responsibilities of a dealer as herein provided.

                              B. This Agreement  supercedes all prior agreements
                              between  the  parties  relative  to the  sale  and
                              servicing of Company  Products  and will  continue
                              until terminated pursuant to Clause 25 hereof.

                              C. This  Agreement  contains the entire  agreement
                              between the parties hereto.  Any amendment  hereto
                              must be in  writing  and  signed  by an  Executive
                              Officer of Distributor and a person  identified in
                              Paragraph II hereof on behalf of Dealer.

                              D.  This  Agreement  is to  be  governed  by,  and
                              construed  according  to, the laws of the State of
                              New Jersey.  If any provision of this Agreement is
                              invalid or unenforceable or prohibited by the laws
                              of the State or place where it is to be performed,
                              such  provision is  severable  from the balance of
                              this Agreement.

                              E.  Non-exclusively  and in  accordance  with  the
                              terms of this  Agreement,  Distributor  will  sell
                              Company  Products  to  Dealer,   and  Dealer  will
                              purchase Company Products from Distributor.

                              F.  The  parties  hereto  shall  annually   review
                              Dealer's Area of Responsibility and determine fair
                              and equitable performance standards for Dealer.

                              G. Dealer will use its best efforts to promote and
                              develop  sales and service of Company  Products in
                              its Area of Responsibility.

                              H.   Distributor   recognizes   Dealer's   special
                              interests   and   obligations   in  its   Area  of
                              Responsibility,  as such  Area  may be  designated
                              from time to time in accordance  with Clause 1 (E)
                              hereof.   Accordingly,   if  Dealer  performs  its
                              obligations   under   Paragraph   I  (G)   hereof,
                              Distributor   will  not  increase  the  number  of
                              authorized   dealers  for   Company   Products  in
                              Dealer's   Area   of   Responsibility   so  as  to
                              substantially  impair Dealer's business in Company
                              Products as it has therefor been conducted  except
                              after  thirty  (30) days prior  written  notice to
                              Dealer and a written survey showing need therefor,
                              provided that nothing  contained in this Agreement
                              shall require or be construed to require  Dealer's
                              approval  of  Distributor's   appointment  of  any
                              authorized dealer.

                              I. Nothing  contained in this Agreement limits any
                              person as to the geographic  area in which, or the
                              persons to whom, it may sell Company Products.

PARAGRAPH II                  This   Agreement   has   been   entered   into  by
                              Distributor     in    reliance    upon    Dealer's
                              representations that:

                              A.  The  following   person(s)  is  the  principal
                              owner(s) of Dealer:

                              Name      Home Address   Percentage      Title
                                                      of Interest

                              Richard S. Dyer, Jr.        100%        President
                              --------------------------------------------------
                                         9570 Marsh Cove Court
                              --------------------------------------------------
                                         Dunwoody. Georgia 30350
                              --------------------------------------------------

                              --------------------------------------------------

                              B. The following  person(s)  also has an ownership
                              interest in Dealer:

                              --------------------------------------------------

                              --------------------------------------------------

                              --------------------------------------------------

                              --------------------------------------------------


2

<PAGE>



                              C. The  following  person(s)  has full  managerial
                              authority for the operations of Dealer:

                              Name      Home Address                   Title

                              Same as Paragraph II A.
                              --------------------------------------------------

                              --------------------------------------------------

                              --------------------------------------------------

                              --------------------------------------------------

                              D. Except pursuant to Clause 35, any change in the
                              ownership  or  management  of Dealer  requires the
                              prior written approval of an Executive  Officer of
                              Distributor,   which  shall  not  be  unreasonably
                              withheld.

PARAGRAPH III                 A.  Dealer  will  establish,   staff,   equip  and
                              maintain a salesroom for Vehicles,  facilities for
                              Service  Parts  sales,   service   facilities  and
                              facilities for used passenger  automobile sales in
                              Dealer's   Area  of   Responsibility.   Each  such
                              facility  will  comply  with  reasonable   written
                              lay-out,  appearance and size standards  developed
                              by the parties hereto  pursuant to Paragraph I (F)
                              hereof,  consistent  with promoting the reputation
                              of, and public  confidence in,  Company  Products,
                              and will be sufficient to enable Dealer to satisfy
                              Dealer's   sales  and   service   responsibilities
                              hereunder. Dealer will procure and maintain tools,
                              machinery  and  equipment  adequate  to  meet  the
                              normal  requirements of owners of Company Products
                              in Dealers'  Area of  Responsibility.  Dealer will
                              operate such  facilities  throughout  the business
                              hours  customary in the trade in Dealer's  Area of
                              Responsibility.

                              B.  This   Agreement  has  been  entered  into  by
                              Distributor     in     reliance     on    Dealer's
                              representations  that  selling  and  servicing  of
                              Company  Products  will  be  conducted  from   the
                              following address(es):

                              (1) Sales: 5260 Peachtree Industrial Boulevard
                                        ----------------------------------------
                                          Chamblee, Georgia 30341
                              --------------------------------------------------

                              --------------------------------------------------

                              (2) Service: 5260 Peachtree Industrial Boulevard
                                        ----------------------------------------
                                           Chamblee, Georgia 30341
                              --------------------------------------------------

                              --------------------------------------------------

                              Dealer  will not move  such  place  or  places  of
                              business,  or establish  any  additional  place or
                              places  of  business  for  sales or  servicing  of
                              Company   Products,   without  the  prior  written
                              approval of an  Executive  Officer of  Distributor
                              which shall not be unreasonably withheld.

PARAGRAPH IV                  In  order   to  more   particularly   define   the
                              obligations of the parties  hereto,  it is further
                              agreed as follows:

CLAUSE I-                     A.  COMPANY  PRODUCTS  means  Vehicles and Service
DEFINITIONS                   Parts  that from time to time may be  offered  for
                              sale by Distributor to authorized dealers.

                              B. VEHICLES means passenger  vehicles  bearing the
                              trademark "VOLVO"

                              C.   SERVICE   PARTS  means   service   parts  and
                              accessories  supplied or  approved by  Distributor
                              for Vehicles.

                              D.  DATE OF  DISPATCH  means  the  time  at  which
                              Distributor  shall deliver products sold hereunder
                              to  a  carrier  for  delivery  to  Dealer  or  its
                              designee,     in    accordance    with    Dealer's
                              instructions.


                                                                               3

<PAGE>



                              E. AREA OF  RESPONSIBILITY  means  the  geographic
                              area  designated as such in writing by Distributor
                              from time to time.

                              F.  DEALER  PRICE  means the  price to Dealer  for
                              Company Products as established by Distributor.

                              G.  MANUFACTURER   means   Aktiebolaget  Volvo  of
                              Gothenburg, Sweden.

CLAUSE 2-                     A.  Distributor  has the right,  from time to time
POLICY                        during regular  business hours to inspect Dealer's
                              salesroom,  facilities  for service  parts  sales,
                              service  facilities and used passenger  automobile
                              outlet.

                              B.  Dealer  will  maintain  and employ in Dealer's
                              business and operations  under this Agreement such
                              net  working  capital  and net  worth  as  enables
                              Dealer to satisfy Dealer's  responsibilities under
                              this Agreement.

                              C.  Distributor  will  provide,  and  Dealer  will
                              participate  in,  and will make  available  to its
                              employees,    training   courses   and   personnel
                              development programs.

                              D. Dealer will conform to such reasonable  written
                              rules  and   regulations   consistent   with  this
                              Agreement   as  may,   from   time  to  time,   be
                              promulgated by Distributor to Dealer.

                              E. Dealer will make  reasonable  efforts to handle
                              satisfactorily any matters relating to the sale or
                              servicing of Company  Products in Dealer's Area of
                              Responsibility.  Dealer  will  report  promptly to
                              Distributor  each  complaint  received  by  Dealer
                              relating  to  any  Company  Product  which  Dealer
                              cannot remedy,  together with the name and address
                              of the complainant.

                              F. Dealer  warrants  that Dealer will  procure and
                              maintain   any   license  or  other   governmental
                              authorization   necessary   to   engage   in   the
                              businesses   contemplated  by  Paragraph  III  (A)
                              hereof.

CLAUSE 3-                     A.  Distributor  will keep Dealer  informed of the
WARRANTIES ON                 warranty  or  warranties   applicable  to  Company
COMPANY PRODUCTS              Products,  and will insure  that such  warranty or
                              warranties  extend to each customer of Dealer upon
                              the  sale of a  Company  Product  by  Dealer  to a
                              customer.  Dealer will  include  such  warranty or
                              warranties,  in the form and content  specified by
                              Distributor,  in each  agreement for the sale of a
                              Company Product by Dealer, and will furnish a copy
                              of such  warranty or  warranties  to the  customer
                              upon delivery of that Company Product.

                              B.   Distributor  and  Dealer  each  will  fulfill
                              promptly their respective  obligations  under such
                              warranty or warranties.  Said  obligations are set
                              forth  in  detail,   as  are  procedures  for  the
                              administration  and payment of warranty claims, in
                              the  Volvo  Service  Policy  Manual  and the Volvo
                              Parts and Accessories  Operations Guide (including
                              any successor publications). Said Publications may
                              be  amended  by  Distributor  from  time to  time,
                              provided  that no less than thirty (30) days prior
                              written  notice  to  Dealer  will be  given in the
                              event of  amendment  to  warranty  obligations  or
                              procedures.
  
                              C.  Manufacturer  and  Distributor  give no  other
                              warranty,   express  or  implied,   including  any
                              implied warranty of merchantability or fitness, on
                              any Company Product.


4

<PAGE>



CLAUSE 4-                     Dealer will furnish to each retail  purchaser of a
WARRANTY  AND                 Vehicle  from  Dealer  such form of  Warranty  and
SERVICE RECORD                Maintenance  Record and/or Operating  Instructions
AND/OR OPERATING              Book,  if any, as may then be currently  furnished
INSTRUCTIONS BOOK             by Distributor.

CLAUSE 5-                     A. Dealer  expressly  recognizes its obligation to
"FREE SERVICE                 use  its  best  efforts  to  effectively   perform
COUPON" AND                   warranty and Free Service Coupon work on Vehicles,
WARRANTY WORK                 whether   delivered   by  Dealer  or  by   another
                              authorized  Volvo dealer,  in accordance  with the
                              provisions of the "Volvo  Warranty and Maintenance
                              Record" booklet.  Dealer further recognizes that a
                              material and continuing default in its obligations
                              under this Clause constitutes a breach of Dealer's
                              obligations under Paragraph I (G) hereof.

                              B.  Dealer   authorizes   Distributor   to  charge
                              Dealer's  account for such "Free  Service  Coupon"
                              work on a  Vehicle sold by  Dealer  as may be per-
                              formed by another  authorized dealer and to credit
                              Dealer's  account for such "Free  Service  Coupon"
                              work  on a  Vehicle  sold  by  another  authorized
                              dealer  as may be  performed  by  Dealer  in  such
                              amount as may be provided therefor.

CLAUSE 6-                     Dealer expressly  recognizes its obligation to use
PRE-DELIVERY                  its  best  efforts  to  effectively   service  and
SCHEDULE                      condition  each new  Vehicle  before  delivery  in
                              accordance  with normal  pre-delivery  service and
                              conditioning schedules furnished from time to time
                              by  Distributor  to Dealer,  and to  perform  such
                              other normal service and conditioning  work as may
                              be  prescribed in any  then-current  Volvo Service
                              Policy Manual,  Notice, or Bulletin,  furnished by
                              Distributor.  Upon request by Distributor,  Dealer
                              will furnish  evidence of such performance of such
                              pre-delivery  services.  Dealer further recognizes
                              that a  material  and  continuing  default  in its
                              obligations under this Clause constitutes a breach
                              of  Dealer's  obligations  under  Paragraph  I (G)
                              hereof.

CLAUSE 7-                     Dealer expressly  recognizes its obligation to use
REPAIR AND                    its best efforts to effectively  perform repair or
MAINTENANCE                   maintenance   required  on  Company   Products  in
SERVICE                       accordance     with     Distributor's      current
                              recommendations   and   specifications.   Dealer's
                              prices   for  such   services   shall   always  be
                              determined  by  Dealer  in  the  exercise  of  its
                              discretion.   Dealer  further  recognizes  that  a
                              material and continuing default in its obligations
                              under  this   Clause  constitutes  a   breach   of
                              Dealer's obligations under Paragraph I (G) hereof.

CLAUSE 8-                     A. Dealer at all times will keep in Dealer's place
SERVICE PARTS                 of business an  inventory  of Service  Parts of an
                              assortment and in quantities that are necessary to
                              meet  the  current  and   reasonably   anticipated
                              service requirements of Dealer's customers.

                              B.  Dealer  will not sell or offer for sale or use
                              in the repair of any Company Product, as a genuine
                              new Volvo  Service  Part,  any part that is not in
                              fact a genuine new Volvo Service Part.

CLAUSE 9-                     A.  Dealer will  conduct its  business in a manner
TRADE PRACTICES               that  will  reflect  favorably  at  all  times  on
AND ADVERTISING               Distributor,  Manufacturer,  Company  Products and
                              the good name and reputation of the foregoing.

                              B.  Dealer  will  not  engage  in  any  deceptive,
                              misleading, or unethical practice or advertising.

                              C.   Dealer   will   forthwith   discontinue   any
                              advertising   upon  written  notice  of  objection
                              thereto  by   Distributor,   or  upon   notice  of
                              withdrawal of Distributor's approval thereof.


                                                                               5

<PAGE>



CLAUSE 10-                    Dealer  warrants  that  Dealer  will  not  exhibit
EXHIBITIONS                   Vehicles    without   the   written   consent   of
                              Distributor at any Motor Exhibition,  Agricultural
                              Show, or the like.

CLAUSE 11-                    A.  Dealer  will  keep  records  of  its  business
DEALER'S                      relating  to Company  Products.  From time to time
ACCOUNTING AND                during regular  business hours,  and on reasonable
REPORTS                       notice to dealer, Distributor may examine or cause
                              the  examination of Dealer's  accounts and records
                              relating  to the sale  and  servicing  of  Company
                              Products.   Dealer   may  be   present   at   such
                              examination.

                              B.  Dealer  will  furnish to  Distributor,  within
                              reasonable  time limits  specified by  Distributor
                              and on the forms  prescribed by Distributor or the
                              reasonable  equivalent thereof,  statements of the
                              financial   condition  and  operating  results  of
                              Dealer's business in Company Products.

                              C. Dealer  will  furnish to  Distributor,  on such
                              forms  and  at  such  times  as  Distributor   may
                              reasonably require,  reports of Dealer's sales and
                              stock of Company Products and used automobiles.

CLAUSE 12-                    If  Dealer  finds  that any new  Vehicle  has been
FACTORY  SUGGESTED            delivered  to Dealer with an incorrect  label,  or
PRICE LABELS                  without  a  completed   label,   affixed   thereto
                              pursuant  to the  Federal  Automobile  Information
                              Disclosure  Act,  15 U.S.C.  ss.1232,  Dealer will
                              notify Distributor of such finding. Thereafter, in
                              the event Distributor  gives written  instructions
                              to Dealer with respect to correcting or completing
                              the form or content of such label, Dealer warrants
                              that   it   will   comply   with   such    written
                              instructions.

CLAUSE 13-                    Dealer will maintain, during the existence of this
LINES OF CREDIT               Agreement,  a line of  credit  with a  responsible
                              financing institution at a level permitting Dealer
                              to inventory  Company Products  commensurate  with
                              annually set objectives.

CLAUSE 14-                    A.  Dealer  warrants  that Dealer will comply with
TAXES                         all laws  dealing  with  collection  or payment by
                              Dealer of taxes applicable to resale  transactions
                              by Dealer, and will furnish evidence of compliance
                              to Distributor upon written request.

                              B. As to any Company Products put to a taxable use
                              by Dealer or in fact purchased by Dealer otherwise
                              than for resale, Dealer warrants timely return and
                              payment of all applicable taxes.

CLAUSE 15-                    Payment  for each  Company  Product  purchased  by
PAYMENTS BY DEALER            Dealer will be made in cash in advance  unless the
                              invoice or Dealer's  then  current and  applicable
                              wholesale  payment  plan  provides  otherwise,  in
                              which  event the terms of the invoice or such plan
                              will govern.  Receipt of any commercial paper will
                              not  constitute  payment until  collected in full.
                              Dealer will pay all collection charges.

CLAUSE  16-                   Title to each Company Product  purchased by Dealer
TITLE                         under this  Agreement  will pass to Dealer,  or to
                              the  finance  institution  designated  by it, upon
                              delivery  to the  carrier or to Dealer,  whichever
                              first  occurs,   but  Distributor  will  retain  a
                              security interest in, and right to repossess,  any
                              such Company Product until paid therefor.

CLAUSE 17-                    At Distributor's  request,  Dealer will submit its
FIRM  ORDERS                  firm orders for new Vehicles to be shipped  during
                              an Allocation  Period,  and Dealer's estimated new
                              Vehicle requirements for the succeeding Allocation
                              Period.  An  Allocation  Period  shall not  exceed
                              eight (8) weeks in duration.


6

<PAGE>



CLAUSE 18-                    A.  Distributor  will  use  its  best  efforts  to
DELIVERIES                    fill each  of  Dealer's  firm  orders for  Company
                              Products  in   accordance   with  delivery   dates
                              specified  by Dealer.

                              B. When allocation of available  Company  Products
                              is necessary,  Distributor will allocate available
                              Company   Products  on  a  fair,   equitable   and
                              nondiscriminatory basis.

                              C.   Delivery  of  standard   current  model  year
                              Vehicles by Distributor  pursuant to Dealer's firm
                              orders  may  be  made  at  any  time   during  the
                              Allocation  Period for which Dealer has  specified
                              delivery, or during the next Allocation Period.

                              D. After the Allocation Period next following that
                              Allocation  Period for which Dealer has  specified
                              delivery,  any  unfilled  firm order for  standard
                              current model year Vehicles shall continue as such
                              until  cancelled  by  Dealer  before  the  Date of
                              Dispatch.

                              E.  Distributor's  delivery and Dealer's  right to
                              cancel orders for  non-standard  Vehicles shall be
                              subject  to such  terms and  conditions  as may be
                              indicated by  Distributor  in  accepting  Dealer's
                              orders for such Vehicles.  Distributor may require
                              a non-refundable  deposit as a condition precedent
                              to accepting any order for a non-standard vehicle.

                              F. If  Dealer  fails  to  accept  or  refuses  any
                              Company Product delivered by Distributor  pursuant
                              to this Clause 18, Dealer will pay Distributor all
                              expenses  incurred by Distributor in shipping such
                              Company  Product to Dealer and in (a) returning it
                              to the point of shipment,  or (b)  directing it to
                              another destination whichever is the less.

CLAUSE   19-                  Distributor  will not be liable in any respect for
DELAYS IN                     failures or delays in  deliveries  due in whole or
DELIVERIES                    in part to such matters as shortage or curtailment
                              of  material,  labor,  transportation  or  utility
                              services, or to any labor or production difficulty
                              in   Manufacturer's   plants   or   those  of  its
                              suppliers,  or to any cause  beyond  Distributor's
                              control   or   without   Distributor's   fault  or
                              negligence.

CLAUSE  20-                   Any claims  which  Dealer  submits to  Distributor
DEALER                        must  be   submitted   in  writing   within   such
CLAIMS                        reasonable time as may be specified by Distributor
                              for  the   submission   of  such  claims.   Claims
                              submitted  after the  expiration  of the said time
                              will not be considered or allowed.

CLAUSE  21-                   Dealer  will  maintain a stock of new  Vehicles of
STOCK  VEHICLES               the  latest  model in  accordance  with the annual
                              objectives   mutually  agreed  to  by  Dealer  and
                              Distributor.

CLAUSE 22-                    Dealer will keep  available at all times,  in good
DEMONSTRATORS                 running  order  and   presentable   condition  for
                              demonstration  purposes,  an  adequate  number  of
                              Vehicles  equipped with  accessories of the latest
                              model  but not at any  time  less  than  two  such
                              Vehicles.

CLAUSE   23-                  Distributor  reserves for itself and  Manufacturer
CHANGE IN MODELS              the right to discontinue  the  manufacture or sale
AND/OR  DESIGNS               of any  Company  Product  or to  make  changes  in
                              design, or to add improvements to Company Products
                              at any time,  all  without  notice  to Dealer  and
                              without  incurring any obligation to Dealer either
                              with  respect to any  Company  Product  previously
                              ordered or purchased by Dealer or otherwise.


                                                                               7

<PAGE>



CLAUSE 24-                    Distributor  may  change at any time and from time
CHANGE IN PRICES              to time, the Dealer Price and Distributor's charge
                              for  distribution  and  delivery  of  any  Company
                              Product,  provided that no less than ten (10) days
                              prior  written  notice shall be given to Dealer of
                              any change in the Dealer  Price of  Vehicles as to
                              which a Dealer Price has  theretofore  existed for
                              the  current   model  year.   Except  as  to  such
                              discounts   as  may  be   allowed  in  writing  by
                              Distributor,  such price and such charge  shall be
                              the price and charge in effect,  and  delivery  to
                              Dealer  shall be  deemed to have been made and the
                              order deemed to have been  filled,  on the Date of
                              Dispatch.

CLAUSE 25-                    A. This  Agreement will continue in full force and
TERMINATION OF                effect,  and will  govern  all  relationships  and
AGREEMENT                     transactions  between  the parties  hereto,  until
                              terminated  pursuant  to the  provisions  of  this
                              Clause 25.

                              B.  Dealer may  terminate  this  Agreement  at any
                              time,  without  assigning any reason therefor,  by
                              giving  sixty  (60) days prior  written  notice of
                              termination to Distributor.

                              C. Distributor may terminate this Agreement:

                                   1.  Effective  upon no less than  thirty (30)
                                   days prior written notice to Dealer  (subject
                                   to  Paragraph  (D) of this Clause 25), in the
                                   event that:

                                        a.  Dealer  shall  fail to  correct  any
                                        default    in    performance    of   its
                                        responsibilities  under  Paragraph I (G)
                                        or Clauses 2 (B), 2 (F),  8, 9 (B),  ll,
                                        15, 21, 22, or 34 (B) within  sixty (60)
                                        days  after   written   notice  of  such
                                        default is given to Dealer; or

                                        b.   Any   dispute,    disagreement   or
                                        controversy  between  or  among  persons
                                        identified   in  Paragraph  II  of  this
                                        Agreement  which  adversely  affects the
                                        ownership,  operation,   management,  or
                                        business  of  Dealer  arises  and is not
                                        resolved  within  sixty  (60) days after
                                        notice thereof is given to Dealer; or

                                        c.  Dealer  or a  person  identified  in
                                        Paragraph   II  of  this   Agreement  is
                                        finally   convicted   in  a   court   of
                                        competent  jurisdiction of a crime which
                                        adversely   affects  the   operation  or
                                        business  of  Dealer or the good name or
                                        reputation  of  Distributor  or  Company
                                        Products; or

                                        d.  Dealer (if Dealer is an  individual)
                                        or any person identified in Paragraph II
                                        (A) of this Agreement shall suffer death
                                        or total physical or mental  incapacity;
                                        or

                                        e. Dealer misrepresents the ownership or
                                        management    of   Dealer    either   in
                                        connection with the application for this
                                        Agreement or thereafter; or

                                        f.   Dealer   shall  file  a   voluntary
                                        petition  in  bankruptcy,  or  shall  be
                                        adjudicated as a bankrupt pursuant to an
                                        involuntary  petition,  or shall  suffer
                                        appointment  of a temporary or permanent
                                        receiver,  trustee,   or  custodian  for
                                        Dealer or  Dealer's  business  who shall
                                        not be  discharged  within  thirty  (30)
                                        days,  or shall make an  assignment  for
                                        the benefit of creditors; or

                                        g.  An  unapproved  change  is  made  by
                                        Dealer in the ownership or management of
                                        Dealer specified by Paragraph II hereof,
                                        or in the locations of Dealer businesses
                                        for  Company   Products   specified   by
                                        Paragraph III (B) hereof.

                                   2. After  January 1,  1978,  effective  on no
                                   less than one hundred twenty (120) days prior
                                   written  notice to Dealer in connection  with
                                   the    simultaneous    termination   of   all
                                   outstanding Sales Agreements for Company


8

<PAGE>





                                 Products as to which Distributor is a party, in
                                 connection  with   Distributor's   simultaneous
                                 offering to all then-current authorized dealers
                                 in Company Products (including Dealer) a new or
                                 amended standard form of Sales Agreement.

                              D.  Any  claim  by  Dealer  that  good  cause  for
                              termination of this Agreement by Distributor  does
                              not exist pursuant to Clause 25 (C) (1) hereof may
                              be  settled  by  arbitration  upon the  request of
                              Dealer.  Such request,  if made,  shall be made in
                              writing  by  Dealer  to the  American  Arbitration
                              Association,  and written  notice of such  request
                              shall be given by  Dealer to  Distributor,  within
                              thirty  (30) days  after  Distributor's  notice of
                              termination  under Clause 25 (C) (1) hereof.  Such
                              request  shall  suspend  the  effective   date  of
                              termination    pending    the   outcome   of   the
                              arbitration.

                                   1.   Dealer   may   formally    initiate   an
                                   arbitration  under  this  Clause  25  (D)  by
                                   filing a written request  therefor,  together
                                   with  the  appropriate  filing  fee,  at  any
                                   office    of   the    American    Arbitration
                                   Association,  which  shall  then  become  the
                                   locale   and   site   of   the    arbitration
                                   proceeding.

                                   2.  The  arbitration  shall be  conducted  in
                                   accordance  with the Commercial  Rules of the
                                   American   Arbitration   Association  and  in
                                   consonance with the United States Arbitration
                                   Act (8 U.S.C. ss.1 et seq.).

                                   3. The arbitration shall be heard by a single
                                   impartial  arbitrator  mutually  agreeable to
                                   the parties hereto, and selected from a panel
                                   of    American    Arbitration     Association
                                   Arbitrators.

                                   4. If the arbitrator  finds that  Distributor
                                   has shown that  termination of this Agreement
                                   would accord with the  provisions  hereof and
                                   the  standards  set  forth in the  Automobile
                                   Dealers Franchise act, 15 U.S.C. ss.1221-1225
                                   (the  "Act"),  the  termination  shall become
                                   effective on the date of such finding, Dealer
                                   shall  pay  the  fees  and  expenses  of  the
                                   arbitration,    and   said   termination   is
                                   expressly recognized by Dealer as having been
                                   made  by   Distributor   without   breach  by
                                   Distributor  of the Act.  Absent such finding
                                   by the  Arbitrator,  Distributor's  notice of
                                   termination   shall  be  wholly   void,   and
                                   Distributor  shall pay the fees and  expenses
                                   of the Arbitration.

CLAUSE 26-                    A.   Termination  of  this  Agreement   shall  end
PROCEDURE ON                  Dealer's status as an authorized Volvo Dealer, but
TERMINATION                   shall not affect any  liability of either party to
                              the   other   accruing   prior   to  the  date  of
                              termination, or arising out of this Agreement.

                              B. Upon  termination  Dealer agrees to immediately
                              discontinue  the use of any  trademarks  or  trade
                              names made up in whole or in part of any trademark
                              or  trade  name   belonging  to   Distributor   or
                              Manufacturer;  to remove all signs  containing any
                              such  trademarks  or trade  names;  and to  render
                              unfit  for  the use   originally  intended  (or to
                              certify to  Distributor  that  Dealer will not use
                              for   the   purpose   originally   intended)   any
                              stationery,   printed   matter,   or   advertising
                              containing  any such  trademarks  or trade  names.
                              After termination  Dealer will not represent,  and
                              will not continue any  practices  which might make
                              it appear,  that it is still an  authorized  Volvo
                              Dealer and will permanently discontinue any use of
                              the word Volvo in Dealer's  corporate title,  firm
                              name or trade name and will take such steps as may
                              be  necessary  or  appropriate  in the  opinion of
                              Distributor to change such corporate  title,  firm
                              name or trade  name to  eliminate  the word  Volvo
                              therefrom,   all   without   cost  or  expense  to
                              Distributor.

                              C.  On  termination  under  Clause  25 (C) (1) all
                              unfilled  orders  for  Company  Products  will  be
                              cancelled,   subject   to   Clause   18  (E).   On
                              termination under


                                                                               9

<PAGE>



                              Clause 25 (B) Distributor  will have the option to
                              complete or cancel all unfilled orders for Company
                              Products  then  pending  and will  have a  similar
                              right to complete or cancel any firm orders  given
                              after notice and before  termination.  Termination
                              under Clause 25 (C) (2) shall not affect  unfilled
                              orders for Company Products then pending.

                              D. After  termination  acceptance  of orders  from
                              Dealer by  Distributor,  or the continuance of the
                              sale  by  Dealer  of  Company  Products,   or  the
                              referring of inquiries to Dealer by Distributor or
                              any business  relations  either party has with the
                              other will not be  construed  as a renewal of this
                              Agreement  nor a  waiver  of the  termination.  If
                              Distributor  accepts any orders from Dealer  after
                              termination   all   such   transactions   will  be
                              governed,  unless the contrary  intention appears,
                              by the terms of this Agreement  applicable to such
                              transactions.

CLAUSE 27-                    A. Within  thirty (30) days after  termination  of
REPURCHASES BY                this Agreement under Clause 25 (B) Distributor may
DISTRIBUTOR                   give  Dealer  written   notice  of   Distributor's
                              exercise of an option granted hereby to repurchase
                              all of the following:

                                   1.  All  new,  unused,  undamaged,  standard,
                                   current model year Vehicles  which Dealer may
                                   own or have  an  interest  in on the  date of
                                   notice to Dealer of Distributor's exercise of
                                   the aforementioned  option, at the price paid
                                   by Dealer to  Distributor  for such  Vehicles
                                   (a)  less  any  price   reduction   allowance
                                   credited   or  paid  to  Dealer   (net  after
                                   discounts,  allowances or  adjustments),  (b)
                                   plus transportation charges paid by Dealer;

                                   2. All new, unused,  standard,  current model
                                   year Vehicles  which Dealer may own or has an
                                   interest  in on the date of  notice to Dealer
                                   of    Distributor's     exercise    of    the
                                   aforementioned option, which were received by
                                   Dealer   from   Distributor,   in  a  damaged
                                   condition  and were not repaired by Dealer to
                                   standard condition, at the price specified in
                                   subparagraph  (1) of this  Paragraph (A), but
                                   provided  that  Dealer  shall  subrogate  all
                                   claims for the repair of such Vehicles to the
                                   benefit of Distributor;

                                   3. All new,  undamaged  Service Parts offered
                                   for sale by Distributor to its dealers on the
                                   date of  termination  which Dealer may own or
                                   have an  interest in on the date of notice to
                                   Dealer  of  Distributor's   exercise  of  the
                                   aforementioned  option,  at the Dealer  Price
                                   for  such  Service   Parts  on  the  date  of
                                   termination  less a  handling  charge  of ten
                                   percent (10 % ) and any charges actually paid
                                   by Distributor for the transportation of such
                                   Service Parts from Dealer's place of business
                                   to Distributor's place of business; and

                                   4.  All  tools,   signs  and  other   special
                                   equipment  which  are,   because  of  design,
                                   applicable  only to Company  Products,  which
                                   Dealer may own or have an  interest in on the
                                   date of notice  to  Dealer  of  Distributor's
                                   exercise of the  aforementioned  option,  and
                                   which  are  in  useable  and  good  condition
                                   (except for reasonable wear and tear), at the
                                   price paid by Dealer  therefor less an amount
                                   equal   to   the   accrued    straight   line
                                   depreciation   on   such   equipment   during
                                   Dealer's (assumed) ownership thereof, if such
                                   equipment  had a  useful  life  of  five  (5)
                                   years,  and less any charges actually paid by
                                   Distributor  for the  transportation  of such
                                   equipment  from Dealer's place of business to
                                   Distributor's place of business.  Dealer will
                                   furnish to Distributor  satisfactory evidence
                                   of the  date  on  which  Dealer  acquired  an
                                   interest in such equipment,  and of the price
                                   paid by Dealer therefor.

                                   5.  Vehicles,  Service  Parts,  and equipment
                                   specified in the four preceding subparagraphs
                                   of  this   Paragraph   (A)  are  referred  to
                                   collectively in this Clause 27 as "Repurchase
                                   Products."



10

<PAGE>



                              B. Within  thirty (30) days after  termination  of
                              this Agreement  under Clauses 25 (C) (1) or 25 (C)
                              (2)  (provided in the latter  instance that Dealer
                              shall  not  then be a party  to a Sales  Agreement
                              with  Distributor)  Distributor  shall  repurchase
                              from Dealer, and Dealer shall sell to Distributor,
                              all  Repurchase  Products  which Dealer may own or
                              have  an  interest  in on the  effective  date  of
                              termination,  at  the  prices  specified  for  the
                              particular Repurchase Product by subparagraph (1),
                              (2), (3), or (4) (as the case may be) of Paragraph
                              (A) of this Clause 27.

                              C.  In  the  event  that  Distributor   elects  to
                              repurchase   Repurchase   Products   pursuant   to
                              Paragraph  (A) of this  Clause 27, or in the event
                              that Distributor  becomes  obligated to repurchase
                              Repurchase  Products  pursuant to Paragraph (B) of
                              this Clause 27, then:

                                   1.  Dealer   shall   promptly   deliver  such
                                   Repurchase Products to Distributor, and

                                   2.  Dealer  shall  comply  with  any  and all
                                   applicable laws and requirements which may be
                                   necessary or proper to transfer good title to
                                   Repurchase Products to Distributor,  free and
                                   clear of any charge,  lien,  or  encumbrance,
                                   and

                                   3.   Distributor   shall   pay   Dealer   for
                                   Repurchase  Products  acquired by it pursuant
                                   to this Clause 27 promptly following Dealer's
                                   fulfillment  of its  obligations  under  this
                                   Clause and Clause 26 (B).

CLAUSE 28-                    Any notice given  hereunder  shall be deemed given
SERVICE OF NOTICE             on the seventh day after it has been sent by first
                              class  certified mail,  return receipt  requested,
                              properly  enclosed in a wrapper  addressed  to the
                              party  for  whom it is  intended  at such  party's
                              address hereinabove set forth. Notices may also be
                              given  by  personal   delivery  by  Dealer  to  an
                              Executive   Officer   of   Distributor,    or   by
                              Distributor  to  any  principal   owner  named  in
                              Paragraph II (A) hereof.  Each party will promptly
                              give written  notice to the other of any change of
                              address.

CLAUSE 29-                    Failure  by  either  party at any time to  require
WAIVER                        performance  by the  other  party  or to  claim  a
                              breach of any provision of this Agreement will not
                              be construed as a waiver of any subsequent  breach
                              nor affect the  effectiveness  of this  Agreement,
                              nor any part thereof,  nor prejudice  either party
                              as regards any subsequent action..

CLAUSE  30-                   This  Agreement  does  not in any way  create  the
DEALER NOT AGENT              relationship   of  principal   and  agent  between
OF  DISTRIBUTOR               Distributor  and Dealer.  Dealer  warrants that it
                              will  not  act or  attempt  to act,  or  represent
                              itself,  directly or by  implication,  as agent of
                              Distributor  or in any manner create or attempt to
                              create any  obligation on behalf of or in the name
                              of Distributor.

CLAUSE  31-                   Dealer has no  authority to establish an associate
SUBDEALERS                    dealer or subdealer for Company Products.

CLAUSE 32-                    Dealer has no authority to assign the whole or any
ASSIGNMENT                    part of this  Agreement,  or any right or interest
                              hereunder, without the prior written consent of an
                              Executive Officer of Distributor,  which shall not
                              be unreasonably withheld.


                                                                              11

<PAGE>



CLAUSE 33-                    Distributor  recognizes  Dealer's right to sell or
DISPOSITION OF                otherwise  dispose of all or substantially  all of
BUSINESS BY DEALER            Dealer's assets related to Dealer's obligations or
                              performance  under this Agreement,  including Good
                              Will, at any time and on such terms and conditions
                              as Dealer may decide to accept in the  exercise of
                              its  sole   discretion.   Distributor   shall  not
                              unreasonably  refuse to enter into a new agreement
                              with the  person  contracting  to so acquire or so
                              acquiring such assets from Dealer,  the provisions
                              of  which  will be  substantially  the same as the
                              provisions of this Agreement.

CLAUSE 34-                    In connection with this Agreement, Distributor has
TRADEMARKS  AND               been  authorized by  Manufacturer to permit Dealer
TRADE NAMES                   to use the name "Volvo" under the following  terms
                              and conditions, to each of which Dealer agrees:

                              A. During the existence of this Agreement,  Dealer
                              may,  nonexclusively;  use the name "Volvo" in the
                              trade name used in connection  with the conduct of
                              Dealer's  business  under this  Agreement.  Dealer
                              will not claim or make any attempt to register any
                              corporate  or  other  name  or   trademark   which
                              includes  the name "Volvo" in any place or office,
                              but  Dealer  may,  in  connection   with  Dealer's
                              operations  under this Agreement  register a trade
                              name    containing    the   name   "Volvo"   where
                              registration  of  fictitious   names  under  which
                              businesses are conducted is required by law.

                              B. Dealer  acknowledges that the name "Volvo" is a
                              valid and existing  trademark  presently  owned by
                              Manufacturer  and is registered by Manufacturer in
                              the United States Patent Office, that Manufacturer
                              presently has the sole right to use such trademark
                              (except  to the  extent  that  it  has  previously
                              expressly  authorized  others  to do  so)  and  to
                              authorize  others to use such trademark,  and that
                              valuable  good will has accrued to and is attached
                              to such trademark.

                              C. Dealer will take any action  which  Distributor
                              shall  deem   necessary  or  desirable  to  permit
                              Distributor or Manufacturer to use, or to license,
                              or to permit  others to use,  the name  "Volvo" in
                              Dealer's Area of Responsibility, including without
                              limitation  the use of  "Volvo" in the name of any
                              other company.

                              D.  Dealer  will not  alter  any  Company  Product
                              furnished hereunder or change or substitute any of
                              its equipment nor do anything that will in any way
                              infringe,  impeach or lessen the  validity  of the
                              trademarks associated with any Company Product.

                              E. The permission  herein granted shall  terminate
                              automatically if, at any time:

                                   1.  Dealer  ceases  to  act  as a  dealer  in
                                   Company Products; or

                                   2. Dealer  sells  motor  vehicles or parts or
                                   accessories  therefor,   other  than  Company
                                   Products,  under any name containing the name
                                   "Volvo"; or

                                   3.  Dealer  files  a  voluntary  petition  in
                                   bankruptcy,  or is  adjudicated as a bankrupt
                                   pursuant  to  an  involuntary   petition,  or
                                   suffers   appointment   of  a  temporary   or
                                   permanent receiver,  trustee or custodian for
                                   Dealer  or  Dealer's   business  who  is  not
                                   discharged  within thirty (30) days, or makes
                                   an  assignment  for the benefit of creditors;
                                   or

                                   4.  Dealer  assigns or attempts to assign any
                                   interest in this Agreement, or

                                   5.  This  Sales   Agreement   expires  or  is
                                   terminated.


12

<PAGE>



                              F. Distributor or  Manufacturer,  upon thirty (30)
                              days prior written notice to Dealer, may terminate
                              the  permissions  given by this  Clause  34 at any
                              time.

                              G. Upon  termination of the  permissions  given by
                              this   Clause   34,   Dealer   will    immediately
                              discontinue   the  use  of  the  name  "Volvo"  in
                              Dealer's  trade  name,  and will also  immediately
                              discontinue the use of any signs, structures,  and
                              forms of  advertising  based upon  Dealer's  trade
                              name  which  include  the name  "Volvo" As soon as
                              possible after such termination,  Dealer will take
                              all necessary and  appropriate  action to effect a
                              change in  Dealer's  trade name so that it will no
                              longer contain the name "Volvo" or any combination
                              or   variation   thereof,   or  any   other   name
                              deceptively similar thereto.

                              H. Dealer's  interest in this trademark license is
                              personal and non-assignable.

                              I.  Distributor's  rights hereunder shall inure to
                              the  benefit  of,  and  are   assignable  to,  any
                              successor to its business.

                              J. All rights  exercisable by  Manufacturer as the
                              owner of the trademark "Volvo" shall, in the event
                              of any  assignment  of such  trademark,  be  fully
                              exercisable  by and  inure to the  benefit  of the
                              assignee.

CLAUSE  35-                   Upon termination of this Agreement  because of the
DEALER'S SUCCESSOR            death or incapacity  of any principal  owner named
ON DEATH OR                   in Paragraph II (A) hereof:
INCAPACITY
                              A. Distributor will offer a one-year Interim Sales
                              Agreement for Company Products:

                                   1.  to any  person  previously  nominated  by
                                   notice in  writing  to  Distributor,  by such
                                   owner  as his  successor,  together  with any
                                   remaining  persons  named in Paragraph II (A)
                                   or II (B) provided that:

                                        a. the nominee has been participating in
                                        the  management of the  dealership for a
                                        reasonable  period  of time and is named
                                        in  Paragraph  II  when  notice  of such
                                        termination is given, and

                                        b. if more  than  one  person  has  been
                                        nominated, Distributor in its discretion
                                        will   determine  to  which  nominee  or
                                        nominees  the  Interim  Sales  Agreement
                                        will be offered; or

                                   2. if there is no valid nominee,  then to the
                                   spouse  of  such  owner   together  with  any
                                   remaining  persons  named in Paragraph II (A)
                                   or (B) provided that managerial authority for
                                   the operation of the dealership will continue
                                   to be vested in the persons theretofore named
                                   in  Paragraph  II  (C),  if  any,  or in  the
                                   absence  of such  persons,  in other  persons
                                   mutually   agreeable   to  such   spouse  and
                                   Distributor.

                              B. Distributor will, within thirty (30) days after
                              it first  learned  of such  death  or  incapacity,
                              offer to a nominated successor under Clause 35 (A)
                              (1) or to the spouse  referred to in Clause 35 (A)
                              (2) the  one  year  Interim  Sales  Agreement  for
                              Company Products provided that:

                                        a. Dealer within thirty (30) days of the
                                        occurrence  of such death or  incapacity
                                        will have given notice to Distributor of
                                        such an occurrence, and

                                        b. in the event  that the person to whom
                                        an Interim  Sales  Agreement  is offered
                                        does not accept the same  within  thirty
                                        (30) days the offer  will  automatically
                                        expire.


                                                                              13

<PAGE>



                              C. The aforementioned Interim Sales Agreement will
                              be the same as  Distributor's  then standard Sales
                              Agreement  for Company  Products,  except that its
                              duration  will be  limited  to one (1)  year,  and
                              shall not be subject to renewal.  Distributor may,
                              in its discretion,  extend the term of any Interim
                              Sales  Agreement  to  facilitate  the  purchase by
                              others  of  the  former  owner's  interest  in the
                              dealer  ship.  At the  end of  any  Interim  Sales
                              Agreement,   Distributor   will   offer  its  then
                              standard form of Company  Products Sales Agreement
                              to the persons  named in  Paragraph  II (A) of the
                              Interim  Sales   Agreement,   provided  that  said
                              persons   then  possess  the   requisites   of  an
                              authorized dealer.


PARAGRAPH V                   A. This  Agreement in its entirety,  consisting of
                              14  pages,   has  been  read  and   agreed  to  by
                              Distributor and Dealer.  Notwithstanding  anything
                              to   the   contrary'    hereinabove   set   forth,
                              Distributor  has the  right to amend,  modify,  or
                              change  its  standard  Dealer  Sales   Agreements,
                              including  this  Agreement,   as  necessitated  by
                              legislation or governmental  regulation materially
                              affecting the relationship between Distributor and
                              Dealer existing on the date hereof.

                              B. This  Agreement  will not be binding  unless it
                              bears the  signatures  of an Executive  Officer of
                              Distributor  and of a person named in Paragraph II
                              (A) hereof on behalf of Dealer. 

                              IN WITNESS  WHEREOF the  parties  hereto have duly
                              executed  this  Agreement in  triplicate as of the
                              day and year first written.


Volvo Cars of North America, Inc.           Dealer
By /s/ William J Hoover                     By /s/ Richard S. Dyer, Jr.
   -----------------------------               ----------------------------
                William J Hoover                       Richard S. Dyer, Jr.
Title  Senior Vice President                Title  President
      --------------------------                  -------------------------


14

    

   


                             TOYOTA DEALER AGREEMENT


This is an Agreement between Southeast Toyota Distributors,  Inc. (DISTRIBUTOR),
and Marcus David Corporation (DEALER), a(n) [ ] individual, [ ] partnership, [X]
corporation. If a corporation, DEALER is duly incorporated in the State of North
Carolina and doing business as Town & Country Toyota.


                    PURPOSES AND OBJECTIVES OF THIS AGREEMENT


DISTRIBUTOR  sells Toyota Products which are  manufactured or approved by Toyota
Motor  Corporation  (FACTORY) and imported  and/or sold to DISTRIBUTOR by Toyota
Motor Sales, U.S.A., Inc.  (IMPORTER).  It is of vital importance to DISTRIBUTOR
that Toyota  Products are sold and serviced in a manner which promotes  consumer
confidence  and  satisfaction  and  leads  to  increased   product   acceptance.
Accordingly, DISTRIBUTOR has established a network of authorized Toyota dealers,
operating at approved locations and pursuant to certain  standards,  to sell and
service  Toyota  Products.   DEALER  desires  to  become  one  of  DISTRIBUTOR's
authorized  dealers.  Based upon the representations and promises of DEALER, set
forth  herein,  DISTRIBUTOR  agrees to appoint  DEALER as an  authorized  Toyota
dealer and welcomes  DEALER to  DISTRIBUTOR'S  network of authorized  dealers of
Toyota Products.

This  Agreement  sets forth the rights and  responsibilities  of  DISTRIBUTOR as
seller  and DEALER as buyer of Toyota  Products.  DISTRIBUTOR  enters  into this
Agreement in reliance upon DEALER's  integrity,  ability,  assurance of personal
services, expressed  intention to deal fairly with the consuming public and with
DISTRIBUTOR, and promise to adhere to the terms and conditions herein. Likewise,
DEALER  enters into this  Agreement in reliance  upon  DISTRIBUTOR'S  promise to
adhere to the terms and conditions herein.  DISTRIBUTOR and DEALER shall refrain
from  conduct  which  may  be  detrimental  to or  adversely  reflect  upon  the
reputation of the FACTORY, IMPORTER,  DISTRIBUTOR,  DEALER or Toyota Products in
general.  The parties  acknowledge that the success of the relationship  between
DISTRIBUTOR and DEALER depends upon the mutual  understanding and cooperation of
both DISTRIBUTOR and DEALER.


Dealer Code 32112


                                       1

<PAGE>


I.   RIGHTS GRANTED TO THE DEALER

     Subject to the terms of this  Agreement,  DISTRIBUTOR  hereby grants DEALER
     the non-exclusive right:

     A.   To buy and resell the Toyota Products identified in the Toyota Product
          Addendum hereto which may be periodically revised by IMPORTER;

     B.   To identify itself as an authorized  Toyota dealer utilizing  approved
          signage at the location(s) approved herein;

     C.   To use the  name  Toyota  and the  Toyota  Marks  in the  advertising,
          promotion,  sale and servicing of Toyota Products in the manner herein
          provided.

     DISTRIBUTOR  reserves the unrestricted right to sell Toyota Products and to
     grant the  privilege  of using the name Toyota or the Toyota Marks to other
     dealers or entities, wherever they may be located.

II.  RESPONSIBILITIES ACCEPTED BY THE DEALER

     DEALER accepts its  appointment  as an authorized  Toyota dealer and agrees
     to:

     A.   Sell and promote Toyota  Products  subject to the terms and conditions
          of this Agreement;

     B.   Service  Toyota  Products  subject to the terms and conditions of this
          Agreement;

     C.   Establish  and  maintain  satisfactory  dealership  facilities  at the
          location(s) set forth herein; and

     D.   Make all payments to DISTRIBUTOR when due.

III. TERM OF AGREEMENT

     This Agreement is effective this 6th day of August, 1996 and shall continue
     for a period  of (24)  Months , and shall  expire on August 5, 1998  unless
     ended earlier by mutual  agreement or terminated as provided  herein.  This
     Agreement may not be continued beyond its expiration date except by written
     consent of DISTRIBUTOR and IMPORTER.



                                       2

<PAGE>



IV.  OWNERSHIP OF DEALERSHIP

     This Agreement is a personal service Agreement and has been entered into by
     DISTRIBUTOR   in   reliance   upon  and  in   consideration   of   DEALER's
     representation  that only the  following  named  persons  are the Owners of
     DEALER, that such persons will serve in the capacities indicated,  and that
     such persons are committed to achieving the purposes, goals and commitments
     of this Agreement:

          OWNERS'                                            PERCENT OF
           NAMES                    TITLE                    OWNERSHIP
           -----                    -----                    ---------
     O. Bruton Smith                PRES                       80.0%
     William S. Egan                VP GM                      20.0%


V.   MANAGEMENT OF DEALERSHIP

     DISTRIBUTOR and DEALER agree that the retention of qualified  management is
     of critical  importance to satisfy the  commitments  made by DEALER in this
     Agreement.  DISTRIBUTOR,  therefore, enters into this Agreement in reliance
     upon  DEALER's  representation  that William S. Egan , and no other person,
     will  exercise the function of General  Manager,  be in complete  charge of
     DEALER'S  operations,  and will have  authority  to make all  decisions  on
     behalf of DEALER with respect to DEALER'S operations. DEALER further agrees
     that the General  Manager  shall devote his or her full efforts to DEALER'S
     operations.

VI.  CHANGE IN MANAGEMENT OR OWNERSHIP

     This is a personal  service  contract.  DISTRIBUTOR  has entered  into this
     Agreement because DEALER has represented to DISTRIBUTOR that the Owners and
     General   Manager  of  DEALER   identified   herein  possess  the  personal
     qualifications,  skill and commitment  necessary to ensure that DEALER will
     promote,  sell and service Toyota  Products in the most  effective  manner,
     enhance the Toyota image and increase market acceptance of Toyota Products.
     Because  DISTRIBUTOR has entered into this Agreement in reliance upon these
     representations  and DEALER's  assurances of the active involvement of such
     persons in DEALER operations,  any change in ownership,  no matter what the
     share or relationship  between  parties,  or any changes in General Manager
     from the person  specified  herein,  requires the prior written  consent of
     DISTRIBUTOR, which DISTRIBUTOR shall not unreasonably withhold.


                                       3

<PAGE>


     DEALER agrees that factors which would make  DISTRIBUTOR's  withholding  of
     consent reasonable would include, without limitation,  the failure of a new
     Owner or General  Manager to meet  DISTRIBUTOR'S  standards  with regard to
     financial  capability,  experience and success in the automobile dealership
     business.

VII. APPROVED DEALER LOCATIONS

     In order that  DISTRIBUTOR may establish and maintain an effective  network
     of  authorized  Toyota  dealers,  DEALER  agrees that it shall  conduct its
     Toyota operation only and exclusively in facilities and at locations herein
     designated and approved by DISTRIBUTOR. DISTRIBUTOR  hereby  designates and
     approves the following facilities as the exclusive location(s) for the sale
     and servicing of Toyota Products and the display of Toyota Marks:

     New Vehicle Sales and Showroom             Used Vehicle Display and Sales
     ------------------------------             ------------------------------

      9101 South Boulevard                       9101 South Boulevard
      Charlotte, NC 28224                        Charlotte, NC 28224

     Sales and General Office                   Body and Paint
     ------------------------                   --------------
      Same as above                              Same as above

     Parts                                      Service
     -----                                      -------
      Same as above                              Same as above

     Other Facilities
     ----------------
      Storage
      Same as above


     DEALER may not,  either  directly or  indirectly,  display  Toyota Marks or
     establish  or  conduct  any  dealership  operations  contemplated  by  this
     Agreement, including the display, sale and servicing of Toyota Products, at
     any location or facility other than those approved herein without the prior
     written consent of  DISTRIBUTOR.  DEALER may not modify or change the usage
     or  function  of any  location or  facility  approved  herein or  otherwise
     utilize  such  locations or  facilities  for any  functions  other than the
     approved function(s) without the prior written consent of DISTRIBUTOR.

VIII. PRIMARY MARKET AREA

     DISTRIBUTOR  will assign DEALER a geographic  area called a Primary  Market
     Area  ("PMA").  The  PMA  is  used  by  DISTRIBUTOR  to  evaluate  DEALER's
     performance of its obligations,


                                        4


<PAGE>


     among other  things.  DEALER  agrees that it has no exclusive  right to any
     such PMA.  DISTRIBUTOR  may add new dealers,  relocate  dealers,  or adjust
     DEALER'S PMA as it reasonably determines is necessary.  DEALER'S PMA is set
     forth on the PMA Addendum hereto.

     Nothing contained in this Agreement,  with the exception of Section XIV(B),
     shall limit or be construed to limit the geographical area in which, or the
     persons to whom, DEALER may sell or promote the sale of Toyota products.

IX.  STANDARD PROVISIONS

     The "Toyota Dealer Agreement Standard  Provisions" are incorporated  herein
     and made part of this Agreement as if fully set forth herein.

X.   ADDITIONAL PROVISIONS

     In  consideration  of  DISTRIBUTOR'S  agreement  to  appoint  DEALER  as an
     authorized Toyota dealer, DEALER further agrees:

     1)   Dealer agrees to achieve,  prior to the  expiration of this  Agreement
          and to thereafter  maintain throughout the duration of this Agreement,
          Toyota car and truck penetration in its Primary Market Area that is at
          least equal to the Region's penetration rate.

     2)   Dealer agrees to achieve 100 percent car sales efficiency prior to the
          expiration of this  Agreement  and to thereafter  maintain 100 percent
          car sales efficiency throughout the duration of this Agreement.

     3)   Dealer agrees to achieve and maintain, prior to the expiration of this
          Agreement,  a  satisfactory  customer  satisfaction  performance,   as
          measured  by all  applicable  standards  established  by Toyota  Motor
          Sales, U. S. A., Inc., and which are modified from time to time.

     4)   If,  at any  time  during  the  term  of  this  Agreement,  all of the
          Additional   Provisions   set  forth  above  have  been  attained  and
          maintained  for a  continuous  period of six (6) months and dealer has
          complied   with   Distributor's   policies   concerning   truck  sales
          efficiency,  profitability,  Net Working Capital,  debt-to-equity  and
          facility, then Distributor will immediately recommend to Importer that
          dealer be granted a Six (6) Year Renewal Agreement.


                                       5


<PAGE>


XI.  EXECUTION OF AGREEMENT

     Notwithstanding  any other provision herein, the parties to this Agreement,
     DISTRIBUTOR  and  DEALER,  agree  that  this  Agreement  shall be valid and
     binding only if it is signed:

     A.   On behalf of DEALER by a duly authorized person;

     B.   On behalf of DISTRIBUTOR by the President and/or an authorized General
          Manager, if any, of DISTRIBUTOR, and

     C.   On  behalf  of  IMPORTER,   solely  in  connection  with  its  limited
          undertaking herein, by President of IMPORTER

XII. CERTIFICATION

     By their  signatures  hereto,  the  parties  agree  that they have read and
     understand this Agreement,  including the Standard Provisions  incorporated
     herein,  are committed to its purposes and objectives and agree to abide by
     all of its terms and conditions.


              Marcus David Corporation d/b/a
              Town & Country Toyota
     ---------------------------------------------------------------------DEALER
                              (Dealer Entity Name)

     Date:   6/20/96   By: /s/ O. Bruton Smith                Pres. 
          ------------    ---------------------------  -----------------------
                                   Signature                  Title


     Date:             By:                             
          ------------    ---------------------------  -----------------------
                                   Signature                  Title

              Southeast Toyota Distributors, Inc.
     ----------------------------------------------------------------DISTRIBUTOR
                                (Distributor Name


     Date:   7/3/96    By: /s/ John Williams, Jr.         General Manager 
          ------------    ---------------------------  -----------------------
                                   Signature                  Title
                               John Williams, Jr.

     Date:             By:                             
          ------------    ---------------------------  -----------------------
                                   Signature                  Title


                                       6

<PAGE>



Undertaking by IMPORTER: In the event of termination of this Agreement by virtue
of termination or expiration of DISTRIBUTOR's contract with IMPORTER,  IMPORTER,
through its  designee,  will offer  DEALER a new  agreement  of no less than one
year's  duration and  containing  the terms of the Toyota Dealer  Agreement then
prescribed by IMPORTER


                        TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.

Date:  8/6/96          By:  /s/ Y. Ishizaka                      President
      ----------------     --------------------------------  -------------------
                                Y. Ishizaka    Signature           Title






                                       7


<PAGE>


                                       Map

                       CHARLOTTE M - TOWN & COUNTRY TOYOTA
                      PMA Shaded/ZIP codes outlined in Blue

                                [GRAPHIC OMITTED]





<PAGE>


                                       Map

                       CHARLOTTE M - TOWN & COUNTRY TOYOTA
                      PMA Shaded/ZIP codes outlined in Blue

                                [GRAPHIC OMITTED]



<PAGE>

                                       Map

                       CHARLOTTE M - TOWN & COUNTRY TOYOTA
                   PMA Shaded/Census Tracts outlined in Black

                                [GRAPHIC OMITTED]



<PAGE>



DEFINITION:   A-ORIGINAL DATE:  07/30/97


PMA 0503100012000001 TOWN & COUNTRY TOYOTA ZIP / ZIP*
  p28130  28134  28202  28203  28208  28209  28210   28214  28216  28217  p28219
  p28220  p28224 28226  p28228 p2823O p28231 p28232  p28233 p28234 p28235 
  p28236  p28237  p2824 p28242 p28243 p28244 p28246  p28247 p28250 p28255  
  p2826O  p28261 p28265 p28266 p28272 p28274 p28275  28277  p28280 p28281 
  p28282  p28283 p28284 p28285 p28286 p28287 p28288 p28289  p28290 p28296 
  p28297
  28078(45%)   28105(20%)   28110(2%)   28112(10%)  28173(89%)   28204(40%)
  28206(12%)   28207(46%)   28211(35%)  28269(8%)   28273(95%)   28278(10%)
  29715(53%)   29720(29%)

DEFINTION:    A-ORIGINAL DATE:  07/30/96

PMA 0503100012000001 TOWN & COUNTRY TOYOTA Tract / Tract*
  37-119-1 2 3 4 5 6 26 27 29.01 29.03 29.04 30.05 30.06 30.07
  30.08 30.09 31.02 31.03 31.04 31.05 32.98 33 34 35 36 37 38.03
  38.04 38.98 39.01 39.02 40 41 42 43.01 43.02 44 45 46 47 48 49
  50 54.01 58.06 58.07 58.08 58.09 58.10 59.01 59.03 60.01 60.02
  61 62.02 37-179-210 45-57-111 112 45-91-610.01


<PAGE>



                                  TOYOTA DEALER
                      MINIMUM NET WORKING CAPITAL AGREEMENT


THIS AGREEMENT, made as of the 13th day of December, by and between MARCUS DAVID
CORPORATION  DBA TOWN & COUNTRY TOYOTA a(as) ___ Individual  ___Partnership  _X_
Corporation,  located  at 9101  SOUTH  BLVD.  CHARLOTTE  NC  Dealer  Code  32112
(hereinafter  called "DEALER") and SOUTHEAST TOYOTA,  INC.  (hereinafter  called
"DISTRIBUTOR").

DEALER and  DISTRIBUTOR  have entered into a Toyota Dealer  Agreement dated June
20, 1994 and net working capital requirements have been established in an effort
to ensure that there is sufficient capital available for the growth of a dealer.
The net working capital requirements are the established minimums. The term "net
working  capital" shall mean the difference  between  current assets and current
liabilities plus the current portion of long-term debt.

DEALER and DISTRIBUTOR mutually agree as follows:

     1.   That it is considered  necessary for the proper  operation of DEALER's
          business that DEALER should have,  maintain and actually employ in its
          business $1,370,635 of net working capital.

     2.   That as of the 21 ST day of NOVEMBER 1995 ,DEALER meets or exceeds the
          Net Working Capital requirement as documented on DEALER's OCTOBER 1995
          Year-To-Date Financial Statement or Pro Forma dated_________________.

                                       OR

     3.   That as of the _____day of _______ , DEALER is deficient $_________ in
          Net Working Capital,  as documented on DEALER'S _______,  Year-To-Date
          Financial Statement.

          Dealer is required to remedy the Net Working  deficiency  as stated in
          Paragraph 3 above no later than ____________

     4.   If,  because of changed  conditions,  it should  become  necessary  to
          revise  the  minimum  amount  of  net  working  capital  deemed  to be
          necessary to conduct DEALER's  business  properly,  DISTRIBUTOR  shall
          have  the  right  to  revise  DEALER's  minimum  net  working  capital
          requirement to be used in dealership's  operation and DEALER agrees to
          meet the new standard within a reasonable period of time.

     5.   This  Agreement is  incorporated  in and made a part of the  aforesaid
          Toyota Dealer  Agreement and any  subsequent  Toyota Dealer  Agreement
          entered into between DEALER and DISTRIBUTOR.


DEALER:                                     DISTRIBUTOR:

MARCUS DAVID CORPORATION DBA TOWN & COUNTRY TOYOTA       SOUTHEAST TOYOTA, INC.
- --------------------------------------------------      ------------------------
               DEALER ENTITY NAME                          DISTRIBUTOR NAME


By  /s/  [illegible]                                    By /s/ [illegible]
   ------------------------------                         ----------------------


              V.P.                                          General Manager
   ------------------------------                       ------------------------
             Title                                              Title

    

   
<PAGE>
                                                                    EXHIBIT 21.1
 
                     SUBSIDIARIES OF SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.
 
1. Town and Country Ford, Inc.
State of Incorporation: North Carolina
 
2. Marcus David Corporation d/b/a Town & Country Toyota
State of Incorporation: North Carolina
 
3. Frontier Oldsmobile-Cadillac, Inc.
State of Incorporation: North Carolina
 
4. Fort Mill Ford, Inc.
State of Organization: South Carolina
 
5. Fort Mill Chrysler-Plymouth-Dodge Inc.
State of Incorporation: South Carolina
 
6. Lone Star Ford, Inc.
State of Incorporation: Texas
 
7. Sonic Dodge, LLC
State of Incorporation: North Carolina
 
8. Sonic Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep-Eagle, LLC
State of Incorporation: North Carolina
 
9. Sonic Automotive of Nevada, Inc.
State of Incorporation: Nevada

10. Sonic Automotive of Tennessee, Inc.
State of Incorporation: Tennessee

11. Sonic Automotive --  6025 International Drive, LLC
State of Organization: Tennessee

12. Sonic Automotive of Nashville, LLC
State of Organization: Tennessee

13. Sonic Automotive of Chattanooga, LLC
State of Organization: Tennessee

14. Town and Country Jaguar, LLC
State of Organization: Tennessee

15. Town and Country Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep, LLC
State of Organization: Tennessee

16. Town and Country Dodge of Chattanooga, LLC
State of Organization: Tennessee

17. Sonic Automotive -- 2490 South Lee Highway, LLC
State of Organization: Tennessee

18. Town and Country Ford of Cleveland, LLC
State of Organization: Tennessee

19. Sonic Automotive 5260 Peachtree Industrial Blvd., LLC
State of Organization: Georgia

20. Ken Marks Ford, Inc.
State of Incorporation: Florida

21. Town and Country Chrysler-Plymouth-Jeep of Rock Hill, Inc.
State of Incorporation: South Carolina
    




<PAGE>
                                                                    EXHIBIT 23.1
                         INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' CONSENT
To the Board of Directors and Stockholders
Sonic Automotive, Inc.
   
     We consent to the use in this Amendment No. 7 to the Registration Statement
relating to shares of Class A Common Stock of Sonic Automotive, Inc. on Form S-1
of (i) our report dated October 16, 1997 on the combined financial statements of
Sonic Automotive, Inc. and Affiliated Companies as of December 31, 1995 and 1996
and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1996; (ii) our
report dated August 7, 1997 on the financial statements of Dyer & Dyer, Inc. as
of December 31, 1995 and 1996 and for each of the three years in the period
ended December 31, 1996; (iii) our report dated August 7, 1997 (October 16, 1997
as to Note 1) on the combined financial statements of Bowers Dealerships and
Affiliated Companies as of December 31, 1995 and 1996 and for the years then
ended; (iv) our report dated August 7, 1997 (September 29, 1997 as to Note 1) on
the combined financial statements of Lake Norman Dodge, Inc. and Affiliated
Companies as of and for the year ended December 31, 1996; and (v) our report
dated August 26, 1997 (October 15, 1997 as to Note 1) on the financial
statements of Ken Marks Ford, Inc. as of and for the year ended April 30, 1997
appearing in the Prospectus, which is a part of this Amendment No. 7 to the
Registration Statement, and to the reference to us under the heading "Experts"
in such Prospectus.
    
DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
   
Charlotte, North Carolina
November 5, 1997
    

   

                   RESERVE SHARE PROGRAM DOCUMENTATION
 
                                                    "MERRILL LYNCH COVER LETTER"

[LOGO] MERRILL LYNCH

                                                              October ____, 1997



To    Directors, Officers, Employees, Business Associates and
      Related Persons of Sonic Automotive, Inc.:

         In connection with the recent filing with the Securities and Exchange
Commission of a Registration Statement relating to a proposed offering of shares
of Class A Common Stock of Sonic Automotive, Inc. (the "Company"), we are
sending you at the request of the Company a copy of the preliminary prospectus
included in the registration statement and the enclosed letter of the Company
describing the reservation of shares of Common Stock for certain directors,
officers, employees, business associates and related persons of the Company,
along with certain related materials.

         If you have any questions regarding the details of the enclosed
material or the preliminary prospectus, please contact your present Merrill
Lynch Financial Consultant or the Reserved Share Program Hotline at (212)
449-8209 between the hours of 8:00 a.m. and 6:00 p.m. Eastern time, Monday
through Friday.


                                   Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                                                Incorporated


<PAGE>


                                                                  "C.E.O.LETTER"

                        Sonic Automotive, Inc. Letterhead


October ____, 1997

TO:    Directors,  Officers,  Employees,  Business Associates
       and Related Persons of Sonic Automotive, Inc.

                  A Registration Statement providing for a public offering of
shares of Class A Common Stock of Sonic Automotive, Inc. (the "Company") has
been filed with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.

                  The offering will be made through a group of underwriters
including Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated ("Merrill Lynch").
In the course of its discussions with the underwriters, the Company has arranged
to reserve a limited number of shares of the Company's Class A Common Stock for
purchase by directors, officers, employees, business associates and related
persons of the Company. The purchase price to you will be the same as the
offering price to the public, which is presently expected to be between $_______
and $_______ per share.

                  Enclosed for your information is a copy of the preliminary
prospectus dated October ____, 1997, which is part of the Registration
Statement. No sales of the Class A Common Stock may be made until the
Registration Statement has been declared effective by the United States
Securities and Exchange Commission and the price per share of the Common Stock
has been determined. This is expected to occur on or about October ___, 1997.

                  If, after reading the preliminary prospectus, you have an
interest in purchasing shares in the public offering, please complete the
enclosed Expression of Interest Form, Participant Information Form and NASD
Questionnaire. If you would be purchasing stock through a joint account, the
joint account holder must also complete, sign and return the Joint Account
Holder Questionnaire attached. All forms must be returned to: Merrill Lynch,
Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, 250 Vesey Street, 14th Floor, New York, New
York 10281, Attention: Sonic Automotive, Inc. Reserved Share Program so that
they are received no later than October ___, 1997. (You may send completed forms
to Merrill Lynch by fax at (800) 825-3705 as long as you send manually executed
copies to Merrill Lynch by first class mail on the same day.) DO NOT SEND MONEY
NOW. A list of the most commonly asked questions about the Reserved Share
Program, along with the answers to those questions, is enclosed. If you have any
other questions, please call the Reserved Share Program Hotline at Merrill Lynch
at (212) 449-8209 between the hours of 8:00 a.m. and 6:00 p.m. Eastern time,
Monday through Friday.

                  You are permitted to reserve shares only for your own personal
account and not on behalf of any other person or any business account, although
you may choose to

<PAGE>
                                                                  "C.E.O.LETTER"


purchase jointly with a member of your immediate family. The shares may not be
purchased on margin. Given the limited number of shares available, we cannot
assure you that you will obtain the number of shares requested. Further, all
such reservations and ultimate sales are subject to final clearance under
federal and state securities laws and the rules and regulations of the National
Association of Securities Dealers, Inc.; it cannot be determined at this time
whether such clearances will be obtained.

                  In the event that the aggregate expressions of interest exceed
the maximum number of shares reserved for the program, shares of Class A Common
Stock will be allocated in a manner to be determined. In addition, certain
individuals may be required, as a condition to their purchase of Class A Common
Stock, to agree in writing not to offer, sell, or otherwise dispose of their
shares for a period of three months after the date of the public offering.

                  Arrangements have been made with Merrill Lynch to handle the
sale of the reserved shares. If you complete and return an Expression of
Interest Form, Participant Information Form and NASD Questionnaire (and Joint
Account Holder Questionnaire, if applicable), a Merrill Lynch Financial
Consultant will contact you to assist you in opening a Merrill Lynch brokerage
account if you do not currently have one. Purchases of reserved shares may be
made only through a brokerage account at Merrill Lynch. While your purchase of
shares of the Company's Class A Common Stock will not be subject to normal
brokerage commissions, your account at Merrill Lynch will be subject to Merrill
Lynch's normal account charges. Merrill Lynch will need all the information
requested on the enclosed form, so be certain to complete it in all respects. It
is the policy and the practice of Merrill Lynch to afford confidentiality to any
information that it receives about a client's financial affairs. Aside from the
restrictions on the dissemination and use of proprietary information contained
in the federal securities laws, Merrill Lynch has a firm policy that prohibits
Merrill Lynch employees from discussing or conveying, even by implication, the
affairs of any client with or to other Merrill Lynch employees who are not
concerned with the matter.

                  After the Registration Statement is declared effective, and
assuming you have been approved by any required regulatory authority to receive
shares, you will be orally informed of the purchase price by a representative of
Merrill Lynch and asked if you wish to purchase the Class A Common Stock. At
that time you may confirm your intention to purchase the number of shares you
have previously indicated, confirm your intention to purchase Class A Common
Stock but specify a smaller number (subject to a minimum of ___ shares) or
decide to purchase no shares at all. If you orally confirm your intention to
purchase shares, a copy of the Prospectus, in final form, will be sent to you by
Merrill Lynch together with a written confirmation of the sale. UPON YOUR
RECEIPT OF WRITTEN CONFIRMATION OF THE PURCHASE YOU WILL HAVE ENTERED INTO A
BINDING LEGAL CONTRACT TO PURCHASE THE SHARES, AND YOU MUST PURCHASE AND PAY FOR
THEM. Full payment of the purchase price of your shares will be required
promptly after you receive such confirmation or at the latest within three (3)
business days after effectiveness of the Registration Statement.

<PAGE>
                                                                  "C.E.O.LETTER"

                  No offer to buy Class A Common Stock can be accepted and no
part of the purchase price can be received by Merrill Lynch until the
Registration Statement relating to the Class A Common Stock has become effective
under the Securities Act of 1933. ANY SUCH OFFER TO BUY MAY BE WITHDRAWN OR
REVOKED, WITHOUT OBLIGATION OR COMMITMENT OF ANY KIND, AT ANY TIME PRIOR TO
NOTICE OF ITS ACCEPTANCE GIVEN AFTER THE EFFECTIVE DATE OF THE REGISTRATION
STATEMENT. AN EXPRESSION OF INTEREST IN RESPONSE TO THIS LETTER WILL INVOLVE NO
OBLIGATION OR COMMITMENT.

                  The following statement is required to be included in this
letter by the rules and regulations of the United States Securities and Exchange
Commission:

                  "A Registration Statement relating to these securities has
                  been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission but has
                  not yet become effective. These securities may not be sold nor
                  may offers to buy be accepted prior to the time the
                  Registration Statement becomes effective. This letter shall
                  not constitute an offer to sell or the solicitation of an
                  offer to buy nor shall there be any sale of these securities
                  in any state in which such offer, solicitation or sale would
                  be unlawful prior to registration or qualification under the
                  securities laws of any such state."

                  The Company does not wish to influence in any way your
decision in this matter. This notice is not designed to encourage you to request
any shares of Class A Common Stock. It is simply intended to inform you that
there is a proposed offering, should you be interested in investing. The
purchase of shares of Class A Common Stock involves certain risks which are
described in the enclosed preliminary prospectus. Please review the preliminary
prospectus carefully and discuss it with your financial advisor, if appropriate.

                                                  Sincerely,



                                                  [Chief Executive Officer]



<PAGE>


                                                  "PARTICIPANT INFORMATION FORM"


                          PARTICIPANT INFORMATION FORM

                RESERVED SHARE PROGRAM FOR SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.

PLEASE COMPLETE THE FOLLOWING: (PRINT OR TYPE)

Last Name:

First Name:                                             Middle Initial:

Home Address:

City:                                    State:             Zip:

Telephone  (Include Area Code):  Business:  (      )        Home: (      )

Citizen of What Country?                   Social Security Number:

Have you attained the age of majority in the state in which you reside? 
                                                           Yes          No
    (The age of majority is 18 in all states except for the following:
    Alabama - 19; Mississippi - 21; Nebraska - 19; and Puerto Rico - 21)

Do you have an account with Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated?

If yes, Address of Branch:                          Account Number:

Is it a Joint Account? Yes   No
If yes, what is the name of the joint account holder?

Name of Financial Consultant:         Financial Consultant #:  __ __ __ __

NOTE: If purchases are contemplated to be made through this or any joint
account, the Joint Account Holder Questionnaire must be completed and signed by
the co-holder of the account.

Name of Your Employer:

Your Position:

If your employer is not Sonic Automotive, Inc. (the "Company"), briefly describe
your employer's relationship, or your relationship, with the Company (nature of
services provided or goods supplied, frequency of contact, etc.)




Signature:                                               Date:



<PAGE>


                                                   "EXPRESSION OF INTEREST FORM"


                           EXPRESSION OF INTEREST FORM

                RESERVED SHARE PROGRAM FOR SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC.


Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated
World Financial Center, North Tower                                  PIN:

250 Vesey Street, 14th Floor
New York, New York 10281                                             NAME:

Attention: Michael Conigliaro / Claire Taggart
                                                                     REF:


Ladies and Gentlemen:

                  I am interested in purchasing __________ shares (not less than
_______ or more than ______ and in blocks of 10) of Class A Common Stock of
Sonic Automotive, Inc. and would like such number of shares to be reserved for
me. I acknowledge that:

1. I have received and read my copy of the preliminary prospectus dated October
____ 1997.

2.   The number of shares requested is for my own personal account or my joint
     account with a member of my immediate family and not on behalf of any other
     person.

3.   I am not assured of obtaining any or all of the shares requested and I will
     be notified of the number of shares, if any, available for purchase by me.

4.   No offer to buy any shares can be accepted and no part of the purchase
     price can be received by Merrill Lynch until the Registration Statement
     covering the proposed offering has been declared effective by the United
     States Securities and Exchange Commission and until the shares have been
     qualified for sale, where required, by the administrative authorities of
     the jurisdiction in which I reside, and any such offer may be withdrawn or
     revoked, without obligation or commitment of any kind, at any time prior to
     notice of its acceptance at or after the effective date of the Registration
     Statement. This indication of interest involves no obligation or
     commitment.

5.   By signing below, I certify that all the information I have provided on
     this form is complete and accurate to the best of my knowledge.



- ---------------------------------            ----------------------------------
      (Signature)                                            (Date)


- ---------------------------------            ----------------------------------
       (Print Name)                                       (Employer)

IF YOU ARE INTERESTED IN RESERVING SHARES, YOU MUST COMPLETE THIS FORM, THE
PARTICIPANT INFORMATION FORM AND THE NASD QUESTIONNAIRE (AND YOUR JOINT ACCOUNT
HOLDER, IF ANY, MUST COMPLETE THE JOINT ACCOUNT HOLDER NASD QUESTIONNAIRE) AND
RETURN THEM TO MERRILL LYNCH SO THAT THEY ARE RECEIVED NO LATER THAN OCTOBER
___, 1997.


<PAGE>


                                                           "NASD QUESTIONNAIRE"




                               NASD QUESTIONNAIRE


Last Name:                   First Name:                    Middle Initial:


PLEASE ANSWER THE FOLLOWING QUESTIONS IN THE SPACES PROVIDED:

(IMPORTANT: YOU MUST ANSWER ALL OF THESE QUESTIONS IN ORDER TO RESERVE SHARES
FOR PURCHASE. IF YOU WISH TO PURCHASE SHARES JOINTLY THROUGH A JOINT ACCOUNT,
THE OTHER PERSON ON THE ACCOUNT MUST COMPLETE AND SIGN THE JOINT ACCOUNT HOLDER
QUESTIONNAIRE ACCOMPANYING THIS FORM.)

DEFINITIONS: FOR PURPOSES OF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS, CAPITALIZED WORDS HAVE
THE FOLLOWING MEANING:

IMMEDIATE FAMILY: As used in the statements that follow, the term "Immediate
Family" includes a person's parents, mother-in-law or father-in-law, husband or
wife, brother or sister, brother-in-law or sister-in-law, son-in-law or
daughter-in-law, and children.

ASSOCIATED PERSON: As used in the statements that follow, a person is an
"Associated Person" of a broker-dealer if he or she is a sole proprietor,
partner, officer, director, or branch manager of any broker-dealer in
securities, foreign or domestic, or any natural person occupying a similar
status or performing similar functions, or any natural person engaged in the
investment banking or securities business who is directly or indirectly
controlling or controlled by such a broker-dealer (for example, any employee),
whether or not such person is registered or exempt from registration with the
National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. or any other regulatory
organization.

INSTITUTIONAL TYPE ACCOUNT: As used in the following statements, "Institutional
Type Account" generally includes any corporation or other entity which is
involved as part of its business in the buying and selling of securities.





NOTE: YOU MUST WRITE YOUR NAME AND SOCIAL SECURITY NUMBER IN THE TRACKING BOX
      ON EACH PAGE OF THIS QUESTIONNAIRE.




                                             -----------------------------------
                                                     For Tracking Purposes:
                                             Last Name:
                                             First Name:
- - 1 -                                        Social Security #:
                                             -----------------------------------

<PAGE>

                                                            "NASD QUESTIONNAIRE"


IF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS ARE TRUE, PLEASE PLACE AN "X" ON THE LINE NEXT TO
"TRUE". IF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS ARE NOT TRUE, PLEASE PLACE AN "X" ON THE
LINE NEXT TO "FALSE" AND PROVIDE THE INFORMATION REQUESTED.
YOU MUST ANSWER QUESTIONS 1 THROUGH 6.

                             BROKER-DEALER QUESTIONS

1.       I am NOT an officer, director, general partner, shareholder, employee
         or agent of any broker-dealer in securities or otherwise an ASSOCIATED
         PERSON of any broker-dealer in securities, except for a broker-dealer
         engaged solely in the purchase or sale of either investment
         company/variable contracts securities or direct participation program
         securities.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the broker-dealer and your
position.




2.       In addition, I am NOT materially supported directly or indirectly by an
         IMMEDIATE FAMILY MEMBER or any other person who is an officer,
         director, general partner, shareholder, employee, agent or ASSOCIATED
         PERSON of any broker-dealer in securities, except for a broker-dealer
         engaged solely in the purchase or sale of either investment
         company/variable contracts securities or direct participation program
         securities.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the broker-dealer, the position
with such broker-dealer of the person materially supporting you, the
relationship of that person to you, and please describe the nature of such
support.




3.       I am NOT an IMMEDIATE FAMILY MEMBER of an officer, director, general
         partner, shareholder, employee, agent or ASSOCIATED PERSON of any
         broker-dealer in securities, except for a broker-dealer engaged solely
         in the purchase or sale of either investment company/variable contracts
         securities or direct participation program securities.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the broker-dealer employing
such immediate family member, the position of that person with such
broker-dealer, and that person's relationship to you.


                                             -----------------------------------
                                                     For Tracking Purposes:
                                             Last Name:
                                             First Name:
- - 2 -                                        Social Security #:
                                             -----------------------------------

<PAGE>

                                                            "NASD QUESTIONNAIRE"

                            FINDER/FIDUCIARY QUESTION

4.       I am NOT, nor am I supported to a material extent by, a person who is
         either a finder with respect to the public offering of the Class A
         Common Stock or a person acting in a fiduciary capacity to Merrill
         Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, the managing underwriter
         for the public offering, including attorneys, accountants and financial
         consultants to, Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the finder or person acting in
a fiduciary capacity, whether the person is a finder or fiduciary, the capacity
in which such person is acting, and describe the relationship of that person to
you (or indicate that you are such person).




                      INSTITUTIONAL TYPE ACCOUNT QUESTIONS

5.       I am NOT, nor am I materially supported by, a senior officer of a bank,
         savings and loan institution, insurance company, investment company,
         investment advisory firm or any other INSTITUTIONAL TYPE ACCOUNT.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the company employing such
person, the type of company it is, the employee's position with that company,
and describe the relationship of that person to you (or indicate that you are
such person).




6.       I am NOT a person, nor am I materially supported by any person, who
         works in the securities department of, or who may influence, or whose
         activities directly or indirectly involve or are related to, the
         function of buying or selling securities for any bank, savings and loan
         institution, insurance company, investment company, investment advisory
         firm or any other INSTITUTIONAL TYPE ACCOUNT.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the company employing such
person, the type of company it is, the employee's position with that company,
and describe the relationship of that person to you (or indicate that you are
such person).

                                             -----------------------------------
                                                     For Tracking Purposes:
                                             Last Name:
                                             First Name:
- - 3 -                                        Social Security #:
                                             -----------------------------------

<PAGE>
                                                           "NASD QUESTIONNAIRE"

IF YOU HAVE ANSWERED "FALSE" TO ANY OF THE QUESTIONS ABOVE, PLEASE ANSWER THE
FOLLOWING QUESTION:

                       SECURITY BROKERAGE ACCOUNT QUESTION

7.       Do you have an account with any broker-dealer in which you have
         actively traded equity securities in the last 12 months?

YES________ NO________ If YES, please name the broker-dealer and describe your
trading activity over this period, including the date you purchased or sold
equity securities, the name of the issuer of the security, the number of shares
purchased or sold, the price per share and the total purchase or sale price. You
should include trading activity (other than the purchase of mutual fund shares)
in any 401(k) or other retirement account.
Please type or print legibly. Attach additional sheets if necessary.


                     Buy/                                 Price/
Date    Broker       Sell      Issuer         Shares      Share     Total Price




























         Signature                                     Date

         Print Name

================================================================================
         NOTE: YOU MUST SIGN THIS FORM, WHETHER OR NOT YOU HAVE ANSWERED
                               QUESTION 7, ABOVE.
================================================================================

                                             -----------------------------------
                                                     For Tracking Purposes:
                                             Last Name:
                                             First Name:
- - 4 -                                        Social Security #:
                                             -----------------------------------

<PAGE>

                                                            "NASD QUESTIONNAIRE"


                     JOINT ACCOUNT HOLDER NASD QUESTIONNAIRE

          (TO BE COMPLETED BY THE CO-HOLDER OF A JOINT ACCOUNT, IF ANY)

IF YOU WOULD BE PURCHASING THE CLASS A COMMON STOCK THROUGH A JOINT ACCOUNT,
PLEASE HAVE THE CO-HOLDER OF YOUR JOINT ACCOUNT COMPLETE AND SIGN THIS FORM.


Last Name:                        First Name:                Middle Initial:

Relationship to Primary Account Holder:

PLEASE ANSWER THE FOLLOWING QUESTIONS IN THE SPACES PROVIDED:

(IMPORTANT: YOU MUST ANSWER ALL OF THESE QUESTIONS IN ORDER TO RESERVE SHARES
 FOR PURCHASE.)

DEFINITIONS:  FOR PURPOSES OF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS, CAPITALIZED WORDS HAVE
THE FOLLOWING MEANING:

IMMEDIATE FAMILY: As used in the statements that follow, the term "Immediate
Family" includes a person's parents, mother-in-law or father-in-law, husband or
wife, brother or sister, brother-in-law or sister-in-law, son-in-law or
daughter-in-law, and children.

ASSOCIATED PERSON: As used in the statements that follow, a person is an
"Associated Person" of a broker-dealer if he or she is a sole proprietor,
partner, officer, director, or branch manager of any broker-dealer in
securities, foreign or domestic, or any natural person occupying a similar
status or performing similar functions, or any natural person engaged in the
investment banking or securities business who is directly or indirectly
controlling or controlled by such a broker-dealer (for example, any employee),
whether or not such person is registered or exempt from registration with the
National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. or any other regulatory
organization.

INSTITUTIONAL TYPE ACCOUNT: As used in the following statements, "Institutional
Type Account" generally includes any corporation or other entity which is
involved as part of its business in the buying and selling of securities.


NOTE: YOU MUST WRITE YOUR NAME AND SOCIAL SECURITY NUMBER IN THE TRACKING
      BOX ON EACH PAGE OF THIS QUESTIONNAIRE.


                                             -----------------------------------
                                                     For Tracking Purposes:
                                             Last Name:
                                             First Name:
- - 5 -                                        Social Security #:
                                             -----------------------------------

<PAGE>

                                                    "FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS"

IF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS ARE TRUE, PLEASE PLACE AN "X" ON THE LINE NEXT TO
"TRUE". IF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS ARE NOT TRUE, PLEASE PLACE AN "X" ON THE
LINE NEXT TO "FALSE" AND PROVIDE THE INFORMATION REQUESTED.
YOU MUST ANSWER QUESTIONS 1 THROUGH 6.

                             BROKER-DEALER QUESTIONS

1.       I am NOT an officer, director, general partner, shareholder, employee
         or agent of any broker-dealer in securities or otherwise an ASSOCIATED
         PERSON of any broker-dealer in securities, except for a broker-dealer
         engaged solely in the purchase or sale of either investment
         company/variable contracts securities or direct participation program
         securities.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the broker-dealer and your
position.




2.       In addition, I am NOT materially supported directly or indirectly by an
         IMMEDIATE FAMILY MEMBER or any other person who is an officer,
         director, general partner, shareholder, employee, agent or ASSOCIATED
         PERSON of any broker-dealer in securities, except for a broker-dealer
         engaged solely in the purchase or sale of either investment
         company/variable contracts securities or direct participation program
         securities.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the broker-dealer, the position
with such broker-dealer of the person materially supporting you, the
relationship of that person to you, and please describe the nature of such
support.




3.       I am NOT an IMMEDIATE FAMILY MEMBER of an officer, director, general
         partner, shareholder, employee, agent or ASSOCIATED PERSON of any
         broker-dealer in securities, except for a broker-dealer engaged solely
         in the purchase or sale of either investment company/variable contracts
         securities or direct participation program securities.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the broker-dealer employing
such immediate family member, the position of that person with such
broker-dealer, and that person's relationship to you.



                                             -----------------------------------
                                                     For Tracking Purposes:
                                             Last Name:
                                             First Name:
- - 6 -                                        Social Security #:
                                             -----------------------------------

<PAGE>

                                                    "FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS"


                            FINDER/FIDUCIARY QUESTION

4.       I am NOT, nor am I supported to a material extent by, a person who is
         either a finder with respect to the public offering of the Class A
         Common Stock or a person acting in a fiduciary capacity to Merrill
         Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, the managing underwriter
         for the public offering, including attorneys, accountants and financial
         consultants to Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the finder or person acting in
a fiduciary capacity, whether the person is a finder or fiduciary, the capacity
in which such person is acting, and describe the relationship of that person to
you (or indicate that you are such person).




                      INSTITUTIONAL TYPE ACCOUNT QUESTIONS

5.       I am NOT, nor am I materially supported by, a senior officer of a bank,
         savings and loan institution, insurance company, investment company,
         investment advisory firm or any other INSTITUTIONAL TYPE ACCOUNT.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the company employing such
person, the type of company it is, the employee's position with that company,
and describe the relationship of that person to you (or indicate that you are
such person).




6.       I am NOT a person, nor am I materially supported by any person, who
         works in the securities department of, or who may influence, or whose
         activities directly or indirectly involve or are related to, the
         function of buying or selling securities for any bank, savings and loan
         institution, insurance company, investment company, investment advisory
         firm or any other INSTITUTIONAL TYPE ACCOUNT.

TRUE________ FALSE________ If FALSE, please name the company employing such
person, the type of company it is, the employee's position with that company,
and describe the relationship of that person to you (or indicate that you are
such person).


                                             -----------------------------------
                                                     For Tracking Purposes:
                                             Last Name:
                                             First Name:
- - 7 -                                        Social Security #:
                                             -----------------------------------

<PAGE>

                                                    "FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS"


IF YOU HAVE ANSWERED "FALSE" TO ANY OF THE QUESTIONS ABOVE, PLEASE ANSWER THE
FOLLOWING QUESTION:

                       SECURITY BROKERAGE ACCOUNT QUESTION

7.       Do you have an account with any broker-dealer in which you have
         actively traded equity securities in the last 12 months?

YES________ NO________ If YES, please name the broker-dealer and describe your
trading activity over this period, including the date you purchased or sold
equity securities, the name of the issuer of the security, the number of shares
purchased or sold, the price per share and the total purchase or sale price. You
should include trading activity (other than the purchase of mutual fund shares)
in any 401(k) or other retirement account.
Please type or print legibly. Attach additional sheets if necessary.

                        Buy/                                Price/
Date       Broker       Sell        Issuer       Shares     Share    Total Price












         Signature                                             Date

         Print Name

================================================================================
         NOTE: YOU MUST SIGN THIS FORM, WHETHER OR NOT YOU HAVE ANSWERED
                               QUESTION 7, ABOVE.
================================================================================

                                             -----------------------------------
                                                     For Tracking Purposes:
                                             Last Name:
                                             First Name:
- - 8 -                                        Social Security #:
                                             -----------------------------------


<PAGE>

                                                    "FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS"


                      FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS REGARDING
                THE SONIC AUTOMOTIVE, INC. RESERVED SHARE PROGRAM


O    WHAT FORMS WILL I NEED TO COMPLETE IN ORDER TO PARTICIPATE?

     There are three forms that everyone will need to complete in order to
     participate in the Reserved Share Program set up for Sonic Automotive, Inc.
     (the "Company"); the Expression of Interest Form, the Participant
     Information Form and the NASD Questionnaire (and Joint Account Holder NASD
     Questionnaire, if applicable). These forms are included in this package. In
     addition, some people may need to execute a Lock-up Agreement.

O    WHAT IS THE EXPRESSION OF INTEREST FORM?

     The Expression of Interest Form is a non-binding indication of how many
     shares you intend to purchase in the offering. It is only used to allocate
     the appropriate number of shares to the Reserved Share Program. No matter
     how many shares you indicate you may be interested in purchasing, you will
     not be bound to purchase any shares, or a particular number of shares,
     until you are notified of the price of the shares and confirm, at that
     time, the number of shares you wish to purchase.

O    WHY IS IT IMPORTANT THAT I COMPLETE THE NASD QUESTIONNAIRE?

     In order to comply with the rules of the NASD, a federal regulatory body,
     Merrill Lynch is required to gather certain information to determine your
     eligibility to purchase shares in the Reserved Share Program. It is
     important that you answer ALL of the questions completely and accurately.
     Please pay particular attention to the defined terms which will help you in
     responding to the questions. It is possible that your responses may require
     that certain steps be taken (including entering into a Lock-Up Agreement)
     in order for you to be eligible to participate in the Reserved Share
     Program, or may cause you to be ineligible to participate.

O    WHAT IS A LOCK-UP AGREEMENT?

     Under the NASD rules certain individuals associated with banks, insurance
     companies, broker-dealers or other institutional type accounts may only
     participate in the Reserved Share Program if they agree not to sell,
     transfer, assign, pledge or hypothecate any shares purchased for a
     specified period of time. Depending on your responses to the NASD
     questions, you may have to sign a Lock-up Agreement for 3 months.

O    WHEN CAN I SELL MY SHARES PURCHASED THROUGH THE RESERVED SHARE PROGRAM?

     The shares may be sold or transferred, subject to certain federal
     regulations governing the sale of shares by officers, directors and
     affiliates of the Company and subject to the Company's insider trading
     policies, at any time after their purchase (i.e., after you have paid for
     them), unless the shares are subject to a Lock-up Agreement. If you sign a
     Lock-up Agreement, the shares may not be sold or transferred for the term
     of that agreement.

                                      -1-
<PAGE>
                                                    "FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS"

O    IS IT NECESSARY TO OPEN A MERRILL LYNCH ACCOUNT TO PURCHASE SHARES IF I
     HAVE A BROKERAGE ACCOUNT AT ANOTHER FIRM?

     Yes, the shares must be purchased through Merrill Lynch. However, the
     shares may later be transferred (after the expiration of any Lock-up
     Agreement) to your non-Merrill Lynch account without incurring fees for
     such transfer.

O    WHAT IF I ALREADY HAVE A MERRILL LYNCH ACCOUNT?

     You should provide the branch at which your Merrill Lynch account is held,
     along with your account number and the name of your Financial Consultant,
     on the Participant Information Form. Your current Financial Consultant will
     contact you regarding your purchase of shares.

O    CAN I PURCHASE SHARES THROUGH MY EXISTING MERRILL LYNCH IRA ACCOUNT?

     Yes. However, if you do not have an existing IRA account at Merrill Lynch,
     it will be more difficult. The best advice is to talk to your Financial
     Consultant when you are contacted to see if such a transaction is possible.
     If you contemplate transferring your current IRA account to Merrill Lynch
     or liquidating assets currently held in your IRA account to purchase shares
     in the Reserved Share Program you should speak to your current Merrill
     Lynch Financial Consultant (if the IRA is held at Merrill Lynch) or the
     custodian of the account (if the IRA is not held at Merrill Lynch) as soon
     as possible concerning how and when to transfer the account or liquidate
     such assets to enable you to purchase the Company's Class A Common Stock.

O    CAN I PURCHASE SHARES THROUGH MY 401(K) PLAN?

     No.

O    CAN I PURCHASE SHARES THROUGH A JOINT ACCOUNT?

     Yes, subject to the joint account holder completing the Joint Account
     Holder NASD Questionnaire. As with you, it is possible that the joint
     account holder's answers may make him or her ineligible to participate in
     the Reserved Share Program, or may require that a Lock-up Agreement be
     signed by both of you. Please speak to your Merrill Lynch Financial
     Consultant if you intend to purchase shares through a joint account.

O    WILL I BE CHARGED BROKERAGE FEES FOR SETTING UP A NEW ACCOUNT AND
     PURCHASING SHARES?

     No. In order to accommodate the purchase of Reserved Shares at a minimal
     cost, Merrill Lynch has provided a type of account, known as a Delaware
     Cash Account, which provides no additional services other than the ability
     to purchase or sell securities. The standard $40.00 fee will not be charged
     to the holder of a Delaware Cash Account unless the account is maintained
     for the full calendar year running from January through December, 1998.
     There are various other types of accounts available, and there is an
     account maintenance fee payable in respect of each type of account,
     assuming that you do not close your account. Please consult your Financial
     Consultant with regard to account types and fee structures.

                                      -2-
<PAGE>
                                                    "FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS"

O    WILL I BE CHARGED A FEE WHEN I SELL OR TRANSFER MY SHARES?

     When you sell your shares you will be charged a customary sales commission.
     There is no fee to transfer the shares to another account. However, if you
     choose to receive share certificates at a later date there are typically
     fees involved with physical delivery of the share certificates to you.

O    WILL I RECEIVE A STOCK CERTIFICATE?

     Not automatically. If you desire an actual certificate, notify your Merrill
     Lynch Financial Consultant when your account is set up. Doing this will
     avoid subsequent charges for certificate delivery.

O    IF I CONTINUE TO USE THE DESIGNATED FINANCIAL CONSULTANT FOR SUBSEQUENT
     SECURITIES TRANSACTIONS, WILL MY TRANSACTIONS CONTINUE TO BE FREE OF
     TRANSACTION CHARGES?

     No. Transaction costs are only exempted for your purchase in the Reserved
     Share Program. You will be responsible for all transaction and brokerage
     fees for any subsequent transactions.

O    HOW WILL I BE ASSIGNED A MERRILL LYNCH FINANCIAL CONSULTANT? WHEN WILL I BE
     CONTACTED?

     A Merrill Lynch Financial Consultant will be selected based on geographic
     proximity to you to better facilitate ongoing service. You will be
     contacted by a Merrill Lynch Financial Consultant approximately one week
     before the expected pricing date. At that time you will be asked for
     information necessary to open a brokerage account. It takes time to open an
     account and an account must be opened prior to pricing so an order can be
     placed. You will be contacted again on the night of pricing or the next
     morning to be informed of the final price of the shares and to confirm your
     participation.

O    WHAT INFORMATION WILL THE MERRILL LYNCH FINANCIAL CONSULTANT ASK ME FOR?

     The Merrill Lynch Financial Consultant will ask for your social security
     number, your date of birth, your salary (a regulatory requirement), and
     your address, among other information, and the same information for your
     spouse, if applicable, or other joint account holder.

O    IF I COMPLETE AND TIMELY SUBMIT THE REQUIRED FORMS, BUT A MERRILL LYNCH
     FINANCIAL CONSULTANT DOES NOT MANAGE TO CONTACT ME PERSONALLY PRIOR TO THE
     PRICING DATE, WILL MY PURCHASE REQUEST BE HONORED?

     No. An account can only be established for you after a conversation with a
     Merrill Lynch Financial Consultant prior to the pricing of the shares, and
     the purchase of the shares can only be confirmed for you through a
     follow-up conversation with a Financial Consultant after the pricing of the
     shares. If the Financial Consultant cannot reach you, your order will be
     disregarded. IF YOU COMPLETE AND RETURN THE EXPRESSION OF INTEREST FORM AND
     YOU HAVE NOT BEEN CONTACTED BY A MERRILL LYNCH FINANCIAL CONSULTANT BY
     OCTOBER ___, 1997 YOU SHOULD CONTACT THE RESERVED SHARE PROGRAM HOTLINE AT
     (212) 449-8209 BETWEEN THE HOURS OF 8:00 A.M. AND 6:00 P.M. EASTERN TIME,
     MONDAY THROUGH FRIDAY.

                                      -3-
<PAGE>
                                                    "FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS"

O    WILL I BE ABLE TO PURCHASE ALL OF THE SHARES I REQUEST ON THE EXPRESSION OF
     INTEREST FORM?

     The number of shares you indicate on the Expression of Interest Form is the
     maximum number of shares which you may purchase. If the total number of
     shares requested by all participants in the Reserved Share Program exceeds
     the number of shares available for purchase, an allocation will be made in
     a manner to be determined.

O    WHAT WILL THE PRICE OF THE SHARES BE?

     The purchase price to you will be the offering price to the public, which
     is presently expected to be between $__ and $__ per share, but which may be
     higher or lower. You will be contacted by your Merrill Lynch Financial
     Consultant with the actual price after that price is determined, which is
     currently expected to occur during the week of October ___, 1997.

O    WHEN DO I PAY FOR THE SHARES?

     The full balance will be due no later than the close of business three
     business days after the opening trade date (which is typically the day of
     pricing or the day after pricing). Your Merrill Lynch Financial Consultant
     will telephone you as soon as possible after pricing occurs to confirm the
     number of shares you wish to purchase and the purchase price. You should
     make your payment immediately after you know the payment amount. You will
     be mailed a confirmation of your transaction the day after pricing.

O    WHAT FORMS OF PAYMENT MAY I USE?

     You may pay by personal check, wire transfer, certified check or cashier's
     check. You should review your method of payment with your Merrill Lynch
     Financial Consultant in advance to ensure timely receipt of your payment.

O    WHAT HAPPENS IF I AM NOT AVAILABLE WHEN MY MERRILL LYNCH FINANCIAL
     CONSULTANT CALLS ME AFTER PRICING?

     You will only be able to purchase shares through the Reserved Share Program
     if you speak to your Merrill Lynch Financial Consultant after pricing of
     the offering. If you will not be available at or around the expected
     pricing date, please make arrangements with your Merrill Lynch Financial
     Consultant so that you may be contacted.

O    IF I DECIDE TO PARTICIPATE AFTER THE DEADLINE OF OCTOBER __, 1997 HAS
     PASSED, WILL I BE ABLE TO?

     No. The deadline is necessary to give Financial Consultants enough time to
     set up accounts before the pricing of the shares. The account must be open
     by this time so that there is a place to credit the shares at the time of
     pricing.



                                      -4-
<PAGE>

                                                    "FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS"

O    CAN OTHER PEOPLE, INCLUDING MY RELATIVES AND FRIENDS, BUY SHARES THROUGH
     THE RESERVED SHARE PROGRAM?

     No, the Reserved Share Program is limited to those persons invited to
     participate by the Company. No relatives or other persons (other than
     members of your immediate family purchasing jointly with you) are eligible
     to purchase shares.

O    IF I HAVE FURTHER QUESTIONS WHO SHOULD I CALL?

     If you have a question prior to the time you are contacted by a Merrill
     Lynch Financial Consultant, please call the Reserved Share Program Hotline
     at (212) 449-8209 between the hours of 8:00 a.m. and 6:00 p.m. Eastern
     time, Monday through Friday. After that time, please contact your Merrill
     Lynch Financial Consultant.


                                      -5-
<PAGE>

    


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission